You are on page 1of 678

FANUC Series 30*-MODEL A FANUC Series 31*-MODEL A FANUC Series 32*-MODEL A

PARAMETER MANUAL

B-63950EN/04

No part of this manual may be reproduced in any form. All specifications and designs are subject to change without notice. The products in this manual are controlled based on Japans Foreign Exchange and Foreign Trade Law. The export of Series 30i/300i/300is-MODEL A, Series 31i/310i/310is-MODEL A5 from Japan is subject to an export license by the government of Japan. Other models in this manual may also be subject to export controls. Further, re-export to another country may be subject to the license of the government of the country from where the product is re-exported. Furthermore, the product may also be controlled by re-export regulations of the United States government. Should you wish to export or re-export these products, please contact FANUC for advice. In this manual we have tried as much as possible to describe all the various matters. However, we cannot describe all the matters which must not be done, or which cannot be done, because there are so many possibilities. Therefore, matters which are not especially described as possible in this manual should be regarded as impossible.

CHANGE IN CNC MODEL NAMES

CHANGE IN CNC MODEL NAMES


The model names of the following CNCs described in this manual have been changed from those shown in lower lines to those shown in upper lines in fields of the following table. The model names were changed, but their specifications remain unchanged. Keep the following in mind when using these models. Replace the old model names in this manual with the corresponding new model names. Replace the old model names indicated by the machines with the corresponding new model names.
Table 1 CNC Model Names Model name FANUC Series 30i-MODEL A (Old model name : FANUC Series 300i-MODEL A) FANUC Series 30i-MODEL A (Old model name : FANUC Series 300is-MODEL A) FANUC Series 31i-MODEL A (Old model name : FANUC Series 310i-MODEL A) FANUC Series 31i-MODEL A5 (Old model name : FANUC Series 310i-MODEL A5) FANUC Series 31i-MODEL A (Old model name : FANUC Series 310is-MODEL A) FANUC Series 31i-MODEL A5 (Old model name : FANUC Series 310is-MODEL A5) FANUC Series 32i-MODEL A (Old model name : FANUC Series 320i-MODEL A) FANUC Series 32i-MODEL A (Old model name : FANUC Series 320is-MODEL A) 30i A (300iA) 30i A (300isA) 31i A (310iA) 31i A5 (310iA5) 31i A (310isA) 31i A5 (310isA5) 32i A (320iA) 32i A (320isA) Abbreviation Series 30i (Series 300i) Series 30i (Series 300is) Series 31i (Series 310i)

Series 31i (Series 310is)

Series 32i (Series 320i) Series 32i (Series 320is)

B-63950EN/04

DEFINITION OF WARNING, CAUTION, AND NOTE

DEFINITION OF WARNING, CAUTION, AND NOTE


This manual includes safety precautions for protecting the user and preventing damage to the machine. Precautions are classified into Warning and Caution according to their bearing on safety. Also, supplementary information is described as a Note. Read the Warning, Caution, and Note thoroughly before attempting to use the machine.

WARNING Applied when there is a danger of the user being injured or when there is a danger of both the user being injured and the equipment being damaged if the approved procedure is not observed. CAUTION Applied when there is a danger of the equipment being damaged, if the approved procedure is not observed. NOTE The Note is used to indicate supplementary information other than Warning and Caution.
Read this manual carefully, and store it in a safe place.

s-1

B-63950EN/04

PREFACE

PREFACE
Applicable models
The models covered by this manual, and their abbreviations are :
Model name FANUC Series 30i MODEL A FANUC Series 300iMODEL A FANUC Series 300isMODEL A FANUC Series 31i MODEL A FANUC Series 31i MODEL A5 FANUC Series 310iMODEL A FANUC Series 310iMODEL A5 FANUC Series 310isMODEL A FANUC Series 310isMODEL A5 FANUC Series 32i MODEL A FANUC Series 320iMODEL A FANUC Series 320isMODEL A Abbreviation Series 30i Series 300i Series 300is Series 31i Series 310i Series 310is Series 32i Series 320i Series 320is

30i A 300iA 300isA 31i A 31i A5 310iA 310iA5 310isA 310isA5 32i A 320iA 320isA

NOTE 1 For an explanatory purpose, the following descriptions may be used according to the types of path control used: - T series: For the lathe system - M series: For the machining center system 2 Unless otherwise noted, the model names 31i/310i/310is-A, 31i/310i/310is-A5, and 32i/320i/320is-A are collectively referred to as 30i/300i/300is. However, this convention is not necessarily observed when item 3 below is applicable. 3 Some functions described in this manual may not be applied to some products. For details, refer to the DESCRIPTIONS (B-63942EN).

Related manuals of Series 30i/300i/300is- MODEL A Series 31i/310i/310is- MODEL A Series 32i/320i/320is- MODEL A
The following table lists the manuals related to Series 30i/300i /300is-A, Series 31i/310i /310is-A, Series 32i/320i /320is-A. This manual is indicated by an asterisk(*).
Table 1 Related manuals Manual name DESCRIPTIONS CONNECTION MANUAL (HARDWARE) CONNECTION MANUAL (FUNCTION) OPERATORS MANUAL (Common to Lathe System/Machining Center System) OPERATORS MANUAL (For Lathe System) OPERATORS MANUAL (For Machining Center System) MAINTENANCE MANUAL PARAMETER MANUAL Programming Macro Executor PROGRAMMING MANUAL Macro Compiler PROGRAMMING MANUAL C Language Executor PROGRAMMING MANUAL Specification number B-63942EN B-63943EN B-63943EN-1 B-63944EN B-63944EN-1 B-63944EN-2 B-63945EN B-63950EN B-63943EN-2 B-66263EN B-63943EN-3

p-1

PREFACE
Manual name PMC PMC PROGRAMMING MANUAL Network PROFIBUS-DP Board CONNECTION MANUAL Fast Ethernet / Fast Data Server OPERATORS MANUAL DeviceNet Board CONNECTION MANUAL FL-net Board CONNECTION MANUAL CC-Link Board CONNECTION MANUAL Operation guidance function MANUAL GUIDE i (Common to Lathe System/Machining Center System) OPERATORS MANUAL MANUAL GUIDE i (For Machining Center System) OPERATORS MANUAL MANUAL GUIDE i (Set-up Guidance Functions) OPERATORS MANUAL Dual Check Safety Dual Check Safety CONNECTION MANUAL

B-63950EN/04

Specification number B-63983EN B-63993EN B-64014EN B-64043EN B-64163EN B-64463EN B-63874EN B-63874EN-2 B-63874EN-1

B-64003EN

Related manuals of SERVO MOTOR i/i series


The following table lists the manuals related to SERVO MOTOR i/i series
Table 2 Related manuals Manual name FANUC AC SERVO MOTOR i series DESCRIPTIONS FANUC AC SERVO MOTOR i series / FANUC AC SERVO MOTOR i series / FANUC LINEAR MOTOR LiS series / FANUC SYNCHRONOUS BUILT-IN SERVO MOTOR DiS series PARAMETER MANUAL FANUC AC SPINDLE MOTOR i series DESCRIPTIONS FANUC AC SPINDLE MOTOR i/i series, BUILT-IN SPINDLE MOTOR Bi series PARAMETER MANUAL FANUC SERVO AMPLIFIER i series DESCRIPTIONS FANUC AC SERVO MOTOR i series / FANUC AC SPINDLE MOTOR i series / FANUC SERVO AMPLIFIER i series MAINTENANCE MANUAL

Specification number B-65262EN B-65270EN B-65272EN B-65280EN B-65282EN B-65285EN

CNCs that are described in this manual can be connected to following servo motors and spindle motors. This manual mainly assumes that the FANUC SERVO MOTOR i series of servo motor is used. For servo motor and spindle information, refer to the manuals for the servo motor and spindle that are actually connected.

p-2

B-63950EN/04

TABLE OF CONTENTS

TABLE OF CONTENTS
DEFINITION OF WARNING, CAUTION, AND NOTE .................................s-1 PREFACE ....................................................................................................p-2 1 2 3 DISPLAYING PARAMETERS................................................................. 1 SETTING PARAMETERS FROM MDI .................................................... 2 INPUTTING AND OUTPUTTING PARAMETERS THROUGH THE READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE ................................................. 4
3.1 3.2 3.3 OUTPUTTING PARAMETERS THROUGH THE READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE .................................................................................................. 4 INPUTTING PARAMETERS THROUGH THE READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE .................................................................................................. 5 I/O FORMATS ............................................................................................... 6
3.3.1 3.3.2 3.3.3 3.3.4 3.3.5 3.3.6 3.3.7 3.3.8 3.3.9 3.3.10 3.3.11 3.3.12 3.3.13 3.3.14 3.3.15 3.3.16 3.3.17 3.3.18 Keywords .................................................................................................................6 Inch/Metric Switching ..............................................................................................7 Bit Format.................................................................................................................7 Bit Machine Group Format ......................................................................................7 Bit Path Format ........................................................................................................8 Bit Axis Format ........................................................................................................8 Bit Spindle Format ...................................................................................................9 Byte/Word/Two-Word Format.................................................................................9 Byte/Word/Two-Word Machine Group Format.......................................................9 Byte/Word/Two-Word Path Format.......................................................................10 Byte/Word/Two-Word Axis Format ......................................................................10 Byte/Word/Two-Word Spindle Format..................................................................11 Real Number Format ..............................................................................................11 Real Number Machine Group Format ....................................................................12 Real Number Path Format ......................................................................................12 Real Number Axis Format......................................................................................13 Real Number Spindle Format.................................................................................13 Start and End of a Record.......................................................................................14

DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS ...................................................... 15


4.1 4.2 4.3 4.4 4.5 DATA TYPE................................................................................................. 15 REPRESENTATION OF PARAMETERS .................................................... 16 STANDARD PARAMETER SETTING TABLES........................................... 17 PARAMETERS OF SETTING...................................................................... 18 PARAMETERS OF READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE .............................. 21
4.5.1 4.5.2 4.5.3 4.5.4 Parameters Common to All Channels ....................................................................21 Parameters of Channel 1 (I/O CHANNEL=0) .......................................................24 Parameters of Channel 1 (I/O CHANNEL=1) .......................................................25 Parameters of Channel 2 (I/O CHANNEL=2) .......................................................26

4.6 4.7 4.8 4.9

PARAMETERS OF CNC SCREEN DISPLAY FUNCTIONS........................ 26 PARAMETERS OF ETHERNET/DATA SERVER FUNCTIONS.................. 27 PARAMETERS OF POWER MATE CNC .................................................... 30 PARAMETERS OF SYSTEM CONFIGURATION ....................................... 30
c-1

TABLE OF CONTENTS 4.10 4.11 4.12 4.13 4.14 4.15 4.16 4.17 4.18 4.19 4.20 4.21 4.22 4.23

B-63950EN/04

PARAMETERS OF AXIS CONTROL/INCREMENT SYSTEM (1 OF 3) ...... 33 PARAMETERS OF COORDINATE SYSTEM (1 OF 2) ............................... 44 PARAMETERS OF STORED STROKE CHECK ......................................... 51 PARAMETERS OF THE CHUCK AND TAIL STOCK BARRIER ................. 56 PARAMETERS OF FEEDRATE .................................................................. 61 PARAMETERS OF ACCELERATION/DECELERATION CONTROL .......... 75 PARAMETERS OF SERVO (1 OF 2) .......................................................... 90 PARAMETERS OF DI/DO (1 OF 2)........................................................... 126 PARAMETERS OF DISPLAY AND EDIT (1 OF 5) .................................... 136 PARAMETERS OF PROGRAMS (1 OF 4) ................................................ 166 PARAMETERS OF PITCH ERROR COMPENSATION ............................ 181 PARAMETERS OF SPINDLE CONTROL ................................................. 188 PARAMETERS OF TOOL COMPENSATION (1 OF 3) ............................. 224 PARAMETERS OF CANNED CYCLES..................................................... 245
4.23.1 4.23.2 4.23.3 4.23.4 4.23.5 Parameters of Canned Cycle for Drilling (1 of 2) ................................................245 Parameters of Thread Cutting Cycle ....................................................................251 Parameters of Multiple Repetitive Canned Cycle ................................................252 Parameters of Canned Cycle for Drilling (2 of 2) ................................................256 Parameters of Canned Cycle for Grinding (for Grinding Machine).....................261

4.24 4.25 4.26 4.27 4.28 4.29 4.30 4.31 4.32 4.33 4.34 4.35 4.36 4.37 4.38 4.39 4.40 4.41 4.42 4.43 4.44 4.45 4.46 4.47 4.48 4.49

PARAMETERS OF RIGID TAPPING ........................................................ 264 PARAMETERS OF SCALING/COORDINATE ROTATION ....................... 276 PARAMETERS OF SINGLE DIRECTION POSITIONING ......................... 278 PARAMETERS OF POLAR COORDINATE INTERPOLATION ................ 279 PARAMETERS OF NORMAL DIRECTION CONTROL............................. 280 PARAMETERS OF INDEX TABLE INDEXING.......................................... 282 PARAMETERS OF INVOLUTE INTERPOLATION ................................... 285 PARAMETERS OF EXPONENTIAL INTERPOLATION ............................ 285 PARAMETERS OF FLEXIBLE SYNCHRONOUS CONTROL (1 OF 2) .... 286 PARAMETERS OF STRAIGHTNESS COMPENSATION (1 OF 2) ........... 289 PARAMETERS OF INCLINATION COMPENSATION .............................. 292 PARAMETERS OF CUSTOM MACROS ................................................... 294 PARAMETERS OF PATTERN DATA INPUT ............................................ 311 PARAMETERS OF POSITIONING BY OPTIMUM ACCELERATION ....... 312 PARAMETERS OF SKIP FUNCTION ....................................................... 314 PARAMETERS OF EXTERNAL DATA INPUT/OUTPUT .......................... 324 PARAMETERS OF FINE TORQUE SENSING.......................................... 327 PARAMETERS OF MANUAL HANDLE RETRACE (1 OF 2) .................... 328 PARAMETERS OF GRAPHIC DISPLAY (1 OF 5) .................................... 333 PARAMETERS OF SCREEN DISPLAY COLORS (1 OF 2)...................... 335 PARAMETERS OF RUN HOUR AND PARTS COUNT DISPLAY............. 336 PARAMETERS OF TOOL MANAGEMENT FUNCTIONS (1 OF 2)........... 339 PARAMETERS OF TOOL LIFE MANAGEMENT (1 OF 2)........................ 339 PARAMETERS OF POSITION SWITCH FUNCTIONS ............................. 348 PARAMETERS OF MANUAL OPERATION AND AUTOMATIC OPERATION.............................................................................................. 350 PARAMETERS OF MANUAL HANDLE (1 OF 2) ...................................... 352
c-2

B-63950EN/04

TABLE OF CONTENTS PARAMETERS OF REFERENCE POSITION WITH MECHANICAL STOPPER ................................................................................................. 357 PARAMETERS OF SOFTWARE OPERATOR'S PANEL .......................... 358 PARAMETERS OF PROGRAM RESTART (1 OF 2)................................. 361 PARAMETERS OF HIGH-SPEED CYCLE CUTTING ............................... 362 PARAMETERS OF ROTARY TABLE DYNAMIC FIXTURE OFFSET ....... 370 PARAMETERS OF POLYGON TURNING ................................................ 371 PARAMETERS OF THE ELECTRONIC GEAR BOX (EGB) ..................... 378 PARAMETERS OF AXIS CONTROL BY PMC (1 OF 3) ........................... 387 PARAMETERS OF MULTI-PATH CONTROL ........................................... 395 PARAMETERS OF INTERFERENCE CHECK BETWEEN PATHS .......... 398 PARAMETERS OF SYNCHRONOUS/COMPOSITE CONTROL AND SUPERIMPOSED CONTROL (1 OF 3) ..................................................... 402 PARAMETERS OF ANGULAR AXIS CONTROL ...................................... 415 PARAMETERS OF AXIS SYNCHRONOUS CONTROL ........................... 417 PARAMETERS OF SEQUENCE NUMBER COMPARISON AND STOP .. 425 PARAMETERS OF CHOPPING ................................................................ 426 PARAMETERS OF AI CONTOUR CONTROL (1 OF 2)............................ 428 PARAMETERS OF HIGH-SPEED POSITION SWITCH (1 OF 2) ............. 431 OTHER PARAMETERS ............................................................................ 435 PARAMETERS OF MAINTENANCE ......................................................... 440 PARAMETERS OF THE INCORRECT OPERATION PREVENTION FUNCTION ................................................................................................ 441 PARAMETERS OF AUTOMATIC DATA BACKUP.................................... 448 PARAMETERS OF AXIS CONTROL ........................................................ 449 PARAMETERS OF PARALLEL AXIS CONTROL ..................................... 450 PARAMETERS OF AXIS SWITCHING ..................................................... 451 PARAMETERS OF TOOL RETRACT AND RECOVER ............................ 451 PARAMETERS OF SCREEN DISPLAY COLORS (2 OF 2)...................... 451 PARAMETERS OF SMOOTH TCP ........................................................... 452 PARAMETERS OF DUAL CHECK SAFETY (1 OF 2) ............................... 453 PARAMETERS OF WAVEFORM DIAGNOSIS ......................................... 454 PARAMETERS OF 3-DIMENSIONAL ERROR COMPENSATION ........... 454 PARAMETERS OF 3-DIMENSIONAL MACHINE POSITION COMPENSATION...................................................................................... 456 PARAMETERS OF ROTATION AREA INTERFERENCE CHECK (1 OF 2) ..................................................................................................... 458 PARAMETERS OF SPINDLE CONTROL WITH SERVO MOTOR ........... 463 PARAMETERS OF WORKPIECE SETTING ERROR COMPENSATION (1 OF 2) ..................................................................................................... 469 PARAMETERS OF LINEAR INCLINATION COMPENSATION FUNCTION ................................................................................................ 470 PARAMETERS OF TILTED WORKING PLANE COMMAND.................... 471 PARAMETERS OF AXIS CONTROL/INCREMENT SYSTEM (2 OF 3) .... 472 PARAMETERS OF DI/DO (2 OF 2)........................................................... 472

4.50 4.51 4.52 4.53 4.54 4.55 4.56 4.57 4.58 4.59 4.60 4.61 4.62 4.63 4.64 4.65 4.66 4.67 4.68 4.69 4.70 4.71 4.72 4.73 4.74 4.75 4.76 4.77 4.78 4.79 4.80 4.81 4.82 4.83 4.84 4.85 4.86 4.87

c-3

TABLE OF CONTENTS 4.88 4.89 4.90 4.91 4.92 4.93 4.94 4.95 4.96 4.97 4.98 4.99 4.100 4.101 4.102 4.103 4.104 4.105 4.106 4.107 4.108 4.109 4.110 4.111 4.112 4.113 4.114 4.115 4.116 4.117 4.118 4.119 4.120 4.121 4.122 4.123 4.124

B-63950EN/04

PARAMETERS OF FEEDRATE CONTROL AND ACCELERATION/DECELERATION CONTROL........................................ 473 PARAMETERS OF PROGRAM RESTART (2 OF 2)................................. 474 PARAMETERS OF TOOL CENTER POINT CONTROL ........................... 475 PARAMETERS OF COORDINATE SYSTEM (2 OF 2) ............................. 477 PARAMETERS OF SYNCHRONOUS/COMPOSITE CONTROL AND SUPERIMPOSED CONTROL (2 OF 3) ..................................................... 478 PARAMETERS OF PROGRAMS (2 OF 4) ................................................ 478 PARAMETERS OF DISPLAY AND EDIT (2 OF 5) .................................... 479 PARAMETERS OF EMBEDDED MACRO (1 OF 2) .................................. 485 PARAMETERS OF DISPLAY AND EDIT (3 OF 5) .................................... 486 PARAMETERS OF GRAPHIC DISPLAY (2 OF 5) .................................... 488 PARAMETERS OF DISPLAY AND EDIT (4 OF 5) .................................... 492 PARAMETERS OF TOOL COMPENSATION (2 OF 3) ............................. 496 PARAMETERS OF OPTIMUM TORQUE ACCELERATION/DECELERATION FOR RIGID TAPPING ...................... 498 PARAMETERS OF PROGRAMS (3 OF 4) ................................................ 501 PARAMETERS OF MACHINING QUALITY LEVEL ADJUSTMENT ......... 505 PARAMETERS OF WORKPIECE SETTING ERROR COMPENSATION (2 OF 2) ..................................................................................................... 506 PARAMETERS OF SERVO (2 OF 2) ........................................................ 508 PARAMETERS OF AXIS CONTROL BY PMC (2 OF 3) ........................... 509 PARAMETERS OF PMC ........................................................................... 509 PARAMETERS OF EMBEDDED MACRO (2 OF 2) .................................. 518 PARAMETERS OF HIGH-SPEED POSITION SWITCH (2 OF 2) ............. 520 PARAMETERS OF MALFUNCTION PROTECTION................................. 521 PARAMETERS OF MANUAL HANDLE (2 OF 2) ...................................... 521 PARAMETERS OF SYNCHRONOUS/COMPOSITE CONTROL AND SUPERIMPOSED CONTROL (3 OF 3) ..................................................... 528 PARAMETERS OF AXIS CONTROL BY PMC (3 OF 3) ........................... 529 PARAMETERS OF EXTERNAL DECELERATION POSITIONS EXPANSION.............................................................................................. 531 PARAMETERS OF DISPLAY AND EDIT (5 OF 5) .................................... 533 PARAMETERS OF TOOL MANAGEMENT FUNCTIONS (2 OF 2)........... 541 PARAMETERS OF TOOL LIFE MANAGEMENT (2 OF 2)........................ 552 PARAMETERS OF STRAIGHTNESS COMPENSATION (2 OF 2) ........... 553 PARAMETERS OF FLEXIBLE SYNCHRONOUS CONTROL (2 OF 2) .... 554 PARAMETERS OF PROGRAMS (4 OF 4) ................................................ 557 PARAMETERS OF MANUAL LINER/CIRCULAR INTERPOLATION........ 558 PARAMETERS OF CANNED CYCLES FOR DRILLING M CODE OUTPUT IMPROVEMENT ........................................................................ 559 PARAMETERS OF THE MACHINING CONDITION SELECTION FUNCTION ................................................................................................ 559 PARAMETERS OF PARAMETER CHECK SUM FUNCTION ................... 564 PARAMETERS OF DUAL CHECK SAFETY (2 OF 2) ............................... 567

c-4

B-63950EN/04

TABLE OF CONTENTS PARAMETERS OF PARAMETERS OF AXIS CONTROL/INCREMENT SYSTEM (3 OF 3)...................................................................................... 568 PARAMETERS OF LINEAR SCALE WITH ABSOLUTE ADDRESS REFERENCE POSITION .......................................................................... 568 PARAMETERS OF PIVOT AXIS CONTROL............................................. 569 PARAMETERS OF FSSB.......................................................................... 572 PARAMETERS OF SERVO GUIDE Mate ................................................. 579 PARAMETERS OF GRAPHIC DISPLAY (3 OF 5) .................................... 579 PARAMETERS OF EMBEDDED ETHERNET........................................... 581 PARAMETERS OF ROTATION AREA INTERFERENCE CHECK (2 OF 2) ..................................................................................................... 583 PARAMETERS OF PERIODICAL SECONDARY PITCH COMPENSATION...................................................................................... 600 PARAMETERS OF MANUAL HANDLE RETRACE (2 OF 2) .................... 601 PARAMETERS OF AI CONTOUR CONTROL (2 OF 2)............................ 603 PARAMETERS OF CYLINDRICAL INTERPOLATION.............................. 604 PARAMETERS OF OPTIMAL TORQUE ACCELERATION/DECELERATION .......................................................... 606 PARAMETERS OF NANO SMOOTHING.................................................. 608 PARAMETERS OF TOOL COMPENSATION (3 OF 3) ............................. 609 PARAMETERS OF 5-AXIS MACHINING FUNCTION............................... 615 PARAMETERS OF GRAPHIC DISPLAY (4 OF 5) .................................... 634 PARAMETERS OF SPINDLE UNIT COMPENSATION AND NUTATING ROTARY HEAD TOOL LENGTH COMPENSATION................................. 635 PARAMETERS OF GRAPHIC DISPLAY (5 OF 5) .................................... 638

4.125 4.126 4.127 4.128 4.129 4.130 4.131 4.132 4.133 4.134 4.135 4.136 4.137 4.138 4.139 4.140 4.141 4.142 4.143

APPENDIX A CHARACTER CODE LIST .................................................................. 657

c-5

B-63950EN/04

1.DISPLAYING PARAMETERS

1
1

DISPLAYING PARAMETERS
Press the function key on the MDI as many times as required, or alternatively, press the

Follow the procedure below to display parameters.

function key once, then the [PARAM] section display soft key. The parameter screen is then selected.

Function keys

The parameter screen consists of multiple pages. Use step (a) or (b) to display the page that contains the parameter you want to display. (a) Use the page select key or the cursor move keys to display the desired page. (b) Enter the data number of the parameter you want to display from the keyboard, then press the [NO.SRH] soft key. The parameter page containing the specified data number appears with the cursor positioned at the data number. (The data is displayed in reverse video.)

NOTE If key entry is started with the section select soft keys displayed, they are replaced automatically by operation select soft keys including [NO.SRH]. Pressing the [(OPRT)] soft key can also cause the operation select keys to be displayed.

-1-

2.SETTING PARAMETERS FROM MDI

B-63950EN/04

SETTING PARAMETERS FROM MDI

Follow the procedure below to set parameters. 1 Place the NC in the MDI mode or the emergency stop state. 2 Follow the substeps below to enable writing of parameters. 2-1 To display the setting screen, press the alternatively press the function key as many times as required, or

function key once, then the [SETTING] section select soft key.

(The first page of the setting screen appears.)

2-2 Position the cursor on "PARAMETER WRITE" using the cursor move keys. 2-3 Press the [(OPRT)] soft key to display operation select soft keys.

2-4 To set "PARAMETER WRITE=" to 1, press the [ON:1] soft key, or alternatively enter 1 and press the [INPUT] soft key. From now on, the parameters can be set. At the same time an alarm condition (SW0100 PARAMETER WRITE ENABLE) occurs in the CNC. 3 To display the parameter screen, press the alternatively press the 4 5 function key as many times as required, or

function key once, then the [PARAM] section select soft key. (See

Chapter 1, "DISPLAYING PARAMETERS.") Display the page containing the parameter you want to set, and position the cursor on the parameter. (See Chapter 1, "DISPLAYING PARAMETERS.") Enter data, then press the [INPUT] soft key. The parameter indicated by the cursor is set to the entered data. 12000 [INPUT]

[Example]

-2-

B-63950EN/04

2.SETTING PARAMETERS FROM MDI

6 7 8

Data can be entered continuously for parameters, starting at the selected parameter, by separating each data item with a semicolon (;). [Example] Entering 10;20;30;40 and pressing the [INPUT] soft key assigns values 10, 20, 30, and 40 to parameters in order starting at the parameter indicated by the cursor. Repeat steps (4) and (5) as required. If parameter setting is complete, set "PARAMETER WRITE=" to 0 on the setting screen to disable further parameter setting. Reset the NC to release the alarm condition (SW0100). If an alarm condition (PW0000 PLEASE TURN OFF POWER) occurs in the NC, turn it off before continuing operation.

-3-

3. INPUTTING AND OUTPUTTING PARAMETERS THROUGH THE READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE

B-63950EN/04

INPUTTING AND OUTPUTTING PARAMETERS THROUGH THE READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE

This section explains the parameter input/output procedures for input/output devices connected to the reader/puncher interface. The following description assumes the input/output devices are ready for input/output. It also assumes parameters peculiar to the input/output devices, such as the baud rate and the number of stop bits, have been set in advance. (See Section 4.5, PARAMETERS OF READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE.)

3.1
1 2

OUTPUTTING PARAMETERS THROUGH THE READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE


Select the EDIT mode or set to Emergency stop. To select the parameter screen, press the alternatively press the function key as many times as required, or

function key once, then the [PARAM] section select soft key.

Press the [(OPRT)] soft key to display operation select soft keys, then press the forward menu key located at the right-hand side of the soft keys to display another set of operation select keys including [PUNCH].

Pressing the [PUNCH] soft key changes the soft key display as shown below:

5 6

Press the [EXEC] soft key to start parameter output. When parameters are being output, "OUTPUT" blinks in the state display field on the lower part of the screen. When parameter output terminates, "OUTPUT" stops blinking. Press the parameter output.
-4-

key to interrupt

B-63950EN/04

3. INPUTTING AND OUTPUTTING PARAMETERS THROUGH THE READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE

3.2
1 2

INPUTTING PARAMETERS THROUGH THE READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE


Place the NC in the emergency stop state. Enable parameter writing. 2-1 To display the setting screen, press the alternatively press the function key as many times as required, or

function key once, then the [SETTING] section select soft key.

The first page of the setting screen appears. 2-2 Position the cursor on "PARAMETER WRITE" using the cursor move keys. 2-3 Press the [(OPRT)] soft key to display operation select soft keys. 2-4 To set "PARAMETER WRITE=" to 1, press the [ON:1] soft key, or alternatively enter 1, then press the [INPUT] soft key. From now on, parameters can be set. At the same time an alarm condition (SW0100 PARAMETER WRITE ENABLE) occurs in the NC. 3 To select the parameter screen, press the alternatively press the 4 function key as many times as required, or

key once, then [PARAM] soft key.

Press the [(OPRT)] soft key to display operation select keys, then press the forward menu key located at the right-hand side of the soft keys to display another set of operation select soft keys including [READ].

Pressing the [READ] soft key changes the soft key display as shown below:

Press the [EXEC] soft key to start inputting parameters from the input/output device. When parameters are being input, "INPUT" blinks in the state display field on the lower part of the screen. Press the key to interrupt parameter input. When parameter read terminates, "INPUT" stops blinking, and an alarm condition (PW0100) occurs in the NC. Turn it off before continuing operation.

-5-

3. INPUTTING AND OUTPUTTING PARAMETERS THROUGH THE READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE

B-63950EN/04

3.3

I/O FORMATS

This section describes the I/O formats of parameters. Parameters are classified by data format as follows:
Data format Bit Bit machine group Bit path Bit axis Bit spindle Byte Byte machine group Byte path Byte axis Byte spindle Word Word machine group Word path Word axis Word spindle 2-word 2-word machine group 2-word path 2-word axis 2-word spindle Real Real machine group Real path Real axis Real spindle Remarks Data of these formats is represented by an 8-digit binary number, with each digit corresponding to a bit.

The setting range of data varies from one parameter to another. For details, refer to the description of each parameter.

3.3.1

Keywords

The alphabetic characters listed below are used as keywords. A numeric value after each keyword has the following meaning:
Keyword N Q A S P M I Meaning of a numeric value that follows Parameter number Data identifier (1: Parameter data, 0: Pitch error compensation data) Machine group number (1 and up) of a machine group type parameter Path number (1 and up) of a path type parameter Controlled axis number (1 and up) of an axis type parameter Spindle number (1 and up) of a spindle type parameter Value of a parameter independent of inch/metric switching Metric input value of a parameter dependent on inch/metric switching Inch input value of a parameter dependent on inch/metric switching

-6-

B-63950EN/04

3. INPUTTING AND OUTPUTTING PARAMETERS THROUGH THE READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE

3.3.2

Inch/Metric Switching

For parameters dependent on inch/metric switching such as those for length and feedrate, whether data is inch data or metric data is specified by the input mode in the case of input from the MDI panel, or by the keyword I or M prefixed to the data in the case of input from an external I/O device. The keyword I or M is added also when data is output from an external I/O device. If the input mode or keyword differs from the actually used mode as in a case where data input in the inch mode is used in the metric mode, the CNC performs automatic data conversion. So, data need not be converted according to a mode change. Moreover, when parameter data is displayed, the data is converted according to the display mode. However, when data is output from an external I/O device, the original data is output according to the original keyword.

3.3.3
N

Bit Format
***** Q1 P ******** ;

A numeric value after N represents a parameter number. Q1 indicates that the data is parameter data. An 8-digit binary number after P represents the bit values (0/1) of a parameter, with the first digit corresponding to bit 0 and the eighth digit corresponding to bit 7. Leading zeros may not be omitted. A semicolon (;) marks the end of a block. (LF is used for the ISO code, and CR is used for the EIA code.)

Example N00010Q1P00000001; Parameter No. 10 Parameter value Bit 0 is set to 1, and the other bits are set to 0.

3.3.4
N *****

Bit Machine Group Format


Q1 T ** P ******** T ** P ******** ;

A numeric value after N represents a parameter number. Q1 indicates that the data is parameter data. A numeric value after T represents a machine group number (1 and up). An 8-digit binary number after P represents the bit values (0/1) of a parameter for each machine group, with the first digit corresponding to bit 0 and the eighth digit corresponding to bit 7. Leading zeros may not be omitted. A semicolon (;) marks the end of a block. (LF is used for the ISO code, and CR is used for the EIA code.)

Example N01005Q1T1P10000001T2P10000001 ; Parameter No. 1005 Parameter value 1st machine group: Bits 0 and 7 are set to 1, and the other bits are set to 0. 2nd machine group: Bits 0 and 7 are set to 1, and the other bits are set to 0.

-7-

3. INPUTTING AND OUTPUTTING PARAMETERS THROUGH THE READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE

B-63950EN/04

3.3.5
N *****

Bit Path Format


Q1 L ** P ******** L ** P ******** ;

A numeric value after N represents a parameter number. Q1 indicates that the data is parameter data. A numeric value after L represents a path number (1 and up). An 8-digit binary number after P represents the bit values (0/1) of a parameter for each path, with the first digit corresponding to bit 0 and the eighth digit corresponding to bit 7. Leading zeros may not be omitted. A semicolon (;) marks the end of a block. (LF is used for the ISO code, and CR is used for the EIA code.)

Example N01005Q1L1P10000001L2P10000001.......; Parameter No. 1005 Parameter value Path 1: Bits 0 and 7 are set to 1, and the other bits are set to 0. Path 2: Bits 0 and 7 are set to 1, and the other bits are set to 0.

3.3.6
N *****

Bit Axis Format


Q1 A ** P ******** A ** P ******** ;

A numeric value after N represents a parameter number. Q1 indicates that the data is parameter data. A numeric value after A represents a controlled axis number (1 and up). An 8-digit binary number after P represents the bit values (0/1) of a parameter for each controlled axis, with the first digit corresponding to bit 0 and the eighth digit corresponding to bit 7. Leading zeros may not be omitted. A semicolon (;) marks the end of a block. (LF is used for the ISO code, and CR is used for the EIA code.)

Example N01005Q1A1P10000001A2P10000001A3P10000001.......; Parameter No. 1005 Parameter value 1st axis: Bits 0 and 7 are set to 1, and the other bits are set to 0. 2nd axis: Bits 0 and 7 are set to 1, and the other bits are set to 0. 3rd axis: Bits 0 and 7 are set to 1, and the other bits are set to 0.

-8-

B-63950EN/04

3. INPUTTING AND OUTPUTTING PARAMETERS THROUGH THE READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE

3.3.7
N *****

Bit Spindle Format


Q1 S ** P ******** S ** P ******** ;

A numeric value after N represents a parameter number. Q1 indicates that the data is parameter data. A numeric value after S represents a spindle number (1 and up). An 8-digit binary number after P represents the bit values (0/1) of a parameter for each spindle, with the first digit corresponding to bit 0 and the eighth digit corresponding to bit 7. Leading zeros may not be omitted. A semicolon (;) marks the end of a block. (LF is used for the ISO code, and CR is used for the EIA code.)

Example N05603Q1S1P00001000S2P00001000S3P00000000; Parameter No. 5603 Parameter value 1st spindle: Bit 3 is set to 1, and the other bits are set to 0. 2nd spindle: Bit 3 is set to 1, and the other bits are set to 0. 3rd spindle: All bits are set to 0.

3.3.8
N

Byte/Word/Two-Word Format
***** Q1 P ******** ;

A numeric value after N represents a parameter number. Q1 indicates that the data is parameter data. A numeric value after P represents a parameter value (integer). A semicolon (;) marks the end of a block. (LF is used for the ISO code, and CR is used for the EIA code.)

Example N00100Q1P31515; Parameter No. 100 Parameter value 31515

3.3.9
N *****

Byte/Word/Two-Word Machine Group Format


Q1 T ** P ****** T ** P ****** ;

A numeric value after N represents a parameter number. Q1 indicates that the data is parameter data. A numeric value after T represents a machine group number (1 and up). A numeric value after P represents the value (integer) of a parameter for each machine group. A semicolon (;) marks the end of a block. (LF is used for the ISO code, and CR is used for the EIA code.)

Example N01020Q1T1P88T2P89......; Parameter No. 1020 Parameter value 1st machine group: 2nd machine group:
-9-

88 89

3. INPUTTING AND OUTPUTTING PARAMETERS THROUGH THE READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE

B-63950EN/04

3.3.10
N *****

Byte/Word/Two-Word Path Format


Q1 L ** P ****** L ** P ****** ;

A numeric value after N represents a parameter number. Q1 indicates that the data is parameter data. A numeric value after L represents a path number (1 and up). A numeric value after P represents the value (integer) of a parameter for each path. A semicolon (;) marks the end of a block. (LF is used for the ISO code, and CR is used for the EIA code.)

Example N01020Q1L1P88L2P89L3P90......; Parameter No. 1020 Parameter value Path 1: 88 Path 2: 89 Path 3: 90

3.3.11
N *****

Byte/Word/Two-Word Axis Format


Q1 A ** P ****** A ** P ****** ;

A numeric value after N represents a parameter number. Q1 indicates that the data is parameter data. A numeric value after A represents a controlled axis number (1 and up). A numeric value after P represents the value (integer) of a parameter for each controlled axis. A semicolon (;) marks the end of a block. (LF is used for the ISO code, and CR is used for the EIA code.)

Example N01020Q1A1P88A2P89A3P90A4P66......; Parameter No. 1020 Parameter value 1st axis: 88 2nd axis: 89 3rd axis: 90 4th axis: 66

- 10 -

B-63950EN/04

3. INPUTTING AND OUTPUTTING PARAMETERS THROUGH THE READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE

3.3.12
N *****

Byte/Word/Two-Word Spindle Format


Q1 S ** P ****** S ** P ****** ;

A numeric value after N represents a parameter number. Q1 indicates that the data is parameter data. A numeric value after S represents a spindle number (1 and up). A numeric value after P represents the value (integer) of a parameter for each spindle. A semicolon (;) marks the end of a block. (LF is used for the ISO code, and CR is used for the EIA code.)

Example N05680Q1S1P19S2P19S3P0S4P0; Parameter No. 5680 Parameter value 1st spindle: 19 2nd spindle: 19 3rd spindle: 0 4th spindle: 0

3.3.13
N N N

Real Number Format


***** ***** ***** Q1 Q1 Q1 P M I ****** ****** ****** ; ; ;

A numeric value after N represents a parameter number. Q1 indicates that the data is parameter data. A numeric value after each of P, M, and I represents the value (real number) of a parameter. A semicolon (;) marks the end of a block. (LF is used for the ISO code, and CR is used for the EIA code.)

Example N01451Q1P5000.0; Parameter No. 1451 Parameter value 5000.0

- 11 -

3. INPUTTING AND OUTPUTTING PARAMETERS THROUGH THE READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE

B-63950EN/04

3.3.14
N N N ***** ***** *****

Real Number Machine Group Format


Q1 Q1 Q1 T T T ** ** ** P M I ****** ****** ****** T T T ** ** ** P M I ****** ****** ****** ; ; ;

A numeric value after N represents a parameter number. Q1 indicates that the data is parameter data. A numeric value after T represents a machine group number (1 and up). A numeric value after each of P, M, and I represents the value (real number) of a parameter for each machine group. A semicolon (;) marks the end of a block. (LF is used for the ISO code, and CR is used for the EIA code.)

Example N01220Q1T1M50.0T2M60.0........; Parameter No. 1220 Parameter value 1st machine group: 50.0 2nd machine group: 60.0

3.3.15
N N N ***** ***** *****

Real Number Path Format


Q1 Q1 Q1 L L L ** ** ** P M I ****** ****** ****** L L L ** ** ** P M I ****** ****** ****** ; ; ;

A numeric value after N represents a parameter number. Q1 indicates that the data is parameter data. A numeric value after L represents a path number (1 and up). A numeric value after each of P, M, and I represents the value (real number) of a parameter for each path. A semicolon (;) marks the end of a block. (LF is used for the ISO code, and CR is used for the EIA code.)

Example N01220Q1L1M50.0L2M60.0L3M70.0 ; Parameter No. 1220 Parameter value Path 1: 50.0 Path 2: 60.0 Path 3: 70.0

- 12 -

B-63950EN/04

3. INPUTTING AND OUTPUTTING PARAMETERS THROUGH THE READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE

3.3.16
N N N ***** ***** *****

Real Number Axis Format


Q1 Q1 Q1 A A A ** ** ** P M I ****** ****** ****** A A A ** ** ** P M I ****** ****** ****** ; ; ;

A numeric value after N represents a parameter number. Q1 indicates that the data is parameter data. A numeric value after A represents a controlled axis number (1 and up). A numeric value after each of P, M, and I represents the value (real number) of a parameter for each controlled axis. A semicolon (;) marks the end of a block. (LF is used for the ISO code, and CR is used for the EIA code.)

Example N01220Q1A1M50.0A2M60.0A3M70.0A4M0.0A5M0.0 ........; Parameter No. 1220 Parameter value 1st axis: 50.0 2nd axis: 60.0 3rd axis: 70.0 4th axis: 0.0 5th axis: 0.0

3.3.17
N N N ***** ***** *****

Real Number Spindle Format


Q1 Q1 Q1 S S S ** ** ** P M I ****** ****** ****** S S S ** ** ** P M I ****** ****** ****** ; ; ;

A numeric value after N represents a parameter number. Q1 indicates that the data is parameter data. A numeric value after S represents a spindle number (1 and up). A numeric value after each of P, M, and I represents the value (real number) of a parameter for each spindle. A semicolon (;) marks the end of a block. (LF is used for the ISO code, and CR is used for the EIA code.)

Example N05898Q1S1P30.0S2P30.0S3P0.0S4P0.0; Parameter No. 5898 Parameter value 1st spindle: 30.0 2nd spindle: 30.0 3rd spindle: 0.0 4th spindle: 0.0

- 13 -

3. INPUTTING AND OUTPUTTING PARAMETERS THROUGH THE READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE

B-63950EN/04

3.3.18

Start and End of a Record

A parameter record starts with "%" and ends with "%".

Example %; ......................................... Start of record N00000Q1P00001100; N00002Q1P00000000; N09162Q1P00000000; N09163Q1P00000000; % .......................................... End of record
When parameters and pitch error compensation data are included in a single file, the file starts with "%" and ends with "%".

- 14 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

4
4.1

DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
DATA TYPE
Data type Valid data range Remarks

Parameters are classified by data type as follows:


Bit Bit machine group Bit path Bit axis Bit spindle Byte Byte machine group Byte path Byte axis Byte spindle Word Word machine group Word path Word axis Word spindle 2-word 2-word machine group 2-word path 2-word axis 2-word spindle Real Real machine group Real path Real axis Real spindle

0 or 1

-128 to 127 0 to 255

Some parameters handle these types of data as unsigned data.

-32768 to 32767 0 to 65535

Some parameters handle these types of data as unsigned data.

0 to 999999999

Some parameters handle these types of data as unsigned data.

See the Standard Parameter Setting Tables.

NOTE 1 Each of the parameters of the bit, bit machine group, bit path, bit axis, and bit spindle types consists of 8 bits for one data number (parameters with eight different meanings). 2 For machine group types, parameters corresponding to the maximum number of machine groups are present, so that independent data can be set for each machine group. 3 For path types, parameters corresponding to the maximum number of paths are present, so that independent data can be set for each path. 4 For axis types, parameters corresponding to the maximum number of control axes are present, so that independent data can be set for each control axis. 5 For spindle types, parameters corresponding to the maximum number of spindles are present, so that independent data can be set for each spindle axis. 6 The valid data range for each data type indicates a general range. The range varies according to the parameters. For the valid data range of a specific parameter, see the explanation of the parameter.

- 15 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

4.2

REPRESENTATION OF PARAMETERS

Parameters of the bit type, bit machine group type, bit path type, bit axis type, and bit spindle type
#7 0000 #6 #5 #4 EIA #3 NCR #2 ISP #1 CTV #0 TVC

Data No.

Data (Data #0 to #7 are bit positions.)

Parameters other than the bit-type parameters above


1023 Number of the servo axis for each axis

Data No.

Data

NOTE 1 The bits left blank in 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS and parameter numbers that appear on the display but are not found in the parameter list are reserved for future expansion. They must always be 0. 2 A parameter usable with only one path control type, namely, the lathe system (T series) or the machining center system (M series), is indicated using two rows as shown below. When a row is blank, the parameter is not usable with the corresponding series. [Example 1] Parameter HTG is a parameter common to the M and T series, but Parameters RTV and ROC are parameters valid only for the T series.
#7 1403 RTV #6 #5 HTG HTG #4 ROC #3 #2 #1 #0 T series M series

[Example 2] The following parameter is provided only for the M series.


T series 1411 Cutting feedrate M series

3 When "to" is inserted between two parameter numbers, there are parameters with successive numbers between the two starting and ending parameter numbers, but those intermediate parameter numbers are omitted for convenience. 4 The lower-case letter "x" or "s" following the name of a bit-type parameter indicates the following: - x : Bit axis type parameters - s : Bit spindle type parameters

- 16 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

4.3
Overview

STANDARD PARAMETER SETTING TABLES

This section defines the standard minimum data units and valid data ranges of the CNC parameters of the real type, real machine group type, real path type, real axis type, and real spindle type. The data type and unit of data of each parameter conform to the specifications of each function.

Explanation
(A) Length and angle parameters (type 1)
Unit of data Increment system IS-A IS-B IS-C IS-D IS-E IS-A IS-B IS-C IS-D IS-E Minimum data unit 0.01 0.001 0.0001 0.00001 0.000001 0.001 0.0001 0.00001 0.000001 0.0000001 Valid data range -999999.99 -999999.999 -99999.9999 -9999.99999 -999.999999 to +999999.99 to +999999.999 to +99999.9999 to +9999.99999 to +999.999999

mm deg.

inch

-99999.999 to +99999.999 -99999.9999 to +99999.9999 -9999.99999 to +9999.99999 -999.999999 to +999.999999 -99.9999999 to +99.9999999

(B) Length and angle parameters (type 2)


Unit of data Increment system IS-A IS-B IS-C IS-D IS-E IS-A IS-B IS-C IS-D IS-E Minimum data unit 0.01 0.001 0.0001 0.00001 0.000001 0.001 0.0001 0.00001 0.000001 0.0000001 Valid data range 0.00 0.000 0.0000 0.00000 0.000000 to +999999.99 to +999999.999 to +99999.9999 to +9999.99999 to +999.999999

mm deg.

inch

0.000 to +99999.999 0.0000 to +99999.9999 0.00000 to +9999.99999 0.000000 to +999.999999 0.0000000 to +99.9999999

(C) Velocity and angular velocity parameters


Unit of data Increment system IS-A IS-B IS-C IS-D IS-E IS-A IS-B IS-C IS-D IS-E Minimum data unit 0.01 0.001 0.0001 0.00001 0.000001 0.001 0.0001 0.00001 0.000001 0.0000001 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 Valid data range to +999000.00 to +999000.000 to +99999.9999 to +9999.99999 to +999.999999 to +96000.000 to +9600.0000 to +4000.00000 to +400.000000 to +40.0000000

mm/min degree/min

inch/min

- 17 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

If bit 7 (IESP) of parameter No. 1013 is set to 1, the valid data ranges for IS-C, IS-D, and IS-E are extended as follows:
Unit of data mm/min degree/min Increment system IS-C IS-D IS-E IS-C IS-D IS-E Minimum data unit 0.001 0.0001 0.00001 0.0001 0.00001 0.00001 Valid data range 0.000 to +999000.000 0.0000 to +99999.9999 0.0000 to +99999.9999 0.0000 to +9600.0000 0.00000 to +4000.00000 0.00000 to +4000.00000

inch/min

(D)Acceleration and angular acceleration parameters


Unit of data
2

Increment system IS-A IS-B IS-C IS-D IS-E IS-A IS-B IS-C IS-D IS-E

Minimum data unit 0.01 0.001 0.0001 0.00001 0.000001 0.001 0.0001 0.00001 0.000001 0.0000001

Valid data range 0.00 0.000 0.0000 0.00000 0.000000 to +999999.99 to +999999.999 to +99999.9999 to +9999.99999 to +999.999999

mm/sec deg./sec2

inch/sec2

0.000 to +99999.999 0.0000 to +99999.9999 0.00000 to +9999.99999 0.000000 to +999.999999 0.0000000 to +99.9999999

If bit 7 (IESP) of parameter No. 1013 is set to 1, the valid data ranges for IS-C, IS-D, and IS-E are extended as follows:
Unit of data mm/min degree/min Increment system IS-C IS-D IS-E IS-C IS-D IS-E Minimum data unit 0.001 0.0001 0.0001 0.0001 0.00001 0.00001 Valid data range 0.000 to +999999.999 0.0000 to +99999.9999 0.0000 to +99999.9999 0.0000 to +99999.9999 0.00000 to +9999.99999 0.00000 to +9999.99999

inch/min

Notes
(1) Values are rounded up or down to the nearest multiples of the minimum data unit. (2) A valid data range means data input limits, and may differ from values representing actual performance. (3) For information on the ranges of commands to the CNC, refer to Appendix D, "LIST OF COMMAND RANGES," in the "OPERATORS MANUAL" (B-63944EN).

4.4
0000

PARAMETERS OF SETTING
#7 #6 #5 SEQ #4 #3 #2 INI #1 ISO #0 TVC

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit path #0 TVC TV check 0: Not performed 1: Performed
- 18 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
ISO Code used for data output 0: EIA code 1: ISO code

#1

NOTE ASCII code is used at all times for output to the memory card.
#2 INI Unit of input 0: In metrics 1: In inches SEQ Automatic insertion of sequence numbers 0: Not performed 1: Performed
#7 0001 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 FCV #0

#5

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit path #1 FCV Program format 0: Series 16 standard format 1: Series 15 format

NOTE 1 Programs created in the Series 15 program format can be used for operation on the following functions: 1 Subprogram call M98 2 Thread cutting with equal leads G32 (T series) 3 Canned cycle G90, G92, G94 (T series) 4 Multiple repetitive canned cycle G71 to G76 (T series) / G71.7 to G71.6 (M series) 5 Drilling canned cycle G83.1, G80 to G89 (T series) / G73, G74, G76, G80 to G89 (M series) 2 When the program format used in the Series 15 is used for this CNC, some limits may add. Refer to the Operators Manual.
#7 0002 SJZ #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit #7 SJZ On an axis for which bit 3 (HJZx) of parameter No. 1005 is set: 0: If a reference position is not established yet, reference position return is performed with deceleration dogs. If a reference position is already established, reference position return is performed at a parameter-set feedrate without using deceleration dogs. 1: Reference position return is performed with deceleration dogs at all times.
- 19 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE SJZ is valid for an axis for which bit 3 (HJZx) of parameter No. 1005 is set to 1. When bit 1 (DLZx) of parameter No. 1005 is set to 1, however, manual reference position return after a reference position is set is performed at a parameter-set feedrate, regardless of the setting of SJZ.
#7 0010 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 PEC #1 PRM #0 PZS

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit path #0 PZS When a part program is punched out, the O number is: 0: Not zero-suppressed. 1: Zero-suppressed. PRM When parameters are output, the parameters whose values are 0 are: 0: Output. 1: Not output. PEC When pitch error compensation data is output, the data whose value is 0 is: 0: Output. 1: Not output.

#1

#2

NOTE This parameter is invalid for output of high-precision pitch error compensation data.
#7 0012 RMVx #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 MIRx

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit axis #0 MIRx Mirror image for each axis 0: Mirror image is off. (Normal) 1: Mirror image is on. (Mirror) RMVx Releasing the assignment of the control axis for each axis 0: Not released 1: Released (Equivalent to the control axis detachment signals DTCH1, DTCH2, and so forth <G0124>)

#7

NOTE RMVx is valid when bit 7 (RMBx) of parameter No. 1005 is set to 1.

- 20 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

4.5

PARAMETERS OF READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE


To transfer data (programs, parameters, and so forth) to and from an external input/output device through the I/O device interface (RS-232-C serial interface), the parameters described below need to be set. The input/output device connected to a channel (such as RS-232-C serial port 1 and RS-232-C serial port 2) can be selected by setting I/O CHANNEL (parameter No. 0020). The specifications (input/output specification number, baud rate, and the number of stop bits) of an input/output device connected to each channel must be set in the parameters corresponding to each channel beforehand. For channel 1, two combinations of parameters to specify the input/output device data are provided. The following shows the interrelation between the input/output device interface parameters for the channels.
0020 I/O CHANNEL or foreground input Input/output channel number (parameter No.0020) 0101 I/O CHANNEL=0 (Channel 1) 0102 0103 Stop bit and other data Number specified for the input/output device Baud rate

Set channels to be used for data input/output. I/O CHANNEL (0 to 5) =0 : Channel 1 =1 : Channel 1 =2 : Channel 2 =3 : Channel 3 : : : Input/output to and from the memory card interface, etc. is also possible. When IO4 is set 0021 Foreground output 0022 Background input 0023 Background input The channel setting is the same as No.0020.

0111 I/O CHANNEL=1 (Channel 1) 0112 0113

Stop bit and other data Number specified for the input/output device Baud rate

0121 I/O CHANNEL=2 (Channel 2) : : : I/O CHANNEL=5 0122 0123

Stop bit and other data Number specified for the input/output device Baud rate

4.5.1
0020 0021 0022 0023

Parameters Common to All Channels


I/O CHANNEL : Input/output device selection, or interface number for a foreground input device Foreground output device setting Background input device setting Background output device setting

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Byte [Valid data range] 0 to 9 The CNC has the following interfaces for transferring data to and from an external input/output device and the host computer:
- 21 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

Input/output device interface (RS-232-C serial ports 1 and 2) Memory card interface Data server interface Embedded Ethernet interface By setting bit 0 (IO4) of parameter No. 0110, data input/output can be controlled separately. When IO4 is not set, data input/output is performed using the channel set in parameter No. 0020. When IO4 is set, a channel can be assigned to each of foreground input, foreground output, background input, and background output. In these parameters, specify the interface connected to each input/output device to and from which data is to be transferred. See the table below for these settings.
Correspondence between settings and input/output devices Description RS-232-C serial port 1 RS-232-C serial port 2 Memory card interface Data server interface Embedded Ethernet interface

Setting 0,1 2 4 5 9

0024

Setting of communication with the ladder development tool (FANUC LADDER-III, ladder editing package)

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to 255 This parameter is used to enable or disable the PMC online connection function. By specifying this parameter, the PMC online connection function can be enabled or disabled without displaying the PMC online setting screen.
Setting 0 1 2 10 11 12 255 RS-232-C High-speed interface The setting on the PMC online setting screen is not altered. To be used (channel 1) Not to be used To be used (channel 2) Not to be used Not to be used To be used To be used (channel 1) To be used To be used (channel 2) To be used Communication is terminated forcibly (as with the [FORCED STOP] soft key).

NOTE 1 The setting of this parameter becomes valid when the power is turned on or this parameter is modified. After this parameter is set, the power need not be turned off then back on. 2 A setting modification made on the PMC online setting screen is not reflected in this parameter. 3 The communication settings of a baud rate and so forth for using RS-232-C made on the PMC online setting screen are valid. When no modification is ever made to the settings on the PMC online setting screen, the baud rate is 9600, parity is not used, and the number of stops bits is 2. 4 If you set this parameter to 1, 2, 11, or 12, the PMC online monitor occupies the specified RS232-C communications port. To use the communications port for the Handy File, for example, set the parameter to 255 to prevent the RS232-C port from being used by the PMC online monitor.
- 22 -

B-63950EN/04 #7 0100 ENS #6 IOP #5 #4

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#3 NCR #2 CRF #1 CTV #0

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit #1 CTV Character counting for TV check in the comment section of a program. 0: Performed 1: Not performed CRF Output of the end of block (EOB) in ISO code 0: Depends on the setting of bit 3 (NCR) of parameter No. 0100. 1: CR, LF are output. NCR Output of the end of block (EOB) in ISO code 0: LF, CR, CR are output. 1: Only LF is output. IOP Stopping a program output or input operation by a reset is: 0: Enabled 1: Disabled (Stopping a program input/output operation with the soft key [STOP] is enabled at all times.) ENS Action taken when a NULL code is found during read of EIA code 0: An alarm is generated. 1: The NULL code is ignored.
#7 0110 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 IO4

#2

#3

#6

#7

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 IO4 Separate control of I/O channel numbers is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed. If the I/O channels are not separately controlled, set the input/output device in parameter No. 0020. If the I/O channels are separately controlled, set the input device and output device in the foreground and the input device and output device in the background in parameters No. 0020 to No. 0023 respectively. Separate control of I/O channels makes it possible to perform background editing, program input/output, and the like during the DNC operation.
#7 0138 MNC #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 MDP

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit


- 23 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#0 MDP To the extensions of input/output files, a path number is: 0: Not added. 1: Added.

B-63950EN/04

NOTE If a file name is specified by setting F, this parameter is ignored, and a path number is not added to the extension.
#7 MNC DNC operation from the memory card and external device subprogram call from the memory card are: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed.

4.5.2
0101

Parameters of Channel 1 (I/O CHANNEL=0)


#7 NFD #6 #5 #4 #3 ASI #2 #1 #0 SB2

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 SB2 The number of stop bits 0: 1 1: 2 ASI Code used at data input 0: EIA or ISO code (automatically distinguished) 1: ASCII code NFD Feed before and after the data at data output 0: Output 1: Not output When input/output devices other than the FANUC PPR are used, set NFD to 1.
Number specified for the input/output device (when the I/O CHANNEL is set to 0)

#3

#7

0102

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte [Valid data range] 0 to 6 Set the specification number of the input/output device corresponding to I/O CHANNEL=0. The following table lists the specification numbers and corresponding input/output device specifications.
Specification numbers and corresponding input/output device specifications Specification number Input/output device specification 0 1 2 3 RS-232-C (control codes DC1 to DC4 are used) FANUC CASSETTE ADAPTOR 1(FANUC CASSETTE B1/B2) FANUC CASSETTE ADAPTOR 3(FANUC CASSETTE F1) FANUC PROGRAM FILE MateFANUC FA Card Adaptor, FANUC FLOPPY CASSETTE ADAPTOR, FANUC Handy File FANUC SYSTEM P-MODEL H RS-232-C (control codes DC1 to DC4 are not used)

- 24 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Specification number 5 6 Input/output device specification Portable tape reader FANUC PPR FANUC SYSTEM P-MODEL G, FANUC SYSTEM P-MODEL H
Baud rate (when I/O CHANNEL is set to 0)

0103

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte [Valid data range] 1 to 12 Set the baud rate of the input/output device corresponding to I/O CHANNEL=0. When setting this parameter, see the following table:
Baud rates and corresponding settings Baud rate (bps) Setting 50 110 150 300 600 8 9 10 11 12

Setting 1 3 4 6 7

Baud rate (bps) 1200 2400 4800 9600 19200

4.5.3
0111

Parameters of Channel 1 (I/O CHANNEL=1)


#7 NFD #6 #5 #4 #3 ASI #2 #1 #0 SB2

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 SB2 The number of stop bits 0: 1 1: 2 ASI Code used at data input 0: EIA or ISO code (automatically distinguished) 1: ASCII code NFD Feed before and after the data at data output 0: Output 1: Not output When input/output devices other than the FANUC PPR are used, set NFD to 1.
Number specified for the input/output device (when the I/O CHANNEL is set to 1)

#3

#7

0112

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte [Valid data range] 0 to 6 Set the specification number of the input/output device corresponding to I/O CHANNEL=1.
0113 Baud rate (when I/O CHANNEL is set to 1)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte


- 25 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

[Valid data range] 1 to 12 Set the baud rate of the input/output device corresponding to I/O CHANNEL=1.

4.5.4
0121

Parameters of Channel 2 (I/O CHANNEL=2)


#7 NFD #6 #5 #4 #3 ASI #2 #1 #0 SB2

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 SB2 The number of stop bits 0: 1 1: 2 ASI Code used at data input 0: EIA or ISO code (automatically distinguished) 1: ASCII code NFD Feed before and after the data at data output 0: Output 1: Not output
Number specified for the input/output device (when the I/O CHANNEL is set to 2)

#3

#7

0122

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte [Valid data range] 0 to 6 Set the specification number of the input/output device corresponding to I/O CHANNEL=2.
0123 Baud rate (when I/O CHANNEL is set to 2)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte [Valid data range] 1 to 12 Set the baud rate of the input/output device corresponding to I/O CHANNEL=2.

4.6
0300

PARAMETERS OF CNC SCREEN DISPLAY FUNCTIONS


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 PCM

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit #0 PCM If the CNC screen display function is enabled, when a memory card interface is provided on the NC side (For HSSB connection), 0: The memory card interface on the NC side is used. 1: The memory card interface on the PC side is used. In a system with a built-in PC, the memory card interface on the PC side is used regardless of the setting of this parameter. This parameter is valid only while the CNC screen display function is active.
- 26 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

4.7
0901

PARAMETERS OF ETHERNET/DATA SERVER FUNCTIONS


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 EFT #0

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit #1 EFT The FTP file transfer function by the Ethernet function is: 0: Not used. 1: Used.

NOTE In a multi-path system, the setting of the parameter for path 1 is used throughout the system.
#7 0904 LCH #6 DHC #5 DNS #4 UNM #3 D1E #2 #1 #0 BWT

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit #0 BWT If FTP communication is behind data supply during DNC operation in the buffer mode of the Data Server function: 0: An error is caused. 1: No error is caused and DNC operation continues after waiting the completion of FTP communication. D1E When the DHCP function is used: 0: Default parameters for the FOCAS2/Ethernet functions are set. Port number (TCP) 8193 Port number (UDP) 0 Time interval 0 1: Default parameters for CIMPLICITY iCELL communication are set. Port number (TCP) 8193 Port number (UDP) 8192 Time interval 50 UNM The CNC Unsolicited Messaging function is: 0: Not used. 1: Used. DNS The DNS client function is: 0: Not used. 1: Used. DHC The DHCP client function is: 0: Not used. 1: Used.

#3

#4

#5

#6

- 27 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7

B-63950EN/04

LCH In the LIST-GET service of the Data Server function, when a list file specifies 1025 or more files: 0: A check for duplicated file names is performed. 1: A check for duplicated file names is not performed.
#7 #6 #5 #4 UNS #3 DSF #2 #1 PCH #0 DNE

0905

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit #0 DNE During DNC operation using the FOCAS2/Ethernet functions, the termination of DNC operation is: 0: Waited. 1: Not waited. (FOCAS2/HSSB compatible specification) PCH At the start of communication of the Data Server function, FTP file transfer function, or machine remote diagnosis function, checking for the presence of the server using PING is: 0: Performed. 1: Not performed.

#1

NOTE Usually, set 0. If 1 is set not to check the presence of the server by using PING, it may take several tens of seconds to recognize an error when the server is not present in the network. For mainly security reasons, a personal computer may be set so that it does not respond to the PING command. To communicate with such a personal computer, set 1.
#3 DSF When an NC program is stored on the memory card of the Data Server: 0: The file name takes priority. 1: The program name in the NC program takes priority.

NOTE Even when this parameter is set to 1, an NC program is stored with a file name, then the name is changed to a program name in the NC program. Therefore, if the same file name is already present on the memory card of the Data Server, an error occurs.
#4 UNS In the CNC Unsolicited Messaging function, when the end of the function is requested by other than the CNC Unsolicited Messaging server currently connected: 0: The request for the end of the function is rejected. 1: The request for the end of the function is accepted.
Selects the host computer 1 OS. Selects the host computer 2 OS. Selects the host computer 3 OS.

0921 0922 0923

[Input type] Parameter input


- 28 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to 2 0: Windows95/98/Me/2000/XP. 1: UNIX, VMS. 2: Linux.

NOTE Some FTP server software products do not depend on the OS. So, even when the above parameters are set, it is sometimes impossible to display a list of files properly.
0924 FOCAS2/Ethernet waiting time setting

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word millisecond 0 to 32767 When the FOCAS2/Ethernet and Data Server functions are used simultaneously, this parameter sets the FOCAS2/Ethernet function waiting time in milliseconds. When a value of 0 is set, the functions operate with assuming that 1 millisecond is specified.
File attribute specification during FTP server operation

0929

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to 2 This parameter sets whether to give priority to the file attribute specified in a TYPE command of FTP during operation as an FTP server. 0: Priority is given to the file attribute specified in a TYPE command from an FTP client. 1: Text files are always assumed. 2: Binary files are always assumed.
0930 Maximum number of files that can be registered to the memory card of the Data Server and maximum size per file that can be registered

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0, 10 to 15
No. 930 0 10 11 12 13 14 15 Maximum number of files 2047 511 1023 2047 4095 8191 16383 Maximum size per file 512MB 2048MB 1024MB 512MB 256MB 128MB 64MB

NOTE 1 When the memory card is formatted after this parameter is set, the maximum number of files and maximum size per file are changed. 2 Each folder is counted as one file.
- 29 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

4.8
0960

PARAMETERS OF POWER MATE CNC


#7 #6 #5 #4 PPE #3 PMN #2 MD2 #1 MD1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path # 1, 2 MD1,MD2 These parameters set a slave parameter input/output destination.
Parameter MD2 0 0 Parameter MD1 0 1 I/O destination Program memory Memory card

NOTE The output destination depends on the setting for path 1.


#3 PMN The Power Mate CNC manager function is: 0: Enabled. 1: Disabled. When priority is to be given to commands to slaves by a ladder (communication by the Power Mate CNC manager function is to be stopped) after necessary data setting and checking for each of the connected slaves are completed, set this bit to 1 for every path. PPE 0: 1: The Power Mate CNC manager can set slave parameters at all times. Slave parameter setting by the Power Mate CNC manager follows the setting of PWE for the host CNC. When PWE = 0, the setting of the I/O LINK parameter is prohibited.
#7 0961 #6 #5 #4 #3 PMO #2 #1 #0

#4

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #3 PMO The O number of a program for saving and restoring the I/O LINK parameter is set based on: 0: Group number and channel number 1: Group number only

4.9
0980

PARAMETERS OF SYSTEM CONFIGURATION


Machine group number to which each path belongs

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to 3
- 30 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Set the machine group number to which each path belongs.

NOTE When 0 is set, each path is assumed to belong to machine group 1.


0981 Absolute path number to which each axis belongs

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte axis [Valid data range] 1 to 10 Set the path to which each axis belongs.

NOTE When 0 is set, each axis is assumed to belong to path 1.


0982 Absolute path number to which each spindle belongs

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte spindle [Valid data range] 1 to 10 Set the path to which each spindle belongs.

NOTE When 0 is set, each spindle is assumed to belong to path 1.


0983 Path control type of each path

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 1 Set the path control type of each path. The following two path control types are available: T series (lathe system) :0 M series (machining system) : 1
#7 0984 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 LCP

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path


- 31 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 LCP Set whether the path is a loader control path. 0: The path is not a loader control path. 1: The path is a loader control path.

- 32 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

4.10
1000

PARAMETERS OF AXIS CONTROL/INCREMENT SYSTEM (1 OF 3)


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 EEA

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 EEA An extended axis name and extended spindle name are: 0: Invalid 1: Valid
#7 1001 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 INM

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 INM Least command increment on the linear axis 0: In mm (metric system machine) 1: In inches (inch system machine)
#7 1002 IDG #6 #5 #4 XIK #3 AZR #2 #1 #0 JAX

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 JAX Number of axes controlled simultaneously in jog feed, manual rapid traverse and manual reference position return 0: 1 axis 1: 3 axes AZR When no reference position is set, the G28 command causes: 0: Reference position return using deceleration dogs (as during manual reference position return) to be executed. 1: Alarm PS0304, "G28 IS COMMANDED WITHOUT ZERO RETURN" to be displayed.

#3

NOTE When reference position return without dogs is specified, (when bit 1 (DLZ) of parameter No. 1005 is set to 1) the G28 command specified before a reference position is set causes an alarm PS0304 to be issued, regardless of the setting of AZR.

- 33 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#4

B-63950EN/04

XIK When bit 1 (LRP) of parameter No. 1401 is set to 0, namely, when positioning is performed using non-linear type positioning, if an interlock is applied to the machine along one of axes in positioning, 0: The machine stops moving along the axis for which the interlock is applied and continues to move along the other axes. 1: The machine stops moving along all the axes. IDG When the reference position is set without dogs, automatic setting of the bit 0 (IDGx) of parameter No. 1012 to prevent the reference position from being set again is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed.

#7

NOTE When this parameter is set to 0, bit 0 (IDGx) of parameter No. 1012 is invalid.
#7 1004 IPR #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #7 IPR When a number with no decimal point is specified, the least input increment of each axis is: 0: Not 10 times greater than the least command increment 1: 10 times greater than the least command increment When the increment system is IS-A, and bit 0 (DPI) of parameter No. 3401 is set to 1 (pocket calculator type decimal point programming), the least input increment cannot be 10 times greater than the least command increment.
#7 1005 RMBx #6 MCCx #5 EDMx #4 EDPx #3 HJZx #2 #1 DLZx #0 ZRNx

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 ZRNx If a move command other than G28 is specified by automatic operation when no reference position return is performed yet after the power is turned on: 0: The alarm PS0224, "PERFORM REFERENCE POSITION RETURN." is issued. 1: Operation is performed without issuing an alarm.

NOTE 1 The state in which a reference position has not been established refers to the following state: - When an absolute position detector is not used and reference position return has not been performed even once after power-up - When an absolute position detector is used and the association of the machine position with the position detected with the absolute position detector has not been completed (See the description of bit 4 (APZx) of parameter No. 1815.) 2 When the Cs axis coordinates are to be set up, set ZRN to 0.

- 34 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

#1

DLZx Function for setting the reference position without dogs 0: Disabled 1: Enabled HJZx When a reference position is already set: 0: Manual reference position return is performed with deceleration dogs. 1: Manual reference position return is performed using rapid traverse without deceleration dogs, or manual reference position return is performed with deceleration dogs, depending on the setting of bit 7 (SJZ) of parameter No.0002. When the function for setting the reference position without dogs (see the description of bit 1 (DLZx) of parameter No. 1005) is used, manual reference position return after a reference position is set is always performed at a parameter-set feedrate, regardless of the setting of HJZ. EDPx In cutting feed, an external deceleration signal in the + direction for each axis is: 0: Invalid 1: Valid EDMx In cutting feed, an external deceleration signal in the - direction for each axis is: 0: Invalid 1: Valid MCCx If a multi-axis amplifier is used, and another axis of the same amplifier is placed in the control axis detach state, the MCC signal of the servo amplifier is: 0: Turned off. 1: Not turned off.

#3

#4

#5

#6

NOTE This parameter can be set for a control axis. WARNING When the servo motor of a controlled axis to be detached is connected to a multi-axis amplifier such as a two-axis amplifier, placing the axis in the control axis detach state causes the activating current in the amplifier to drop. As a result, alarm SV0401, "V READY OFF" is issued in the other axes. This alarm can be suppressed by setting this parameter bit. With this method, however, the target axis for the control axis detach operation is placed in the servo off state (the amplifier remains on, but no current flows through the motor). The torque of the target axis becomes 0, so care should be taken. For a vertical axis, in particular, it is necessary to prepare a sequence that starts operating the mechanical brake before the control axis detach operation. When this method is applied to a vertical axis, special care should be taken. Even when a controlled axis has been detached, detaching a cable (a command cable or feedback cable) of the axis causes an alarm. In such applications, it is impossible to perform a control axis detach operation with a multi-axis amplifier by setting this parameter bit. (Prepare a single-axis amplifier.)

- 35 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7

B-63950EN/04

RMBx The control axis detachment signal for each axis and the setting input bit 7 (RMV) of parameter No. 0012 are: 0: Invalid 1: Valid
#7 #6 #5 ZMIx ZMIx TCHx #4 #3 DIAx DIAx #2 #1 ROSx ROSx #0 ROTx ROTx

1006

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
ROTx, ROSx Setting linear or rotary axis.
ROSx 0 ROTx 0 Meaning Linear axis (1) Inch/metric conversion is done. (2) All coordinate values are linear axis type. (Is not rounded in 0 to 360) (3) Stored pitch error compensation is linear axis type (Refer to parameter No. 3624) Rotary axis (A type) (1) Inch/metric conversion is not done. (2) Machine coordinate values are rounded in 0 to 360. Absolute coordinate values are rounded or not rounded by bits 0 (ROAx) and 2 (RRLx) of parameter No. 1008. (3) Stored pitch error compensation is the rotation type. (Refer to parameter No. 3624) (4) Automatic reference position return (G28, G30) is done in the reference position return direction and the move amount does not exceed one rotation. Rotary axis (B type) (1) Inch/metric conversion is not done. (2) Machine coordinate values, absolute coordinate values and relative coordinate values are linear axis type. (Is not rounded in 0 to 360). (3) Stored pitch error compensation is linear axis type (Refer to parameter No. 3624) (4) Cannot be used with the rotary axis roll-over function and the index table indexing function (M series) Setting is invalid (unused)

Except for the above.

#3

DIAx The move command for each axis is based on: 0: Radius specification 1: Diameter specification TCHx Specify whether each axis is a torch swing control axis for gas cutting machine or not.: 0: Not the torch swing control axis for gas cutting machine. 1: The torch swing control axis for gas cutting machine. ZMIx The direction of manual reference position return is: 0: + direction 1: - direction
- 36 -

#4

#5

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 #6 #5 G90x #4 GRDx #3 RAAx #2 #1 ALZx #0 RTLx

1007

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 RTLx When manual reference position return is performed on a rotary axis (A type) with the deceleration dog pressed before a reference position is established: 0: A movement is made at the reference position return feedrate FL. 1: Until a servo motor grid is established, a movement is not made at the reference position return feedrate FL even if the deceleration dog is pressed, but a movement is made at the rapid traverse rate. If the deceleration dog is released after a movement at the rapid traverse rate and the deceleration dog is then pressed again and released after the rotary axis makes one revolution, reference position return operation is completed. When this parameter is set to 0, the alarm PS0090, "REFERENCE POSITION RETURN FAILURE" is issued if the deceleration dog is released before a servo motor grid is established. If this alarm is issued, start manual reference position return at a position sufficiently far away from the reference position. #1 ALZx In automatic reference position return (G28): 0: Reference position return is performed by positioning (rapid traverse). If no reference position return is performed after the power is turned on, however, reference position return is performed using the same sequence as for manual reference position return. 1: Reference position return is performed using the same sequence as for manual reference position return. RAAx Rotary axis control is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed. When an absolute programming is specified, the rotary axis control function determines the direction of rotation from the sign of the command value and determines an end coordinate from the absolute value of the command value.

#3

NOTE RAA is valid when bit 0 (ROA) of parameter No. 1008 is set to 1 and bit 1 (RAB) of parameter No. 1008 is set to 0. To use this function, the option for rotary axis control is required.
#4 GRDx When absolute position detection is performed for an axis and the correspondence between the machine position and the position on the absolute-position detector has not yet been established for the axis, reference position setting without digs is: 0: Not performed more than once. 1: Performed more than once. G90x A command for a rotary axis control is: 0: Regarded as an absolute/incremental programming according to the G90/G91 mode setting. 1: Regarded as an absolute programming at all times.
- 37 -

#5

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 1008 #6 RRFx #5 RMCx #4 SFDx #3 #2 RRLx #1 RABx

B-63950EN/04 #0 ROAx

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 ROAx The rotary axis roll-over is 0: Invalid 1: Valid

NOTE ROAx specifies the function only for a rotary axis (for which bit 0 (ROTx) of parameter No. 1006 is set to 1)
#1 RABx In the absolute programming, the axis rotates in the direction 0: In which the distance to the target is shorter. 1: Specified by the sign of command value.

NOTE RABx is valid only when ROAx is 1.


#2 RRLx Relative coordinates are 0: Not rounded by the amount of the shift per one rotation 1: Rounded by the amount of the shift per one rotation

NOTE 1 RRLx is valid only when ROAx is 1. 2 Assign the amount of the shift per one rotation in parameter No. 1260.
#4 SFDx In reference position return based on the grid method, the reference position shift function is: 0: Disabled 1: Enabled RMCx When machine coordinate system selection (G53) is specified, bit 1 (RABx) of parameter No. 1008 for determining the rotation direction of an absolute programming for the rotary axis roll-over function, and bit 3 (RAAx) of parameter No. 1007 for rotary axis control are: 0: Invalid 1: Valid RRFx When a reference position return command (G28) is specified, the rotation direction of an absolute command for the rotary axis roll-over function follows: 0: Up to the middle point, it depends on the setting of bit 1 (RAB) of parameter No. 1008. From the middle point to the origin, it depends on the setting of bit 5 (ZMI) of parameter No. 1006. 1: It depends on the setting of bit 1 (RAB) of parameter No. 1008.
- 38 -

#5

#6

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
When bit 1 (ALZ) of parameter No. 1007 is 1, reference position return is performed using the same sequence as for manual reference position return.

NOTE The setting of bit 6 (RRF) of parameter No. 1008 to 1 is valid when all of the following conditions are met: Rotary axis (A type) (Bit 0 (ROT) of parameter No. 1006 = 1, bit 1 (ROS) of parameter No. 1006 = 0) Roll-over is enabled (Bit 0 (ROA) of parameter No. 1008 = 1) The reference position has been established.
#7 1012 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 IDGx

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 IDGx The function for setting the reference position again, without dogs, is: 0: Not inhibited. 1: Inhibited. (The alarm PS0301, RESETTING OF REFERENCE RETURN IS INHIBITED is issued.)

NOTE IDGx is enabled when the bit 7 (IDG) of parameter No. 1002 is 1. If the function for setting the reference position without dogs is used, and the reference position is lost in absolute position detection for a cause, the alarm DS0300, APC ALARM: NEED REF RETURN is issued when the power is turned on again. If the operator performs reference position return, as a result of mistakenly identifying the alarm as that requesting the operator to perform a normal reference position return, an invalid reference position may be set. To prevent such an operator error, the IDGx parameter is provided to prevent the reference position from being set again without dogs. (1) If the bit 7 (IDG) of parameter No. 1002 is set to 1, the bit 0 (IDGx) of parameter No. 1012 is automatically set to 1 when the reference position is set using the function for setting the reference position without dogs. This prevents the reference position from being set again without dogs. (2) Once the reference position is prevented from being set for an axis again, without dogs, any attempt to set the reference position for the axis without dogs results in the output of an alarm PS0301. (3) When the reference position must be set again without dogs, set bit 0 (IDGx) of parameter No. 1012 to 0 before setting the reference position.

- 39 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 1013 IESPx #6 #5 #4 #3 ISEx #2 ISDx #1 ISCx

B-63950EN/04 #0 ISAx

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 ISAx #1 ISCx #2 ISDx #3 ISEx Increment system of each axis
Increment system IS-A IS-B IS-C IS-D IS-E Bit 3 (ISE) 0 0 0 0 1 Bit 2 (ISD) 0 0 0 1 0 Bit 1 (ISC) 0 0 1 0 0 Bit 0 (ISA) 1 0 0 0 0

#7

IESPx When the least input increment is C (IS-C), D(IS-D), or E(IS-E), the function to allow to set the larger value to the parameter of the speed and the acceleration: 0: Not used. 1: Used. As for the axis which set this parameter when the least input increment is C (IS-C), D (IS-D), or E (IS-E), the larger value can be set to the parameter of the speed and the acceleration. The valid data ranges of these parameters are indicated in the table of velocity and angular velocity parameters in (C) of the standard parameter setting tables and the table of acceleration and angular acceleration parameters in (D). When this function is made effective, the digit number below the decimal point of the parameter on input screen is changed. The digit number below the decimal point decreases by one digit in case of the least input increment C (IS-C) or D (IS-D), and it decreases by two digits in case of the least input increment E (IS-E).
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

1014

CDMx

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#7 CDMx The Cs contour control axis is: 0: Not a virtual Cs axis 1: Virtual Cs axis

- 40 -

B-63950EN/04 #7 1015 DWT #6 WIC #5 #4 ZRL

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #4 ZRL When a reference position is established, the tool path from the middle point to the reference position and machine coordinate positioning (G53) in automatic reference position return (G28) or 2nd/3rd/4th reference position return (G30) are based on: 0: Positioning of nonlinear interpolation type 1: Positioning of linear interpolation type

NOTE This parameter is valid when bit 1 (LRP) of parameter No. 1401 is set to 1.
#6 WIC Workpiece origin offset measurement value direct input is: 0: (M series) Performed without considering the external workpiece origin offset value. (T series) Valid only in the currently selected workpiece coordinate system. 1: (M series) Performed considering the external workpiece origin offset value. (T series) Valid in all coordinate systems.

NOTE In the T series, if this parameter bit is set to 0, workpiece origin offset measurement value direct input is enabled only in the currently selected workpiece coordinate system or an external workpiece coordinate system. If an attempt is made to perform workpiece origin offset measurement value direct input in a workpiece coordinate system other than these workpiece coordinate systems, warning "WRITE PROTECTED" is displayed.
#7 DWT When time for dwell per second is specified by P, the increment system: 0: Depends on the increment system 1: Does not depend on the increment system (1 ms)
Program axis name for each axis

1020

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte axis [Valid data range] 65 to 67, 85 to 90 An axis name (axis name 1: parameter No. 1020) can be arbitrarily selected from A, B, C, U, V, W, X, Y, and Z. (When G code system A is used with the lathe system, however, U, V, and W are not selectable.) When bit 0 (EEA) of parameter No. 1000 is set to 1, the length of an axis name can be extended to three characters by setting axis name 2 (parameter No. 1025) and axis name 3 (parameter No. 1026) (extended axis name). For axis names 2 and 3, a character from 0 to 9 and A to Z of ASCII code can be arbitrarily selected. However, the setting of axis name 3 for each axis is invalid if axis name 2 is not set. Moreover, if a character from 0 to 9 is set as axis name 2, do not use a character from A to Z as axis name 3.

- 41 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
(Tip) ASCII code
Axis name Setting X 88 Y 89 Z 90 A 65 B 66 C 67 U 85

B-63950EN/04

V 86

W 87

When G code system A is used with the lathe system, and the character X, Y, Z, or C is used as axis name 1 of an axis, a command with U, V, W, or H specified for axis name 1 represents an incremental programming for the axis.

NOTE 1 When a multiple repetitive canned cycle for turning is used, no character other than X, Y, and Z can be used as the address of the axis. 2 An address other than addresses A, B, and C cannot be used as the address of a rotary axis used for the function for tool length compensation in a specified direction or the tool center point control function. 3 When the custom macro function is enabled, the same extended axis name as a reserved word cannot be used. Such an extended axis name is regarded as a reserved word. Because of reserved words of custom macros, extended axis names that start with the following two characters cannot be used: AB, AC, AD, AN, AS, AT, AX, BC, BI, BP, CA, CL, CO, US, WH, WR, XO, ZD, ZE, ZO, ZW 4 In a macro call, no extended axis name can be used as an argument.
1022 Setting of each axis in the basic coordinate system

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte axis [Valid data range] 0 to 7 To determine a plane for circular interpolation, cutter compensation, and so forth (G17: Xp-Yp plane, G18: Zp-Xp plane, G19: Yp-Zp plane) and a 3-dimensional tool compensation space (XpYpZp), specify which of the basic three axes (X, Y, and Z) is used for each control axis, or a parallel axis of which basic axis is used for each control axis. A basic axis (X, Y, or Z) can be specified only for one control axis. Two or more control axes can be set as parallel axes for the same basic axis.
Setting 0 1 2 3 5 6 7 Meaning Rotary axis (Neither the basic three axes nor a parallel axis ) X axis of the basic three axes Y axis of the basic three axes Z axis of the basic three axes Axis parallel to the X axis Axis parallel to the Y axis Axis parallel to the Z axis

In general, the increment system and diameter/radius specification of an axis set as a parallel axis are to be set in the same way as for the basic three axes.

- 42 -

B-63950EN/04 1023

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Number of the servo axis for each axis

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte axis [Valid data range] 0 to Number of controlled axes Set the servo axis for each control axis. Usually set to same number as the control axis number. The control axis number is the order number that is used for setting the axis-type parameters or axis-type machine signals With an axis for which Cs contour control/spindle positioning is to be performed, set -(spindle number) as the servo axis number. Example) When exercising Cs contour control on the fourth controlled axis by using the first spindle, set -1. For tandem controlled axes or electronic gear box (EGB) controlled axes, two axes need to be specified as one pair. So, make a setting as described below. Tandem axis: For a master axis, set an odd (1, 3, 5, 7, ...) servo axis number. For a slave axis to be paired, set a value obtained by adding 1 to the value set for the master axis. EGB axis: For a slave axis, set an odd (1, 3, 5, 7, ...) servo axis number. For a dummy axis to be paired, set a value obtained by adding 1 to the value set for the slave axis.
1025 1026 Program axis name 2 for each axis Program axis name 3 for each axis

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte axis [Valid data range] 48 to 57, 65 to 90 When axis name extension is enabled (when bit 0 (EEA) of parameter No. 1000 is set to 1), the length of an axis name can be extended to a maximum of three characters by setting axis name 2 and axis name 3.

NOTE If program axis name 2 is not set, program axis name 3 is invalid.
1031 Reference axis

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to Number of controlled axes The unit of some parameters common to all axes such as those for dry run feedrate and single-digit F1 feedrate may vary according to the increment system. An increment system can be selected by a parameter on an axis-by-axis basis. So, the unit of those parameters is to match the increment system of a reference axis. Set which axis to use as a reference axis. Among the basic three axes, the axis with the finest increment system is generally selected as a reference axis.
- 43 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

4.11
1201

PARAMETERS OF COORDINATE SYSTEM (1 OF 2)


#7 WZR WZR #6 NWS #5 #4 #3 FPC FPC #2 ZCL ZCL #1 #0 ZPR ZPR

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 ZPR Automatic setting of a coordinate system when the manual reference position return is performed 0: Not set automatically 1: Set automatically

NOTE ZPR is valid while a workpiece coordinate system function is not provided. If a workpiece coordinate system function is provided, making a manual reference position return always causes the workpiece coordinate system to be established on the basis of the workpiece zero point offset (parameters Nos. 1220 to 1226), irrespective of this parameter setting.
#2 ZCL Local coordinate system when the manual reference position return is performed 0: The local coordinate system is not canceled. 1: The local coordinate system is canceled.

NOTE ZCL is valid when the workpiece coordinate system option is specified. In order to use the local coordinate system (G52), the workpiece coordinate system option is required.
#3 FPC When a floating reference position is set with a soft key, the relative position indication is: 0: Not preset to 0 (The relative position indication remains unchanged.) 1: Preset to 0. NWS The workpiece coordinate system shift amount setting screen is: 0: Displayed 1: Not displayed

#6

NOTE When the workpiece coordinate shift amount setting screen is not displayed, a workpiece coordinate system shift amount modification using G10P0 cannot be made.
#7 WZR If the CNC is reset by the RESET key on the MDI panel, external reset signal, reset and rewind signal, or emergency stop signal when bit 6 (CLR) of parameter No. 3402 is set to 0, the G code of group number 14 (workpiece coordinate system) is: 0: Placed in the reset state (not returned to G54). 1: Placed in the cleared state (returned to G54).

- 44 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE 1 When the 3-dimensional conversion mode is set, and bit 2 (D3R) of parameter No. 5400 is set to 1, the G code is placed in the reset state, regardless of the setting of this parameter. 2 When bit 6 (CLR) of parameter No. 3402 is set to 1, whether to place the G code in the reset state depends on bit 6 (C14) of parameter No. 3407.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 RLC RLC #2 G92 G92 #1 EWS #0 EWD EWD

1202

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 EWD The shift direction of the workpiece coordinate system is: 0: The direction specified by the external workpiece zero point offset value 1: In the opposite direction to that specified by the external workpiece zero point offset value EWS The external workpiece zero point offset is made: 0: Valid 1: Invalid

#1

NOTE When the external workpiece zero point offset is made invalid, the following operation results: 1 As the external workpiece zero point offset on the workpiece zero point offset setting screen, a workpiece coordinate system shift amount is displayed. 2 Data keyed through the MDI panel for the workpiece coordinate system shift amount and external workpiece zero point offset is loaded into the memory for the workpiece coordinate system shift amount. 3 A write to or read from the workpiece coordinate system shift amount and external workpiece zero point offset with a macro variable is performed using the respective memory. 4 A write to or read from the workpiece coordinate system shift amount and external workpiece zero point offset with the window function is performed using the respective memory.
#2 G92 When the CNC has commands G52 to G59 specifying workpiece coordinate systems (optional function), if the G command for setting a coordinate system (G92 for M series, G50 for T series (or the G92 command in G command system B or C)) is specified, 0: G command is executed and no alarm is issued. 1: G command is not executed and an alarm PS0010, IMPROPER G-CODE is issued. RLC Local coordinate system is 0: Not cancelled by reset 1: Cancelled by reset
- 45 -

#3

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE 1 When bit 6 (CLR) of parameter No. 3402 is set to 0, and bit 7 (WZR) of parameter No. 1201 is set to 1, the local coordinate system is cancelled, regardless of the setting of this parameter. 2 When bit 6 (CLR) of parameter No. 3402 is set to 1, and bit 6 (C14) of parameter No. 3407 is set to 0, the local coordinate system is cancelled, regardless of the setting of this parameter. 3 When the 3-dimensional coordinate system conversion mode is set, and bit 2 (D3R) of parameter No. 5400 is set to 1, the local coordinate system is not cancelled, regardless of the setting of this parameter.
#7 1203 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 EMS

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 EMS The extended external machine zero point shift function is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.

NOTE 1 To use the extended external machine zero point shift function, the external machine zero point shift function or the external data input function is required. 2 When the extended external machine zero point shift function is enabled, the conventional external machine zero point shift function is disabled.
#7 1205 WTC #6 3TW #5 R2O #4 R1O #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #4 R1O The output of the signal for the reference position is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. R2O The output of the signal for the second reference position is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. 3TW When workpiece coordinate system selection is specified with G code in tilted working plane command mode: 0: The alarm PS5462, "ILLEGAL COMMAND (G68.2/G69)" is issued. 1: Workpiece coordinate system selection is executed.

#5

#6

- 46 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS CAUTION When this parameter is 1, only G54 to G59 or G54.1 can be specified. Specifying G52 or G92 causes alarm PS5462. Specifying G54 to G59 or G54.1 suppresses buffering.
Feature coordinate system (G68.2) Feature coordinate system (G68.2) Coordinate Coordinate system zero system zero point shift point shift amount amount

Machine zero point


G54 Feature coordinate system (G68.2) Feature coordinate system (G68.2) Coordinate system zero point shift amount G55

Coordinate system zero point shift amount

G56

G57

Program example G90 G17 G54 G68.2 X_Y_Z_ I_ J_ K_ G53.1 G43H_ G55 X_Y_Z_ G56 X_Y_Z_ G57 X_Y_Z_ G49 G69

X_Y_Z_: Coordinate system zero point shift amount

#7

WTC When workpiece coordinate system preset is done, actual tool length offset is: 0: Not considered. 1: Considered. When this parameter is set 1, it is possible to preset the workpiece coordinate system by G-code, MDI operation or the workpiece coordinate system preset signal without canceling the tool length compensation modes. The compensation vector is kept as the below figure when the workpiece coordinate system preset is done to the coordinate shifted by amount of movement during manual intervention.

- 47 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
G54 workpiece coordinate System before manual intervention WZo

B-63950EN/04

Po Tool length offset value Amount of movement during manual intervention

G54 workpiece coordinate system after manual intervention Machine zero point WZn Tool length offset value Pn

#7 1206

#6

#5

#4

#3

#2

#1 HZP

#0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #1 HZP At high-speed manual reference position return, presetting the coordinate system is: 0: Performed. 1: Not performed.

NOTE This parameter is valid when no workpiece coordinate system exists with bit 0 (ZPR) of parameter No. 1201 set to 0.
#7 1207 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 WOL

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 WOL The calculation method for workpiece origin offset measurement value direct input is as follows: 0: In a machine that requires that the difference from the reference tool be set as the tool length compensation amount, the workpiece origin offset is measured and set with the reference tool mounted on the machine. (The tool length of the reference tool is assumed to be 0.) 1: In a machine that requires that the tool length itself be set as the tool length compensation amount, the workpiece origin offset is measured and set considering the tool length when the tool length compensation for the mounted tool is enabled.

- 48 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE The setting of this parameter is valid only when the system used is the M series and bit 6 (DAL) of parameter No. 3104 is set to 1. If this parameter is set to 1 in other than the above conditions, the system operates as if this parameter bit were set to 0.

1220

External workpiece zero point offset value in each axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real axis mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This is one of the parameters that give the position of the zero point of workpiece coordinate system (G54 to G59). It gives an offset of the workpiece zero point common to all workpiece coordinate systems. In general, the offset varies depending on the workpiece coordinate systems. The value can be set from the PMC using the external data input function.
Workpiece zero point offset value in workpiece coordinate system 1 (G54) Workpiece zero point offset value in workpiece coordinate system 2(G55) Workpiece zero point offset value in workpiece coordinate system 3(G56) Workpiece zero point offset value in workpiece coordinate system 4 (G57) Workpiece zero point offset value in workpiece coordinate system 5 (G58) Workpiece zero point offset value in workpiece coordinate system 6 (G59)

1221 1222 1223 1224 1225 1226

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real axis mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) The workpiece zero point offset values in workpiece coordinate systems 1 to 6 (G54 to G59) are set.
Coordinate value of the reference position in the machine coordinate system

1240

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input Real axis mm, inch, degree (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Set the coordinate values of the reference position in the machine coordinate system.
- 49 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
1241 1242 1243

B-63950EN/04

Coordinate value of the second reference position in the machine coordinate system Coordinate value of the third reference position in the machine coordinate system Coordinate value of the fourth reference position in the machine coordinate system

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch, degree (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Set the coordinate values of the second to fourth reference positions in the machine coordinate system.
Coordinate value of the floating reference position in the machine coordinate system

1244

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch, degree (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Set the coordinate values of the floating reference position in the machine coordinate system.
Coordinate system of the reference position used when automatic coordinate system setting is performed

1250

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Set the coordinate system of the reference position on each axis to be used for performing automatic coordinate system setting.
The shift amount per one rotation of a rotary axis

1260

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input Real axis Degree Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) Set the shift amount per one rotation of a rotary axis. For the rotary axis used for cylindrical interpolation, set the standard value.

- 50 -

B-63950EN/04 1280

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Start address of signals used with the extended external machine zero point shift function

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] Even number from 0 to 32767 Set the start address of signals used with the extended external machine zero point shift function. If a nonexistent address value is specified, this function is disabled. If 100 is set, for example, this function uses R100 and up. The last R address to be used depends on the number of controlled axes. When eight controlled axes are used, R100 to R115 are used.

NOTE If a nonexistent R address or an address in the system area is set, this function is disabled.
1290 Distance between two opposite tool posts in mirror image

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) Set the distance between two opposite tool posts in mirror image.

4.12
1300

PARAMETERS OF STORED STROKE CHECK


#7 BFA #6 LZR #5 RL3 #4 #3 #2 LMS #1 NAL #0 OUT

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit path #0 OUT The area inside or outside of the stored stroke check 2 is set as an inhibition area 0: Inside 1: Outside NAL When the tool enters the inhibition area of stored stroke limit 1: 0: The overtravel alarm signal is not output. 1: The overtravel alarm signal is output, and the tool is decelerated to a stop. If manual operation is in progress at this time, the alarm is not output.

#1

NOTE When this parameter is set to 1, the alarm is issued if the tool enters stored stroke limit 1 during automatic operation.
#2 LMS The stored stroke check 1 select signal (EXLM3, EXLM2, or EXLM when stored stroke check 1 area expansion is used) for switching stored stroke check 0: Disabled 1: Enabled
- 51 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE When bit 0 (DLM) of parameter No. 1301 is set to 1, the stored stroke check 1 select signal EXLM <Gn007.6> (EXLM3 <Gn531.7>, EXLM2 <Gn531.6>, or EXLM <Gn007.6> when stored stroke check 1 area expansion is used) is made invalid.
#5 RL3 Stored stroke check 3 release signal RLSOT3 is 0: Disabled 1: Enabled LZR When the stored stroke check immediately after power-on is enabled (bit 0 (DOT) of parameter No. 1311 is set to 1), the stored stroke check is: 0: Performed even before a manual reference position return is made. 1: Not performed until a manual reference position return is made. BFA When the stored stroke check 1, 2, or 3 alarm is issued, an interference alarm is issued with the inter-path interference check function (T series), or a chuck/tail stock barrier (T series) alarm is issued: 0: The tool stops after entering the prohibited area. 1: The tool stops before the prohibited area.
#7 1301 PLC #6 OTS #5 #4 OF1 #3 #2 NPC #1 LMA #0 DLM

#6

#7

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit path #0 DLM The axis direction dependent stored stroke check 1 switch signal +EXLx <G104> and EXLx <G105> are: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. When this parameter is set to 1, the stored stroke check 1 select signal EXLM <G007.6> is made invalid. LMA When the stored stroke check 1 select signal EXLM <G007.6> is 1 with bit 2 (LMS) of parameter No. 1300 set to 1, the movable area for stored stroke check 1 is: 0: The inside area set for stored stroke check 1-II. 1: The inside area set for stored stroke check 1-I and the inside area set for stored stroke check 1-II as well. NPC As part of the stroke limit check performed before movement, the movement specified in G31 (skip) and G37 (automatic tool length measurement) blocks is: 0: Checked 1: Not checked

#1

#2

NOTE This parameter is valid only when the option for stroke limit check before movement is selected.

- 52 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
OF1 If the tool is moved into the range allowed on the axis after an alarm is raised by stored stroke check 1, 0: The alarm is not canceled before a reset is made. 1: The OT alarm is immediately canceled.

#4

NOTE In the cases below, the automatic release function is disabled. To release an alarm, a reset operation is required. 1 When a setting is made to issue an alarm before a stored stroke limit is exceeded (bit 7 (BFA) of parameter No. 1300 is set to 1) 2 When an another overtravel alarm (such as stored stroke check 2, stored stroke check 3, and interference check) is already issued 3 When an overtravel alarm is already issued with the chopping function
#6 OTS When the overtravel alarm is issued: 0: The overtravel alarm signal is not output to the PMC. 1: The overtravel alarm signal is output to the PMC. PLC Stroke check before movement is: 0: Not performed 1: Performed

#7

NOTE This parameter is valid only when the option for stroke limit check before movement is selected.
#7 1310 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 OT3x #0 OT2x

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit axis #0 OT2x Stored stroke check 2 for each axis is : 0: Disabled 1: Enabled OT3x Stored stroke check 3 for each axis is : 0: Disabled 1: Enabled
#7 1311 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 DOTx

#1

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.

- 53 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#0 DOTx Stored stroke limit check immediately after power-on is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.

B-63950EN/04

If the stored stroke check is enabled, the machine coordinate value present immediately before the power is turned off is stored. The machine coordinate value is set immediately after the power is turned on. Based on the machine coordinate value, absolute coordinate and relative coordinate values are set.

NOTE Because this function uses software to store machine coordinates, the function puts an extra load on the system. So, this function should not be set for axes that do not require this function. The amount of a movement made while the power is off is not reflected in machine coordinates immediately after the power is turned on.
#7 1312 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 SLM

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 SLM The stroke limit area changing function is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
Coordinate value I of stored stroke check 1 in the positive direction on each axis Coordinate value I of stored stroke check 1 in the negative direction on each axis

1320 1321

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch, degree (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Set the coordinate value of stored stroke check 1 on each axis in the + or - direction in the machine coordinate system.

NOTE 1 Specify diameter values for any axes for which diameter programming is specified. 2 The area outside the area set by parameters Nos. 1320 and 1321 is a prohibited area.
1322 1323 Coordinate value of stored stroke check 2 in the positive direction on each axis Coordinate value of stored stroke check 2 in the negative direction on each axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data]

Setting input Real axis mm, inch, degree (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis
- 54 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Valid data range] 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Set the coordinate value of stored stroke check 2 on each axis in the + or - direction in the machine coordinate system.

NOTE 1 Specify diameter values for any axes for which diameter programming is specified. 2 Whether the inside area or outside area is a prohibited area is set using bit 0 (OUT) of parameter No. 1300.
1324 1325 Coordinate value of stored stroke check 3 in the positive direction on each axis Coordinate value of stored stroke check 3 in the negative direction on each axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real axis mm, inch, degree (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Set the coordinate value of stored stroke check 3 on each axis in the + or - direction in the machine coordinate system.

NOTE 1 Specify diameter values for any axes for which diameter programming is specified. 2 The area inside the area set by parameters Nos. 1324 and 1325 is a prohibited area.
1326 1327 1350 1351 1352 1353 1354 1355 1356 1357 1358 1359 1360 1361 Coordinate value II of stored stroke check 1 in the positive direction on each axis Coordinate value II of stored stroke check 1 in the negative direction on each axis Coordinate value III of stored stroke check 1 in the positive direction on each axis Coordinate value III of stored stroke check 1 in the negative direction on each axis Coordinate value IV of stored stroke check 1 in the positive direction on each axis Coordinate value IV of stored stroke check 1 in the negative direction on each axis Coordinate value V of stored stroke check 1 in the positive direction on each axis Coordinate value V of stored stroke check 1 in the negative direction on each axis Coordinate value VI of stored stroke check 1 in the positive direction on each axis Coordinate value VI of stored stroke check 1 in the negative direction on each axis Coordinate value VII of stored stroke check 1 in the positive direction on each axis Coordinate value VII of stored stroke check 1 in the negative direction on each axis Coordinate value VIII of stored stroke check 1 in the positive direction on each axis Coordinate value VIII of stored stroke check 1 in the negative direction on each axis

- 55 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

B-63950EN/04

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch, degree (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Set the coordinate value of stored stroke check 1 on each axis in the + or - direction in the machine coordinate system. The stored stroke check 1 select signal (EXLM3, EXLM2, EXLM) and the stroke parameter to be selected have the following relationships:
EXLM3 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 EXLM2 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 EXLM 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Stroke parameter to be selected Coordinate value I (No. 1320 / No. 1321) Coordinate value II (No. 1326 / No. 1327) Coordinate value III (No. 1350 / No. 1351) Coordinate value IV (No. 1352 / No. 1353) Coordinate value V (No. 1354 / No. 1355) Coordinate value VI (No. 1356 / No. 1357) Coordinate value VII (No. 1358 / No. 1359) Coordinate value VIII (No. 1360 / No. 1361)

NOTE 1 Specify diameter values for any axes for which diameter programming is specified. 2 The outside of the area set with each parameter is treated as the inhibition area. 3 The stored stroke check 1 select signal (EXLM3, EXLM2, EXLM) is valid only when bit 2 (LMS) of parameter No. 1300 is 1. 4 When axis direction dependent stored stroke check 1 is enabled (with bit 0 (DLM) of parameter No. 1301 set to 1), stroke parameter switching by the stored stroke check 1 select signal (EXLM3, EXLM2, EXLM) is disabled.

4.13
1330

PARAMETERS OF THE CHUCK AND TAIL STOCK BARRIER


Profile of a chuck

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 1 Select a chuck figure. 0 : Chuck which holds a workpiece on the inner surface 1 : Chuck which holds a workpiece on the outer surface
1331 Dimensions of the claw of a chuck (L)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Real path [Unit of data] mm, inch (input unit)
- 56 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Min. unit of data] Depend on the increment system of the applied axis [Valid data range] 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) Set the length (L) of the claw of the chuck.

NOTE Whether to specify this parameter by using a diameter value or radius value depends on whether the corresponding axis is based on diameter specification or radius specification.
1332 Dimensions of the claw of a chuck (W)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) Set the width (W) of the claw of the chuck.

NOTE Specify this parameter by using a radius value at all times.


1333 Dimensions of the claw of a chuck (L1)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) Set the length (L1) of the claw of the chuck.

NOTE Whether to specify this parameter by using a diameter value or radius value depends on whether the corresponding axis is based on diameter specification or radius specification.
1334 Dimensions of the claw of a chuck (W1)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999)
- 57 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Set the width (W1) of the claw of the chuck.

B-63950EN/04

NOTE Specify this parameter by using a radius value at all times.


1335 X coordinate of a chuck (CX)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Set the chuck position (X coordinate) in the workpiece coordinate system.

NOTE Whether to specify this parameter by using a diameter value or radius value depends on whether the corresponding axis is based on diameter specification or radius specification.
1336 Z coordinate of a chuck (CZ)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Set the chuck position (Z coordinate) in the workpiece coordinate system.

NOTE Whether to specify this parameter by using a diameter value or radius value depends on whether the corresponding axis is based on diameter specification or radius specification.
1341 Length of a tail stock (L)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) Set the length (L) of the tail stock.

- 58 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE Whether to specify this parameter by using a diameter value or radius value depends on whether the corresponding axis is based on diameter specification or radius specification.

1342

Diameter of a tail stock (D)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) Set the diameter (D) of the tail stock.

NOTE Specify this parameter by using a diameter value at all times.


1343 Length of a tail stock (L1)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) Set the length (L1) of the tail stock.

NOTE Whether to specify this parameter by using a diameter value or radius value depends on whether the corresponding axis is based on diameter specification or radius specification.
1344 Diameter of a tail stock (D1)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) Set the diameter (D1) of the tail stock.

NOTE Specify this parameter by using a diameter value at all times.

- 59 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
1345 Length of a tail stock (L2)

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) Set the length (L2) of the tail stock.

NOTE Whether to specify this parameter by using a diameter value or radius value depends on whether the corresponding axis is based on diameter specification or radius specification.
1346 Diameter of a tail stock (D2)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) Set the diameter (D2) of the tail stock.

NOTE Specify this parameter by using a diameter value at all times.


1347 Diameter of a tail stock (D3)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) Set the diameter (D3) of the tail stock.

NOTE Specify this parameter by using a diameter value at all times.


1348 Z coordinate of a tail stock (TZ)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Real path [Unit of data] mm, inch (input unit)
- 60 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Min. unit of data] Depend on the increment system of the applied axis [Valid data range] 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Set the tail stock position (Z coordinate) in the workpiece coordinate system.

NOTE Whether to specify this parameter by using a diameter value or radius value depends on whether the corresponding axis is based on diameter specification or radius specification.

4.14
1401

PARAMETERS OF FEEDRATE
#7 #6 RDR #5 TDR #4 RF0 #3 #2 JZR #1 LRP #0 RPD

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 RPD Manual rapid traverse during the period from power-on time to the completion of the reference position return. 0: Disabled (Jog feed is performed.) 1: Enabled LRP Positioning (G00) 0: Positioning is performed with non-linear type positioning so that the tool moves along each axis independently at rapid traverse. 1: Positioning is performed with linear interpolation so that the tool moves in a straight line. When using 3-dimensional coordinate system conversion, set this parameter to 1. JZR The manual reference position return at jog feedrate 0: Not performed 1: Performed RF0 When cutting feedrate override is 0% during rapid traverse, 0: The machine tool does not stop moving. 1: The machine tool stops moving. TDR Dry run during threading or tapping (tapping cycle G74 or G84, rigid tapping) 0: Enabled 1: Disabled RDR Dry run for rapid traverse command 0: Disabled 1: Enabled
#7 1402 #6 #5 #4 JRV #3 OV2 #2 #1 JOV #0 NPC

#1

#2

#4

#5

#6

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

- 61 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#0

B-63950EN/04

NPC Feed per revolution without the position coder (function for converting feed per revolution F to feed per minute F in the feed per revolution mode (G95)) is: 0: Not used 1: Used JOV Jog override is: 0: Enabled 1: Disabled (tied to 100%) OV2 Signals used for 2nd feedrate override are 0: *AFV0 to AFV7 <G013> (specified every 1%) 1: *APF00 to *APF15 <G094, G095> (specified every 0.01%) JRV Jog feed or incremental feed is 0: Performed at feed per minute. 1: Performed at feed per rotation.

#1

#3

#4

NOTE 1 Specify a feedrate in parameter No. 1423. 2 For the machining center system, the option for threading/synchronous feed is required.
#7 1403 RTV RTV #6 #5 HTG HTG #4 ROC ROC EDT #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #3 EDT The function for corner control by feedrate (for a gas cutting machine) is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. When the feedrate has reduced to the feedrate set in parameter No. 1474, from which the system regards the number of accumulated pulses as being 0, the next block is executed. ROC In the threading cycles G92 (T series), G76 (T series), and G76.7 (M series), rapid traverse override for retraction after threading is finished is: 0: Effective 1: Not effective (Override of 100%) HTG The feedrate for helical interpolation/helical involute interpolation/3-dimensional circular interpolation is: 0: Specified using the feedrate along the tangent to an arc/involute curve/3-dimensional arc 1: Specified using the feedrate along axes including a linear axis (specified axes other than the circular interpolation axis in the case of 3-dimensional circular interpolation) RTV Rapid traverse override while the tool is retracting in threading 0: Rapid traverse override is effective. 1: Rapid traverse override is not effective.

#4

#5

#7

- 62 -

B-63950EN/04 #7 1404 FC0 FC0 #6 #5 #4

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#3 #2 FM3 #1 DLF DLF #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #1 DLF After a reference position is set, manual reference position return performed at: 0: Rapid traverse rate (parameter No. 1420) 1: Manual rapid traverse rate (parameter No. 1424)

NOTE This parameter selects a feedrate for reference position return performed without dogs. This parameter also selects a feedrate when manual reference position return is performed according to bit 7 (SJZ) of parameter No.0002 using rapid traverse without deceleration dogs after a reference position is set.
#2 FM3 The increment system of an F command without a decimal point in feed per minute is: 0: 1 mm/min (0.01 inch/min for inch input) 1: 0.001 mm/min (0.00001 inch/min for inch input) FC0 Specifies the behavior of the machine tool when a block (G01, G02, G03, etc.) containing a feedrate command (F command) that is 0 is issued during automatic operation, as follows: 0: An alarm PS0011, FEED ZERO (COMMAND) occurs. 1: An alarm PS0011 does not occur, and the block is executed.

#7

NOTE 1 In inverse time feed (G93) mode, the alarm PS1202, "NO F COMMAND AT G93" is issued irrespective of the setting of this parameter. 2 This parameter is set from 1 to 0, if a bit 6 (CLR) of parameter No. 3402 is 1, reset the CNC. Or if CLR is 0, turn off and on the CNC.
#7 1405 #6 #5 EDR EDR #4 #3 HFR HFR #2 PCL PCL FR3 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #1 FR3 The increment system of an F command without a decimal point in feed per revolution is: 0: 0.01 mm/rev (0.0001 inch/rev for inch input) 1: 0.001 mm/rev (0.00001 inch/rev for inch input) PCL The function for constant surface speed control without the position coder is: 0: Not used. 1: Used.

#2

- 63 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE The option for constant surface speed control without the position coder is required.
#3 HFR Feedrate command in rapid traverse is: 0: A value of set in parameter. 1: Synchronized with handle pulse by the handle-synchronous feed function.

NOTE This parameter is available when the handle-synchronous feed function is available.
#5 EDR As the external deceleration rate for positioning of linear interpolation type: 0: The external deceleration rate for cutting feed is used. 1: The external deceleration rate in rapid traverse for the first axis of path 1 is used. Let us use external deceleration 1 as an example. When this parameter bit is set to 0, the value of parameter No. 1426 is used as the external deceleration rate for external deceleration 1. When this parameter bit is set to 1, the value of axis 1 of parameter No. 1427 is used as the external deceleration rate for external deceleration 1.
#7 1406 F1O #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 EX3 EX3 #0 EX2 EX2

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 EX2 External deceleration function setting 2 is: 0: Invalid 1: Valid EX3 External deceleration function setting 3 is: 0: Invalid 1: Valid F1O For the cutting feedrate specified by a single-digit F code (F1 to F9), feedrate override, second feedrate override, and override cancellation are: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.

#1

#7

NOTE For the F0 feedrate, rapid traverse override is enabled regardless of the setting of this parameter.
#7 1408 #6 #5 #4 #3 IRCx #2 #1 #0 RFDx

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis

- 64 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

#0

RFDx Feedrate control on a rotary axis is exercised using: 0: Conventional method 1: Method that specifies a feedrate on the virtual circle of the rotary axis IRCx The least input increment of the maximum cutting feedrates set in parameter Nos. 1430 and 1432 is: 0: Not multiplied by ten. 1: Multiplied by ten. Set this parameter for the following axes, which are operated by the following functions: Spindle control axis by servo motor Tool rotary axis in the polygon turning function Tool rotary axis in interpolation type rigid tapping If a rotation speed of 1000 (1/min) (=360000 (deg/min)) is to be used when this parameter is set to 1, set 36000.0 in parameter No. 1430/1432.

#3

1410

Dry run rate

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) Set the dry run rate at the 100% position on the jog feedrate specification dial. The unit of data depends on the increment system of the reference axis.

1411

Cutting feedrate

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range] Setting input Real path mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) A cutting feedrate can be specified with this parameter for a machine which does not have to change the cutting feedrate frequently during machining. This eliminates the need to specify a cutting feedrate (F code) in the NC program.

1414

Feedrate for retrace

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0)
- 65 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

Set a cutting feedrate for retrace operation. When 0 is set, a retrace operation is performed at a programmed feedrate.
1415 Manual synchronous feedrate for manual linear/circular interpolation continuous feed at override 100%

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0)

NOTE This parameter is valid only when bit 4 (JRV) of parameter No. 1402 is 1 (manual per revolution feed is enabled). If manual per revolution feed is disabled, the manual linear/circular interpolation continuous feedrate follows the dry run rate (parameter No. 1410). For a machining center system, the manual linear/circular interpolation continuous feedrate follows the dry run rate (parameter No. 1410) (feed per minute) even though bit 4 (JRV) of parameter No. 1402 is set to 1 when the threading/synchronous feed option is not specified.
1420 Rapid traverse rate for each axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) Set the rapid traverse rate when the rapid traverse override is 100% for each axis.
F0 rate of rapid traverse override for each axis

1421

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) Set the F0 rate of the rapid traverse override for each axis.
Feedrate in manual continuous feed (jog feed) for each axis

1423

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) (1) When bit 4 (JRV) of parameter No. 1402 is set to 0 (feed per minute), specify a jog feedrate (feed per minute) under an override of 100%.
- 66 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
(2) When bit 4 (JRV) of parameter No. 1402 is set to 1 (feed per revolution), specify a jog feedrate (feed per revolution) under an override of 100%.

NOTE This parameter is clamped to the axis-by-axis manual rapid traverse rate (parameter No. 1424).
1424 Manual rapid traverse rate for each axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) Set the rate of manual rapid traverse when the rapid traverse override is 100% for each axis.

NOTE 1 If 0 is set, the rate set in parameter No. 1420 (rapid traverse rate for each axis) is assumed. 2 When manual rapid traverse is selected (bit 0 (RPD) of parameter No. 1401 is set to 1), manual feed is performed at the feedrate set in this parameter, regardless of the setting of bit 4 (JRV) of parameter No. 1402.
1425 FL rate of the reference position return for each axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) Set feedrate (FL rate) after deceleration when the reference position return is performed for each axis.
External deceleration rate of cutting feed

1426

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) Set an external deceleration rate for cutting feed or positioning of linear interpolation type (G00).
External deceleration rate of rapid traverse for each axis

1427

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Real axis [Unit of data] mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit)
- 67 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
[Min. unit of data] Depend on the increment system of the applied axis [Valid data range] Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) Set the external deceleration rate of rapid traverse for each axis.
1428 Reference position return feedrate for each axis

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) This parameter sets a rapid traverse rate for reference position return operation using deceleration dogs, or for reference position return operation before a reference position is set. This parameter is also used to set a feedrate for the rapid traverse command (G00) in automatic operation before a reference position is set.

- 68 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE 1 To this feedrate setting 100%, a rapid traverse override (F0, 25, 50, or 100%) is applicable. 2 For automatic return after completion of reference position return and machine coordinate system establishment, the normal rapid traverse rate is used. 3 As a manual rapid traverse rate before machine coordinate system establishment by reference position return, the jog feedrate or manual rapid traverse rate can be selected with bit 0 (RPD) of parameter No. 1401.
Automatic reference position return (G28) Automatic rapid traverse (G00) Manual reference position return *1 Manual rapid traverse Before coordinate system establishment No. 1428 No. 1428 No. 1428 No. 1423 *2 After coordinate system establishment No. 1420 No. 1420 No. 1428 *3 No. 1424

4 When parameter No. 1428 is set to 0, the following parameter-set feedrates are applied.
Automatic reference position return (G28) Automatic rapid traverse (G00) Manual reference position return *1 Manual rapid traverse Before coordinate system establishment No. 1420 No. 1420 No. 1424 No. 1423 *2 After coordinate system establishment No. 1420 No. 1420 No. 1424 *3 No. 1424

No. 1420: Rapid traverse rate No. 1423: Jog feedrate No. 1424: Manual rapid traverse rate *1 : By using bit 2 (JZR) of parameter No. 1401, the jog feedrate can be used for manual reference position return at all times. *2 : When bit 0 (RPD) of parameter No. 1401 is set to 1, the setting of parameter No. 1424 is used. *3 : When rapid traverse is used for reference position return without dogs or manual reference position return after reference position establishment, regardless of the deceleration dog, the feedrate for manual reference position return based on these functions is used (the setting of bit 1 (DLF) of parameter No. 1404 is followed).
1430 Maximum cutting feedrate for each axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) Specify the maximum cutting feedrate for each axis.
Maximum cutting feedrate for all axes in the acceleration/deceleration before interpolation

1432

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0)
- 69 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

Set a maximum cutting feedrate for each axis in the acceleration/deceleration before interpolation mode such as AI contour control. When the acceleration/deceleration before interpolation mode is not set, the maximum cutting feedrate set in parameter No. 1430 is used.
1434 Maximum manual handle feedrate for each axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) Set a maximum manual handle feedrate for each axis in case of maximum manual handle feedrate switch signal HNDLF<Gn023.3>=1.
External deceleration rate setting 2 in cutting feed

1440

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) Set external deceleration rate 2 for cutting feed or positioning of linear interpolation type (G00).
External deceleration rate setting 2 for each axis in rapid traverse

1441

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) Set external deceleration rate 2 for each axis in rapid traverse.
Maximum manual handle feedrate setting 2 for each axis

1442

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) Set a maximum manual handle feedrate 2 for each axis.
External deceleration rate setting 3 in cutting feed

1443

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0)
- 70 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Set external deceleration rate 3 for cutting feed or positioning of linear interpolation type (G00).

1444

External deceleration rate setting 3 for each axis in rapid traverse

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) Set external deceleration rate 3 for each axis in rapid traverse.
Maximum manual handle feedrate setting 3 for each axis

1445

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) Set a maximum manual handle feedrate 3 for each axis.
Adjusting parameter 1 for threading start position compensation in changing spindle speed function (multiplier)

1446

[Data type] Word path [Unit of data] 1/10000 [Valid data range] -32768 to 32767 (Assumed to be 10000 when the setting is 0.) This parameter sets a multiplier for finely adjusting the NC-calculated offset value (NC-internal delay of acceleration/deceleration after interpolation).
1448 Adjusting parameter 2 for threading start position compensation in changing spindle speed function (multiplier)

[Data type] Word path [Unit of data] 1/10000 [Valid data range] -32768 to 32767 (Assumed to be 10000 when the setting is 0.) This parameter sets a multiplier for finely adjusting the NC-calculated offset value (servo delay).
1449 Adjusting parameter 3 for threading start position compensation in changing spindle speed function (multiplier)

[Data type] Word path [Unit of data] 1/10000 [Valid data range] -32768 to 32767 (Assumed to be 10000 when the setting is 0.) This parameter sets a multiplier for finely adjusting the NC-calculated offset value (delay in one-rotation signal detection). When the NC-calculated offset value is 1280, the multiplier is assumed to be 10000 if this parameter is set to 0, where 1280*10000/10000=1280 leads to a shift of 1280/4096*360=112.500[deg]. If the parameter is set to 12000, however, 1280*12000/10000=1536 leads to a shift of 1536/4096*360=135.000[deg].
- 71 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
1450

B-63950EN/04

Change of feedrate for one graduation on the manual pulse generator during one-digit F feed code

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to 127 Set the constant that determines the change in feedrate as the manual pulse generator is rotated one graduation during one-digit F feed code.

F =

F max i (where, i=1 or 2) 100n

In the above equation, set n. That is, the number of revolutions of the manual pulse generator, required to reach feedrate Fmaxi is obtained. Fmaxi refers to the upper limit of the feedrate for a one-digit F code feed command, and set it in parameter No. 1460 or 1461. Fmax1: Upper limit of the feedrate for F1 to F4 (parameter No. 1460) Fmax2: Upper limit of the feedrate for F5 to F9 (parameter No. 1461)
1451

Feedrate for F1

to
1459

to
Feedrate for F9

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real path mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) These parameters set the feedrates for one-digit F code feed commands F1 to F9. When a one-digit F code feed command is specified, and the feedrate is changed by turning the manual pulse generator, the parameter-set value also changes accordingly.

1460

Upper limit of feedrate for F1 to F4

1461

Upper limit of feedrate for F5 to F9

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) Set the upper limit of feedrate for the one-digit F code feed command. As the feedrate increases by turning the manual pulse generator, the feedrate is clamped when it reaches the upper limit set. If a one-digit F feed command F1 to F4 is executed, the upper limit is that set in parameter No. 1460. If a one-digit F code feed command F5 to F9 is executed, the upper limit is that set in parameter No. 1461.
Radius of a virtual circle when a feedrate is specified on the virtual circle of a rotary axis

1465

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Real axis


- 72 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Unit of data] mm, inch (input unit) [Min. unit of data] Depend on the increment system of the applied axis [Valid data range] Refer to the standard parameter setting table (B) Set the radius of a virtual circle when a feedrate on the virtual circle of a rotary axis is specified. If 0 is set for a rotary axis, the axis is excluded from feedrate calculation. If the input unit is the inch, enter a value in inches. The data is then converted to a millimeter value and displayed.
1466 Feedrate for retraction in threading cycle G92 or G76 Feedrate for retraction in threading cycle G76.7

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm/min, inch/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) When threading cycle G92, G76 or G76.7 is specified, retraction is performed after threading. Set a feedrate for this retraction.

NOTE When this parameter is set to 0 or bit 1 (CFR) of parameter No. 1611 is set to 1, the rapid traverse rate set in parameter No. 1420 is used.
1474

Feedrate regarded as accumulated pulse 0. (corner control by feedrate (for gas cutting machine))

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, deg/min (machine unit) 0 to 32767 When a cutting feed block (block A) is followed by another cutting feed block (block B), execution proceeds to block B if the feedrate in the automatic acceleration/deceleration circuit for each axis is reduced to the setting of this parameter, and the number of accumulated pulses in the automatic acceleration/deceleration circuit is assumed to be 0. This setting is used for corner control by feedrate (for a gas cutting machine).
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 LMV #1 TOV #0

1490

PGF

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #1 TOV The threading start position compensation in changing spindle speed function is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. LMV The offset value for Z-axis threading start position at a spindle speed change is set: 0: By spindle resolution (lead/4096). 1: In Z-axis least command increments.

#2

- 73 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7

B-63950EN/04

PGF The feedrate specified for circular interpolation, involute interpolation, spiral/conical interpolation, and NURBS interpolation in the high-speed program check mode is: 0: The dry run feedrate. At this time, manual feedrate override signals *JV0 to *JV15 <Gn010 to Gn011> can be used. 1: The maximum feedrate specified by the CNC.

CAUTION If this parameter is set to 1, feedrate clamp, override, and dry run for circular interpolation, involute interpolation, spiral/conical interpolation, and NURBS interpolation are disabled. If a movement around a stroke limit is specified, therefore, a stroke limit check cannot sometimes be made correctly.
1495

Torch swing feedrate of the torch control axis for gas cutting machine

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) Set the swing feedrate of the torch control axis for gas cutting machine.

1496

Critical angle of automatic exact stop check

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word path degree 0 to 179 Set the critical internal angle of a corner in 1-degree steps to cause an exact stop in the automatic exact stop check. If 0 is set, the automatic exact stop check is disabled.

1497

The amount of Minute block movement of automatic exact stop check

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (Refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) Set the amount of Minute block movement of automatic exact stop check. If the amounts of movements along the two axes of the currently selected plane in a specified block are both smaller than the setting of this parameter, the automatic exact stop check for that block is disabled.

- 74 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

4.15
1601

PARAMETERS OF ACCELERATION/DECELERATION CONTROL


#7 #6 #5 NCI #4 RTO #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #4 RTO Block overlap in rapid traverse 0: Blocks are not overlapped in rapid traverse. 1: Blocks are overlapped in rapid traverse. NCI An in-position check: 0: Confirms that the specified feedrate becomes 0 (the acceleration/deceleration delay becomes 0) at deceleration time and that the machine position has reached a specified position (the servo positional deviation is within the in-position width set by parameter No. 1826). 1: Confirms only that the specified feedrate becomes 0 (the acceleration/deceleration delay becomes 0) at deceleration time.
#7 1602 #6 LS2 #5 #4 #3 BS2 #2 #1 #0

#5

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #3 BS2 Acceleration/deceleration in a mode of acceleration/deceleration before look-ahead interpolation such as the AI contour control mode: 0: Exponential acceleration/deceleration or linear acceleration/ deceleration is used. (The setting of bit 6 (LS2) of parameter No. 1602 is followed.) 1: Bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration is used. LS2 Acceleration/deceleration in a mode of acceleration/deceleration before interpolation such as the AI contour control mode: 0: Exponential acceleration/deceleration is used. 1: Linear acceleration/deceleration is used.
#7 1603 #6 #5 #4 PRT #3 #2 #1 #0

#6

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #4 PRT For positioning of linear interpolation type: 0: Acceleration/deceleration of acceleration fixed type is used. 1: Acceleration/deceleration of time fixed type is used.
#7 1604 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 SHP

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path


- 75 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#0

B-63950EN/04

SHP When automatic operation is started, the state equivalent to the specification of G5.1Q1 for AI contour control is: 0: Not set 1: Set Upon reset, the state where G5.1Q1 is specified is set.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 EST #1 #0

1605

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#2 EST Axis immediate stop function is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
#7 1606 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 MNJx

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 MNJx In manual handle interrupt or automatic manual simultaneous operation (interrupt type): 0: Only cutting feed acceleration/deceleration is enabled, and jog feed acceleration/deceleration is disabled. 1: Both cutting feed acceleration/deceleration and jog feed acceleration/deceleration are applied.
#7 1610 #6 #5 THLx #4 JGLx #3 #2 #1 CTBx #0 CTLx

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 CTLx Acceleration/deceleration in cutting feed or dry run during cutting feed 0: Exponential acceleration/deceleration is applied. 1: Linear acceleration/deceleration after interpolation is applied. CTBx Acceleration/deceleration in cutting feed or dry run during cutting feed 0: Exponential acceleration/deceleration or linear acceleration/ deceleration is applied. (depending on the setting in bit 0 (CTLx) of parameter No. 1610) 1: Bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration is applied. JGLx Acceleration/deceleration in jog feed 0: Exponential acceleration/deceleration is applied. 1: The same acceleration/deceleration as for cutting feedrate is applied. (Depending on the settings of bits 1 (CTBx) and 0 (CTLx) of parameter No. 1610)

#1

#4

- 76 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

#5

THLx Acceleration/deceleration in threading cycles 0: Exponential acceleration/deceleration is applied. 1: The same acceleration/deceleration as for cutting feedrate is applied. (Depending on the settings of bits 1 (CTBx) and 0 (CTLx) of parameter No. 1610) As the time constant and FL rate, however, the settings of parameters Nos. 1626 and 1627 for threading cycles are used.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 TCO #2 AOFF #1 THA #0 CFR

1611

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 CFR For retraction after threading in the threading cycles G92 (T series), G76 (T series), and G76.7 (M series): 0: The type of acceleration/deceleration after interpolation for threading is used together with the threading time constant (parameter No. 1626) and FL rate (parameter No. 1627). 1: The type of acceleration/deceleration after interpolation for rapid traverse is used together with the rapid traverse time constant.

NOTE If this parameter is set to 1, a check is made before a retraction to see that the specified feedrate has become 0 (the delay in acceleration/deceleration has become 0). For retraction, the rapid traverse rate (parameter No. 1420) is used, regardless of the setting of parameter No. 1466. When this parameter is set to 0, parameter No. 1466 is used as the feedrate for retraction. As acceleration/deceleration used for retraction, only acceleration/deceleration after interpolation is used. Rapid traverse before look-ahead interpolation and optimum torque acceleration/deceleration are disabled.
#1 THA When a threading command is specified in AI contour control mode: 0: An alarm is issued. 1: AI contour control mode is temporarily canceled and the command is executed.

NOTE If acceleration/deceleration before interpolation is enabled by the command following or followed by a threading command with this parameter set to 1, the tool is decelerated to a stop at the joint of the relevant block.
#2 AOFF When AI contour control mode is off and the parameter of the advanced-preview feed forward function is valid, the advanced-preview feed forward function is: 0: Enabled. 1: Disabled.

NOTE This parameter is valid when bit 0 (SHP) of parameter No. 1604 is 0 with none of G05.1Q1, G05P10000, and G08P1 specified.
- 77 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#3

B-63950EN/04

TCO Blocks in a threading cycle are: 0: Not overlapped in rapid traverse. 1: Overlapped in rapid traverse. In a threading cycle that is a turning canned cycle, the rapid traverse overlap function can perform rapid traverse overlap between a retract operation and return operation and between a return operation and a positioning operation for the next threading cycle. The rapid traverse deceleration ratio in an overlap between blocks is set in parameter No. 1726.

NOTE When this function is used, threading cycle retraction is disabled.


#7 1612 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 AIR #0 PRO

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 PRO The feedrate reduction ratio for rapid traverse overlap is specified by : 0: The parameter No. 1722 1: The system variables #100851[#_ROVLP[1]]-#100874[#_ROVLP[24]] This function is available in following conditions. Rapid traverse block overlap disable signal ROVLP<Gn053.5>=0 and bit 4 (RTO) of parameter No. 1601=1(Blocks are overlapped in rapid traverse). #1 AIR The status display and mode signal in AI contour control mode is: 0: Enabled only when the conditions for executing AI contour control are satisfied. 1: Enabled always in AI contour control mode. If this parameter is set to 1, in-mode blinking display and the AI contour control mode signal AICC <Fn062.0> remain enabled in the AI contour control mode.

NOTE The parameter is invalid during a stop on feed hold or a single-block stop.
1620 Time constant T or T1 used for linear acceleration/deceleration or bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration in rapid traverse for each axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis msec 0 to 4000 Specify a time constant used for acceleration/deceleration in rapid traverse.

- 78 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
[Example] For linear acceleration/deceleration
Speed Rapid traverse rate (Parameter No. 1420)

Time

T : Setting of parameter No. 1620 For bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration


Speed Rapid traverse rate (Parameter No. 1420)

T2 T1

T2

T2 T1

T2

Time

T1 : Setting of parameter No. 1620 T2 : Setting of parameter No. 1621 (However, T1 T2 must be satisfied.) Total acceleration (deceleration) time : T1 + T2 Time for linear portion : T1T2 Time for curve portion : T2 2
1621 Time constant T2 used for bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration in rapid traverse for each axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis msec 0 to 1000 Specify time constant T2 used for bell-shaped acceleration/ deceleration in rapid traverse for each axis.
Time constant of acceleration/deceleration in cutting feed for each axis

1622

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis msec 0 to 4000

- 79 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

Set the time constant used for exponential acceleration/deceleration in cutting feed, bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration after interpolation or linear acceleration/deceleration after interpolation in cutting feed for each axis. Which type to use is selected with bits 1 (CTBx) and 0 (CTLx) of parameter No. 1610. Except for special applications, the same time constant must be set for all axes in this parameter. If the time constants set for the axes differ from each other, proper straight lines and arcs cannot be obtained.
1623 FL rate of exponential acceleration/deceleration in cutting feed for each axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) Set the lower limit (FL rate) of exponential acceleration/deceleration in cutting feed for each axis.
Time constant of acceleration/deceleration in jog feed for each axis.

1624

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis msec 0 to 4000 Set the time constant used for acceleration/deceleration in jog feed for each axis.
FL rate of exponential acceleration/deceleration in jog feed for each axis

1625

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) Set the FL rate of exponential acceleration/deceleration in jog feed for each axis. This parameter allows only the exponential type.
Acceleration/deceleration time constant in threading cycles for each axis

1626

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis msec 0 to 4000 Set a time constant for acceleration/deceleration after interpolation in the threading cycles G92 (T series), G76 (T series), and G76.7 (M series) for each axis.
FL rate for acceleration/deceleration in threading cycles for each axis

1627

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0)
- 80 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Set an FL rate for acceleration/deceleration after interpolation in the threading cycles G92 (T series), G76 (T series), and G76.7 (M series) for each axis. Set 0 at all times except in a special case.

1650

Timer for the acceleration/deceleration signal

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word path msec 0 to 32767 Set the output duration of the acceleration/deceleration signal.
Maximum allowable acceleration rate in acceleration/deceleration before interpolation for each axis

1660

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/sec2, inch/sec2, degree/sec2 (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (D) (When the machine system is metric system, 0.0 to +100000.0. When the machine system is inch system, machine, 0.0 to +10000.0.) Set a maximum allowable acceleration rate in acceleration/ deceleration before interpolation for each axis. If a value greater than 100000.0 is set, the value is clamped to 100000.0. If 0 is set, the specification of 100000.0 is assumed. If 0 is set for all axes, however, acceleration/deceleration before interpolation is not performed. If a maximum allowable acceleration rate set for one axis is greater than a maximum allowable acceleration rate set for another axis by a factor or 2 or more, the feedrate at a corner where the direction of travel abruptly changes can decrease temporarily.

1671

Maximum allowable acceleration rate in acceleration/deceleration before interpolation for linear rapid traverse for each axis, or maximum allowable reference acceleration rate in optimum torque acceleration/deceleration

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/sec2, inch/sec2, degree/sec2 (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (D) (When the machine system is metric system, 0.0 to +100000.0. When the machine system is inch system, machine, 0.0 to +10000.0.) (1) Set a maximum allowable acceleration rate in acceleration/ deceleration before interpolation for linear rapid traverse. If a value greater than 100000.0, the value is clamped to 100000.0. If 0 is set, the specification of the following is assumed: 1000.0 mm/sec2 100.0 inch/sec2 100.0 degrees/sec2 If 0 is specified for all axes, however, acceleration/deceleration before interpolation is not performed. (2) Maximum allowable reference acceleration rate in optimum torque acceleration/deceleration
- 81 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
1672

B-63950EN/04

Acceleration change time of bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration before interpolation for linear rapid traverse, or acceleration change time of bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration in optimum torque acceleration/deceleration

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word path msec 0 to 200 (1) Set an acceleration change time of bell-shaped acceleration/ deceleration for linear rapid traverse (time for changing from the state of constant feedrate (A) to the state of constant acceleration/deceleration (C) at the acceleration rate calculated from the acceleration rate set in parameter No. 1671: time of (B) in the figure below). (2) Set an acceleration change time of bell-shaped acceleration/ deceleration in optimum torque acceleration/deceleration (time for changing from the state of constant feedrate (A) to the state of acceleration/deceleration (C) at the acceleration rate calculated from optimum torque acceleration/deceleration: time of (B) in the figure).
F ee d ra te in ta n g e nt d ire ctio n

M axim u m a c ce le ra tio n ra te n ot e xc e ed in g m a xim u m a llow a b le a c ce le ra tion rate s e t b y p a ra m e te r N o . 1 6 7 1 fo r e a ch a xis is a u to m atic a lly c a lc ula te d .

(A )

(B )

(C )

(B )

(A )

(B )

(C )

(B )

(A )

T im e se t b y p a ra m e te r N o . 1 6 7 2

1673

Maximum allowable acceleration rate in tangent direction at axis immediate stop

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm/sec/sec, inch/sec/sec, degree/sec/sec (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (D) (When the machine system is metric system, 0.0 to +100000.0. When the machine system is inch system, machine, 0.0 to +10000.0.) This parameter sets the maximum allowable acceleration rate in the tangent direction for acceleration/deceleration before interpolation at a feed axis immediate stop. If the parameter is set to a value equal to or greater than 100000.0, the value is clamped to 100000.0. If a value lower than the acceleration of acceleration/deceleration before interpolation is set, the tool stops by using the current setting without making the following changes: Change to the acceleration of acceleration/deceleration before interpolation. Change to the acceleration/deceleration type from bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration before interpolation to linear acceleration/deceleration before interpolation.
Minimum deceleration ratio (MDR) for inner circular cutting feedrate change by automatic corner override

1710

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Byte path % 0 to 100


- 82 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Set a minimum deceleration ratio (MDR) for an inner circular cutting feedrate change by automatic corner override. In the case of circular cutting offset inward, the actual feedrate is determined by a specified feedrate (F) as follows:

Rc Rp

Rc: Radius of tool center path Rp: Programmed radius

Thus, the feedrate along the programmed path satisfies the specified value of F.

Programmed path

Rc
Tool center path

Rp

However, if Rc is too small when compared with Rp, Rc/Rp 0 results to stop the tool. So, a minimum deceleration ratio (MDR) is set, and the feedrate of the tool is set to F(MDR) when Rc/Rp MDR. When this parameter is 0, the minimum deceleration ratio (MDR) is 100%.
1711 Inner determination angle (p) for inner corner override

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path deg Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 2 to 178 Set an inner determination angle for inner corner override in automatic corner overriding.
Override value for inner corner override

1712

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Byte path % 1 to 100 Set an inner corner override value in automatic corner overriding.
Start distance (Le) for inner corner override

1713

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Set a start distance for inner corner override in automatic corner overriding.

- 83 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
1714 End distance (Ls) for inner corner override

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Set an end distance for inner corner override in automatic corner overriding. When p, an inner corner is assumed. (Parameter No. 1711 is used to set p.) When a corner is determined to be an inner corner, an override is applied to the feedrate in the range of Le in the previous block from the intersection of the corner and in the range of Ls in the next block from the intersection of the corner. Distances Le and Ls represent linear distances from the intersection of a corner to points on the tool center path. Le and Ls are set in parameters Nos. 1713 and 1714.
Programmed path

Tool center path

An override is applied to the range from point a to point b.

1722

Rapid traverse feedrate reduction ratio for overlapping rapid traverse blocks

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Byte axis % 0 to 100 This parameter is used when rapid traverse blocks are arranged successively, or when a rapid traverse block is followed by a block that does not cause, movement. When the feedrate for each axis of a block is reduced to the ratio set in this parameter, the execution of the next block is started.

NOTE The parameter No. 1722 is effective when bit 4 (RTO) of parameter No. 1601 is set to 1.
1726 Rapid traverse rate reduction ratio for overlapping threading cycle blocks

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Byte axis % 0 to 100 In a threading cycle that is a turning canned cycle, when the feedrate for each axis is reduced to the deceleration ratio set in this parameter between a retraction and a return to the cycle start point or between a return to the cycle start point and a movement to the threading start point, the execution of the next block is started.
- 84 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE The parameter No. 1726 is valid when bit 3 (TCO) of parameter No. 1611 is set to 1.

1732

Minimum allowable feedrate for the deceleration function based on acceleration in circular interpolation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) With the deceleration function based on acceleration in circular interpolation, an optimum feedrate is automatically calculated so that acceleration produced by changing the move direction in circular interpolation does not exceed the maximum allowable acceleration rate specified in parameter No. 1735. If the radius of an arc is very small, a calculated feedrate may become too low. In such a case, the feedrate is prevented from decreasing below the value specified in this parameter.

NOTE During involute interpolation, the minimum allowable feedrate of "clamping of acceleration near a basic circle" in involute interpolation automatic feedrate control is used.
1735 Maximum allowable acceleration rate for the deceleration function based on acceleration in circular interpolation for each axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/sec2, inch/sec2, degree/sec2 (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (D) (When the machine system is metric system, 0.0 to +100000.0. When the machine system is inch system, machine, 0.0 to +10000.0.) Set a maximum allowable acceleration rate for the deceleration function based on acceleration in circular interpolation. Feedrate is controlled so that acceleration produced by changing the move direction in circular interpolation does not exceed the value specified in this parameter. For an axis with 0 set in this parameter, the deceleration function based on acceleration is disabled. If a different value is set in this parameter for each axis, a feedrate is determined from the smaller of the acceleration rates specified for the two circular axes.

NOTE During involute interpolation, the minimum allowable feedrate of "clamping of acceleration near a basic circle" in involute interpolation automatic feedrate control is used.
1737 Maximum allowable acceleration rate for the deceleration function based on acceleration in AI contour control for each axis

[Input type] Parameter input


- 85 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
[Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

B-63950EN/04

Real axis mm/sec2, inch/sec2, degree/sec2 (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (D) (When the machine system is metric system, 0.0 to +100000.0. When the machine system is inch system, machine, 0.0 to +10000.0.) Set a maximum allowable acceleration rate produced by changing the tool move direction. For an axis with 0 set in this parameter, the deceleration function based on acceleration is disabled. If 0 is set for all axes, the deceleration function based on acceleration is not performed. In circular interpolation, however, the deceleration function based on feedrate control using acceleration in circular interpolation (parameter No. 1735) is enabled.
Minimum allowable feedrate for the deceleration function based on acceleration in AI contour control

1738

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) With the deceleration function based on acceleration in AI contour control, a feedrate most suitable for a desired figure is automatically calculated. Depending on the figure, however, the calculated feedrate may become too low. In such a case, the feedrate is prevented from decreasing below the value specified in this parameter. If overriding using the deceleration function based on cutting load is enabled, a feedrate lower than the minimum allowable feedrate may be used.
FL rate for acceleration/deceleration after cutting feed interpolation for each axis in the acceleration/deceleration before interpolation mode

1763

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) Set a minimum allowable feedrate (FL rate) for acceleration/ deceleration after cutting feed interpolation in acceleration/deceleration before interpolation as in AI contour control.
Time constant for acceleration/deceleration after cutting feed interpolation in the acceleration/deceleration before interpolation mode

1769

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis msec 0 to 4000 In the acceleration/deceleration before interpolation mode as in AI contour control, not the ordinary time constant (parameter No. 1622) but the value of this parameter is used. Be sure to specify the same time constant value for all axes except for a special application. If different values are set, correct linear and circular figures cannot be obtained.
- 86 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Acceleration change time of bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration before interpolation

1772

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word path msec 0 to 200 Set an acceleration change time of bell-shaped acceleration/ deceleration before interpolation (time for changing from the state of constant feedrate (A) to the state of constant acceleration/deceleration (C) at the acceleration rate calculated from the acceleration rate set in parameter No. 1660: time of (B) in the figure).
Feedrate in tangent direction

Optimum inclination is automatically calculated from the setting of parameter No. 1660.

(A)

(B)

(C)

(B)

(A)

(B)

(C)

(B)

(A)

Time set by parameter No. 1772

1783

Maximum allowable feedrate difference for feedrate determination based on corner feedrate difference

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) If a feedrate component change for each axis exceeding the value set in this parameter occurs at the joint of blocks, the feedrate determination function based on corner feedrate difference finds a feedrate not exceeding the set value and performs deceleration by using acceleration/deceleration before interpolation. Thus, a shock to the machine and machining error at a corner can be reduced.
Maximum allowable acceleration change rate in feedrate determination based on acceleration change for each axis

1788

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/sec2, inch/sec2, degree/sec2 (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (D) (When the machine system is metric system, 0.0 to +100000.0. When the machine system is inch system, machine, 0.0 to +10000.0.) Set a maximum allowable acceleration change rate for each axis in feedrate control based on acceleration change under control on the rate of change of acceleration.
- 87 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

For an axis with 0 set in this parameter, feedrate control based on acceleration change is disabled. If 0 is set for all axes, feedrate control based on acceleration change is not exercised.
1789 Maximum allowable acceleration change rate in feedrate determination based on acceleration change for each axis (linear interpolation)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/sec2, inch/sec2, degree/sec2 (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (D) (When the machine system is metric system, 0.0 to +100000.0. When the machine system is inch system, machine, 0.0 to +10000.0.) Set a maximum allowable acceleration change rate for each axis in feedrate control based on acceleration change under control on the rate of change of acceleration in successive linear interpolation operations. In feedrate control based on acceleration change at a corner between linear interpolation operations, the maximum allowable acceleration change rate not set in parameter No. 1788 but set in this parameter is valid. For an axis with 0 set in this parameter, the maximum allowable acceleration change rate set in parameter No. 1788 is valid. Feedrate control based on acceleration change is disabled for an axis with 0 set in parameter No. 1788, so that the setting of this parameter for such an axis is ignored.
Ratio of change time of the rate of change of acceleration in smooth bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration before interpolation

1790

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Byte path % 0 to 50 Set the ratio of the change time of the rate of change of acceleration to the change time of acceleration(*1) by percentage (%) in smooth bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration before look-ahead interpolation. If 0 is set in this parameter or a value not within the valid data range is specified in this parameter, smooth bell-shaped acceleration/ deceleration before look-ahead interpolation is not performed. (*1) Parameter No. 1772 for acceleration/deceleration before look-ahead interpolation (cutting feed). Parameter No. 1672 for acceleration/deceleration before interpolation in linear rapid traverse, or for optimum torque acceleration/ deceleration.

1791

Acceleration rate on each axis for the outage-time deceleration stop function

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/sec2, inch/sec2, degree/sec2 (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (D) (0.0 to +100000.0 for the metric system, 0.0 to +10000.0 for the inch system) Set an acceleration rate for deceleration on an axis on which the tool is decelerated to a stop at the time of power outage.
- 88 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
On an axis for which this parameter is set to 0, deceleration based on the outage-time deceleration signal is not performed. In synchronization control or tandem control, set the same parameter for the master axis and slave axis.

- 89 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

4.16
1800

PARAMETERS OF SERVO (1 OF 2)
#7 #6 #5 #4 RBK #3 FFR #2 #1 CVR #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #1 CVR When velocity control ready signal VRDY is set ON before position control ready signal PRDY comes ON 0: A servo alarm is generated. 1: A servo alarm is not generated. FFR Feed-forward control in rapid traverse is: 0: Disabled 1: Enabled Feed-forward is enabled only in normal cutting feed. When this parameter is set to 1, feed-forward is enabled in rapid traverse as well. This capability reduces the servo positional deviation, thus reducing the time required to enter the in-position width at the time of positioning.

#3

NOTE The parameter setting becomes valid after reference position return is completed.
#4 RBK Backlash compensation applied separately for cutting feed and rapid traverse 0: Not performed 1: Performed
#7 1801 #6 #5 CIN #4 CCI #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #4 CCI As the in-position width for cutting feed: 0: The parameter No. 1826 applicable to rapid traverse as well is used. 1: The parameter No. 1827 dedicated to cutting feed is used. This parameter enables the in-position width for cutting feed (parameter No. 1827) to be set instead of the in-position width for rapid traverse (parameter No. 1826). By setting bit 4 (CCI) of parameter No. 1801, choose whether to use this function or the conventional in-position check function. This function, when specified, is enabled for all axes. So, for an axis that does not require this function, set the same data in parameters Nos. 1826 and 1827. CIN When CCI is set to 1, the dedicated parameter for specifying an in-position width for cutting feed is used: 0: Only when the next block specifies cutting feed. 1: Regardless of the next block. The table indicates the relationships between the parameters for cutting feed and rapid traverse.

#5

- 90 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Bit 5 (CIN) of parameter No. 1801 0 Rapid traverse Rapid traverse Rapid traverse Cutting feed Cutting feed Cutting feed Cutting feed Rapid traverse Rapid traverse Rapid traverse Rapid traverse Cutting feed Cutting feed Cutting feed Cutting feed Rapid traverse No. 1826 No. 1826 No. 1826 No. 1826 No. 1826 No. 1826 No. 1827 No. 1826 1 Rapid traverse Rapid traverse Rapid traverse Cutting feed Cutting feed Cutting feed Cutting feed Rapid traverse Rapid traverse Rapid traverse Rapid traverse Cutting feed Cutting feed Cutting feed Cutting feed Rapid traverse No. 1826 No. 1826 No. 1826 No. 1826 No. 1826 No. 1826 No. 1827 No. 1827

Bit 4 (CCI) of parameter No. 1801

The parameters CCI and CIN can also be applied to a Cs axis.


#7 1802 #6 #5 #4 BKL15 #3 #2 DC2x #1 DC4x #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #1 DC4x When the reference position is established on the linear scale with reference marks: 0: An absolute position is established by detecting three reference marks. 1: An absolute position is established by detecting four reference marks. DC2x Reference position establishment operation for a linear scale with reference marks is performed as follows: 0: The setting of bit 1 (DC4) of parameter No. 1802 is followed. 1: An absolute position is established by detecting two reference marks.

#2

NOTE 1 When this parameter is set to 1, specify the direction of the scale zero point by setting bit 4 (SCP) of parameter No. 1817. 2 When a rotary encoder with absolute address reference marks is used, this parameter is invalid. Even when this parameter is set to 1, the setting of bit 1 (DC4) of parameter No. 1802 is followed.
#4 BKL15 When the direction of a movement is determined in backlash compensation: 0: The compensation amount is not considered. 1: The compensation amount (pitch error, straightness, external machine coordinate system shift, etc.) is considered.
#7 1803 NFP #6 #5 #4 TQF #3 #2 #1 TQA #0 TQI

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 TQI Within a torque limit, an in-position check is: 0: Made. 1: Not made.
- 91 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#1 TQA Within a torque limit, an excessive stop-time/move-time error is: 0: Checked. 1: Not checked.

B-63950EN/04

#4

TQF When torque control is performed by the PMC axis control, follow-up operation is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed. NFP If position matching between the machine position and absolute position detector is not performed even once, follow-up operation is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed.
#7 #6 SAK #5 ANA #4 IVO #3 #2 #1 #0

#7

1804

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #4 IVO When an attempt is made to release an emergency stop while the VRDY OFF alarm ignore signal is 1: 0: The emergency stop state is not released until the VRDY OFF alarm ignore signal is set to 0. 1: The emergency stop state is released.

NOTE When a reset is issued while the VRDY OFF alarm ignore signal is set to 1 and the motor activating current is low, the reset state can also be released, provided this parameter is set to 1.
#5 ANA When an unexpected disturbance torque is detected for an axis: 0: Movement along all axes is stopped, and a servo alarm is output. 1: No servo alarm is output, and movement along only the axes of the group containing the axis with the an unexpected disturbance torque is stopped in interlock mode. (The group number of each axis is set in parameter No. 1881.) SAK When the VRDY OFF alarm ignore signal IGNVRY is 1, or when the VRDY OFF alarm ignore signals IGNVRYn are 1: 0: Servo ready signal SA is set to 0. 1: Servo ready signal SA remains set to 1.
#7 1805 #6 #5 #4 TSM #3 TSA #2 #1 TRE #0

#6

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

- 92 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
TRE When bit 4 (TQF) of parameter No. 1803 is set to 0 (not to perform follow-up operation with a torque control command in PMC axis control), the servo error counter is: 0: Updated. When the error count exceeds the maximum allowable cumulative travel value (parameter No. 1885), the alarm SV0423 is issued. 1: Not updated. No errors are accumulated, so that the alarm SV0423 is not issued. When the maximum allowable feedrate is exceeded, however, the alarm SV0422 is issued. To return to position control when this parameter bit is set to 1, a reference position return operation needs to be performed. TSA As the unexpected disturbance torque detection level during dwell, M code execution, and automatic operation halt state: 0: The threshold value for rapid traverse is used. (parameter No. 2142) 1: The threshold value for cutting feed is used. (parameter No. 2104) This parameter is valid when bit 3 (ABG0) of parameter No. 2200 is set to 1. TSM As the unexpected disturbance torque detection level in the jog feed mode (excluding manual rapid traverse) and manual handle feed mode: 0: The threshold value for rapid traverse is used. (parameter No. 2142) 1: The threshold value for cutting feed is used. (parameter No. 2104) This parameter is valid when bit 3 (ABG0) of parameter No. 2200 is set to 1.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 SWP #1 #0

#1

#3

#4

1807

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #2 SWP This parameter specifies the operation of the i series servo amplifier in its warning state (for example, with the fan stopped). 0: An alarm is issued when the amplifier is placed in the warning state. Automatic operation enters the feed hold state and the servo axis is decelerated to a stop. 1: An alarm is not issued even when the amplifier is placed in the warning state. Automatic operation is kept. The servo is deactivated if the amplifier shifts from the warning state to the alarm state. (Series and edition of applicable software) Servo software Series 90D0/M(13) and subsequent editions Series 90E0/M(13) and subsequent editions

- 93 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

CAUTION If operation is continued with the external fan stopped while bit 2 (SWP) of parameter No. 1807 is set to 1, the servo amplifier may be overheated and "overheat alarm", "IPM alarm", or "VRDY off alarm" may be issued depending on the operating conditions. If such an alarm is issued, the amplifier is deactivated and the servo motor is stopped by the dynamic brake, involving a risk of breaking the workpiece or tool as the stop from high-speed rotation requires an extended distance. The user should therefore understand that the operation with bit 2 (SWP) of parameter No. 1807 set to 1 is a temporary step to take before fan replacement. Once the fan has stopped, be sure to replace the fan immediately and set bit 2 (SWP) of parameter No. 1807 back to 0. If bit 2 (SWP) of parameter No. 1807 is set to 1, the warning text "FAN" blinks on the NC screen to show that the external fan has been stopped. Also on the machine side, monitor the warning signal output to the PMC and remind the operator of the operation with the fan stopped.
#7 1814 ALGx #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #7 ALGx The servo axis loop gain in the Cs contour control mode is: 0: Not matched with the Cs contour control loop gain. 1: Matched with the Cs contour control loop gain.
#7 1815 #6 RONx #5 APCx #4 APZx #3 DCRx #2 DCLx #1 OPTx #0 RVSx

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 RVSx When rotary axis B type using a scale that does not have speed data is used, if the movable range is more than one rotation: 0: The CNC does not maintain speed data. 1: The CNC maintains speed data.

NOTE 1 In the case of a rotary axis B type whose movable range is over one rotation, a rotary scale with rotary data had better be used. 2 This parameter is available for only the rotary axis B type with an absolute position detector (absolute Pulsecoder) or a rotary scale with distance-coded reference marks (serial).This function cannot be used for distance coded rotary scale interface (phase A/B).
- 94 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE 3 If this parameter is available, the machine coordinate value just before CNC turns off is saved. In the case of moving over 180 degree during turning off, a machine coordinate value may get out over a rotation because CNC saves a machine coordinate value just before CNC turns off and in following turning on get from the value. 4 If this parameter is changed, the correspondence between the machine position and the absolute position detector is lost. Bit 4 (APZ) of parameter No. 1815 is set to 0, and an alarm DS0300, APC ALARM: NEED REF RETURN is issued. The cause that sets bit 4 (APZ) of parameter No. 1815 to 0 is indicated in diagnosis No. 310#0. 5 Absolute coordinate value is set by machine coordinate value. However, after CNC turns on, the workpiece offset such as G92 and G52 executed before CNC turns off is not set. 6 This function cannot be used together with the bit 3 (SCRx) of parameter No. 1817 that convert scale data. 7 In the case that the amount of one rotation of rotary axis is 360, the parameter No. 1869 is set to 0. Moreover, set the parameter No. 1240 to 0. 8 If it is necessary to set an amount of one rotation of rotary axis arbitrarily, the parameter No. 1869 is set to the amount of one rotation. Moreover, set the parameter No. 1240 to 0.

#1

OPTx Position detector 0: A separate Pulsecoder is not used. 1: A separate Pulsecoder is used.

NOTE Set this parameter to 1 when using a linear scale with reference marks or a linear scale with an absolute address zero point (full-closed system).
#2 DCLx As a separate position detector, a linear scale with reference marks or a linear scale with an absolute address zero point is: 0: Not used. 1: Used. DCRx As a scale with absolute address reference marks: 0: A rotary encoder with absolute address reference marks is not used. 1: A rotary encoder with absolute address reference marks is used.

#3

NOTE When using a rotary encoder with absolute address reference marks, set also bit 2 (DCLx) of parameter No. 1815 to 1.
#4 APZx Machine position and position on absolute position detector when the absolute position detector is used 0: Not corresponding 1: Corresponding
- 95 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

When an absolute position detector is used, after primary adjustment is performed or after the absolute position detector is replaced, this parameter must be set to 0, power must be turned off and on, then manual reference position return must be performed. This completes the positional correspondence between the machine position and the position on the absolute position detector, and sets this parameter to 1 automatically. #5 APCx Position detector 0: Other than absolute position detector 1: Absolute position detector (absolute Pulsecoder) RONx With a rotary axis A type, an absolute position detector (absolute Pulsecoder) using a scale without rotary data is: 0: Not used. 1: Used.

#6

NOTE 1 This parameter is available for only the rotary axis A type with an absolute position detector (absolute Pulsecoder). This function cannot be used for a rotary scale with distance-coded reference marks (serial) or for a distance coded rotary scale interface (phase A/B). 2 Set it to a rotary axis A type using a scale without rotary data. 3 Do not set it to a rotary axis A type using a scale with rotary data. 4 When this parameter is set, machine position and position on absolute position detector become uncorresponding. Consequently, the bit 4 (APZ) of parameter No. 1815 (indicating that the correspondence is established) is set to 0, alarm DS0300. Why the bit 4 (APZ) of parameter No. 1815 is set to 0 can be checked using diagnostic data No. 310#0.
#7 1816 #6 DM3x #5 DM2x #4 DM1x #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#4 #5 #6 DM1x DM2x DM3x By using DM1x, DM2x, and DM3x, a detection multiplication factor (DMR) is set. This parameter is valid when a separate position detector (AB phase) is used and parameter No. 2084 and No. 2085 are not set.
DM3x 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 DM2x 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 DM1x 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 DMR 1/2 1 3/2 2 5/2 3 7/2 4

- 96 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 #6 TANx #5 #4 SCPx #3 SCRx #2 SBLx #1 #0

1817

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#2 SBLx Smooth backlash compensation is : 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. SCRx Specifies whether to convert scale data by using threshold position (parameter No. 1868) so that rotary axis B type is available, in the case of the axis B type that use a rotary scale without data (the number of rotation), whose movable range is under one rotation: 0 : Not to convert. 1 : To convert.

#3

NOTE 1 This parameter is available for only the rotary axis B type with an absolute position detector (absolute Pulsecoder) or a rotary scale with distance-coded reference marks (serial). This function cannot be used for distance coded rotary scale interface (phase A/B). 2 Don't set this parameter in the case of no uncontinuous point within movable range of rotary axis even if the rotary axis B type. 3 When this parameter is set, machine position and position on absolute position detector become uncorresponding. Consequently, the bit 4 (APZ) of parameter No. 1815 (indicating that the correspondence is established) is set to 0, alarm DS0300. Why the bit 4 (APZ) of parameter No. 1815 is set to 0 can be checked using diagnostic data No. 310#0. 4 This function cannot be used together with the bit 0 (RVSx) of parameter No. 1815 that save rotary data by CNC, in the case of a rotary axis B type whose movable range is over one rotation. 5 In this function, the amount of one rotation of rotary axis assumes 360, and the machine position 0 assumes the reference position. It is not possible to apply to a rotary axis other than the above-mentioned setting. 6 Set the parameter No. 1240 to 0.
#4 SCPx For two-point measurement (when bit 2 (DC2) of parameter No. 1802 is set to 1), the scale zero point direction is: 0: On the minus side. (The reference position is located in the plus direction when viewed from the scale zero point.) 1: On the plus side. (The reference position is located in the minus direction when viewed from the scale zero point.)

- 97 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE 1 This parameter is valid when bit 2 (DC2) of parameter No. 1802 is set to 1. 2 If this parameter is set to an incorrect value, an incorrect coordinate system is established. In such a case, reverse the setting then perform reference position establishment operation again.
When parameter SCP = 0
Mark 1 = mark 2 Mark 1 Mark 2 Mark 1 Mark 1 Mark 2 Mark 1 Mark 2 Mark 1 Mark 2 Mark 1

0.020

0.040

9.940

9.960

9.980

Scale zero point

Machine coordinate system

Reference position

When parameter SCP = 1


Mark 1 = Mark 2 Mark 1 Mark 2 Mark 1 Mark 1 Mark 2 Mark 1 Mark 2 Mark 1 Mark 2 Mark 1

0.020

0.040

9.940

9.960

9.980

Scale zero point

Machine coordinate system Reference position

#6

TANx Tandem control 0: Not used 1: Used

NOTE Set this parameter to both master axis and slave axis.
#7 1818 #6 #5 #4 #3 SDC #2 DG0 #1 RF2x #0 RFSx

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 RFSx If G28 is specified for an axis for which a reference position is not established (ZRF <Fn120>= 0) when a linear scale with an absolute address zero point or a linear scale with absolute address reference marks is used: 0: A movement is made to the reference position after reference position establishment operation. 1: No movement is made after reference position establishment operation, but the operation is completed.

- 98 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE This parameter disables movement based on the G28 command to a reference position. So, use this parameter only in special cases.

#1

RF2x If G28 is specified for an axis for which a reference position is already established (ZRF<Fn120> = 1) when a linear scale with an absolute address zero point or a linear scale with absolute address reference marks is used: 0: A movement is made to the reference position. 1: No movement is made to the intermediate position and reference position, but the operation is completed.

NOTE This parameter disables movement based on the G28 command to a reference position. So, use this parameter only in special cases.
#2 DG0 When the linear scale function with absolute address reference marks is used, reference position establishment operation based on the G00 command and jog feed is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. SDCx A linear scale with an absolute address zero point is: 0: Not used. 1: Used.
#7 1819 NAHx #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 DATx #1 CRFx #0 FUPx

#3

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 FUPx To perform follow-up when the servo is off is set for each axis. 0: The follow-up signal, *FLWU, determines whether follow-up is performed or not. When *FLWU<Gn007.5> is 0, follow-up is performed. When *FLWU<Gn007.5> is 1, follow-up is not performed. 1: Follow-up is not performed.

NOTE When using the index table indexing function, set FUPx to 1 for a control axis subject to index table indexing.
#1 CRFx When the servo alarm SV0445, SOFT DISCONNECT ALARM, SV0447, HARD DISCONNECT(EXT), or SV0421, EXCESS ERROR(SEMI-FULL) is issued: 0: The reference position established state is not affected. 1: The reference position unestablished state is assumed. (Bit 4 (APZ) of parameter No. 1815 is set to 0.) DATx When a linear scale with an absolute address zero point or a linear scale with absolute address reference marks is used, the automatic setting of parameters Nos. 1883 and 1884 at manual reference position return time is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed.

#2

- 99 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

The automatic setting procedure is as follows: <1> Set an appropriate value in parameters Nos. 1815, 1821, and 1882. <2> Position the machine at the reference position by manual operation. <3> Set this parameter to 1. <4> Perform a manual reference position return operation. Upon completion of manual reference position return operation, parameters Nos. 1883 and 1884 are set, and this parameter is automatically set to 0. #7 NAHx In the advanced preview control mode, advanced preview feed-forward is: 0: Used 1: Not used
Command multiplier for each axis (CMR)

1820

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte axis [Valid data range] See below : Set a command multiplier indicating the ratio of the least command increment to the detection unit for each axis. Least command increment = detection unit command multiplier Relationship between the increment system and the least command increment (1) T series
Least input increment Millimeter machine IS-B Inch machine Rotary axis Millimeter input Inch input Millimeter input Inch input 0.001 mm 0.001 mm 0.0001 inch 0.0001 inch 0.001 mm 0.001 mm 0.0001 inch 0.0001 inch 0.001 deg (diameter specification) (radius specification) (diameter specification) (radius specification) (diameter specification) (radius specification) (diameter specification) (radius specification) Least command increment 0.0005 mm 0.001 mm 0.0005 mm 0.001 mm 0.00005 inch 0.0001 inch 0.00005 inch 0.0001 inch 0.001 deg Least command increment 0.00005 mm 0.0001 mm 0.00005 mm 0.0001 mm 0.000005 inch 0.00001 inch 0.000005 inch 0.00001 inch 0.0001 deg

Least input increment Millimeter machine IS-C Inch machine Rotary axis Millimeter input Inch input Millimeter input Inch input 0.0001 mm 0.0001 mm 0.00001 inch 0.00001 inch 0.0001 mm 0.0001 mm 0.00001 inch 0.00001 inch 0.0001 deg (diameter specification) (radius specification) (diameter specification) (radius specification) (diameter specification) (radius specification) (diameter specification) (radius specification)

- 100 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Least input increment Millimeter machine Millimeter input Inch input Millimeter input Inch input 0.00001 mm 0.00001 mm 0.000001 inch 0.000001 inch 0.00001 mm 0.00001 mm 0.000001 inch 0.000001 inch 0.00001 deg (diameter specification) (radius specification) (diameter specification) (radius specification) (diameter specification) (radius specification) (diameter specification) (radius specification) Least command increment 0.000005 mm 0.00001 mm 0.000005 mm 0.00001 mm 0.0000005 inch 0.000001 inch 0.0000005 inch 0.000001 inch 0.00001 deg Least command increment 0.0000005 mm 0.000001 mm 0.0000005 mm 0.000001 mm 0.00000005 inch 0.0000001 inch 0.00000005 inch 0.0000001 inch 0.000001 deg

IS-D Inch machine Rotary axis

Least input increment Millimeter machine IS-E Inch machine Rotary axis Millimeter input Inch input Millimeter input Inch input 0.000001 mm 0.000001 mm 0.0000001 inch 0.0000001 inch 0.000001 mm 0.000001 mm 0.0000001 inch 0.0000001 inch 0.000001 deg (diameter specification) (radius specification) (diameter specification) (radius specification) (diameter specification) (radius specification) (diameter specification) (radius specification)

(2) M series
Increment system Millimeter machine Millimeter input Rotary axis IS-A 0.01 0.001 0.01 Least input increment and least command increment IS-B IS-C IS-D IS-E 0.001 0.0001 0.001 0.0001 0.00001 0.0001 0.00001 0.000001 0.00001 0.000001 0.0000001 0.000001 Unit mm inch deg

Setting command multiply (CMR), detection multiply (DMR), and the capacity of the reference counter
Command pulse least command increment CMR + Error counter DA Converter To velocity control

Reference counter

Detection unit

DMR

Feedback pulse

Position detector

Set CMR and DMR so that the pulse weight of + input (command from the CNC) into the error counter matches the pulse weight of -input (feedback from the position detector). [Least command increment]/CMR=[Detection unit]= [Feedback pulse unit]/DMR [Least command increment] Minimum unit of commands issued from the CNC to the machine [Detection unit] Minimum unit for machine position detection The unit of feedback pulses varies, depending on the type of detector. [Feedback pulse unit]= [Amount of travel per rotation of the Pulsecoder]/ [Number of pulses per rotation of the Pulsecoder]
- 101 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

As the size of the reference counter, specify the grid interval for the reference position return in the grid method. [Size of the reference counter]=[Grid interval]/[Detection unit] [Grid interval]=[Amount of travel per rotation of the Pulsecoder] The setting of a command multiplier is as follows: (1) When command multiplier is 1 to 1/27 Set value = 1 / command multiplier + 100 Valid data range : 101 to 127 (2) When command multiply is 0.5 to 48 Set value = 2 command multiplier Valid data range : 1 to 96

NOTE If a feedrate exceeding the feedrate found by the expression below is used, an incorrect travel amount may result or a servo alarm may be issued. Be sure to use a feedrate not exceeding the feedrate found by the following expression: Fmax[mm/min] = 196602 104 least command increment / CMR
1821 Reference counter size for each axis

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit 0 to 999999999 Set a reference counter size. As a reference counter size, specify a grid interval for reference position return based on the grid method. When a value less than 0 is set, the specification of 10000 is assumed. When a linear scale with absolute address reference marks is used, set the interval of mark 1.
Value of the numerator of arbitrary command multiplier n/m

1822

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis [Valid data range] 0 to 9999 Set the value of the numerator of the arbitrary command multiplier n/m. The arbitrary command multiplier option is required. When a value other than 0 is set in parameters Nos. 1822 and 1823, the setting of the arbitrary command multiplier n/m (n: No. 1822, m: No. 1823) becomes valid.

- 102 -

B-63950EN/04
1823

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Value of the denominator of arbitrary command multiplier n/m

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis [Valid data range] 0 to 9999 Set the value of the denominator of the arbitrary command multiplier n/m. The arbitrary command multiplier option is required. When a value other than 0 is set in parameters Nos. 1822 and 1823, the setting of the arbitrary command multiplier n/m (n: No. 1822, m: No. 1823) becomes valid.
1825 Servo loop gain for each axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis 0.01/sec 1 to 9999 Set the loop gain for position control for each axis. When the machine performs linear and circular interpolation (cutting), the same value must be set for all axes. When the machine requires positioning only, the values set for the axes may differ from one another. As the loop gain increases, the response by position control is improved. A too large loop gain, however, makes the servo system unstable. The relationship between the positioning deviation (the number of pulses counted by the error counter) and the feedrate is expressed as follows: Positioning deviation = Feedrate / (60 Loop gain) Unit : Positioning deviation mm, inch or deg Feedrate mm/min, inch/min, or deg/min Loop gain 1/sec
In-position width for each axis

1826

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit 0 to 99999999 The in-position width is set for each axis. When the deviation of the machine position from the specified position (the absolute value of the positioning deviation) is smaller than the in-position width, the machine is assumed to have reached the specified position. (The machine is in the in-position state.)
In-position width in cutting feed for each axis

1827

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit 0 to 99999999 Set an in-position width for each axis in cutting feed. This parameter is used when bit 4 (CCI) of parameter No. 1801=1.

- 103 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
1828 Positioning deviation limit for each axis in movement

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit 0 to 99999999 Set the positioning deviation limit in movement for each axis. If the positioning deviation exceeds the positioning deviation limit during movement, a servo alarm SV0411, EXCESS ERROR (MOVING) is generated, and operation is stopped immediately (as in emergency stop). Generally, set the positioning deviation for rapid traverse plus some margin in this parameter.
Positioning deviation limit for each axis in the stopped state

1829

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit 0 to 99999999 Set the positioning deviation limit in the stopped state for each axis. If, in the stopped state, the positioning deviation exceeds the positioning deviation limit set for stopped state, a servo alarm SV0410, EXCESS ERROR (STOP) is generated, and operation is stopped immediately (as in emergency stop).
Axis-by-axis positional deviation limit at servo-off time

1830

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit 0 to 99999999 This parameter is used to set a positional deviation limit at servo-off time, on an axis-by-axis basis. If the value specified with this parameter is exceeded at servo-off time, a servo alarm is issued to cause an immediate stop (same as an emergency stop). Usually, set the same value as a positional deviation at stop time.
Feed stop positioning deviation for each axis

1832

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit 0 to 99999999 Set the feed stop positioning deviation for each axis. If the positioning deviation exceeds the feed stop positioning deviation during movement, pulse distribution and acceleration/ deceleration control are stopped temporarily. When the positioning deviation drops to the feed stop positioning deviation or below, pulse distribution and acceleration/deceleration control are resumed. The feed stop function is used to reduce overshoot in acceleration/ deceleration mainly by large servo motors. Generally, set the middle value between the positioning deviation limit during movement and the positioning deviation at rapid traverse as the feed stop positioning deviation.

- 104 -

B-63950EN/04
1836

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Servo error amount where reference position return is possible

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis Detection unit 0 to 32767 This parameter sets a servo error used to enable reference position return. In general, set this parameter to 0. (When 0 is set, 128 is assumed as the default.) If, during reference position return, such a feedrate as exceeding a set value is not reached even once before the limit switch for deceleration is released (the deceleration signal (*DEC) <G196> for reference position return is set to 1 again), the alarm PS0090, "REFERENCE POSITION RETURN FAILURE" is issued. If, during reference position return, such a feedrate as exceeding a set servo error amount is not reached even once before the limit switch for deceleration is released (the deceleration signal (*DEC) is set to 1 again), the alarm PS0090, "REFERENCE POSITION RETURN FAILURE" is issued.

1838 1842

These parameters are related to Dual Check Safety. See Dual Check Safety CONNECTION MANUAL (B-64003EN) for details.
1844 Distance to the first grid point when the reference position shift amount in the reference position shift function is 0 or when a reference position return is made by grid shift

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit -999999999 to 999999999 (1) When the reference position shift function is enabled (when bit 4 (SFDx) of parameter No. 1008 is set to 1) Set the distance (detection unit) to the first grid point from a point at which the deceleration dog is released when the reference position shift (parameter No. 1850) is set to 0. (2) When a reference position return is made by grid shift with a setting not to use reference position setting without dogs (when bit 4 (SFDx) of parameter No. 1008 is set to 0, and bit 1 (DLZx) of parameter No. 1005 is set to 0) Set the distance to the first grid point from a point at which the deceleration dog is released. (Detection unit) (3) When a reference position return is made by grid shift with a setting to use reference position setting without dogs (when bit 4 (SFDx) of parameter No. 1008 is set to 0, and bit 1 (DLZx) of parameter No. 1005 is set to 1) Set the distance from the start position for reference position setting without dogs to the first grid point. (Detection unit)

- 105 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE 1 When the reference position shift function is enabled (when bit 4 (SFDx) of parameter No. 1008 is set to 1) When bit 4 (SFDx) of parameter No. 1008 is set to 1, the distance from a point at which the deceleration dog is released to the first grid point (parameter No. 1844) is set to 0, and reference position shift (parameter No. 1850) is set to 0, a manual reference position return allows this parameter to be set automatically. Do not change an automatically set value. 2 When a reference position return is made by grid shift with a setting not to use reference position setting without dogs (when bit 4 (SFDx) of parameter No. 1008 is set to 0, and bit 1 (DLZx) of parameter No. 1005 is set to 0) When a manual reference position return using deceleration dogs is made, this parameter is set automatically. 3 When a reference position return is made by grid shift with a setting to use reference position setting without dogs (when bit 4 (SFDx) of parameter No. 1008 is set to 0, and bit 1 (DLZx) of parameter No. 1005 is set to 1) When a reference position setting without dogs is made, this parameter is set automatically.
1846 Distance for starting the second stage of smooth backlash compensation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit 0 to 999999999 For each axis, set the distance from the point where the axis movement direction is reversed to the point where the second stage of smooth backlash compensation is started.
Distance for ending the second stage of smooth backlash compensation

1847

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit 0 to 999999999 For each axis, set the distance from the point where the axis movement direction is reversed to the point where the second stage of smooth backlash compensation is ended.
Value of the first stage of smooth backlash compensation

1848

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis Detection unit -9999 to 9999 Set the value of the first stage of smooth backlash compensation for each axis.

- 106 -

B-63950EN/04
1850

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Grid shift and reference position shift for each axis

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit -99999999 to 99999999 To shift the reference position, the grid can be shifted by the amount set in this parameter. Up to the maximum value counted by the reference counter can be specified as the grid shift. In case of bit 4 (SFDx) of parameter No. 1008 is 0: Grid shift In case of bit 4 (SFDx) of parameter No. 1008 is 1: Reference point shift

NOTE For setting the reference position without dogs, only the grid shift function can be used. (The reference position shift function cannot be used.)
1851 Backlash compensating value for each axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis Detection unit -9999 to 9999 Set the backlash compensating value for each axis. When the machine moves in a direction opposite to the reference position return direction after the power is turned on, the first backlash compensation is performed.
Backlash compensating value used for rapid traverse for each axis

1852

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis Detection unit -9999 to 9999 Set the backlash compensating value used in rapid traverse for each axis. (This parameter is valid when bit 4 (RBK) of parameter No. 1800 is set to 1.) More precise machining can be performed by changing the backlash compensating value depending on the feedrate, the cutting feed or the rapid traverse positioning. Let the measured backlash at cutting feed be A and the measured backlash at rapid traverse be B. The backlash compensating value is shown below depending on the change of feedrate (cutting feed or rapid traverse) and the change of the direction of movement.
Change of feedrate Change of direction of movement Same direction Opposite direction Cutting feed to cutting feed 0 A Rapid traverse to rapid traverse 0 B Rapid traverse to cutting feed (B+) Cutting feed to rapid traverse (-) (B+)

- 107 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE 1 =(A-B)/2 2 The positive or negative direction for compensating values is the direction of movement.
1868 Threshold position for converting scale data (each axis)

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input Real axis degree (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (Refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to ++999999.999) In the case that scale data of a rotary scale without rotary data is larger than the scale data of the threshold position (this parameter value), it is converted to be continuous data in movable range by subtracting data of one rotation. The position out of movable range (angle from an uncontinuous point) must be set as threshold position. As for the axis for which this parameter is set to 0, conversion of scale data is not performed.

NOTE 1 This parameter is available for only the rotary axis B type with an absolute position detector (absolute Pulsecoder) or a rotary scale with distance-coded reference marks (serial), for which the bit 3 (SCRx) of parameter No. 1817 is set to 1.This function cannot be used for distance coded rotary scale interface (phase A/B). 2 Don't set this parameter in the case of no uncontinuous point within movable range of rotary axis even if the rotary axis B type. 3 When this parameter is set, machine position and position on absolute position detector become uncorresponding. Consequently, the bit 4 (APZ) of parameter No. 1815 (indicating that the correspondence is established) is set to 0, alarm DS0300, APC ALARM: NEED REF RETURN. Why the bit 4 (APZ) of parameter No. 1815 is set to 0 can be checked using diagnosis indication (No. 0310#0).
1869 The amount of one rotation of rotary axis B type (each axis)

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] Parameter input Real axis degree (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis
- 108 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Valid data range] 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (Refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to ++999999.999) Normally, the amount of one rotation of rotary axis is 360, and the machine position 0 is the reference position. In this case, this parameter is set to 0. For instance, when this parameter is set to 523.000, the amount of one rotation become 523.000 (in the case of IS-B), if it is necessary to set it arbitrarily.

NOTE 1 This parameter is available for only the rotary axis B type with an absolute position detector (absolute Pulsecoder) or a rotary scale with distance-coded reference marks (serial), as for the bit 3 (SCRx) of parameter No. 1817 is set to 1 or the bit 0 (RVS) of parameter No. 1815 is set to 1. 2 In the case that the amount of one rotation of rotary axis is 360, this parameter is set to 0.If it is necessary to set an amount of one rotation of rotary axis arbitrarily, this parameter is set to the amount of one rotation. 3 When this parameter is set, machine position and position on absolute position detector become uncorresponding. Consequently, the bit 4 (APZ) of parameter No. 1815 (indicating that the correspondence is established) is set to 0, alarm DS0300, APC ALARM: NEED REF RETURN. Why the bit 4 (APZ) of parameter No. 1815 is set to 0 can be checked using diagnosis indication No. 0310#0. 4 This parameter No. 1869 is common in movable range that is under one rotation (the bit 3 (SCRx) of parameter No. 1817 is set to 1) and movable range that is over one rotation (the bit 0 (RVS) of parameter No. 1815 is set to 1).
1874 1875 Numerator of the flexible feed gear for the built-in position detector Denominator of the flexible feed gear for the built-in position detector

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis [Valid data range] 1 to 32767 When using temporary absolute coordinate setting, set the flexible feed gear for the built-in position detector on each axis. The settings are as follows:
No.1874 = No.1875 1,000,000
Number of position feedback pulses per motor revolution

- 109 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
1880 Abnormal load detection alarm timer

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word path msec 0 to 32767 This parameter sets the time from the detection of an unexpected disturbance torque until a servo alarm is issued. When 0 is set, however, the specification of 200 msec is assumed.
Group number when an unexpected disturbance torque is detected

1881

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte axis [Valid data range] 0 to 32 Set the group number on each axis when an unexpected disturbance torque is detected. When an unexpected disturbance torque is detected on an axis, only the movements on those axes that belong to the same group as the axis are stopped. If 0 is set for an axis, the movement on the axis is stopped when an unexpected disturbance torque is detected on any other axis. This parameter is valid when bit 5 (ANA) of parameter No. 1804 is set to 1. [Example] When the settings indicated below are made, and an unexpected disturbance torque is detected on the 6th axis, the movements on the 2nd axis, 4th axis, 6th axis, and 7th axis are stopped. When an unexpected disturbance torque is detected on the 4th axis, the movements on the 4th axis and the 7th axis are stopped.
Parameter No. 1881 (1st axis) (2nd axis) (3rd axis) (4th axis) (5th axis) (6th axis) (7th axis)
1882

Setting value 1 2 1 0 3 2 0

Interval of mark 2 of a linear scale with absolute address reference marks

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit 0 to 999999999 Set the interval of mark 2 of a linear scale with absolute address reference marks.

- 110 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Distance 1 from the scale zero point to reference position (linear scale with absolute address reference marks) or distance 1 from the base point to reference position (linear scale with an absolute address zero point)

1883

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]
1884

Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit -999999999 to 999999999


Distance 2 from the scale zero point to reference position (linear scale with absolute address reference marks) or distance 2 from the base point to reference position (linear scale with an absolute address zero point)

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit -999 to 999 When a linear scale with absolute address reference marks is used, set the distance from the scale zero point to reference position in parameter Nos. 1883 and 1884). Distance from the zero point to the reference position of a linear scale = No. 1884 1,000,000,000 + No. 1883 The scale zero point represents a point where mark 1 and mark 2 match. Usually, this point is a virtual point that does not physically exist on the scale. (See the Fig. 4.16 (a).) If the reference position is placed in the + direction when viewed from the scale zero point, set a positive value. If the reference position is placed in the - direction when viewed from the scale zero point, set a negative value.
Encoder end Mark 1 Mark 1 = mark 2 .. 8.0 42.0 8.2 41.8 Mark 2 Mark 1 Mark 2 Reference position

Zero point of encoder

PRM.1821 PRM.1882 PRM.1884 1,000,000,000 + PRM.1883 Fig. 4.16 (a)

- 111 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

[Example of parameter settings] When an encoder as shown Fig. 4.16 (b) is used with an IS-B, millimeter machine:
Scale zero point + direction Reference position - direction

A
Mark 1 = mark 2 Mark 1 Mark 2 Mark 1
Mark 1 Mark 2 Mark 1

B
Mark 2 Mark 1 Mark 2 Mark 1

20.000

19.980

9.940

10.060

9.960

10.040

9.980

10.020

5.000
-[9960/(20020-20000)*20000+5000] = -9965000

20.000mm 20.020mm

Parameters No.1821 (interval of mark 1) = 20000 No.1882 (interval of mark 2) = 20020 No.1883 (reference position) = position of point A + 5.000 = distance between A and B/(mark 2 mark 1) mark 1 + 5000 = 9960/(20020-20000) 20000 + 5000 = 9965000 = -9965000 (the reference position is on the negative side)
Fig. 4.16 (b)

[Setting parameter No. 1883] When it is difficult to measure the distance from the scale zero point to the reference position (parameter No. 1883), the method described below can be used to find the distance. <1> Set parameter No. 1815 to enable this function. Set an appropriate value in parameter No. 1821 and No. 1882. Set 0 in parameter No. 1240. Set 0 in parameter No. 1883 and No. 1884. <2> At an appropriate position, establish a reference position. (As a result, the machine coordinate represents the distance from the scale zero point to the current position.) <3> By jog feed or handle feed, place the machine at the accurate reference position. <4> In parameter No. 1883, set the machine coordinate of that time converted to the detection unit (machine coordinate CMR). <5> If necessary, set parameter No. 1240. When a linear scale with an absolute address zero point is used, set the distance from the base point to the reference position in parameter Nos. 1883 and 1884. The base point is a point at a scale end as shown Fig. 4.16 (c).

- 112 -

B-63950EN/04 Base point Mark 1 Mark 2 Mark 1

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Reference position Mark 2 Mark 1 Mark 2 Mark 1

10.020

9.980

10.040

9.960

10.060

9.940

20.000 20.020

Fig. 4.16 (c)

If the reference position is located in the positive direction when viewed from the base point, set a positive value; if the reference position is located in the negative direction, set a negative value. Set the value by following the steps explained below. <1> Set bit 1 (OPT) of parameter No. 1815 , bit 2 (DCL) of parameter No. 1815, and bit 3 (SDC) of parameter No. 1818 to enable this function. Set 0 in parameter No. 1240. Set 0 in parameter Nos. 1883 and 1884. <2> At an appropriate position, establish a reference position. (Consequently, the machine coordinate value indicates the distance from the base point to current position.) <3> By jog feed or handle feed, place the machine at the accurate reference position. <4> In parameters Nos. 1883 and 1884, set the machine coordinate of that time converted to the detection unit (machine coordinate CMR). If necessary, set parameter No. 1240.

NOTE 1 Set parameter Nos. 1883 and 1884 so that the distance from the scale zero point (for a linear scale with absolute address reference marks) or the base point (for a linear scale with an absolute address zero point) to the reference position is within the range from -999,999,999,999 to +999,999,999,999. If a value beyond this range is set, an alarm DS0016 or DS1448 is issued. 2 The scale area on the scale cannot be extended across the scale zero point or base point. Make parameter settings not to cause the scale area to extend beyond the scale zero point or base point.
1885 Maximum allowable value for total travel during torque control

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis Detection unit 0 to 32767 Set a maximum allowable cumulative travel value (error counter value) during torque control. If the cumulative travel value exceeds the set value, the servo alarm SV0423 is issued.

NOTE This parameter is enabled when the bit 4 (TQF) of parameter No. 1803 is 0 (follow-up is not performed during torque control).
- 113 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
1886 Positional deviation when torque control is canceled

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis Detection unit 1 to 32767 Set a positional deviation value when torque control is canceled to return to positional deviation. After the positional deviation has fallen to the parameter-set value, switching to position control is performed.

NOTE This parameter is enabled when the bit 4 (TQF) of parameter No. 1803 is 0 (follow-up is not performed during torque control).
1895 Servo motor axis number used for a milling tool

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to number of controlled axes This parameter sets the servo motor axis number used for displaying the speed of a milling tool that incorporates a servo motor.
1898 Number of gear teeth on the servo motor axis side

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis [Valid data range] 1 to 9999 This parameter sets the number of servo motor axis gear teeth used for displaying the speed of a milling tool that incorporates a servo motor.

NOTE This parameter is valid when a non-zero value is set in parameter No. 1895.
1899 Number of gear teeth on the milling axis side

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis [Valid data range] 1 to 9999 This parameter sets the number of milling axis gear teeth used for displaying the speed of a milling tool that incorporates a servo motor.

NOTE This parameter is valid when a non-zero value is set in parameter No. 1895.
#7 1902 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 ASE #0 FMD

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit

- 114 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.

#0

FMD The FSSB setting mode is: 0: Automatic setting mode. (When the relationship between an axis and amplifier is defined on the FSSB setting screen, parameters Nos. 1023, 1905, 1936 to 1939, and 14340 to 14407 (plus parameters Nos. 14408 to 14425 and 14444 to 14459 if an additional axis board is attached) are automatically set. 1: Manual setting 2 mode. (Parameters Nos. 1023, 1905, 1936 to 1939 and 14340 to 14407 (plus parameters Nos. 14408 to 14425 and 14444 to 14459 if an additional axis board is attached) are to be manually set.) ASE When automatic setting mode is selected for FSSB setting (when the bit 0 (FMD) parameter No. 1902 is set to 0), automatic setting is: 0: Not completed. 1: Completed. This bit is automatically set to 1 upon the completion of automatic setting.
#7 #6 DCE DCN #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

#1

1902 1904

These parameters are related to Dual Check Safety. See Dual Check Safety CONNECTION MANUAL (B-64003EN) for details.
#7 1905 PM2 #6 PM1 #5 #4 #3 #2 PM4 #1 PM3 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#1 PM3 The third separate detector interface unit is: 0: Not used. 1: Used. PM4 The fourth separate detector interface unit is: 0: Not used. 1: Used. PM1 The first separate detector interface unit is: 0: Not used. 1: Used. PM2 The second separate detector interface unit is: 0: Not used. 1: Used.
- 115 -

#2

#6

#7

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE 1 When automatic setting mode is selected for FSSB setting (when the bit 0 (FMD) of parameter No. 1902 is set to 0), this parameter is automatically set when input is performed with the FSSB setting screen. When manual setting 2 mode is selected for FSSB setting (when the bit 0 (FMD) of parameter No. 1902 is set to 1), this parameter must be set directly. 2 When a separate detector interface unit is used, a connector number must be set in the corresponding parameter No. 1936, 1937, 1938, or 1939.
1936 1937 1938 1939 Connector number of the first separate detector interface unit Connector number of the second separate detector interface unit Connector number of the third separate detector interface unit Connector number of the fourth separate detector interface unit

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte axis [Valid data range] 0 to 7 Set the connector numbers corresponding to connectors to be connected when the separate detector interface unit set by bit 6 (PM1), 2 (PM4), 1 (PM3), or 7 (PM2) of parameter No. 1905 is used. The values to be set are indicated below. This parameter sets the connector number corresponding to the connector to be connected when the separate detector interface unit set by bit 1, 2, 6, or 7 of parameter No. 1905 is used. The values to be set are as follows. Within one separate detector interface unit, use connector numbers sequentially. No intermediate number may be omitted.
Correspondence between connectors and connector numbers Connector Connector number
JF101 JF102 JF103 JF104 JF105 JF106 JF107 JF108 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

Example of setting)
Controlled axis
X1 Y1 Z1 X2

Separate detector connection destination Parameter setting Connectors Connectors Connectors Connectors No. No. No. No. No.1905 for 1st unit for 2nd unit for 3rd unit for 4th unit 1936 1937 1938 1939 (#7,#6,#2,#1)
JF101 JF102 JF101 JF102 0 1 0 1 0,1,0,0 1,0,0,0 0,0,0,1 1,0,0,0

- 116 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Separate detector connection destination Parameter setting Connectors Connectors Connectors Connectors No. No. No. No. No.1905 for 1st unit for 2nd unit for 3rd unit for 4th unit 1936 1937 1938 1939 (#7,#6,#2,#1)
JF102 JF104 JF103 JF101 JF101 JF102 JF103 1 3 2 0 0 1 2 0,0,1,0 0,0,0,0 0,0,0,1 0,0,1,0 1,0,0,0 0,1,0,0 1,0,0,0 0,0,1,0

Controlled axis
Y2 Z2 A1 B1 C1 A2 B2 C2

NOTE When automatic setting mode is selected for FSSB setting (when the bit 0 (FMD) of parameter No. 1902 is set to 0), these parameters are automatically set when input is performed with the FSSB setting screen. When manual setting 2 mode is selected for FSSB setting (when the bit 0 (FMD) of parameter No. 1902 is set to 1), these parameters must be set directly.
1945 1946 1948 1950

These parameters are related to Dual Check Safety. See Dual Check Safety CONNECTION MANUAL (B-64003EN) for details. Parameters Nos. 2000 to 2999 are for digital servo, The following parameters are not explained in this manual. Refer to FANUC AC SERVO MOTOR i series PARAMETER MANUAL (B-65270EN)
No.
2000 2001 2002 2003 2004 2005 2006 2007 2008 2009 2010 2011 2012 2013 2014 2015 2016 2017 2018

Data type
Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis AMR6 VOFS SFCM FRCA LAXD BLST POLE XIAx STNG APTG BZNG PK2V25 PFBCPY OVSC BRKC AMR5 BLEN

Contents
PGEX AMR4 NPSP AMR3 PFSE PIEN TRW1 AMR2 OBEN TRW0 DGPR AMR1 TGAL TIB0 FEED IGNV TNDM PLC0 AMR0

TIA0 FCBL ESP2 SERD

VFBA BLCU HBBL RCCL VCM2 SPCTRF BLAT HBPE VCMD1 BLTE LINE

FFAL MSFE

EGB HRV3 HRV4 PGTW ABNT DBST RVRSE

TDOU HTNG PK2VDN COMSRC OVR8

SSG1

MOVOBS

- 117 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
No.
2019 2020 2021 2022 2023 2024 2028 2029 2030 2031 2033 2034 2036 2039 2040 2041 2042 2043 2044 2045 2046 2047 2048 2049 2050 2051 2053 2054 2055 2056 2057 2058 2060 2062 2063 2064 2065 2066 2067 2068 2069 2070 2071 2072 2073 2074 2077 2078 2079 2080 2081 2082 2083

B-63950EN/04

Data type
Bit axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis

Contents
DPFB SLEN INVSYS LBUFEX TANDMP Motor number Load inertia ratio Direction of motor rotation Number of velocity pulses Number of position pulses Position gain switching speed Effective speed for integral acceleration at low speed Effective speed for integral deceleration at low speed Torque command difference threshold of torque difference alarm Number of position feedback pulses for damping control Damping control gain Damping compensation gain (main axis) and damping compensation phase coefficient (sub-axis) for tandem control Second-stage acceleration for two-stage backlash acceleration Current loop integral gain (PK1) Current loop proportional gain (PK2) Current loop gain (PK3) Velocity loop integral gain (PK1V) Velocity loop proportional gain (PK2V) Velocity loop incomplete integral gain (PK3V) Velocity loop gain (PK4V) Observer parameter (POA1) Backlash acceleration Maximum amplitude for dual position feedback Observer parameter (POK1) Observer parameter (POK2) Current dead-band compensation (PPMAX) Current dead-band compensation (PDDP) Current dead-band compensation (PHYST) Variable current gain during deceleration Phase-D current at high speed Phase-D current limit at high speed Torque limit Overload protection coefficient (OVC1) Overload protection coefficient (OVC2) Soft disconnection alarm level Overload protection coefficient (OVCLMT) Acceleration feedback gain Torque command filter Feed forward coefficient Velocity feed forward coefficient Backlash acceleration timing Backlash acceleration effective duration, number of times static friction compensation is performed Static friction compensation Parameter for determining stop of static friction compensation Current-dependent current loop gain Overshoot compensation counter Conversion coefficient for dual position feedback (numerator) Conversion coefficient for dual position feedback (denominator) First-order lag time constant for dual position feedback Zero width for dual position feedback Backlash acceleration stop amount Brake control timer (ms)

- 118 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Contents
Flexible feed gear (numerator) Flexible feed gear (denominator) Rated current parameter Torque offset Machine velocity feedback coefficient gain Second-stage end magnification for two-stage backlash acceleration Torque characteristic for spindle use: coefficient A Advanced preview feed forward coefficient Torque characteristic for spindle use: coefficient B Single-direction backlash acceleration amount Feed-forward timing adjustment coefficient Machining point control: Timing adjustment parameter Static friction compensation stop parameter N-pulse suppression level Overshoot compensation effective level Final clamp value for actual current limit Amount of track back upon detection of unexpected disturbance torque Unexpected disturbance torque detection alarm level (for cutting when switching is used) Torque constant for torque control Velocity loop gain override during cutting Magnetic saturation compensation (base/coefficient) Deceleration torque limit (base/coefficient) AMR conversion coefficient 1 Resonance elimination filter 1 : Attenuation center frequency Acceleration amount override for backlash acceleration Unexpected disturbance torque detection, dynamic friction compensation value Excessive error level between semi-closed and closed loops for dual position feedback Stop level with variable proportional gain Tandem control, time constant for switching position feedback Non-interacting control coefficient Weak magnetic flux compensation (coefficient) Weak magnetic flux compensation (base/limit) Two smooth compensations per magnetic pole pair Four smooth compensations per magnetic pole pair Six smooth compensations per magnetic pole pair Deceleration phase delay compensation coefficient (PHDLY1) Deceleration phase delay compensation coefficient (PHDLY2) Stage 1 acceleration amount override for two-stage backlash acceleration AMR conversion coefficient 2 AMR offset Alarm level for detecting unexpected disturbance torque during rapid traverse Position feed forward coefficient for cutting Velocity feed forward coefficient for cutting Two-stage backlash acceleration end timer Torque command filter (during rapid traverse) OVC magnification at stop time (OVCSTP) Second overload protection coefficient (POVC21) Second overload protection coefficient (POVC22) Second overload protection coefficient (POVCLMT2) Maximum amplifier current Stage 2 acceleration amount offset for two-stage backlash acceleration Distance to lift for the lifting function against gravity at emergency stop Resonance elimination filter 1 : Attenuation band width Reference counter capacity (denominator)

No.
2084 2085 2086 2087 2088 2089 2090 2092 2093 2094 2095 2096 2097 2099 2101 2102 2103 2104 2105 2107 2110 2111 2112 2113 2114 2116 2118 2119 2126 2127 2128 2129 2130 2131 2132 2133 2134 2137 2138 2139 2142 2144 2145 2146 2156 2161 2162 2163 2164 2165 2167 2173 2177 2179

Data type
Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis

- 119 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
No.
2182 2185 2198 2199 2200 2201 2202 2203 2204 2205 2206 2207 2209 2210 2211 2212 2213 2214 2215 2220 2221 2223 2226 2227 2229 2263 2265 2266 2268 2270 2271 2273 2274 2275 2277 2278 2279 2281 2282 2283 2288 2290 2292 2293 2300 2301 2304 2305 2310 2315 2318 2319 2320 2321

B-63950EN/04

Data type
Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Bit axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Current A for pole detection Position pulse conversion coefficient Current B for pole detection Current C for pole detection P2EX CPEE

Contents

ABGO OVS1

IQOB PIAL CRPI FULDMY RNLV VGCCR HSTP10

OVSP CROF

DUAL FRC2AX2 DBS2 PGTWN2 HDIS HBSF HCNGL ESPTM1 PLW4 OVQK OCM FFCHG ABT2 P16 ESPTM0

HD2O PK2D50

PK12S2 PHCP

TCPCLR DECAMR VFFNCH LNOTCH DISOBS QUCKST PARTLN ABSEN

BLCUT2 MEMCLR

PRFCLR ERRCHK

ANGLNG ANGREF GOKAN TAWAMI STPRED Detection unit setting Machining point control: gain 2 Machining point control: gain 1 Allowable travel distance magnification/stop speed decision value DSTIN DSTTAN DSTWAV ACREF 2NDTMG RETR2 DBTLIM EGBFFG EGBEX POA1NG DD2048 ACC1ON ACC2ON ACC3ON ACCNEG PM2ACC

AMR60 WSVCPY RCNCLR HP2048 800PLS PM1TP DMCON RDPMU1 NOG54

PM2SCB

PM1SCB

PM2TP RDPMU2

FSAQS BLSTP2 MCPEF MOVAXS MV1IFC MV2IFC MV1ID2 MV2ID2 MV1ID1 MV2ID1

ISE64

CKLNOH TQCT10 Acceleration torque limit 1 Acceleration torque limit 2 Phase-D current at high-speed: voltage coefficient Servo check interface unit output signal setting Gain of disturbance elimination filter Inertia ratio of disturbance elimination filter Inverse function gain of disturbance elimination filter Filter time constant of disturbance elimination filter

MV1ID0 MV2ID0 THRMO

ACCMON IFC1ON IFC2ON DD

ACCHLD C1TYP1 C2TYP1

ACCOUT C1TYP0 C2TYP0 HRVEN

- 120 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Contents
Acceleration feedback limit of disturbance elimination filter Variable current PI ratio Optional magnification at stop of cutting for stop-time variable proportional gain function Integral gain (main axis) and phase coefficient (sub-axis) for tandem damping control Disturbance input gain Start frequency of disturbance input End frequency of disturbance input Number of disturbance input measurement points Incomplete integral gain (main axis) for tandem camping control Current loop gain magnification (valid only during high-speed HRV current control) Velocity loop gain magnification (valid only during high-speed HRV current control) Limit of acceleration amount for backlash acceleration Second-stage acceleration limit for two-stage backlash acceleration Second-stage acceleration amount (single direction) for two-stage backlash acceleration Acceleration amount override (single direction) for backlash acceleration Second-stage acceleration override (single direction) for two-stage backlash acceleration Limit of acceleration amount (single direction) for backlash acceleration Second-stage acceleration limit (single direction) for two-stage backlash acceleration Dynamic friction compensation amount at stop for disturbance estimation function Limit of dynamic friction compensation amount for disturbance estimation function Static friction compensation amount (single direction) Adaptive damping filter detection level Machining point control: Center frequency of band-pass filter Resonance elimination filter L: Feed-forward filter exclusion rate Tandem speed difference alarm threshold Unexpected disturbance torque detection: Post-acceleration timer Resonance elimination filter 1 : Damping Resonance elimination filter 2 : Attenuation center frequency Resonance elimination filter 2 : Attenuation band width Resonance elimination filter 2 : Damping Resonance elimination filter 3 : Attenuation center frequency Resonance elimination filter 3 : Attenuation band width Resonance elimination filter 3 : Damping Resonance elimination filter 4 : Attenuation center frequency Resonance elimination filter 4 : Attenuation band width Resonance elimination filter 4 : Damping Two smooth compensations per magnetic pole pair (single direction) Four smooth compensations per magnetic pole pair (single direction) Six smooth compensations per magnetic pole pair (single direction) Serial EGB exponent setting Pull-up amount for vertical axis pull-up function for emergency stop Pull-up time for vertical axis pull-up function for emergency stop Torque limit magnification during brake control Smoothing compensation performed 1.5 times per pole pair Smoothing compensation performed 1.5 times per pole pair (negative direction) Smoothing compensation performed three times per pole pair Smoothing compensation performed three times per pole pair (negative direction) Torsion preview control: maximum compensation value Torsion preview control: acceleration 1 Torsion preview control: acceleration 2 Torsion preview control: acceleration 3 Torsion preview control: acceleration torsion compensation value K1 Torsion preview control: acceleration torsion compensation value K2 Torsion preview control: acceleration torsion compensation value K3 Torsion preview control: torsion delay compensation value KD

No.
2322 2323 2324 2325 2326 2327 2328 2329 2333 2334 2335 2338 2339 2340 2341 2345 2346 2347 2352 2355 2356 2357 2358 2359 2360 2361 2362 2363 2364 2365 2366 2367 2368 2369 2370 2371 2372 2373 2374 2375 2377 2378 2380 2381 2382 2383 2384 2385 2386 2387 2388 2389

Data type
Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis

- 121 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
No.
2390 2391 2392 2393 2394 2402 2403 2404 2405 2415 2455 2456 2463 2468 2469 2478 2479 2480 2481 2482 2483 2490 2491

B-63950EN/04

Data type
Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis Word axis

Contents
Torsion preview control: torsion delay compensation value KDN Torsion preview control: acceleration torsion compensation value K1N Torsion preview control: acceleration torsion compensation value K2N Torsion preview control: acceleration torsion compensation value K3N Number of data mask digits Torsion preview control: torsion torque compensation coefficient Synchronous axes automatic compensation: coefficient Synchronous axes automatic compensation: maximum compensation value (sub-axis), dead-band width (main-axis) Synchronous axes automatic compensation : filter coefficient IAHDON Integral part () of the number of pulses for one rotation Exponential part () of the number of pulses for one rotation Power consumption monitor: common power loss coefficient C Power consumption monitor: motor winding resistance Power consumption monitor: servo amplifier loss coefficient A Interactive force compensation: Angle data offset (for the first moving axis) Interactive force compensation: Angle data offset (for the first moving axis) Interactive force compensation: Angle data offset (for the second moving axis) Interactive force compensation: Angle data offset (for the second moving axis) Speed arrival detection level Speed zero detection level Power consumption monitor: servo amplifier loss coefficient B Power consumption monitor: common power loss coefficient D
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 VFA #1 TDM #0

2008

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #1 TDM This bit is automatically set to 1 when bit 6 (tandem axis) of parameter No. 1817 is set to 1. This bit cannot be directly set. VFA In tandem control, the feedrate feedback average function is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
#7 2011 XIAx #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 SYNx

#2

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 SYNx When the electronic gear box function (EGB) is used, this bit sets the axis to be synchronized. 0: Axis not synchronized by EGB 1: Axis synchronized by EGB Set 1 for both of the slave and dummy axes of EGB.

- 122 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE The setting of this parameter becomes valid after the power is turned off then back on.

#7

XIAx Temporary absolute coordinate setting is: 0: Not used. 1: Used.

NOTE 1 When temporary absolute coordinate setting is used, bit 1 (OPTx) of parameter No. 1815, bit 5 (APCx) of parameter No. 1815, parameter No. 1874, and parameter No. 1875 must be set. 2 The setting of this parameter becomes effective after the power is turned off then back on.
2021 Load inertia ratio

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis [Valid data range] 0 to 32767 (Load inertia)/(motor inertia) 256 For tandem control: (Load inertia)/(motor inertia) 256/2 Set the same value for the master axis and slave axis.
2022 Direction of motor rotation

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis [Valid data range] -111,111 Set the direction of motor rotation. If the motor turns clockwise when viewed from the Pulsecoder side, set 111. If the motor turns counterclockwise when viewed from the Pulsecoder side, set -111.

Turned counterclockwise when viewed from the pulse coder: Set -111.

FANUC

Turned clockwise when viewed from the pulse coder: Set 111.

2031

Torque command difference threshold of torque difference alarm

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis [Valid data range] 0 to 14564
- 123 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

If the absolute value of the torque command difference between two axes exceeds the value set in this parameter, an alarm is issued. Set the same value for two axes that are placed under axis synchronous control. The servo axis numbers of the synchronized master axis and slave axis must be assigned so that an odd number is assigned to the master axis and the next axis number is assigned to the slave axis. Examples are (1,2) and (3,4).
2087 Preload value for each axis (Tcmd offset)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis (Ampere limit)/7282 -1821 to 1821 An offset is applied to a torque command to suppress backlash. Set a value much greater than the friction. As a guideline, specify a value that is about one-third of the rated torque. [Example] To set a torque equivalent to 3 A in the opposite directions: When the ampere limit is 40 A 3/(40/7282) = 546 Master side = 546 Slave side = -546
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 ISE64 #2 #1 #0

2282

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #3 ISE64 To feed forward (bit 1 (FEED) of parameter No. 2005 is set to 1): 0: Normal feedrate limits are applied. 1: Extended feedrate limits are applied. When feed forward is enabled, bit 7 of parameter No. 1013 is set to 1, and this parameter is set for an axis, feedrate limits for the axis are extended as following table if the increment system is IS-C, IS-D, or IS-E: [Normal position control]
Functions used when Normal position control is used High-speed, high-precision Feed forward
Not used/used (advanced preview type) Not used/used (advanced preview type) Used (conventional type)

Permissible feedrate Detection unit: 1 Detection unit: 0.1 Detection unit: 0.01 Detection unit: 0.001

None

AI contour control I AI contour control II

IS-B:999m/min IS-B:196m/min IS-D:10m/min IS-C:999m/min IS-C:999m/min 100m/min

IS-E:1m/min 100m/min

Electronic gear box

IS-B:240m/min IS-C:100m/min

24m/min

2.4m/min 100m/min

0.24m/min 100m/min

- 124 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
[When spindle control with servo motor is used]
Functions used when Normal position control is Permissible rotation speed used Extended Feedrate limit Detection unit: Detection unit: Detection unit: Detection unit: permissible multiplied by 1/1000deg 1/10000deg 1/100000deg 1/1000000deg feedrate 10
Disabled Disabled (No.1013#7=0) (No.1408#3=0) Enabled (No.1408#3=1) Enabled (No.1013#7=1) (No.2282#3=1) Disabled (No.1408#3=0) Enabled (No.1408#3=1)

IS-B:2777min-1 IS-C: 277min-1 IS-B:27777min-1 IS-C: 2777min-1 IS-B:2777min-1 IS-C: 277min-1 IS-B:27777min-1 IS-C: 27777min-1

IS-B:2777min-1 IS-D:27min-1 IS-C: 277min-1 IS-B:27777min-1 IS-D:277min-1 IS-C: 2777min-1 IS-B:2777min-1 IS-D:277min-1 IS-C: 277min-1 IS-B:27777min-1 IS-D:2777min-1 IS-C: 2777min-1

IS-E:2min-1 IS-E:27min-1 IS-E:27min-1 IS-E:349min-1

The values enclosed by a rectangle in the table are limits imposed by internal processing of the servo software. As CMR is increased to make the detection unit smaller, the permissible feedrate limited by the internal processing of the servo software lowers in proportion to the detection unit (when a detection unit of 0.1 m is changed to 0.05m, the permissible feedrate is halved). In a semi-closed loop system using a high-resolution detector (a rotary motor or linear motor), use of nano interpolation allows the maximum resolution of the detector to be used for position control without using a smaller detection unit. Even when a large detection unit is to be used because the feedrate is limited by detection unit as mentioned above, feedrate feedback data that significantly affects velocity loop control is controlled by using a maximum resolution of the detector.

- 125 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

4.17
3001

PARAMETERS OF DI/DO (1 OF 2)
#7 MHI #6 PGS #5 #4 #3 #2 RWM #1 SON #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #1 SON Automatic operation is started: 0: On the falling edge (1 0) of the automatic operation start signal ST <Gn007.2> 1: On the rising edge (0 1) of the of the automatic operation start signal ST <Gn007.2> RWM While a program in the program memory is being searched for, the rewind signal RWD <Fn000.0> is: 0: Not output. 1: Output. PGS In the high speed program check mode, M, S, T, and B codes are: 0: Not output. 1: Output.

#2

#6

CAUTION 1 If this parameter is set to 1, M, S, T, and B codes are neither saved nor restored at the start and end of the high speed program check mode. Accordingly, M, S, T, and B codes output in the high speed program check mode remain valid even after the high speed program check mode ends. 2 If this parameter is set to 1, M, S, T, and B codes are output to the PMC in the high speed program check mode. Therefore, when M, S, T, and B commands need not be executed in the high speed program check mode, create a ladder sequence that references the high speed program check mode signal <Fn290.5> and suppresses the execution of any of the M, S, T, and B codes. 3 If this parameter is set to 1, the operation of the M, S, T, and B codes depends on the status of auxiliary function lock signal AFL <Gn005.6>. 4 In the high speed program check mode, an attempt to rewrite this bit parameter by using G10 results in an alarm PS5364, ILLEGAL COMMAND IN PROGRAM CHECK.
#7 MHI Exchange of strobe and completion signals for the M, S, T, and B 0: Normal 1: High-speed
#7 3002 OVM #6 POV #5 #4 IOV #3 #2 MFD #1 #0 CHM

[Input type] Parameter input


- 126 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Data type] Bit path #0 CHM For high-speed M/S/T/B, the distribution end signal DEN <Fn001.3> and an auxiliary function code signal M00 to M31 <Fn010 to Fn013> are: 0: Not turned off even upon completion of the execution of the auxiliary function. 1: Turned off upon completion of the execution of the auxiliary function. MFD When the high-speed M/S/T/B interface is used, if a block specifying an M, S, T, or B code does not contain a move command or dwell command, the distribution end signal DEN <Fn001.3> and the strobe signal (MF<Fn007.0>, SF<Fn007.2>, TF<Fn007.3>, or BF<Fn007.7>) for the function are: 0: Output conventionally (the output of the distribution end signal is delayed). 1: Output at the same time. IOV Override-related signal logic is: 0: Used without modification (A signal of negative logic is used as a negative logic signal, and a signal of positive logic is used as a positive logic signal.) 1: Inverted (A signal of negative logic is used as a positive logic signal, and a signal of positive logic is used as a negative logic signal.) The signals indicated below are affected. Signal of negative logic: Feedrate override signals *FV0 to *FV7<Gn012> Second feedrate override signals*AFV0 to *AFV7<Gn013> Feedrate override signals (for PMC axis control) *EFOV0g to *EFOV7g<G0151/G0163/G0175/G0187> Software operators panel signals *FV0O to *FV7O<Fn078> Signals of positive logic: Rapid traverse override signals ROV1,ROV2<G0014.0, G0014.1> Software operators panel signals ROV1O,ROV2O<F0076.4, F0076.5> Rapid traverse override signals (for PMC axis control) EROV1g,EROV2g<G0150.0, G0150.1/G0162.0, G0162.1/G0174.0, G0174.1/G0186.0, G0186.1> The signals indicated below are not affected. 1% step rapid traverse override selection signal HROV <Gn096.7> 1% step rapid traverse override signals *HROV0 to *HROV6 <Gn096.0 to Gn096.6> 0.1% step rapid traverse override selection signal FHROV <Gn353.7> 0.1% step rapid traverse override signals *FHRO0 to *FHRO9 <Gn352.0 to Gn352.7, Gn353.0 to Gn353.1> #6 POV Dwell/Auxiliary function time override function is: 0: Invalid. 1: Valid. OVM In Dwell/Auxiliary function time override function, override function for M02,M30 is: 0: Invalid. 1: Valid.

#2

#4

#7

- 127 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 3003 #6 #5 DEC DEC #4 DAU #3 DIT DIT #2 ITX ITX #1

B-63950EN/04 #0 ITL ITL

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 ITL Interlock signal for all axes 0: Enabled 1: Disabled ITX Interlock signals for each axis 0: Enabled 1: Disabled DIT The interlock signal for each axis direction is: 0: Valid. 1: Invalid. DAU When bit 3 (DIT) of parameter No. 3003 is set to 0, the interlock signal for each axis direction is: 0: Valid only in manual operation, and invalid in automatic operation. 1: Valid in either manual operation or automatic operation. DEC Deceleration signal (*DEC1 to *DEC8 <G196.0G196.7>) for reference position return 0: Deceleration is applied when the signal is 0. 1: Deceleration is applied when the signal is 1.
#7 3004 #6 #5 OTH #4 #3 #2 #1 BCY #0 BSL

#2

#3

#4

#5

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 BSL The block start interlock signal *BSL <Gn008.3> and cutting block start interlock signal *CSL <Gn008.1> are: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. BCY When more than one operation is performed by one block command such as a canned cycle, the block start interlock signal *BSL <Gn008.3> is: 0: Checked only at the beginning of the first cycle. 1: Checked at the beginning of every cycle. OTH The overtravel limit signal is: 0: Checked 1: Not checked

#1

#5

WARNING For safety, usually set 0 to check the overtravel limit signal.

- 128 -

B-63950EN/04 #7 3006 #6 WPS #5 #4

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#3 #2 EPS #1 EPN #0 GDC

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 GDC As the deceleration signal for reference position return: 0: X0009 is used. 1: G0196 is used. (X0009 is disabled.) EPN As signals for specifying workpiece numbers for external workpiece number search: 0: The external workpiece search signals (PN1 to PN16) are used. (A number from 1 to 31 can be specified.) 1: The extended external workpiece number search signals (EPN0 to EPN13) are used. (A number from 1 to 9999 can be specified.) EPS As the signal for starting external workpiece number search: 0: The automatic operation start signal ST is used. When automatic operation (memory operation) is started, a search is made. 1: The external workpiece number search start signal EPNS is used. ST does not start a search. WPS Each axis workpiece coordinate system preset signal: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. When this parameter is set to 1, a workpiece coordinate system is preset after the end of the high speed program check mode.
#7 3008 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 XSG #1 #0

#1

#2

#6

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#2 XSG A signal assigned to an X address is: 0: Fixed at the address. 1: Able to be reassigned to an arbitrary X address.

NOTE When this parameter is set to 1, set parameter No. 3013, No. 3014, No. 3012, and No. 3019. If parameter No. 3013 and No. 3014 are not set, the deceleration signal for reference position return is assigned to bit 0 of <X0000>. If parameter No. 3012 and No. 3019 are not set, the skip signal, the PMC axis control skip signal, the measurement position arrival signal, the manual feed interlock signal for each axis direction, and the tool compensation value write signal are assigned to <X0000>.

- 129 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
3010 Time lag in strobe signals MF, SF, TF, and BF

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word path msec 0 to 32767 The time required to send strobe signals MF<Fn007.0>, SF<Fn007.2>, TF<Fn007.3>, and BF<Fn007.7> after the M, S, T, and B codes are sent, respectively.

M, S, T, B code MF, SF, TF, BF signal Delay time

NOTE The time is counted in units of 4 ms. If the set value is not a multiple of four, it is raised to the next multiple of four Example When 30 is set, 32 ms is assumed. When 0 is set, 4 ms is assumed. The time count period may change, depending on the system.
3011 Acceptable width of M, S, T, and B function completion signal (FIN)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word path msec 0 to 32767 Set the minimum signal width of the valid M, S, T, and B function completion signal (FIN).
M, S, T, B code MF, SF, TF, BF signal FIN sigal

Ignored because shorter than min. signal width

Valid because longer than min. signal width

NOTE The time is counted in units of 4 ms. If the set value is not a multiple of four, it is raised to the next multiple of four Example When 30 is set, 32 ms is assumed. When 0 is set, 4 ms is assumed. The time count period may change, depending on the system.

- 130 -

B-63950EN/04 3012

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Skip signal assignment address

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to 727 Set an X address to which the skip signal SKIPn is to be assigned.

NOTE This parameter is valid when bit 2 (XSG) of parameter No. 3008 is set to 1. Depending on the option configuration of the I/O Link, the actually usable X addresses are: <X0000 to X0127>, <X0200 to X0327>, <X0400 to X0527>, <X0600 to X0727>
3013 X address to which the deceleration signal for reference position return is assigned

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis [Valid data range] 0 to 727 Set an address to which the deceleration signal *DECn for reference position return for each axis is to be assigned.

NOTE This parameter is valid when bit 2 (XSG) of parameter No. 3008 is set to 1. Depending on the option configuration of the I/O Link, the actually usable X addresses are: <X0000 to X0127>, <X0200 to X0327>, <X0400 to X0527>, <X0600 to X0727>
3014 Bit position of an X address to which the deceleration signal for reference position return is assigned

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte axis [Valid data range] 0 to 7 Set a bit position to which the deceleration signal for reference position return *DECn for each axis is to be assigned.
- 131 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE This parameter is valid when bit 2 (XSG) of parameter No. 3008 is set to 1.
3017 Output time of reset signal RST

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word path 16msec 0 to 255 When the output time of the reset signal RST is to be extended, set an extended time. (RST signal output time) = (Time required for reset processing) + (Parameter setting) 16 msec
Percentage assumed when the 1% rapid traverse override signal indicates 0% during execution of an auxiliary function

3018

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Byte path % 0 to 100 When the 1% rapid traverse override signal indicates 0% in the dwell/auxiliary function time override function, this parameter sets the percentage for calculating an insufficient time. 0% is assumed to be 10%.
Address to which the PMC axis control skip signal, measurement position arrival signal, and tool offset write signals are assigned

3019

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to 727 Set an X address to which the PMC axis control skip signal ESKIP, measurement position arrival signals (XAE, YAE, and ZAE (M series) or XAE and ZAE (T series)), and tool offset write signals (MIT1 and MIT2 (T series)) are to be assigned.

Example 1. When parameter No. 3012 is set to 5 and parameter No. 3019 is set to 6
When bit 2 (XSG) of parameter No. 3008 is 1, the PMC axis control skip signal, and measurement position arrival signal are allocated to X0006 and the skip signal is allocated to X0005.
#7 X0005 SKIP #7 SKIP #7 X0006 #7 #6 SKIP6 #6 SKIP6 #6 ESKIP #6 ESKIP #5 SKIP5 #5 SKIP5 #5 -MIT2 #5 #4 SKIP4 #4 SKIP4 #4 +MIT2 #4 #3 SKIP3 #3 SKIP3 #3 -MIT1 #3 #2 SKIP2 #2 SKIP2 #2 +MIT1 #2 ZAE #1 SKIP8 #1 SKIP8 #1 ZAE #1 YAE #0 SKIP7 #0 SKIP7 #0 XAE #0 XAE (M series) (T series) (M series) (T series)

- 132 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
When bit 2 (XSG) of parameter No. 3008 is 1, the PMC axis control skip signal, measurement position arrival signal, and skip signal are allocated to X0005.
#7 #6 ESKIP SKIP6 #6 ESKIP SKIP6 #5 -MIT2 SKIP5 #5 SKIP5 #4 +MIT2 SKIP4 #4 SKIP4 #3 -MIT1 SKIP3 #3 SKIP3 #2 +MIT1 SKIP2 #2 ZAE SKIP2 #1 ZAE SKIP8 #1 YAE SKIP8 #0 XAE SKIP7 #0 XAE SKIP7 (M series) (T series)

Example 2. When parameter No. 3012 is set to 5 and parameter No. 3019 is set to 5

X0005

SKIP #7 SKIP

NOTE This parameter is valid when bit 2 (XSG) of parameter No. 3008 is set to 1. Depending on the option configuration of the I/O Link, the actually usable X addresses are: <X0000 to X0127>, <X0200 to X0327>, <X0400 to X0527>, <X0600 to X0727>
3020 Correspondence between workpiece numbers and program numbers in external workpiece number search (PN)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] -1 to 999999 This parameter has the following meaning according to the value set. When a value from 0 to 999999 is set (Program number) = (setting)*100+(workpiece number) This means that the setting specifies the higher 6 digits of a program number. When the value -1 is set The higher 6 digits of a program number represent the minimum of the existing program numbers. Example When workpiece number 21 is specified, program numbers such as O0021, O0121, and O0221 are searched for. If O0021 is not found, but O0121 and O0221 are found, O0121 is selected as the program number.

NOTE This parameter is valid when a workpiece number is specified using the PN1 to PN16 signals (when bit 1 (EPN) of parameter No. 3006 is set to 0).
3021 Address to which an axis signal is assigned

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte axis [Valid data range] 0 to 7, 10 to 17, 20 to 27, ... , 90 to 97 For each axis of the CNC, set a PMC interface address. Set a value according to the tables below.
- 133 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Setting value 0 1 9

B-63950EN/04

Value of parameter No. 3021 (the second digit) Input signal address Output signal address G0000 to G0767 G1000 to G1767 : G9000 to G9767 F0000 to F0767 F1000 to F1767 F9000 to F9767

Setting value 0 1 7

Value of parameter No. 3021 (the first digit) Input signal address Output signal address 0 1 : 7 0 1 7

[Example of setting]
Axis number 1 2 3 4 5 No. 3021 0 1 2 10 11 Signal allocation +J1<G0100.0>, -J1<G0102.0>, ZP1<F0090.0>, ... +J2<G0100.1>, -J2<G0102.1>, ZP2<F0090.1>, ... +J3<G0100.2>, -J3<G0102.2>, ZP3<F0090.2>, ... +J4<G1100.0>, -J4<G1102.0>, ZP4<F1090.0>, ... +J5<G1100.1>, -J5<G1102.1>, ZP5<F1090.1>, ...

If eight or less axes are used per path, the following signal allocation results when 0 is set for all axes: Axis 1 of path 1 = Setting equivalent to 0 Axis 2 of path 1 = Setting equivalent to 1 : Axis 1 of path 2 = Setting equivalent to 10 :

NOTE Set this parameter when more than eight axes are used per path. The valid data range varies, depending on the system software.
3022 Address to which a spindle signal is assigned

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte spindle [Valid data range] 0 to 3, 10 to 13, 20 to 23, ... , 90 to 93 For each axis of the CNC, set a PMC interface address. Set a value according to the tables below.
Value of parameter No. 3022 (the second digit) Setting value Input signal address 0 1 9 G0000toG0767 G1000toG1767 : G9000toG9767 Output signal address F0000toF0767 F1000toF1767 F9000toF9767

- 134 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Value of parameter No. 3022 (the first digit) Setting value Input signal address 0 1 2 3 Bit position A Bit position B Bit position C Bit position D Output signal address Bit position A Bit position B Bit position C Bit position D

(The bit positions A, B, C, and D vary, depending on the type of signal.) [Example of setting]
Spindle number 1 2 3 4 No. 3022 0 1 10 11 Signal allocation TLMLA<G0070.0>, TLMHA<G0070.1>, ALMA<F0045.0>, ... TLMLB<G0074.0>, TLMHB<G0074.1>, ALMB<F0049.0>, ... TLMLA<G1070.0>, TLMHA<G1070.1>, ALMA<F1045.0>, ... TLMLB<G1074.0>, TLMHB<G1074.1>, ALMB<F1049.0>, ...

If four or less axes are used per path, the following signal allocation results when 0 is set for all axes: Axis 1 of path 1 = Setting equivalent to 0 Axis 2 of path 1 = Setting equivalent to 1 : Axis 1 of path 2 = Setting equivalent to 10 :

NOTE The valid data range varies, depending on the system software.
3030 3031 3032 Allowable number of digits for the M code Allowable number of digits for the S code Allowable number of digits for the T code

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to 8 Set the allowable numbers of digits for the M, S, and T codes. When 0 is set, the allowable number of digits is assumed to be 8.
3033 Allowable number of digits for the B code (second auxiliary function)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to 8 Set the allowable number of digits for the second auxiliary function. When 0 is set, the allowable number of digits is assumed to be 8. To enable a decimal point to be specified, bit 0 (AUP) of parameter No. 3450 must be set to 1. In this case, the allowable number of digits set in this parameter includes the number of decimal places. If a value exceeding the allowable number of digits is specified, the alarm PS0003, TOO MANY DIGIT is issued.

- 135 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

4.18
3100

PARAMETERS OF DISPLAY AND EDIT (1 OF 5)


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 CEM #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #1 CEM On the help and operation history screens, CE-marked MDI keys are displayed with: 0: Key names. 1: Symbols.
#7 3101 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 KBF #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #1 KBF When the screen or mode is changed, the contents of the key-in buffer are: 0: Cleared. 1: Not cleared.
#7 3103 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 NMH #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #2 NMH System alarm history screen is: 0: Not displayed. 1: Displayed.
#7 3104 DAC DAC DAL #6 #5 DRC DRC DRL #4 #3 PPD PPD #2 #1 #0 MCN MCN

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 MCN Machine position 0: Regardless of whether input is made in mm or inches, the machine position is displayed in mm for millimeter machines, or in inches for inch machines. 1: When input is made in mm, the machine position is displayed in mm, and when input is made in inches, the machine position is displayed in inches accordingly. PPD Relative position display when a coordinate system is set 0: Not preset 1: Preset

#3

- 136 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE If any of the following is executed when PPD is set to 1, the relative position display is preset to the same value as the absolute position display: (1) Manual reference position return (2) Coordinate system setting based on G92 (G50 for G code system A on the lathe system) (3) Workpiece coordinate system presetting based on G92.1 (G50.3 for G code system A on the lathe system) (4) When a T code for the lathe system is specified.

#4

DRL Relative position 0: The actual position displayed takes into account tool length offset. 1: The programmed position displayed does not take into account tool length offset. DRC When relative positions are displayed: 0: Values not excluding the amount of travel based on cutter compensation and tool nose radius compensation are displayed. 1: Values excluding the amount of travel based on cutter compensation and tool nose radius compensation (programmed positions) are displayed. DAL Absolute position 0: The actual position displayed takes into account tool length offset. 1: The programmed position displayed does not take into account tool length offset.

#5

#6

NOTE In lathe systems, whether to exclude a tool offset when displaying the absolute position is determined by the setting of bit 1 (DAP) of parameter No. 3129.
#7 DAC When an absolute position are displayed: 0: Values not excluding the amount of travel based on cutter compensation and tool nose radius compensation are displayed. 1: Values excluding the amount of travel based on cutter compensation and tool nose radius compensation (programmed positions) are displayed.
#7 3105 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 DPS #1 PCF #0 DPF

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 DPF The actual speed is: 0: Not displayed 1: Displayed PCF Addition of the movement of the PMC-controlled axes to the actual speed display 0: Added 1: Not added DPS The actual spindle speed is: 0: Not displayed 1: Displayed
- 137 -

#1

#2

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 3106 #6 DAK #5 SOV #4 OPH #3 #2 #1

B-63950EN/04

#0 DHD

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit #0 DHD On the program screen: 0: Only a selected path can be edited and displayed. 1: Multiple paths can be edited and displayed at the same time. OPH The operation history screen is: 0: Not displayed. 1: Displayed. SOV A spindle override value is: 0: Not displayed. 1: Displayed.

#4

#5

NOTE This parameter is valid only when bit 2 (DPS) of parameter No. 3105 is set to 1.
#6 DAK Specifies whether to display coordinates in the program coordinate system or workpiece coordinate system as absolute coordinates when the 3-dimensional coordinate conversion mode, the tilted working plane command mode or the workpiece setting error compensation mode is set. 0: Display coordinates in the program coordinate system. 1: Display coordinates in the workpiece coordinate system.
#7 3107 #6 #5 #4 SOR #3 GSC #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit path #3 GSC The feedrate to be displayed: 0: Is a feedrate per minute. 1: Follows the setting of bit 5 (FSS) of parameter No. 3191. SOR Display of the program directory 0: Programs are listed in the order of registration. 1: Programs are listed in the order of name.
#7 3108 JSP #6 SLM #5 #4 WCI #3 #2 PCT #1 #0

#4

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #2 PCT For modal T display on the program check screen: 0: A specified T value is displayed. 1: HD.T and NX.T are displayed. Values displayed follow bit 1 of parameter No. 13200.
- 138 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
WCI On the workpiece coordinate system screen, a counter input is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. SLM The spindle load meter is: 0: Not displayed. 1: Displayed.

#4

#6

NOTE This parameter is valid only when bit 2 (DPS) of parameter No. 3105 is set to 1.
#7 JSP On the current position display screen and program check screen, jog feed is: 0: Not displayed. 1: Displayed. In manual operation mode, the jog feedrate is displayed. In automatic operation mode, the dry run feedrate is displayed. In each case, the feedrate to which a manual feedrate override has been applied is displayed.
#7 3109 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 IKY #1 DWT #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #1 DWT Characters G and W in the display of tool wear/geometry compensation amount 0: The characters are displayed at the left of each number. 1: The characters are not displayed. IKY On the tool offset screen and workpiece shift screen (T series), soft key [INPUT] is: 0: Displayed. 1: Not displayed.
#7 3110 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 OFA

#2

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 OFA The axis names on the offset screen and fourth-axis/fifth-axis offset screen are: 0: Fixed to be "X", "Z", and "Y" ("E" and "5" on the fourth-axis/fifth-axis offset screen). 1: Parameter-set axis names.
#7 3111 NPA #6 OPS #5 OPM #4 #3 #2 SVP #1 SPS #0 SVS

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit path

- 139 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#0 SVS Servo setting screen and servo tuning screen 0: Not displayed 1: Displayed SPS Spindle tuning screen 0: Not displayed 1: Displayed

B-63950EN/04

#1

#2

SVP Spindle synchronization errors displayed on the spindle tuning screen 0: Instantaneous values are displayed. 1: Peak-hold values are displayed. Spindle synchronization errors are displayed on the side of the spindle that functions as a slave axis in spindle synchronization control. OPM Operating monitor 0: Not displayed 1: Displayed OPS The speedometer on the operating monitor screen indicates: 0: Spindle motor speed 1: Spindle speed NPA Action taken when an alarm is generated or when an operator message is entered 0: The display shifts to the alarm or message screen. 1: The display does not shift to the alarm or message screen.

#5

#6

#7

NOTE When MANUAL GUIDE i is provided, bit 7 (NPA) of parameter No. 3111 must be set to 0. (If this bit is set to 1, a warning message is issued at power-on.)
#7 3112 #6 #5 #4 #3 EAH #2 OMH #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #2 OMH The external operator message history screen is: 0: Not displayed. 1: Displayed. EAH Messages of the external alarm/macro alarm in alarm or operation history: 0: Not recorded 1: Recorded

#3

NOTE This parameter is valid when bit 7 (HAL) of parameter No. 3196 is set to 0.
#7 3113 MS1 #6 MS0 #5 DCL #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 HMC

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit


- 140 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
HMC The contents of the external operator message history: 0: Cannot be erased. 1: Can be erased.

#0

NOTE This parameter is valid when bit 3 (SOH) of parameter No. 11354 is set to 1.
#5 DCL The touch panel compensation screen is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. Set this parameter to 0 usually. Touch panel compensation becomes necessary only when the panel is replaced or memory all clear operation is performed. Set this parameter to 1 only when performing touch panel compensation. Upon completion of compensation, set this parameter to 0. MS0 MS1 Set the combination of the number of characters and the number of messages to be preserved in the external operator message history.
Parameter MS0=0 MS0=1 MS0=0 MS0=1 MS1=0 MS1=0 MS1=1 MS1=1 Maximum number of characters 255 200 100 50 Number of messages 8 10 18 32

#6 #7

NOTE 1 Although up to 255 characters can be specified for each external operator message, you can use the combination of bits 6 (MS0) and 7 (MS1) of parameter No. 3113 to limit the number of characters and select the number of messages to be preserved in the external operator message history. 2 The settings of bits 6 (MS0) and 7 (MS1) of parameter No. 3113 take effect the next time the power is turned on. The external operator message history is erased at that time. 3 Even though you change the settings of bits 6 (MS0) and 7 (MS1) of parameter No. 3113, the alarm PW0000, "POWER MUST BE OFF" is not issued. You must however turn on the power again before the new settings can take effect. 4 If text (such as single-byte katakana or kanji characters) is entered in character code, the number of characters recorded in the external operator message history may be smaller than the maximum number of characters set by bits 6 (MS0) and 7 (MS1) of parameter No. 3113.
#7 3114 #6 ICU #5 IGR #4 IMS #3 ISY #2 IOF #1 IPR #0 IPO

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit


- 141 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#0 IPO When the

B-63950EN/04

function key is pressed while the position display screen is being

displayed: 0: The screen is changed. 1: The screen is not changed. #1 IPR When the 0: 1: #2 function key is pressed while the program screen is being displayed:

The screen is changed. The screen is not changed. function key is pressed while the offset/setting screen is being

IOF When the

displayed: 0: The screen is changed. 1: The screen is not changed. #3 ISY When the 0: 1: #4 function key is pressed while the system screen is being displayed:

The screen is changed. The screen is not changed. function key is pressed while the message screen is being displayed:

IMS When the 0: 1:

The screen is changed. The screen is not changed. function key is pressed while the custom or graphic screen is being

#5

IGR When the

displayed: 0: The screen is changed. 1: The screen is not changed. #6 ICU When the 0: 1: function key is pressed while the custom screen is being displayed:

The screen is changed. The screen is not changed.


#7 #6 #5 APLx #4 PGA #3 NDFx #2 #1 NDAx #0 NDPx

3115

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 NDPx The current position is: 0: Displayed. 1: Not displayed.

NOTE When using the electronic gear box (EGB) function, set 1 for the EGB dummy axis to disable current position display.
#1 NDAx The current position and the amount of the movement to be made in absolute and relative coordinates are: 0: Displayed. 1: Not displayed.
- 142 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

#3

NDFx In calculation for actual cutting feedrate display, the feedrate of a selected axis is: 0: Considered. 1: Not considered. PGAx In the high speed program check mode, the machine position on each axis is: 0: Displayed according to the setting of bit 7 (PGM) of parameter No. 11320. 1: Displayed with machine coordinates used for program checking.

#4

NOTE 1 When PMC axis select signal EAX*<G0136> is set to 1 for an axis, the actual machine coordinate value on the axis is indicated regardless of the settings of bit 7 (PGM) of parameter No. 11320 and bit 4 (PGA) of parameter No. 3115. 2 In diagnosis No. 301 (machine position), actual machine coordinates are always displayed regardless of the settings of bit 7 (PGM) of parameter No. 11320 and bit 4 (PGA) of parameter No. 3115.
#5 APLx When the active offset value modification mode based on manual feed is selected, the relative position display is automatically: 0: Not preset. 1: Preset. Use this parameter when returning a modified offset value to the original value before modification in the active offset value modification mode based on manual feed. The offset value can be returned to the original value by making a movement on the axis by manual feed so that the relative position display (counter) indicates the position 0.
#7 3116 MDC #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 PWR #1 #0

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit path #2 PWR Alarm SW0100, PARAMETER ENABLE SWITCH ON, which is issued when bit 0 (PWE) of setting parameter No. 8900 is set to 1, is cleared by: 0: 1: #7 + .

or turning on the external reset.

MDC Maintenance information data: 0: Cannot be erased entirely. 1: Can be erased entirely.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 SPP #0

3117

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

- 143 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#1

B-63950EN/04

SPP When a serial spindle is used, the position coder signal pulse data based on the one-rotation signal is: 0: Not displayed on diagnosis screen No. 445. 1: Displayed on diagnosis screen No. 445.

NOTE 1 For a spindle not connected, 0 is indicated. 2 To display this data, the following conditions must be met: <1> FANUC's spindle amplifier and serial spindle are used. <2> The serial spindle detects the one-rotation signal. To detect the one-rotation signal accurately, spindle orientation must be performed. This operation must be performed just once after the power is turned on and is not needed subsequently. To determine whether the one-rotation signal has been detected or not, check the serial spindle status signals (PC1DEA <F0047.0>, PC1DEB <F0051.0>, FC1DEC <F0170.0>, and PC1DED <F0268.0>).
#7 3119 #6 #5 #4 #3 TPA #2 DDS #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#2 DDS The touch panel is: 0: Enabled. 1: Disabled. Set this parameter to 1 when disabling the touch panel temporarily, for example, at start-up time. TPA When the option for the external touch panel interface is selected, the external touch panel interface connection is: 0: Valid. 1: Invalid. For an external touch panel (called ETP hereinafter), the RS-232C serial port 2 (JD36A or JD54) on the main board of the CNC is used. When using ETP, set bit 3 (TPA) of parameter No. 3119 to 0. By this setting, JD36A or JD54 is used for ETP, regardless of the setting of I/O CHANNELI/O device selectionof the existing parameters Nos. 0021 to 0023. For other I/O devices, use JD56A and so forth. By the setting above, the settings of the existing parameters Nos. 0100 and 0121 to 0123 become invalid for channel 2 (JD36A or JD54), and the following settings are applied at all times: - Baud rate : 19200 bps - Stop bit : 1 bit - Parity check : Even parity

#3

- 144 -

B-63950EN/04 3122

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Time interval used to record time data in operation history

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word path min 0 to 1440 When history data is recorded within a set time period, the time for each set time period is recorded in the history data. When 0 is set, the specification of a time period of 10 minutes is assumed.
Time required before a screen saver is activated

3123

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Byte path min 0 to 127 After a time (in minutes) set in parameter No. 3123 passes without key operation, the NC screen is erased automatically. Pressing a key causes the NC screen to reappear.

NOTE 1 Setting 0 disables automatic screen erasure. 2 This function cannot be used together with manual screen erasure. If 1 or a larger value is set in this parameter, manual screen erasure is disabled.
#7 3124 D08 #7 3125 D16 #7 3126 D24 #7 3127 D32 #6 D07 #6 D15 #6 D23 #6 D31 #5 D06 #5 D14 #5 D22 #5 D30 #4 D05 #4 D13 #4 D21 #4 D29 #3 D04 #3 D12 #3 D20 #3 D28 #2 D03 #2 D11 #2 D19 #2 D27 #1 D02 #1 D10 #1 D18 #1 D26 #0 D01 #0 D09 #0 D17 #0 D25

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path D01 to D32 Set a group of G codes to be displayed on the program check screen. The table below indicates the correspondence between bits and G code groups. The setting of a bit has the following meaning: 0: Displays the G code group corresponding to a bit. 1: Does not display the G code group corresponding to a bit.
Parameter D01 D02 D03 : D32 G code group 01 02 03 : 32

- 145 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
3128 Retracement time for deleting alarm data from the alarm history

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word path sec 0 to 255 From the alarm history, the alarm data that occurred during a set period of time back from the power-off time is deleted. When 0 is set, a retracement time of 1 second is assumed to be specified.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 MRE MRE #1 DAP #0 DRP

3129

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 DRP For relative coordinate display: 0: The actual position considering a tool offset (tool movement) is displayed. 1: The programmed position excluding a tool offset (tool movement) is displayed. DAP For absolute coordinate display: 0: The actual position considering a tool offset (tool movement) is displayed. 1: The programmed position excluding a tool offset (tool movement) is displayed.

#1

NOTE In machining center systems, whether to exclude the tool length offset when displaying the absolute position is determined according to the setting of bit 6 (DAL) of parameter No. 3104.
#2 MRE When mirror image is used, relative coordinates are: 0: Updated with respect to the machine coordinates. 1: Updated with respect to the absolute coordinates. Set this parameter to 1 when handling relative coordinates in the same way as for the lathe system of the FS16i/18i/21i.
3130 Axis display order for current position display screens

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte axis [Valid data range] 0 to 32 Set the order in which axes are displayed on current position display screens (absolute, relative overall, and handle interrupt screens).
3131 Subscript of axis name

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte axis [Valid data range] 0 to 9, 65 to 90 In order to distinguish axes under parallel operation, synchronization control, and tandem control, specify a subscript for each axis name.

- 146 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Setting value 0 1 to 9 65 to 90 Meaning Each axis is set as an axis other than a parallel axis, synchronization control axis, and tandem control axis. A set value is used as a subscript. A set letter (ASCII code) is used as a subscript.

[Example] When the axis name is X, a subscript is added as indicated below.


Setting value 0 1 77 83 Axis name displayed on a screen such as the position display screen X X1 XM XS

If a multi-path system is used, no extended axis name is used within a path, and no subscript is set for the axis names, then the path number is automatically used as the subscript for the axis names. To disable the display of axis name subscripts, set a blank (32) of ASCII code in the parameter for specifying an axis name subscript.

NOTE If even one axis in a path uses an extended axis name when bit 2 (EAS) of parameter No. 11308 is set to 0, subscripts cannot be used for axis names in the path.
3132 Axis name (absolute coordinate) for current position display

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte axis [Valid data range] 0 to 255 These parameters set the axis name for current position display. When G code system B or C is used, the axis name set in parameter No. 3132 is used for both absolute and relative coordinate axes. The values set in these parameters are used only for display. When 0 is set in this parameter, the setting of parameter No. 1020 is used. When an extended axis name is used, only the first character displayed is replaced.
3133 Axis name (relative coordinate) for current position display

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte axis [Valid data range] 0 to 255 These parameters set the axis name for current position display. When G code system B or C is used, the axis name set in parameter No. 3132 is used for both absolute and relative coordinate axes. The values set in these parameters are used only for display. When 0 is set in this parameter, the setting of parameter No. 1020 is used. When an extended axis name is used, only the first character displayed is replaced.
3134 Data display order of each axis on the workpiece coordinate system setting screen and workpiece coordinate system shift amount setting screen

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte axis [Valid data range] 0 to Number of controlled axes

- 147 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

Set the data display order of each axis on the workpiece coordinate system setting screen (M series/T series) and workpiece coordinate system shift amount setting screen (T series). No data is displayed for an axis with 0 set in this parameter.
3135 Number of decimal places in actual feedrate display

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 3 Set the number of decimal places in actual feedrate display. In the case of inch input, the number of decimal places is a set value plus 2. [Setting value] 0 : Metric input Displayed without a decimal point Inch input Displayed using the second decimal place 1 : Metric input Displayed using the first decimal place Inch input Displayed using the third decimal place 2 : Metric input Displayed using the second decimal place Inch input Displayed using the fourth decimal place 3 : Metric input Displayed using the third decimal place Inch input Displayed using the fifth decimal place
3141 3142 3143 3144 3145 3146 3147 Path name (1st character) Path name (2nd character) Path name (3rd character) Path name (4th character) Path name (5th character) Path name (6th character) Path name (7th character)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] See the character-code correspondence table. Specify a path name with codes. Any character string consisting of alphanumeric characters, katakana characters, and special characters with a maximum length of seven characters can be displayed as a series name.

NOTE 1 For characters and codes, see Appendix A, CHARACTER CODE LIST. 2 When 0 is set in parameter No. 3141, PATH1(,PATH2...) are displayed as path names. 3 When optional path name display is enlarged (with bit 2 (PNE) of parameter No. 11350 set to 1), only alphanumeric characters are displayed. If any other type of characters are set, spaces are displayed instead.
3160 Setting of MDI unit type

[Input type] Parameter input


- 148 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Data type] Byte [Valid data range] 0 to 4 Set the type of an MDI unit when the type of an MDI unit is not automatically identified.
Setting value 0 1 2 3 4 Type Depends on the system type and indicator type. Standard MDI unit for the lathe system Standard MDI unit for the machining center system Small MDI unit for the lathe system Small MDI unit for the machining center system

When 0 is set in this parameter, the type of a MDI unit is determined as follows:
Type of path control When the type for the lathe system is used with path 1 When the type for the machining center system is used with path 1
#7 3191 #6

Type of indicator Type of 12 horizontal soft keys Type of 7 horizontal soft keys Type of 12 horizontal soft keys Type of 7 horizontal soft keys

Type Standard MDI unit for the lathe system Small MDI unit for the lathe system Standard MDI unit for the machining center system Small MDI unit for the machining center system
#2 WSI #1 #0

#5 FSS

#4

#3 SSF

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #2 WSI On the workpiece zero point offset screen, the soft key [INPUT] is: 0: Displayed. 1: Not displayed. SSF On the setting screen, the soft key for confirming data input is: 0: Not displayed. 1: Displayed. FSS Feedrate display is: 0: Switched between feedrate per minute and feedrate per revolution depending on the operating state. 1: Fixed to feedrate per revolution irrespective of the operating state.
#7 3192 PLD #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 TRA #1 T2P #0

#3

#5

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #1 T2P When more than one point is pressed on the touch panel: 0: The position at the center of gravity is obtained. 1: The point pressed first is obtained.

- 149 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE 1 Even when bit parameter T2P is set to 1, the position at the center of gravity is assumed to be pressed if two or more points are pressed within a scan period (32 ms) of the touch panel. 2 If a C executer application or the like has a touch panel drag (move in pressed state) function, set parameter T2P to 0.
#2 TRA If a point on the touch panel is kept pressed for a time specified in parameter No. 3197 or longer, 0: An alarm is not raised. 1: An alarm SR5303, TOUCH PANEL ERROR is raised.

NOTE 1 If an C executer application or the like has a touch panel repeat (continue pressing) function, set parameter TRA to 0. 2 In open CNC, the parameter is valid just for the CNC screen display function.
#7 PLD When the current position is indicated for a path, and when the program check screen is displayed in a two- or three-path system, the function for displaying servo load meters and spindle load meters is : 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
#7 3194 #6 #5 #4 #3 DPM #2 DPA #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #2 DPA The absolute coordinates, relative coordinates, and remaining move amount during diameter/radius specification switching are displayed: 0: According to the specification during switching. 1: According to the setting of bit 3 (DIAx) of parameter No. 1006. DPM The machine coordinates during diameter/radius specification switching are displayed: 0: According to the setting of bit 3 (DIAx) of parameter No. 1006. 1: According to the specification during switching.
#7 3195 EKE #6 HDE #5 HKE #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

#3

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #5 HKE A key operation history is: 0: Recorded. 1: Not recorded. HDE A DI/DO history is: 0: Recorded. 1: Not recorded.
- 150 -

#6

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
EKE The [ALL CLEAR] soft key for clearing all history data is: 0: Not displayed. 1: Displayed.
#7 #6 HOM #5 #4 #3 HMV #2 HPM #1 HWO #0 HTO

#7

3196

HAL

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 HTO A modification history of tool offset data is: 0: Not recorded. 1: Recorded. HWO A modification history of workpiece offset data/extended workpiece offset data/workpiece shift (T series) is: 0: Not recorded. 1: Recorded. HPM A modification history of parameters is: 0: Not recorded. 1: Recorded. HMV A modification history of custom macro common variables is: 0: Not recorded. 1: Recorded. HOM A history of external operator messages and macro messages ((#3006) is: 0: Recorded. 1: Not recorded. HAL When an alarm is issued, additional information (modal data, absolute coordinates, and machine coordinates present at the issuance of the alarm) is: 0: Recorded in the operation history and alarm history. 1: Not recorded in the operation history and alarm history. To record as many alarm history items as possible, rather than detailed alarm information, set 1.
Detection time of continuous pressing on touch panel

#1

#2

#3

#6

#7

3197

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word sec 0 to 255 Set a period of continuous pressing on the touch panel which causes alarm to be raised. When 0 is set, it is equivalent to 20.

NOTE This parameter is valid when bit 2 (TRA) of parameter No. 3192 is set to 1.

- 151 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 3201 #6 NPE #5 N99 #4 #3 #2 REP #1 RAL

B-63950EN/04 #0 RDL

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 RDL When a program is registered by input/output device external control 0: The new program is registered following the programs already registered. 1: All registered programs are deleted, then the new program is registered. Note that programs which are protected from being edited are not deleted.

NOTE Registered programs are placed in the background default folder set in the program list screen. Before manipulating this signal, set the default folder in the background correctly.
#1 RAL When programs are registered by external I/O device control: 0: All programs are registered. 1: Only one program is registered.

NOTE Registered programs are placed in the background default folder set in the program list screen. Before manipulating this signal, set the default folder in the background correctly.
#2 REP Action in response to an attempt to register a program whose number is the same as that of an existing program 0: An alarm is generated. 1: The existing program is deleted, then the new program is registered. Note that if the existing program is protected from being edited, it is not deleted, and an alarm is generated. N99 With an M99 block, when bit 6 (NPE) of parameter No. 3201 is set to 0, program registration is assumed to be: 0: Completed 1: Not completed NPE With an M02, M30, or M99 block, program registration is assumed to be: 0: Completed 1: Not completed
#7 3202 #6 PSR #5 #4 NE9 #3 #2 #1 #0 NE8

#5

#6

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 NE8 Editing of subprograms with program numbers 8000 to 8999 0: Not inhibited 1: Inhibited When this parameter is set to 1, the following editing operations are disabled: (1) Program deletion (Even when deletion of all programs is specified, programs with program numbers 8000 to 8999 are not deleted.)
- 152 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
(2) Program output (Even when outputting all programs is specified, programs with program numbers 8000 to 8999 are not output.) (3) Program number search (4) Program editing of registered programs (5) Program registration (6) Program collation (7) Displaying programs

NOTE This parameter setting does not affect the following programs: (1) Programs on the Data Server (2) Programs for running and editing memory card programs on a memory card
#4 NE9 Editing of subprograms with program numbers 9000 to 9999 0: Not inhibited 1: Inhibited When this parameter is set to 1, the following editing operations are disabled: (1) Program deletion (Even when deletion of all programs is specified, programs with program numbers 9000 to 9999 are not deleted.) (2) Program output (Even when outputting all programs is specified, programs with program numbers 9000 to 9999 are not output.) (3) Program number search (4) Program editing of registered programs (5) Program registration (6) Program collation (7) Displaying programs

NOTE This parameter setting does not affect the following programs: (1) Programs on the Data Server (2) Programs for running and editing memory card programs on a memory card
#6 PSR Search for the program number of a protected program 0: Disabled 1: Enabled
#7 3203 MCL #6 MER #5 MZE #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #5 MZE After MDI operation is started, program editing during operation is: 0: Enabled 1: Disabled MER When the last block of a program has been executed at single block operation in the MDI mode, the executed block is: 0: Not deleted 1: Deleted
- 153 -

#6

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE When MER is set to 0, the program is deleted if the end-of-record mark (%) is read and executed. (The mark % is automatically inserted at the end of a program.)
#7 MCL Whether a program prepared in the MDI mode is cleared by reset 0: Not deleted 1: Deleted
#7 3204 #6 MKP #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 OPC #0 PAR

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 PAR When a small MDI unit is used, characters "[" and "]" are: 0: Used as "[" and "]". 1: Used as "(" and ")".

NOTE When a multi-path system is used, the setting for path 1 is followed.
#1 OPC In MEM/EDIT/RMT mode, a program search or cueing operation: 0: Causes a warning when automatic operation has been started (automatic operation start signal STL = 1) or paused (feed hold signal SPL = 1). 1: Causes a warning during automatic operation (automatic operation signal OP = 1). MKP When M02, M30, or EOR(%) is executed during MDI operation, the created MDI program is: 0: Erased automatically. 1: Not erased automatically.

#6

NOTE If the bit 6 (MER) of parameter No. 3203 is set to 1, executing the last block provides a choice of whether to automatically erase a created program.
#7 3205 #6 #5 #4 OSC #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #4 OSC On the offset screen, offset value erasure by a soft key is: 0: Enabled. 1: Disabled.
#7 3206 NS2 #6 #5 S2K #4 PHS #3 #2 #1 MIF #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit


- 154 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
MIF Editing of the maintenance information screen is: 0: Not prohibited. 1: Prohibited. PHS Operation history signal selection: 0: Does not interact with parameters. Operation history signal selection is added or deleted on the operation history signal selection screen. Changing the settings of parameters Nos. 24901 to 24920, Nos. 12801 to 12820, Nos. 12841 to 12860, or Nos. 12881 to 12900 has no effect on operation history signal selection. Changes to the signals of the addresses specified by parameters Nos. 24901 to 24920, Nos. 12801 to 12820, Nos. 12841 to 12860, or Nos. 12881 to 12900 are not recorded in the history. 1: Interacts with parameters. Operation history signal selection can be performed either on the operation history signal selection screen or by setting parameters.

#1

#4

NOTE Setting this parameter to 1 reflects the current operation history signal selection data on parameters Nos. 24901 to 24920 and Nos. 12801 to 12900.
#5 S2K In CNC screen dual display function, 0: Key control is selected by DI signal <G0295.7>. 1: Key control is selected by pushing at left upper corner on the screen. (Touch panel only) NS2 CNC screen dual display function is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
#7 3207 #6 TPP #5 VRN #4 #3 #2 #1 EXS #0

#7

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #1 EXS Soft key expansion of the machine menu function is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. VRN On the custom macro variable screen, the variable names of common variables #500 to #549 are: 0: Not displayed. 1: Displayed. TPP When a virtual MDI key is pressed, signal TPPRS <F0006.0> is 0: Not output. 1: Output

#5

#6

- 155 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 3208 #6 #5 PSC #4 OFY #3 NOS #2 #1

B-63950EN/04 #0 SKY

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit #0 SKY The function key 0: 1: #3 Enabled. Disabled. on the MDI panel is:

NOS The one-touch menu is 0: Displayed. 1: Not displayed. OFY The offset screen can be used to display and enter: 0: Only conventional offset values. 1: Y-axis offset values as well. The conventional Y-axis offset screen cannot be displayed. Only the 10.4/15-inch screen is acceptable; the setting of this parameter is invalid to the 9-inch screen. For both of the T series and M series, the parameter setting is valid when the option for tool position compensation (machining center system) is enabled (the option for offset memory C is also required). PSC When the path is switched based on the path switch signal or operation for switching to the loader path: 0: The screen display is switched to the last selected screen of the path. 1: The same screen as for the path before switching is displayed.
Program protection (PSW)

#4

#5

3210

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word [Valid data range] 0 to 99999999 This parameter sets a password for protecting program Nos. 9000 to 9999. When a value other than zero is set in this parameter and this value differs from the keyword set in parameter No. 3211, bit 4 (NE9) of parameter No. 3202 for protecting program Nos. 9000 to 9999 is automatically set to 1. This disables the editing of program Nos. 9000 to 9999. Until the value set as the password is set as a keyword, NE9 cannot be set to 0 and the password cannot be modified.

NOTE 1 The state where password 0 and password keyword is referred to as the locked state. When an attempt is made to modify the password by MDI input operation in this state, the warning message "WRITE PROTECTED" is displayed to indicate that the password cannot be modified. When an attempt is made to modify the password with G10 (programmable parameter input), alarm PS0231, ILLEGAL FORMAT IN G10 L52 is issued. 2 When the value of the password is not 0, the parameter screen does not display the password. Care must be taken in setting a password.
- 156 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Program protection key (KEY)

3211

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word [Valid data range] 0 to 99999999 When the value set as the password (set in parameter No. 3210) is set in this parameter, the locked state is released and the user can now modify the password and the value set in bit 4 (NE9) of parameter No. 3202.

NOTE The value set in this parameter is not displayed. When the power is turned off, this parameter is set to 0.
3216 Increment in sequence numbers inserted automatically

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to 99999999 Set the increment for sequence numbers for automatic sequence number insertion (when bit 5 (SEQ) of parameter No. 0000 is set to 1.)
3220 Password (PSW)

[Input type] Locked parameter [Data type] 2-word [Valid data range] 0 to 99999999 This parameter sets a password (PSW). When a value other than 0 is set, a password is set. When a password is set, a blank is displayed in this parameter, and the state (locked state) where an operation such as program editing is locked is set. When password (PSW) = 0, namely, in the normal state, or when password (PSW) = keyword (KEY), namely, in the unlock state, this parameter can be set.
3221 Keyword (KEY)

[Input type] Locked parameter [Data type] 2-word [Valid data range] 0 to 99999999 When the same value as the password (PSW) is set in this parameter, the lock is released (unlock state). The value set in this parameter is not displayed. The value of this parameter is initialized to 0 automatically when the power is turned on. So, if the power is turned off in the unlock state then is turned on again, the lock state is automatically set.
3222 3223 Program protection range (minimum value) (PMIN) Program protection range (maximum value) (PMAX)

[Input type] Locked parameter [Data type] 2-word [Valid data range] 0 to 99999999 The programs in a range set here can be locked. Set the minimum program number and maximum program number of a desired range. Set these parameters to satisfy PMAX > PMIN.
- 157 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

These parameters can be set when password (PSW) = 0, namely, in the normal state, or when password (PSW) = keyword (KEY), namely in the unlock state. [Example] Parameter No. 3222 = 7000 Parameter No. 3223 = 8499 When the values above are set, the programs from O7000 to O8499 can be locked. When PMIN = 0, the specification of PMIN = 9000 is assumed. When PMAX = 0, the specification of PMAX = 9999 is assumed. So, when these parameters are set to the defaults, the programs from O9000 to O9999 are locked.

NOTE 1 Parameters Nos. 3220 to 3223 are neither punched nor read. 2 Parameters Nos. 3220 to 3223 are not cleared even when a parameter file clear operation is performed in the IPL state. 3 The values of a password (PSW) and keyword (KEY) are not displayed. When password (PSW) = 0, 0 is displayed in parameter No. 3220 to indicate that the normal state is set. 4 When a password (PSW) or keyword (KEY) is set, [+INPUT] has the same effect as [INPUT]. For example, if the input operation "1[+INPUT]" is performed when 99 is set in the keyword (KEY) parameter, 1 is set. 5 This parameter setting does not affect the following programs: - Programs on the Data Server - Programs saved in program storage files on a memory card
3225 3226

These parameters are related to Dual Check Safety. See Dual Check Safety CONNECTION MANUAL (B-64003EN) for details.
3227 3228 Selection of a block number of machine operation menu data (horizontal soft keys) Selection of a block number of machine operation menu data (vertical soft keys)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte [Valid data range] 0 to 98 These parameters select a block number of machine operation menu data stored in the FROM for soft key expansion in the machine operation menu function. When a 10.4-inch display is used, set a value in the parameter for the vertical or horizontal soft keys that are to be used for displaying a machine operation menu. In the parameter for the vertical or horizontal soft keys that are not to be displayed, set 0. When values are input in both parameters, parameter No. 3227 takes priority, and the machine operation menu is displayed in the horizontal soft keys. When a 15-inch display is used, set 0 in parameter No. 3227, and set the block number of a machine operation menu to be displayed in the vertical soft keys in parameter No. 3228.
#7 3233 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 PDM #0 PCE

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit


- 158 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
PCE Program editing is: 0: Performed in the word edit mode. 1: Performed in the character edit mode. PDM On the Data Server file list screen: 0: M198 operation folders and DNC operation files can be set. 1: Folders in the Data Server can be set as the foreground folder and background folder.

#0

#1

NOTE When an M198 external subprogram call or DNC operation is performed on the Data Server, set this bit to 0. For the foreground and background folders, refer to Chapter 12, "PROGRAM MANAGEMENT", in Part III in the OPERATORS MANUAL (B-63944EN).
3241 3242 3243 3244 3245 3246 3247 Character blinking in the AI contour control I mode (first character) Character blinking in the AI contour control I mode (second character) Character blinking in the AI contour control I mode (third character) Character blinking in the AI contour control I mode (fourth character) Character blinking in the AI contour control I mode (fifth character) Character blinking in the AI contour control I mode (sixth character) Character blinking in the AI contour control I mode (seventh character)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to 95 Set the first to seventh blinking characters in the AI contour control I mode by using ASCII codes represented as decimal numbers. When 0 is set in all of these parameters, "AICC 1" blinks. Code numbers 032 to 095 in the Appendix A, "CHARACTER CODE LIST" can be set.
3251 3252 3253 3254 3255 3256 3257 Character blinking in the AI contour control II mode (first character) Character blinking in the AI contour control II mode (second character) Character blinking in the AI contour control II mode (third character) Character blinking in the AI contour control II mode (fourth character) Character blinking in the AI contour control II mode (fifth character) Character blinking in the AI contour control II mode (sixth character) Character blinking in the AI contour control II mode (seventh character)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to 95 Set the first to seventh blinking characters in the AI contour control II mode by using ASCII codes represented as decimal numbers. When 0 is set in all of these parameters, "AICC 2" blinks.
- 159 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

Code numbers 032 to 095 in the Appendix A, "CHARACTER CODE LIST" can be set.
#7 3280 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 NLC

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 NLC Dynamic display language switching is: 0: Enabled. 1: Disabled. When dynamic display language switching is disabled, the language setting screen is not displayed. In this case, change the setting of parameter No. 3281 on the parameter screen then turn on the power again to switch the display language.
Display language

3281

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte [Valid data range] 0 to 17 Select a display language from the following: 0 : English 1 : Japanese 2 : German 3 : French 4 : Chinese(traditional characters) 5 : Italian 6 : Korean 7 : Spanish 8 : Dutch 9 : Danish 10 : Portuguese 11 : Polish 12 : Hungarian 13 : Swedish 14 : Czech 15 : Chinese(simplified characters) 16 : Russian 17 : Turkish If a number not indicated above is set, English is selected.
#7 3282 SPN #7 3283 RUS #7 3284 #6 HGL #6 CZE #6 #5 ITA #5 SWE #5 #4 CHS #4 HUN #4 #3 CHT #3 POL #3 #2 FRE #2 POR #2 #1 GER #1 DAN #1 #0 JPN #0 DTH #0 TRK

- 160 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE 1 When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued. 2 If six or more languages are selected, five languages are used according to the priority shown in the table below.

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit Select the languages to be used with the function for selecting five optional languages.
Priority <1> <2> <3> <4> <5> <6> <7> <8> <9> <10> <11> <12> <13> <14> <15> <16> <17>
#7 3290 KEY KEY #6 MCM MCM #5 GO2

Language JPN GER FRE CHT CHS ITA HGL SPN DTH DAN POR POL HUN SWE CZE RUS TRK
#4 IWZ IWZ #3 WZO WZO

Japanese German French Chinese(traditional characters) Chinese(simplified characters) Italian Korean Spanish Dutch Danish Portuguese Polish Hungarian Swedish Czech Russian Turkish
#2 #1 GOF GOF #0 WOF WOF

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 WOF Setting the tool offset value (tool wear offset) by MDI key input is: 0: Not disabled. 1: Disabled. (With parameters Nos. 3294 and 3295, set the offset number range in which updating the setting is to be disabled.)

NOTE When tool offset memory A is selected with the M series, the tool offset set in the parameter WOF is followed even if geometric compensation and wear compensation are not specified with the T series.
#1 GOF Setting the tool geometry offset value by MDI key input is: 0: Not disabled. 1: Disabled. (With parameters Nos. 3294 and 3295, set the offset number range in which updating the setting is to be disabled.)

- 161 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#3

B-63950EN/04

WZO Setting a workpiece zero point offset value and workpiece shift value (T series) by MDI key input is: 0: Not disabled. 1: Disabled. IWZ Setting a workpiece zero point offset value or workpiece shift value (T series) by MDI key input in the automatic operation activation or halt state is: 0: Not disabled. 1: Disabled. GO2 Setting the second geometric tool offset value by MDI key input is: 0: Disabled. 1: Not disabled. MCM Setting a custom macro variable by MDI key input is: 0: Enabled in any mode. 1: Enabled only in the MDI mode. KEY For memory protection keys: 0: The KEY1, KEY2, KEY3, and KEY4 signals are used. 1: Only the KEY1 signal is used.

#4

#5

#6

#7

NOTE 1 The functions of the signals depend on whether KEY=0 or KEY=1. When KEY = 0: - KEY1: Enables a tool offset value, workpiece zero point offset value, and workpiece shift value to be input. - KEY2: Enables setting data, macro variables, and tool life management value to be input. - KEY3: Enables program registration and editing. - KEY4: Enables PMC data (counter and data table) to be input. When KEY = 1: - KEY1: Enables program registration and editing, and enables PMC parameter input. - KEY2 to KEY4: Not used 2 When a multi-path system is used, the setting for path 1 is followed.
#7 3291 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 WPT

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 WPT The input of the tool wear compensation amount is: 0: Enabled according to memory protection key signal KEY1. 1: Enabled, regardless of the memory protection key signal KEY1.
Start number of tool offset values whose input by MDI is disabled Number of tool offset values (from the start number) whose input by MDI is disabled

3294 3295

[Input type] Parameter input


- 162 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to 999 When the modification of tool offset values by MDI key input is to be disabled using bits 0 (WOF) and 1 (GOF) of parameter No. 3290, parameters Nos. 3294 and 3295 are used to set the range where such modification is disabled. In parameter No. 3294, set the offset number of the start of tool offset values whose modification is disabled. In parameter No. 3295, set the number of such values. In the following cases, however, none of the tool offset values may be modified: When 0 or a negative value is set in parameter No. 3294 When 0 or a negative value is set in parameter No. 3295 When a value greater than the maximum tool offset number is set in parameter No. 3294 In the following case, a modification to the values ranging from the value set in parameter No. 3294 to the maximum tool offset number is disabled: When the value of parameter No. 3294 added to the value of parameter No. 3295 exceeds the maximum tool offset number When the offset value of a prohibited number is input through the MDI panel, the warning "WRITE PROTECT" is issued. [Example] When the following parameter settings are made, modifications to both of the tool geometry offset values and tool wear offset values corresponding to offset numbers 51 to 60 are disabled: Bit 1 (GOF) of parameter No. 3290 = 1 (to disable tool geometry offset value modification) Bit 0 (WOF) of parameter No. 3290 = 1 (to disable tool wear offset value modification) Parameter No. 3294 = 51 Parameter No. 3295 = 10 If the setting of bit 0 (WOF) of parameter No. 3290 is set to 0 without modifying the other parameter settings above, tool geometry offset value modification only is disabled, and tool wear offset value modification is enabled.
#7 3299 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 PKY

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit #0 PKY "Parameter write enable" is: 0: Set on the setting screen (bit 0 (PWE) of setting parameter No. 8900). 1: Set by the memory protection signal KEYP<G046.0>.
#7 3301 HDC #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 H16

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 H16 Bit map data of screen hard copies uses: 0: 256 colors. 1: 16 colors. HDC A screen hard copy function is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
- 163 -

#7

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
3321 to 3336 Screen number assigned to the 1st vertical soft key to Screen number assigned to the 16th vertical soft key

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 1 to 10000 Assign a screen number to be displayed as a shortcut to a vertical soft key. The 1st to 8th vertical soft keys are displayed on page 1, and the 9th to 16th vertical soft keys are displayed on page 2. When specifying page 2, be sure to specify "Display of next page" on each page. When not specifying page 2, set 0 for the 9th to 16th soft keys. In this case, page 2 is not used, so that "Display of next page" need not be specified on page 1.

(1) CNC operation screens


Screen No. 99 100 101 102 103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 113 114 115 Screen name Display of next page(*1) Absolute position display(*2) Relative position display(*2) Overall position display(*2) Overall position display(*3) Handle screen Monitor screen 3-dimensional manual feed Program Program directory display Next block Program check Time display Manual value specification Program restart Offset display Setting parameter Screen No. 143 144 145 146 147 148 149 150 151 152 153 154 155 156 157 158 159 Screen name Spindle setting Spindle adjustment Spindle monitor FSSB amplifier setting FSSB axis setting FSSB amplifier maintenance Servo setting Servo adjustment Periodic maintenance: State Periodic maintenance: Machine Periodic maintenance: NC 8-level data protection: Operation level setting 8-level data protection: Password change 8-level data protection: Protection level setting Protection against wrong operations Protection against wrong operations Offset range setting screen Protection against wrong operations External workpiece origin offset range setting screen Protection against wrong operations Workpiece origin offset range setting screen Protection against wrong operations Y-axis offset range setting screen Protection against wrong operations Workpiece shift range setting screen Servo guide: Y-TIME Servo guide: XY Servo guide: CIRCLE Servo guide: FOURIER Servo guide: BODE Servo guide: Channel setting Alarm: Details Alarm: All paths Waveform diagnosis: Graph Waveform diagnosis: Parameter Operation history Operation history signal selection Cartridge management Tool management

116 117 118 119 120 121 122 123 124 125 126 127 128 129 130 131 132

Coordinate system display Software operator's panel Y-axis offset Workpiece coordinate system shift Second geometry offset Tool geometry data Precision level Chopping Chuck/tail Language Parameter Diagnosis System configuration Memory contents display Pitch error compensation Machining adjustment Color setting

160 161 162 163 164 165 166 167 168 169 170 171 172 173 174 175 176

- 164 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Screen name Maintenance information Touch panel calibration(*2) Parameter adjustment code group 3-dimensional error compensation External operator message Alarm history External operator message history Drawing parameter Tool path drawing Screen No. 177 178 179 180 181 182 183 184 185 186 Screen name Power Mate CNC manager: Absolute coordinates Power Mate CNC manager: Machine coordinates Power Mate CNC manager: Parameter Power Mate CNC manager: Message Power Mate CNC manager: Diagnosis Power Mate CNC manager: System configuration Macro: Custom Macro: Execution Macro: Conversation Macro: Auxiliary

Screen No. 133 134 135 136 137 138 139 140 141 142

*1 *2 *3

Definition for feeding vertical soft key pages Specifiable with a 10.4-inch display unit only Specifiable with a 15-inch display unit only

(2) PMC operation screens


Screen No. 200 201 202 203 204 205 206 207 208 209 210 211 212 213 214 215 216 217 218 219 220 Screen name PMC signal status PMC IO link PMC alarm PMC input/output PMC timer PMC counter PMC keep relay PMC data table PMC trace PMC trace setting PMC program directory display PMC ladder diagram display PMC title setting PMC configuration parameter setting PMC general setting PMC status PMC system parameter PMC IO assignment PMC symbol PMC message PMC online setting

(3) Communication operation screens


Screen No. Screen name Ethernet setting 300 [Built-in port] Common 301 [Built-in port] FOCAS2/Ethernet 302 [Built-in port] FTP transfer 303 [Built-in port] PING 304 [Built-in port] Communication state 305 [Built-in port] Task state 306 [PCMCIA] Common 307 [PCMCIA] FOCAS2/Ethernet 308 [PCMCIA] FTP transfer 309 [PCMCIA] PING 310 [PCMCIA] Communication state 311 [PCMCIA] Task state 312 [Board] Common 313 [Board] FOCAS2/Ethernet 314 [Board] Data server 315 [Board] PING 316 [Board] Communication state 317 [Board] Task state 318 [Board] DS mode 319 [Board] DS format Ethernet log 320 [Built-in/PCMCIA] Overall 321 [Built-in/PCMCIA] Common 322 [Built-in/PCMCIA] FOCAS2/Ethernet 323 [Built-in/PCMCIA] FTP transfer Profibus setting 324 [MASTER] Overall 325 [MASTER] Bus parameter 326 [MASTER] Slave table 327 [MASTER] Communication state 328 [MASTER] Slave parameter 329 [MASTER] Module data 330 [MASTER] DI/DO address 331 [MASTER] Mode

- 165 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

4.19
3400

PARAMETERS OF PROGRAMS (1 OF 4)
#7 #6 SMX #5 PGD #4 #3 #2 #1 MGC #0 MGO

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 MGO If the program restart M/S/T/B code output function is used: 0: When bit 6 (MOA) of parameter No. 7300 is set to 0, the last M code only is output. When bit 6 (MOA) of parameter No. 7300 is set to 1, M codes are output in a specified order. 1: When bit 6 (MOA) of parameter No. 7300 is set to 0, the last M code of each M code group is output in the order of groups. When bit 6 (MOA) of parameter No. 7300 is set to 1, M codes are output in the order of groups.

NOTE This parameter is valid only when the optional M code grouping function is used and bit 7 (MOU) of parameter No. 7300 is set to 1. If this parameter is set to 1, M codes of group 0 are not output. If this parameter is set to 1, M codes are output in the order of groups starting from the smallest group number.
#1 MGC When a single block specifies multiple M commands, an M code group check is: 0: Made. 1: Not made. PGD The G10.9 command (programmable diameter/radius specification switching) is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.

#5

NOTE 1 The option for the diameter and radius switching function is required. 2 When the G10.9 command is enabled by this parameter, signal-based diameter/radius switching is disabled.
#6 SMX An S code specified in a block that specifies G92 (G50 with G code system A of the T series) is: 0: Regarded as a maximum spindle speed command. 1: Not regarded as a maximum spindle speed command (but regarded as a spindle speed command).
#7 3401 GSC #6 GSB #5 ABS ABS #4 MAB MAB #3 #2 #1 #0 DPI DPI

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

- 166 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
DPI When a decimal point is omitted in an address that can include a decimal point 0: The least input increment is assumed. (Normal decimal point input) 1: The unit of mm, inches, degree, or second is assumed. (Pocket calculator type decimal point input) MAB Switching between the absolute and incremental programming in MDI operation 0: Performed by G90 or G91 1: Depending on the setting of bit 5 (ABS) of parameter No. 3401

#0

#4

NOTE When G code system A of the lathe system is used, this parameter is invalid.
#5 ABS Program command in MDI operation 0: Assumed as an incremental programming 1: Assumed as an absolute programming

NOTE ABS is valid when bit 4 (MAB) of parameter No. 3401 is set to 1. When G code system A of the lathe system is used, this parameter is invalid.
#6 GSB The G code system is set. #7 GSC
GSC 0 0 1 GSB 0 1 0 G code G code system A G code system B G code system C

NOTE G code system B and G code system C are optional functions. When no option is selected, G code system A is used, regardless of the setting of these parameters.
#7 3402 G23 G23 #6 CLR CLR G70 #5 #4 FPM #3 G91 G91 G19 G18 #2 #1 #0 G01 G01

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 G01 G01 Mode entered when the power is turned on or when the control is cleared 0: G00 mode (positioning) 1: G01 mode (linear interpolation) G18 Plane selected when power is turned on or when the control is cleared 0: G17 mode (plane XY) 1: G18 mode (plane ZX) G19 Plane selected when power is turned on or when the control is cleared 0: The setting of bit 1 (G18) of parameter No. 3402 is followed. 1: G19 mode (plane YZ)
- 167 -

#1

#2

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
When this bit is set to 1, set bit 1 (G18) of parameter No. 3402 to 0. #3 G91 When the power is turned on or when the control is cleared 0: G90 mode (absolute programming) 1: G91 mode (incremental programming) FPM At power-on time or in the cleared state: 0: G99 or G95 mode (feed per revolution) is set. 1: G98 or G94 mode (feed per minute) is set. G70 The commands for inch input and metric input are: 0: G20 (inch input) and G21 (metric input). 1: G70 (inch input) and G71 (metric input).

B-63950EN/04

#4

#5

#6

CLR Reset button on the MDI panel, external reset signal, reset and rewind signal, and emergency stop signal 0: Cause reset state. 1: Cause clear state. For the reset and clear states, refer to Appendix in the OPERATORS MANUAL. G23 When the power is turned on 0: G22 mode (stored stroke check on) 1: G23 mode (stored stroke check off)
#7 #6 ADB #5 CIR #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

#7

3403

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #5 CIR When neither the distance (I, J, K) from a start point to the center nor an arc radius (R) is specified in circular interpolation (G02, G03) or helical interpolation (G02, G03): 0: The tool moves to an end point by linear interpolation. 1: An alarm PS0022, R OR I,J,K COMMAND NOT FOUND is issued. ADB When the same address two or more times are specified in one block: 0: The address specified last is valid. 1: It is treated as a program error and the alarm PS5074, "ADDRESS DUPLICATION ERROR" is issued.

#6

- 168 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE The following notes apply when this parameter is set to 1: 1 When two or more M codes are acceptable to one block, up to three M codes can be specified in the same block. Specifying more than three results in the alarm PS5074. 2 You can specify any number of G codes in the same block as long as they belong to different groups. Specifying G codes belonging to the same group causes the alarm PS5074. You can however specify any number of G90 and G91 codes in the same block as they cause no alarm. 3 The alarm is not caused by blocks which call a custom macro or execution macro. 4 When G code system A is used with the lathe system, specifying an absolute programming and incremental programming for the same axis causes the alarm PS5074.
#7 #6 #5 M02 #4 M30 #3 #2 SBP #1 POL #0 NOB

3404

M3B

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 NOB When a program is executed, a block consisting of an O, N, or EOB is: 0: Not ignored. 1: Ignored. POL When a command is specified with a decimal point omitted in an address that can include a decimal point: 0: The command is assumed to be valid as it is. 1: A program error is assumed and the alarm PS5073, "NO DECIMAL POINT" is issued.

#1

NOTE The following notes apply when this parameter is set to 1: 1 G codes with a decimal point omitted do not cause the alarm PS5073. 2 Commands using a macro variable or numerical expression are treated as commands with a decimal point. Accordingly, they do not cause the alarm PS5073. 3 Argument specification I/II of a custom macro/execution macro does not cause the alarm PS5073. 4 Omitting a decimal point from a command of an extended axis name causes the alarm PS5073. 5 Omitting a decimal point from a command in an execution macro also causes the alarm PS5073. 6 Address R indicating setting data for programmable parameter input (G10L52) does not cause the alarm PS5073.

- 169 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#2 SBP In an external device subprogram call, the address P format is based on: 0: File number specification 1: Program number specification

B-63950EN/04

NOTE In memory card operation, the program number specification format is used, regardless of the setting of this parameter.
#4 M30 When M30 is specified in a memory operation: 0: M30 is sent to the machine, and the head of the program is automatically searched for. So, when the ready signal FIN is returned and a reset or reset and rewind operation is not performed, the program is executed, starting from the beginning. 1: M30 is sent to the machine, but the head of the program is not searched for. (The head of the program is searched for by the reset and rewind signal.) M02 When M02 is specified in memory operation 0: M02 is sent to the machine, and the head of the program is automatically searched for. So, when the end signal FIN is returned and a reset or reset and rewind operation is not performed, the program is executed, starting from the beginning. 1: M02 is sent to the machine, but the head of the program is not searched for. (The head of the program is searched for by the reset and rewind signal.) M3B The number of M codes that can be specified in one block 0: One 1: Up to three
#7 3405 #6 #5 DDP #4 CCR #3 G36 #2 #1 DWL DWL #0 AUX AUX

#5

#7

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 AUX When the second auxiliary function is specified in the calculator-type decimal point input format or with a decimal point, the multiplication factor for a value output (onto the code signal) relative to a specified value is such that: 0: The same multiplication factor is used for both of metric input and inch input. 1: A multiplication factor used for inch input is 10 times greater than that used for metric input. When the second auxiliary function is specified in the calculator-type decimal point input format or with a decimal point, the value output onto the code signal is a specified value multiplied by a value indicated below.
Metric input system Increment system IS-A for reference axis IS-B for reference axis IS-C for reference axis IS-D for reference axis IS-E for reference axis IS-A for reference axis IS-B for reference axis IS-C for reference axis IS-D for reference axis IS-E for reference axis Parameter AUX=0 100 times 1000 times 10000 times 100000 times 1000000 times 100 times 1000 times 10000 times 100000 times 1000000 times Parameter AUX=1 100 times 1000 times 10000 times 100000 times 1000000 times 1000 times 10000 times 100000 times 1000000 times 10000000 times

Inch input system

- 170 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
DWL The dwell time (G04) is: 0: Always dwell per second. 1: Dwell per second in the feed per minute mode (G94), or dwell per rotation in the feed per rotation mode (G95). G36 As a G code to be used with the automatic tool length measurement function (M series)/automatic tool offset function (T series) is: 0: G36 (T series only)/G37 is used. 1: G37.1/G37.2/G37.3 is used.

#1

#3

NOTE If it is necessary to perform circular threading (counterclockwise), set this parameter to 1.


#4 CCR Addresses used for chamfering 0: Address is I, J, or K. In direct drawing dimension programming, addresses ",C", ",R", and ",A" (with comma) are used in stead of "C", "R", and "A". 1: Address is C. Addresses used for direct drawing dimension programming are "C", "R", and "A" without comma.

NOTE If this bit (CCR) is set to 0, the function for changing the compensation direction by specifying I, J, or K in a G01 block in the cutter compensation/ tool nose radius compensation mode cannot be used. If this bit (CCR) is set to 1 when address C is used as an axis name, the chamfer function cannot be used.
#5 DDP Angle commands by direct drawing dimension programming 0: Normal specification 1: A supplementary angle is given.
#7 3406 3407 3408 3409 C07 #7 C15 #7 C23 #7 CFH #6 C06 #6 C14 #6 C22 #6 C30 #5 C29 #5 C05 #5 C13 #5 #4 C04 #4 C12 #4 C20 #4 C28 #3 C03 #3 C11 #3 C19 #3 C27 #2 C02 #2 C10 #2 C18 #2 C26 #1 C01 #1 C09 #1 C17 #1 C25 #0 C08 #0 C16 #0 C24 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit C01 to C30 If bit 6 (CLR) of parameter No. 3402 is set to 1, set a group of G codes to be placed in the cleared state when the CNC is reset by the key of the MDI panel, the external reset signal, the reset and rewind signal, or the emergency stop signal. The table below indicates the correspondence between bits and G code groups The setting of a bit has the following meaning: 0: Places the G code group in the cleared state. 1: Does not place G code group in the cleared state.
- 171 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Parameter C01 C02 C03 : C30 G code group 01 02 03 : 30

B-63950EN/04

#7

CFH When bit 6 (CLR) of parameter No. 3402 is 1, the

key on the MDI panel, the

external reset signal, the reset and rewind signal, or emergency stop will, 0: Clear F codes, H codes (for the M series), D codes (for the M series), and T codes (for the T series). 1: Not clear F codes, H codes (for the M series), D codes (for the M series), and T codes (for the T series).
3410 Tolerance of arc radius

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) When a circular interpolation command is executed, the tolerance for the radius between the start point and the end point is set.
M code preventing buffering 1 M code preventing buffering 2 to M code preventing buffering 10

3411 3412 to 3420

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to 99999999 Set M codes that prevent buffering the following blocks. If processing directed by an M code must be performed by the machine without buffering the following block, specify the M code. M00, M01, M02, and M30 always prevent buffering even when they are not specified in these parameters.
3421 3422 3423 3424 3425 3426 3427 Range specification 1 of M codes that do not perform buffering (lower limit) Range specification 1 of M codes that do not perform buffering (upper limit) Range specification 2 of M codes that do not perform buffering (lower limit) Range specification 2 of M codes that do not perform buffering (upper limit) Range specification 3 of M codes that do not perform buffering (lower limit) Range specification 3 of M codes that do not perform buffering (upper limit) Range specification 4 of M codes that do not perform buffering (lower limit)

- 172 -

B-63950EN/04 3428 3429 3430 3431 3432

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Range specification 4 of M codes that do not perform buffering (upper limit) Range specification 5 of M codes that do not perform buffering (lower limit) Range specification 5 of M codes that do not perform buffering (upper limit) Range specification 6 of M codes that do not perform buffering (lower limit) Range specification 6 of M codes that do not perform buffering (upper limit)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 3 to 99999999 When a specified M code is within the range specified with parameters Nos. 3421 and 3422, 3423 and 3424, 3425 and 3426, 3427 and 3428, 3429 and 3430, or 3431 and 3432, buffering for the next block is not performed until the execution of the block is completed.

NOTE M00, M01, M02, and M30 are M codes that do not perform buffering, regardless of parameter setting. M98, M99, M codes for calling subprograms, and M codes for calling custom macros are M codes that performs buffering, regardless of parameter setting.
3436 3437 3438 3439 Range specification 1 of second auxiliary function codes that do not perform buffering (lower limit) Range specification 1 of second auxiliary function codes that do not perform buffering (upper limit) Range specification 2 of second auxiliary function codes that do not perform buffering (lower limit) Range specification 2 of second auxiliary function codes that do not perform buffering (upper limit)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 1 to 99999999 Set the upper limit and lower limit of a series of second auxiliary function codes that do not perform buffering. These parameters are invalid if the setting of an upper limit conflicts with the setting of a lower limit.
3441 3442 3443 3444 Start number of M codes for which an M code group can be set (1) Start number of M codes for which an M code group can be set (2) Start number of M codes for which an M code group can be set (3) Start number of M codes for which an M code group can be set (4)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0, 100to99999999 Code numbers 0 to 99 on the M code group setting screen correspond to M00 to M99. When adding M codes after the first 100 M codes, specify a start M code number in these parameters. Thus, up to 400 M codes can be added to the M code group setting screen in groups of 100 M codes starting with the set value. When 0 is set, no M codes are added to the M code group setting screen.
- 173 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

When setting these parameters, follow the setting condition described below. If the condition is not satisfied, no M codes are added to the M code group setting screen as in the case where 0 is set. (Setting condition) The settings of parameters (1) to (4) (excluding the setting of 0) must satisfy: 99 < (1), (1)+99 < (2), (2)+99 < (3), (3) +99 < (4)
#7 3450 BDX #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 FGT #1 #0 AUP

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 AUP The second auxiliary function specified in the calculator-type decimal point input format, with a decimal point, or with a negative value is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. If the second auxiliary function is specified after setting this bit to 0, the following operation results: 1. When a value is specified without a decimal point A specified value is output onto the code signal without modification, regardless of the setting of the calculator-type decimal point input format (with bit 0 (DPI) of parameter No. 3401). 2. When a value is specified with a decimal point The alarm PS0007, ILLEGAL USE OF DECIMAL POINT is issued. 3. When a negative value is specified The alarm PS0006, ILLEGAL USE OF MINUS SIGN is issued. FGT The GOTO statement in the forward direction during DNC operation is: 0: Disabled. (The alarm PS0123, "ILLEGAL MODE FOR GOTO/WHILE/DO" is issued.) 1: Enabled.

#2

BDX When ASCII code is called using the same address as the address for the second auxiliary function (specified by parameter No. 3460), this parameter prevents the argument unit used when the option for the second auxiliary function is selected from differing from the argument unit used when the same option is not selected. 0: When bit 0 (AUP) of parameter No. 3450 is set to 1, the argument unit differs, depending on whether the option for the second auxiliary function is selected or not. 1: The same argument unit is used. (The unit applied when the option for the second auxiliary function is selected is used.) [Example] A setting is made so that address B is used to call O9004, and the program O1 below is executed with parameter No. 3460 = 66. O1 O9004 B2 #500 = #146 M30 M99 When the increment system is IS-B, and metric input is used, #500 assumes a value indicated in the table below.

#7

- 174 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Bit 0 (DPI) of Bit 0 (AUP) of BDX=0 parameter parameter Without the second With the second auxiliary No. 3450 No. 3401 auxiliary function option function option 0 1 0 1 0 1
#6 #5

BDX=1 2.000 0.002 2.000 2.000

2.000 2.000 2.000 2.000


#4 NBN NBN #3 #2

2.000 0.002 2.000 2.000


#1

#7 3451

#0 GQS

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 GQS When threading is specified, the threading start angle shift function (Q) is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. NBN If bit 0 (NOB) of parameter No. 3404 is set to 1, a block including just N is: 0: Ignored. 1: Not ignored but handled as a single block. (For a block containing only N, bit 0 (NOB) of parameter No. 3404 is ignored.)
#7 3452 EAP EAP GCC GC0 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

#4

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 GC0 When G00 is specified in the mode of groove cutting by continuous circle motion: 0: A P/S alarm is issued. 1: G01 is assumed to have been specified and is executed. GCC When groove cutting along a path is stopped, continuous circle motion is: 0: Stopped. 1: Continued. EAP When bit 0 (ADX) of parameter No. 3455 is set to 1, calculator-type decimal point input at a macro calling argument address is: 0: Enabled. 1: Disabled.

#4

#7

NOTE This parameter is valid when bit 0 (DPI) of parameter No. 3401 is set to 0.
#7 3453 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 CRD

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit path


- 175 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#0

B-63950EN/04

CRD If the functions of chamfering or corner R and direct drawing dimension programming are both enabled, 0: Chamfering or corner R is enabled. 1: Direct drawing dimension programming is enabled.
#7 #6 #5 #4 G1B #3 PGR #2 DTO #1 #0

3454

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #2 DTO The method of specifying a rotation axis in cylindrical interpolation mode is set. 0: In cylindrical interpolation mode, the rotation axis is specified by angle. 1: In cylindrical interpolation mode, the rotation axis is specified by distance on an expanded plane. PGR In the high speed program check mode, data modified during automatic operation is: 0: Neither stored nor restored. 1: Stored and restored. If this parameter is set to 1, when the high speed program check mode ends, data modified during automatic operation in the high speed program check mode can be restored to the state present before the start of the high speed program check mode. After the high speed program check mode ends, therefore, it is possible to perform automatic operation in the state present before the start of the high speed program check mode.

#3

WARNING In a multi-path system, when one of the paths enters the high speed program check mode, data of all paths is stored. After there is no path left in the high speed program check mode, the data of all paths is restored at a time. This means that when the time to change the status of the high speed program check input signal PGCK<Gn290.5> differs among the paths, the end of the high speed program check mode in a path may affect the operation of other paths. For example, if the high speed program check mode of a path is turned off when machining is in progress on another path, data of the path on which machining is in progress is also restored, which poses serious danger. Therefore, when bit 3 (PGR) of parameter No. 3454 is set to 1 in a multi-path system, the status of the high speed program check mode must be made consistent throughout the paths. Make sure that paths placed in the high speed program check mode and paths placed in the normal mode are not present at the same time.
#4 G1B In programmable parameter input, specifying a change to a specific bit parameter is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. (A bit number is specified with Q_.)

- 176 -

B-63950EN/04 #7 3455 #6 #5 #4

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#3 #2 #1 #0 AXDx

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 AXDx If a decimal point is omitted for an axis address with which a decimal point can be used, the value is determined: 0: In accordance with the least input increment. (Normal decimal point input) 1: In millimeters, inches, degrees, or seconds. (calculator-type decimal point input)

NOTE This parameter specifies the calculator-type decimal point input function for each axis. For the same axis name, be sure to make the same setting.
#7 3456 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 PVT

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 PVT As a pivot axis control axis: 0: Not used. 1: Used.

NOTE 1 When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued. 2 The option for pivot axis control is required. 3 When an axis uses a synchronized axis, make this setting for both of them.
#7 3457 SCF #6 SCC #5 #4 #3 SYS #2 MC1 #1 MC2 #0 LIB

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

NOTE 1 The parameters LIB, MC2, MC1, and SYS are used to set a search folder for the following subprogram/macro calls: Subprogram call based on an M code Subprogram call based on a particular address Subprogram call based on a second auxiliary function code Macro call based on a G code Macro call based on an M code Macro call based on a T code One-touch macro call

- 177 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE 2 The parameter SCF is used to set whether to add a search folder for the following subprogram/macro calls: Subprogram call based on M98 Figure copy based on G72.1/G72.2 Macro call based on G65/G66/G66.1 Macro interrupt based on M96
#0 LIB The common program directory "//CNC_MEM/USER/LIBRARY/" of the initial directories is: 0: Set as a search directory. 1: Not set as a search directory. MC2 MTB dedicated directory 2 "//CNC_MEM/MTB2/" of the initial directories is: 0: Set as a search directory. 1: Not set as a search directory. MC1 MTB dedicated directory 1 "//CNC_MEM/MTB1/" of the initial directories is: 0: Set as a search directory. 1: Not set as a search directory. SYS The system directory "//CNC_MEM/SYSTEM/" of the initial directories is: 0: Set as a search directory. 1: Not set as a search directory. SCC The same folder as the main program is added to the top of the search order as a search folder for the following each subprogram call and macro call. Subprogram call by M code Subprogram call by ASCII code Subprogram call by the second auxiliary function code Macro call by S code Macro call by T code Macro call by G code Macro call by M code One-touch macro call The same folder as the main program is: 0: Not added in the search order. 1: Added in the search order. When a search folder is added, a search is made in the following order: 0) Folder only for embedded macro (With the embedded macro-function.) 1) Folder where the main program is stored 2) Common program folder, which is an initial folder (LIBRARY) 3) MTB-dedicated folder 2, which is an initial folder (MTB2) 4) MTB-dedicated folder 1, which is an initial folder (MTB1) 5) System folder, which is an initial folder (SYSTEM) The folders of 2) through 5) can be excluded from search target folders by setting the bits 0 (LIB), 1 (MC2), 2 (MC1), and 3 (SYS) of parameter No. 3457. #7 SCF A search folder is: 0: Not added. 1: Added.
- 178 -

#1

#2

#3

#6

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
When a search folder is added, a search is made in the following order: 0) Folder only for embedded macro (With the embedded macro-function.) 1) Folder where the main program is stored 2) Common program folder, which is an initial folder (LIBRARY) 3) MTB-dedicated folder 2, which is an initial folder (MTB2) 4) MTB-dedicated folder 1, which is an initial folder (MTB1) 5) System folder, which is an initial folder (SYSTEM) The folders of 3) through 5) can be excluded from search target folders by setting the bits 1 (MC2), 2 (MC1), and 3 (SYS) of parameter No. 3457.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 TPS

3458

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 TPS When a plane is selected on the lathe system in the power-on state or cleared state: 0: G18 mode (Z-X plane) is selected. 1: Bits 1 (G18) and 2 (G19) of parameter No. 3402 are followed.
#7 3459 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 ESL

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 ESL When an NC program contains lowercase alphabetic characters: 0: An alarm is issued. 1: The lowercase characters are converted into their uppercase equivalents. This parameter specifies how to handle lowercase alphabetic characters included in an NC program, except in its comment part, program name, and folder name, when the program is registered from an external device into CNC built-in memory or compared. The parameter setting also applies to M198 operation or DNC operation as automatic operation. [Example] G90G01X100y50; When ESL is 1, the program is assumed to be G90G01X100Y50;. When ESL is 0, the alarm SR1090, "PROGRAM FORMAT ERROR" is displayed upon registration or comparison. During operation, the alarm PS1090, "PROGRAM FORMAT ERROR" is issued.

NOTE 1 Program transfer by the program batch input/output function is excluded. 2 Program transfer by the FTP file transfer function is excluded.

- 179 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
3460 Second auxiliary function specification address

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 65to67, 85to87 Specify which of A, B, C, U, V, and W is to be used as the address for specifying the second auxiliary function. If an address used as an axis name is specified, the second auxiliary function is disabled.
Name Setting value A 65 B 66 C 67 U 85 V 86 W 87

Address B is assumed when a value other than the above is set. However, the name U, V, or W can be used with the T series only when G code system B or C is used. When a value from 85 to 87 is specified with G code system A, the specification address for the second auxiliary function is B.
3471 Allowable difference between the specified end position and the end position obtained from the increase/decrease and frequency in spiral interpolation or conic interpolation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the maximum allowable difference (absolute value) between the specified end position and the end position obtained from the increase/decrease and frequency in spiral or conic interpolation.
Minimum radius needed to maintain the actual speed in spiral or conic interpolation

3472

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis (For IS-B and millimeter machines, 1.0 to 999999.999; for inch machines, 1.0 to 99999.9999) If this parameter value is 0 or a value outside the valid data range, the minimum value of the range is assumed. In spiral interpolation and conic interpolation, the speed is generally held constant. In an area near the center, the spiral radius decreases, resulting in an extremely high angular velocity. To prevent this, once the spiral radius has reached the parameter-set value, the angular velocity subsequently remains constant. As a result, the actual speed decreases.

3490 Clamp value of acceleration in continuous circle motion

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm/sec2, inch/sec2, degree/sec2 (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (D) Feedrate command F for continuous circle movement can be clamped by specifying I and K of G12.4/G13.4 and this parameter.
- 180 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Clamp feedrate F = SQR (parameter No. 3490 (I-K)/2) 60 Continuous circle motion feedrate override is applied to the clamped feedrate.

4.20
3601

PARAMETERS OF PITCH ERROR COMPENSATION


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 EPC #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#1 EPC The pitch error compensation on an axis of Cs contour control on the slave spindle side during simple synchronous spindle control is: 0: The same as that on the master spindle. 1: Just for the slave spindle.
#7 3605 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 IPCx #1 IPPx #0 BDPx

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 BDPx Both-direction pitch error compensation is: 0: Not used. 1: Used. IPPx Interpolation type pitch error compensation is: 0: Not used. 1: Used. In interpolation type pitch error compensation, a compensation value at each point in each error completion point interval is divided for output of one pulse at equally spaced intervals. If cycle type second pitch error compensation and interpolation type pitch error compensation are used at the same time, a cycle type second pitch error compensation value is output in interpolation mode within a cycle type second pitch error compensation point interval. If a high feedrate is used, multiple compensation pulse may be output at a time. A minimum interval where multiple compensation pulses are not output at a time is determined by the following expression: Minimum pitch error compensation point interval = (Fmax/7500) (Pmax+1) Fmax: Maximum feedrate Pmax: Maximum pitch error compensation value
- 181 -

#1

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

[Example] When the maximum feedrate is 15000 mm/min, and the maximum pitch error compensation value is 7 pulses, the minimum compensation point interval is 16mm.

NOTE Interpolation type pitch error compensation cannot be used with spindle positioning.
#2 IPCx Interpolated straightness compensation function is: 0: Not used. 1: Used.
Number of the pitch error compensation position for the reference position for each axis

3620

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis [Valid data range] 0 to 1535 Set the number of the pitch error compensation position for the reference position for each axis.
3621 Number of the pitch error compensation position at extremely negative position for each axis

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis [Valid data range] 0 to 1535 Set the number of the pitch error compensation position at the extremely negative position for each axis.
3622 Number of the pitch error compensation position at extremely positive position for each axis

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis [Valid data range] 0 to 1535 Set the number of the pitch error compensation position at the extremely positive position for each axis. This value must be larger than set value of parameter No. 3620.

- 182 -

B-63950EN/04 3623

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Magnification for pitch error compensation for each axis

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte axis [Valid data range] 0 to 100 Set the magnification for pitch error compensation for each axis. If the magnification is set to 1, the same unit as the detection unit is used for the compensation data. If 0 is set, compensation is not performed.
3624 Interval between pitch error compensation positions for each axis

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input Real axis mm, inch, degree (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis See the description below. The pitch error compensation positions are arranged with equal spacing. The space between two adjacent positions is set for each axis. The minimum interval between pitch error compensation positions is limited and obtained from the following equation: Minimum interval between pitch error compensation positions = maximum feedrate/7500 Unit : mm, inch, deg or mm/min, inch/min, deg/min [Example] When the maximum feedrate is 15000 mm/min, the minimum interval between pitch error compensation positions is 2 mm.
3625 Travel distance per revolution in pitch error compensation of rotation axis type

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input Real axis mm, inch, degree (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis See the description below. If the pitch error compensation of rotation axis type is performed (bit 1 (ROSx) of parameter No. 1006 is set to 0 and bit 0 (ROTx) of parameter No. 1006 is set to 1), set the travel distance per revolution. The travel distance per revolution does not have to be 360 degrees, and a cycle of pitch error compensation of rotation axis type can be set. However, the travel distance per revolution, compensation interval, and number of compensation points must satisfy the following condition: (Travel distance per revolution) = (Compensation interval) (Number of compensation points)
- 183 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

The compensation at each compensation point must be set so that the total compensation per revolution equals 0.

NOTE If 0 is set, the travel distance per revolution becomes 360 degrees.
3626 Number of the both-direction pitch error compensation position at extremely negative position (for movement in the negative direction)

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis [Valid data range] 0 to 1023, 3000 to 4023 When using both-direction pitch error compensation, set the number of compensation point at the farthest end in the negative direction for a movement in the negative direction.

NOTE 1 For a movement in the positive direction, set the compensation point number at the farthest end in the negative direction in parameter No. 3621. 2 A set of compensation data items for a single axis should not be set to lie astride 1023 to 3000.
3627 Pitch error compensation at reference position when a movement to the reference position is made from the direction opposite to the direction of reference position return

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input Word axis Detection unit -32768 to 32767 Set the absolute value of pitch error compensation at reference position when a movement to the reference position is made from the negative direction if the direction of reference position return (bit 5 (ZMI) of parameter No. 1006) is positive or from the positive direction if the direction of reference position return is negative.
Number of a pitch error compensation position for the reference position for each slave axis when independent pitch error compensation is performed under simple spindle synchronous control

3661

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word spindle [Valid data range] 0 to 1535
- 184 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Set the number of a pitch error compensation position for the reference position.

NOTE 1 This parameter is valid if pitch error compensation on an axis of Cs contour control on the salve side during simple synchronous spindle control is carried out just for the slave axis (bit 1 (EPC) of parameter No. 3601 is set to 1). 2 The usable number of pitch error compensation positions and their range depend on the option configuration.
3666 Number of the pitch error compensation position at extremely negative position for each slave axis when independent pitch error compensation is performed under simple spindle synchronous control

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word spindle [Valid data range] 0 to 1535 Set the compensation position number at the farthest end in the negative direction.

NOTE 1 This parameter is valid if pitch error compensation on an axis of Cs contour control on the salve side during simple synchronous spindle control is carried out just for the slave axis (bit 1 (EPC) of parameter No. 3601 is set to 1). 2 When using the both-direction pitch error compensation function, set a compensation position number for a movement in the positive direction. 3 The usable number of pitch error compensation positions and their range depend on the option configuration.
3671 Number of the pitch error compensation position at extremely positive position for each slave axis when independent pitch error compensation is performed under simple spindle synchronous control

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word spindle [Valid data range] 0 to 1535 Set the compensation position number at the farthest end in the positive direction.

- 185 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE 1 This parameter is valid if pitch error compensation on an axis of Cs contour control on the salve side during simple synchronous spindle control is carried out just for the slave axis (bit 1 (EPC) of parameter No. 3601 is set to 1). 2 When using the both-direction pitch error compensation function, set a compensation position number for a movement in the positive direction. 3 The usable number of pitch error compensation positions and their range depend on the option configuration.
3676 Number of the pitch error compensation position at extremely negative position for each slave axis when independent both-direction pitch error compensation is performed under simple spindle synchronous control

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word spindle [Valid data range] 0 to 1535 When using both-direction pitch error compensation, set the compensation position number at the farthest end in the negative direction for a movement in the negative direction.

NOTE 1 This parameter is valid if pitch error compensation on an axis of Cs contour control on the salve side during simple synchronous spindle control is carried out just for the slave axis (bit 1 (EPC) of parameter No. 3601 is set to 1). 2 The usable number of pitch error compensation positions and their range depend on the option configuration.
Pitch error compensation value at the reference position when a movement is made to the reference position in the direction opposite to the reference position return direction for each slave axis in the case where independent both-direction pitch error compensation is performed under simple spindle synchronous control

3681

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word spindle [Valid data range] -32767 to 32767 By using an absolute value, set a pitch error compensation value at the reference position when a movement is made in the negative direction if the reference position return direction (bit 5 (ZMI) of parameter No. 1006) is positive or when a movement is made in the positive direction if the reference position return direction (bit 5 (ZMI) of parameter No. 1006) is negative.

- 186 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE This parameter is valid if pitch error compensation on an axis of Cs contour control on the salve side during simple synchronous spindle control is carried out just for the slave axis (bit 1 (EPC) of parameter No. 3601 is set to 1).

- 187 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

4.21
3700

PARAMETERS OF SPINDLE CONTROL


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 CNM #1 NRF #0 CRF

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 CRF Reference position setting at an arbitrary position under Cs contour control is: 0: Not used. 1: Used.

NOTE When this function is used, an attempt to specify G00 for a Cs contour control axis without performing a reference position return operation even once after switching the serial spindle to the Cs contour control mode results in the alarm PS0303, REFERENCE POSITION RETURN IS NOT PERFORMED even if bit 1 (NRF) of parameter No. 3700 is set to 0. Be sure to perform a reference position return operation by specifying G28.
#1 NRF With the first move command (G00) after switching the series spindle to Cs contour control mode: 0: A reference position return operation is once performed then positioning is performed. 1: A normal positioning operation is performed. CNM When an axis command of travel distance 0 is specified for the Cs axis in the origin unestablished state: 0: The alarm PS0224, "ZERO RETURN NOT FINISHED" is issued. 1: The alarm PS0224 is not issued.
#7 3702 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 EMS #0

#2

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #1 EMS The multi-spindle control function is: 0: Used. 1: Not used.
#7 3703 #6 #5 #4 SPR #3 MPP #2 MPM #1 #0 2P2

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.

- 188 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
2P2 When a multi-path system is used, inter-path spindle control allows: 0: Configuration where the spindle that belongs to one path only is shared between path 1 and path 2. 1: Configuration where the spindles that belong to path 1 and 2 are shared between the two paths. When the spindle that belongs to an arbitrary path is shared between arbitrary paths, set bit 2 (MPM) of parameter No. 3703. (The meanings of signals used vary, so that ladder program modifications need to be made.)

#0

#2

MPM When a multi-path system is used, the configuration allowed by inter-path spindle control: 0: Follows the setting of bit 0 (2P2) of parameter No. 3703. 1: Allows the sharing of the spindle that belongs to a path between arbitrary paths. MPP In multi-spindle control, a spindle selection using a programmed command instead of using the signals (SWS1 to SWS4<G027.0 to 2, G026.3>) is: 0: Not made. 1: Made.

#3

NOTE When this parameter is set to 1, set parameter No. 3781 at the same time.
#4 SPR Rigid tapping with spindle of another path function is: 0: Not available. 1: Available.
#7 3704 CSS #6 #5 SSY #4 SSS #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#4 SSS Synchronous spindle control by each spindle is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed. The master axis and slave axis of synchronous spindle control can be selected from the arbitrary spindles. The target spindle of synchronous spindle control is specified in parameter No. 4831. In addition, the following signals affect the control. Synchronous spindle signals of each spindle SPSYCs Signals of synchronous control of the spindle phase for each spindle SPPHSs SSY Simple synchronous spindle control by each spindle is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed. The master axis and slave axis of simple synchronous spindle control can be selected from the arbitrary spindles. The target spindle of simple synchronous spindle control is set in parameter No. 4821. In addition, the following signals affect the control.
- 189 -

#5

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 Signals of simple synchronous control of each spindle ESSYCs Parking signals of simple synchronous control of each spindle PKESEs

B-63950EN/04

CSS On the each spindle, Cs contour control is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed.
#7 #6 SFA #5 NSF #4 EVS SGT SGB GST #3 #2 #1 #0 ESF ESF

3705

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 ESF When the spindle control function (Spindle analog output or Spindle serial output) is used, and the constant surface speed control function is used or bit 4 (GTT) of parameter No. 3706 is set to 1: 0: S codes and SF are output for all S commands. 1: For the T series: S codes and SF are not output for an S command in the constant surface speed control (G96) mode and a command for maximum spindle speed clamping (G92 S_; (G50 for G code system A)). For the M series: S codes and SF are not output for an S command in the constant surface speed control (G96) mode.

NOTE The operation of this parameter varies between the T series and M series. For the T series: This parameter is valid when bit 4 (EVS) of parameter No. 3705 is set to 1. For the M series: For an S command for maximum spindle speed clamping (G92 S_;), SF is not output, regardless of the setting of this parameter.
#1 GST The SOR signal is used for: 0: Spindle orientation 1: Gear shift SGB Gear switching method is: 0: Method A (Parameters Nos. 3741 to 3743 for the maximum spindle speed at each gear are used for gear selection.) 1: Method B (Parameters Nos. 3751 and 3752 for the spindle speed at the gear switching point are used for gear selection.) SGT Gear switching method during tapping cycle (G84 and G74) is: 0: Method A (Same as the normal gear switching method) 1: Method B (Gears are switched during tapping cycle according to the spindle speed set in parameters Nos. 3761 and 3762).

#2

#3

- 190 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
EVS When the spindle control function (Spindle analog output or Spindle serial output) is used, S codes and SF are: 0: Not output for an S command. 1: Output for an S command. The output of S codes and SF for an S command in constant surface speed control mode (G96), or for an S command used to specify maximum spindle speed clamping (G92 S_; (G50 for G code system A)) depends on the setting of bit 0 (ESF) of parameter No. 3705. NSF For the M series, when a T type gear is selected (with bit 4 (GTT) of parameter No. 3706 set to 1 or with the option for constant surface speed control), and an S code is specified: 0: SF is output. 1: SF is not output.

#4

#5

NOTE This parameter does not affect S code output. For an S command for maximum spindle speed clamping (G92 S_;), SF is not output, regardless of the setting of this parameter.
#6 SFA The SF signal is output: 0: When gears are switched. 1: Irrespective of whether gears are switched.
#7 3706 TCW TCW #6 CWM CWM #5 ORM ORM GTT #4 #3 PCS PCS #2 MPA MPA #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #2 MPA If a spindle is to be selected using a P command (with bit 3 (MPP) of parameter No. 3703 set to 1) in multi-spindle control, and a P command is not specified together with an S command: 0: The alarm PS5305, ILLEGAL SPINDLE NUMBER is issued. 1: The last P specified by S_ P_; (by S_ P_; specified for the path in case of a multi-path system) is used. If P is not specified even once after power-up, the value of parameter No. 3775 is used.

NOTE This parameter is valid only when bit 3 (MPP) of parameter No. 3703 is set to 1.
#3 PCS When a multi-path system is used, and multi-spindle control is enabled with each path, as the position coder signals (PC2SLC<Gn028.7>, PC3SLC<Gn026.0>, PC4SLC<Gn026.1>) for selecting the position coder of a spindle among the multiple spindles that belong to a path selected by the inter-path spindle feedback selection signals: 0: The signals of the path selected by the inter-path spindle feedback selection signal are used. 1: The signals of the local path are used. Suppose that path x is selected by the inter-path spindle feedback selection signals (SLPCA<Gn063.2> to SLPCD<Gn063.5>). Then, the following position coder is selected in path x by the position coder selection signals: n = m(path number)-1
- 191 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
y = x(path number selected by the spindle feedback selection signals)-1

B-63950EN/04

Position coder selected in path m PC1 of path x PC2 of path x PC3 of path x PC4 of path x

When bit 3 (PCS) of parameter No. 3706 is set to 0 Selected path Selecting path Position coder selection signals (path x) Position coder selection signals (path m) PC2SLC PC3SLC PC4SLC PC2SLC PC3SLC PC4SLC <Gy028.7> <Gy026.0> <Gy026.1> <Gn028.7> <Gn026.0> <Gn026.1> 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 1 When bit 3 (PCS) of parameter No. 3706 is set to 1 Selected path Selecting path Position coder selection signals (path x) Position coder selection signals (path m) PC2SLC PC3SLC PC4SLC PC2SLC PC3SLC PC4SLC <Gy028.7> <Gy026.0> <Gy026.1> <Gn028.7> <Gn026.0> <Gn026.1> 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 1

Position coder selected in path m PC1 of path x PC2 of path x PC3 of path x PC4 of path x

#4

GTT Spindle gear selection method is: 0: Type M. 1: Type T.

NOTE 1 M type The gear selection signal is not input. The CNC selects a gear based on the speed range of each gear set by a parameter beforehand according to S codes, and the selected gear is posted by outputting the gear selection signal. Moreover, the spindle speed matching the gear selected by the output gear selection signal is output. T type The gear selection signal is input. The spindle speed matching the gear selected by this signal is output. 2 When the constant surface speed control option is selected, type T is selected, regardless of whether this parameter is specified. 3 When type T spindle gear switching is selected, the following parameters have no effect: No.3705#2(SGB), No.3751, No.3752, No.3705#1(GST), No.3705#3(SGT), No.3761, No.3762, No.3705#6(SFA), No.3735, No.3736 On the other hand, parameter No. 3744 becomes usable.
#5 ORM Voltage polarity during spindle orientation 0: Positive 1: Negative

- 192 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

#6 CWM #7 TCW Voltage polarity when the spindle speed voltage is output
TCW 0 0 1 1
#7 3708

CWM 0 1 0 1
#6 TSO TSO

Voltage polarity Both M03 and M04 positive Both M03 and M04 negative M03 positive, M04 negative M03 negative, M04 positive
#5 SOC SOC #4 #3 #2 #1 SAT #0 SAR SAR

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 SAR The spindle speed arrival signal (SAR) is: 0: Not checked 1: Checked SAT Check of the spindle speed arrival signal at the start of executing the thread cutting block 0: The signal is checked only when bit 0 (SAR) of parameter No. 3708 is set to 1. 1: The signal is always checked irrespective of the setting of SAR.

#1

NOTE When thread cutting blocks are consecutive, the spindle speed arrival signal is not checked for the second and subsequent thread cutting blocks.
#5 SOC During constant surface speed control (G96 mode), the speed clamp by the maximum spindle speed clamp command (G92 S_; (G50 for G code system A of lathe system)) is carried out: 0: Before spindle speed override. 1: After spindle speed override. If this parameter is set to 0, the spindle speed may exceed the maximum spindle speed (numeric value following S in G92 S_; (G50 for G code system A of lathe system)). If this parameter is set to 1, the spindle speed is limited to the maximum spindle speed. The spindle speed is limited to the upper limit of spindle speed specified in parameter No. 3772, irrespective of the setting of this parameter. TSO During a threading or tapping cycle, the spindle override is: 0: Disabled (tied to 100%). 1: Enabled.

#6

NOTE During rigid tapping, the override is tied to 100%, irrespective of the setting of this parameter.
#7 3709 #6 #5 #4 #3 MRS #2 MSI #1 RSC #0 SAM

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path


- 193 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#0 SAM The sampling frequency to obtain the average spindle speed 0: 4 (Normally, set to 0.) 1: 1

B-63950EN/04

#1

RSC In the constant surface speed control mode, the surface speed of a rapid traverse block is calculated: 0: In accordance with the coordinates of the end point. 1: In accordance with the current value, as in cutting feed. MSI In multi-spindle control, the SIND signal is valid 0: Only when the first spindle is valid (SIND signal for the 2nd, 3rd spindle becomes ineffective) (TYPE-A) 1: For each spindle irrespective of whether the spindle is selected (Each spindle has its own SIND signal). (TYPE-B) MRS When the actual spindle speed signals and S 12-bit code signals are output in multi-spindle control: 0: The signals common to the first spindle and second spindle are used, and the signals for the spindle selected by the spindle selection signal are output. 1: The signals for the first spindle and the signals for the second spindle are output separately.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 CSF #1 #0

#2

#3

3712

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #2 CSF In the Cs contour control mode, the function for setting machine coordinates and absolute coordinates based on the machine position of the spindle if the origin is already set up is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
#7 3713 #6 MPC #5 #4 EOV #3 MSC #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#3 MSC Multi-spindle control TYPE-C is: 0: Not used. 1: Used.

NOTE If parameter MSC and bit 2 (MSI) of parameter No. 3709 for multi-spindle control TYPE-B ) are set to 1 at the same time, multi-spindle control TYPE-C is enabled.

- 194 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
EOV Each spindle speed override is: 0: Not used. 1: Used.

#4

NOTE Multi-spindle control TYPE-C (bit 3 (MSC) of parameter No. 3713=1) is necessary to use this function.
#6 MPC When a spindle is selected with address P in a program during multi-spindle control (bit 3 (MPP) of parameter No. 3703 is set to 1), position coder feedback used for thread cutting, feed per revolution, and so forth is: 0: Not changed automatically according to the selected spindle. 1: Changed automatically according to the selected spindle.

NOTE Setting this parameter produces the same effects as when position coder select signals PC2SLC<Gn028.7>, PC3SLC<Gn026.0>, and PC4SLC<Gn026.1>, inter-path spindle feedback signals SLPCA<Gn064.2>, SLPCB<Gn064.3>, SLPCC<Gn403.4>, and SLPCD<Gn403.5> are set. At this time, even when an attempt to set these signals is made by a PMC ladder, these signal operations are ignored.
#7 3715 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 NSAx

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 NSAx When a move command is executed for an axis, the spindle speed arrival signal SAR is: 0: Checked. 1: Not checked. Set an axis for which the spindle speed arrival signal SAR need not be checked when a move command is executed for the axis. When a move command is specified only for an axis with this parameter set to 1, the spindle speed arrival signal SAR is not checked.
#7 3716 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 A/Ss

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit spindle

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 A/Ss Spindle motor type is : 0: Analog spindle. 1: Serial spindle.

- 195 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE 1 When an analog spindle is used, the option for spindle analog output is required. 2 When a serial spindle is used, the option for spindle serial output is required. 3 The option for the number of controlled spindles needs to be specified.
3717 Spindle amplifier number of each spindle

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte spindle [Valid data range] 0 to Maximum number of controlled axes Set a spindle amplifier number to be assigned to each spindle. 0: No spindle amplifier is connected. 1: Spindle motor connected to amplifier number 1 is used. 2: Spindle motor connected to amplifier number 2 is used. to n: Spindle motor connected to amplifier number n is used.
3718 Subscript for display of a serial spindle (main spindle) or analog spindle

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte spindle [Valid data range] 0 to 122 Set a subscript to be added to spindle speed display on a screen such as the position display screen.
3719 Subscript for display of a serial spindle (sub-spindle)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte spindle [Valid data range] 0 to 122 Set a subscript to be added to spindle speed display on a screen such as the position display screen.
3720 Number of position coder pulses

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input 2-word spindle Detection unit 1 to 32767 Set the number of position coder pulses.

- 196 -

B-63950EN/04 3721

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Number of gear teeth on the position coder side

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word spindle [Valid data range] 0 to 9999 Set the number of gear teeth on the position coder side in speed control (such as feed per revolution and threading).
3722 Number of gear teeth on the spindle side

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word spindle [Valid data range] 0 to 9999 Set the number of gear teeth on the spindle side in speed control (such as feed per revolution and threading).
#7 3729 CSCs #6 CHMs #5 #4 #3 NCSs #2 CSNs #1 FPRs #0 ORTs

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit spindle #0 ORTs When a serial spindle is used, the spindle orientation function of stop position external setting type based on the position coder is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed. FPRs Feed per revolution (without a position coder) is: 0: Not used for a spindle. 1: Used for a spindle. In a machine that does not use a position coder, when FPRs is set to 1 for each axis, feed per revolution can be performed with a spindle command. A feed per revolution is specified with G95 (G99 for lathe systems) in the same way as for normal operation. When multispindle control is performed, the target spindle for feed per revolution is selected with a position coder select signal (PC2SLC<Gn028.7>, PC3SLC<Gn026.0>, PC4SLC <Gn026.1>).

#1

NOTE The option for constant surface speed control is required.


#2 CSNs When the Cs contour control mode is turned off, an in-position check is: 0: Performed. 1: Not performed. NCSs When the Cs contour control mode is set: 0: Switching to Cs contour control is completed when the spindle activating current is on (the spindle amplifier is ready for operation in the Cs contour control mode). 1: Switching to Cs contour control is completed even when the spindle activating current is off (the spindle amplifier is not ready for operation in the Cs contour control mode). If this parameter is set to 1, the Cs contour control switch end signal is output without waiting for the spindle to decelerate to a stop.
- 197 -

#3

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#6

B-63950EN/04

CHMs Manual reference position return after the reference position for the Cs contour control axis is established is performed as: 0: Spindle orientation operation. 1: High-speed type of reference position return operation. CSCs The increment system of the Cs contour control axis is: 0: IS-B. 1: IS-C.
Data used for adjusting the gain of the analog output of spindle speed

#7

3730

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word spindle 0.1% 700 to 1250 Set data used for adjusting the gain of the analog output of spindle speed. [Adjustment method] <1> Assign standard value 1000 to the parameter. <2> Specify the spindle speed so that the analog output of the spindle speed is the maximum voltage (10 V). <3> Measure the output voltage. <4> Assign the value obtained by the following equation to parameter No. 3730. Setting value = (10 (V) / Measured data (V)) 1000 <5> After setting the parameter, specify the spindle speed so that the analog output of the spindle speed is the maximum voltage. Confirm that the output voltage is 10V.

NOTE This parameter needs not to be set for serial spindles.


3731 Compensation value for the offset voltage of spindle speed analog output

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word spindle Velo -1024 to 1024 Set a compensation value for the offset voltage of spindle speed analog output. Setting = -8191 offset voltage (V)/12.5 [Adjustment method] <1> Assign standard value 0 to the parameter. <2> Specify the spindle speed so that the analog output of the spindle speed is 0. <3> Measure the output voltage. <4> Assign the value obtained by the following equation to parameter No. 3731.
Setting value = -8191 Offset voltage (V) 12.5

<5> After setting the parameter, specify the spindle speed so that the analog output of the spindle speed is 0. Confirm that the output voltage is 0V.

NOTE This parameter needs not to be set for serial spindles.


3732 The spindle speed during spindle orientation or the spindle motor speed during spindle gear shift

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path


- 198 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Valid data range] 0 to 20000 Set the spindle speed during spindle orientation or the spindle motor speed during gear shift. When bit 1 (GST) of parameter No. 3705 is set to 0, set the spindle speed during spindle orientation in min-1. When bit 1 (GST) of parameter No. 3705 is set to 1, set the spindle motor speed during spindle gear shift calculated from the following formula. For a serial spindle
Setting value = Spindle motor speed during spindle gear shift Maximum spindle motor speed Spindle motor speed during spindle gear shift Maximum spindle motor speed 16383

For an analog spindle


Setting value = 4095

3735

Minimum clamp speed of the spindle motor

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to 4095 Set the minimum clamp speed of the spindle motor.
Setting value = Minimum clamp speed of the spindle motor Maximum spindle motor speed 4095

3736

Maximum clamp speed of the spindle motor

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to 4095 Set the maximum clamp speed of the spindle motor.
Setting value = Maximum clamp speed of the spindle motor Maximum spindle motor speed 4095

Spindle motor speed

Max. speed (4095, 10V)

Spindle motor max. clamp speed (Parameter No.3736)

Spindle motor minimum clamp speed (Parameter No.3735) Spindle speed (S command)

- 199 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
3738 3739 Spindle name 2 of each spindle Spindle name 3 of each spindle

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte spindle [Valid data range] 48 to 57, 65 to 90 The command for a spindle is basically "S". When all conditions below are satisfied, however, an extended spindle name can be used. An extended spindle name consists of up to three characters starting with "S" as the first spindle name. Thus, a command for a spindle can be specified. The serial (analog) spindle function is enabled. The multi-spindle function is enabled. Bit 0 (EEA) of parameter No. 1000 is set to 1. Bit 3 (MPP) of parameter No. 3703 is set to 1. Bit 1 (ESN) of parameter No. 3798 is set to 1. Bit 4 (GTT) of parameter No. 3706 is set to 1. (M series only) As spindle name 2 (No. 3738) and spindle name 3 (No. 3739), ASCII codes from 0 to 9 and A to Z can be arbitrary set. However, before spindle name 3 for a spindle can be valid, spindle name 2 must be set for the spindle. Moreover, when a character from 0 to 9 is set as spindle name 2, do not set a character from A to Z as spindle name 3.

NOTE 1 When an extended spindle name is used, a subscript (for a main spindle (parameter No. 3718)) and a subscript (for a sub-spindle (parameter No. 3719)) are unusable. 2 When the custom macro function is enabled, the same extended spindle name as a reserved word must not be used. Such an extended spindle name is regarded as a reserved word.
3740 Time elapsed prior to checking the spindle speed arrival signal

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word path msec 0 to 32767 Set the time elapsed from the execution of the S function up to the checking of the spindle speed arrival signal.
Maximum spindle speed for gear 1 Maximum spindle speed for gear 2 Maximum spindle speed for gear 3 Maximum spindle speed for gear 4

3741 3742 3743 3744

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word spindle min-1 0 to 99999999 Set the maximum spindle speed corresponding to each gear.

- 200 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Spindle motor speed

Max. speed (4095, 10V)

Spindle motor max. clamp speed (Parameter No.3736)

Spindle motor minimum clamp speed (Parameter No.3735) Spindle speed command (S command)

Gear 1 Max. speed (Parameter No.3741)

Gear 2 Max. speed (Parameter No.3742)

Gear 3 Max. speed (Parameter No.3743)

3751

Spindle motor speed when switching from gear 1 to gear 2

3752

Spindle motor speed when switching from gear 2 to gear 3

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to 4095 For gear switching method B, set the spindle motor speed when the gears are switched. Setting value = (Spindle motor speed when the gears are switched / Maximum spindle motor speed) 4095

- 201 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Spindle motor speed

B-63950EN/04

Max. speed (4095, 10V)

Spindle motor max. clamp speed Speed at gear 2-3 change point

Parameter No.3736 Parameter No.3752

Speed at gear 1-2 change point

Parameter No.3751

Spindle motor minimum clamp speed

Parameter No.3735

Gear 1 max. speed parameter No.3741

Gear 2 max. speed parameter No.3742

Gear 3 max speed parameter No.3743

Spindle speed command (S command)

Gear 1-2 change point

Gear 2-3 change point

3761

Spindle speed when switching from gear 1 to gear 2 during tapping

3762

Spindle speed when switching from gear 2 to gear 3 during tapping

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word path min-1 0 to 99999999 When method B is selected as the gear change method in the tapping cycle (when bit 3 (SGT) of parameter No. 3705 is set to 1), set the spindle speed at a change point of each gear.

- 202 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Spindle motor speed

Max. speed (4095, 10V)

Spindle motor max. clamp speed (Parameter No.3736)

Spindle motor minimum clamp speed (Parameter No.3735) Spindle speed command (S command)

Gear 1 Max. speed Parameter No.3741

Gear 2 Max. speed Parameter No.3742

Gear 3 Max. speed Parameter No.3743

Gear 1-2 change point parameter No.3761

Gear 2-3 change point parameter No.3762

3770

Axis as the calculation reference in constant surface speed control

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to Number of controlled axes Set the axis as the calculation reference in constant surface speed control.

NOTE When 0 is set, constant surface speed control is always applied to the X-axis. In this case, specifying P in a G96 block has no effect on the constant surface speed control.
3771 Minimum spindle speed in constant surface speed control mode (G96)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word path min-1 0 to 99999999 Set the minimum spindle speed in the constant surface speed control mode (G96). The spindle speed in constant surface speed control is clamped to the speed given by parameter 3771.

- 203 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
3772 Maximum spindle speed

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word spindle min-1 0 to 99999999 This parameter sets the maximum spindle speed. When a command specifying a speed exceeding the maximum speed of the spindle is specified , or the speed of the spindle exceeds the maximum speed because of the spindle speed override function, the spindle speed is clamped at the maximum speed set in the parameter.

CAUTION 1 When 0 is set in this parameter, the speed of the spindle is not clamped. 2 When spindle speed command control is applied using the PMC, this parameter has no effect, and the spindle speed is not clamped. NOTE 1 For M series, this parameter is valid if the function of constant surface speed control is provided. 2 When the constant surface speed control option is selected, the spindle speed is clamped at the maximum speed, regardless of whether the G96 mode or G97 mode is specified.
3775 Default P command value for spindle selection in multi-spindle control

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to 32767 When bit 3 (MPP) of parameter No. 3703 is set to 1 and bit 2 (MPA) of parameter No. 3706 is set to 1 in multi-spindle control, set a default P command value applicable if S_P_ is not specified even once after power-up.
3781 P code for selecting the spindle in multi-spindle control

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word spindle [Valid data range] 0 to 32767 If bit 3 (MPP) of parameter No. 3703 is set to 1, set the P code to select each spindle under multi-spindle control. Specify the P code in a block containing the S command. [Example] If the P code value for selecting the second spindle is set to 3, S1000 P3; causes the second spindle to rotate at S1000.

- 204 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE 1 This parameter is valid if bit 3 (MPP) of parameter No. 3703 is set to 1. 2 If this parameter is set to 0, the corresponding spindle cannot be selected by a P code. 3 Under multi-path control, the P code specified here is valid for each path. For instance, if the P code to select the first spindle of path 2 is set to 21, specifying S1000 P21; in path 1 causes the first spindle of path 2 to be rotated at S1000. 4 Identical P code values cannot be used for different spindles. (Identical P code values cannot be used even if the paths are different.) 5 When this parameter is used (when bit 3 (MPP) of parameter No. 3703 is set to 1), the spindle command selection signal is invalid. 6 To use this parameter, the multi-spindle control function is needed.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 CSH

3794

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 CSH The spindle control switching function for high-speed cycle machining is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
M code for high-speed switching of Cs contour control

3795

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word spindle None 0 to 99999999 This parameter sets an M code command value for high-speed switching of Cs contour control.

NOTE 1 The parameter setting must not be the same as the M code used for any other function. 2 The parameter set to 0 becomes invalid. 3 If the same value is set for two or more Cs contour control axes within the system, the alarm PS0513, "CS HI-SPEED SWITCHING SETTINGERROR" is issued. 4 The M code set here is buffering-inhibited.

- 205 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 3797 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1

B-63950EN/04 #0 DCN

This parameter is related to Dual Check Safety. See Dual Check Safety CONNECTION MANUAL (B-64003EN) for details.
#7 3798 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 ESN #0 ALM

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 ALM The spindle alarm SP**** for all spindles is: 0: Enabled. 1: Ignored. When this parameter is set to 1, the spindle-related alarms are ignored. So, be sure to set this parameter to 0 at all times except for special cases such as maintenance. ESN When the multi-spindle function is enabled and bit 3 (MPP) of parameter No. 3703 is set to 1, a spindle is specified in a program by using: 0: P command. 1: Extended spindle name. A spindle to be specified is selected as follows:
Bit 1 (ESN) of parameter No. 3798 0 0 1 1 Bit 3 (MPP) of parameter No. 3703 0 1 0 1 Selection method Signal selection P command Signal selection Extended spindle name

#1

NOTE This parameter is valid when bit 0 (EEA) of parameter No. 1000 is set to 1. When setting this parameter to 1, set also parameter No. 3738 and No. 3739 properly.
#7 3799 #6 #5 SSH #4 #3 SVPs #2 ASDs #1 NDPs #0 NALs

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit spindle #0 NALs An alarm detected on the spindle amplifier side is: 0: Displayed. 1: Not displayed. (This parameter is valid when bit 0 (ALM) of parameter No. 3798 is set to 0.) When this parameter is set to 1, an alarm detected on the spindle amplifier side is ignored. So, be sure to set this parameter to 0 at all times except for special cases such as maintenance. NDPs When an analog spindle is used, a position coder disconnection check is: 0: Made. 1: Not made. (This parameter is valid when bit 0 (NAL) of parameter No. 3799 is set to 0.)
- 206 -

#1

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
When no position coder is used with an analog spindle, set this parameter to 1.

#2

ASDs When a serial spindle is used, a spindle speed is calculated based on: 0: Feedback pulses from the position coder. 1: Speed monitor. SVPs As synchronization errors displayed on the spindle screen: 0: Monitor values are displayed. 1: Peak-hold values are displayed, Spindle synchronization errors are displayed on the side of the spindle that functions as a slave axis in spindle synchronization control.
Parameters for Control of Serial Interface Spindle Cs Contouring Control Axis Data Description Number format 3900 Byte path Number of the servo axis whose loop gain is to be changed according to the set values of parameters 3901 to 3904 when the Cs contouring axis is controlled Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for spindle gear 1 selection Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for spindle gear 2 selection Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for spindle gear 3 selection Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for spindle gear 4 selection Number of the servo axis whose loop gain is to be changed according to the set values of parameters 3911 to 3914 when the Cs contouring axis is controlled Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for spindle gear 1 selection Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for spindle gear 2 selection Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for spindle gear 3 selection Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for spindle gear 4 selection Number of the servo axis whose loop gain is to be changed according to the set values of parameters 3921 to 3924 when the Cs contouring axis is controlled Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for spindle gear 1 selection Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for spindle gear 2 selection Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for spindle gear 3 selection Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for spindle gear 4 selection

#3

3901 3902 3903 3904 3910

Word path Word path Word path Word path Byte path First group

3911 3912 3913 3914 3920

Word path Word path Word path Word path Byte path Second group

3921 3922 3923 3924

Word path Word path Word path Word path Third group

- 207 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Number 3930 Data format Byte path Description

B-63950EN/04

3931 3932 3933 3934 3940

3941 3942 3943 3944

Number of the servo axis whose loop gain is to be changed according to the set values of parameters 3931 to 3934 when the Cs contouring axis is controlled Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled Word path for spindle gear 1 selection Fourth Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled Word path group for spindle gear 2 selection Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled Word path for spindle gear 3 selection Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled Word path for spindle gear 4 selection Number of the servo axis whose loop gain is to be changed according Byte path to the set values of parameters 3941 to 3944 when the Cs contouring axis is controlled Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled Word path for spindle gear 1 selection Fifth Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled Word path group for spindle gear 2 selection Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled Word path for spindle gear 3 selection Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled Word path for spindle gear 4 selection

<Setting method> First, select servo axes which perform interpolation with the Cs contouring axis. (Up to five axes can be selected.) When there is no servo axis for interpolation with the Cs contouring axis, set the parameters 3900, 3910, 3920, 3930, and 3940 to 0 to terminate parameter setting. When there are servo axes for interpolation with the Cs contouring axis, the parameters must be set according to the procedure below for each axis. (1) Set the number of a servo axis (1 to maximum number of controlled axes) for interpolation with the Cs contouring axis in parameters 39n0 (n = 0, 1, 2, 3, and 4). (2) Set loop gain values of the servo axis specified in (1) above which is used when the Cs contouring axis is controlled in parameters 39n1, 39n2, 39n3, and 39n4. (There are four stages for main gears used.) (3) When the number of specified servo axes is less than 5, set the remaining parameters (39n0) to 0 to terminate parameter setting. When the number of a Cs contouring axis is set to parameter 39n0, the parameter is assumed to be set to 0.

NOTE 1 In general, it is difficult to set a high loop gain for a spindle motor axis when compared with a servo axis. These parameters are provided so that, by changing the loop gain of a servo axis that requires interpolation with the Cs contour axis, interpolation control can be exercised correctly between the Cs axis and servo axis while the spindle exercises Cs contour control.

- 208 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE 2 The loop gain of the servo axis is changed using the parameter settings made for a spindle gear selected at the time of conversion from the spindle mode to the Cs contour control mode. In normal use, it is unlikely that the gear of the spindle is switched during Cs contour control. However, note that if the gear of the spindle is changed during Cs contour control, the loop gain of the servo axis is not changed. 3 Even when multiple Cs axes are used with one path (bit 7 (CSS) of parameter No. 3704 = 1), these parameters are shared.

#5

SSH On the diagnosis screen, total spindle speed data is: 0: Not displayed. 1: Displayed.

Parameters for Serial interface spindle or spindle


Parameters Nos. 4000 to 4799 below are basically used with the serial spindle amplifier. For details of these parameters, refer to either of the following manuals and other related documents, depending on the spindle that is actually connected. FANUC AC SPINDLE MOTOR i series Parameter Manual (B-65280EN)
3841 Servo motor spindle control axis number

[Data type] Word [Valid data range] 1 to 24 This parameter sets the axis number of an axis to be subject to servo motor spindle control or servo motor spindle synchronization. Setting the parameter to 0 disables servo motor spindle control and servo motor spindle synchronization. For servo motor spindle synchronization, you have to set bit 4 (SPSx) of parameter No. 2016.
3842 Maximum speed for servo motor spindle control

[Data type] 2-word [Valid data range] 0 to 9999 This parameter sets the maximum speed of the spindle to be subject to servo motor spindle control.
3843 Time constant for acceleration/deceleration under servo motor spindle control

[Data type] Word [Unit of data] msec [Valid data range] 0 to 4000 This parameter sets the time constant for acceleration/deceleration under servo motor spindle control and servo motor spindle synchronization. The type of acceleration/deceleration is linear acceleration/deceleration. Set the parameter to the time to be taken for the spindle speed to reach 1000 (min-1).
3844 Master spindle number

[Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to 104


- 209 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

Set the number of the spindle (position coder) to be subject to servo motor spindle synchronization. The hundreds and tens digits represent a path; the units digit represents the number of the position coder in the path. To synchronize the servo axis in the second path and the second position coder in the first path under dual-path control, for example, set this parameter for the second path to 12. When the hundreds and tens digits are both 0, the local path is assumed. When a value of 0 is specified, the first position coder in the local path is assumed.

WARNING 1 The combination of the position coder and servo motor to be synchronized with each other is determined by wire connection. Even though you change the setting of this parameter, therefore, you cannot change the combination of the position coder and servo motor to be synchronized with each other. 2 This parameter is used for acceleration or deceleration to be performed when the synchronization mode is turned on/off. 3 It is dangerous to set a value not matching the actually wire-connected combination as it prevents correct acceleration/deceleration. Be sure to set a value matching the actual wire connection.
#7 4000 to 4015 to 4019 (Note 2) to (No user setting allowed = Note 1) to #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit spindle


4020 to 4133 to

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word spindle


4134 4135

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word spindle


4136 to 4175 to

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word spindle

- 210 -

B-63950EN/04 #7 4176 to 4191 to 4195 (Note 2) #6 #5 #4

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#3 to (No user setting allowed = Note 1) to #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit spindle


4196 to 4309 to

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word spindle


4310 4311

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word spindle


4312 to 4351 to

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word spindle


#7 4352 4353 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit spindle


4354 to 4371 4372 to (No user setting allowed = Note 1)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word spindle


#7 4373 4374 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit spindle


4375 to 4393 to

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word spindle


- 211 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 4394 to 4403 to #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1

B-63950EN/04 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit spindle


4404 to 4466 to

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word spindle


#7 4467 to 4476 to #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit spindle


4477 to 4539 to

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word spindle


#7 4540 to 4549 to #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit spindle


4550 to 4669 to

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word spindle


#7 4670 to 4679 to #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit spindle


4680 to 4799 to

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word spindle

- 212 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE 1 Among the parameters of the spindle amplifier with the serial interface, parameters Nos. 4015 and 4191 cannot be changed by the users. These parameters require to assign optional software to the CNC and are automatically set depending on the type of the software. The setting of parameter No. 4371 is also unchangeable by the user. 2 To set the parameters of the spindle amplifier with the serial interface automatically, set bit 7 of parameter No. 4019 (if the sub spindle is set in the CNC with the spindle switching function, use parameter No. 4195) to 1, assign the model code of the motor to be used to parameter No. 4133 (if the sub spindle is set in the CNC with the spindle switching function, use parameter No. 4309), turn off the power of the CNC and spindle amplifier, and restart the CNC and spindle amplifier. 3 Parameters Nos. 4000 to 4799 are used in the processing on the spindle amplifier. For details of these parameters, refer to either of the following manuals, depending on the serial spindle that is actually used. - FANUC AC SPINDLE MOTOR i series Parameter Manual (B-65280EN) 4 The CNC can control up to eight spindle amplifiers with the serial interface. When the spindle amplifier provides the spindle switching function, one spindle amplifier can control two spindle motors using the switching function. The output switching function can be used in spindle motors to be connected. Up to sixteen spindles, or thirty two types, can be used by switching the spindle motors. (The number of spindles that can controlled simultaneously is the same as the number of spindle amplifiers, that is eight spindles.) Parameters of the spindle amplifier with the serial interface correspond to the above functions as follows: (1) Serial spindle parameters for the first to eighth spindles: Nos. 4000 to 4799 S1toS8 (2) Parameters Nos. 4000 to 4175 "S1" to "S8": When the spindle switching function is not provided, or for the main spindle in the spindle amplifier when the function is provided. Parameter Nos. 4176 to 4351 "S1" to "S8": For the sub spindle in the spindle amplifier when the spindle switching function is provided. (3) Parameters at low speed when the output switching function is provided. Parameters Nos. 4136 to 4175 "S1" to "S8": When the spindle switching function is not provided, or for the main spindle when the function is provided. Parameters Nos. 4284 to 4351 "S1" to "S8": For the sub spindle when the spindle switching function is provided.
- 213 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE 5 The CNC stores the parameters of the spindle amplifier with the serial interface. The CNC sends them to the spindle amplifier at the system power on and they are used in the unit. These parameters are sent from the CNC to the spindle amplifier in a batch when: - The CNC is switched on. If these parameters are rewritten, they are sent from the CNC to the spindle amplifier sequentially when: - The parameters have been entered from the MDI. - The parameters have been entered as programmable (G10). - The parameters have been entered via the reader/punch interface. To set parameters automatically, upload parameters corresponding to the motor model from the spindle amplifier to the CNC prior to the procedure specified above. The parameters of the spindle amplifier with serial interface can be changed after the system starts. Changing the parameters Nos. 4000 to 4799 "S1" to "S8") in the CNC sends them to the spindle amplifier at an appropriate time and the parameters in the unit are updated. (Be careful not to change parameters incorrectly.)
#7 4800 SPK #6 EPZ #5 SCB #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#5 SCB The combination of a master spindle and slave spindle for spindle synchronization depends on: 0: Setting of bit 4 (SSS) of parameter No. 3704. When bit 4 (SSS) of parameter No. 3704 is set to 0 The first spindle and second spindle of each path can be selected as the master spindle and slave spindle, respectively, for spindle synchronization. When bit 4 (SSS) of parameter No. 3704 is set to 1 A combination of arbitrary spindles of each path can be selected for spindle synchronization. Set a master spindle for each slave spindle in parameter No. 4831. Set a spindle number of each path. By setting a spindle number common to the system in parameter No. 4832, an arbitrary spindle that belongs to a different path can be selected as a master spindle for spindle synchronization. Set a spindle number common to the system. Set parameter No. 4831 to 0. Spindle synchronization based on arbitrary spindles must be enabled for the path to which a slave spindle belongs and for the path to which a master spindle belongs.

- 214 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
1: Conventional 16TT system compatible specifications. The first spindle of path 1 and the first spindle of path 2 can be selected as the master spindle and slave spindle, respectively, for spindle synchronization. As control signals, the signal interface of the 16TT system compatible specifications can be used.

#6

EPZ When the parking signal is switched in the reference position established state during Cs contour control exercised using simple spindle synchronous control: 0: Reference position established state is continued. 1: Reference position established state is canceled. If this parameter is set, the same reference position return operation as manual reference position return is performed with the G28 command immediately after the parking signal is switched. The G00 command performs a positioning operation including reference position return (when bit 1 (NRF) of parameter No. 3700 is set to 0). SPK As the parking signals for simple spindle synchronous control: 0: PKESS1<Gn122.6> (first spindle) and PKESS2<Gn122.7> (second spindle) are used. 1: PKESS1<Gn031.6> (first spindle) and PKESS2<Gn031.7> (second spindle) are used.

#7

NOTE 1 This parameter is valid only when bit 5 (SSY) of parameter No. 3704 is set to 0. 2 If the parking signals PK7 and PK8 for synchronization control are used when simple spindle synchronous control and synchronization control are used at the same time, set bit 7 (SPK) of parameter No. 4800 to 1 to use the parking signals PKESS1 and PKESS2 for simple spindle synchronous control as <Gn031.6,Gn031.7>.
#7 4801 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 SNDs

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit spindle

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 SNDs During spindle synchronization control, the rotation direction of each spindle motor is: 0: Same as the specified sign. 1: Opposite to the specified sign.
Error pulse between two spindles when synchronizing phases in the spindle synchronization control mode

4810

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word spindle Detection unit 0 to 255 Set an allowable error pulse value between two spindles at phase synchronization time in the spindle synchronization control mode.
- 215 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

This parameter is used to check the completion of phase synchronization performed in the spindle synchronization control mode and to check the phase difference during spindle synchronization control. When the error pulse value between two spindles become equal to or less than the value set in this parameter, the spindle phase synchronization control completion signals FSPPH<F044.3> and FSPPH1 to 4<F289.0 to 3> are set to 1.
4811 Allowable error count for the error pulses between two spindles in the spindle synchronization control mode

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word spindle Detection unit 0 to 32767 Set the allowable error count for the error pulses between two spindles in the spindle synchronization control mode. This parameter is used to check a spindle synchronization error phase difference. When a spindle synchronization error equal to or greater than the value set in this parameter is detected, the phase error monitor signals SYCAL<F044.4> and SYCAL1 to 4<F043.0 to F043.3> are set to 1.
Master axis of each slave spindle under simple synchronous spindle control

4821

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte spindle [Valid data range] 0 to Maximum number of controlled spindle axes (within a path) When a spindle is set as a slave spindle in simple spindle synchronous control on each spindle, set which spindle (master spindle) the slave spindle is to be synchronized with. [Examples of parameter setting] When simple spindle synchronous control is exercised with the first spindle selected as a master spindle and the second spindle selected as a slave spindle: No. 4821(1)=0 No. 4821(2)=1 No. 4821(3)=0 No. 4821(4)=0 When simple spindle synchronous control is exercised with four spindles under the following combinations: (Two combinations, namely, first spindle (master spindle)/ second spindle (slave spindle), and third spindle (master spindle)/fourth spindle (slave spindle)) No. 4821(1)=0 No. 4821(2)=1 No. 4821(3)=0 No. 4821(4)=3

- 216 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE 1 This parameter is valid if bit 5 (SSY) of parameter No. 3704 is set to 1. 2 The setting of a slave spindle as a master spindle is invalid. Be sure to set 0 for a spindle that is to function as a master spindle. 3 In this parameter, set a spindle number within the same path.

4826

Allowable error count for the error pulses between two spindles in the simple synchronization spindle control mode

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word spindle Detection unit 0 to 32767 Set the allowable error count for the error pulses between two spindles in the simple synchronization spindle control mode. This parameter is used to check a spindle synchronization error phase difference. When a spindle synchronization error equal to or greater than the value set in this parameter is detected, the spindle phase error monitor signals SYCAL<Fn044.4> and SYCALs are set to 1.

NOTE 1 The detection unit per pulse depends on the spindle control mode (Cs contour control, rigid tapping, or spindle positioning). 2 Set this parameter for a spindle that is to function as a slave spindle. Set 0 for the master spindle. 3 In the spindle rotation control mode, synchronization error detection is not performed.
4831 Master axis of each slave spindle under spindle synchronous control

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte spindle [Valid data range] 0 to Maximum number of controlled spindle axes (within a path) When a spindle is set as a slave spindle in spindle synchronization control on each spindle, set which spindle (master spindle) the slave spindle is to be synchronized with. [Examples of parameter setting] When spindle synchronization control is exercised with the first spindle selected as a master spindle and the second spindle selected as a slave spindle: No. 4831(1)=0 No. 4831(2)=1 No. 4831(3)=0 No. 4831(4)=0 When spindle synchronization control is exercised with four spindles under the following combinations: (Two combinations, namely, first spindle (master spindle)/second spindle (slave spindle), and third spindle (master spindle)/fourth spindle (slave spindle)) No. 4831(1)=0 No. 4831(2)=1
- 217 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

No. 4831(3)=0 No. 4831(4)=3 When spindle synchronization control is exercised with one master spindle and multiple slave spindles: (First spindle (master spindle)/second spindle (slave spindle)/third spindle (slave spindle)/fourth spindle (slave spindle)) No. 4831(1)=0 No. 4831(2)=1 No. 4831(3)=1 No. 4831(4)=1

NOTE 1 This parameter is valid if bit 4 (SSS) of parameter No. 3704 is set to 1. 2 The setting of a slave spindle as a master spindle is invalid. Be sure to set 0 for a spindle that is to function as a master spindle. 3 In this parameter, set a spindle number within the same path. When a spindle not belonging to the local path is to be selected as a master spindle for spindle synchronization, set a spindle number common to the system in parameter No. 4832. In such a case, set 0 in this parameter.
4832 Master spindle of each slave spindle under spindle synchronization control (spindle number common to the system)

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte spindle [Valid data range] 0 to Maximum number of controlled spindle axes (common to the system) When a spindle is set as a slave spindle in spindle synchronization control on each spindle, set which spindle (master spindle) the slave spindle is to be synchronized with.

NOTE 1 This parameter is valid if bit 4 (SSS) of parameter No. 3704 is set to 1. Bit 4 (SSS) of parameter No. 3704 must be set to 1 (to enable spindle synchronization based on arbitrary spindles) for the path to which a slave spindle belongs and for the path to which a master spindle belongs. 2 The setting of a slave spindle as a master spindle is invalid. Be sure to set 0 for a spindle that is to function as a master spindle. 3 In this parameter, set a spindle number common to the system. When this parameter is used, parameter No. 4831 is set to 0.
#7 4900 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 FLRs

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit spindle


- 218 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
FLRs When the spindle speed fluctuation detection function is used, the unit of an allowable ratio (q) and fluctuation ratio (r) set by parameters No. 4911 and No. 4912 is: 0: 1% 1: 0.1%
Allowable speed ratio (q) used to assume that the spindle has reached a specified speed

#0

4911

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word spindle 1%, 0.1% 1 to 100, 1 to 1000 When the spindle speed fluctuation detection function is used, set an allowable speed ratio (q) used to assume that the spindle has reached a specified speed.

NOTE The unit of data is determined by bit 0 (FLR) of parameter No. 4900.
4912 Spindle fluctuation ratio (r) for not issuing a spindle speed fluctuation detection alarm

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word spindle 1%, 0.1% 1 to 100, 1 to 1000 When the spindle speed fluctuation detection function is used, set a spindle fluctuation ratio (r) for not issuing an alarm.

NOTE The unit of data is determined by bit 0 (FLR) of parameter No. 4900.
4913 Spindle speed fluctuation width (i) for not issuing a spindle speed fluctuation detection alarm

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word spindle min-1 0 to 99999 When the spindle speed fluctuation detection function is used, set an allowable fluctuation width (i) for not issuing an alarm.
Time (p) from the change of a specified speed until spindle speed fluctuation detection is started

4914

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word spindle msec 0 to 999999 When the spindle speed fluctuation detection function is used, set a time (p) from the change of a specified speed until spindle speed fluctuation detection is started. In other words, spindle speed fluctuation detection is not performed until a set time has elapsed after a specified speed is changed. However, when the actual spindle speed is assumed to have reached a specified value within a set time (p), spindle speed fluctuation detection is started.
- 219 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 4950 IMBs #6 ESIs #5 TRVs #4 #3 #2 ISZs #1 IDMs

B-63950EN/04 #0 IORs

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit spindle #0 IORs Resetting the system in the spindle positioning mode 0: Does not release the mode. 1: Releases the mode IDMs The direction of spindle positioning (half-fixed angle positioning based on M codes) is: 0: Plus direction. 1: Minus direction. ISZs When an M code for switching to the spindle positioning mode is specified for spindle positioning: 0: The spindle is switched to the spindle positioning mode, and spindle orientation operation is performed. 1: Only the switching of the spindle to the spindle positioning mode is performed. (Spindle orientation operation is not performed.) TRVs The rotation direction for spindle positioning is: 0: Same as the specified sign. 1: Opposite to the specified sign.

#1

#2

#5

NOTE When a serial spindle is used, this parameter is invalid for the specification of a rotation direction for the orientation command.
#6 ESIs The unit of rapid traverse rate on the spindle positioning axis is: 0: Not increased by a factor of 10. 1: Increased by a factor of 10. IMBs When the spindle positioning function is used, half-fixed angle positioning based on M codes uses: 0: Specification A 1: Specification B In the case of half-fixed angle positioning based on M codes, three types of spindle positioning operations can occur: (1) The spindle rotation mode is cleared, then the mode is switched to the spindle positioning mode. (After switching to the spindle positioning mode, spindle orientation operation is also performed.) (2) Spindle positioning is performed in the spindle positioning mode. (3) The spindle positioning mode is cleared, then the mode is switched to the spindle rotation mode. In the case of specification A: Operations (1) to (3) are specified using separate M codes. (1) Specified using an M code for switching to the spindle positioning mode. (See parameter No. 4960) (2) Specified using M codes for specifying a spindle positioning angle. (See parameter No. 4962) (3) Specified using M codes for clearing spindle positioning operation. (See parameter No. 4961.)
- 220 -

#7

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
In the case of specification B: When M codes for specifying a spindle positioning angle are specified, operations (1) to (3) are performed successively. (See parameter No. 4962.) (However, spindle orientation operation of (1) is not performed.)
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 DMDx

4959

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 DMDx A machine coordinate on the spindle positioning axis is displayed in: 0: Degrees. 1: Pulses.
M code specifying the spindle orientation

4960

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word spindle [Valid data range] 6 to 97 Set an M code for switching to the spindle positioning mode.

NOTE 1 Do not set an M code that duplicates other M codes used for spindle positioning. 2 Do not set an M code used with other functions (such as M00-05, 30, 98, and 99, and M codes for calling subprograms).
4961 M code releasing the spindle positioning mode

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word spindle [Valid data range] 6 to 97 Set an M code for canceling the spindle positioning mode on the spindle positioning axis.

NOTE 1 Do not set an M code that duplicates other M codes used for spindle positioning. 2 Do not set an M code used with other functions (such as M00-05, 30, 98, and 99, and M codes for calling subprograms).
4962 M code for specifying a spindle positioning angle

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word spindle [Valid data range] 6 to 9999999 Two methods are available for specifying spindle positioning. One method uses axis address for arbitrary-angle positioning. The other use an M code for half-fixed angle positioning. This parameter sets an M code for the latter method.
- 221 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

In this parameter, set an M code to be used for half-fixed angle positioning based on M codes. Six M code from M to M(+5) are used for half-fixed angle positioning, when is the value of this parameter. When the number of M codes is set in parameter No. 4964, let be the value set in parameter No. 4962, and let be the value set in parameter No. 4964. Then, M codes from M to M(+-1) are used as M codes for half-fixed angle positioning based on M codes. The table below indicates the relationship between the M codes and positioning angles.
M code M M(+1) M(+2) M(+3) M(+4) M(+5) : M(+-1) Positioning angle 2 3 4 5 6 : Example: Positioning angle when = 30 30 60 90 120 150 180 : 30

represents the number of M codes set in parameter No. 4964. (When parameter No. 4964 is set to 0, = 6.) represents the basic angular displacement set in parameter No. 4963.

NOTE 1 Do not set an M code that duplicates other M codes used for spindle positioning. 2 Do not set an M code used with other functions (such as M00-05, 30, 98, and 99, and M codes for calling subprograms).
4963 Basic angle for half-fixed angle positioning

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real spindle Degree Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 0 to 60 This parameter sets a basic angular displacement used for half-fixed angle positioning using M codes.
Number of M codes for specifying a spindle positioning angle

4964

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word spindle [Valid data range] 0 to 255 This parameter sets the number of M codes used for Half-fixed angle positioning using M codes. As many M codes as the number specified in this parameter, starting with the M code specified in parameter No. 4962, are used to specify half-fixed angle positioning. Let be the value of parameter No. 4962, and let be the value of parameter No. 4964. That is, M codes from M to M(+-1) are used for half-fixed angle positioning. Setting this parameter to 0 has the same effect as setting 6. That is, M code from M to M(+5) are used for half-fixed angle positioning.
- 222 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE 1 Make sure that M codes from M to M (+-1) do not duplicate other M codes. 2 Do not set an M code that duplicates other M codes used for spindle positioning. 3 Do not set an M code used with other functions (such as M00-05, 30, 98, and 99, and M codes for calling subprograms).

4970

Position gain

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word spindle 0.01/sec 1 to 9999 Set the position gain of the analog spindle in the spindle positioning mode.
Position gain multiplier (first stage) Position gain multiplier (second stage) Position gain multiplier (third stage) Position gain multiplier (fourth stage)

4971 4972 4973 4974

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word spindle [Valid data range] 1 to 32767 Set a position gain multiplier for an analog spindle in spindle positioning. Position gain multiplier GC is obtained from the following equation:
GC = 2048000 360 PC E PLS SP L

PLS Number of pulses output from the position coder (pulses/rev) SP Number of gear teeth on the spindle side PC Number of gear teeth on the position coder side E Specified voltage (V) for turning the spindle motor at 1000 min-1 L Angular displacement of the spindle (degrees) per spindle motor rotation [Example] For the spindle motor and gear ratio given below, GC is calculated as follows: PLS = 4096 pulse/rev SP =1 PC =1 E = 2.2 V L = 360 deg
GC = 2048000 360 1 2.2 = 1100 4096 1 360

NOTE On the assumption that the spindle motor used turns at 4500 min-1 at 10 V, 2.2 V is required to turn the spindle motor at 1000 min-1

- 223 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

4.22
5000

PARAMETERS OF TOOL COMPENSATION (1 OF 3)


#7 #6 #5 #4 ASG #3 #2 #1 MOF #0 SBK

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit path #0 SBK With a block created internally for tool radius - tool nose radius compensation: 0: A single block stop is not performed. 1: A single block stop is performed. This parameter is used to check a program including cutter compensation/tool nose radius compensation. MOF When the tool length compensation shift type (bit 6 (TOS) of parameter No. 5006 is set to 1) is used, if the tool length compensation amount is changed(NOTE 3) in the tool length compensation mode (NOTE 1) when look-ahead blocks are present(NOTE 2): 0: Compensation is performed for the change in compensation amount as the movement type. 1: Compensation is not performed for the change until a tool length compensation command (offset number) and an absolute programming for the compensation axis are specified.

#1

NOTE 1 The tool length compensation mode refers to the following state: Tool length offset (G43/G44) Tool length compensation in tool axis direction (G43.1) Tool center point control (G43.4/G43.5) 2 "When look-ahead blocks are present" means as follows: The modal G code of the G codes (such as tool radius - tool nose radius compensation) of group 07 is other than G40. In the smooth interpolation (G05.1Q2) mode One look-ahead block during automatic operation and multiple look-ahead blocks in the AI contour control mode are not included in the state "when look-ahead blocks are present". 3 Changes in tool length compensation amount are as follows: When the tool length compensation number is changed by H code (or D code for the extended tool selection function for lathe systems) When G43 or G44 is specified to change the direction of tool length compensation When the tool length compensation amount is changed using the offset screen, G10 command, system variable, PMC window, and so forth during automatic operation if bit 1 (EVO) of parameter No. 5001 is set to 1. When the tool length compensation vector is restored after being temporarily canceled by G53, G28, G30, or G30.1 during tool length compensation.

- 224 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
ASG When tool compensation memory B/C (M series) or the tool geometry/wear compensation function (T series) is valid, the compensation amount to be modified by the active offset value change mode based on manual feed is: 0: Geometry compensation value 1: Wear compensation value

#4

NOTE This parameter is valid when the option for tool compensation memory B/C (M series) or tool geometry/wear compensation (T series) is specified.
#7 5001 #6 EVO EVO EVR TAL TLB TLC #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 TLC #1 TLB These bits are used to select a tool length compensation type.
Type Tool length compensation A Tool length compensation B Tool length compensation C TLB 0 1 TLC 0 0 1

The axis to which cutter compensation is applied varies from type to type as described below. Tool length compensation A : Z-axis at all times Tool length compensation B : Axis perpendicular to a specified plane (G17/G18/G19) Tool length compensation C : Axis specified in a block that specifies G43/G44 #3 TAL Tool length compensation C 0: Generates an alarm when two or more axes are offset 1: Not generate an alarm even if two or more axes are offset EVR When a tool compensation value is changed in tool radius - tool nose radius compensation mode: 0: Enables the change, starting from that block where the next D or H code is specified. 1: Enables the change, starting from that block where buffering is next performed. EVO If a tool compensation value modification is made for tool length compensation A or tool length compensation B in the offset mode (G43 or G44): 0: The new value becomes valid in a block where G43, G44, or an H code is specified next. 1: The new value becomes valid in a block where buffering is performed next.
#7 5002 WNP #6 LWM #5 LGC #4 LGT #3 ETC #2 LWT #1 LGN #0

#4

#6

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #1 LGN Geometry offset number of tool offset 0: Is the same as wear offset number 1: Specifies the geometry offset number by the tool selection number
- 225 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE This parameter is valid when the option for tool geometry/wear compensation is specified.
#2 LWT Tool wear compensation is performed by: 0: Moving the tool. 1: Shifting the coordinate system.

NOTE This parameter is valid when the option for tool geometry/wear compensation is specified.
#3 ETC When a T-code command is two digits or shorter, the T code is: 0: Not extended. 1: Extended. When this parameter is 1, two-digit or shorter T-code commands are extended. (Three-digit or longer T-code commands are not extended.) The value after extension is determined by the setting of the number of digits in the offset number in T-code commands (parameter No. 5028).
Parameter No. 5028 1 2 3 or greater Number of digits after extension Extended to two digits Extended to four digits Not extended Sample extension Before extension: T1 After extension: T11 Before extension: T1 After extension: T0101

[Example] Parameter No. 5028 : 2 Parameter No. 3032 : 4 (Allowable number of digits in T code)
Before extension T1 T12 T112 T1122 After extension T0101 (1-digit command is extended to 4 digits.) T1212 (2-digit command is extended to 4 digits.) T112 (Not extended) T1122 (Not extended)

NOTE 1 The setting of the allowable number of digits in T code (parameter No. 3032) indicates the number of digits in a specified command (before being extended). If the number of digits in the command exceeds the allowable number of digits in T code, the alarm PS0003, "TOO MANY DIGIT" is issued. 2 This parameter is dedicated to the lathe system. Tool change is available with the turret type setting (bit 3 (TCT) of parameter No. 5040 = 0). 3 If the number of digits in the offset number in a T-code command (parameter No. 5028) is set to 0, the value after extension is determined by the number of digits in the number of tool compensation values (parameter No. 5024). 4 Common variable #149 for calling a T-code macro is set to the pre-extension value.
- 226 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
LGT Tool geometry compensation 0: Compensated by the shift of the coordinate system 1: Compensated by the tool movement

#4

NOTE This parameter is valid when the option for tool geometry/wear compensation is specified.
#5 LGC When tool geometry compensation is based on coordinate shifting, the tool geometry offset is: 0: Not canceled by a command with offset number 0. 1: Canceled by a command with offset number 0.

NOTE This parameter is valid when the option for tool geometry/wear compensation is specified.
#6 LWM Tool offset operation based on tool movement is performed: 0: In a block where a T code is specified. 1: Together with a command for movement along an axis. WNP Imaginary tool tip number used for tool nose radius compensation, when the tool geometry/wear compensation function is equipped, is the number specified by: 0: Geometry offset number 1: Wear offset number
#7 5003 TGC LVK #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 SUV SUV #0 SUP SUP

#7

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 SUP #1 SUV These bits are used to specify the type of startup/cancellation of tool radius - tool nose radius compensation.
SUV SUP Type 0 0 Operation Type A compensation vector perpendicular to the block next to the startup block or A the block preceding the cancellation block is output. G41 N2 N1 Tool nose radius center path / Tool center path Programmed path

- 227 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
SUV SUP Type 0 1 Operation

B-63950EN/04

Type A compensation vector perpendicular to the startup block or cancellation block B and an intersection vector are output.
Intersection point

Tool nose radius center path / Tool center path Programmed path

G41 N1 1 0 1

N2

Type When the startup block or cancellation block specifies no movement operation, C the tool is shifted by the cutter compensation amount in a direction perpendicular to the block next to the startup or the block before cancellation block. Intersection point Tool nose radius center path / Tool center path Shift G41 N2 N3 Programmed path

When the block specifies movement operation, the type is set according to the SUP setting; if SUP is 0, type A is set, and if SUP is 1, type B is set.

NOTE When SUV,SUP = 0,1 (type B), an operation equivalent to that of FS16i-T is performed.
#6 LVK Tool length compensation vector 0: Cleared by reset 1: Not cleared, but held by reset The tool length compensation vector in the tool axis direction is handled in the same way by this bit. TGC A tool geometry offset based on a coordinate shift is: 0: Not canceled by reset. 1: Canceled by reset.

#7

NOTE This parameter is valid when the option for tool geometry/wear compensation is specified.
#7 5004 #6 #5 #4 #3 TS1 TS1 ODI #2 #1 ORC #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #1 ORC The setting of a tool offset value is corrected as: 0: Diameter value 1: Radius value

- 228 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE This parameter is valid only for an axis based on diameter specification. For an axis based on radius specification, specify a radius value, regardless of the setting of this parameter.

#2

ODI The setting of a tool radius - tool nose radius compensation value is corrected as: 0: Radius value 1: Diameter value TS1 For touch sensor contact detection with the function for direct input of offset value measured B: 0: Four-contact input is used. 1: One-contact input is used.

#3

NOTE For the machining center system, set TS1 to 1.


#7 5005 #6 TLE #5 QNI QNI #4 #3 #2 PRC #1 #0 CNI

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 CNI On the offset screen, Y-axis offset screen, and macro screen, the [INP.C] soft key is: 0: Used. 1: Not used. (The [INP.C] soft key is not displayed.) PRC For direct input of a tool offset value or workpiece coordinate system shift amount: 0: The PRC signal is not used. 1: The PRC signal is used. QNI With the tool length measurement function or the function for direct input of offset value measured B, a tool compensation number is selected by: 0: Operation through the MDI panel by the operator (selection based on cursor operation). 1: Signal input from the PMC. TLE The "direct input of tool offset value measured B" function updates the offset value in offset write mode: 0: Constantly. 1: During axis movement. Axis movement assumes a positional deviation other than 0.
#7 5006 #6 TOS TOS #5 #4 #3 LVC #2 #1 TGC #0 GSC

#2

#5

#6

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit

- 229 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#0

B-63950EN/04

GSC When the function for direct input of offset value measured B is used, an offset write input signal is input from: 0: Machine side 1: PMC side When the interlock function for each axis direction is enabled (when bit 3 (DIT) of parameter No. 3003 is set to 0), switching can also be made between input from the machine side and input from PMC side for the interlock function for each axis direction. TGC If a T code is specified in a block where G50, G04, or G10 is specified: 0: No alarm is issued. 1: The alarm PS0245, T-CODE NOT ALLOWED IN THIS BLOCK is issued. LVC A tool offset (geometry/wear) based on a tool movement and wear offset based on a coordinate shift are: 0: Not canceled by reset. 1: Canceled by reset. TOS Set a tool length compensation operation. 0: Tool length compensation is performed by an axis movement. 1: Tool length compensation is performed by shifting the coordinate system.
#7 #6 3OC 3OC WMC WMH WMA TMA TC3 TC2 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

#1

#3

#6

5007

3OF 3OF

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 TC2 #1 TC3 If a tool length compensation value is set by pressing the [MEASURE] or [+MEASURE] soft key in tool length measurement, the tool automatically moves to the tool change position. Specify at which reference position the tool change position is located.
TC3 0 0 1 1 TC2 0 1 0 1 Meaning The tool change position is at the first reference position. The tool change position is at the second reference position. The tool change position is at the third reference position. The tool change position is at the fourth reference position.

#2

TMA 0: 1: WMA 0: 1:

Tool length measurement is enabled along the Z-axis only. Tool length measurement is enabled along each axis. Surface-based measurement of a workpiece zero point offset value is enabled along the Z-axis only. Surface-based measurement of a workpiece zero point offset value is enabled along each axis. Hole-based measurement of a workpiece zero point offset value is disabled. Hole-based measurement of a workpiece zero point offset value is enabled.

#3

#4

WMH 0: 1: WMC 0:

#5

An axis for workpiece zero point offset value measurement is selected by entering an axis name. 1: An axis for workpiece zero point offset value measurement is selected by using the cursor. This parameter is valid when bit 3 (WMA) of parameter No. 5007 is set to 1.

- 230 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
3OC If tool length compensation is not cancelled before 3-dimensional coordinate conversion is specified, an alarm is: 0: Not raised. 1: Raised. (alarm PS0049, ILLEGAL COMMAND(G68,G69)) 3OF If 3-dimensional coordinate conversion is not nested with a command for tool length compensation, or if 3-dimensional coordinate conversion is specified during tool length compensation and another command for tool length compensation is specified: 0: No alarm is issued. 1: The alarm PS0049, ILLEGAL COMMAND(G68,G69) is issued.

#6

#7

Example 1) An alarm is raised in the following cases: 1) G68 X_ Y_ Z_ I_ J_ K_ R_ ; : G43 H1 ; : PS0049 raised G69 ; : G49 ; 2) G43 H1 ; : G68 X_ Y_ Z_ I_ J_ K_ R_ ; : G49(G43H2,H2 etc.) ; PS0049 raised : G69 ;
Example 2) No alarm is raised in the following cases: 3) G68 X_ Y_ Z_ I_ J_ K_ R_ ; : G43 H1 ; : G49 ; : G69 ; 4) G43 H1 ; : G68 X_ Y_ Z_ I_ J_ K_ R_ ; : G69 ; : G49 ;

NOTE A command to cancel tool length compensation (G28, etc.) will not cause an alarm to be raised. If a command like this is specified in the G68 mode, program as indicated in 3) above.
G43 H1 ; : G68 X_ Y_ Z_ I_ J_ K_ R_ ; : G28 X_ Y_ Z_ ; : G69 ;

Offset is cancelled. No alarm is raised.

- 231 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 5008 #6 #5 #4 MCR #3 CNV #2 #1 CNC

B-63950EN/04 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #1 #3 CNC CNV These bits are used to select an interference check method in the tool radius - tool nose radius compensation mode.
CNV 0 0 1 CNC 0 1 Operation Interference check is enabled. The direction and the angle of an arc are checked. Interference check is enabled. Only the angle of an arc is checked. Interference check is disabled.

For the operation taken when the interference check shows the occurrence of an reference (overcutting) , see the description of bit 5 (CAV) of parameter No. 19607.

NOTE Checking of only the direction cannot be set.


#4 MCR If G41/G42 (tool radius - tool nose radius compensation) is specified in the MDI mode, an alarm is: 0: Not raised. 1: Raised. (alarm PS5257, G41/G42 NOT ALLOWED IN MDI MODE)
#7 5009 #6 #5 TIP #4 TSD #3 #2 #1 #0 GSC

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 GSC When the function for direct input of offset value measured B is used, an offset write input signal is input from: 0: Machine side 1: PMC side When the interlock function for each axis direction is enabled (when bit 3 (DIT) of parameter No. 3003 is set to 0), switching can also be made between input from the machine side and input from PMC side for the interlock function for each axis direction. TSD In the function for direct input of offset value measured B, the movement direction determination specifications: 0: Do not apply. 1: Apply. This parameter is valid when four-contact input is used (bit 3 (TS1) of parameter No. 5004 is set to 0). TIP In tool radius - tool nose radius compensation, the virtual tool tip direction is: 0: Not used. 1: Used.
- 232 -

#4

#5

B-63950EN/04 5010

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Limit for ignoring the small movement resulting from tool radius - tool nose radius compensation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) When the tool moves around a corner in cutter compensation or tool nose radius compensation mode, the limit for ignoring the small travel amount resulting from compensation is set. This limit eliminates the interruption of buffering caused by the small travel amount generated at the corner and any change in feedrate due to the interruption.
If Vx Vlimit and VY Vlimit, this vector is ignored.

Vx

V Y
r S Even if Vx Vlimit and VY Vlimit, vector to single-block stop point remains.

Tool center path N1 Programmed path

N2

Vlimit is determined depending on the setting in parameter No. 5010.

5011

Constant denominator for 3-dimensional tool compensation or tool length compensation in a specified direction

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the value of p in the expressions used for finding a 3-dimensional tool compensation vector:
Vx = i r / p Vy = j r / p Vz = k r / p

where, : Components of a 3-dimensional tool compensation vector along the X-axis, Y-axis, and Z-axis, or their parallel axes i, j, k : Values specified in addresses I, J, and K in the program r : Compensation value p : Value set in this parameter When 0 is set in this parameter, the following is assumed:
Vx,Vy ,Vz

p=

I2 + J 2 + K2

- 233 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
5013 Maximum value of tool wear compensation

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (offset unit) The increment system of a tool offset value is followed. The settings of bits 3 to 0 (OFE, OFD, OFC, and OFA) of parameter No. 5042 are followed. For metric input
OFE 0 0 0 0 1 OFD 0 0 0 1 0 OFD 0 0 0 1 0 OFC 0 0 1 0 0 OFC 0 0 1 0 0 OFA 1 0 0 0 0 OFA 1 0 0 0 0 Valid data range 0 to 9999.99mm 0 to 9999.999mm 0 to 9999.9999mm 0 to 9999.99999mm 0 to 999.999999mm Valid data range 0 to 999.999inch 0 to 999.9999inch 0 to 999.99999inch 0 to 999.999999inch 0 to 99.9999999inch

For inch input


OFE 0 0 0 0 1

This parameter sets the maximum allowable tool wear compensation value. If an attempt is made to set a tool wear compensation value, the absolute value of which exceeds the value set in this parameter, the following alarm or warning is output:
Input from MDI Input by G10 Warning: Too many digits Alarm PS0032: ILLEGAL OFFSET VALUE IN G10.

When 0 or a negative value is set, no maximum allowable value is applied. [Example] When 30.000 is set As a tool offset value, a value from -30.000 to +30.000 can be input.
5014 Maximum value of incremental input for tool wear compensation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (offset unit) The increment system of a tool offset value is followed. The settings of bits 3 to 0 (OFE, OFD, OFC, and OFA) of parameter No. 5042 are followed. For metric input
OFE 0 0 0 0 1 OFD 0 0 0 1 0 OFD 0 0 0 1 0 OFC 0 0 1 0 0 OFC 0 0 1 0 0 OFA 1 0 0 0 0 OFA 1 0 0 0 0 Valid data range 0to9999.99mm 0to9999.999mm 0to9999.9999mm 0to9999.99999mm 0to999.999999mm Valid data range 0to999.999inch 0to999.9999inch 0to999.99999inch 0to999.999999inch 0to99.9999999inch

For inch input


OFE 0 0 0 0 1

- 234 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Set the maximum allowable value for the tool wear compensation value, input as an incremental value. If the incremental input value (absolute value) exceeds the set value, the following alarm or warning message is output:
Input from MDI Input by G10 Warning: Too many digits Alarm PS0032: ILLEGAL OFFSET VALUE IN G10.

When 0 or a negative value is set, no maximum allowable value is applied.


5015 5016 5017 5018 5056 5057 5058 5059 Distance to X-axis + contact surface of touch sensor 1 (X1P) Distance to X-axis - contact surface of touch sensor 1 (X1M) Distance to Z-axis + contact surface of touch sensor 1 (Z1P) Distance to Z-axis - contact surface of touch sensor 1 (Z1M) Distance to X-axis + contact surface of touch sensor 2 (X2P) Distance to X-axis - contact surface of touch sensor 2 (X2M) Distance to Z-axis + contact surface of touch sensor 2 (Z2P) Distance to Z-axis - contact surface of touch sensor 2 (Z2M)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) This parameter is related to the function for direct input of offset value measured B. Set the distance (signed) from a measurement reference position to each contact surface of a sensor. For a diameter specification axis, set a diameter value. When arbitrary angular axis control is performed, set the distance in the Cartesian coordinate system.

NOTE Parameters Nos. 5056 to 5059 are valid when bit 0 (2NR) of parameter No. 5051 is set to 1.
Measurement reference position X1m X-axis - contact surface

X1p Z-axis + contact surface Z-axis - contact surface

+X X-axis + contact surface

Z1m

Z1p +Z

- 235 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Measuremenet reference position X-axis contact surface X2m

B-63950EN/04

X2p Z-axis + contact surface

Z-axis contact surface

+X

Z2m X-axis + contact surface Z2p +Z

5020

Tool offset number used with the function for direct input of offset value measured B

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to number of tool compensation values Set a tool offset number used with the function for direct input of offset value measured B (when a workpiece coordinate system shift amount is set). (Set the tool offset number corresponding to a tool under measurement beforehand.) This parameter is valid when automatic tool offset number selection is not performed (when bit 5 (QNI) of parameter No. 5005 is set to 0).
5021 Number of interpolation cycles of pulses stored until the tool is about to touch the touch sensor

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 8 When a touch sensor with one contact signal input is used for the "direct input of tool offset value measured B" function or when the movement direction determination specification is enabled, set the number of interpolation cycles of pulses stored until the tool is about to touch the touch sensor by manual operation. When 0 is set, the specification of the maximum value 8 is assumed.

NOTE This parameter is valid when bit 3 (TS1) of parameter No. 5004 or bit 4 (TSD) of parameter No. 5009 is set to 1.
5022

Distance (L) from reference tool tip position to the reference measurement surface

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999)
- 236 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
For each axis, this parameter sets the distance from the reference tool tip position to the reference measurement surface when the machine is at the machine zero point.

Machine zero point (Tool tip position of reference tool)

Tool T01 OFSL OFSL

Tool T01

Zm Zt Zm

L Measurement surface

Workpiece Measurement surface Reference measurement surface Reference block Hm Hm

Table on the machine L:

Table on the machine

Distance from the reference tool tip to the reference measurement surface (machine coordinates of the reference measurement surface) Hm: Distance from the reference measurement surface to actual measurement surface Zm: Distance from the tool tip of the measured tool at the machine zero point to the measurement surface Zt: Distance from the tool tip of the measured tool at the machine zero point to the reference measurement surface OFSL: Tool length compensation (OFSL = Zm-Hm-L)

5024

Number of tool compensation values

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to 999 Set the maximum allowable number of tool compensation values used for each path. Ensure that the total number of values set in parameter No. 5024 for the individual paths is within the number of compensation values usable in the entire system. The number of compensation values usable in the entire system depends on the option configuration. If the total number of values set in parameter No. 5024 for the individual paths exceeds the number of compensation values usable in the entire system, or 0 is set in parameter No. 5024 for all paths, the number of compensation values usable for each path is a value obtained by dividing the number of compensation values usable in the entire system by the number of paths. Tool compensation values as many as the number of compensation values used for each path are displayed on the screen. If tool compensation numbers more than the number of compensation values usable for each path are specified, an alarm is issued.
- 237 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

For example, 64 tool compensation sets are used, 20 sets may be allocated to path 1, 30 sets to path 2, and 14 sets to path 3. All of 64 sets need not be used.
5028 Number of digits of an offset number used with a T code command

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 3 Specify the number of digits of a T code portion that is used for a tool offset number (wear offset number when the tool geometry/wear compensation function is used). When 0 is set, the number of digits is determined by the number of tool compensation values. When the number of tool compensation values is 1 to 9: Lower 1 digit When the number of tool compensation values is 10 to 99: Lower 2 digits When the number of tool compensation values is 100 to 999: Lower 3 digits [Example] When an offset number is specified using the lower 2 digits of a T code, set 2 in parameter No. 5028. Txxxxxx yy xxxxxx : Tool selection yy : Tool offset number

NOTE A value longer than the setting of parameter No. 3032 (allowable number of digits of a T code) cannot be set.
5029 Number of tool compensation value memories common to paths

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to 999 When using memories common to paths, set the number of common tool compensation values in this parameter. Ensure that the setting of this parameter does not exceed the number of tool compensation values set for each path (parameter No. 5024). [Example 1] When parameter No. 5029 = 10, parameter No. 5024 (path 1) = 15, and parameter No. 5024 (path 2) = 30 in a 2-path system, tool compensation numbers 1 to 10 of all paths are made common. [Example 2] When parameter No. 5029 = 20 and the other conditions are the same as for Example 1, tool compensation numbers 1 to 15 are made common.

NOTE 1 When a multi-path system involving the machining center system and lathe system is used, memories are made common in each system. 2 In each of the machining center system and lathe system, the same unit of tool compensation values needs to be used.

- 238 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE 3 Ensure that the setting of parameter No. 5029 does not exceed the number of tool compensation values for each path (parameter No. 5024). If the setting of parameter No. 5029 exceeds the number of compensation values of a path, the least of the numbers of compensation values in all paths is made common. 4 When 0 or a negative value is set, memories common to paths are not used.

5032

Direction of tool offset B

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 7 Specify the offset direction of tool offset B (G43, G44).
When G43 is specified 3 Y 4 X 5 6 1 2 3 0 0 4 2 1 7 When G44 is specified 6 5

Setting value of parameter No. 5032 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

Offset direction G43 X+a X+a Y+a Y+a X-a Y+a X-a X-a Y-a Y-a X+a Y-a G44 X-a X-a Y-a Y-a X+a Y-a X+a X+a Y+a Y+a X-a Y+a

a : Offset value set to offset memory number specified by H code


#7 5033 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 GOB

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

- 239 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#0 GOB The tool offset B function (for a gas cutting machine) is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
#7 5040 NO4 #6 #5 #4 TLG #3 TCT #2 MOF MOF #1

B-63950EN/04

#0 OWD

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 OWD In radius programming (bit 1 (ORC) of parameter No. 5004 is set to 1), 0: Tool offset values of both geometry compensation and wear compensation are specified by radius. 1: Tool offset value of geometry compensation is specified by radius and tool offset value of wear compensation is specified by diameter, for an axis of diameter programming.

NOTE This parameter is valid when the option for tool geometry/wear compensation is specified.
#2 MOF The DI/DO signals used with the active offset value modification mode based on manual feed are: 0: G297.4, G297.5, G297.6, and F297.5 1: G203.4, G203.5, G203.6, and F199.5 TCT The tool change method is based on: 0: Turret rotation. (Tool change operation is performed with a T command only.) With a T command, an auxiliary function and tool offset operation are performed. 1: Automatic tool changer (ATC). (Tool change operation is performed with an M command (such as M06)). With a T command, an auxiliary function only is performed. This parameter is valid with a lathe system only.

#3

WARNING Before changing the setting of this parameter, cancel the offset. If the setting is changed while the offset is applied, the subsequent offset operation may not be performed correctly or an alarm PS0368 occurs.
#4 TLG When tool change operation is performed with the automatic tool changer (when bit 3 (TCT) of parameter No. 5040 is set to 1), tool offset operation is specified by: 0: G43.7. At this time, G43 and G44 function as G codes for tool length compensation. 1: G43. At this time, G43.7 and G44.7 function as G codes for tool length compensation. NO4 4th axis offset function is: 0: Used. 1: Not used.

#7

- 240 -

B-63950EN/04 #7 5041 #6 AON AON #5 #4

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#3 #2 #1 ATP #0 ACR ACR

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 ACR When the active offset value modification mode based on manual feed is selected in the reset state or cleared state, the tool compensation value is: 0: Changeable. 1: Not changeable. For the M series In the cleared state (when bit 6 (CLR) of parameter No. 3402 is set to 1), the tool compensation value changeability depends on the setting of bit 7 (CFH) of parameter No. 3409 as indicated below.
Parameter ACR=0 Parameter CFH=0 Parameter CFH=1 Not changeable Changeable Parameter ACR=1 Not changeable Not changeable

For the T series The tool compensation value changeability depends on the settings of this parameter, bit 3 (LVC) of parameter No. 5006, and bit 7 (TGC) of parameter No. 5003 as indicated below.
Parameter ACR=0 Parameter LVC=0 Parameter LVC=1 Parameter TGC=0 Parameter TGC=1 Changeable Not changeable Changeable Not changeable Parameter ACR=1

Not changeable

#1

ATP When the tool compensation value in the active offset value modification mode based on manual feed is changed: 0: By moving the tool along the X-axis, Z-axis, and Y-axis, the compensation value for each axis can be changed.
Move axis X-axis Z-axis Y-axis Selected offset value X-axis compensation value Z-axis compensation value Y-axis compensation value State display TOFS TOFS TOFS

1:

By moving the tool along an arbitrary axis (other than rotation axes), the compensation value can be changed according to the selection of the output signals AOFS1 and AOFS2 (Gn297.5, Gn297.6).
Output signal AOFS2 AOFS1 0 0 1 0 1 1 Selected offset value X-axis compensation value Z-axis compensation value Y-axis compensation value State display OFSX OFSZ OFSY

NOTE Do not change the setting of this parameter in the active offset value modification mode.

- 241 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#6

B-63950EN/04

AON When the tool compensation value (tool length compensation value used with tool length compensation A/B in the case of the M series) is changed in the active offset value modification mode: 0: In the case of the M series, the change becomes effective starting with the next block specifying G43, G44, or an H code. In the case of the T series, the change becomes effective starting with the next block specifying a T code. 1: The change becomes effective starting with the next block to be buffered.

NOTE 1 This parameter is valid when bit 6 (EVO) of parameter No. 5001 is set to 0. 2 The operation of this parameter set to 1 is valid even if a new compensation value is further changed by MDI input or a G10 command before the new compensation value becomes effective. 3 The operation of this parameter set to 1 is invalid if a reset operation is performed before a new compensation value becomes effective.
#7 5042 #6 #5 #4 #3 OFE #2 OFD #1 OFC #0 OFA

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 OFA #1 OFC #2 OFD #3 OFE These bits are used to specify the increment system and valid data range of a tool offset value.
For metric input OFE OFD 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 1 0 OFC 0 0 1 0 0 OFA 1 0 0 0 0 Unit 0.01mm 0.001mm 0.0001mm 0.00001mm 0.000001mm Valid data range 9999.99mm 9999.999mm 9999.9999mm 9999.99999mm 999.999999mm

For inch input OFE OFD 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 1 0

OFC 0 0 1 0 0

OFA 1 0 0 0 0

Unit 0.001inch 0.0001inch 0.00001inch 0.000001inch 0.0000001inch

Valid data range 999.999inch 999.9999inch 999.99999inch 999.999999inch 99.9999999inch

- 242 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Axis number for which Y-axis offset is used

5043

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 24 Set the number of an axis for which the tool offset is corrected. If 0 or a value beyond the valid data range is set, the Y-axis offset is applied to the Y-axis of the basic three axes. If setting is made for the X- or Z-axis of the basic three axes, the standard tool offset for the X- or Z-axis is not used, and only the Y-axis offset is used.
5044 Axis number for which 4th-axis offset is used

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0, 1 to number of controlled axes Set the number of an axis for which the 4th-axis offset is used. When a value ranging from 1 to the number of controlled axes is set in this parameter, the 4th-axis offset is applied to the set axis number. If 0 or a value beyond the valid data range is set, the 4th-axis offset is not used. For the basic two axes X and Z, the standard tool offsets are used, so the 4th-axis offset cannot be used. When the axis set for the Y-axis offset function is set in this parameter, the Y-axis offset is used for the axis, and the 4th-axis offset is not used.

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
5045 Axis number for which 5th-axis offset is used

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0, 1 to number of controlled axes Set the number of an axis for which the 5th-axis offset is used. When a value ranging from 1 to the number of controlled axes is set in this parameter, the 5th-axis offset is applied to the set axis number. If 0 or a value beyond the valid data range is set, the 5th-axis offset is not used. For the basic two axes X and Z, the standard tool offsets are used, so the 5th-axis offset cannot be used. When the axis set for the Y-axis offset function is set in this parameter, the Y-axis offset is used for the axis, and the 4th-axis offset is not used. When settings are made so that both the 5th-axis offset and 4th-axis offset apply to the same axis, only the 4th-axis offset is used, and the 5th-axis offset is not used.

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#7 5051 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 2AT #0 2NR

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

- 243 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#0 2NR When the direct input of offset value measured B for 2 spindle lathe is used: 0: One touch sensor is used. 1: Two touch sensors are used.

B-63950EN/04

#1

2AT When a workpiece coordinate system shift amount is set in the workpiece coordinate system memory with the direct input of offset value measured B for 2 spindle lathe: 0: A setting is made at the current cursor position. 1: An automatic selection is made.
Tool compensation number shift amount for the direct input of offset value measured B for 2 spindle lathe

5053

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to number of tool compensation values When the direct input of offset value measured B for 2 spindle lathe is used, tool compensation numbers used to set measured tool compensation values are divided into two groups, one for spindle 1 and the other for spindle 2. [Example] When there are 32 tool offset pairs
Setting 8 Spindle 1 Spindle 2 1 to 8 9 to 32 10 1 to 10 11 to 32

When this parameter is set to 0 or a value greater than the maximum number of tool offset pairs, the table below is applied.
Number of tool offset pairs

32 pairs 1 to 16 17 to 32

64 pairs 1 to 32 33 to 64

99 pairs 1 to 49 50 to 98

200 pairs

400 pairs

499 pairs

999 pairs

Spindle 1 Spindle 2
5054 5055

1 to 100 1 to 200 1 to 249 1 to 499 101 to 200 201 to 400 250 to 498 500 to 998

Workpiece coordinate system memory for spindle 1 Workpiece coordinate system memory for spindle 2

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 54 to 59 Specify a workpiece coordinate system from G54 to G59 for which a workpiece coordinate system shift amount is set. When parameter No. 5054 or No. 5055 is set to 0 or a value beyond the valid data range, the specification of 54 is assumed for the workpiece coordinate system memory for spindle 1, or the specification of 57 is assumed for the workpiece coordinate system memory for spindle 2.

NOTE These parameters are valid when bit 1 (2AT) of parameter No. 5051 is set to 1.
5071

Number of first axis for grinding wheel wear compensation

5072

Number of second axis for grindingwheel wear compensation

- 244 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Input type] Parameter Input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to number of controlled axis This parameter specifies the controlled axis numbers of the first and second axis for which grinding-wheel wear compensation is applied.
5081

1st-axis coordinate value of compensation center 1 in grinding-wheel wear compensation

5082

2nd-axis coordinate value of compensation center 1 in grinding-wheel wear compensation

5083

1st-axis coordinate value of compensation center 2 in grinding-wheel wear compensation

5084

2nd-axis coordinate value of compensation center 2 in grinding-wheel wear compensation

5085

1st-axis coordinate value of compensation center 3 in grinding-wheel wear compensation

5086

2nd-axis coordinate value of compensation center 3 in grinding-wheel wear compensation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Set the coordinate value (in the workpiece coordinate system) of the center of compensation in grinding-wheel wear compensation.

4.23
4.23.1
5101

PARAMETERS OF CANNED CYCLES


Parameters of Canned Cycle for Drilling (1 of 2)
#7 M5B #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 RTR #1 EXC EXC #0 FXY FXY

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 FXY The drilling axis in the drilling canned cycle, or cutting axis in the grinding canned cycle is: 0: In case of the Drilling canned cycle: Z-axis at all times. In case of the Grinding canned cycle: For the Lathe system X-axis at all times. For the Machining Center system G75,G77 command :Y-axis G78,G79 command :Z-axis 1: Axis selected by the program
- 245 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE In the case of the T series, this parameter is valid only for the drilling canned cycle in the Series 15 format.
#1 EXC G81 0: Specifies a drilling canned cycle 1: Specifies an external operation command RTR G83 and G87 0: Specify a high-speed peck drilling cycle 1: Specify a peck drilling cycle M5B In drilling canned cycles G76 and G87: 0: Outputs M05 before an oriented spindle stops 1: Not output M05 before an oriented spindle stops
#7 5102 RDI #6 RAB #5 #4 #3 F16 #2 QSR QSR #1 #0

#2

#7

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #2 QSR Before a multiple repetitive canned cycle (G70 (T series), G70.7 (M series) to G73 (T series), G73.7 (M series)) is started, a check to see if the program contains a block that has the sequence number specified in address Q is: 0: Not made. 1: Made. When 1 is set in this parameter and the sequence number specified in address Q is not found, the alarm PS0063 is issued and the canned cycle is not executed. F16 When the Series 15 format is used (with bit 1 (FCV) of parameter No.0001 set to 1), a canned drilling cycle is specified using : 0: Series 15 format 1: Series 16 format. However, the number of repetitions is specified using address L. RAB When a canned drilling cycle using the Series 15 format is specified (with bit 1 (FCV) of parameter No. 0001 set to 1 and bit 3 (F16) of parameter No. 5102 set to 0), address R specifies: 0: Increment command. 1: Absolute command with G code system A. With G code system B or C, G90 and G91 are followed. RDI When a canned drilling cycle using the Series 15 format is specified (with bit 1 (FCV) of parameter No. 0001 set to 1 and bit 3 (F16) of parameter No. 5102 set to 0), address R is based on: 0: Radius specification. 1: Diameter/radius specification of the drilling axis.
#7 5103 #6 TCZ TCZ #5 #4 #3 PNA #2 DCY DCY SIJ #1 #0

#3

#6

#7

[Input type] Parameter input


- 246 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Data type] Bit path #0 SIJ When the Series 15 program format is used (with bit 1 (FCV) of parameter No.0001 set to 1), a tool shift value for the drilling canned cycle G76 or G87 is specified by: 0: Address Q. Set a tool retraction direction in parameter No. 5148. 1: Address I, J, or K. DCY When an axis (to be used as a drilling axis) perpendicular to the positioning plane is specified in a drilling canned cycle: 0: The specified axis is used as a drilling axis. 1: The axis specified in the block where the G code for the drilling canned cycle is specified is used as a drilling axis. The specified axis is used as a positioning axis.

#2

NOTE This parameter is valid when bit 0 (FXY) of parameter No. 5101 is set to 1.
#3 PNA In a drilling canned cycle using the Series 15 format (with bit 1 (FCV) of parameter No. 0001 set to 1 and bit 3 (F16) of parameter No. 5102 set to 0), when a plane where no axis is present is specified in the drilling canned cycle mode: 0: An alarm is issued. 1: No alarm is issued. TCZ In a tapping cycle (excluding rigid tapping), an accumulated zero check in the tapping step (forward, backward) is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed. Execute a tapping cycle (excluding rigid tapping) with the servo feed forward (bit 1 (FEED) of parameter No. 2005). If an impact is detected, set this parameter to 1.
#7 5104 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 FCK FCK #1 #0

#6

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #2 FCK In a multiple repetitive canned cycle (G71 (T series), G71.7 (M series), G72 (T series), G72.7 (M series)), the machining profile is: 0: Not checked. 1: Checked. The target figure specified by G71, G71.7, G72, or G72.7 is checked for the following before machining operation: If the start point of the canned cycle is less than the maximum value of the machining profile even when the plus sign is specified for a finishing allowance, the alarm PS0322, FINISHING SHAPE WHICH OVER OF STARTING POINT is issued. If the start point of the canned cycle is greater than the minimum value of the machining profile even when the minus sign is specified for a finishing allowance, the alarm PS0322 is issued.

- 247 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

If an unmonotonous command of type I is specified for the axis in the cutting direction, the alarm PS0064, THE FINISHING SHAPE IS NOT A MONOTONOUS CHANGE(FIRST AXES) or PS0329, THE FINISHING SHAPE IS NOTA MONOTONOUS CHANGE(SECOND AXES) is issued. If an unmonotonous command is specified for the axis in the roughing direction, the alarm PS0064 or PS0329 is issued. If the program does not include a block that has a sequence number specified by address Q, the alarm PS0063, THE BLOCK OF A SPECIFIED SEQUENCE NUMBER IS NOT FOUND is issued. This check is made, regardless of bit 2 (QSR) of parameter No. 5102. If a command (G41/G42) on the blank side in tool nose radius compensation is inadequate, the alarm PS0328, ILLEGAL WORK POSITION IS IN THE TOOL NOSE RADIUS COMPENSATION is issued.
#7 #6 #5 TFA TFA #4 K0D #3 M5T M5T #2 RF2 RF2 #1 RF1 RF1 #0 SBC SBC

5105

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 SBC In a drilling canned cycle, chamfer cycle, or corner rounding cycle: 0: A single block stop is not performed. 1: A single block stop is performed. RF1 In a multiple repetitive canned cycle (G71 (T series), G71.7 (M series), G72 (T series), G72.7 (M series)) of type I, roughing is: 0: Performed. 1: Not performed.

#1

NOTE When a roughing allowance (i/k) is specified using the Series 15 program format, roughing is performed, regardless of the setting of this parameter.
#2 RF2 In a multiple repetitive canned cycle (G71 (T series), G71.7 (M series), G72 (T series), G72.7 (M series)) of type II, roughing is: 0: Performed. 1: Not performed.

NOTE When a roughing allowance (i/k) is specified using the Series 15 program format, roughing is performed, regardless of the setting of this parameter.
#3 M5T When the rotation direction of the spindle is changed from forward rotation to reverse rotation or from reserve rotation to forward rotation in a tapping cycle (G84/G88 with the T series, or G84/G74 with the M series): 0: M05 is output before output of M04 or M03. 1: M05 is not output before output of M04 or M03.

- 248 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
K0D When K0 is specified in a drilling canned cycle (G80 to G89): 0: Drilling operation is not performed, but drilling data only is stored. 1: One drilling operation is performed. TFA During tool center point control or tool length compensation in tool axis direction, canned cycles: 0: Cannot be used. 1: Can be used. However, an alarm PS5424, ILLEGAL TOOL DIRECTION is issued if the position of the rotation axis is not 90 n (n=0, 1, 2, ...) in the workpiece coordinate system.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 GFX

#4

#5

5106

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 GFX When the options of multiple respective canned cycle and grinding canned cycle are both specified, G71/G72/G73/G74 commands are: 0: Multiple respective canned cycle. 1: Grinding canned cycle.
#7 5107 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 ASC ASC #0 ASU ASU

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 ASU For G71 (T series), G71.7 (M series), G72 (T series), or G72.7 (M series), movement to the last turning start position is performed by: 0: Cutting feed. 1: Rapid traverse. For two-cycle operation to move toward the current turning start position, this parameter selects the feed in the first cycle (movement to the last turning start position). The feed in the second cycle (movement from the last turning start position to the current turning start position) follows the feed in the first block of the shape program. This parameter is valid to both of type-I and type-II commands. #1 ASC The G71/G72 and G71.7/G72.7 TYPE1 commands execute the movement toward the current turning start position in: 0: Two cycles. 1: One cycle. You can change the two-cycle operation to move to the current turning start position from two cycles to one cycle. The feed mode follows the mode (G00, G01) in the first block of the shape program. This parameter is valid only to type-I commands.
- 249 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
5110 M code for C-axis clamping in canned cycles for drilling

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to 99999998 This parameter sets the M code for C-axis clamping in canned cycles for drilling.

NOTE When bit 4 (CME) of parameter No. 5161 is 1, the M code for C-axis clamping for the first pair is assumed.
5111 Dwell time when C-axis unclamping is specified in drilling canned cycle

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to 32767 [Unit of data]
Increment system IS-A 10 IS-B 1 IS-C 0.1 IS-D 0.01 IS-E 0.001 Unit msec

(The increment system does not depend on whether inch input or metric input is used.) This parameter sets the dwell time when C-axis unclamping is specified in a drilling canned cycle.
5112 Spindle forward-rotation M code in drilling canned cycle

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to 99999999 This parameter sets the spindle forward-rotation M code in a drilling canned cycle.

NOTE M03 is output when 0 is set.


5113 Spindle reverse-rotation M code in drilling canned cycle

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to 99999999 This parameter sets the spindle reverse-rotation M code in a drilling canned cycle.

NOTE M04 is output when 0 is set.


5114 Return value of high-speed peck drilling cycle

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Real path [Unit of data] mm, inch (input unit)
- 250 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Min. unit of data] Depend on the increment system of the reference axis [Valid data range] 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the return value in high-speed peck drilling cycle.
G73 (M series) G83 (T series, when the bit 2 (RTR) of parameter No. 5101 is set to 0)
q : Depth of cut d : Return value R point q d

q Z point

5115

Clearance value in a peck drilling cycle

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets a clearance value in a peck drilling cycle.
G83 (M series) G83 (T series, when the bit 2 (RTR) of parameter No. 5101 is set to 1)
q : Depth of cut d : Clearance value R point q d

q Z point

4.23.2
5130

Parameters of Thread Cutting Cycle


Cutting value (chamfering value) in thread cutting cycles G92 and G76 Cutting value (chamfering value) in thread cutting cycle G76.7

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Byte path 0.1 0 to 127 This parameter sets a cutting value (chamfering value) in the thread cutting cycle (G76/G76.7) of a multiple repetitive canned cycle and in the thread cutting cycle (G92) of a canned cycle. Let L b a lead. Then, a cutting value range from 0.1L to 12.7L is allowed.
- 251 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

To specify a cutting value of 10.0L, for example, specify 100 in this parameter.
5131 Cutting angle in thread cutting cycles G92 and G76 Cutting angle in thread cutting cycle G76.7

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Byte path Degree 1 to 89 This parameter sets a thread cutting angle in a thread cutting cycle (G92/G76/G76.7). When 0 is set, an angle of 45 degrees is specified.

4.23.3
5132

Parameters of Multiple Repetitive Canned Cycle


Depth of cut in multiple repetitive canned cycles G71 and G72 Depth of cut in multiple repetitive canned cycles G71.7 and G72.7

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the depth of cut in multiple repetitive canned cycles G71 and G72 or G71.7 and G72.7. This parameter is not used with the Series 15 program format.

NOTE Specify a radius value at all times.


5133 Escape in multiple repetitive canned cycles G71 and G72 Escape in multiple repetitive canned cycles G71.7 and G72.7

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the escape in multiple repetitive canned cycles G71 and G72 or G71.7 and G72.7.

NOTE Specify a radius value at all times.


5134 Clearance value in multiple repetitive canned cycles G71 and G72 Clearance value in multiple repetitive canned cycles G71.7 and G72.7

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis
- 252 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Valid data range] 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) This parameter sets a clearance value up to the cutting feed start point in multiple repetitive canned cycles (G71/G72 or G71.7/G72.7).

NOTE Specify a radius value at all times.


5135 Retraction distance in the multiple repetitive canned cycle G73 (second axis on the plane) Retraction distance in the multiple repetitive canned cycle G73.7 (second axis on the plane)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets a retraction distance along the second axis on the plane in the multiple repetitive canned cycle G73 or G73.7. This parameter is not used with the Series 15 program format.

NOTE Specify a radius value at all times.


5136 Retraction distance in the multiple repetitive canned cycle G73 (first axis on the plane) Retraction distance in the multiple repetitive canned cycle G73.7 (first axis on the plane)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets a retraction distance along the first axis on the plane in the multiple repetitive canned cycle G73 or G73.7. This parameter is not used with the Series 15 program format.

NOTE Specify a radius value at all times.


5137 Number of divisions in the multiple repetitive canned cycle G73 Number of divisions in the multiple repetitive canned cycle G73.7

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word path Cycle 1 to 99999999 This parameter sets the number of divisions in the multiple repetitive canned cycle G73 or G73.7. This parameter is not used with the Series 15 program format.

- 253 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
5139 Return in multiple repetitive canned cycles G74 and G75 Return in multiple repetitive canned cycles G74.7 and G75.7

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the return in multiple repetitive canned cycles G74 and G75 or G74.7 and G75.7.

NOTE Specify a radius value at all times.


5140 Minimum depth of cut in the multiple repetitive canned cycle G76 Minimum depth of cut in the multiple repetitive canned cycle G76.7

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) This parameter sets a minimum depth of cut in the multiple repetitive canned cycle G76 or G76.7 so that the depth of cut does not become too small when the depth of cut is constant.

NOTE Specify a radius value at all times.


5141 Finishing allowance in the multiple repetitive canned cycle G76 Finishing allowance in the multiple repetitive canned cycle G76.7

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the finishing allowance in multiple repetitive canned cycle G76 or G76.7.

NOTE Specify a radius value at all times.


5142 Repetition count of final finishing in multiple repetitive canned cycle G76 Repetition count of final finishing in multiple repetitive canned cycle G76.7

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path


- 254 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Unit of data] Cycle [Valid data range] 1 to 99999999 This parameter sets the number of final finishing cycle repeats in the multiple repetitive canned cycle G76 or G76.7. When 0 is set, only one final finishing cycle is executed.
5143 Tool nose angle in multiple repetitive canned cycle G76 Tool nose angle in multiple repetitive canned cycle G76.7

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Byte path Degree 0, 29, 30, 55, 60, 80 This parameter sets the tool nose angle in multiple repetitive canned cycle G76 or G76.7. This parameter is not used with the Series 15 program format.
Allowable value 1 in multiple repetitive canned cycles G71 and G72 Allowable value 1 in multiple repetitive canned cycles G71.7 and G72.7

5145

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) If a monotonous command of type I or II is not specified for the axis in the roughing direction, the alarm PS0064, THE FINISHING SHAPE IS NOT A MONOTONOUS CHANGE(FIRST AXES) or PS0329, THE FINISHING SHAPE IS NOTA MONOTONOUS CHANGE(SECOND AXES) is issued. When a program is created automatically, a very small unmonotonous figure may be produced. Set an unsigned allowable value for such an unmonotonous figure. By doing so, G71 and G72 or G71.7 and G72.7 cycles can be executed even in a program including an unmonotonous figure. [Example] Suppose that a G71 or G71.7 command where the direction of the cutting axis (X-axis) is minus and the direction of the roughing axis (Z-axis) is minus is specified. In such a case, when an unmonotonous command for moving 0.001 mm in the plus direction along the Z-axis is specified in a target figure program, roughing can be performed according to the programmed figure without an alarm by setting 0.001 mm in this parameter.

NOTE A check for a monotonous figure is made at all times during G71 and G72 or G71.7 and G72.7 cycles. A figure (programmed path) is checked. When tool nose radius compensation is performed, a path after compensation is checked. When bit 2 (FCK) of parameter No. 5104 is set to 1, a check is made before G71, G72, G71.7, or G72.7 cycle operation. In this case, not a path after tool nose radius compensation but a programmed path is checked. Note that no alarm is issued when an allowable value is set. Use a radius value to set this parameter at all times.
5146 Allowable value 2 in multiple repetitive canned cycles G71 and G72 Allowable value 2 in multiple repetitive canned cycles G71.7 and G72.7

[Input type] Parameter input


- 255 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
[Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

B-63950EN/04

Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 0 to cut of depth If a monotonous command of type I is not specified for the axis in the cutting direction, the alarm PS0064, THE FINISHING SHAPE IS NOT A MONOTONOUS CHANGE(FIRST AXES) or PS0329, THE FINISHING SHAPE IS NOTA MONOTONOUS CHANGE(SECOND AXES) is issued. When a program is created automatically, a very small unmonotonous figure may be produced. Set an unsigned allowable value for such an unmonotonous figure. By doing so, G71 and G72 or G71.7 and G72.7 cycles can be executed even in a program including an unmonotonous figure. The allowable value is clamped to the depth of cut specified by a multiple repetitive canned cycle. [Example] Suppose that a G71 or G71.7 command where the direction of the cutting axis (X-axis) is minus and the direction of the roughing axis (Z-axis) is minus is specified. In such a case, when an unmonotonous command for moving 0.001 mm in the minus direction along the X-axis is specified in a target figure program for moving from the bottom of cutting to the end point, roughing can be performed according to the programmed figure without an alarm by setting 0.001 mm in this parameter.

NOTE A check for a monotonous figure is made at all times during G71 and G72 or G71.7 and G72.7 cycles. A figure (programmed path) is checked. When tool nose radius compensation is performed, a path after compensation is checked. When bit 2 (FCK) of parameter No. 5104 is set to 1, a check is made before G71, G72, G71.7, or G72.7 cycle operation. In this case, not a path after tool nose radius compensation but a programmed path is checked. Note that no alarm is issued when an allowable value is set. Use a radius value to set this parameter at all times.

4.23.4
5148

Parameters of Canned Cycle for Drilling (2 of 2)


Tool retraction direction after orientation in a fine boring cycle or back boring cycle

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte axis [Valid data range] -24 to 24 This parameter sets an axis and direction for tool retraction after spindle orientation in a fine boring cycle or back boring cycle. For each boring axis, an axis and direction for tool retraction after orientation can be set. Set a signed axis number. To use a fine boring cycle or back boring cycle in the tilted working plane command, set the retract direction when the absolute coordinate value of the rotation axis is 0. [Example] Suppose that: When the boring axis is the X-axis, the tool retraction direction after orientation is -Y. When the boring axis is the Y-axis, the tool retraction direction after orientation is +Z. When the boring axis is the Z-axis, the tool retraction direction after orientation is -X. Then, set the following (assuming that the first, second, and third axes are the X-axis, Y-axis, and Z-axis, respectively): Set -2 in the parameter for the first axis. (The tool retraction direction is -Y.) Set 3 in the parameter for the second axis. (The tool retraction direction is +Z.)
- 256 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Set -1 in the parameter for the third axis. (The tool retraction direction is -X.) Set 0 for other axes.

5149

Override for retraction in a boring cycle (G85/G89)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word path % 0 to 2000 This parameter sets an override value for the feedrate of retraction in a boring cycle. The cutting feedrate override signal and the second feedrate override signal are valid, regardless of the setting of this parameter. The setting of this parameter is valid even when the override cancel signal is set to 1. When 0 is set in this parameter, the following operation is performed: For the T series Operation performed when 200 is set in this parameter (The retraction feedrate is two times greater than the cutting feedrate.) For the M series Operation performed when 100 is set in this parameter (The retraction feedrate is the cutting feedrate.)
#7 #6 #5 #4 TSG #3 CYM CYM NOL OLS #2 #1 #0

5160

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #1 OLS When an overload torque detection signal is received in a peck drilling cycle of a small diameter, the feedrate and spindle speed are: 0: Not changed. 1: Changed. NOL When the depth of cut per action is satisfied although no overload torque detection signal is received in a peck drilling cycle of a small diameter, the feedrate and spindle speed are: 0: Not changed. 1: Changed. CYM When a subprogram call is specified in a block specifying other commands in the canned cycle mode: 0: No alarm is issued. (When a command of address P is specified, the command is handled as both a command specifying a dwell time and a command specifying a subprogram number in a canned cycle.) 1: An alarm is issued. TSG The overload torque detection signal for a small-hole peck drilling cycle: 0: Depends on the parameter settings for the skip function. 1: Does not depend on the parameter settings for the skip function. When this parameter is set to 1, the X address can be used for the overload torque signal even with the skip signal setting disabled. Even when the overload torque detection signal does not depend on the skip function parameter settings, parameter No. 3012 and bit 1 (SK0) of parameter No. 6200 remain valid.

#2

#3

#4

- 257 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 5161 #6 #5 #4 CME #3 #2 #1

B-63950EN/04 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #4 CME For drilling canned cycles, the M code for C-axis clamping/unclamping is set to: 0: Value set by parameter No. 5110/value set by parameter No. 5110 + 1. 1: Value set by parameter No. 5110/value set by parameter No. 13543 (first pair), or the value set by parameter No. 13544/value set by parameter No. 13545 (second pair).

5163

M code that specifies the peck drilling cycle mode of a small diameter

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 1 to 99999999 This parameter sets an M code that specifies the peck drilling cycle mode of a small diameter.
5164

Percentage of the spindle speed to be changed at the start of the next advancing after an overload torque detection signal is received

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word path % 1 to 255 This parameter sets the percentage of the spindle speed to be changed at the start of the next advancing after the tool is retracted because the overload torque detection signal is received. S2 = S1 d1 100 S1: Spindle speed to be changed S2: Spindle speed changed Set d1 as a percentage.

NOTE When 0 is set, the spindle speed is not changed.


5165

Percentage of the spindle speed to be changed at the start of the next advancing when no overload torque detection signal is received

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word path % 1 to 255 This parameter sets the percentage of the spindle speed to be changed at the start of the next advancing after the tool is retracted without the overload torque detection signal received. S2 = S1 d2 100 S1: Spindle speed to be changed S2: Spindle speed changed
- 258 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Set d2 as a percentage.

NOTE When 0 is set, the spindle speed is not changed.


5166

Percentage of the cutting feedrate to be changed at the start of the next cutting after an overload torque detection signal is received

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word path % 1 to 255 This parameter sets the percentage of the cutting feedrate to be changed at the start of cutting after the tool is retracted and advances because the overload torque detection signal is received. F2 = F1 b1 100 F1: Cutting feedrate to be changed F2: Cutting feedrate changed Set b1 as a percentage.

NOTE When 0 is set, the cutting feedrate is not changed.

5167

Percentage of the cutting feedrate to be changed at the start of the next cutting when no overload torque detection signal is received

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word path % 1 to 255 This parameter sets the percentage of the cutting feedrate to be changed at the start of cutting after the tool is retracted and advances without the overload torque detection signal received. F2 = F1 b2 100 F1: Cutting feedrate to be changed F2: Cutting feedrate changed Set b2 as a percentage.

NOTE When 0 is set, the cutting feedrate is not changed.


5168

Lower limit of the percentage of the cutting feedrate in a peck drilling cycle of a small diameter

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Byte path % 1 to 255 This parameter sets the lower limit of the percentage of the cutting feedrate changed repeatedly to the specified cutting feedrate.
- 259 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
FL = F b3 100 F: Specified cutting feedrate FL: Changed cutting feedrate Set b3 as a percentage.
5170

B-63950EN/04

Number of the macro variable to which to output the total number of retractions during cutting

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 100 to 149 This parameter sets the number of the custom macro common variable to which to output the total number of times the tool is retracted during cutting. The total number cannot be output to common variables #500 to #599.
5171

Number of the macro variable to which to output the total number of retractions because of the reception of an overload torque detection signal

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 100 to 149 This parameter sets the number of the custom macro common variable to which to output the total number of times the tool is retracted after the overload torque detection signal is received during cutting. The total number cannot be output to common variables #500 to #599.
5172

Feedrate of retraction to point R when no address I is specified

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm/min, inch/min (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) This parameter sets the feedrate of retraction to point R when no address I is specified.

5173

Feedrate of advancing to the position just before the bottom of a hole when no address I is specified

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm/min, inch/min (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) This parameter sets the feedrate of advancing to the position just before the bottom of a previously machined hole when no address I is specified.

5174

Clearance in a peck drilling cycle of a small diameter

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Real path


- 260 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Unit of data] mm, inch (input unit) [Min. unit of data] Depend on the increment system of the reference axis [Valid data range] 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the clearance in a peck drilling cycle of a small diameter.

4.23.5
5176

Parameters of Canned Cycle for Grinding (for Grinding Machine)


Grinding axis number in Traverse Grinding Cycle(G71) Grinding axis number in Plunge Grinding Cycle(G75)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to Number of controlled axes For the Lathe system: Set the Grinding axis number of Traverse Grinding Cycle(G71). For the Machining Center system: Set the Grinding axis number of Plunge Grinding Cycle(G75).

NOTE The axis number except for the cutting axis can be specified. When the axis number which is same to cutting axis is specified, an alarm PS0456, ILLEGAL PARAMETER IN GRINDING is issued at the time of execution. The Grinding Cycle is executed when this parameter value is 0, the alarm PS0456 is also issued.
5177 Grinding axis number of Traverse direct constant-size Grinding cycle(G72) Grinding axis number of Direct Constant Dimension Plunge Grinding Cycle(G77)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to Number of controlled axes For the Lathe system: Set the Grinding axis number of Traverse direct constant-size Grinding cycle(G72). For the Machining Center system: Set the Grinding axis number of Direct Constant Dimension Plunge Grinding Cycle (G77).

NOTE The axis number except for the cutting axis can be specified. When the axis number which is same to cutting axis is specified, an alarm PS0456, ILLEGAL PARAMETER IN GRINDING is issued at the time of execution. The Grinding Cycle is executed when this parameter value is 0, the alarm PS0456 is also issued.
5178 Grinding axis number of Oscillation Grinding Cycle(G73) Grinding axis number of Continuous feed surface grinding cycle(G78)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to Number of controlled axes For the Lathe system:
- 261 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

Set the Grinding axis number of Oscillation Grinding Cycle(G73). For the Machining Center system: Set the Grinding axis number of Continuous feed surface grinding cycle(G78).

NOTE The axis number except for the cutting axis can be specified. When the axis number which is same to cutting axis is specified, an alarm PS0456, ILLEGAL PARAMETER IN GRINDING is issued at the time of execution. The Grinding Cycle is executed when this parameter value is 0, the alarm PS0456 is also issued.
5179 Grinding axis number of Oscillation Direct Fixed Dimension Grinding Cycle(G74) Grinding axis number of Intermittent feed surface grinding cycle(G79)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to Number of controlled axes For the Lathe system: Set the Grinding axis number of Oscillation Direct Fixed Dimension Grinding Cycle(G74). For the Machining Center system: Set the Grinding axis number of Intermittent feed surface grinding cycle(G79).

NOTE The axis number except for the cutting axis can be specified. When the axis number which is same to cutting axis is specified, an alarm PS0456, ILLEGAL PARAMETER IN GRINDING is issued at the time of execution. The Grinding Cycle is executed when this parameter value is 0, the alarm PS0456 is also issued.
5180

Axis number of dressing axis in Plunge grinding cycle(G75)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to Number of controlled axes Set the axis number of dressing axis in Plunge grinding cycle(G75).

NOTE The axis number except for the cutting axis or grinding axis can be specified. When the axis number which is same to cutting axis or grinding axis is specified, an alarm PS0456, ILLEGAL PARAMETER IN GRINDING is issued at the time of execution. The Grinding Cycle is executed when this parameter value is 0 and address "L" is specified in NC program, the alarm PS0456 is also issued.
5181

Axis number of dressing axis in Direct constant dimension plunge grinding cycle(G77)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path


- 262 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Valid data range] 0 to Number of controlled axes Set the axis number of dressing axis in Direct constant dimension plunge grinding cycle(G77).

NOTE The axis number except for the cutting axis or grinding axis can be specified. When the axis number which is same to cutting axis or grinding axis is specified, an alarm PS0456, ILLEGAL PARAMETER IN GRINDING is issued at the time of execution. The Grinding Cycle is executed when this parameter value is 0 and address "L" is specified in NC program, the alarm PS0456 is also issued.
5182

Axis number of dressing axis in Continuous feed surface grinding cycle(G78)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to Number of controlled axes Set the axis number of dressing axis in Continuous feed surface grinding cycle(G78).

NOTE The axis number except for the cutting axis or grinding axis can be specified. When the axis number which is same to cutting axis or grinding axis is specified, an alarm PS0456, ILLEGAL PARAMETER IN GRINDING is issued at the time of execution. The Grinding Cycle is executed when this parameter value is 0 and address "L" is specified in NC program, the alarm PS0456 is also issued.
5183

Axis number of dressing axis in Intermittent feed surface grinding cycle(G79)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to Number of controlled axes Set the axis number of dressing axis in Intermittent feed surface grinding cycle(G79).

NOTE The axis number except for the cutting axis or grinding axis can be specified. When the axis number which is same to cutting axis or grinding axis is specified, an alarm PS0456, ILLEGAL PARAMETER IN GRINDING is issued at the time of execution. The Grinding Cycle is executed when this parameter value is 0 and address "L" is specified in NC program, the alarm PS0456 is also issued.

- 263 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

4.24
5200

PARAMETERS OF RIGID TAPPING


#7 SRS #6 FHD FHD #5 PCP PCP #4 DOV DOV #3 SIG SIG #2 CRG CRG #1 #0 G84 G84

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 G84 Method for specifying rigid tapping: 0: An M code specifying the rigid tapping mode is specified prior to the issue of the G84 (or G74) command. (See parameter No. 5210). 1: An M code specifying the rigid tapping mode is not used. (G84 cannot be used as a G code for the tapping cycle; G74 cannot be used for the reverse tapping cycle.) CRG Rigid mode when a rigid mode cancel command is specified (G80, 01 group G code, reset, etc.) : 0: Canceled after rigid tapping signal RGTAP is set to 0. 1: Canceled before rigid tapping signal RGTAP is set to 0. SIG When gears are changed for rigid tapping, the use of SINDs is: 0: Not permitted. 1: Permitted. DOV Override during extraction in rigid tapping: 0: Invalidated 1: Validated (The override value is set in parameter No. 5211. However, set an override value for rigid tapping return in parameter No. 5381.) PCP Rigid tapping: 0: Used as a high-speed peck tapping cycle 1: Not used as a high-speed peck tapping cycle FHD Feed hold and single block in rigid tapping: 0: Invalidated 1: Validated SRS To select a spindle used for rigid tapping in multi-spindle control: 0: The spindle selection signals SWS1, SWS2, SWS3, and SWS4 are used. (These signals are used also for multi-spindle control.) 1: The rigid tapping spindle selection signals RGTSP1, RGTSP2, RGTSP3, and RGTSP4 are used. (These signals are provided expressly for rigid tapping.)
#7 5201 #6 #5 #4 OV3 #3 OVU #2 TDR #1 #0

#2

#3

#4

#5

#6

#7

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #2 TDR Cutting time constant in rigid tapping: 0: Uses a same parameter during cutting and extraction (Parameters Nos. 5261 to 5264) 1: Not use a same parameter during cutting and extraction Parameters Nos. 5261 to 5264: Time constant during cutting Parameters Nos. 5271 to 5274: Time constant during extraction
- 264 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
OVU The increment unit of the override parameter No. 5211 for tool rigid tapping extraction is: 0: 1% 1: 10% OV3 A spindle speed for extraction is programmed, so override for extraction operation is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
#7 #6 #5 #4 IRR #3 CHR #2 #1 RG3 #0 ORI

#3

#4

5202

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 ORI When rigid tapping is started: 0: Spindle orientation is not performed. 1: Spindle orientation is performed. This parameter can be used only for a serial spindle. This spindle orientation performs reference position return in the serial spindle/servo mode. The stop position can be changed using the serial spindle parameter No. 4073. RG3 Retraction for rigid tapping is performed by: 0: Input signal RTNT <Gn062.6>. 1: One-shot G code G30 command.

#1

NOTE When this parameter is 1, retraction for rigid tapping using the input signal RTNT <Gn062.6> cannot be performed.
#3 CHR Rigid tapping is: 0: Normal rigid tapping. 1: Interpolation type rigid tapping.

NOTE 1 The rigid tapping function and interpolation type rigid tapping function cannot be used together within a path. 2 Before the interpolation type rigid tapping function can be used, the Cs contour control function is required. If interpolation type rigid tapping is specified when the Cs contour control function is disabled, an alarm PS1223, ILLEGAL SPINDLE SELECT is issued. 3 The interpolation type rigid tapping function cannot be used in a path that has a spindle positioning axis. If interpolation type rigid tapping is specified for a path that has a spindle positioning axis, an alarm PS1223 is issued.

- 265 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#4

B-63950EN/04

IRR As the in-position width at point R after movement from point I to point R in rigid tapping: 0: The in-position widths dedicated to rigid tapping (parameters Nos. 5300, 5302, 5304, and 5306) are selected. 1: The normal in-position width (parameter No. 1826) is selected.
#7 #6 #5 RBL #4 OVS #3 #2 RFF #1 HRM #0 HRG

5203

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 HRG Rigid tapping by the manual handle is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. HRM When the tapping axis moves in the negative direction during rigid tapping controlled by the manual handle, the direction in which the spindle rotates is determined as follows: 0: In G84 mode, the spindle rotates in a normal direction. In G74 mode, the spindle rotates in reverse. 1: In G84 mode, the spindle rotates in reverse. In G74 mode, the spindle rotates in a normal direction. RFF In rigid tapping, feed forward is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. (Recommended) As the standard setting, set 1. At the same time, set the parameter for the advanced preview feed forward coefficient for the tapping axis and the parameter for the advance preview feed forward coefficient for the spindle so that these values match. Advanced preview feed forward coefficient for the tapping axis: Parameter No. 2092 (or parameter No. 2144 if the cutting/rapid traverse feed forward function is enabled (bit 4 of parameter No. 2214 is set to 1)) Advanced preview feed forward coefficient for the spindle: Parameter No. 4344

#1

#2

NOTE This parameter is valid when a serial spindle is used.


#4 OVS In rigid tapping, override by the feedrate override select signal and cancellation of override by the override cancel signal is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. When feedrate override is enabled, extraction override is disabled. The spindle override is clamped to 100% during rigid tapping, regardless of the setting of this parameter. RBL As acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping cutting feed: 0: Linear acceleration/deceleration is used. 1: Bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration is used.

#5

- 266 -

B-63950EN/04 #7 5209 #6 #5 #4

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#3 #2 DWP #1 RIP RIP #0 RTX

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 RTX In rigid tapping in a lathe system, the tapping axis is: 0: Selected by selecting a plane. 1: Always assumed to be the Z-axis for G84 or the X-axis for G88.

NOTE This parameter becomes invalid when bit 1 (FCV) of parameter No.0001 is set to 1, and rigid tapping is specified using the Series15 format.
#1 RIP When a movement from the initial point to point R is made, the in-position check is: 0: Dependent on the setting of bit 5 (NCI) of parameter No. 1601. 1: Performed.

NOTE This parameter is valid when bit 5 (NCI) of parameter No. 1601 is set to 1 and bit 4 (IRR) of parameter No. 5202 is set to 0. If bit 5 (NCI) of parameter No. 1601 is set to 0, the in-position check is performed regardless of the setting of this parameter.
#2 DWP When a dwell (address P) command is not included in a block for lathe-system rigid tapping: 0: Dwelling at the bottom of a hole is not performed. 1: The dwell (address P) command specified in the block for drilling is valid.

NOTE This parameter becomes invalid if rigid tapping is specified in the Series 15 format with bit 1 (FCV) of parameter No. 0001 set to 1.
5210 Rigid tapping mode specification M code

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to 65535 This parameter sets an M code that specifies the rigid tapping mode. The M code is judged to be 29 (M29) when 0 is set.
5211 Override value during rigid tapping extraction

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word path 1% or 10% 0 to 200 The parameter sets the override value during rigid tapping extraction.

- 267 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE The override value is valid when bit 4 (DOV) of parameter No. 5200 is set to 1. When bit 3 (OVU) of parameter No. 5201 is set to 1, the unit of set data is 10%. An override of up to 200% can be applied to extraction.
5213 Return in peck rigid tapping cycle

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the drilling axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the return or clearance in the peck tapping cycle.
When the parameter PCP (bit 5 of No.5200) is set to 1. q : Depth of cut d : Clearance value R point q d d

When the parameter PCP (bit 5 of No.5200) is set to 0. q : Depth of cut d : Return value R point q d d

q q

q q

Z point

Z point

5214

Setting of an allowable rigid tapping synchronization error range

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word spindle Detection unit 0 to 99999999 This parameter sets an allowable synchronization error range in rigid tapping. If a synchronous error range exceeding the setting of this parameter is detected, the alarm SP0741, RIGID TAP ALARM : EXCESS ERROR is issued. When 0 is set in this parameter, no synchronization error check is made.
Number of gear teeth on the spindle side in rigid tapping (first gear) Number of gear teeth on the spindle side in rigid tapping (second gear) Number of gear teeth on the spindle side in rigid tapping (third gear) Number of gear teeth on the spindle side in rigid tapping (fourth gear)

5221 5222 5223 5224

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word spindle


- 268 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Valid data range] 1 to 32767 Each of these parameters is used to set the number of gear teeth on the spindle side for each gear in rigid tapping.

NOTE When a position coder is attached to the spindle, set the same value for all of parameters Nos. 5221 to 5224.
5231 5232 5233 5234 Number of gear teeth on the position coder side in rigid tapping (first gear) Number of gear teeth on the position coder side in rigid tapping (second gear) Number of gear teeth on the position coder side in rigid tapping (third gear) Number of gear teeth on the position coder side in rigid tapping (fourth gear)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word spindle [Valid data range] 1 to 32767 Each of these parameters is used to set the number of gear teeth on the position coder side for each gear in rigid tapping.

NOTE When a position coder is attached to the spindle, set the same value for all of parameters Nos. 5231 to 5234.
5241 5242 5243 5244 Maximum spindle speed in rigid tapping (first gear) Maximum spindle speed in rigid tapping (second gear) Maximum spindle speed in rigid tapping (third gear) Maximum spindle speed in rigid tapping (fourth gear)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word spindle min-1 0 to 9999 Spindle position coder gear ratio 1 : 1 0 to 7400 1 : 2 0 to 9999 1 : 4 0 to 9999 1 : 8 0 to 9999 Each of these parameters is used to set a maximum spindle speed for each gear in rigid tapping. Set the same value for both parameter No. 5241 and parameter No. 5243 for a one-stage gear system. For a two-stage gear system, set the same value as set in parameter No. 5242 in parameter No. 5243. Otherwise, alarm PS0200, ILLEGAL S CODE COMMAND will be issued. This applies to the M series.
Time constant for acceleration/deceleration in rigid tapping for each gear (first gear) Time constant for acceleration/deceleration in rigid tapping for each gear (second gear)

5261 5262

- 269 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
5263 5264

B-63950EN/04

Time constant for acceleration/deceleration in rigid tapping for each gear (third gear) Time constant for acceleration/deceleration in rigid tapping for each gear (fourth gear)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word spindle msec 0 to 4000 Each of these parameters is used to set a linear acceleration/ deceleration time constant for the spindle of each gear and the tapping axis in rigid tapping. Set the period required to reach each maximum spindle speed (parameters Nos. 5241 to 5244). The set time constant, multiplied by the ratio of a specified S value to a maximum spindle speed, is actually used as a time constant. For bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration, set a time constant for a linear portion.
Time constant for acceleration/deceleration in rigid tapping extraction (first gear) Time constant for acceleration/deceleration in rigid tapping extraction (second gear) Time constant for acceleration/deceleration in rigid tapping extraction (third gear) Time constant for acceleration/deceleration in rigid tapping extraction (fourth gear)

5271 5272 5273 5274

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word spindle msec 0 to 4000 Each of these parameters is used to set a linear acceleration/ deceleration time constant for the spindle of each gear and tapping axis in extraction operation during rigid tapping. For bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration, set a time constant for a linear portion. In interpolation type rigid tapping, linear/bell-shaped acceleration/ deceleration of constant acceleration time type is used. So, set a time constant directly for the spindle and tapping axis for each gear.

NOTE These parameters are enabled when the parameter TDR (bit 2 of parameter No. 5201) is set to 1.
5280 5281 5282 5283 5284 Position control loop gain for the spindle and tapping axis in rigid tapping (common to gears) Position control loop gain for the spindle and tapping axis in rigid tapping (first gear) Position control loop gain for the spindle and tapping axis in rigid tapping (second gear) Position control loop gain for the spindle and tapping axis in rigid tapping (third gear) Position control loop gain for the spindle and tapping axis in rigid tapping (fourth gear)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word spindle 0.01/sec 1 to 9999


- 270 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Each of these parameters is used to set a position control loop gain for the spindle and tapping axis in rigid tapping. These parameters significantly affect the precision of threading. Optimize these parameters as well as the loop gain multipliers by conducting a cutting test.

NOTE To use a varied loop gain on a gear-by-gear basis, set parameter No. 5280 to 0, and set a loop gain for each gear in parameters Nos. 5281 to 5284. The specification of a loop gain on a gear-by-gear basis is disabled if parameter No. 5280 is set to a value other than 0. In such a case, the value set in parameter No. 5280 is used as a loop gain that is common to all the gears.
5291 5292 5293 5294 Loop gain multiplier for the spindle in rigid tapping (first gear) Loop gain multiplier for the spindle in rigid tapping (second gear) Loop gain multiplier for the spindle in rigid tapping (third gear) Loop gain multiplier for the spindle in rigid tapping (fourth gear)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word spindle [Valid data range] 1 to 32767 Each of these parameters is used to set a loop gain multiplier for the spindle in rigid tapping each gear. These parameters significantly affect the precision of threading. Optimize these parameters as well as the loop gains by conducting a cutting test. Loop gain multiplier GC is obtained from the following equation:
GC = 2048000 360 PC E PLS SP L

PLS Number of pulses output from the position coder (pulses/rev) SP Number of gear teeth on the spindle side PC Number of gear teeth on the position coder side E Specified voltage (V) for turning the spindle motor at 1000 min-1 L Angular displacement of the spindle (degrees) per spindle motor rotation [Example] For the spindle motor and gear ratio given below, GC is calculated as follows:
GC = 2048000 360 1 2.2 = 1100 4096 1 360

PLS = 4096 pulse/rev SP = 1 PC = 1 E = 2.2 V L = 360 deg (Note) On the assumption that the spindle motor used turns at 4500 min-1 at 10 V, 2.2 V is required to turn the spindle motor at 1000 min-1.

NOTE These parameters are used for analog spindles.


5300 Tapping axis in-position width in rigid tapping (first spindle)

[Input type] Parameter input


- 271 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

[Data type] Word axis [Unit of data] Detection unit [Valid data range] 0 to 32767 This parameter sets a tapping axis in-position width when rigid tapping is performed using the first spindle.

NOTE Set the following parameter for each spindle: First spindle No. 5300 Second spindle No. 5302 Third spindle No. 5304 Fourth spindle No. 5306
5301 Spindle in-position width in rigid tapping

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word spindle Detection unit 0 to 32767 These parameters are used to set spindle in-position widths in rigid tapping.

NOTE If an excessively large value is specified, the threading precision will deteriorate.
5302 Tapping axis in-position width in rigid tapping (second spindle)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis Detection unit 0 to 32767 This parameter sets a tapping axis in-position width when rigid tapping is performed using the second spindle.
Tapping axis in-position width in rigid tapping (third spindle)

5304

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis Detection unit 0 to 32767 This parameter sets a tapping axis in-position width when rigid tapping is performed using the third spindle.
Tapping axis in-position width in rigid tapping (fourth spindle)

5306

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis Detection unit 0 to 32767 This parameter sets a tapping axis in-position width when rigid tapping is performed using the fourth spindle.

- 272 -

B-63950EN/04 5310

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Positional deviation limit imposed during tapping axis movement in rigid tapping (first spindle)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit 0 to 99999999 This parameter sets a positional deviation limit imposed during tapping axis movement in rigid tapping using the first spindle.

NOTE Set the following parameter for each spindle: First spindle No. 5310 Second spindle No. 5350 Third spindle No. 5354 Fourth spindle No. 5358
5311 Limit value of spindle positioning deviation during movement in rigid tapping

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word spindle Detection unit 0 to 99999999 This parameter sets the limit value of a spindle positioning deviation during movement in rigid tapping. Find a value to be set from the following expression:
Setting value = S PLS 100 SP C 60 GP C

Maximum spindle speed in rigid tapping (min-1) (Setting value of parameter Nos. 5241 and greater) PLS Number of pulses output from the position coder (pulses/rev) SP Number of gear teeth on the spindle side PC Number of gear teeth on the position coder side G Loop gain in the rigid tapping (0.01sec-1) (Setting value of parameter Nos. 5281 and greater) C Coefficient 1.5 S [Calculation example] S PLS SP PC G C = 3600 = 4096 = 10 = 20 = 3000 = 1.5
3600 4096 100 10 1.5 = 6144 60 3000 20

SPINDLE MOTOR Spindle Position coder

Setting value =

10 : 10 : 20

- 273 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
5312

B-63950EN/04

Positional deviation limit imposed while the tapping axis is stopped in rigid tapping (first spindle)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis Detection unit 0 to 32767 This parameter sets a positional deviation limit imposed while the tapping axis is stopped in rigid tapping using the first spindle.

NOTE Set the following parameter for each spindle: First spindle No. 5312 Second spindle No. 5352 Third spindle No. 5356 Fourth spindle No. 5360
5313 Positional deviation limit imposed while the spindle is stopped in rigid tapping

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word spindle Detection unit 0 to 99999999 This parameter is used to set a positional deviation limit imposed while the spindle is stopped in rigid tapping.
Spindle backlash in rigid tapping (first-stage gear) Spindle backlash in rigid tapping (second-stage gear) Spindle backlash in rigid tapping (third-stage gear) Spindle backlash in rigid tapping (fourth-stage gear)

5321 5322 5323 5324

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word spindle Detection unit -9999 to 9999 Each of these parameters is used to set a spindle backlash.
Positional deviation limit imposed during tapping axis movement in rigid tapping (second spindle)

5350

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit 0 to 99999999 This parameter sets a positional deviation limit imposed during tapping axis movement in rigid tapping using the second spindle.
Positional deviation limit imposed while the tapping axis is stopped in rigid tapping (second spindle)

5352

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis Detection unit 0 to 32767


- 274 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
This parameter is used to set a positional deviation limit imposed while the tapping axis is stopped in rigid tapping using the second spindle.

5354

Positional deviation limit imposed during tapping axis movement in rigid tapping (third spindle)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit 0 to 99999999 This parameter sets a positional deviation limit imposed during tapping axis movement in rigid tapping using the third spindle.
Positional deviation limit imposed while the tapping axis is stopped in rigid tapping (third spindle)

5356

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis Detection unit 0 to 32767 This parameter is used to set a positional deviation limit imposed while the tapping axis is stopped in rigid tapping using the third spindle.
Positional deviation limit imposed during tapping axis movement in rigid tapping (fourth spindle)

5358

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit 0 to 99999999 This parameter sets a positional deviation limit imposed during tapping axis movement in rigid tapping using the fourth spindle.
Positional deviation limit imposed while the tapping axis is stopped in rigid tapping (fourth spindle)

5360

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis Detection unit 0 to 32767 This parameter is used to set a positional deviation limit imposed while the tapping axis is stopped in rigid tapping using the fourth spindle.
Bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration time constant in rigid tapping (first-stage gear) Bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration time constant in rigid tapping (second-stage gear) Bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration time constant in rigid tapping (third-stage gear) Bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration time constant in rigid tapping (fourth-stage gear)

5365 5366 5367 5368

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word spindle msec 0 to 512 Each of these parameters is used to set a time constant for a curved portion when bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration is selected in rigid tapping. When 0 is set in this parameter, linear acceleration/ deceleration is performed.
- 275 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE This parameter is enabled when the parameter RBL (bit 5 of parameter No. 5203) is set to 1.
5381 Override value during rigid tapping return

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word path % 0 to 200 This parameter is used to set the override value during rigid tapping return. If the setting is 0, no override is applied.

NOTE This parameter is valid when bit 4 (DOV) of parameter No. 5200 for enabling override at normal extraction time is set to 1.
5382 Amount of return for rigid tapping return

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the drilling axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) This parameter is used to set an extra amount of rigid tapping return. The tool is retracted additionally near point R by the distance set in this parameter. If the tool has already been retracted from rigid tapping, it will be retracted further only by the distance specified in this parameter.

4.25
5400

PARAMETERS OF SCALING/COORDINATE ROTATION


#7 SCR #6 XSC #5 LV3 #4 #3 #2 D3R #1 #0 RIN

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 RIN Coordinate rotation angle command (R) : 0: Specified by an absolute method 1: Specified by an absolute method (G90) or incremental method (G91) D3R When Reset is done by reset operation or reset signal from PMC, 3-dimensional coordinate system conversion mode, tilted working plane command mode and workpiece setting error compensation mode is: 0: Canceled. 1: Not canceled. LV3 When system variables #100101 to #100132 (current position coordinates) and #100151 to #100182 (skip coordinates) are read in the 3-dimensional coordinate conversion mode or tilted working plane command mode: 0: Coordinates of the workpiece coordinate system can be read.
- 276 -

#2

#5

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
1: Coordinates of the program coordinate system after 3-dimensional coordinate conversion or tilted working plane command can be read. This parameter applies also to system variables #5041 to #5060 (current position coordinates) and #5061 to #5080 (skip coordinates).

#6

XSC The setting of a scaling magnification (axis-by-axis scaling) is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. SCR Scaling (G51) magnification unit: 0: 0.00001 times (1/100,000) 1: 0.001 times
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 SCLx

#7

5401

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 SCLx Scaling on this axis: 0: Invalidated 1: Validated
#7 5402 #6 #5 #4 #3 DMK #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #3 DMK The manual handle interruption screen is displayed: 0: Using the program coordinate system (post-conversion coordinate system). 1: Using the workpiece coordinate system (pre-conversion coordinate system). This parameter is valid only in 3-dimensional coordinate conversion mode.
Angular displacement used when no angular displacement is specified for coordinate system rotation

5410

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input 2-word path 0.001 degree -360000 to 360000 This parameter sets the angular displacement for coordinate system rotation. When the angular displacement for coordinate system rotation is not specified with address R in the block where G68 is specified, the setting of this parameter is used as the angular displacement for coordinate system rotation.
Scaling (G51) magnification

5411

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input 2-word path 0.001 or 0.00001 times (Selected using bit 7 (SCR) of parameter No. 5400) 1to999999999 This parameter sets a scaling magnification when axis-by-axis scaling is disabled (with bit 6 (XSC) of parameter No. 5400 set to 0). If no scaling magnification (P) is specified in the program, the setting of this parameter is used as a scaling magnification.
- 277 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE When bit 7 (SCR) of parameter No. 5400 is set to 1, the valid data range is 1 to 9999999.
5412 Rapid traverse rate for canned cycle for drilling in 3-dimensional coordinate conversion mode

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) This parameter sets a rapid traverse rate for canned cycle for drilling in the 3-dimensional coordinate conversion mode, the tilted working plane command mode, or the workpiece setting error compensation mode.
Scaling magnification for each axis

5421

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input 2-word axis 0.001 or 0.00001 times (Selected using bit 7 (SCR) of parameter No. 5400) -999999999 to -1, 1 to 999999999 This parameter sets a scaling magnification for each axis when axis-by-axis scaling is enabled (with bit 6 (XSC) of parameter No. 5400 set to 1). For the first spindle to the third spindle (X-axis to Z-axis), the setting of this parameter is used as a scaling magnification if scaling magnifications (I, J, K) are not specified in the program.

NOTE When bit 7 (SCR) of parameter No. 5400 is set to 1, the valid data ranges are -9999999 to -1 and 1 to 9999999.

4.26
5431

PARAMETERS OF SINGLE DIRECTION POSITIONING


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 PDI #0 MDL

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 MDL The G60 code (single direction positioning) is: 0: One-shot G code (group 00). 1: Modal G code (group 01). PDI In the G60 mode, an in-position check at a stop position is: 0: Not made. (Waiting for only the end of acceleration/deceleration) 1: Made.
Positioning direction and overrun distance in single direction positioning

#1

5440

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch, degree (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis
- 278 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Valid data range] Refer to the standard parameter setting table (A) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the positioning direction and overrun distance in single direction positioning (G60) for each axis. The positioning direction is specified using a setting data sign, and the overrun distance using a value set here. Overrun distance>0: The positioning direction is positive (+). Overrun distance<0: The positioning direction is negative (-). Overrun distance=0: Single direction positioning is not performed.

4.27
5450

PARAMETERS OF POLAR COORDINATE INTERPOLATION


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 PLS #1 #0 PDI

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 PDI When the second axis on the plane in the polar coordinate interpolation mode is based on radius specification: 0: Radius specification is used. 1: Diameter specification is used. PLS The polar coordinate interpolation shift function is: 0: Not used. 1: Used. This enables machining using the workpiece coordinate system with a desired point which is not the center of the rotation axis set as the origin of the coordinate system in polar coordinate interpolation.
Axis (linear axis) specification for polar coordinate interpolation

#2

5460

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to number of controlled axes This parameter sets control axis numbers of linear axis to execute polar interpolation.
5461 Axis (rotation axis) specification for polar coordinate interpolation

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to number of controlled axes This parameter sets control axis numbers of rotation axis to execute polar interpolation.
5463 Automatic override tolerance ratio for polar coordinate interpolation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Byte path % 0 to 100 Typical setting: 90% (treated as 90% when set to 0) Set the tolerance ratio of the fastest cutting feedrate to the speed of the rotation axis during automatic override of polar coordinate interpolation.
- 279 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
5464

B-63950EN/04

Compensation for error on hypothetical axis of polar coordinate interpolation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Byte path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (For IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter is used to set the error if the center of the rotation axis on which polar coordinate interpolation is performed is not on the X-axis. If the setting of the parameter is 0, regular polar coordinate interpolation is performed.

4.28
5480

PARAMETERS OF NORMAL DIRECTION CONTROL


Number of the axis for controlling the normal direction

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to the maximum controlled axis number This parameter sets the controlled axis number of the axis for controlling the normal direction.
5481

Feedrate of rotation of the normal direction controlled axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis deg/min Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) This parameter sets the feedrate of the movement along the normal direction controlled axis that is inserted at the start point of a block during normal direction control.

5482

Limit value used to determine whether to ignore the rotation insertion of the normal direction controlled axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path Degree Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) The rotation block of the normal direction controlled axis is not inserted when the rotation insertion angle calculated during normal direction control does not exceed this setting. The ignored rotation angle is added to the next rotation insertion angle, and the block insertion is then judged.

- 280 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE 1 No rotation block is inserted when 360 or more degrees are set. 2 If 180 or more degrees are set, a rotation block is inserted only when the circular interpolation setting is 180 or more degrees.

5483

Limit value of movement that is executed at the normal direction angle of a preceding block

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (B)
N2 N3 N1 Travel distance For straight line When the travel distance of N2 in the figure on the left does not exceed the setting, block N2 is machined with the tool being normal to block N1.

Tool center path

Programmed path For arc When the arc diameter of N2 in the figure on the left does not exceed the setting, arc N2 is machined with the tool being normal to block N1. A normal direction axis is not controlled to move in the normal direction according to the arc movement.

N2 Programmed path

Tool center path N3

N1 Diameter

#7 5484

#6

#5

#4

#3

#2

#1

#0 SDC

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 SDC Gentle normal direction control function is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.

5485

Limit for single-block rotation by the gentle normal direction control function

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path degree Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 0 to 360 This parameter is valid when bit 0 (SDC) of parameter No. 5484 is set to 1. Gentle normal direction control rotates a normal direction control axis simultaneously with an X/Y-axis move block when the calculated rotation insertion angle is smaller than this parameter setting. If it is greater than the setting, the normal direction control axis is rotated with a single block.
- 281 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE 1 This parameter is valid only when the normal direction control axis is rotated according to the settings of parameters No. 5482 and No. 5483. 2 If this parameter is set to 360 or greater, the setting is assumed to be 360, and the normal direction control axis is rotated simultaneously with the X/Y-axis move block. 3 If this parameter is set to 180 or greater, the normal direction control axis is rotated simultaneously with the X/Y-axis move block unless circular interpolation is used. 4 If this parameter is set to a negative value, the setting is assumed to be 0, and the normal direction control axis is rotated with the single block.
5486

Block distance to move until the end of rotation of the normal direction control axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data This parameter sets the command block distance to move until the rotation of the normal direction control axis is completed. When 0 is specified, this function is disabled.

5490

Axis number in which torch swing axis exists

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte axis [Valid data range] 0 to number of controlled axes Set the axis in which to the torch swing axis exists for gas cutting machine. Set either the Y or V axis on the torch swing axis for gas cutting machine.

4.29
5500

PARAMETERS OF INDEX TABLE INDEXING


#7 IDX #6 SIM #5 #4 G90 #3 INC #2 ABS #1 REL #0 DDP

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 DDP As the method for inputting a decimal point in a command for the index table indexing axis: 0: The conventional method is used. 1: The pocket calculator method is used. REL The position display of the index table indexing axis in the relative coordinate system is: 0: Not rounded by one rotation. 1: Rounded by one rotation.

#1

- 282 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
ABS The position display of the index table indexing axis in the absolute coordinate system is: 0: Not rounded by one rotation. 1: Rounded by one rotation. INC When the M code that specifies rotation in the negative direction (parameter No. 5511) is not set, rotation in the G90 mode is: 0: Not set to the shorter way around the circumference. 1: Set to the shorter way around the circumference. G90 A command for the index table indexing axis is: 0: Assumed to be an absolute or incremental programming according to the mode. 1: Always assumed to be an absolute programming. SIM When the same block includes a command for the index table indexing axis and a command for another controlled axis: 0: The setting of bit 0 (IXS) of parameter No. 5502 is followed. 1: The commands are executed.

#2

#3

#4

#6

NOTE Even when this parameter is set to 1, an alarm PS1564, INDEX TABLE AXIS - OTHER AXIS SAME TIME is issued if the block is neither G00, G28, nor G30 (or the G00 mode).
#7 IDX Operation sequence of the index table indexing axis: 0: Type A 1: Type B
#7 5501 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 ISP #0 ITI

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 ITI The index table indexing function is: 0: Enabled. 1: Disabled. ISP Servo-off for an index axis at the completion of clamping is: 0: Processed by the CNC. 1: Not processed by the CNC. (The CNC follows the status of the servo-off signal <Gn0126> input from the PMC.)
#7 5502 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 IXS

#1

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 IXSx When a command is specified in a block that contains a command for the index table indexing axis: 0 : An alarm PS1564, INDEX TABLE AXIS - OTHER AXIS SAME TIME is issued. 1 : The command is executed.
- 283 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

If bit 6 (SIM) of parameter No. 5500 is set to 1, a simultaneous operation with all axes except the index table indexing axis can be performed regardless of the setting of this parameter. To set an axis that allows simultaneous operation for each axis, set SIM to 0, and set this parameter.

NOTE Even when this parameter is set to 1, an alarm PS1564, INDEX TABLE AXIS - OTHER AXIS SAME TIME is issued if the block is neither G00, G28, nor G30 (or the G00 mode).
5510 Controlled axis number of the index table indexing axis

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to Number of controlled axes This parameter sets the number of a controlled axis to be used as the index table indexing axis. When 0 is set, the fourth axis is assumed.
5511 M code that specifies rotation in the negative direction for index table indexing

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to 99999999 0: The rotation direction for the index table indexing axis is determined according to the setting of bit 3 (INC) of parameter No. 5500 and a command. 1 to 99999999: The rotation for the index table indexing axis is always performed in the positive direction. It is performed in the negative direction only when a move command is specified together with the M code set in this parameter.

NOTE Be sure to set bit 2 (ABS) of parameter No. 5500 to 1.


5512 Minimum positioning angle for the index table indexing axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path deg Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the minimum positioning angle (travel distance) for the index table indexing axis. The travel distance specified in the positioning command must always be an integer multiple of this setting. When 0 is set, the travel distance is not checked. The minimum positioning angle is checked not only for the command, but also for the coordinate system setting and workpiece origin offset.
- 284 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

4.30
5610

PARAMETERS OF INVOLUTE INTERPOLATION


Limit of initial permissible error during involute interpolation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the allowable limit of deviation between an involute curve passing through a start point and an involute curve passing through an end point for an involute interpolation command.
Lower override limit in automatic feedrate control during involute interpolation

5620

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Byte path % 0 to 100 In "override in the cutter compensation mode" under involute interpolation automatic feedrate control, the feedrate of the tool center near a basic circle may become very low in the case of an inner offset. To prevent this, set a lower override limit in this parameter. Thus, the feedrate is clamped so that the feedrate is not lower than a specified feedrate multiplied by the lower override limit set in this parameter.

NOTE When 0 or a value not within the valid data range is set, involute interpolation automatic feedrate control ("override in the cutter compensation mode" and "acceleration clamping near a basic circle") is disabled.

4.31
5630

PARAMETERS OF EXPONENTIAL INTERPOLATION


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 SPN

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 SPN The amount of linear axis division (span value) in exponential interpolation is: 0: Specified with parameter No. 5643. 1: Specified using address K in a block containing G02.3/G03.3. When address K is not specified, the value set with parameter No. 5643 is used.
Linear axis number subject to exponential interpolation

5641

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to number of controlled axes
- 285 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

This parameter sets the ordinal number, among the controlled axes, for the linear axis to which exponential interpolation is applied.
5642 Rotation axis number subject exponential interpolation

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to number of controlled axes This parameter sets the ordinal number, among the controlled axes, for the rotation axis to which exponential interpolation is applied.
5643 Amount of linear axis division (span value) in exponential interpolation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real path mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) This parameter sets an amount of linear axis division in exponential interpolation when bit 0 (SPN) of parameter No. 5630 is set to 0 or when address K is not specified.

4.32
5660 5661 5662 5663 5664 5665 5666 5667

PARAMETERS OF FLEXIBLE SYNCHRONOUS CONTROL (1 OF 2)


Master axis number (group A) Slave axis number (group A) Master axis number (group B) Slave axis number (group B) Master axis number (group C) Slave axis number (group C) Master axis number (group D) Slave axis number (group D)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data Input type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 ,1 to 32 Specify both master and slave axis numbers.
#7 5668 #6 #5 #4 #3 ACD #2 ACC #1 ACB #0 ACA

[Input type] Parameter input [Data Input type] Bit axis

#0

ACA Update of the machine coordinates of flexible synchronous control group A is: 0 : Executed. 1 : Not executed.
- 286 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
ACB Update of the machine coordinates of flexible synchronous control group B is: 0 : Executed. 1 : Not executed. ACC Update of the machine coordinates of flexible synchronous control group C is: 0 : Executed. 1 : Not executed. ACD Update of the machine coordinates of flexible synchronous control group D is: 0 : Executed. 1 : Not executed.

#1

#2

#3

NOTE The machine coordinates update is not done though the slave axis operates on the motor. In this case, if an automatic reference position return to origin is done after the synchronous mode is canceled, the alarm of DS0405, ZERO RETURN END NOT ON REF is issued. Please use a manual reference position return to origin to do the return to origin.
#7 5669 #6 #5 #4 #3 PHD #2 PHC #1 PHB #0 PHA

[Input type] Parameter input [Data Input type] Bit path

#0

PHA The automatic phase synchronization for flexible synchronous control of group A is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. PHB The automatic phase synchronization for flexible synchronous control of group B is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. PHC The automatic phase synchronization for flexible synchronous control of group C is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. PHD The automatic phase synchronization for flexible synchronous control of group D is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.

#1

#2

#3

NOTE When this parameter is set, acceleration/deceleration upon a synchronization start or synchronization cancellation is enabled. For automatic positioning, set the automatic phase synchronization signal for each group to 1.

- 287 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
5670 5671 5672 5673 5674 5675 5676 5677

B-63950EN/04

M code number for turning on the flexible synchronous control mode(group A) M code number for turning off the flexible synchronous control mode(group A) M code number for turning on the flexible synchronous control mode(group B) M code number for turning off the flexible synchronous control mode(group B) M code number for turning on the flexible synchronous control mode(group C) M code number for turning off the flexible synchronous control mode(group C) M code number for turning on the flexible synchronous control mode(group D) M code number for turning off the flexible synchronous control mode(group D)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data Input type] Word path [Valid data range] 1 to 999 Specify an M code for turning on or off the flexible synchronous control mode for an automatic operation.
5680 5681 5682 5683 5684 5685 5686 5687 Numerator determining gear ratio for flexible synchronization(group A) Denominator determining gear ratio for flexible synchronization(group A) Numerator determining gear ratio for flexible synchronization(group B) Denominator determining gear ratio for flexible synchronization(group B) Numerator determining gear ratio for flexible synchronization(group C) Denominator determining gear ratio for flexible synchronization(group C) Numerator determining gear ratio for flexible synchronization(group D) Denominator determining gear ratio for flexible synchronization(group D)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data Input type] 2 word path [Valid data range] -99999999 to 99999999 Specify a gear ratio between the master and slave axes.
5690 5691 5692 5693 Index to gear ratio denominator for flexible synchronization(group A) Index to gear ratio denominator for flexible synchronization(group B) Index to gear ratio denominator for flexible synchronization(group C) Index to gear ratio denominator for flexible synchronization(group D)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data Input type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 8 Specify an index to the denominator of a gear ratio between the master and slave axes. Let p, q, and k be, respectively, a denominator determining gear ratio for flexible synchronization, numerator determining gear ratio for flexible synchronization, and index to the gear ratio denominator for flexible synchronization:

The gear ratio is

q p 10 k
- 288 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

4.33
5700

PARAMETERS OF STRAIGHTNESS COMPENSATION (1 OF 2)


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 SM2 #1 #0 RSR

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 RSR Rewriting of real-time data of straightness compensation is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. With this parameter, it becomes possible to rewrite data listed below, which is related to straightness compensation and interpolated straightness compensation, by using G10, a PMC window, and a FOCAS2 library function while the power-on status is maintained. New data set by rewriting is reflected in the next and subsequent compensation points. Compensation amount at each compensation point for straightness compensation (Parameters Nos. 5761 to 5784, 13351 to 13374) Compensation magnification for moving axes 1 to 6 in interpolated straightness compensation (Parameters Nos. 13391 to 13396) Interpolated straightness compensation data (Compensation data Nos. 6000 to 6767)

NOTE 1 When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued. 2 If this parameter is set to "enabled" (bit 0 of parameter No. 5700 is set to 1), a power disconnection alarm is not issued even when parameters for setting a compensation amount at a compensation point for straightness compensation (parameter Nos. 5761 to 5784, and 13351 to 13374) and parameters for setting the compensation magnification for interpolated straightness compensation (parameter Nos. 13391 to 13396) are changed. 3 When this parameter is set to "enabled" (bit 0 of parameter No. 5700 is set to 1), be sure to stop all axes before rewriting any of the parameters related to straightness compensation or interpolated straightness compensation data mentioned above.
#2 SM2 In the straightness compensation function, magnification parameters (parameters Nos. 13391 to 13396) are treated as follows: 0: When more than one moving axis is set with the same number, the setting of the magnification parameter for the moving axis set first is used. 1: When more than one moving axis is set with the same number, the setting of the magnification parameter for each axis is used.

- 289 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
5711 5712 5713 5714 5715 5716 Straightness compensation : Axis number of moving axis 1 Straightness compensation : Axis number of moving axis 2 Straightness compensation : Axis number of moving axis 3 Straightness compensation : Axis number of moving axis 4 Straightness compensation : Axis number of moving axis 5 Straightness compensation : Axis number of moving axis 6

B-63950EN/04

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to number of controlled axes Set the axis number of a moving axis in straight compensation. When 0 is set, compensation is not performed.
5721 5722 5723 5724 5725 5726 Straightness compensation : Axis number of compensation axis 1 for moving axis 1 Straightness compensation : Axis number of compensation axis 2 for moving axis 2 Straightness compensation : Axis number of compensation axis 3 for moving axis 3 Straightness compensation : Axis number of compensation axis 4 for moving axis 4 Straightness compensation : Axis number of compensation axis 5 for moving axis 5 Straightness compensation : Axis number of compensation axis 6 for moving axis 6

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to number of controlled axes
5731 5732 5733 5734 Straightness compensation : Compensation point number a of moving axis 1 Straightness compensation : Compensation point number b of moving axis 1 Straightness compensation : Compensation point number c of moving axis 1 Straightness compensation : Compensation point number d of moving axis 1

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to 1023 These parameters set compensation point numbers in stored pitch error compensation.
- 290 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Set four compensation points for each moving axis.

5741 5742 5743 5744

Straightness compensation : Compensation point number a of moving axis 2 Straightness compensation : Compensation point number b of moving axis 2 Straightness compensation : Compensation point number c of moving axis 2 Straightness compensation : Compensation point number d of moving axis 2

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to 1023 These parameters set compensation point numbers in stored pitch error compensation. Set four compensation points for each moving axis.
5751 5752 5753 5754 Straightness compensation : Compensation point number a of moving axis 3 Straightness compensation : Compensation point number b of moving axis 3 Straightness compensation : Compensation point number c of moving axis 3 Straightness compensation : Compensation point number d of moving axis 3

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to 1023 These parameters set compensation point numbers in stored pitch error compensation. Set four compensation points for each moving axis.
5761 5762 5763 5764 Compensation corresponding compensation point number a of moving axis 1 Compensation corresponding compensation point number b of moving axis 1 Compensation corresponding compensation point number c of moving axis 1 Compensation corresponding compensation point number d of moving axis 1

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input Word path Detection unit -32767 to 32767 Each of these parameters sets a compensation value for each moving axis compensation point.
- 291 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
5771 5772 5773 5774

B-63950EN/04

Compensation corresponding compensation point number a of moving axis 2 Compensation corresponding compensation point number b of moving axis 2 Compensation corresponding compensation point number c of moving axis 2 Compensation corresponding compensation point number d of moving axis 2

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input Word path Detection unit -32767 to 32767 Each of these parameters sets a compensation value for each moving axis compensation point.
Compensation corresponding compensation point number a of moving axis 3 Compensation corresponding compensation point number b of moving axis 3 Compensation corresponding compensation point number c of moving axis 3 Compensation corresponding compensation point number d of moving axis 3

5781 5782 5783 5784

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input Word path Detection unit -32767 to 32767 Each of these parameters sets a compensation value for each moving axis compensation point.

4.34
5861 5862 5863 5864

PARAMETERS OF INCLINATION COMPENSATION


Inclination compensation : Compensation point number a for each axis Inclination compensation : Compensation point number b for each axis Inclination compensation : Compensation point number c for each axis Inclination compensation : Compensation point number d for each axis

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis
- 292 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Valid data range] 0 to 1023 These parameters set the compensation points for inclination compensation. The points are set for the compensation point numbers for stored pitch error compensation.
5871 5872 5873 5874 Inclination compensation : Compensation at compensation point number a for each axis Inclination compensation : Compensation at compensation point number b for each axis Inclination compensation : Compensation at compensation point number c for each axis Inclination compensation : Compensation at compensation point number d for each axis

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input Word axis Detection unit -32767 to 32767 Each of these parameters sets a compensation value for each axis compensation point.

- 293 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

4.35
6000

PARAMETERS OF CUSTOM MACROS


#7 SBV SBV #6 #5 SBM SBM #4 HGO HGO V15 #3 #2 #1 MGO MGO #0 G67 G67

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 G67 If the macro modal call cancel command (G67) is specified when the macro modal call mode (G66/G66.1) is not set: 0: Alarm PS1100, CANCEL WITHOUT MODAL CALL is issued. 1: The specification of G67 is ignored. MGO When a GOTO statement for specifying custom macro control is executed, a high-speed branch to 20 sequence numbers executed from the start of the program is: 0: A high-speed branch is not caused to n sequence numbers from the start of the executed program. 1: A high-speed branch is caused to n sequence numbers from the start of the program. V15 As system variable numbers for tool offset: 0 : The standard system variable numbers for the Series 16 are used. 1 : The same system variable numbers as those used for the Series 15 are used. The tables indicate the system variables for tool offset numbers 1 to 999. The values for tool offset numbers 1 to 200 can be read from or assigned to the system variables in parentheses. (1) Tool offset memory A
System variable number V15 = 0 V15 = 1 #10001 to #10999 #10001 to #10999 (#2001 to #2200) (#2001 to #2200) System variable number V15 = 0 Geometry offset value Wear offset value #11001 to #11999 (#2201 to #2400) #10001 to #10999 (#2001 to #2200) V15 = 1 #10001 to #10999 (#2001 to #2200) #11001 to #11999 (#2201 to #2400)

#1

#3

Wear offset value

(2) Tool offset memory B

(3) Tool offset memory C


System variable number V15 = 0 V15 = 1 #11001 to #11999 #10001 to #10999 (#2201 to #2400) (#2001 to #2200) #10001 to #10999 #11001 to #11999 (#2001 to #2200) (#2201 to #2400) #13001 to #13999 #12001 to #12999 #12001 to #12999 #13001 to #13999

Tool length offset Tool radius offset

Geometry offset value Wear offset value Geometry offset value Wear offset value

#4

HGO When a GOTO statement in a custom macro control command is executed, a high-speed branch to the 30 sequence numbers immediately before the executed statement is: 0: Not made. 1: Made.

- 294 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
SBM Custom macro statement 0: Not stop the single block 1: Stops the single block If you want to disable the single blocks in custom macro statements using system variable #3003, set this parameter to 0. If this parameter is set to 1, the single blocks in custom macro statements cannot be disabled using system variable #3003. To control single blocks in custom macro statements using system variable #3003, use bit 7 (SBV) of parameter No. 6000. SBV Custom macro statement 0: Not stop the single block 1: Enable/disable single block stop with system variable #3003
Bit 5 (SBM) of parameter No. 6000 0 1 Enables single block stop. (With Disables single block stop. variable #3003, single block stop Enables single block stop. (With cannot be enabled/disabled. Single variable #3003, single block stop block stop is enabled at all times.) can be enabled/disabled.)
#5 TCS #4 CRO #3 PV5 #2 #1 PRT #0 MIF

#5

#7

Bit 7 (SBV) of parameter No. 6000

0 1

#7 6001

#6 CCV

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 MIF The custom macro interface signals are based on: 0: Standard specification. (The signals UI000 to UI015, UO000 to UO015, and UO100 to UO131 are used.) 1: Extended specification. (The signals UI000 to UI031, UI100 to UI131, UI200 to UI231, UI300 to UI331, UO000 to UO031, UO100 to UO131, UO200 to UO231, and UO300 to UO331 are used.) PRT Reading zero when data is output using a DPRINT command 0: Outputs a space 1: Outputs no data PV5 Custom macro common variables: 0: #500 to #549 are output. (Note) 1: #100 to #149 and #500 to 549 are output. (Note)

#1

#3

NOTE Output variables are as the table according to the combination of added options.
When the parameter PV5=0 Option Addition of custom macro common variables Non Yes Non #500 to #549 #500 to #999 Yes #500 to #549 #500 to #999

Option Embedded macro

- 295 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

When the parameter PV5=1 Option Addition of custom macro common variables Non Yes Option Embedded macro Non Yes #100 to #149 and #500 to #549 #100 to #149, #200 to #499 and #500 to #549 #100 to #199 and #500 to #999 #100 to #199, #200 to #499 and #500 to #999

#4

CRO ISO code in BPRWT or DPRNT command 0: Outputs only LF after data is output 1: Outputs LF and CR after data is output TCS Custom macro (subprogram) 0: Not called using a T code 1: Called using a T code CCV Common variables #100 to #149(NOTE) cleared by power-off are: 0: Cleared to <null> by reset 1: Not cleared by reset

#5

#6

NOTE Cleared variables are as the table according to the combination of added options.
Option Addition of custom macro common variables Non Yes Option Embedded macro Non Yes #100 to #149 #100 to #149 and #200 to #499
#4 MPR #3 TSE #2 MIN

#100 to #199 #100 to #199 and #200 to #499


#1 MSK #0

#7 6003 MUS

#6

#5 MSB

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#1 MSK Absolute coordinates at that time during custom macro interrupt 0: Not set to the skip coordinates (system variables #5061 and later) 1: Set to the skip coordinates (system variables #5061 and later) MIN Custom macro interrupt 0: Performed by interrupting an in-execution block (Custom macro interrupt type I) 1: Performed after an in-execution block is completed (Custom macro interrupt type II) TSE Custom macro interrupt signal UINT 0: Edge trigger method (Rising edge) 1: Status trigger method

#2

#3

- 296 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
MPR Custom macro interrupt valid/invalid M code 0: M96/M97 1: M code set using parameters Nos. 6033 and 6034 MSB Interrupt program 0: Uses a dedicated local variable (Macro-type interrupt) 1: Uses the same local variable as in the main program (Subprogram- type interrupt) MUS Interrupt-type custom macro 0: Not used 1: Used
#7 #6 #5 D15 #4 #3 #2 VHD #1 #0 NAT NAT

#4

#5

#7

6004

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 NAT The results of the custom macro functions ATAN (with 2 arguments) and ASIN are specified as follows: 0: The result of ATAN is 0 to 360.0. The result of ASIN is 270.0 to 0 to 90.0. 1: The result of ATAN is -180.0 to 0 to 180.0. The result of ASIN is -90.0 to 0 to 90.0. VHD With system variables #5121 to #5140: 0: The tool offset value (geometry offset value) in the block currently being executed is read. (This parameter is valid only when tool geometry/tool wear compensation memories are available.) 1: An interrupt travel distance based on manual handle interrupt is read. D15 When tool compensation memory C is used, for reading or writing tool offset values (for up to offset number 200) for D code (tool radius), the same system variables, #2401 through #2800, as Series 15 are: 0: Not used. 1: Used. When bit 3 (V15) of parameter No. 6000 is set to 1
Compensation number 1 2 3 : 199 200
#7 6005 #6

#2

#5

D code Geometry Variable number #2401 #2402 #2403 : #2599 #2600


#5

Wear Variable number #2601 #2602 #2603 : #2799 #2800


#2

Variable name [#_OFSDG[1]] [#_OFSDG[2]] [#_OFSDG[3]] : [#_OFSDG[199]] [#_OFSDG[200]]


#4 #3

Variable name [#_OFSDW[1]] [#_OFSDW[2]] [#_OFSDW[3]] : [#_OFSDW[199]] [#_OFSDW[200]]


#1 #0 SQC

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path


- 297 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#0 SQC In the subprogram call function, a subprogram sequence number call is: 0: Not used. 1: Used.
#7 6007 SKM #6 #5 #4 CVA #3 MGE #2 BCS #1 SCS

B-63950EN/04

#0 DPG

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 DPG Specifies whether to allow G codes with a decimal point to be called. 0: Do not allow. 1: Allow. SCS Specifies whether to call subprograms with S codes. 0: Do not call with S codes. 1: Call with S codes. BCS Specifies whether to call subprograms with the second auxiliary function codes. 0: Do not call with the second auxiliary function codes. 1: Call with the second auxiliary function codes. MGE Specifies whether a G code modal call is made after movement or for each block. 0: Make a call for each block (equivalent to G66.1). 1: Make a call after movement (equivalent to G66). CVA The format for macro call arguments is specified as follows: 0: Arguments are passed in NC format without modifications. 1: Arguments are converted to macro format then passed. [Example] When G65 P_ X10 ; is specified, the value in local variable #24 in the calling program is set as follows:
Command #24 ADP[#24] CVA=0 0.01 10.0 CVA=1 0.01 0.01

#1

#2

#3

#4

NOTE External operations are the same unless the ADP function is used.
#7 SKM After skip operation, with the workpiece coordinate system setting command (G92 for the M series or G50 for the T series) or select command (G54 to G59), the values of macro variables #100151 to #100200 (#5061 to #5080) holding the skip position: 0: Change. (The workpiece coordinate system at the time of reading is reflected.) 1: Do not change.
#7 6008 IJK #6 GMP #5 ADD #4 ISO #3 KOP #2 DSM #1 MCA #0 F16

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 F16 The precision of operation is based on: 0: New specification. 1: FS16i compatible specification.
- 298 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
MCA A macro alarm specification based on system variable #3000 is selected as follows: 0: An alarm number obtained by adding 3000 to a value assigned to variable #3000 and the corresponding message are displayed. (A value from 0 to 200 can be assigned to variable #3000.) 1: A value assigned to variable #3000 and the corresponding message are displayed. (A value from 0 to 4095 can be assigned to variable #3000.) [Example] Execution of #3000=1 (ALARM MESSAGE); When bit 1 (MCA) of parameter No. 6008 is set to 0: The alarm screen displays "MC 3001 ALARM MESSAGE". When bit 1 (MCA) of parameter No. 6008 is set to 1: The alarm screen displays "MC0001 ALARM MESSAGE". DSM On the custom macro screen, the rewriting of a system variable that can be specified (written) on the left side from the MDI panel is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. KOP When the NC is reset in the state where the line is made open by POPEN: 0: Communication continues, and the line is left open. 1: Communication stops, and the line is closed. ISO 0: 1: When the EIA code is used, the bit patterns of codes specified instead of [, ], #, *, =, ?, @, &, and _ are set in parameter No. 6010 to No. 6018. When the ISO/ASCII code is used, the bit patters of codes specified instead of [, ], #, *, =, ?, @, &, and _ are set in parameter No. 6010 to No. 6018.

#1

#2

#3

#4

#5

ADD When the number of digits in the integer part, a, in the format specification [a,b] of the DPRNT statement is less than the number of digits in the integer part of an output variable value: 0: The specified number of digits only are output, with the unspecified digits discarded. 1: An alarm for excessive digits is issued. GMP The calling of M, S, T, a second auxiliary function code, or a particular code during the calling of a G code, and the calling of a G code during the calling of M, S, T, a second auxiliary function code, or particular code are: 0: Not allowed. (They are executed as an ordinary G, M, S, T, second auxiliary function code, and NC address.) 1: Allowed. IJK For addresses I, J, and K specified as arguments: 0: Argument specification I or II is automatically determined. 1: Argument specification I is always used.

#6

#7

- 299 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

Example When K_J_I_ is specified: When this parameter is set to 0: Argument specification II is used and K=#6, J=#8, and I=#10 are specified. When this parameter is set to1: Argument specification I is used and I=#4, J=#5, and K=#6 are specified regardless of the specification order. (Argument specification II cannot be used.)
#7 6009 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 MSM

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 MSM When a Macro Call using M code or a Macro Call using M code (Specification of 3 Sets) are not at the beginning of the block: 0: Alarm PS0127, DUPLICATE NC,MACRO STATEMENT is issued. 1: The Macro Call using M code is executed. All addresses specified in the same block are used as arguments.

NOTE 1 When MSM is set to 1 and an M code specified for a macro call is not at the beginning of the block, argument specification II cannot be used. 2 When MSM is set to 1 and an M code specified for a macro call is not at the beginning of the block, the number of repetitions (L) cannot be used.
#7 6010 6011 6012 6013 6014 6015 6016 6017 6018 *7 #7 =7 #7 #7 #7 [7 #7 ]7 #7 ?7 #7 @7 #7 &7 #7 _7 #6 *6 #6 =6 #6 #6 #6 [6 #6 ]6 #6 ?6 #6 @6 #6 &6 #6 _6 #5 *5 #5 =5 #5 #5 #5 [5 #5 ]5 #5 ?5 #5 @5 #5 &5 #5 _5 #4 *4 #4 =4 #4 #4 #4 [4 #4 ]4 #4 ?4 #4 @4 #4 &4 #4 _4 #3 *3 #3 =3 #3 #3 #3 [3 #3 ]3 #3 ?3 #3 @3 #3 &3 #3 _3 #2 *2 #2 =2 #2 #2 #2 [2 #2 ]2 #2 ?2 #2 @2 #2 &2 #2 _2 #1 *1 #1 =1 #1 #1 #1 [1 #1 ]1 #1 ?1 #1 @1 #1 &1 #1 _1 #0 *0 #0 =0 #0 #0 #0 [0 #0 ]0 #0 ?0 #0 @0 #0 &0 #0 _0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path *0 to *7 : The bit pattern of the EIA or ISO/ASCII code indicating * is set.
- 300 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
The bit pattern of the EIA or ISO/ASCII code indicating = is set. The bit pattern of the EIA or ISO/ASCII code indicating # is set. The bit pattern of the EIA or ISO/ASCII code indicating [ is set. The bit pattern of the EIA or ISO/ASCII code indicating ] is set. The bit pattern of the EIA or ISO/ASCII code indicating ? is set. The bit pattern of the EIA or ISO/ASCII code indicating @ is set. The bit pattern of the EIA or ISO/ASCII code indicating & is set. The bit pattern of the EIA or ISO/ASCII code indicating _ is set. 0: A corresponding bit is 0. 1: A corresponding bit is 1.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 OFN #2 DPD #1 #0 MCO

=0 to =7 : #0 to #7 : [0 to [7 : ]0 to ]7 : ?0 to ?7 : @0 to @7 : &0 to &7 : _0 to _7 :

6019

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 MCO When data is output, the decimal number value of the macro variable data is 0: Not output as a comment. 1: Output at the same time as a comment. After the number, data, and the variable name of the macro variable are output when data output operation is performed the variable number and the value of the macro variable data in decimal number are output as a comment.

NOTE 1 Output data by this parameter is "Comment", and this is ignored at the time of reading. 2 Accuracy of the output data of the comment is up to 15 digits. The range of output data are nine digits above decimal point and eight digits below decimal point. " OVER FLOW" is output instead of a value when the total digits number is more than 16 and the digit number above the decimal point is ten or more. When the number of digits below the decimal point becomes nine digits or more, the ninth place of the decimal point is rounded off and output. Moreover, the seventh place or the eighth place of the decimal point is rounded off and output when the total digits number is more than 16 and the digit number above decimal point is nine or eight. 3 The output becomes "EMPTY" when displayed, the macro variable data is "DATA EMPTY".
#2 DPD When argument D is specified for a macro call without a decimal point, the number of decimal places: 0: Is assumed to be 0. [Example] When G65PppppD1 is specified, #7=1.0000 is passed as the argument. 1: Depends on the increment system of the reference axis. [Example] When the increment system of the reference axis is IS-B and G65PppppD1 is specified, #7=0.0010 is passed as the argument.

- 301 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#3

B-63950EN/04

OFN The format of the name of a file output by the external output command (DPRNT or BPRNT) is: 0: PRNTxxxx.DAT (xxxx: 0000 to 9999). 1: MCR_PRNT.TXT (fixed).
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 NC2 #0 NC1

6020

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 NC1 The setting of the number of custom macro variables common to paths for #100 to #199 (#499) (parameter No. 6036) is: 0: Valid. As many custom macro variables #100 to #199 (or #100 to #499) set for this path as the number set in parameter No. 6036 are used as custom macro variables common to tool paths. 1: Invalid. Custom macro variables #100 to #199 (or #100 to #499) set for this path are all used as variables for the path.

NOTE For path 1, be sure to set this parameter to 0. Example In a 4-path system, when parameters are set as listed below, custom macro variables for paths 1 to 3 are used as variables common to these paths, but for path 4, custom macro variables for the path are used.
Path number No. 6036 NC1 1 2 3 4 20 0 0 0 1 Used custom macro variables Custom macro variables #100 to #119 are used as variables common to these paths, and other custom macro variables are used independently for the relevant path. Custom macro variables for path 4 are all used independently.

#1

NC2 The setting of the number of custom macro variables common to paths for #500 to #999 (parameter No. 6037) is: 0: Valid. As many custom macro variables #500 to #999 set for this path as the number set in parameter No. 6037 are used as custom macro variables common to tool paths. 1: Invalid. Custom macro variables #500 to #999 set for this path are all used as variables for the path.

NOTE For path 1, be sure to set this parameter to 0.


- 302 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS Example In a 4-path system, when parameters are set as listed below, custom macro variables for paths 1 to 3 are used as variables common to these paths, but for path 4, custom macro variables for the path are used.
Path number No. 6037 NC2 1 2 3 4 50 0 0 0 1 Used custom macro variables Custom macro variables #500 to #999 are used as variables common to these paths, and other custom macro variables are used independently for the relevant path. Custom macro variables for path 4 are all used independently.

6030

M code to execute external device subprogram calls

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to 99999999 Set the M code to execute external device subprogram calls. When 0 is set, M198 is used. M01, M02, M30, M98, and M99 cannot be used to execute external device subprogram calls. When a negative number, 1, 2, 30, 98, or 99 is set for this parameter, M198 is used to execute external device subprogram calls.
6031 6032 Start number of common variables to be protected among the common variables (#500 to #999) End number of common variables to be protected among the common variables (#500 to #999)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 500 to 999 Among the common variables #500 to #999, the range of common variables specified by this parameter can be protected (by setting their attributes to read-only). If a write attempt (on the left side) is made, an alarm is issued.

NOTE Set 0 in both parameter No. 6031 and No. 6032 not to protect common variables.
6033 6034 M code that validates a custom macro interrupt M code that invalidates a custom macro interrupt

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 03 to 99999999 (excluding 30, 98 and 99) These parameters can be used when bit 4 (MPR) of parameter No. 6003 is 1. M96 is used as a valid M code and M97 is used as an invalid M code when MPR is 0, irrespective of the state of this parameter.
6036 Number of custom macro variables common to tool path (for #100 to #199 (#499))

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to 400
- 303 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

When the memory common to paths is used, this parameter sets the number of custom macro common variables to be shared (custom macro variables common to paths). Common variables #100 to #199 (up to #499 in a system with the embedded macro option) may be shared. Ensure that the maximum number of usable macro common variables is not exceeded.

Example When 20 is set in parameter No. 6036 #100 to #119: Shared by all paths #120 to #149: Used by each path independently NOTE 1 To use up to #199, the option for adding custom macro common variables is required. 2 To use up to #499, the embedded macro option is required. 3 When 0 or a negative value is set, the memory common to paths is not used. 4 When the option for embedded macro is effective and the option for addition of custom macro common variables is not effective, #150 to #199 can not be used but this parameter should be set the number which includes #150 to #199.
6037 Number of custom macro variables common to tool path (for #500 to #999)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to 500 When the memory common to paths is used, this parameter sets the number of custom macro common variables to be shared (custom macro variables common to paths). Common variables #500 to #999 may be shared. Ensure that the maximum number of usable macro common variables is not exceeded.

Example When 50 is set in parameter No. 6037 #500 to #549: Shared by all paths #550 to #599: Used by each path independently NOTE 1 To use up to #999, the option for adding custom macro common variables is required. 2 When 0 or a negative value is set, the memory common to paths is not used.
6038 Start G code used to call a custom macro

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] -9999 to 9999
6039 Start program number of a custom macro called by G code

[Input type] Parameter input


- 304 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 1 to 9999


6040 Number of G codes used to call custom macros

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to 255 Set this parameter to define multiple custom macro calls using G codes at a time. With G codes as many as the value set in parameter No. 6040 starting with the G code set in parameter No. 6038, the custom macros of program numbers as many as the value set in parameter No. 6040 starting with the program number set in parameter No. 6039 can be called. Set 0 in parameter No. 6040 to disable this mode of calling. If a negative value is set in parameter No. 6038, the modal call mode is entered. Whether the modal call is equivalent to G66 or G66.1 depends on bit 3 (MGE) of parameter No. 6007. [Example] When parameter No. 6038 = 900, parameter No. 6039 = 1000, and parameter No. 6040 = 100 are set, a set of 100 custom macro calls (simple calls) is defined as follows: G900 O1000 G901 O1001 G902 O1002 : G999 O1099 When the setting of parameter No. 6038 is changed to -900, the same set of custom macro calls (modal calls) is defined.

NOTE 1 When the following conditions are satisfied, all calls using these parameters are disabled: 1) When a value not within the specifiable range is set in each parameter 2) (Value of parameter No. 6039 + value of parameter No. 6040 1) > 9999 2 The specification of a mixture of simple calls and modal calls is not allowed. 3 If a range of G codes set by these parameters duplicate G codes specified in parameters Nos. 6050 to 6059, the calls specified by parameters Nos. 6050 to 6059 are made preferentially.
6041 Start G code with a decimal point used to call a custom macro

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] -999 to 999
6042 Start program number of a custom macro called by G code with a decimal point

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 1 to 9999
6043 Number of G codes with a decimal point used to call custom macros

- 305 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to 255 Set this parameter to define multiple custom macro calls using G codes with a decimal point at a time. With G codes with a decimal point as many as the value set in parameter No. 6043 starting with the G code with a decimal point set in parameter No. 6041, the custom macros of program numbers as many as the value set in parameter No. 6043 starting with the program number set in parameter No. 6042 can be called. Set 0 in parameter No. 6043 to disable this mode of calling. If a negative value is set in parameter No. 6041, the modal call mode is entered. Whether the modal call is equivalent to G66 or G66.1 depends on bit 3 (MGE) of parameter No. 6007. [Example] When parameter No. 6041 = 900, parameter No. 6042 = 2000, and parameter No. 6043 = 100 are set, a set of 100 custom macro calls (simple calls) is defined as follows: G90.0 O2000 G90.1 O2001 G90.2 O2002 : G99.9 O2099 When the setting of parameter No. 6041 is changed to -900, the same set of custom macro calls (modal calls) is defined.

NOTE 1 When the following conditions are satisfied, all calls using these parameters are disabled: 1) When a value not within the specifiable range is set in each parameter 2) (Value of parameter No. 6042 + value of parameter No. 6043 1) > 9999 3) When bit 0 (DPG) of parameter No. 6007 = 0 (to disable calls using G codes with a decimal point) 2 The specification of a mixture of simple calls and modal calls is not allowed. 3 If a range of G codes set by these parameters duplicate G codes specified in parameters Nos. 6060 to 6069, the calls specified by parameters Nos. 6060 to 6069 are made preferentially.
6044 Start M code used to call a subprogram

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 3 to 99999999
6045 Start program number of a subprogram called by M code

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 1 to 9999
6046 Number of M codes used to call subprograms (number of subprograms called by M codes)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path


- 306 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Valid data range] 0 to 32767 Set this parameter to define multiple subprogram calls using M codes at a time. With M codes as many as the value set in parameter No. 6046 starting with the M code set in parameter No. 6044, the subprograms of program numbers as many as the value set in parameter No. 6046 starting with the program number set in 6045 can be called. Set 0 in parameter No. 6046 to disable this mode of calling. [Example] When parameter No. 6044 = 80000000, parameter No. 6045 = 3000, and parameter No. 6046 = 100 are set, a set of 100 subprogram calls is defined as follows: M80000000 O3000 M80000001 O3001 M80000002 O3002 : M80000099 O3099

NOTE 1 When the following conditions are satisfied, all calls using these parameters are disabled: 1) When a value not within the specifiable range is set in each parameter 2) (Value of parameter No. 6045 + value of parameter No. 6046 1) > 9999 2 If a range of M codes set by these parameters duplicate M codes specified in parameter No. 6071 to No. 6079, the calls specified by parameter No. 6071 to 6079 are made preferentially.
6047 Start M code used to call a custom macro

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 3 to 99999999
6048 Start program number of a custom macro called by M code

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 1 to 9999
6049 Number of M codes used to call custom macros (number of custom macros called by M codes)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to 32767 Set this parameter to define multiple custom macro calls using M codes at a time. With M codes as many as the value set in parameter No. 6049 starting with the M code set in parameter No. 6047, the custom macros of program numbers as many as the value set in parameter No. 6049 starting with the program number set in parameter No. 6048 can be called. Set 0 in parameter No. 6049 to disable this mode of calling. [Example] When parameter No. 6047 = 90000000, parameter No. 6048 = 4000, and parameter No. 6049 = 100 are set, a set of 100 custom macro calls (simple calls) is defined as follows: M90000000 O4000 M90000001 O4001 M90000002 O4002 :
- 307 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
M90000099 O4099

B-63950EN/04

NOTE 1 When the following conditions are satisfied, all calls using these parameters are disabled: 1) When a value not within the specifiable range is set in each parameter 2) (Value of parameter No. 6048 + value of parameter No. 6049 1) > 9999 2 If a range of M codes set by these parameters duplicate M codes specified in parameter No. 6080 through No. 6089, the calls specified by parameter No. 6080 through 6089 are made preferentially.
6050 6051 6052 6053 6054 6055 6056 6057 6058 6059 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9010 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9011 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9012 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9013 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9014 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9015 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9016 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9017 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9018 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9019

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] (-9999 to 9999 : excluding 0, 5, 65, 66 and 67) Set the G codes used to call the custom macros of program numbers 9010 to 9019. However, note that when a negative value is set in this parameter, it becomes a modal call. For example, if this parameter is set to -11, the modal call mode is entered by G11. Whether the modal call is equivalent to G66 or G66.1 depends on bit 3 (MGE) of parameter No. 6007.
6060 6061 6062 6063 6064 6065 6066 6067 G code with a decimal point used to call the custom macro of program number 9040 G code with a decimal point used to call the custom macro of program number 9041 G code with a decimal point used to call the custom macro of program number 9042 G code with a decimal point used to call the custom macro of program number 9043 G code with a decimal point used to call the custom macro of program number 9044 G code with a decimal point used to call the custom macro of program number 9045 G code with a decimal point used to call the custom macro of program number 9046 G code with a decimal point used to call the custom macro of program number 9047

- 308 -

B-63950EN/04 6068 6069

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
G code with a decimal point used to call the custom macro of program number 9048 G code with a decimal point used to call the custom macro of program number 9049

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] -999 to 999 Set the G codes used to call the custom macros of program numbers 9040 to 9049. However, note that when a negative value is set in this parameter, it becomes a modal call. For example, if this parameter is set to -11, the modal call mode is entered by G11. Whether the modal call is equivalent to G66 or G66.1 depends on bit 3 (MGE) of parameter No. 6007. Set G codes in the format Gm.n. The value expressed by (m10+n) is set in the parameter. The values m and n must satisfy the following relationships: 0 m 99, 0 n 9.

NOTE Parameter Nos. 6060 to 6069 are valid when bit 0 (DPG) of parameter No. 6007 is set to 1.
6071 6072 6073 6074 6075 6076 6077 6078 6079 M code used to call the subprogram of program number 9001 M code used to call the subprogram of program number 9002 M code used to call the subprogram of program number 9003 M code used to call the subprogram of program number 9004 M code used to call the subprogram of program number 9005 M code used to call the subprogram of program number 9006 M code used to call the subprogram of program number 9007 M code used to call the subprogram of program number 9008 M code used to call the subprogram of program number 9009

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 3 to 99999999 (excluding 30, 98 and 99) These parameters set the M codes that call the subprograms of program numbers 9001 to 9009.

NOTE If the same M code is set in these parameters, the younger number is called preferentially. For example, if 100 is set in parameter No. 6071 and 6072, and programs O9001 and O9002 both exist, O9001 is called when M100 is specified.
6080 6081 6082 6083 M code used to call the custom macro of program number 9020 M code used to call the custom macro of program number 9021 M code used to call the custom macro of program number 9022 M code used to call the custom macro of program number 9023

- 309 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
6084 6085 6086 6087 6088 6089 M code used to call the custom macro of program number 9024 M code used to call the custom macro of program number 9025 M code used to call the custom macro of program number 9026 M code used to call the custom macro of program number 9027 M code used to call the custom macro of program number 9028 M code used to call the custom macro of program number 9029

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 3 to 99999999 (excluding 30, 98 and 99) Set the M codes used to call the custom macros of program numbers 9020 to 9029. The simple call mode is set.

NOTE 1 If the same M code is set in these parameters, the younger number is called preferentially. For example, if 200 is set in parameter No. 6081 and No. 6082, and programs O9021 and O9022 both exist, O9021 is called when M200 is specified. 2 If the same M code is set in a parameters Nos. 6071 to 6079 used to call subprograms and in a parameters Nos. 6080 to 6089 used to call custom macros, a custom macro is called preferentially. For example, if 300 is set in parameters Nos. 6071 and 6081, and programs O9001 and O9021 both exist, O9021 is called when M300 is specified.
6090 6091 ASCII code that calls the subprogram of program number 9004 ASCII code that calls the subprogram of program number 9005

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 65(A:41H) to 90(Z:5AH) These parameters set the ASCII codes that call subprograms in decimal. The settable addresses are indicated below.
Address A B D F H I J K L M P Q R S T Parameter setting value 65 66 68 70 72 73 74 75 76 77 80 81 82 83 84 T series O O X O O O O O O O O O O O O M series O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O

- 310 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Address V X Y Z Parameter setting value 86 88 89 90 T series X X X X M series O O O O

NOTE 1 When address L is set, the number of repeats cannot be specified. 2 Set 0 when no subprogram is called.
6095 The number of programs used by the one touch macro call function

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 16 Specify the number of programs used by the one touch macro call function. For instance, when three is set, macro call start signal MCST1, MCST2, and MCST3 is valid. When 0 is specified, this function is invalid.
6096 The first O number of the program used by the one touch macro call function

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 1 to 9999 Specify the first O number of the program used by the one touch macro call function. When 9000 is set, for example, the relationship between macro call start signal MSCTx and the program number of a program started by the signal is as follows: MCST1 signal : Starts O9000 (when 1 or a greater value is set in parameter No. 6095). MCST2 signal : Starts O9001 (when 2 or a greater value is set in parameter No. 6095). MCST3 signal : Starts O9002 (when 3 or a greater value is set in parameter No. 6095). : : : MCST15 signal : Starts O9014 (when 15 or a greater value is set in parameter No. 6095). MCST16 signal : Starts O9015 (when 16 or a greater value is set in parameter No. 6095).

4.36
6101 6102 6103 6104 6105 6106 6107 6108 6109

PARAMETERS OF PATTERN DATA INPUT


Macro variable number selected first when pattern menu 1 is selected Macro variable number selected first when pattern menu 2 is selected Macro variable number selected first when pattern menu 3 is selected Macro variable number selected first when pattern menu 4 is selected Macro variable number selected first when pattern menu 5 is selected Macro variable number selected first when pattern menu 6 is selected Macro variable number selected first when pattern menu 7 is selected Macro variable number selected first when pattern menu 8 is selected Macro variable number selected first when pattern menu 9 is selected

- 311 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
6110 Macro variable number selected first when pattern menu 10 is selected

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0,100 to 199,500 to 999 Set the macro variable number to be selected first when a pattern menu is selected on the custom macro screen. If 0 is specified, 500 is assumed. If a value beyond the above range is entered, 100 is assumed.

4.37
6131

PARAMETERS OF POSITIONING BY OPTIMUM ACCELERATION


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 OAD

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 OAD The function for positioning by optimum acceleration (seven step switch of the rapid traverse rate, time constant, and loop gain by the positioning distance to rapid traverse by automatic operation) is 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
#7 6132 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 ILG

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 ILG In the function for positioning by optimum acceleration, the switch of the loop gain is 0: Enabled. (Parameters Nos. 6181 to 6187 is used.) 1: Disabled. (Parameter No. 1825 is used.)
Distance D1 for level 1 of positioning by optimum acceleration for each axis Distance D2 for level 2 of positioning by optimum acceleration for each axis Distance D3 for level 3 of positioning by optimum acceleration for each axis

6136 6137 6138

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch, degree(machine unit) Refer to the standard parameter setting table(B) When a function for changing the rapid traverse rate, time constant, and loop gain according to the positioning distance is used, set the positioning distance for each axis.

- 312 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE 1 When this parameter is enabled, bit 0 (OADx) of parameter No. 6131 must be set to 1. 2 When 0 is set to all parameters Nos. 6136 to 6138 and Nos. 11230 to 11232, this function is invalid. 3 The setting must satisfy the relationship D1 < D2 < D3 < D4 < D5 < D6. 4 Up to seven levels can be used for adjustment. When using four levels, for example, set to become D1<D2<D3 and set D4, D5, D6 to maximum setting value (When the increment system is IS-B, 999999.999). 5 For diameter programming axes, set a diameter. For example, assume that 10.000mm is set in a parameter for diameter programming axes. Then, when the travel distance has reached 10.000 mm, adjustment is performed. 6 The distance of each axis is set to each parameter Nos. 6136 to 6138 and Nos. 11230 to 11232. The length of the block cannot be specified.

6161 6162 6163 6164 6165 6166 6167

Level 1 rapid traverse rate Level 2 rapid traverse rate Level 3 rapid traverse rate Level 4 rapid traverse rate Level 5 rapid traverse rate Level 6 rapid traverse rate Level 7 rapid traverse rate

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Refer to the standard parameter setting table(C) The rapid traverse rate for each axis is set.
Level 1 rapid traverse time constant Level 2 rapid traverse time constant Level 3 rapid traverse time constant Level 4 rapid traverse time constant Level 5 rapid traverse time constant Level 6 rapid traverse time constant Level 7 rapid traverse time constant

6171 6172 6173 6174 6175 6176 6177

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis msec 0 to 4000


- 313 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
The rapid traverse time constant for each axis is set.
6181 6182 6183 6184 6185 6186 6187 Level 1 servo loop gain Level 2 servo loop gain Level 3 servo loop gain Level 4 servo loop gain Level 5 servo loop gain Level 6 servo loop gain Level 7 servo loop gain

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis 0.01/sec 1 to 9999 The servo loop gain for each axis is set. If 0 is set, parameter No. 1825 is used.
Time constant T2 of level 1 bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration in rapid traverse T2 Time constant T2 of level 2 bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration in rapid traverse T2 Time constant T2 of level 3 bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration in rapid traverse T2 Time constant T2 of level 4 bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration in rapid traverse T2 Time constant T2 of level 5bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration in rapid traverse T2 Time constant T2 of level 6 bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration in rapid traverse T2 Time constant T2 of level 7 bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration in rapid traverse T2

6191 6192 6193 6194 6195 6196 6197

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis msec 0 to 512 Time constant T2 of bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration in rapid traverse for each axis is set.

4.38
6200

PARAMETERS OF SKIP FUNCTION


#7 SKF #6 SRE #5 SLS #4 HSS #3 #2 #1 SK0 #0 GSK

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 GSK As a skip signal, the skip signal SKIPP is: 0: Invalid. 1: Valid.

- 314 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
SK0 This parameter specifies whether the skip signal is made valid under the state of the skip signal SKIP and the multistage skip signals SKIP2 to SKIP8. 0: Skip signal is valid when these signals are 1. 1: Skip signal is valid when these signals are 0. HSS 0: 1: The skip function does not use high-speed skip signals while skip signals are input. (The conventional skip signal is used.) The step skip function uses high-speed skip signals while skip signals are input. The multi-step skip function does not use high-speed skip signals while skip signals are input. (The conventional skip signal is used.) The multi-step skip function uses high-speed skip signals while skip signals are input.

#1

#4

#5

SLS 0: 1:

NOTE The skip signals (SKIP and SKIP2 to SKIP8) are valid regardless of the setting of this parameter. They can also be disabled using bit 4 (IGX) of parameter No. 6201. If you want to use high-speed skip signals when the multi-step skip function option is used, set this parameter to 1.
#6 SRE When a high-speed skip signal or high-speed measurement position arrival signal is used: 0: The signal is assumed to be input on the rising edge (contact open close). 1: The signal is assumed to be input on the falling edge (contact close open). SKF Dry run, override, and automatic acceleration/deceleration for G31 skip command 0: Disabled 1: Enabled
#7 6201 SKPXE #6 #5 CSE #4 IGX #3 #2 TSE #1 SEB #0

#7

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #1 SEB When a skip signal or measurement position arrival signal goes on while the skip function, or the automatic tool length measurement (M series) or automatic tool compensation (T series) is used, the accumulated pulses and positional deviation due to acceleration/deceleration are: 0: Ignored. 1: Considered and compensated. The accumulated pulses and positional deviation due to actual acceleration/deceleration when the skip signal or measurement position arrival signal goes on are considered to obtain the position at which the signal is input. TSE When the torque limit skip function (G31 P98/99) is used, the skip position held in a system variable (#5061 to #5080) is: 0: Position that is offset considering the delay (positional deviation) incurred by the servo system. 1: Position that does not reflect the delay incurred by the servo system.

#2

- 315 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Position during skip operation Current position of CNC

B-63950EN/04

Machine position

Error amount

Origin of the coordinate system Position in consideration of delay Position without consideration of delay

Stop point

#4

IGX When the high-speed skip function is used, SKIP, SKIPP, and SKIP2 to SKIP8 are: 0: Enabled as skip signals. 1: Disabled as skip signals. CSE For the continuous high-speed skip command, high-speed skip signals are: 0: Effective at either a rising or falling edge (depending on the setting of bit 6 (SRE) of parameter No. 6200). 1: Effective at both the rising and falling edges.

#5

#7

SKPXE For the skip function (G31), the skip signal SKIP is: 0: Enabled. 1: Disabled.
Whether the skip signals are enabled or disabled Skip Skip Bit 7 (SKPXE) Bit 0 (GSK) signal signal of parameter of parameter SKIP SKIPP No .6201 No. 6200 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 Disabled Enabled Disabled Enabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Enabled Enabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled

Parameter

Bit 4 (IGX) of parameter No. 6201 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1

Multistage skip signals SKIP2-SKIP8 Enabled Enabled Enabled Enabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled

Setting

Bit 4 (IGX) of parameter No. 6201 is valid for the skip function using high-speed skip signals (when bit 4 (HSS) of parameter No. 6200 is set to 1) or for the multistage skip function using high-speed skip signals (when bit 5 (SLS) of parameter No. 6200 is set to 1). To use multistage skip signals, the multistage skip function option is required.
#7 6202 1S8 #6 1S7 #5 1S6 #4 1S5 #3 1S4 #2 1S3 #1 1S2 #0 1S1

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

- 316 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

1S1 to 1S8 These parameters specify whether to enable or disable each high-speed skip signal when the G31 skip command is issued. The following table shows the correspondence between the bits, input signals, and commands. The settings of the bits have the following meaning : 0: The high-speed skip signal corresponding to a bit is disabled. 1: The high-speed skip signal corresponding to a bit is enabled.
Parameter 1S1 1S2 1S3 1S4 High-speed skip signals HDI0 HDI1 HDI2 HDI3 Parameter 1S5 1S6 1S7 1S8 High-speed skip signals HDI4 HDI5 HDI6 HDI7

NOTE Do not specify the same signal simultaneously for different paths.
#7 6203 6204 6205 6206 2S8 #7 3S8 #7 4S8 #7 DS8 #6 2S7 #6 3S7 #6 4S7 #6 DS7 #5 2S6 #5 3S6 #5 4S6 #5 DS6 #4 2S5 #4 3S5 #4 4S5 #4 DS5 #3 2S4 #3 3S4 #3 4S4 #3 DS4 #2 2S3 #2 3S3 #2 4S3 #2 DS3 #1 2S2 #1 3S2 #1 4S2 #1 DS2 #0 2S1 #0 3S1 #0 4S1 #0 DS1

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path 1S1to1S8, 2S1to2S8, 3S1to3S8, 4S1to4S8, DS1toDS8 Specify which skip signal is enabled when the skip command (G31, or G31P1 to G31P4) and the dwell command (G04, G04Q1 to G04Q4) are issued with the multi-step skip function. The following table shows the correspondence between the bits, input signals, and commands. The setting of the bits have the following meaning : 0: The skip signal corresponding to a bit is invalid. 1: The skip signal corresponding to a bit is enabled.
Multi-step skip function Command Input signal SKIP/HDI0 SKIP2/HDI1 SKIP3/HDI2 SKIP4/HDI3 SKIP5/HDI4 SKIP6/HDI5 SKIP7/HDI6 SKIP8/HDI7 G31 G31P1 G04Q1 1S1 1S2 1S3 1S4 1S5 1S6 1S7 1S8 G31P2 G04Q2 2S1 2S2 2S3 2S4 2S5 2S6 2S7 2S8 G31P3 G04Q3 3S1 3S2 3S3 3S4 3S5 3S6 3S7 3S8 G31P4 G04Q4 4S1 4S2 4S3 4S4 4S5 4S6 4S7 4S8 G04 DS1 DS2 DS3 DS4 DS5 DS6 DS7 DS8

- 317 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE HDI0 to HDI7 are high-speed skip signals. Do not specify the same signal simultaneously for different paths.
When bit 0 (GSK) of parameter No. 6200 is set to 1, commands to be skipped can be selected by setting the following parameter:
Commands skipped by SKIPP signal <G006.6> Parameter Command skipped When bit 0 (1S1) of parameter No. 6202 is set to 1 When bit 0 (2S1) of parameter No. 6203 is set to 1 When bit 0 (3S1) of parameter No. 6204 is set to 1 When bit 0 (4S1) of parameter No. 6205 is set to 1 When bit 0 (DS1) of parameter No. 6206 is set to 1
#7 6207 #6 #5 #4 #3

G31P1,G04Q1 G31P2,G04Q2 G31P3,G04Q3 G31P4,G04Q4 G04,G04Q1,G04Q2,G04Q3,G04Q4


#2 SFN #1 SFP #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #1 SFP The feedrate used when the skip function (G31) is being executed is: 0: Feedrate of a programmed F code. 1: Feedrate set in parameter No. 6281.

NOTE For the multi-stage skip function and high-speed skip, see the description of bit 2 (SFN ) of parameter No. 6207.
#2 SFN The feedrate used when the skip function based on high-speed skip signals (with bit 4 (HSS) of parameter No. 6200 set to 1) or the multi-skip function is being executed is: 0: Feedrate of a programmed F code. 1: Feedrate set in a parameter from parameter No. 6282 to No. 6285.

NOTE For not the multistage skip function, but the skip function using no high-speed skip signals (when bit 4 (HSS) of parameter No. 6200 is set to 0), see the description of bit 1 (SFP) of parameter No. 6207.
#7 6208 9S8 #6 9S7 #5 9S6 #4 9S5 #3 9S4 #2 9S3 #1 9S2 #0 9S1

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path 9S1 to 9S8 Specify which high-speed skip signal is enabled for the continuous high-speed skip command G31P90 or the EGB skip command G31.8. The settings of each bit have the following meaning: 0: The high-speed skip signal corresponding to the bit is disabled. 1: The high-speed skip signal corresponding to the bit is enabled. The bits correspond to signals as follows:

- 318 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Parameter 9S1 9S2 9S3 9S4
#7 #6 MDC #5

High-speed skip signal HDI0 HDI1 HDI2 HDI3


#4 ASB

Parameter 9S5 9S6 9S7 9S8


#3 ASL #2 DSK

High-speed skip signal HDI4 HDI5 HDI6 HDI7


#1 #0

6210

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #2 DSK Skip position reading (system variables #5421 to #5440, #100701 to #100750) by the detection unit is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. ASL ASB The ASB and ASL bits set the type and time constant of acceleration/deceleration after interpolation in the skip function as follows:
ASB 0 1 0 ASL 1 0 Type of acceleration/ deceleration Parameter No. for time constant

#3 #4

Linear type Parameter No. 6280 Bell-shaped (NOTE) This function is disabled .

When bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration is specified, T1=T/2 and T2=T/2 are obtained as with normal acceleration/deceleration after cutting feed interpolation, where T is the time constant. Therefore, the acceleration/deceleration type includes no linear part.

NOTE In this case, the acceleration/deceleration type is set in bits 0 and 1 of parameter No. 1610, and the time constant is set in parameter No. 1622.
#6 MDC The measurement result of automatic tool length measurement (M series) or automatic tool compensation (T series) is: 0: Added to the current offset. 1: Subtracted from the current offset.
#7 6215 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 CSTx

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 CSTx On a Cs contour control axis, torque limit skip operation is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed. Torque limit skip operation is performed using the torque limit command signal TLMH and the load detection signal LDT1 of the serial spindle.

- 319 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
6220

B-63950EN/04

Period during which skip signal input is ignored for the continuous high-speed skip function and EGB axis skip function

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Byte path 8msec 3 to 127( 8msec) This parameter specifies the period from when a skip signal is input to when the next skip signal can be input for the continuous high-speed skip function and EGB axis skip function. This parameter is used to ignore chattering in skip signals. If a value that falls outside the valid range is specified, the setting is assumed to be 24 msec.
Signal ignoring period (parameter No. 6220)

Skip signal This signal is ignored.

When high-speed skip signals are used and bit 5 (CSE) of parameter No. 6201 is set to 1, signals are handled as follows:
Signal ignoring period (parameter No. 6220)

High-speed skip signals

These signals are ignored.

6221

Torque limit dead zone time for a torque limit skip command

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis 2msec 0 to 65535 The torque limit skip arrival signal is ignored for a set period of time. If G31P98 is specified, skip operation is not performed for a set period of time after the torque limit skip arrival signal is set to 1. If G31P99 is specified, skip operation is not performed for a set period of time after the torque limit skip arrival signal is set to 1. However, if a skip signal is input, skip operation is performed, regardless of the period of time set in this parameter.
#7 #6 1A7 #5 1A6 #4 1A5 #3 1A4 #2 1A3 #1 1A2 #0 1A1

6224

1A8

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path 1A1 to 1A8 Specify which high-speed measurement position arrival signal is to be enabled for each AE1 signal of G37 (automatic tool length measurement (M series) or automatic tool compensation (T series)).
- 320 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Parameter 1A1 1A2 1A3 1A4 Corresponding high-speed measurement position arrival signal HAE1 HAE2 HAE3 HAE4 Parameter 1A5 1A6 1A7 1A8 Corresponding high-speed measurement position arrival signal HAE5 HAE6 HAE7 HAE8

0: 1:

The corresponding high-speed measurement position arrival signal is disabled. The corresponding high-speed measurement position arrival signal is enabled.
#7 #6 2A7 #5 2A6 #4 2A5 #3 2A4 #2 2A3 #1 2A2 #0 2A1

6225

2A8

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path 2A1 to 2A8 Specify which high-speed measurement position arrival signal is enabled for each AE2 signal of G37 (automatic tool length measurement (M series) or automatic tool compensation (T series)).
Parameter 2A1 2A2 2A3 2A4 Corresponding high-speed measurement position arrival signal HAE1 HAE2 HAE3 HAE4 Parameter 2A5 2A6 2A7 2A8 Corresponding high-speed measurement position arrival signal HAE5 HAE6 HAE7 HAE8

0: 1:

The corresponding high-speed measurement position arrival signal is disabled. The corresponding high-speed measurement position arrival signal is enabled.
#7 #6 3A7 #5 3A6 #4 3A5 #3 3A4 #2 3A3 #1 3A2 #0 3A1

6226

3A8

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path 3A1 to 3A8 Specify which high-speed measurement position arrival signal is to be enabled for each AE3 signal of G37 (automatic tool length measurement (M series) or automatic tool compensation (T series)).
Parameter 3A1 3A2 3A3 3A4 Corresponding high-speed measurement position arrival signal HAE1 HAE2 HAE3 HAE4 Parameter 3A5 3A6 3A7 3A8 Corresponding high-speed measurement position arrival signal HAE5 HAE6 HAE7 HAE8

0: 1:

The corresponding high-speed measurement position arrival signal is disabled. The corresponding high-speed measurement position arrival signal is enabled.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 AMH #0 AE0

6240

[Input type] Parameter input


- 321 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
[Data type] Bit path #0

B-63950EN/04

AE0 Measurement position arrival is assumed when the automatic tool compensation signals XAE1 and XAE2<X004.0 and X004.1> (T series) or the automatic tool length measurement signals XAE1, XAE2, and XAE3<X004.0, X004.1, and X004.2> (M series) are: 0: 1. 1: 0. AMH For automatic tool compensation signals (T series) or automatic tool length measurement signals (M series), a high-speed measurement position arrival signal is: 0: Not used. 1: Used.
Feedrate during measurement of automatic tool compensation (T series) (for the XAE1 and GAE1 signals) Feedrate during measurement of automatic tool length measurement (M series) (for the XAE1 and GAE1 signals) Feedrate during measurement of automatic tool compensation (T series) (for the XAE2 and GAE2 signals) Feedrate during measurement of automatic tool length measurement (M series) (for the XAE2 and GAE2 signals)

#1

6241

6242

6243

Feedrate during measurement of automatic tool length measurement (M series) (for the XAE3 and GAE3 signals)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm/min, inch/min, deg/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) These parameters set the relevant feedrate during measurement of automatic tool compensation (T series) or automatic tool length measurement (M series).

NOTE When the setting of parameter No. 6242 or 6243 is 0, the setting of parameter No. 6241 is used.
6251 value on the X axis during automatic tool compensation (T series) value during automatic tool length measurement (M series) (for the XAE1 and GAE1 signals) value on the Z axis during automatic tool compensation (T series) value during automatic tool length measurement (M series) (for the XAE2 and GAE2 signals)

6252

6253

value during automatic tool length measurement (M series) (for the XAE3 and GAE3 signals)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word path mm, inch, deg (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999)
- 322 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
These parameters set the relevant value during automatic tool compensation (T series) or automatic tool length measurement (M series).

NOTE 1 For the M series, when the setting of parameter No. 6252 or 6253 is 0, the setting of parameter No. 6251 is used. 2 Set a radius value regardless of whether diameter or radius programming is specified.
6254 value on the X axis during automatic tool compensation (T series) value during automatic tool length measurement (M series) (for the XAE1 and GAE1 signals) 6255 value on the Z axis during automatic tool compensation (T series) value during automatic tool length measurement (M series) (for the XAE2 and GAE2 signals) 6256 value during automatic tool length measurement (M series) (for the XAE3 and GAE3 signals)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word path mm, inch, deg (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the relevant value during automatic tool compensation (T series) or automatic tool length measurement (M series).

NOTE 1 For the M series, when the setting of parameter No. 6252 or 6253 is 0, the setting of parameter No. 6251 is used. 2 Set a radius value regardless of whether diameter or radius programming is specified.
6280 Time constant for acceleration/deceleration after interpolation for the skip function for each axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis msec 0 to 512 This parameter sets a time constant for acceleration/deceleration after interpolation for the skip function for each axis. This parameter is valid when bit 3 (ASB) of parameter No. 6210 or bit 4 (ASL) of parameter No. 6210 is set to 1.
Feedrate for the skip function (G31)

6281

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) This parameter sets a feedrate for the skip function (G31). This parameter is valid when bit 1 (SFP) of parameter No. 6207 is set to 1.
- 323 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE For the multi-stage skip function and high-speed skip, see the description of parameter No. 6282 to No. 6285.
6282 6283 6284 6285 Feedrate for the skip function (G31, G31 P1) Feedrate for the skip function (G31 P2) Feedrate for the skip function (G31 P3) Feedrate for the skip function (G31 P4)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) Each of these parameters sets a feedrate for each skip function G code. These parameters are valid when bit 2 (SFN) of parameter No. 6207 is set to 1.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 TQO

6286

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 TQO The torque limit override function is: 0: Disabled. (Override of 100%) 1: Enabled.

NOTE Before the torque limit skip function can be used, this parameter must be set to 1.
6287 Positional deviation limit in torque limit skip

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit 0 to 327670 This parameter sets a positional deviation limit for each axis imposed when torque limit skip is specified. When the actual positional deviation exceeds the positional deviation limit, the alarm SV0004, EXCESS ERROR (G31) is issued and an immediate stop takes place.

4.39
6300

PARAMETERS OF EXTERNAL DATA INPUT/OUTPUT


#7 EEX #6 #5 #4 ESR #3 ESC #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path


- 324 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
ESC When a reset is input between the input of the external data input read signal ESTB and the execution of a search, the external program number search function: 0: Performs a search. 1: Does not perform a search. ESR The external program number search function is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. EEX PMC EXIN function 0: Conventional specifications 1: Extended specifications If you want to use external machine coordinate system shift which handles 10.000 or more shift unavailable with the PMC/EXIN command in the conventional specifications, set 1. When this function is used for a multi-path system, the setting for path 1 is used. For details of EXIN and how to change ladder software, refer to the PMC manuals.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 EED #2 NNO #1 EXM #0 EXA

#3

#4

#7

6301

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit machine group #0 EXA This bit selects an external alarm message specification. 0: A message number from 0 to 999 can be sent. When displaying an alarm number, the CNC prefixes the character string "EX" to the alarm number obtained by adding 1000 to the message number. 1: A message number from 0 to 4095 can be sent. The CNC prefixes the character string "EX" to a alarm number for display. EXM This bit selects an external operator message specification. 0: A message number from 0 to 999 can be sent. The message of a message number from 0 to 99 is displayed together with its number. The CNC adds 2000 to a number for distinction. A message number from 100 to 999 is not displayed on the screen, but only the corresponding message is displayed on the screen. 1: A message number from 0 to 4095 can be sent. The message of a message number from 0 to 99 is displayed together with its number. The CNC prefixes the character string "EX" to a message number for display. A message number from 100 to 4095 is not displayed on the screen, but only the corresponding message is displayed on the screen. NNO When operator messages are set by external data input, a new line operation between one message set with a number and another message set with a different number is: 0: Performed. 1: Not performed.

#1

#2

- 325 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#3

B-63950EN/04

EED To specify data for external tool compensation and external workpiece coordinate system shift, use: 0: Signals ED15 to ED0. (The value which can be specified for tool compensation and workpiece coordinate system shift is from 0 to 7999.) 1: Signals ED31 to ED0. (The value which can be specified for tool compensation and workpiece coordinate system shift is from 0 to 79999999.)
Setting for number addition to external operator messages

6310

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word machine group [Valid data range] 0 to 4096 This parameter sets the number of messages to which message numbers are to be prefixed in external operator message display. When 0 is set, the same operation as when 100 is set is performed. [Example] When 500 is set in this parameter, the messages of message numbers 0 to 499 are displayed together with their numbers on the screen. A message number of 500 and up is not displayed on the screen, but only the corresponding message is displayed on the screen.
3467 Selection of the target folder among initial folders

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 7, 11 to 20 This parameter selects a folder to be used for the external workpiece number search function, external program number search function, and macro executor program reference and write function among the following initial folders: 0: No specification 1: Root folder (//CNC_MEM) 2: System folder (//CNC_MEM/SYSTEM) 3: MTB-dedicated folder 1 (//CNC_MEM/MTB1) 4: MTB-dedicated folder 2 (//CNC_MEM/MTB2) 5: User folder (//CNC_MEM/USER) 6: Path folder (//CNC_MEM/USER/PATHn) (Note) (NOTE) PATHn: n is the selected path number (1 to the maximum number of paths). 7: Common program folder (//CNC_MEM/USER/LIBRARY) 8 to 10: Not specified. 11: Path 1 folder (//CNC_MEM/USER/PATH1) 12: Path 2 folder (//CNC_MEM/USER/PATH2) 13: Path 3 folder (//CNC_MEM/USER/PATH3) : 20: Path 10 folder (//CNC_MEM/USER/PATH10) When 0: No specification is selected, the following folder is used for each function: External program number search function
- 326 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
External workpiece number search function (Default foreground folder) Macro executor program reference and write function (Default background folder)

NOTE Any user-created folder cannot be specified. For example, assume that a user folder named PATH3 is created in //CNC_MEM/USER in a 2-path system. User-created folder //CNC_MEM/USER/PATH3 cannot be specified by specifying 13 in this parameter.

4.40
6350

PARAMETERS OF FINE TORQUE SENSING


#7 #6 #5 #4 ATL #3 #2 SPL #1 TQ2 #0 TQ1

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 #1 TQ1 TQ2 These parameters set the interval at which the fine torque sensing function stores data.
TQ2 0 0 1 1 TQ1 0 1 0 1 Store interval 8msec 16msec 32msec -

#2

SPL The function which saves the stored disturbance load torque data as sample data is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. ATL On the torque graph screen for fine torque sensing, the alarm threshold for detecting abnormal load: 0: Cannot be changed. 1: Can be changed. When this bit is set to 1, the detection level is reflected in parameter No. 2104 (servo) or 4341 (spindle) when the soft key [END] is pressed after the detection level is changed on the torque monitor screen. (The abnormal load detection function is optional.)

#4

NOTE The detection level on the torque monitor screen is not changed by changing parameter No. 2104 or 4341 by MDI input or using the relevant command.
6360 6361 6362 6363 Target axis 1 for fine torque sensing Target axis 2 for fine torque sensing Target axis 3 for fine torque sensing Target axis 4 for fine torque sensing

- 327 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] -16 to 48 This parameter sets the target axis for the fine torque sensing function. For a servo axis, specify a value between 1 and the number of controlled axes as the corresponding controlled-axis number. For a spindle axis, specify a value between -1 and -(number of controlled axes), inverting the sign of the controlled-axis number, as the corresponding controlled-axis number.

NOTE 1 When target axis for fine torque sensing N is set to 0, the setting of target axis N + 1 and subsequent target axis settings are ignored and assumed to be 0. 2 To set a servo axis as a target axis, the parameter for the target controlled axis (bit 0 of No. 2016) must be set to 1. When this parameter is set to 0, the input torque sensing command signal is not stored.

4.41
6400

PARAMETERS OF MANUAL HANDLE RETRACE (1 OF 2)


#7 MG4 #6 MGO #5 RVN #4 HMP #3 MC8 #2 MC5 #1 FWD #0 RPO

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 RPO With the manual handle retrace function, the rapid traverse rate is clamped, assuming that: 0: An override of 10% is used. 1: An override of 100% is used. FWD With the manual handle retrace function, program execution can be performed: 0: In both forward and backward directions. 1: In the forward direction only. Execution in the backward direction is not permitted. MC5 MC8 These parameters set the number of M code groups and the number of M codes per group. (See explanations of parameters Nos. 6411 to 6490.)
MC5 0 1 0 MC8 0 0 1 M code group setting Standard (20 groups of four) 16 groups of five 10 groups of eight

#1

#2 #3

When 16 groups of five are used, the meanings of parameters are changed as follows: Group A No. 6411(1) to No. 6415(5) Group B No. 6416(1) to No. 6420(5) : Group P No. 6486(1) to No. 6490(5) When 10 groups of eight are used, they are changed as follows: Group A No. 6411(1) to No. 6418(8) Group B No. 6419(1) to No. 6426(8) : Group J No. 6483(1) to No. 6490(8)
- 328 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
HMP When inversion or backward movement is inhibited in other paths: 0: Inversion or backward movement is not inhibited for the currently executed path. 1: Inversion or backward movement is inhibited also for the currently executed path. RVN When the manual handle retrace function is used, M codes other than grouped M codes: 0: Do not disable backward movement. 1: Disable backward movement. When this parameter is set to 1, M codes other than grouped M codes disable backward movement in general. Exceptionally, however, the following M codes allow backward movement: 1. Subprogram call based on M98/M99 2. Subprogram call based on an M code 3. Macro call based on an M code 4. Waiting M code 5. M0

#4

#5

#6

MGO When the manual handle retrace function is used, handle pulses during execution of a G code related to measurement are: 0: Valid. 1: Invalid. A speed with an override of 100% is used for execution at all times. MG4 In the manual handle retrace function, for blocks for which multi-step skip G04 is enabled (when the multi-step skip software option is used, and the settings of parameters Nos. 6202 to 6206 are valid): 0: Backward movement is not prohibited. 1: Backward movement is prohibited.
#7 #6 HST #5 #4 #3 #2 CHS #1 #0 ADC

#7

6401

STO

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 ADC If a move command and an auxiliary function (M/S/T/B code) are specified in the same block when the manual handle retrace function is used, the block: 0: Disables reverse movement. 1: Does not disable reverse movement.

NOTE To use this parameter, the optional function for the direction change movement in auxiliary function output block is required.
#2 CHS In manual handle retrace: 0: The status is displayed if the following conditions are all satisfied: (1) The manual handle retrace software option is used. (2) Bit 6 (HST) of parameter No. 6401, which specifies whether to enable or disable status display, is set to 1. (3) Check mode output signal MMMOD<Fn091.3> is set to 1. 1: The status is displayed if the following conditions are all satisfied: (1) The manual handle retrace software option is used. (2) Bit 6 (HST) of parameter No. 6401, which specifies whether to enable or disable status display, is set to 1.
- 329 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

(3) Cycle start lamp signal STL<Fn000.5> is set to 1. (4) Check mode input signal MMOD<Gn067.2> is set to 1. (5) Handle input signal MCHK<Gn067.3> is set to 1 in the check mode. #6 HST When the manual handle retrace function is used, the time display field on the status display line of the CNC screen: 0: Does not display status. 1: Displays status. STO In the manual handle retrace function, the timing for outputting an S code and T code during backward movement is: 0: Different from the timing during forward movement: 1: The same as during forward movement.
#7 6402 #6 #5 MWR #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

#7

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #5 MWR When the manual handle retrace function is used, for a handle operation placed in the wait state by a wait M code during backward movement: 0: Inversion is prohibited. 1: Inversion is permitted.
#7 6403 #6 #5 #4 HRE #3 HRD #2 HRC #1 HRB #0 HRA

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 HRA In rigid tapping and thread cutting, with the manual handle retrace function, program execution in the forward direction: 0: Cannot be performed. 1: Can be performed. HRB In PMC axis control, with the manual handle retrace, program execution in the forward direction: 0: Cannot be performed. 1: Can be performed. HRC During orientation operation according to G00 for a Cs contour control axis, with the manual handle retrace function, program execution in the backward direction: 0: Cannot be performed. 1: Can be performed. HRD In polygon machining with two spindles, with the manual handle retrace function, program execution in the backward direction: 0: Cannot be performed. 1: Can be performed. HRE In balanced cutting, with the manual handle retrace function, program execution in the backward direction: 0: Cannot be performed. 1: Can be performed.
- 330 -

#1

#2

#3

#4

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Override value (equivalence) for clamping the rapid traverse rate used with the manual handle retrace function

6405

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word path % 0 to 100 This parameter sets an override value (equivalence) for clamping the rapid traverse rate used with the manual handle retrace function. If a value greater than 100 is set in parameter No. 6405, the rapid traverse rate is clamped to an override of 100%. This function is invalid if 0 is set in parameter No. 6405. In this case, the setting of bit 0 (RPO) of parameter No. 6400 is used.
Travel distance per pulse generated from the manual pulse generator

6410

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word path % 0 to 100 Set the travel distance per pulse generated from the manual pulse generator in terms of the override value. The distance traveled by the machine when the manual handle is actually turned can be found by the following expression: [Specified speed] [Handle magnification] ([Setting of this parameter]/100) (8/60000) (mm or inch) [Example] When a specified feedrate is 30mm/min, the manual handle magnification is 100, and parameter No. 6410 is set to 1, the travel distance per pulse generated from the manual pulse generator is calculated as follows: [Travel distance per pulse]=30[mm/min] 100 (1/100) (8/60000)[min]= 0.004mm
6411 to 6414 6415 to 6418 6419 to 6422 6423 to 6426 6427 to 6430 6431 to 6434 M code of group A in manual handle retrace (1) to M code of group A in manual handle retrace (4) M code of group B in manual handle retrace (1) to M code of group B in manual handle retrace (4) M code of group C in manual handle retrace (1) to M code of group C in manual handle retrace (4) M code of group D in manual handle retrace (1) to M code of group D in manual handle retrace (4) M code of group E in manual handle retrace (1) to M code of group E in manual handle retrace (4) M code of group F in manual handle retrace (1) to M code of group F in manual handle retrace (4)

- 331 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
6435 to 6438 6439 to 6442 6443 to 6446 6447 to 6450 6451 to 6454 6455 to 6458 6459 to 6462 6463 to 6466 6467 to 6470 6471 to 6474 6475 to 6478 6479 to 6482 6483 to 6486 6487 to 6490 M code of group G in manual handle retrace (1) to M code of group G in manual handle retrace (4) M code of group H in manual handle retrace (1) to M code of group H in manual handle retrace (4) M code of group I in manual handle retrace (1) to M code of group I in manual handle retrace (4) M code of group J in manual handle retrace (1) to M code of group J in manual handle retrace (4) M code of group K in manual handle retrace (1) to M code of group K in manual handle retrace (4) M code of group L in manual handle retrace (1) to M code of group L in manual handle retrace (4) M code of group M in manual handle retrace (1) to M code of group M in manual handle retrace (4) M code of group N in manual handle retrace (1) to M code of group N in manual handle retrace (4) M code of group O in manual handle retrace (1) to M code of group O in manual handle retrace (4) M code of group P in manual handle retrace (1) to M code of group P in manual handle retrace (4) M code of group Q in manual handle retrace (1) to M code of group Q in manual handle retrace (4) M code of group R in manual handle retrace (1) to M code of group R in manual handle retrace (4) M code of group S in manual handle retrace (1) to M code of group S in manual handle retrace (4) M code of group T in manual handle retrace (1) to M code of group T in manual handle retrace (4)

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to 9999 Set a group of M codes output during backward movement.
- 332 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
For backward movement for an M code, the modal M code in the same group set by the parameter is output. The first M code in each group is set as the default. When the number of M codes in a group is 3 or less, set the parameter corresponding to an unused M code to 0. For backward movement for "M0", "M0" is output regardless of which M code is set for the parameter. 0 set in the parameter is ignored. For an M code which is not set in any group by any of the above parameters, the M code for forward movement is output. With these parameters, an M code in the same group can be output in backward movement only when the M code is the first M code in each block. When a block contains two or more M codes, the same M codes as output in forward movement are output as a second M code and up.

NOTE The above explanation of M code groups applies to the standard settings. The number of M codes in each group and the number of M code groups vary depending on the settings of bits 2 (MC5) and 3 (MC8) of parameter No. 6400.

4.42
6501

PARAMETERS OF GRAPHIC DISPLAY (1 OF 5)


#7 #6 #5 CSR #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #5 CSR On the PATH GRAPHIC (TOOL POSITION) screen, the shape of the cursor indicating the tool position is: 0: A square (). 1: An x ().
Specifying the graphic coordinate system

6510

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 8 (When the dynamic graphic display function is used, set a value from 0 to 7.) Specify the graphic coordinate system in tool path drawing.

- 333 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
For lathe systems:
Setting=0 Z Setting=1 X Setting=2 Setting=3 Z Z

B-63950EN/04

Z X

Setting=4 X

Setting=5

Setting=6

Setting=7

Setting=8

Z X Z

X X

Z X Z

For machining center systems:


Setting=0 (XY) Y Z Setting=1 (YZ) X Setting=2 (ZX)

X Setting=3 (XZ) Z

Y Setting=4 (XYZ) Z

Z Setting=5 (ZXY) Y

When the dynamic graphic display function is used, the relationship between the setting and the drawing coordinate system is as follows:

- 334 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Setting=0 (XY) Y Setting=1 (ZY) Z Z Setting=2 (YZ)

X Setting=3 (XZ) Z X

Y Setting=4 (ZX)

X Setting=5 (XYZ) Z

Z Setting=6 (YXZ) Z Setting=7 (YZX) X

4.43
6581 6582 6583 6584 6585 6586 6587 6588 6589 6590 6591 6592 6593 6594 6595

PARAMETERS OF SCREEN DISPLAY COLORS (1 OF 2)


RGB value of color palette 1 RGB value of color palette 2 RGB value of color palette 3 RGB value of color palette 4 RGB value of color palette 5 RGB value of color palette 6 RGB value of color palette 7 RGB value of color palette 8 RGB value of color palette 9 RGB value of color palette 10 RGB value of color palette 11 RGB value of color palette 12 RGB value of color palette 13 RGB value of color palette 14 RGB value of color palette 15

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word [Valid data range] 0 to 151515
- 335 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

Each of these parameters sets the RGB value of each color palette by specifying a 6-digit number as described below. rrggbb: 6-digit number (rr: red data, gg: green data, bb: blue data) The valid data range of each color is 0 to 15 (same as the tone levels on the color setting screen). When a number equal to or greater than 16 is specified, the specification of 15 is assumed. [Example] When the tone level of a color is: red:1 green:2, blue:3, set 10203 in the parameter.

4.44
6700

PARAMETERS OF RUN HOUR AND PARTS COUNT DISPLAY


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 PRT #0 PCM

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 PCM M code that counts the total number of machined parts and the number of machined parts 0: M02, or M30, or an M code specified by parameter No. 6710 1: Only M code specified by parameter No. 6710 PRT Upon reset, the required parts count arrival signal PRTSF <Fn062.7> is: 0: Set to 0. 1: Not set to 0.
M code that counts the number of machined parts

#1

6710

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to 999999999 The total number of machined parts and the number of machined parts are counted (+1) when the M code set is executed.

NOTE The setting of 0 is invalid (no count operation is performed with M00.) Moreover, M98, M99, M198 (external device subprogram calling), and M codes used for subprogram calling and macro calling cannot be set as M codes for count-up operation. (Even when such an M code is set, count-up operation is not performed, ignoring the M code.)
6711 Number of machined parts

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to 999999999 The number of machined parts is counted (+1) together with the total number of machined parts when the M02, M30, or a M code specified by parameter No. 6710 is executed.

- 336 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE The number of parts is not counted for M02, M30 when bit 0 (PCM) of parameter No. 6700 is set to 1.

6712

Total number of machined parts

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to 999999999 This parameter sets the total number of machined parts. The total number of machined parts is counted (+1) when M02, M30, or an M code specified by parameter No. 6710 is executed.

NOTE The number of parts is not counted for M02, M30, when bit 0 (PCM) of parameter No. 6700 is set to 1.
6713 Number of required parts

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to 999999999 This parameter sets the number of required machined parts. Required parts finish signal PRTSF <F0062.7> is output to PMC when the number of machined parts reaches the number of required parts. The number of parts is regarded as infinity when the number of required parts is zero. The PRTSF signal is then not output.
6750 Integrated value of power-on period

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word path min 0 to 999999999 This parameter displays the integrated value of power-on period.
Operation time (integrated value of time during automatic operation) 1

6751

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input 2-word path msec 0 to 59999 For details, see the description of parameter No. 6752.
Operation time (integrated value of time during automatic operation) 2

6752

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input 2-word path min 0 to 999999999 This parameter displays the integrated value of time during automatic operation (neither stop nor hold time included). The actual time accumulated during operation is the sum of this parameters Nos. 6751 and 6752.
- 337 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
6753 Integrated value of cutting time 1

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input 2-word path msec 0 to 59999 For details, see the description of parameter No. 6754.
Integrated value of cutting time 2

6754

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input 2-word path min 0 to 999999999 This parameter displays the integrated value of a cutting time that is performed in cutting feed such as linear interpolation (G01) and circular interpolation (G02 or G03). The actual time accumulated during cutting is the sum of this parameters Nos. 6753 and 6754.
Integrated value of general-purpose integrating meter drive signal (TMRON) ON time 1

6755

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input 2-word path msec 0 to 59999 For details, see the description of parameter No. 6756.
Integrated value of general-purpose integrating meter drive signal (TMRON) ON time 2

6756

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input 2-word path min 0 to 999999999 This parameter displays the integrated value of a general-purpose integrating meter start signal TMRON <Gn053.0> from PMC is on. The actual integrated time is the sum of this parameters Nos. 6755 and 6756.
Operation time (integrated value of one automatic operation time) 1

6757

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input 2-word path msec 0 to 59999 For details, see the description of parameter No. 6758.
Operation time (integrated value of one automatic operation time) 2

6758

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input 2-word path min 0 to 999999999 This parameter displays the one automatic operation drive time (neither stop nor hold state included). The actual time accumulated during operating is the sum of this parameters Nos. 6757 and 6758. The operation time is automatically preset to 0 during the power-on sequence and the cycle start from the reset state.
- 338 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

4.45
6801

PARAMETERS OF TOOL MANAGEMENT FUNCTIONS (1 OF 2)


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 LVF #1 #0

NOTE The use of this parameter varies depending on whether the tool management function or tool life management function is used.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #2 LVF When the life of a tool is counted in terms of time with the tool management function, the tool life count override signals *TLV0 to *TLV9 <Gn049.0 to Gn050.1> are: 0: Invalid. 1: Valid.
Tool life count restart M code

6811

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 127 (not including 01, 02, 30, 98, and 99) When 0 is set, this parameter is ignored. When an M code for tool life count restart is specified, the counting of the life of the tool attached at the spindle position is started. When the type for counting the number of use times is selected, the target of life counting is switched to the tool attached at the spindle position, and the life count is incremented by 1. When the type for counting time is selected, the target of life counting is switched to the tool attached at the spindle position, with no other operations performed. If the tool attached at the spindle position is not a tool under tool life management, no operation is performed.

NOTE The use of this parameter varies depending on whether the tool management function or tool life management function is used.

4.46
6800

PARAMETERS OF TOOL LIFE MANAGEMENT (1 OF 2)


#7 M6T #6 IGI #5 SNG #4 GRS #3 SIG #2 LTM #1 GS2 #0 GS1

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 GS1 #1 GS2 For the maximum number of groups set in parameter No. 6813, up to four tools can be registered per group. The combination of the number of registrable groups and the number of tools per group can be changed by setting GS1 and GS2.
- 339 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
GS2 0 0 1 1 GS1 0 1 0 1 Number of groups 1/8 of maximum number of groups (No. 6813) 1/4 of maximum number of groups (No. 6813) 1/2 of maximum number of groups (No. 6813) Maximum number of groups (No. 6813)

B-63950EN/04

Number of tools 32 16 8 4

NOTE After changing these parameters, set data again by using G10 L3 ;(registration after deletion of data of all groups).
#2 LTM The tool life count is specified by: 0: Count. 1: Duration.

NOTE After changing this parameter, set data again by using G10 L3 ;(registration after deletion of data of all groups).
#3 SIG When a tool is skipped by a signals TL01 to TL512 <Gn047.0 to Gn048.1>, the group number is: 0: Not input by the tool group number selection signals. 1: Input by the tool group number selection signals.

NOTE When this parameter is set to 0, a tool of the currently used group is skipped.
#4 GRS When the tool change reset signal TLRST <Gn048.7> is input: 0: If the life of the group specified by the tool group number selection signals TL01 to TL512 <Gn047.0 to Gn048.1> has expired, the execution data of the group is cleared. 1: The execution data of all registered groups is cleared. If this parameter is set to 1, the execution data of all registered groups is cleared also when the clear operation to clear execution data is performed on the tool life management list screen. SNG When the tool skip signal TLSKP <Gn048.5> is input while a tool not controlled by the tool life management function is being used: 0: A tool of the most recently used group or a specified group (bit 3 (SIG) of parameter No. 6800) is skipped. 1: The tool skip signal is ignored. IGI Tool back numbers are: 0: Not ignored. 1: Ignored. M6T A T code specified in the same block as M06 is: 0: Assumed to be a back number. 1: Assumed to be a command specifying the next tool group.

#5

#6

#7

- 340 -

B-63950EN/04 #7 6801 M6E M6E #6 #5 #4

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#3 EMD EMD #2 LVF LVF #1 TSM #0

NOTE The use of this parameter varies depending on whether the tool management function or tool life management function is used.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #1 TSM In the tool life management function, life counting is performed as follows when more than one offset is specified: 0: Counting is performed for each tool number. 1: Counting is performed for each tool. LVF When the life value is counted by duration in the tool management function or tool life management function, tool life count override signals *TLV0 to *TLV9 <Gn049.0 to Gn050.1> are: 0: Not used. 1: Used. EMD In the tool life management function, the mark "*" indicating that the life has expired is displayed when: 0: The next tool is used. 1: The life has just expired.

#2

#3

NOTE If this parameter is set to 0, the "@" mark (indicating that the tool is in use) is kept displayed unless the next tool whose life has not expired is used. If this parameter is set to 1, marks are displayed in different ways depending on the life count type. If the life count type is the duration specification type, the "*" mark (indicating that the life has expired) appears when the life has expired. If the life count type is the count specification type, one count is not assumed until the end of the program (M02, M30, and so on). Therefore, even when the life value and the tool life counter value match, the "*" mark (life has expired) does not appear. The "*" mark (life has expired) appears when the tool is used again by a tool group command (T code) or tool change command (M06) issued after the CNC is reset.
#7 M6E When a T code is specified in the same block as M06: 0: The T code is treated as a back number or the group number to be selected next. Which number is assumed depends on the setting of bit 7 (M6T) of parameter No. 6800. 1: Life counting for the tool group starts immediately.
#7 6802 RMT #6 TSK #5 TGN #4 ARL #3 GRP #2 E17 #1 TCO #0 T99

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path


- 341 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#0

B-63950EN/04

T99 When M99 of the main program is executed, and there is a the life was expired tool group: 0: The tool change signal TLCH <Fn064.0> is not output. 1: TLCH is output, and the automatic operation becomes a stopped state.. If the life count is specified by use count and this parameter 1, TLCH is output and the automatic operation becomes a stopped state if the life of at least one tool group has expired when the M99 command is specified. If the life count type is the duration specification type, the automatic operation becomes a stopped state if the life of at least one tool group has expired when the M99 command is specified.

If the life count is specified by use count, after the M99 command is specified, a tool group command (T code) selects, from a specified group, a tool whose life has not expired, and the next tool change command (M06) increments the tool life counter by one.
T

If the life count is specified by use count, hen a tool group command (T code) is specified after the M99 command is specified, a tool whose life has not expired is selected from a specified group, and the tool life counter is incremented by one. When the tool change type is the ATC type (bit 3 (TCT) of parameter No. 5040 = 1), the same specifications as for the M series apply. #1 TCO #2 E17 Specifies whether to allow the FOCAS2 or PMC window function to write tool information of a group being used or a group to be used next during automatic operation (the automatic operation signal OP <Fn000.7> is set to 1).
Bit 1 (TCO) of parameter No. 6802 1 Bit 2 (E17) of 0 parameter No. 6802 1 0

Condition

During automatic operation

Group being used or to be used next

Tool being used Tool not being used Group neither being used nor to be used next Not during automatic operation

: : :

Tool information can be written from FOCAS2 and PMC window. Tool information cannot be written from FOCAS2 and PMC window. When an attempt is made to write tool information from PMC window, completion code 13 (REJECT ALARM) is returned. Tool information cannot be cleared.

- 342 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE When tool information of a tool being used (marked with "@") in the group being used or to be used next or tool information of the most recently used tool (marked with "@") in a group that is neither the group being used nor the group to be used next is cleared, the life counter is reset to 0. It is possible to modify tool information of a tool in the group to be used next. However, because tool selection is already completed, the selected tool does not change even when the tool information is modified. This parameter has no influence on modifications to tool information by edit operations from the tool life management screen.

#3

GRP Management data of tool life arrival notice signal TLCHB <Fn064.3> is: 0: Managed using the remaining life value set in parameter No. 6844 and 6845. 1: Managed using the remaining life value set in tool life management data.

NOTE When the tool life arrival notice signal function is used, bit 4 (LFB) of parameter No. 6805 must be set to 1 to enable the tool life management B function.
#4 ARL Tool life arrival notice signal TLCHB <Fn064.3> of tool life management is: 0: Output for each tool. 1: Output for the last tool of a group. This parameter is valid only when bit 3 (GRP) of parameter No. 6802 is set to 1. TGN In the tool life management function, the optional group number function is: 0: Not used. 1: Used.

#5

NOTE When the optional group number function is used, bit 4 (LFB) of parameter No. 6805 must be set to 1 to enable the tool life management B function. In lathe systems, the optional group number function can be used if the tool change type is the ATC type (bit 3 (TCT) of parameter No. 5040 = 1).
#6 TSK If the count type in tool life management is the duration type, then when the last tool of a group is skipped by a signal: 0: The count value for the last tool equals the life value. 1: The count value for the last tool remains unchanged.

- 343 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7

B-63950EN/04

RMT Tool life arrival notice signal TLCHB <Fn064.3> is turned 1 and 0 as follows: 0: The signal is turned 1 if the remaining life value (the life value minus the life counter value) is smaller than or equal to the remaining life setting. The signal is turned 0 if the remaining life value (the life value minus the life counter value) is greater than the remaining life setting. 1: The signal is turned 1 if the remaining life value (the life value minus the life counter value) is equal to the remaining life setting. The signal is turned 0 if the remaining life value (the life value minus the life counter value) is not equal to the remaining life setting.

NOTE When using the life count override feature, set bit 7 (RMT) of parameter No. 6802 to 0. When the life count is specified by duration, the unit used for determining the result of comparison between the remaining life and the remaining life setting varies depending on the life count interval (bit 0 (FCO) of parameter No. 6805). If the life is counted every second, the comparison is made in units of 1 minute; if the life is counted every 0.1 second, the comparison is made in units of 0.1 minute.
#7 6803 CTB #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #7 CTB Whether to turn the tool life arrival notice signal TLCHB <Fn064.3> of tool life management off is determined when life counting starts. An additional turn-off condition is: 0: Not added. 1: Added. The tool life arrival notice signal is turned off when one of the following operations is performed for the currently used group: Clears the execution data on the tool life management list screen. Deletes all tool group data at a time, adds a tool number, or deletes tool data on the tool life management edit screen. Clears the execution data by the tool change reset signal TLRST <Gn048.7>. Registers, changes, or deletes all tool life management group data by the G10 command. Executes the FOCAS2 cnc_clrcntinfo function (which clears the tool life counter or tool information). Replaces a tool with a tool of which life is not managed by the M06 command.

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#7 6804 #6 LFI #5 #4 #3 #2 ETE #1 TCI #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path


- 344 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
TCI During automatic operation (the automatic operation signal OP<Fn000.7> is 1), editing of tool life data is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.

#1

NOTE When this parameter is set to 1, tool life data can be edited even during automatic operation (the OP is 1). If the target group for editing is the group being used or the group to be used next, however, only presetting of the life counter is permitted, and other data cannot be modified.
#2 ETE In the tool life management screen, the mark of the tool at the life was expired of the final tool in the group : 0: depends on setting bit 3 (EMD) of parameter No. 6801. 1: is "*" mark. If bit 2 (ETE) of parameter No. 6804 is set to 1, when the life counter of the final tool in the group becomes equal to the life value, display mark "*" in the final tool of the tool life management screen. When tool change signal TLCH <Fn064.0> is 1, the state of the life was expired of the tool can be read by reading tool information on the final tool in FOCAS2 or the PMC window. LFI In tool life management, counting of the life of a selected tool is: 0: Enabled. 1: Enabled or disabled according to the status of tool life counting disable signal LFCIV <Gn048.2>.
#7 6805 TAD #6 TRU #5 TRS #4 LFB #3 #2 #1 FGL #0 FCO

#6

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 FCO If the life count type is the duration specification type, the life is counted as follows: 0: Every second. 1: Every 0.1 second. According to the setting of this parameter, the increment system of life values and tool life counter values displayed on the tool life management screen is set as follows:
Parameter FCO Increment system for display and setting of life values and life counter values 0 1-minute increments 1 0.1-minute increments

NOTE After changing the setting of this parameter, set data again by using G10L3;(registration after deletion of data of all groups).
#1 FGL If the life count type is the duration specification type, life data registered by G10 is: 0: In minute increments. 1: In 0.1-second increments.

- 345 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#4

B-63950EN/04

LFB The tool life management B function is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. When the tool life management B function is enabled, the following functions can be used: <1> Tool life value extension (count specification: 99999999 times, duration specification: 100000 minutes) <2> Optional group number function <3> Tool life arrival notice function In lathe systems, if the tool change type is the ATC type (bit 3 (TCT) of parameter No. 5040 = 1), the optional group number function can be used. TRS Tool change reset signal TLRST <Gn048.7> is valid when reset signal RST <Fn001.1> is not 1 and: 0: The reset state (automatic operation signal OP is 0) is observed. 1: The reset state (automatic operation signal OP <Fn000.7> is 0), automatic operation stop state (cycle start lamp signal STL <Fn000.5> and feed hold lamp signal SPL <Fn000.4> are 0 and OP is 1), or the automatic operation pause state (STL is 0 and SPL is 1) is observed. The TLRST signal, however, is invalid when the automatic operation stop state, automatic operation pause state, and automatic operation start state (STL is 1) is observed during execution of a data setting command (G10L3). TRU When the life count type is the duration specification type, and the life is counted every second (bit 0 (FCO) of parameter No. 6805 is set to 0): 0: Cutting time less than one second is discarded and is not counted. 1: Cutting time less than one second is rounded up and is counted as one second.

#5

#6

NOTE If the life is counted every 0.1 second (bit 0 (FCO) of parameter No. 6805 is set to 1), cutting time less than 0.1 second is always rounded up and is counted as 0.1 second.
#7 TAD With tool change type D (bit 7 (M6E) of parameter No. 6801 is set to 1), when a block specifying M06 contains no T command: 0: An alarm PS0153, T-CODE NOT FOUND is issued. 1: No alarm is issued.
Tool life management ignore number

6810

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to 99999999 This parameter sets the tool life management ignore number. When the value specified in a T code exceeds the value set in this parameter, the value obtained by subtracting the parameter-set value from the T code value is assumed to be the tool group number for tool life management.
6811 Tool life count restart M code

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 127 (except 01, 02, 30, 98, and 99) When 0 is specified, it is ignored.
- 346 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
When the life is specified by count, the tool change signal TLCH <Fn064.0> is output if the life of at least one tool group has expired when the tool life count restart M code is issued. The T code (tool life management group command) specified after the tool life count restart M code selects a tool whose life has not expired from a specified group, and the next M06 command increments the tool life counter by one. When the life is specified by duration, specifying the tool life count restart M code causes nothing. When 0 is set in this parameter, the tool life count restart M code is invalid. When the data of M code exceeds 127 values, set 0 in parameter No. 6811, and set the value of M code in parameter No. 13221. The data range of parameter No. 13221 is from 0 to 255.

NOTE The use of this parameter varies depending on whether the tool management function or tool life management function is used.
6813 Maximum number of groups in tool life management

NOTE After this parameter has been set, the power must be turned off then back on for the setting to become effective.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input Word path Group 0, 8, 16 to 256,1024 (when the additional tool life management group option is added) This parameter sets the maximum number of groups to be used for each path. As the maximum number of groups, set a multiple of eight. When the tool life management function is not used, 0 must be set. Set this parameter so that the total number of groups in all paths does not exceed the total number of groups in the entire system (256 groups). When the additional tool life management group option is added, set this parameter so that the total number of groups in all paths does not exceed 1024.

NOTE When the power is turned on, all tool life management file data is initialized. So, tool life management data must be set for all paths that use tool life management.
6844 Remaining tool life (use count)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to 9999 This parameter sets a remaining tool life (use count) used to output the tool life notice signal TLCHB <Fn064.3> when the tool life is specified by use count. If a value greater than the tool life value or 0 is set in this parameter, the tool life notice signal is not output.
6845 Remaining tool life (use duration)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word path min Not greater than the tool life value
- 347 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

This parameter sets the remaining tool life (use duration) used to output the tool life notice signal TLCHB <Fn064.3> when the tool life is specified by use duration. If a value greater than the tool life value or 0 is specified in this parameter, the tool life notice signal is not output.

NOTE When the life is counted every 0.1 second (bit 0 (FCO) of parameter No. 6805 = 1), the parameter value is in 0.1-minute increments.
6846

Remaining tool number in a group

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 127 This parameter sets the remaining tool number in a group. When the remaining tool number in the group selected by the T code is smaller than or equal to the value set in this parameter, the remaining tool number notice signal TLAL <Fn154.0> is output. When this parameter is set to 0, the remaining tool number notice signal is not output.

4.47
6901

PARAMETERS OF POSITION SWITCH FUNCTIONS


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 PSA #1 EPW #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #1 EPW The number of position switches is: 0: Not extended. 1: Extended. PSA In determination of a position switch function operation range, a servo delay amount (positional deviation) and a delay amount in acceleration/deceleration control are: 0: Not considered. 1: Considered.
Controlled axis for which the 1st position switch function is performed (PSWA01) Controlled axis for which the 2nd position switch function is performed (PSWA02) : Controlled axis for which the 16th position switch function is performed (PSWA16)

#2

6910 6911 : 6925

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to Number of controlled axes Set the controlled axis number corresponding to one of the first to sixteenth position switch functions. When the machine coordinate of the corresponding axis is within a parameter-set range, the corresponding position switch signals PSW01 to PSW16 <Fn070 and Fn071> are output to the PMC.

- 348 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE The setting of 0 means that the position switch function is not used.

6930 6931 : 6945

Maximum value of the operating range of the 1st position switch (PSW101) Maximum value of the operating range of the 2nd position switch (PSW102) : Maximum value of the operating range of the 16th position switch (PSW116)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch, degree (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Set the maximum value of the operating range of the first to sixteenth position switches.

NOTE 1 For a diameter-specified axis, use radius values to specify the parameters used to set the maximum and minimum values of an operating range. 2 The position switch function is enabled upon completion of reference position return.
6950 6951 : 6965 Minimum value of the operating range of the 1st position switch (PSW201) Minimum value of the operating range of the 2nd position switch (PSW202) : Minimum value of the operating range of the 16th position switch (PSW216)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch, degree (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Set the minimum value of the operating range of the first to sixteenth position switches.

NOTE 1 For a diameter-specified axis, use radius values to specify the parameters used to set the maximum and minimum values of an operating range. 2 The position switch function is enabled upon completion of reference position return.

- 349 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

4.48
7001

PARAMETERS OF MANUAL OPERATION AND AUTOMATIC OPERATION


#7 MFM #6 JEX #5 #4 JSN #3 #2 JST #1 ABS #0 MIT

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 MIT Manual intervention and return function is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. ABS For the move command after manual intervention in the manual absolute on state: 0: Different paths are used in the absolute (G90) and incremental (G91) modes. 1: The same path (path in the absolute mode) is used in the absolute (G90) and incremental (G91) modes. JST In manual numerical specification, the cycle start lamp signal STL <Fn000.5> is: 0: Not output. 1: Output. JSN When an S code is specified with the manual numerical specification function, the modal display of the S code is: 0: Not updated. 1: Updated. JEX The number of axes controlled simultaneously in jog feed, manual rapid traverse, and manual reference position return is: 0: Set by bit 0 (JAX) of parameter No. 1002. 1: The maximum number of simultaneously controlled axes. MFM For the manual interpolation function, modifying a value specified with a command during jog feed in the guidance direction (approach direction): 0: Immediately starts moving according to the new value. 1: Stops moving.
#7 7002 #6 #5 #4 #3 JBF #2 JTF #1 JSF #0 JMF

#1

#2

#4

#6

#7

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 JMF In manual numerical specification, M function specification is: 0: Allowed. 1: Not allowed. JSF In manual numerical specification, S function specification is: 0: Allowed. 1: Not allowed. JTF In manual numerical specification, T function specification is: 0: Allowed. 1: Not allowed.
- 350 -

#1

#2

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
JBF In manual numerical specification, B function specification is: 0: Allowed. 1: Not allowed.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 JMVx

#3

7010

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 JMVx In manual numerical specification, axis movement specification is: 0: Allowed. 1: Not allowed.
#7 7040 #6 #5 #4 #3 TRC #2 RPS #1 TRS #0 TRI

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 TRI The G10.6 command for tool retract and return is: 0: Assumed to be an absolute or incremental programming according to the absolute or incremental programming mode. 1: Always assumed to be an incremental programming. TRS After the completion of repositioning in tool retract and return: 0: Automatic operation is restarted. 1: Operation stops when the single block switch is on. When a cycle start is executed again, automatic operation is started. RPS When the tool retract signal TRESC <Gn059.0> is set to 1 after G10.6 is specified alone: 0: The tool is not retracted. 1: The tool is retracted with the value set for parameter No. 7041 or 11261 used as the incremental retraction distance. TRC When automatic operation is restarted after the tool retract and return is executed during the execution of a drilling canned cycle: 0: Machining of the same cycle is performed again (the same drilling is performed). 1: Machining of the next drilling cycle is performed (the next drilling is performed).
Retraction distance in tool retract and return

#1

#2

#3

7041

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real axis mm, inch, deg (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the retraction distance used when G10.6 is specified alone for the tool retract and return. The tool is retracted by the distance set for this parameter in the incremental mode. This data is valid only when bit 2 (RPS) of parameter No. 7040 is set to 1. During tool center point control and workpiece setting error compensation, however, this parameter is valid if parameter No. 11261 is set to 0.
- 351 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 7055 #6 #5 #4 #3 BCG #2 #1

B-63950EN/04

#0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #3 BCG The pre-interpolation bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration time constant change function is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
Acceleration/deceleration reference speed for the time constant change function of bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration before interpolation

7066

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real path mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) This parameter is used when the time constant change function of bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration before interpolation is used.

4.49
7100

PARAMETERS OF MANUAL HANDLE (1 OF 2)


#7 #6 #5 MPX #4 #3 HCL #2 #1 THD #0 JHD

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 JHD Manual handle feed in JOG feed mode or incremental feed in the manual handle feed is: 0: Invalid. 1: Valid. THD In the TEACH IN JOG mode, the manual pulse generator is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. HCL The clearing of handle interruption amount display by soft key [CAN] operation is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. MPX In Manual handle feed mode: 0 : Manual handle feed amount selection signals MP1 and MP2 <Gn019.4 and Gn019.5> for the 1st manual pulse generator are used as signals common to all manual pulse generators. 1 : Manual handle feed amount selection signals differ depending on the manual pulse generator as follow: 1st. Manual Pulse Generator : MP1, MP2 <Gn019.4, Gn019.5> 2nd. Manual Pulse Generator : MP21, MP22 <Gn087.0, Gn087.1> 3rd. Manual Pulse Generator : MP31, MP32 <Gn087.3, Gn087.4> 4th. Manual Pulse Generator : MP41, MP42 <Gn087.6, Gn087.7>
- 352 -

#1

#3

#5

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
5th. Manual Pulse Generator : MP51, MP52 <Gn380.0, Gn380.1>
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 HNAx #0 HNGx

7102

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 HNGx Axis movement direction for rotation direction of manual pulse generator 0: Same in direction 1: Reverse in direction HNAx When manual handle feed direction inversion signal HDN <Gn0347.1> is set to 1, the direction of movement is set for each axis with respect to the rotation direction of the manual pulse generator. 0: The axis movement direction is the same as the direction in which the manual pulse generator rotates. 1: The axis movement direction is opposite to the direction in which the manual pulse generator rotates. When the rotation direction is reversed by manual handle feed direction inversion signal HDN <Gn0347.1>, the rotation axis direction obtained by the setting of bit 0 (HNGx) of parameter No. 7102 is reversed.
#7 7103 #6 #5 #4 #3 HIT #2 HNT #1 RTH #0

#1

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #1 RTH By a reset or emergency stop, the amount of manual handle interruption is: 0: Not canceled. 1: Canceled. HNT When compared with the travel distance magnification selected by the manual handle feed travel distance selection signals (incremental feed signals) (MP1, MP2 <Gn019.4, Gn019.5>), the travel distance magnification for incremental feed/manual handle feed is: 0: Same. 1: 10 times greater. HIT When compared with the travel distance magnification selected by the manual handle feed travel distance selection signals (incremental feed signals (MP1, MP2 <Gn019.4, Gn019.5>), the travel distance magnification for manual handle interrupt is: 0: Same. 1: 10 times greater.
#7 7105 #6 BHS #5 LBH #4 #3 #2 #1 HDX #0

#2

#3

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit

- 353 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#1 HDX Manual handle for I/O Link connection is: 0: Automatically set. 1: Manually set.

NOTE In manual setting, parameters Nos. 12300 to 12304 and 12340 to 12344 must be set by manual to connect Manual Pulse Generator with I/O Link.
#5 LBH Manual handle feed for the I/O Link using the I/O link manual pulse generator is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. BHS When the I/O Link is operated using the manual pulse generator on the host, whether to perform manual handle feed is: 0: Not automatically determined. (Whether to perform manual handle feed is set using parameters Nos. 12330 to 12337.) 1: Automatically performed.
#7 7106 #6 #5 HSR #4 MRO #3 MRI #2 #1 #0

#6

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #3 MRI Internal relay (the R signal) of PMC that uses it with input data in manual linear/circular interpolation: 0: R960 to R979 are used. 1: The address that bound it with the parameter No. 13541 is used. MRO Internal relay (the R signal) of PMC that uses it with output data in manual linear/circular interpolation: 0: R980 to R989 are used. 1: The address that bound it with the parameter No. 13542 is used HSR The direction of manual pulse generator rotation in the handle-synchronous feed function is: 0: effective in both. 1: effective in one direction. The effective direction is selected by selecting direction of manual handle rotation signal HDSR <Gn193.3>.
Manual handle feed magnification m

#4

#5

7113

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 1 to 2000 This parameter sets the magnification m when manual handle feed movement selection signals MP1 <Gn019.4> and MP2 <Gn019.5> are set to 0 and 1.

- 354 -

B-63950EN/04 7114

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Manual handle feed magnification n

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 1 to 2000 This parameter sets the magnification when manual handle feed movement selection signals MP1 <Gn019.4> and MP2 <Gn019.5> are set to 1.
7117 Allowable number of pulses that can be accumulated during manual handle feed

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word path Pulse 0 to 999999999 This parameter sets the number of pulses from the manual pulse generator that exceed the rapid traverse rate and can be accumulated without being discarded if manual handle feed faster than the rapid traverse rate is specified. The amount of pulses exceeding the rapid traverse rate can be saved by CNC as B. And amount of pulses B will be exported as pulses C.

Aamount of pulses corresponds to value of Rapid Traverse Rate.

Bamount of pulses accumulated in CNC. Camount of pulses the same as B.

Rapid Traverse Rate

C t

Amount of pulses exported by CNC in Manual Handle Feed

Amount of pulses B is calculated in 2 cases as following: In case of 1) Parameter No.7117 = 0 The feedrate is clamped at the Rapid Traverse Rate and generated pulses exceeding the Rapid Traverse Rate are ignored (B=0) In case of 2) Parameter No.7117 > 0 The feedrate is clamped as the Rapid Traverse Rate, but the pulses exceeding the Rapid Traverse Rate is not ignored. Amount of pulses accumulated in CNC is calculated as following. (Although stopping the rotation of manual pulse generator, if there is pulses accumulated in CNC, it will be exported and the tool will move as long as amount of it.) Magnification set by manual handle feed amount selection signals MP1MP2 <Gn019.4, Gn019.5> is m, value of parameter No.7117 is n. n < m: Clamping is set performed at value of parameter No.7117.
- 355 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

n m: Amount A+B, showed in figure, whichs value is multiple of m and small than n. As a result, clamping is performed as an integral multiple of the selected magnification.
A B
n A: amount of pulses the same as Rapid Traverse Rate. B: amount of pulses saved in CNC. k : integer number

m A+B=km
Pulses over (km) will be ignored

Amount of pulses exceeding the Rapid Traverse Rate (n m)

NOTE Due to change of mode, clamping can be performed not as an integral multiple of the selected magnification. The distance the tool moves may not match the graduations on the manual pulse generator.
7131 7132 7133 7134 7135 7136 7137 7138 Manual handle feed magnification m2 / 2nd. manual pulse generator Manual handle feed magnification n2 / 2nd. manual pulse generator Manual handle feed magnification m3 / 3rd. manual pulse generator Manual handle feed magnification n3 / 3rd. manual pulse generator Manual handle feed magnification m4 / 4th. manual pulse generator Manual handle feed magnification n4 / 4th. manual pulse generator Manual handle feed magnification m5 / 5th. manual pulse generator Manual handle feed magnification n5 / 5th. manual pulse generator

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 1 to 2000 The mx is selected when manual handle feed amount selection signals MPx1 = 0, MPx2 = 1. The nx is selected when manual handle feed amount selection signalsMPx1 =1, MPx2 = 1.
7160 Approach handle clamp feedrate

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to standard parameter setting table (C) Approach handle clamp feedrate is set.
Guidance handle clamp feedrate

7161

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Real path [Unit of data] mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit)
- 356 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Min. unit of data] Depend on the increment system of the reference axis [Valid data range] Refer to standard parameter setting table (C) Guidance handle clamp feedrate is set.

4.50
7180

PARAMETERS OF REFERENCE POSITION WITH MECHANICAL STOPPER


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 SZE #1 SFS #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #1 SFS Reference position setting with mechanical stopper in axis synchronous control is: 0: Disabled (conventional specifications). 1: Enabled. SZE When reference position setting with mechanical stopper is used in axis synchronous control, the limit of the difference between the positional deviation of the master axis and that of the slave axis (parameter No. 8323) is: 0: Checked. 1: Not checked.
First withdrawal distance in reference position setting with mechanical stopper Second withdrawal distance in reference position setting with mechanical stopper

#2

7181 7182

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch, degree (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the distance, by which an axis is withdrawn after the axis butts against the mechanical stopper in each cycle operation, (the distance from the mechanical stopper to the withdrawal point).

NOTE Set the same direction as that set in bit 5 (ZMIx) of parameter No. 1006. Cycle operation cannot be started if the opposite direction is set.
7183 7184 First butting feedrate in reference position setting with mechanical stopper Second butting feedrate in reference position setting with mechanical stopper or butting feedrate in reference position setting with mechanical stopper by grid method Withdrawal feedrate (common to the first and second butting operations) in reference position setting with mechanical stopper

7185

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis
- 357 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

[Valid data range] Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) This parameter sets a feedrate used to butt against the stopper along an axis in each cycle.
7186 Torque limit value in reference position setting with mechanical stopper

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte axis [Valid data range] 0 to 100 This parameter sets a torque limit value. A value from 0 to 100 corresponds to 0% to 39%. The torque limit value is obtained by multiplying the setting by 1/255. If more than 39% is to be set, use parameter No. 7187.

NOTE When 0 is set in this parameter, 100% is assumed.


7187 Torque limit value in reference position setting with mechanical stopper or grid-type reference position return with mechanical stopper

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis [Valid data range] 0 to 255 This parameter sets a torque limit value. A value from 0 to 255 corresponds to 0% to 100%. If this parameter is set up in reference position setting with mechanical stopper, parameter No. 7186 is ignored. If this parameter is set to 0, the setting of parameter No. 7186 is valid. However, in case of reference position setting with mechanical stopper by grid method, only this parameter is valid. If this parameter is set to 0, 100% of the rated torque is assumed even if parameter No.7186 is set up.
#7 7188 RNWx #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 GRSx

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 GRSx Reference point setting with mechanical stopper by grid method is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed. RNWx During grid-type reference position return with mechanical stopper, until the sign of servo position deviation is inverted, the grid is 0: Not ignored. 1: Ignored.

#7

4.51
7200

PARAMETERS OF SOFTWARE OPERATOR'S PANEL


#7 #6 OP7 #5 OP6 #4 OP5 #3 OP4 #2 OP3 #1 OP2 #0 OP1

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path


- 358 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.

#0

OP1 Mode selection on software operator's panel 0: Not performed 1: Performed OP2 JOG feed axis select and manual rapid traverse select on software operator's panel 0: Not performed 1: Performed OP3 Manual pulse generator's axis select and manual pulse generator's magnification select on software operator's panel 0: Not performed 1: Performed OP4 JOG feedrate override select, feedrate override select, and rapid traverse override select on software operator's panel 0: Not performed 1: Performed OP5 Optional block skip select, single block select, machine lock select, and dry run select on software operator's panel 0: Not performed 1: Performed OP6 Protect key on software operator's panel 0: Not performed 1: Performed OP7 Feed hold on software operator's panel 0: Not performed 1: Performed
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 JPC

#1

#2

#3

#4

#5

#6

7201

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 JPC For the name of a general-purpose switch function on the software operator's panel, the use of full-size characters is: 0: Not allowed. 1: Allowed.
Jog-movement axis and its direction on software operator's panel Jog-movement axis and its direction on software operator's panel Jog-movement axis and its direction on software operator's panel Jog-movement axis and its direction on software operator's panel Jog-movement axis and its direction on software operator's panel

7210 7211 7212 7213 7214

- 359 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
7215 7216 7217 Jog-movement axis and its direction on software operator's panel Jog-movement axis and its direction on software operator's panel Jog-movement axis and its direction on software operator's panel

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 8 On software operator's panel, set a feed axis corresponding to an arrow key on the MDI panel when jog feed is performed.
Arrow keys on MDI panel Setting value 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Feed axis and direction Not moved First axis, positive direction First axis, negative direction Second axis, positive direction Second axis, negative direction Third axis, positive direction Third axis, negative direction Fourth axis, positive direction Fourth axis, negative direction

[Example] Under X, Y, and Z axis configuration, to set arrow keys to feed the axes in the direction specified as follows, set the parameters to the values given below. <8> to the positive direction of the Z axis, <2> to the negative direction of the Z axis, <6> to the positive direction of the X axis <4> to the negative direction of the X axis, <1 > to the positive direction of the Y axis, <9 > to the negative direction of the Y axis Parameter No.7210 = 5 (Z axis, positive direction) Parameter No.7211 = 6 (Z axis, negative direction) Parameter No.7212 = 1 (X axis, positive direction) Parameter No.7213 = 2 (X axis, negative direction) Parameter No.7214 = 3 (Y axis, positive direction) Parameter No.7215 = 4 (Y axis, negative direction) Parameter No.7216 = 0 (Not used) Parameter No.7217 = 0 (Not used)
7220 to 7283 7284 to 7299 7352 to 7399 Name of general-purpose switch 1 on software operator's panel (first character) to Name of general-purpose switch 8 on software operator's panel (eighth character) Name of general-purpose switch 9 on software operator's panel (first character) to Name of general-purpose switch 10 on software operator's panel (eighth character) Name of general-purpose switch 11 on software operator's panel (first character) to Name of general-purpose switch 16 on software operator's panel (eighth character)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] -128 to 127

- 360 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Each of these parameters sets the name of a general-purpose switch on the software operator's panel with character codes indicated in the character-code correspondence table. A switch name consists of up to eight characters. Parameters Nos. 7220 to 7227 : Name of general-purpose switch 1 Parameters Nos. 7228 to 7235 : Name of general-purpose switch 2 Parameters Nos. 7236 to 7243 : Name of general-purpose switch 3 Parameters Nos. 7244 to 7251 : Name of general-purpose switch 4 Parameters Nos. 7252 to 7259 : Name of general-purpose switch 5 Parameters Nos. 7260 to 7267 : Name of general-purpose switch 6 Parameters Nos. 7268 to 7275 : Name of general-purpose switch 7 Parameters Nos. 7276 to 7283 : Name of general-purpose switch 8 Parameters Nos. 7284 to 7291 : Name of general-purpose switch 9 Parameters Nos. 7292 to 7299 : Name of general-purpose switch 10 Parameters Nos. 7352 to 7359 : Name of general-purpose switch 11 Parameters Nos. 7360 to 7367 : Name of general-purpose switch 12 Parameters Nos. 7368 to 7375 : Name of general-purpose switch 13 Parameters Nos. 7376 to 7383 : Name of general-purpose switch 14 Parameters Nos. 7384 to 7391 : Name of general-purpose switch 15 Parameters Nos. 7392 to 7399 : Name of general-purpose switch 16
Character code list Character Code Q R S T U V W X Y Z 0 1 2 3 4 5 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 48 49 50 51 52 53

Character A B C D E F G H I J K L M N O P

Code 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80

Character 6 7 8 9 ! # $ % & ( ) * +

Code 54 55 56 57 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43

4.52
7300

PARAMETERS OF PROGRAM RESTART (1 OF 2)


#7 MOU #6 MOA #5 CCS #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #5 CCS When the Cs contour control axis is used in the spindle mode or when the origin of the Cs contour control axis is not established, program restart is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.

- 361 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#6

B-63950EN/04

MOA In program restart operation, before movement to a machining restart point: 0: The last M, S, T, and B codes are output. 1: All M codes and the last S, T, and B codes are output. This parameter is enabled when the bit 7 (MOU) of parameter No.7300 is set to 1. MOU In program restart operation, before movement to a machining restart point after restart block search: 0: The M, S, T, and B codes are not output. 1: The last M, S, T, and B codes are output.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 3DD #0 ROF

#7

7301

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 ROF When the coordinates for restarting are displayed on the program restart screen: 0: Tool length compensation (M series), tool position compensation (T series), cutter compensation (M series), and tool-nose radius compensation (T series) are considered. 1: Whether these compensation values are considered depends on the settings of bit 6 (DAL) of parameter No. 3104, bit 7 (DAC) of parameter No. 3104, and bit 1 (DAP) of parameter No. 3129 (parameters for specifying whether to consider each compensation value). 3DD In program restart operation, when the restart block is in 3-dimensional coordinate conversion mode G68 (machining center system) or G68.1 (lathe system), the tool moves to the restart point along each axis: 0: According to the program coordinate system in dry run. 1: According to the workpiece coordinate system in dry run. The restart coordinates and restart travel distance are also displayed in the coordinate system set in this parameter.

#1

NOTE The change made to this parameter in program restart operation is ignored.
7310 Ordinal number of an axis along which a movement is made in dry run after program restart

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Byte axis [Valid data range] 1 to (Number of controlled axes) This parameter sets the ordinal number of an axis along which a movement is made in dry run after the program is restarted.

4.53
7501

PARAMETERS OF HIGH-SPEED CYCLE CUTTING


#7 IPC #6 IT2 #5 IT1 #4 IT0 #3 BDS #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

- 362 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

#3 BDS In the high-speed binary program operation mode, the data format of axis movement is: 0 : Special format. 1 : Ordinary format. When BDS is set to 0 (special format) The bits marked with an asterisk (*) are used to specify the travel distance per unit time.
15 * 14 * 13 * 12 * 11 * 10 * 9 * 8 0 7 * 6 * 5 * 4 * 3 * 2 * 1 * 0 0

When BDS is set to 1 (ordinary format) The bits marked with an asterisk (*) are used to specify the travel distance per unit time.
15 * 14 * 13 * 12 * 11 * 10 * 9 * 8 * 7 * 6 * 5 * 4 * 3 * 2 * 1 * 0 *

#4 #5 #6

IT0 IT1 IT2


IT2 0 0 0 0 1 1 IT1 0 0 1 1 0 1 IT0 0 1 0 1 0 1 Interpolation of high-speed cutting G05 data (ms) 8 2 4 1 16 0.5

NOTE To perform high-speed cycle cutting for multiple paths, set the same interpolation for all paths.
#7 IPC While high-speed cutting (G05) is being executed using cycle machining data, monitoring to see whether distribution processing is stopped or not is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed. (If distribution processing is stopped, an alarm PS0179, PARAM. (NO.7510) SETTING ERROR is issued after distribution is completed.)
#7 7502 #6 #5 LC2 #4 LC1 #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #4 #5 LC1 LC2 In the servo learning control mode, high-speed cycle cutting and high-speed binary program operation are performed with the retract function as follows.
LC2 0 0 1

High-speed cycle cutting


LC1 0 1 0 End timing of servo learning function during high-speed cycle cutting retract function Disables the servo learning function, after which retract operation starts. Disables the servo learning function upon the completion of retract operation. Disables the servo learning function upon the completion of a retract cycle.

- 363 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
High-speed binary program operation
LC2 Type1 Type2 Type3 0 0 1 LC1 0 1 0

B-63950EN/04

End timing of servo learning function during high-speed binary program operation retract function Disables the servo learning function, after which retract operation starts. Disables the servo learning function at the end of operation according to binary data. Disables the servo learning function when the tool is stopped along all axes.

In pattern 1, retract operation ends after high-speed binary program operation ends, and in pattern 2, retract operation ends before high-speed binary program operation ends. Pattern 1

Type 1

Type 2

Type 3

Pattern 2

Type 1 . . . Binary data . . . Retraction distance . . . Deceleration distance

Type 2

Type 3

#7 7503

#6

#5

#4 HCT

#3

#2 RNR

#1

#0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #2 RNR After retract operation according to the retract function during high-speed binary program operation, when the system enters the reset state, the reset signal RST <Fn001.1>: 0: Is set to 1. 1: Remains 0. HCT The variable number for starting storage of high-speed cycle machining distribution data is: 0: Specified by 1/10. 1: Specified by 1/100.
- 364 -

#4

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 HIF #0 BM0

7504

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 BM0 During high-speed cycle cutting or high-speed binary program operation, axis moving signals MV1 to MV8 <Fn102> are: 0: Always set to 1. 1: Set to 1 when the tool moves along the axis.

NOTE When bit 0 (BM0) of parameter No. 7504 is set to 1 and the same position is specified after a very small movement for each execution cycle, axis moving signals MV1 to MV8 <Fn102> may not be output.
#1 HIF High-speed cycle machining operation information output function is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
#7 7505 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 HUN #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis

NOTE When this parameter bit is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#1 HUN During high-speed cutting, the setting unit of distribution data is: 0: 1 pulse. 1: 10 pulses.

NOTE If data distributed at one time is longer than one word because of the least input increment and the maximum feedrate, this parameter is used. If bit parameter HUN is set to 1 for an axis, high-speed cycle machining/high-speed binary program operation data distributed to that axis is internally multiplied by 10 by the CNC and then input. Therefore, when using HUN for an axis, set a 1/10 of high-speed cycle machining/high-speed binary program operation data to be distributed to that axis.
7510 Number of controlled axes for high-speed cycle machining or high-speed binary program operation

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 1 to number of controlled axes Set the number of axes to be controlled when G05 is specified to perform high-speed cycle machining or high-speed binary program operation.
- 365 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
7514

B-63950EN/04

Retract direction and retract feedrate in high-speed cycle machining retract operation

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Real axis [Valid data range] Refer to standard parameter setting table (C) This parameter sets a retract direction and retract feedrate along each axis in a high-speed cycle machining retract operation. The superimposed feedrate for each axis is specified, and the retract direction is specified with a sign.
7515 Number of retract operation distributions in a high-speed cycle machining retract operation

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to 99999999 This parameter sets the number of retract operation distributions in a high-speed cycle machining retract operation. When the cycle currently being executed ends before the number of distributions specified in this parameter are performed, retract operation is terminated. When 0 is specified in this parameter, the number of retract operation distributions is assumed to be infinite. In this case, retract operation is performed until the cycle currently being executed ends.
7516 High-speed cycle cutting data area ID

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to Number of controlled axes When data assigned to a path is to be used as common data, this parameter sets the number of the path.
7517 Number of high-speed cycle cutting data items

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to 65536, 0 to 131072, 0 to 262144, 0 to 786432, 0 to 2000000 This parameter sets the number of data items to be used for high-speed cycle cutting. Since variables are sequentially assigned to each path from path 1 to path 2 and so on, to some paths, the specified number of variables may not be assigned depending on the setting. When this parameter is set to 0 for all paths, however, all variables are assigned to path 1. In parameter No. 7516, set the number of the path of which data is to be used as common data. For the path of which data is to be used as common data, set the parameter to 0. [Example 1] When the high-speed cycle cutting data variable mode is set to standard (65536 variables), 40000 variables are to be used for paths 1 and 3 as common data and remaining 25536 variables are to be used for path 2 No.7516 No.7517 Available variables Path 1 0 40000 #20000 to #59999 Path 2 0 25536 #20000 to #45535 Path 3 1 0 #20000 to #59999

- 366 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Example 2] When the high-speed cycle cutting data variable mode is set to addition B (262144 variables) and high-speed cycle cutting is to be performed only for path 2 No.7516 No.7517 Available variables Path 1 0 0 #200000 to #462143 (Not used) Path 2 1 0 #200000 to #462143 Path 3 0 0 or No.7516 No.7517 Available variables Path 1 0 0 Path 2 0 262144 #200000 to #462143 Path 3 0 0 [Example 3] When the high-speed cycle cutting data variable mode is addition D (2000000 variables) and all variables are to be used as common variables No.7516 No.7517 Available variables Path 1 0 0 #2000000 to #3999999 Path 2 1 0 #2000000 to #3999999 Path 3 1 0 #2000000 to #3999999
7521 Retract time constant in high-speed binary program operation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis msec 0 to 4000 This parameter sets the time constant for linear acceleration/deceleration of time fixed type for each axis for retract operation during high-speed binary program operation. (Time constant for deceleration during stop operation)

NOTE The set time constant is shifted according to the interpolation of high-speed binary program operation data. When the interpolation is 8 ms, the time constant is assumed to be a multiple of 8 in ms. When the interpolation is 4 ms, the time constant is assumed to be a multiple of 4 in ms. When the interpolation is 2 ms, the time constant is assumed to be a multiple of 2 in ms. When the interpolation is 1 ms or less, the time constant is assumed to be the value in ms. When the set time constant is not a multiple of 8, 4, or 2, it is raised to the next multiple of 8, 4, or 2. [Example] When a value of 9 is set 1) When the interpolation is 8 ms, the time constant is assumed to be 16 msec. 2) When the interpolation is 4 ms, the time constant is assumed to be 12 msec. 3) When the interpolation is 2 ms, the time constant is assumed to be 10 msec. 4) When the interpolation is 1 ms or less, the time constant is assumed to be 9 msec.
- 367 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
7522 Retraction distance in high-speed binary program operation

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word axis [Valid data range] -999999999 to 999999999 This parameter sets the travel distance in retract operation during high-speed binary program operation.
Unit of data Increment system IS-A IS-B IS-C IS-D IS-E IS-A IS-B IS-C IS-D IS-E Value corresponding to 1 0.01 0.001 0.0001 0.00001 0.000001 0.001 0.0001 0.00001 0.000001 0.0000001

mm degree

inch

7523

Feedrate of retract during high-speed binary program operation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min(machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) This parameter sets the feedrate of retract operation during high-speed binary program operation for each axis.
Retract reference axis

7524

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to Number of controlled axes In retract operation during high-speed binary program operation, deceleration can be started at the specified timing when the tool passes a certain point along a reference axis during cycle operation. Setting the reference controlled-axis number and absolute position for parameters makes deceleration start when the tool passes the set absolute position along the reference axis after high-speed binary program operation retract select signal HRST <Gn065.3> is input. This parameter sets the reference axis. 0 : Deceleration starts immediately after HRST is input. Other than 0: Deceleration starts when the tool passes the set absolute position along the reference axes. Set the reference axis with its controlled-axis number.
7525 Retract absolute position

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A))

- 368 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
In retract operation during high-speed binary program operation, deceleration can be started at the specified timing when the tool passes a certain point along a reference axis during cycle operation. Setting the reference controlled-axis number and absolute position for parameters makes deceleration start when the tool passes the set absolute position along the reference axis after high-speed binary program operation retract select signal HRST <Gn065.3> is input. This parameter sets the absolute position.

7526

Start address of the R signal for high-speed cycle cutting operation information output function

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to 7968 (multiple of 4) This parameter sets the start address of the destination PMC internal relay (R signal) when high-speed cycle cutting operation information output is enabled (bit 1 (HIF) of parameter No. 7504 is set to 1). The destination PMC internal relay (R signal) must have a 36-byte area starting from the set address.

NOTE 1 When a multi-path PMC is used, the available R address is only for the first PMC. 2 If one of the following invalid settings is made, alarm PS0507, ILLEGAL PARAMETER(NO.7526) is issued at the start of high-speed cycle cutting: The specified R signal address is invalid. The specified value is not a multiple of 4 (0, 4, 8, ...). A 36-byte area cannot be allocated. 3 In multi-path control, set a data address which is not used for another path. 4 The range of R addresses for the first PMC differs between PMC memory B and PMC memory C. Before setting, check the available range. For details, refer to PMC PROGRAMMING MANUAL (B-63983EN). (Example: First PMC memory B -> R0 to R7999)
#7 9033 #6 #5 SHS #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #5 SHS When the high-speed cycle cutting function is enabled, variables #20000 and after are treated as: 0: High-speed cycle cutting variables. 1: P-CODE variables.
#7 10350 AOS #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit

- 369 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7

B-63950EN/04

AOS When the number of control paths in a system is 2 or more, the high-speed cycle cutting function is: 0: Not executed. 1: Executed.

4.54
7570

PARAMETERS OF ROTARY TABLE DYNAMIC FIXTURE OFFSET


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 CFA #2 #1 #0 FTP

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 FTP Fixture offset type setting 0: Movement type (The tool moves when the fixture offset changes.) 1: Shift type (The tool does not move when the fixture offset changes.) CFA When the fixture offset function is used, and a rotation axis is specified in the increment mode (G91 mode) after manual intervention in the state where the manual absolute switch is on: 0: A vector calculation is made using coordinates not reflecting a manual intervention amount. 1: A vector calculation is made using coordinates reflecting a manual intervention amount.
#7 7575 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 FAX

#3

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 FAX Fixture offset on each axis is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.

7580

Rotation axis for fixture offset (first group)

7581

Linear axis 1 for fixture offset (first group)

7582

Linear axis 2 for fixture offset (first group)

7583

Rotation axis for fixture offset (second group)

7584

Linear axis 1 for fixture offset (second group)

7585

Linear axis 2 for fixture offset (second group)

- 370 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Rotation axis for fixture offset (third group)

7586

7587

Linear axis 1 for fixture offset (third group)

7588

Linear axis 2 for fixture offset (third group)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to Number of controlled axes These parameters specify rotation axes for fixture offset and pairs of linear axes for selecting a rotation plane. Specify a pair of linear axes so that rotation from the positive direction of linear axis 1 to the positive direction is in the normal direction of the rotation axis. Up to three groups of a rotation axis setting and two linear axis settings can be specified. The fixture offset value is calculated first for the rotation axis in the first group. Then, for the second and third groups, the fixture value is sequentially calculated using the previous calculation result. When you do not need the third group, set 0 for the rotation axis.

4.55
7600

PARAMETERS OF POLYGON TURNING


#7 PLZ #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 PFF

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 PFF In spindle-servo polygon turning, feed forward for the tool rotation axis (servo axis) during polygon turning is always: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. PLZ Reference position return based on a G28 command on the tool rotation axis for polygon turning is: 0: Performed in the same sequence as manual reference position return. 1: Performed by positioning using the rapid traverse rate. The synchronous axis returns to the reference position in the same sequence as the manual reference position return when no return-to-reference position is performed after the power is turned on.
#7 7602 #6 #5 COF #4 HST #3 HSL #2 HDR #1 SNG #0 MNG

#7

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 MNG The rotational direction of the master axis in the spindle-spindle polygon turning mode is: 0: Not reversed. 1: Reversed.

- 371 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#1

B-63950EN/04

SNG The rotational direction of the polygon synchronization axis in the spindle-spindle polygon turning mode is: 0: Not reversed. 1: Reversed. HDR When phase control is exercised in spindle-spindle polygon turning mode (bit 5 (COF) of parameter No. 7602 is set to 0), the phase shift direction is: 0: Not reversed for phase synchronization. 1: Reversed for phase synchronization.

#2

NOTE The rotation directions and phase shift directions of the master axis and polygon synchronization axis in the spindle-spindle polygon turning mode can be reversed with a programmed command. MNG, SNG, and HDR are used to reverse an actual direction relative to the programmed command.
#3 HSL When phase control is exercised in spindle-spindle polygon turning mode (bit 5 (COF) of parameter No. 7602 is set to 0), this parameter selects the spindle that is subject to a phase shift operation for phase synchronization: 0: The polygon synchronization axis is selected. 1: The master axis is selected.

NOTE 1 Select an axis to which a phase shift command is applied. 2 Spindle operation for phase synchronization is performed with both spindles.
#4 HST When phase control is applied in spindle-spindle polygon turning mode (bit 5 (COF) of parameter No. 7602 is set to 0), and spindle-spindle polygon turning mode is specified: 0: Spindle-spindle polygon turning mode is entered with the current spindle speed maintained. 1: Spindle-spindle polygon turning mode is entered after the spindle is stopped.

NOTE This parameter can be used, for example, when single-rotation signal detection cannot be guaranteed at an arbitrary feedrate because a separate detector is installed to detect the spindle single-rotation signal, as when a built-in spindle is used. (When bit 7 (RFCHK3) of parameter No. 4016 for the serial spindle is set to 1, together with this parameter, a single-rotation signal detection position in spindle-spindle polygon turning mode is guaranteed.)
#5 COF In spindle-spindle polygon turning mode, phase control is: 0: Enabled. 1: Disabled.

- 372 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE When the use of phase control is not selected, the steady state is reached in a shorter time because phase synchronization control is not applied. Once steady rotation is achieved, however, polygon turning must be completed without changing the steady state. (If a spindle speed change including a spindle stop is made, a phase shift occurs, so that polygon turning is not performed normally.) Even when this parameter is set to 1, an R command (phase position command) in a block containing G51.2 is ignored ; no alarm is issued.
#7 #6 #5 RDG #4 #3 PLROT #2 SBR #1 QDR #0 RPL

7603

PST

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 RPL Upon reset, polygon turning mode or spindle-spindle polygon turning mode is: 0: Released. 1: Not released.

NOTE Notes on the polygon turning function 1 When an emergency stop occurs, the polygon turning mode is released regardless of whether this parameter is set to 0 or 1. 2 When any of the following PS alarms is issued, the polygon turning mode is released regardless of whether this parameter is set to 0 or 1: PS0217, "DUPLICATE G51.2(COMMANDS)" PS0219, "COMMAND G51.2/G50.2 INDEPENDENTLY" PS0220, "ILLEGAL COMMAND IN SYNCHR-MODE" PS0221, "ILLEGAL COMMAND IN SYNCHR-MODE" PS5018, "POLYGON SPINDLE SPEED ERROR" 3 If an SV alarm is issued, the polygon turning mode is released regardless of whether this parameter is set to 0 or 1. 4 When this parameter is set to 1, polygon turning modal information is kept regardless of whether bit 6 (CLR) of parameter No. 3402 is set to 0 or 1. 5 Set bit 4 (C20) of parameter No. 3408 to 0.
#1 QDR The rotational direction of the polygon synchronization axis: 0: Depends on the sign (+/-) of a specified value for Q. 1: Depends on the rotational direction of the first spindle. If a negative value is specified for Q when QDR = 1, the alarm PS0218, NOT FOUND P/Q COMMAND is issued. SBR For spindle synchronization, speed ratio control is: 0: Not used. 1: Used.

#2

- 373 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#3

B-63950EN/04

PLROT The machine coordinates of a tool rotation axis for polygon turning are: 0: Rounded by the setting in parameter No.7620. 1: Rounded by 360 (or the setting in parameter No. 1260 when bit 0 (ROA) of parameter No. 1008 is set to 1). #5 RDG On the diagnosis screen No. 476, for spindle-spindle polygon phase command value (R), displays: 0: The specified value (in the increment system for the rotation axis). 1: The actual number of shift pulses.

NOTE A phase command is specified in address R, in units of degrees. For control, the actual shift amount is converted to a number of pulses according to the conversion formula: 360 degrees = 4096 pulses. This parameter switches the display of a specified value to that of a converted value.
#7 PST The polygon spindle stop signal *PLSST <Gn038.0> is: 0: Not used. 1: Used.
Control axis number of tool rotation axis for polygon turning

7610

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to number of controlled axes This parameter sets the control axis number of a rotation tool axis used for polygon turning. However, when a G51.2 command is executed by setting 0 in this parameter, operation stops with the alarm PS0314, ILLEGAL SETTING OF POLYGONAL AXIS.
7620 Movement of tool rotation axis per revolution for polygon turning

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input Real path Degree Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the movement of a tool rotation axis per revolution.
Maximum allowable speed for the tool rotation axis for polygon turning

7621

[Input type] Parameter input


- 374 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Data type] 2-word path [Unit of data] min-1 [Valid data range] 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the maximum allowable speed of the tool rotation axis.

NOTE If the speed of the tool rotation axis exceeds the set maximum allowable speed during polygon turning, the synchronization between the spindle and tool rotation axis is lost, and operation stops with alarm PS5018, POLYGON SPINDLE SPEED ERROR.
7631 Allowable spindle speed deviation level in spindle-spindle polygon turning

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word path min-1 0 to 99999999 This parameter sets the allowable level of deviation between the actual speed and specified speed of each spindle in spindle-spindle polygon turning. The value set with this parameter is used for both the master axis and polygon synchronization axis. When 0 is set in this parameter, the specification of 8 [min-1] is assumed.
Steady state confirmation time duration in spindle polygon turning

7632

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word path msec 0 to 32767 This parameter sets the duration required to confirm that both spindles have reached their specified speeds in spindle-spindle polygon turning. If the state where the speed of each spindle is within the range set with parameter No.7631, and has lasted at least for the duration specified with parameter No.7632, the spindle polygon speed arrival signal PSAR <Fn063.2> is set to 1. When 0 is set in this parameter, the specification of 64 [msec] is assumed.
Ratio of slave spindle speed in spindle synchronization control

7635

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte spindle [Valid data range] 0 to 9 This parameter sets the ratio of master spindle speed: slave spindle speed (1:n) in spindle synchronization control.

NOTE This parameter is valid only when bit 2 (SBR) of parameter No. 7603 is set to 1.
7636 Maximum allowable slave spindle speed in spindle synchronization control

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word spindle


- 375 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

[Unit of data] min-1 [Valid data range] 0 to 19999 The speed of the slave spindle under speed ratio control in spindle synchronization control is clamped so that the speed does not exceed the value set in this parameter.

NOTE 1 This parameter is valid only when bit 2 (SBR) of parameter No. 7603 is set to 1. 2 When speed ratio control in spindle synchronization control is used, be sure to set this parameter. When 0 is set, the speed is clamped to 0, disabling rotation under spindle synchronization.
7640 Master axis in spindle-spindle polygon turning

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to Maximum number of controlled axes (Within a path) This parameter sets the master axis in spindle-spindle polygon turning.

NOTE 1 Spindle-spindle polygon turning is enabled only for serial spindles. 2 When any one of parameters No. 7640 and 7641 is set to 0, polygon turning is performed using the first spindle (master axis) and the second spindle (polygon synchronous axis) in the path to which the parameter belongs. 3 When a spindle other than the first serial spindle is used as a master axis, the multi-spindle control option is required to specify an S command for the master axis. 4 When the PMC window function or G10 command is used to rewrite this parameter, rewrite this parameter before the block specifying the spindle-spindle polygon command G51.2. When the PMC window function is used to rewrite this parameter in the block immediately before G51.2, specify the rewriting of this parameter by using an M code (parameter No. 3411 and up) without buffering.
7641 Polygon synchronous axis in spindle-spindle polygon turning

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to Maximum number of controlled axes (Within a path) This parameter sets the polygon synchronous (slave) axis in spindle-spindle polygon turning.

- 376 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE 1 Spindle-spindle polygon turning is enabled only for serial spindles. 2 When any one of parameter No. 7640 and No. 7641 is set to 0, polygon turning is performed using the first spindle (master axis) and the second spindle (polygon synchronous axis) in the path to which the parameter belongs. 3 When a spindle other than the first serial spindle is used as a master axis, the multi-spindle control option is required to specify an S command for the master axis. 4 When the PMC window function or G10 command is used to rewrite this parameter, rewrite this parameter before the block specifying the spindle-spindle polygon command G51.2. When the PMC window function is used to rewrite this parameter in the block immediately before G51.2, specify the rewriting of this parameter by using an M code (parameter No. 3411 and up) without buffering.

7642

Master axis in spindle-spindle polygon turning (spindle number common to the system)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to Maximum number of controlled axes (Common to the system) This parameter sets the master axis in spindle-spindle polygon turning.

NOTE 1 Spindle-spindle polygon turning is enabled only for serial spindles. 2 This parameter is invalid if either parameter No. 7642 or No.7643 is set to 0. In this case, the settings of parameter No. 7640 and No.7641 are valid. 3 When a spindle other than the first serial spindle is used as a master axis, the multi-spindle control option is required to specify an S command for the master axis. 4 When the PMC window function or G10 command is used to rewrite this parameter, rewrite this parameter before the block specifying the spindle-spindle polygon command G51.2. When the PMC window function is used to rewrite this parameter in the block immediately before G51.2, specify the rewriting of this parameter by using an M code (parameter No. 3411 and up) without buffering. 5 A spindle number common to the system is to be set in this parameter. When using this parameter, set 0 in parameter No. 7640 and No. 7641.
7643 Polygon synchronous axis in spindle-spindle polygon turning (spindle number common to the system)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to Maximum number of controlled axes (Common to the system) This parameter sets the polygon synchronous (slave) axis in spindle-spindle polygon turning.

- 377 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE 1 Spindle-spindle polygon turning is enabled only for serial spindles. 2 This parameter is invalid if either parameter No. 7642 or No.7643 is set to 0. In this case, the settings of parameter No. 7640 and No.7641 are valid. 3 When a spindle other than the first serial spindle is used as a master axis, the multi-spindle control option is required to specify an S command for the master axis. 4 When the PMC window function or G10 command is used to rewrite this parameter, rewrite this parameter before the block specifying the spindle-spindle polygon command G51.2. When the PMC window function is used to rewrite this parameter in the block immediately before G51.2, specify the rewriting of this parameter by using an M code (parameter No. 3411 and up) without buffering. 5 A spindle number common to the system is to be set in this parameter. When using this parameter, set 0 in parameter No. 7640 and No. 7641.

4.56
7700

PARAMETERS OF THE ELECTRONIC GEAR BOX (EGB)


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 HDR #1 #0 HBR

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 HBR When the electronic gear box (EGB) function is used, performing a reset: 0: Cancels the synchronization mode (G81 or G81.5). 1: Does not cancel the synchronization mode. The mode is canceled only by the G80 or G80.5 command.

NOTE To perform U-axis control, set this parameter to 1 so that performing a reset does not cancel the synchronization mode.
#2 HDR Direction of helical gear compensation (usually, set 1.) [Example] To cut a left-twisted helical gear when the direction of rotation about the C-axis is the negative (-) direction: 0: Set a negative (-) value in P. 1: Set a positive (+) value in P.

- 378 -

B-63950EN/04
When HDR = 1 (a) +C (b) +C (c)

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

+Z

(d) +C +C

-Z +Z

C : +, Z : +, P : + Compensation direction:+ (e) -C

C : +, Z : +, P : Compensation direction:(f) -C

C : +, Z : -, P : + Compensation direction:(g) -C

C : +, Z : -, P : Compensation direction:+ (h) -C

-Z

C : -, Z : +, P : + C : Compensation direction:-

C : -, Z : +, P : Compensation direction:+

C : -, Z : -, P : + Compensation direction:+

C : -, Z : -, P : Compensation direction:-

When HDR = 0 ((a), (b), (c), and (d) are the same as when HDR = 1) +Z (e) -C (f) -C (g) -C (h) -C

C : -, Z : +, P : + -Z Compensation direction:+

C : -, Z : +, P : Compensation direction:-

C : -, Z : -, P : + Compensation direction:-

C : -, Z : -, P : Compensation direction:+

#7 7701

#6

#5

#4

#3 LZR

#2

#1

#0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #3 LZR When L (number of hob threads) = 0 is specified at the start of EGB synchronization (G81): 0: Synchronization is started, assuming that L = 1 is specified. 1: Synchronization is not started, assuming that L = 0 is specified. However, helical gear compensation is performed.
#7 7702 PHD #6 PHS #5 #4 #3 ART #2 #1 UAX #0 TDP

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 TDP The specifiable number of teeth, T, of the electronic gear box (G81) is: 0: 1 to 1000 1: 0.1 to 100 (1/10 of a specified value)

NOTE In either case, a value from 1 to 1000 can be specified.


- 379 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#1 UAX U-axis control is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed.

B-63950EN/04

#3

ART The retract function executed when an alarm is issued is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. When an alarm is issued, a retract operation is performed with a set feedrate and travel distance (parameters Nos. 7740 and 7741).

NOTE If a servo alarm is issued for other than the axis along which a retract operation is performed, the servo activating current is maintained until the retract operation is completed.
#6 PHS When the G81/G80 block contains no R command: 0: Acceleration/deceleration is not performed at the start or cancellation of EGB synchronization. 1: Acceleration/deceleration is performed at the start or cancellation of EGB synchronization. After acceleration at the start of synchronization, phase synchronization is automatically performed. PHD The direction of movement for automatic phase synchronization is: 0: Positive (+). 1: Negative (-).
#7 7703 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 ARO #1 ARE #0 ERV

#7

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 ERV During EGB synchronization (G81), feed per revolution is performed for: 0: Feedback pulses. 1: Pulses converted to the speed for the workpiece axis. ARE The retract function executed when an alarm is issued retracts the tool during: 0: EGB synchronization or automatic operation (automatic operation signal OP <Fn000.7> = 1). 1: EGB synchronization. ARO The retract function executed when an alarm is issued retracts the tool during: 0: EGB synchronization. 1: EGB synchronization and automatic operation (automatic operation signal OP = 1).

#1

#2

NOTE This parameter is valid when bit 1 (ARE) of parameter No. 7703 is set to 1.
The following table lists the parameter settings and corresponding operation.
ARE 1 1 ARO 0 1 Operation During EGB synchronization During EGB synchronization and automatic operation

- 380 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
ARE 0 0 ARO 0 1 Operation During EGB synchronization or automatic operation

NOTE Parameters ARE and ARO are valid when bit 3 (ART) of parameter No. 7702 is set to 1 (when the retract function executed when an alarm is issued ).
#7 7704 #6 #5 #4 #3 UOC #2 #1 #0 ACR

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 ACR In the AI contour control mode, general purpose retract operation is: 0: Not Used. 1: Used. UOC When the U-axis control mode is released, the tool is: 0: Not moved along the U-axis to the position where the reference counter is 0. 1: Moved along the U-axis to the position where the reference counter is 0. Use this parameter to change the U-axis mode.

#3

NOTE Before changing the mode, be sure to perform reference position return along the U-axis and spindle orientation to change the mode at the same position (origin along the U-axis).
7709 Number of the axial feed axis for helical gear compensation

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to Number of controlled axes This parameter sets the number of the axial feed axis for a helical gear.

NOTE When this parameter is set to 0 or a value outside the valid setting range, the Z-axis becomes the axial feed axis. When there are two or more Z-axes in parallel, use this parameter to specify the axis to be used as the axial feed axis.
7710 Axis number of an axis to be synchronized using the method of command specification for a hobbing machine

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to Number of controlled axes

- 381 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

When there are several groups of axes to be synchronized (the axes for which bit 0 (SYNMOD) of parameter No. 2011 is set to 1), an axis for which to start synchronization is specified using the following command (for a hobbing machine): G81 T t L l ; t: Spindle speed (1 t 3000) l: Number of synchronized axis rotations (-250 l 250) Synchronization between the spindle and a specified axis is established with the ratio of l rotations about the synchronized axis to t spindle rotations. t and l correspond to the number of teeth and the number of threads on the hobbing machine, respectively. Above command is issued without setting this parameter when there are several groups of axes to be synchronized, the alarm PS1593, EGB PARAMETER SETTING ERROR is issued.

NOTE 1 Set this parameter when there are two or more groups of servo and spindle EGBs in the same path. Set 0 when there is one group of EGBs in the same path. 2 When there are two or more groups of servo and spindle EGBs in the same path, setting a value outside the valid data range in this parameter causes alarm PS1593 to be issued. 3 For Series 16i, when a value outside the valid data range is set in this parameter, the fourth axis is assumed according to the specifications. 4 The setting of this parameter becomes valid after the power is turned off then back on.
#7 7731 #6 #5 HBR #4 RTS #3 ECN #2 #1 #0 EFX

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 EFX As the EGB command: 0: G80 and G81 are used. 1: G80.4 and G81.4 are used.

NOTE When this parameter is set to 0, no canned cycle for drilling can be used.
#3 ECN When the automatic phase synchronization function for the electronic gear box is disabled, during EGB synchronization, the G81 or G81.5 command: 0: Cannot be issued again. (The alarm PS1595, ILL-COMMAND IN EGB MODE is issued.) 1: Can be issued again. RTS When an OT alarm or axis type malfunction protection alarm is issued during EGB retract operation: 0: Only the axis for which the alarm is issued is stopped. 1: All axes are stopped.

#4

- 382 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
HBR In EGB synchronization start command G81.4, the number of teeth is: 0: Specified in T. 1: Specified in R.

#5

NOTE This parameter is valid when bit 0 (EFX) of parameter No. 7731 is set to 1.
7740 Feedrate during retraction

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) This parameter sets the feedrate during retraction for each axis.
Retract amount

7741

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch, degree (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the retract amount for each axis.

NOTE The tool moves (is retracted) by the specified amount regardless of whether diameter or radius programming is specified.
7745 Time constant for linear acceleration/deceleration in retract operation for each axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input word axis msec 0 to 1000 This parameter sets an acceleration rate for linear acceleration/deceleration in retract operation based on the general-purpose retract function. Set a time (Time constant) used to reach the federate set in parameter No.7740 for each axis.

NOTE This parameter is valid when bit 0 (ACR) of parameter No. 7704 is set to 1 to perform a retract operation in the AI contour control mode.
7772 Number of position detector pulses per rotation about the tool axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word path Detection unit 1 to 999999999


- 383 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

This parameter sets the number of pulses per rotation about the tool axis (on the spindle side), for the position detector. For an A/B phase detector, set this parameter with four pulses equaling one A/B phase cycle.
7773 Number of position detector pulses per rotation about the workpiece axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word path Detection unit 1 to 999999999 This parameter sets the number of pulses per rotation about the workpiece axis (on the slave side), for the position detector. Set the number of pulses output by the detection unit. Set parameters Nos. 7772 and 7773 when using the G81 EGB synchronization command. [Example 1] When the EGB master axis is the spindle and the EGB slave axis is the C-axis

CNC

FFG n/m Command pulses CMR Error counter Speed/current control

p/rev Detector Motor Gear ratio A

Slave axis

Least command increment 0.001deg

Detection unit

Gear ratio B Synchronization factor FFG N/M

Spindle C-axis

Detector p/rev

Dummy axis

Follow-up

Synchronization switch CMR

Error counter

Gear ratio of the spindle to the detector B: 1/1 (The spindle and detector are directly connected to each other.) Number of detector pulses per spindle rotation : 80,000 pulses/rev (Calculated for four pulses for one A/B phase cycle) FFG N/M of the EGB dummy axis: 1/1 Gear ratio of the C-axis A: 1/36 (One rotation about the C-axis to 36 motor rotations) Number of detector pulses per C-axis rotation : 1,000,000 pulses/rev C-axis CMR: 1 C-axis FFG n/m: 1/100 In this case, the number of pulses per spindle rotation is: 80000 1/1 = 80000 Therefore, set 80000 for parameter No. 7772. The number of pulses per C-axis rotation in the detection unit is: 1000000 1/36 1/100 = 360000 Therefore, set 360000 for parameter No. 7773. [Example 2] When the gear ratio of the spindle to the detector B is 2/3 for the above example (When the detector rotates twice for three spindle rotations) In this case, the number of pulses per spindle rotation is:
80000 2 160000 = 3 3

- 384 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
160000 cannot be divided by 3 without a remainder. In this case, change the setting of parameter No. 7773 so that the ratio of the settings of parameters Nos. 7772 and 7773 indicates the value you want to set.
160000 No.7772 160000 3 = 160000 = = No.7773 360000 360000 3 1080000

Therefore, set 160000 for parameter No. 7772 and 1080000 for parameter No. 7773. As described above, all the settings of parameters Nos. 7772 and 7773 have to do is to indicate the ratio correctly. So, you can reduce the fraction indicated by the settings. For example, you may set 16 for parameter No. 7772 and 108 for parameter No. 7773 for this case.
7776 Feedrate during automatic phase synchronization for the workpiece axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path deg/min Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) This parameter sets the feedrate during automatic phase synchronization for the workpiece axis. When this parameter is set to 0, the rapid traverse rate (parameter No. 1420) is used as the feedrate during automatic phase synchronization.
Angle shifted from the spindle position (one-rotation signal position) which the workpiece axis uses as the reference of phase synchronization

7777

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path deg Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 0.000 to 360.000 (when the increment system is IS-B) This parameter sets the angle shifted from the spindle position (one-rotation signal position) which the workpiece axis uses as the reference of phase synchronization.
Acceleration for acceleration/deceleration for the workpiece axis

7778

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis deg/sec2 Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (D) (For a millimeter machine, 0.0 to +100000.0, for an inch machine, 0.0 to +10000.0) This parameter sets an acceleration for acceleration/deceleration for the workpiece axis.

NOTE 1 In the Series 16i, acceleration/deceleration for automatic phase matching is set by specifying a feedrate and a time constant in parameters Nos. 2135 and 2136 (Nos. 4384 and 4385 in the case of spindle EGB) separately; in the Series 30i, acceleration/deceleration is directly set in parameter No. 7778. 2 If this parameter is set to 0, specifying G81 results in an alarm PS1598.
- 385 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
7782 Number of pulses from the position detector per EGB master axis rotation

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit 1 to 999999999 For a slave axis, set the number of pulses generated from the position detector per EGB master axis rotation. For an A/B phase detector, set this parameter with four pulses equaling one A/B phase cycle.
Number of pulses from the position detector per EGB slave axis rotation

7783

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit 1 to 999999999 For a slave axis, set the number of pulses generated from the position detector per EGB slave axis rotation. Set the number of pulses output by the detection unit. Set this parameter when using the G81.5 EGB synchronization command. The method for setting parameters Nos. 7782 and 7783 is the same as for parameters Nos. 7772 and 7773. For the method, see the description of parameters Nos. 7772 and 7773. The ratio of the number of pulses for the master slave to that of pulses for the slave axis may be valid, but the settings of the parameters may not indicate the actual number of pulses. For example, the number of pulses may not be able to be divided without a remainder for the reason of the master and slave axis gear ratios as described in example 2. In this case, the following methods cannot be used for the G81.5 command: G81.5 T_ C_ ; When the speed is specified for the master axis and the travel distance is specified for the slave axis G81.5 P_ C0 L_ ; When the number of pulses is specified for the master axis and the speed is specified for the slave axis

- 386 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

4.57
8001

PARAMETERS OF AXIS CONTROL BY PMC (1 OF 3)


#7 SKE #6 AUX #5 NCC #4 #3 RDE #2 OVE #1 #0 MLE

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 MLE Whether all axis machine lock signal MLK <Gn108> is valid for PMC-controlled axes 0: Valid 1: Invalid The axis-by-axis machine lock signal MLKx depends on the setting of bit 1 of parameter No. 8006. OVE Signals related to dry run and override used in PMC axis control 0: Same signals as those used for the CNC 1: Signals specific to the PMC The signals used depend on the settings of these parameter bits as indicated below.
Bit 2 (OVE) of parameter No. 8001 = 0 (same signals as those used for the CNC) *FV0 to *FV7 OVC ROV1,2 Rapid traverse override signals Dry run signal DRN Rapid traverse selection signal RT <G46.7> <G19.7> <G012> <G006.4> <G014.0,1> Bit 2 (OVE) of parameter No. 8001 = 1 (signals specific to the PMC) *EFOV0 to *EFOV7 EOVC EROV1,2 or *EROV0 to *EROV7 EDRN ERT <G151> <G150.5> <G150.0,1> <G151> <G150.7> <G150.6>

#2

Signals

Feedrate override signals Override cancellation signal

(The listed signal addresses when PMC signals are selected are for the 1st group. Actual addresses differs depending on the used group.) #3 RDE Whether dry run is valid for rapid traverse in PMC axis control 0: Invalid 1: Valid NCC When the program specifies a move command for a PMC-controlled axis (with the controlled axis selection signal *EAX <G0136> set to 1) not placed under PMC axis control: 0: CNC command is valid. 1: The alarm PS0130 is issued. AUX In PMC axis control, the auxiliary function command (12H) output size is: 0: 1 byte (0 to 255) 1: 2 bytes (0 to 65535) SKE Skip signal during axis control by the PMC 0: Uses the same signal SKIP <X004.7, X013.7, or X011.7> as CNC. 1: Uses dedicated axis control signal ESKIP <X004.6, X013.6, or X011.6> used by the PMC.

#5

#6

#7

- 387 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 8002 FR2 #6 FR1 #5 PF2 #4 PF1 #3 F10 #2 #1 DWE

B-63950EN/04 #0 RPD

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 RPD Rapid traverse rate for PMC-controlled axes 0: Feedrate specified with parameter No. 1420 1: Feedrate specified with the feedrate data in an axis control command by PMC DWE Minimum time which can be specified in a dwell command in PMC axis control when the increment system is IS-C 0: 1ms 1: 0.1ms F10 Least increment for the feedrate for cutting feed (per minute) in PMC axis control The following settings are applied when bit 4 (PF1) of parameter No. 8002 is set to 0 and bit 5 (PF2) of parameter No. 8002 is set to 0.
F10 Millimeter input (mm/min) Inch input (inch/min) 0 1 0 1 IS-A 10 100 0.1 1 IS-B 1 10 0.01 0.1 IS-C 0.1 1 0.001 0.01 IS-D 0.01 0.1 0.0001 0.001 IS-E 0.001 0.01 0.00001 0.0001

#1

#3

#4 #5

PF1 PF2 Set the feedrate unit of cutting feedrate (feed per minute) for an axis controlled by the PMC.
Bit 5 (PF2) of parameter No. 8002 0 0 1 1 Bit 4 (PF1) of parameter No. 8002 0 1 0 1 Feedrate unit 1/1 1 / 10 1 / 100 1 / 1000

#6 #7

FR1 FR2 Set the feedrate unit for cutting feedrate (feed per rotation) for an axis controlled by the PMC.
Bit 7 (FR2) of parameter No. 8002 0 1 0 1
#7 #6 #5

Bit 6 (FR1) of parameter No. 8002 0 1 1 0


#4 #3 FEX

Millimeter input (mm/rev) 0.0001 0.001 0.01


#2 #1

Inch input (inch/rev) 0.000001 0.00001 0.0001


#0

8003

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis

NOTE When this parameter bit is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.

- 388 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
FEX The maximum feedrate that can be achieved by the machine during cutting feed or continuous feed in PMC axis control is: 0: Not extended. 1: Extended. Restrictions Parameters for setting the time constants for linear acceleration/deceleration after interpolation and bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration after interpolation When as the acceleration/deceleration type, linear acceleration/ deceleration after interpolation or bell-shaped acceleration/ deceleration after interpolation is used for each of rapid traverse, cutting feed, and manual feed, the maximum allowable time constant is a half of the maximum value that can be set conventionally. The time constant parameters used are as follows:
Parameter No. 1620 Meaning Time constant (T) used for linear acceleration/deceleration in rapid traverse for each axis, or time constant (T1) used for bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration in rapid traverse for each axis Time constant (T2) used for bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration in rapid traverse for each axis Time constant for acceleration/deceleration in cutting feed for each axis Time constant for acceleration/deceleration in jog feed for each axis Time constant for acceleration/deceleration in threading cycles for each axis Time constant for acceleration/deceleration after cutting feed interpolation in the mode of acceleration/deceleration before interpolation Time constant for acceleration/deceleration in rigid tapping extraction (first to fourth gears) Time constant for bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration in rigid tapping (first to fourth gears)

#3

1621 1622 1624 1626 1769 5271 to 5274 5365 to 5368

VCMD waveform display function As the feedrate increases, more data is acquired for VCMD waveform display, which can prevent waveforms from being displayed correctly.

CAUTION 1 When this function is enabled, the feedrate is extended to the maximum value that can be specified for cutting feed or continuous feed in PMC axis control if CMR is 1. If CMR is greater than 1, the feedrate is limited to a value smaller than the maximum value that can be specified. 2 Note that the maximum motor speed may be exceeded depending on the feedrate specified. 3 This function is available with the servo software 90E0 series, 07 edition and later.
#7 8004 #6 NCI #5 DSL #4 #3 #2 JFM #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

- 389 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#2

B-63950EN/04

JFM This parameter sets the units used to specify feedrate data when continuous feed is specified in axis control by the PMC.
Increment system IS-B IS-C Bit 2 (JFM) of No. 8004 0 1 0 1 Millimeter input (mm/min) 1 200 0.1 20 Inch input (inch/min) 0.01 2.00 0.001 0.200 Rotation axis -1 (min ) 0.00023 0.046 0.000023 0.0046

#5

DSL If the selection of an axis is changed when PMC axis selection is disabled: 0: An alarm PS0139, CANNOT CHANGE PMC CONTROL AXIS is issued. 1: The change is valid, and no alarm is issued for an unspecified group. NCI In axis control by the PMC, a position check at the time of deceleration is: 0: Performed. 1: Not performed.
#7 #6 #5 IFV #4 EVP #3 DRR #2 R10 #1 CDI #0 EDC

#6

8005

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit path #0 EDC In axis control by the PMC, an external deceleration function is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. CDI In axis control by the PMC, when diameter programming is specified for a PMC-controlled axis: 0: The amount of travel and feedrate are each specified with a radius. 1: The amount of travel is specified with a diameter while the feedrate is specified with a radius. This parameter is valid when bit 3 (DIA) of parameter No. 1006 is set to 1 (A move command for each axis is based on diameter specification.) R10 When the bit 0 (RPD) of parameter No. 8002 is set to 1, the unit for specifying a rapid traverse rate for the PMC axis is: 0: 1 mm/min. 1: 10mm/min. DRR For cutting feed per rotation in PMC axis control, the dry run function is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. EVP Speed command in PMC axis control is executed by: 0: Velocity control. 1: Position control. This bit is available when speed command in PMC axis control is FS16 type (bit 2 (VCP) of parameter No. 8007 is 1).

#1

#2

#3

#4

- 390 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
IFV When bit 2 (OVE) of parameter No. 8001 is set to 1 in PMC axis control, the feedrate override signal *EFOVx and the override cancel signal OVC are: 0: Used on a path-by-path basis. (The start groups (1st group, 5th group, ... 33rd group, 37th group) of each path are used.) 1: Used on a group-by-group basis.
#7 #6 EZR #5 #4 EFD #3 #2 #1 MLS #0

#5

8006

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #1 MLS When bit 0 (MLE) of parameter No. 8001 is set to 1 (to disable the all axis machine lock signal) in PMC axis control, axis-by-axis machine lock is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. EFD When cutting feed (feed per minute) is used in PMC axis control, the specification unit of feedrate data is: 0: Unchanged (1 times). 1: 100 times greater.

#4

NOTE When this parameter is set to 1, bit 3 (F10) of parameter No. 8002 is invalid.
#6 EZR In PMC axis control, bit 0 (ZRNx) of parameter No. 1005 is: 0: Invalid. With a PMC controlled axis, the alarm PS0224 is not issued. 1: Valid. A reference position return state check is made on a PMC controlled axis as with an NC axis according to the setting of bit 0 (ZRNx) of parameter No. 1005.
#7 8007 #6 #5 #4 #3 ESY #2 VCP #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #2 VCP Speed command in PMC axis control is: 0: FS15 type. 1: FS16 type. ESY In PMC axis control, external pulse synchronization (serial spindle synchronization) is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
#7 8008 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 EMRx

#3

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis

- 391 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#0

B-63950EN/04

EMRx When a PMC axis control command is issued in mirror image state, the mirror image is: 0: Not considered. 1: Considered. This parameter is valid in the mirror image mode set with the mirror image signals MI1 to MI8 <G106.0 to .7> set to 1 or bit 0 (MIRx) of parameter No. 12 set to 1. If a movement is made along the same axis by doubly specifying a command with the CNC and PMC axis control when this parameter is set to 0, and the mirror image mode is set, a coordinate shift can occur afterwards. So, do not attempt to make such a movement.
Selection of the DI/DO group for each axis controlled by the PMC

8010

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte axis [Valid data range] 1 to 40 Specify the DI/DO group to be used to specify a command for each PMC-controlled axis. For addresses of the fifth group and up, 1000 is added in steps of 4 groups. For example: The start address of the 10th group is G2154. The start address of the 25th axis is G6142.
P8010 1 2 3 4 5 6 : 13 : 20 21 : 29 : 35 36 37 38 39 40 Description DI/DO 1st group (G142 to G153) is used. DI/DO 2nd group (G154 to G165) is used. DI/DO 3rd group (G166 to G177) is used. DI/DO 4th group (G178 to G189) is used. DI/DO 5th group (G1142 to G1153) is used. DI/DO 6th group (G1154 to G1165) is used. : DI/DO 13th group (G3142 to G3153) is used. : DI/DO 20th group (G4178 to G4189) is used. DI/DO 21st group (G5142toG5153) is used. : DI/DO 29th group (G7142toG7153) is used. : DI/DO 35th group (G8166toG8177) is used. DI/DO 36th group (G8178toG8189) is used. DI/DO 37th group (G9142toG9153) is used. DI/DO 38th group (G9154toG9165) is used. DI/DO 39th group (G9166toG9177) is used. DI/DO 40th group (G9178toG9189) is used.

NOTE When a value other than the above is set, the axis is not controlled by the PMC.
#7 8011 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 XRT

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis

- 392 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
XRT The axis that uses the group specified by parameter No. 8010 is: 0: Not controlled by the real time custom macro. 1: Controlled by the real time custom macro.

#0

NOTE 1 This parameter is invalid for the axis for which 0 or a value outside the range is set by parameter No. 8010 2 When multiple axes are assigned to the same group by parameter No. 8010, these axes cannot be controlled by the real time custom macro. When multiple axes are assigned to the same group, be sure to set this bit to 0. 3 When this parameter No. 8011 is all 0s, the axis is used for PMC axis control.
#7 8013 #6 #5 #4 #3 ROP #2 #1 OVR #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #1 OVR When bit 2 (OVE) of parameter No. 8001 is set to 1, for rapid traverse override in PMC axis control: 0: Rapid traverse override signals EROV2 and EROV1 <G150.1 and G150.0> for PMC axis control are used. 1: 1% step rapid traverse override signals *EROV7 to *EROV0 <G151> for PMC axis control are used. (The listed signal addresses when PMC signals are selected are for the 1st group. Actual addresses differs depending on the used group.) ROP When rotation axis rollover is enabled for an axis controlled in PMC axis control, the direction in which a movement (rotation) is performed to reach an end point by a reference position return command 07H to 0AH (equivalent to G28, G30P2/P3/P4) is: 0: Determined by the sign of the specified value. 1: The direction in the shortest path.

#3

NOTE ROPx is valid only when bit 0 (ROAx) of parameter No. 1008 is set to 1 and bit 1 (RABx) of parameter No. 1008 is set to 0.
#7 8019 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 EOS

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 EOS In external pulse synchronization (serial spindle synchronization) in PMC axis control, the serial spindle to be synchronized is: 0: The first spindle of path 1. 1: Any spindle.

NOTE If EOS is set to 0, only the servo axis of path 1 can be specified.
- 393 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
8020 FL rate for reference position return along each axis in PMC axis control

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) For each axis, this parameter sets a feedrate (FL rate) after deceleration for reference position return in PMC axis control.

NOTE If 0 is specified, the value of parameter No. 1425 is used.


8022 Upper limit rate of feed per revolution during PMC axis control

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) This parameter sets the upper limit rate of feed per revolution during PMC axis control.
Time for acceleration/deceleration calculation when a feedrate is specified under PMC axis control

8028

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis msec 0 to 32767 When a feedrate is specified under PMC axis control, acceleration/deceleration can be set for parameter No. 8032 or this parameter. When 0 is set in parameter No. 8032, the specification of 1000 min-1 is assumed. When 0 is set in this parameter, the acceleration/deceleration function for feedrate specification is disabled.
Time constant for exponential acceleration/deceleration in cutting feed or continuous feed under PMC axis control

8030

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis msec 0 to 4000 For each axis, this parameter sets a time constant for exponential acceleration/deceleration in cutting feed or continuous feed under PMC axis control.

NOTE When 0 is set in this parameter, the value set in parameter No. 1622 is used. The value set in parameter No. 1622 is used also for linear acceleration/deceleration after cutting interpolation.

- 394 -

B-63950EN/04 8031

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
FL rate for exponential acceleration/deceleration in cutting feed or continuous feed under PMC axis control

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) For each axis, this parameters sets a lower feedrate limit (FL rate) for exponential acceleration/deceleration in cutting feed or continuous feed under PMC axis control.

NOTE When 0 is set in this parameter, the value set in parameter No. 1623 is used. However, be sure to set 0 in this parameter and parameter No. 1623 for all axes at all times except for special purposes. If a value other than 0 is specified, correct linear or circular figures cannot be obtained.
8032 Feedrate for acceleration/deceleration calculation when a feedrate is specified under PMC axis control

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis min-1 0 to 32767 When a feedrate is specified under PMC axis control, acceleration/deceleration can be set for this parameter or parameter No. 8028. When 0 is set in this parameter, the specification of 1000 min-1 is assumed. When 0 is set in parameter No. 8028, the acceleration/deceleration function for feedrate specification is disabled.
Amount of a shift per one rotation of a servo motor of least input increment when speed command in PMC axis control is velocity control

8040

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis mm, inch, degree (machine unit) 1 to 99999999 Set the amount of a shift per one rotation of a servo motor of least input increment when speed command in PMC axis control is velocity control. This parameter is available when speed command in PMC axis control is FS16 type (bit 2 (VCP) of parameter No. 8007 is 1) and is executed by position control (bit 4 (EVP) of parameter No. 8005 is 1).

4.58
8100

PARAMETERS OF MULTI-PATH CONTROL


#7 NWP #6 DSB #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 IAL #0 RST

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit machine group

- 395 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#0 RST The pressing of the key on the MDI panel is:

B-63950EN/04

0: Valid for all paths. 1: Valid only for the path selected by the path selection signal. The reset key on the MDI panel functions for all machine groups. So, in machine groups for which this parameter is set to 0, a reset can be performed for all paths. In machine groups for which this parameter is set to 1, a reset can be performed only for the path that is selected by the path select signal.

NOTE The path by which reset becomes actually effective depends on the combination with bit 0 (MGR) of parameter No.8106 setting and this parameter.
#1 IAL Choice of an option concerning operation continuation when an alarm is issued, and choice of an option concerning the start of automatic operation in alarm state: 0: When an alarm is issued, the operation is stopped with the other path(s) in same group placed in hold state. When the other path or paths in same group are placed in alarm state, automatic operation cannot be started. 1: Even when an alarm is issued, the operation is continued without stopping the other path(s). Even when the other path or paths in same group are placed in alarm state, automatic operation can be started. DSB The inter-path single block check function is: 0: Disabled. When a single block stop occurs with a path, no single block stop occurs with the other path(s). 1: Enabled. When a single block stop occurs with a path, a feed hold stop occurs with all paths in the same machine group. NWP Servo activation is turned on: 0: Together with other machine groups. (Servo activation is not turned on until other machine groups are ready to turn on servo activation.) 1: Independently of other machine groups. (Each machine group turns on servo activation even if other machine groups are not ready to turn on servo activation.)
#7 8103 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 MWP #0 MWT

#6

#7

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 MWT As the signal interface for the waiting M code: 0: The path individual signal interface is used. 1: The path common signal interface is used. This parameter can be selected only when 2-path control is used.
- 396 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

#1

MWP To specify a P command for the waiting M code/balance cut: 0: A binary value is used as conventionally done. 1: A path number combination is used.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 LSL

8104

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 LSL A loader path screen is selected by: 0: Path selection signal <G0063.0, G0062.0, G0408.1, or G0408.2>. (A type) 1: SHIFT+HELP or signal LCBC <G0251.1>. (B type) (FS16 compatible specifications)

NOTE When there are multiple loader paths, set this parameter to 0.
#7 8106 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 MGR

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 MGR When the RESET key on the MDI panel is pressed, 0: All machine groups are reset. 1: Only the machine groups to which the path selected by the path selection signal belongs are reset.

NOTE The path by which reset becomes actually effective depends on the combination with bit 0 (RST) of parameter No.8100 setting and this parameter.
8110 8111 Waiting M code range (minimum value) Waiting M code range (maximum value)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word [Valid data range] 0 ,100to99999999 A range of M code values can be set by specifying a minimum waiting M code value (parameter No. 8110) and a maximum waiting M code value (parameter No. 8111). (parameter No. 8110) (waiting M code) (parameter No. 8111) Set 0 in these parameters when the waiting M code is not used.

- 397 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

4.59
8140

PARAMETERS OF INTERFERENCE CHECK BETWEEN PATHS


#7 IPF #6 #5 ZCL #4 IFE #3 IFM #2 IT0 #1 TY1 #0 TYO

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 #1 TY0 This parameter sets the coordinate system relationship between two tool posts based on the tool post of path 1. TY1 This parameter is used for checking the interference between two paths when bit 7 (IPF) of parameter No. 8140 is set to 0.
(1) When TY1=0 and TY0=0 +X Tool post 2 Tool post 1 Tool post 1 Tool post 2 (2) When TY1=0 and TY0=1 +X +X

+Z +Z

+Z

(3) When TY1=1 and TY0=0 +X +Z Tool post 2

(4) When TY1=1 and TY0=1 +X Tool post 1 +Z

+Z Tool post 1 +X +X

Tool post 2 +Z

#2

IT0 When offset number 0 is specified by the T code, 0: Checking interference between paths is stopped until an offset number other than 0 is specified by the next T code. 1: Checking interference between paths is continued according to the previously specified offset number. IFM In manual mode, a interference check between paths is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed. IFE Interference check between paths is: 0: Performed. 1: Not performed.
- 398 -

#3

#4

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
ZCL Specifies whether interference along the Z axis is checked while checking interference between paths. 0: Checked. 1: Not checked (Only interference along the X axis is checked.) IPF In inter-path interference checking: 0: The interference between two paths is checked. 1: The interference among multiple paths is checked. Even in two-path control, the specification of a multi-path interference check can be applied. If this parameter is set to 0 when three or more paths are controlled, a two-path interference check is made only with path 1 and path 2.
Distance along the X axis between the reference positions of tool post 1 and tool post n in the same machine group Distance along the Z axis between the reference positions of tool post 1 and tool post n in the same machine group

#5

#7

8141

8143

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Each of these parameters sets the distance between the reference positions of the tool post of path 1 and tool post of each path in the same machine group. Set 0 in parameter No. 8141 and No. 8143 for tool post 1 of each machine group. For the lathe system, only a Z-X coordinate system based on parameter No. 8141 and No. 8143 is used for setting.
Paths in the same machine group Tool post 4 Tool post 2

Reference position

+X Reference position 3 1 1

Reference position

Tool post 1 Reference position 3 2 The tool post of path 1 in the same machine group is used as the reference tool post.

Tool post 3

+Z

In the example above, the same machine group contains tool posts for four paths. In the ZX plane coordinate system with its origin placed at the reference position of tool post 1 of path 1 in the same machine group, the position of the reference position of tool post 2 of path 2 is specified by setting the value 1 of the X component in parameter No. 8141 for path 2 and by setting the value 1 of the Z component in parameter No. 8143 for path 2.

- 399 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

Similarly, In the ZX plane coordinate system with its origin placed at the reference position of tool post 1, the position of the reference position of tool post 3 of path 3 is specified by setting the value 2 of the X component in parameter No. 8141 for path 3 and by setting the value 2 of the Z component in parameter No. 8143 for path 3. In the ZX plane coordinate system with its origin placed at the reference position of tool post 1, the position of the reference position of tool post 4 of path 4 is specified by setting the value 3 of the X component in parameter No. 8141 for path 4 and by setting the value 3 of the Z component in parameter No. 8143 for path 4. The unit of setting is the least input increment. For an axis based on diameter specification, make a setting using a diameter value.

WARNING Measure (1, 1), (2, 2), and (3, 3) in the state where reference position return operation is completed for all axes (the tool is at the reference position.) After modifying parameter No. 8141 and No. 8143 for each path, be sure to perform a reference position return operation along all axes in all paths. Otherwise, the internally stored positional relationships of the tool posts are not updated to the newly set parameter values.
8151 Distance along the X axis between the reference positions of tool posts 1 and 2

8152

Distance along the Z axis between the reference positions of tool posts 1 and 2

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters are used for checking the interference between two paths when bit 7 (IPF) of parameter No. 8140 is set to 0. Each of these parameters sets the distance between the tool posts of two paths.

- 400 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Tool post 2 Reference position +X

+Z Reference position Tool post 1


In the Z-X plane coordinate system with its origin at the represent position of tool post 1, set the X component value of the reference position of tool post 2 in parameter No. 8151 and set the Z component value in parameter No. 8152.

WARNING After modifying the parameter values, perform a manual reference position return operation for both tool posts. Otherwise, the internally stored positional relationships of the two tool posts are not updated to the newly set parameter values.
8158 Coordinate system pattern with the reference position based on the tool post of path 1 in the same machine group

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 3 This parameter is used for checking the interference among multiple paths when bit 7 (IPF) of parameter No. 8140 is set to 1. This parameter sets a coordinate system pattern with the reference position based on the tool post of path 1 in the same machine group.

- 401 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
<1> When the parameter 8158 is set to 0 +X Tool post Tool post No. <2> When the parameter 8158 is set to 1 No. +X

B-63950EN/04

+Z <3> When the parameter 8158 is set to 2 +Z Tool post No.

+Z <4> When the parameter 8158 is set to 3 No.

+Z Tool post

+X

+X

4.60
8160

PARAMETERS OF SYNCHRONOUS/COMPOSITE CONTROL AND SUPERIMPOSED CONTROL (1 OF 3)


#7 NRS #6 SPE #5 NCS #4 AXS #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #4 AXS When the axis movement in-progress signal <Fn102> or the axis movement direction signal <Fn106> of the slave axis in superimposed control is output: 0: State output is performed according to the result of adding superimposed move pulses. 1: State output is performed according to the result of movement along each axis instead of superimposed move pulses. NCS If an overtravel alarm is issued for an axis under synchronous, composite, or superimposed control, synchronous, composite, or superimposed control is: 0: Released. 1: Not released.

#5

NOTE After updating the value of this parameter, perform a manual reference position return operation for both tool posts. Otherwise, the internally stored positional relationships of the two tool posts are not updated to the newly set parameter value.
#6 SPE The synchronization deviation is: 0: The difference between the positioning deviation of the master axis and that of the slave axis. 1: The difference between the positioning deviation of the master axis and that of the slave axis plus the acceleration/deceleration delay.
- 402 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE 1 When the master and slave axes have different acceleration/deceleration time constants, set 1. 2 SPE is valid when bit 1 (SERx) of parameter No. 8162 is set to 1. SPE is used to find a synchronization deviation for comparison with parameter No. 8181.

#7

NRS When the system is reset, synchronous, composite, or superimposed control is: 0: Released. 1: Not released.
#7 #6 #5 CRZ #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 NMR

8161

NSR

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 NMR When an axis subject to composite control is placed in servo-off state: 0: Composite control is stopped 1: Composite control is not stopped, provided bit 0 (FUP) of parameter No. 1819 is set to 1 to disable follow-up for the axis. CRZ If the state of the composite control signal is switched in composite control on two axes under Cs contour control, the reference position establishment state of the two axes in composite control is: 0: Maintained. (The unestablished state is not assumed.) 1: Assumed to be unestablished. NSR When servo-off occurs with an axis in synchronous control: 0: Synchronous control is canceled. 1: Synchronous control is not canceled if follow-up operation is disabled for the axis (with bit 0 (FUPx) of parameter No. 1819 set to 1).
#7 8162 MUMx #6 MCDx #5 MPSx #4 MPMx #3 OMRx #2 PKUx #1 SERx #0 SMRx

#5

#7

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 SMRx Synchronous mirror-image control is: 0: Not applied. (The master and slave axes move in the same direction.) 1: Applied. (The master and slave axes move in opposite directions.) SERx The synchronization deviation is: 0: Not detected. 1: Detected.

#1

- 403 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE When both master and slave axes move in synchronization, the positioning deviations of the corresponding axes are compared with each other. If the difference is greater than or equal to the value specified in parameter No. 8181, an alarm occurs. When either axis is in the parking or machine-locked state, however, the synchronization deviation is not detected.
#2 PKUx In the parking state, 0: The absolute, relative, and machine coordinates are not updated. 1: The absolute and relative coordinates are updated. The machine coordinates are not updated.

NOTE 1 With an axis for which polar coordinate interpolation is specified, set this parameter to 1. If this parameter is set to 0, a coordinate shift can occur when a single block stop or feed hold is performed in the polar coordinate interpolation mode. 2 With an axis that is set to function as a synchronous master axis and synchronous slave axis at the same time (with bit 1 (SYWx) of parameter No. 8167), set this parameter to 1. 3 With an axis specified in the 3-dimensional coordinate conversion mode, set this parameter to 1. If this parameter is set to 0, the alarm PS0367, 3-D CONV. WAS COMMANDED IN SYNC MODE AS THE PARAMETER PKUx(NO.8162#2) IS 0. is issued.
#3 OMRx Superimposed mirror-image control is: 0: Not applied. (The superimposed pulse is simply added.) 1: Applied. (The inverted superimposed pulse is added.) MPMx When composite control is started, the workpiece coordinate system is: 0: Not set automatically. 1: Set automatically.

#4

NOTE When the workpiece coordinate system is automatically set at the start of composite control, it is calculated from the following: Current machine coordinates and the workpiece coordinates at the reference point of each axis (parameter No. 8184). When a workpiece coordinate system (G54 to G59, including additional workpiece coordinate systems) is used, however, instead of the coordinate value obtained by the above calculation, the workpiece coordinate value obtained by workpiece coordinate system presetting (equivalent to G92.1 IP 0) in the machine coordinate system of the other axis in composite control is set.
#5 MPSx When composite control is terminated, the workpiece coordinate system is: 0: Not set automatically. 1: Set automatically.

- 404 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE When the workpiece coordinate system is automatically set at the end of composite control, it is calculated from the following: Current machine coordinates and the workpiece coordinates at the reference point of each axis under composite control (parameter No. 1250) When a workpiece coordinate system (G54 to G59, including additional workpiece coordinate systems) is used, however, instead of the coordinate value obtained by the above calculation, the workpiece coordinate value obtained by workpiece coordinate system presetting (equivalent to G92.1 IP 0) in the machine coordinate system of the local axis is set.

#6

MCDx The axes to be replaced with each other under composite control have the coordinate systems placed: 0: In the same direction. Simple composite control is applied. (A movement is made in the same direction along the corresponding axis.) 1: In opposite directions. Mirror-image composite control is applied. (A movement is made in the reverse direction along the corresponding axis.)
X1 MCDz 0 MCDx 0 X1 MCDz 0 MCDx 1 X2

Z1

Z2

Z1

Z2

X2 X1 MCDz 1 MCDx 0 X1 MCDz 1 MCDx 1 X2

Z1

Z2

Z1

Z2

X2

#7

MUMx In composite control, a move command for the axis: 0: Can be specified. 1: Cannot be specified.

- 405 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE Upon the execution of a move command along an axis for which MUMx is set to 1 during mixed control, alarm PS0353, THE INSTRUCTION WAS DONE FOR THE AXIS WHICH WAS NOT ABLE TO MOVE. is issued. For example, when axis X1 and axis X2 are placed under composite control, and a command for axis X2 (motor for axis X1) is to be disabled, set MUMx for path 2 to 1.
#7 8163 NUMx #6 MMIx #5 SMIx #4 SCDx #3 SCMx #2 SPSx #1 SPMx #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #1 SPMx When synchronous control is started, automatic workpiece coordinate system setting for the master axis is 0: Not Performed. 1: Performed.

NOTE When a workpiece coordinate system is automatically set at the start of synchronous control, the workpiece coordinate system is calculated from the current machine coordinates and the workpiece coordinates of each axis at the reference position set in parameter No. 8185.
#2 SPSx When synchronous control terminates, automatic workpiece coordinate system setting for the master axis is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed.

NOTE When a workpiece coordinate system is automatically set at the end of synchronous control, the workpiece coordinate system is calculated from the current machine coordinates and the workpiece coordinates for each axis at the reference position set in parameter No. 1250.
#3 SCMx When workpiece coordinates are calculated in synchronous control: 0: The workpiece coordinates are calculated from the machine coordinates of the slave axis. 1: The workpiece coordinates are calculated from the machine coordinates of the master axis and slave axis. SCDx The positive (+) directions of the master axis and slave axis in the coordinate system in synchronous control are: 0: Identical. 1: Opposite. Set the parameters SPMx, SPSx, SCMx, and SCDx for the master axis. These settings are referenced during automatic workpiece coordinate setting for the master axis at the start of synchronous control.
- 406 -

#4

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
SMIx In synchronous control, the manual handle interruption amount for the master axis or the mirror image mode is: 0: Reflected in the slave axis. 1: Not reflected in the slave axis. When this bit (SMIx) is set to 0 Manual handle interruption : To the travel distance along the slave axis, the interruption amount of the master axis is also added. Mirror image : When mirror image is applied to the master axis, mirror image is also applied to the slave axis. When this bit (SMIx) is set to 1 Manual handle interruption : To the travel distance along the slave axis, the interruption amount of the master axis is not added. Mirror image : Even when mirror image is applied to the master axis, mirror image is not applied to the slave axis.

#5

#6

MMIx For a composite control axis, manual handle interruption under composite control is: 0: Enabled. 1: Disabled. NUMx When neither synchronous control nor composite control is applied, a move command for the axis is: 0: Not disabled. 1: Disabled.

#7

NOTE If a move command is specified for an axis with NUMx set to 1 when neither synchronous control nor composite control is applied, alarm PS0353, THE INSTRUCTION WAS DONE FOR THE AXIS WHICH WAS NOT ABLE TO MOVE. is issued.
#7 8164 #6 SOKx SOKx #5 OPSx OPSx #4 #3 MCEx MCEx #2 MCSx MCSx #1 MWEx #0 MWSx

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 MWSx In automatic workpiece coordinate system setting, performed when composite control is started, a workpiece shift and position offset are: 0: Not considered. 1: Considered.

NOTE When bit 4 (MPMx) of parameter No. 8162 is set to 1 and workpiece coordinate system (G54 to G59, including additional workpiece coordinate system) is not used, MWSx is enabled.
- 407 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#1

B-63950EN/04

MWEx In automatic workpiece coordinate system setting, performed when composite control is canceled, a workpiece shift and position offset are: 0: Not considered. 1: Considered.

NOTE When bit 5 (MPSx) of parameter No. 8162 is set to 1 and workpiece coordinate system (G54 to G59, including additional workpiece coordinate system) is not used, MWEx is enabled.
#2 MCSx In automatic workpiece coordinate system setting, performed when composite control is started: 0: A workpiece coordinate system is automatically set in the same way as normal. 1: The coordinate system of the other path subject to axis recomposition is used.

NOTE When bit 4 (MPMx) of parameter No. 8162 is set to 1 and workpiece coordinate system (G54 to G59, including additional workpiece coordinate system) is not used, MCSx is enabled.
#3 MCEx In automatic workpiece coordinate system setting, performed when composite control is canceled: 0: A workpiece coordinate system is automatically set in the same way as normal. 1: The coordinate system of the other path subject to axis recomposition is used.

NOTE When bit 5 (MPSx) of parameter No. 8162 is set to 1 and workpiece coordinate system (G54 to G59, including additional workpiece coordinate system) is not used, MCEx is enabled.
#5 OPSx When superimposed control is canceled, control in which an amount of movement along a master axis subject to superimposed control is added to the workpiece coordinate of a slave axis is: 0: Not applied. 1: Applied.

NOTE When the workpiece coordinate system option is enabled, workpiece coordinate system presetting (equivalent to G92.1IP0) is performed to set up a coordinate system.
#6 SOKx If a master axis subject to superimposed control is also subject to synchronous control: 0: An alarm is issued when superimposed control is started during synchronous control. 1: No alarm is issued when superimposed control is started during synchronous control.
#7 8166 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 MIX #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit


- 408 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.

#1

MIX For composite control: 0: An interface for three paths or more is used. In this case, set the composite control axis selection signals MIX1 to MIX8 <G128.0 to G128.7> for the axis that is placed under composite control by parameter No. 8183, from 0 to 1 or from 1 to 0. 1: The conventional 2-path interface is used. (Composite control on three paths or more is disabled.) In this case, set parameter No. 8183 for path 2, and use the composite control axis selection signals MIX1 to MIX8 of path 1.
#7 #6 SPVx SPVx #5 SWSx #4 SWMx #3 SGSx #2 SGMx #1 SYWx SYWx #0

8167

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #1 SYWx The axis is: 0: Not used as a master axis and slave axis at the same time. 1: Used as a master axis and slave axis at the same time. SGMx In automatic workpiece coordinate system setting at the start of synchronous control, a tool offset is: 0: Considered. 1: Not considered.

#2

NOTE SGMx is enabled when bit 1 (SPMx) of parameter No. 8163 is set to 1.
#3 SGSx In automatic workpiece coordinate system setting at the end of synchronous control, a tool offset is: 0: Considered. 1: Not considered.

NOTE SGSx is enabled when bit 2 (SPSx) of parameter No. 8163 or bit 6 (SPVx) of parameter No. 8167 is set to 1.
#4 SWMx In automatic workpiece coordinate system setting at the start of synchronous control, a workpiece shift is: 0: Not considered. 1: Considered.

NOTE SWMx is enabled when bit 1 (SPMx) of parameter No. 8163 is set to 1.

- 409 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#5

B-63950EN/04

SWSx In automatic workpiece coordinate system setting at the end of synchronous control, a workpiece shift is: 0: Not considered. 1: Considered.

NOTE SWSx is enabled when bit 2 (SPSx) of parameter No. 8163 or bit 6 (SPVx) of parameter No. 8167 is set to 1.
#6 SPVx At the end of synchronous control, automatic workpiece coordinate system setting for the slave axis is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed.

NOTE When a workpiece coordinate system is automatically set at the end of synchronous control, the workpiece coordinate system is calculated from the current machine coordinates and the workpiece coordinates for each axis at the reference position set in parameter No. 1250.
#7 8168 #6 WST #5 SFH #4 #3 #2 SVF #1 MSO #0 MPA

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 MPA If an alarm concerning synchronous control, composite control, or superimposed control is issued: 0: All paths of the machine group to which the alarm occurrence path belongs are placed in feed hold state. 1: Only the path including the axis placed under synchronous control, composite control, or superimposed control is placed in the feed hold state. MSO When one of the following events occurs in synchronous control or composite control: The emergency stop signal *ESP <G0008.4> is turned off. The servo-off signals SVF1 to SVF8 <Gn126.0 to Gn126.7> are turned on. A servo alarm is issued. 0: The synchronous or composite control mode is canceled and follow-up operation is not performed. For the operation to be performed when the servo-off signal is turned on, however, the setting of bit 7 (NSR) of parameter No. 8161 is used in synchronous control or the setting of bit 0 (NMR) of parameter No. 8161 is used in composite control.

#1

- 410 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
1: The synchronous or composite control mode is not canceled. The following operation is performed to perform follow-up operation: When the emergency stop signal *ESP is turned off, the relevant path is determined and operation is performed so that the emergency stop signal *ESP is virtually turned off for the determined path. When the servo-off signals SVF1 to SVF8 are turned on, the relevant axis is determined and operation is performed so that the servo-off signals SVF1 to SVF8 are virtually turned on for the determined axis. When a servo alarm is issued, the relevant axis is determined and the alarm SV0003, CONTINUATION OF SYNCHRONOUS OR COMPOSITE CONTROL DISABLED is issued for the determined axis to stop moving the tool along the axis. When bit 2 (SVF) of parameter No. 8168 is set to 1, this servo-off specification follows the SVF setting.

NOTE This setting is valid also during operation. For all axes placed under synchronous or composite control, the emergency stop signal is turned off, the servo-off signal is turned on, or a servo alarm is issued.
#2 SVF When an axis under composite control is placed in the servo-off state: 0: Composite control is canceled. 1: Composite control is not canceled. Follow-up specification follows the setting of bit 0 (FUPx) of parameter No. 1819. When bit 2 (SVF) of parameter No. 8168 is set to 1, bit 0 (NMR) of parameter No. 8161 is invalid. Bit 1 (MSO) of parameter No. 8168, specification for servo-off, is also invalid.

NOTE If a composite control axis is placed in the servo-off state when stopped, set this parameter to 1.
#5 SFH For high-speed cycle cutting or high-speed binary program operation, superimposed control is: 0: Not applied. 1: Applied.

NOTE When parameter SFH is set to 0 and superimposed control is applied for high-speed cycle cutting or high-speed binary program operation, alarm DS0070, SUPERIMPOSE FOR HIGH-SPEED CYCLE CANNOT BE USED is issued.
#6 WST When a workpiece coordinate system is automatically set up for a slave axis at the end of synchronous control, workpiece coordinate system presetting is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed.

- 411 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE This parameter is valid when the workpiece coordinate system option is enabled, and bit 6 (SPV) of parameter No. 8167 is set to 1.
#7 8169 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 MRFx #1 MVMx #0 MDMx

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 MDMx As machine coordinates in composite control: 0: Coordinates for the local path are displayed. 1: Coordinates for the other path in composite control are displayed. MVMx In composite control, machine coordinates (#5021 and above) to be read are: 0: Machine coordinates of the local path. 1: Machine coordinates of the other path in composite control. MRFx In composite control, the rapid traverse rate is: 0: The rapid traverse rate for the specified axis. 1: The rapid traverse rate for the axis along which a movement is made.
Master axis with which an axis is synchronized under synchronous control

#1

#2

8180

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis [Valid data range] 101, 102, 103, . . . , (path number)*100+(intra-path relative axis number) (101, 102, 103, . . . , 201, 202, 203, . . . , 1001, 1002, 1003, . . .) This parameter sets the path number and intra-path relative axis number of the master axis with which each axis is synchronized. When zero is specified, the axis does not become a slave axis and is not synchronized with another axis. When an identical number is specified in two or more parameters, one master axis has two or more slave axes.
8181 Synchronization error limit of each axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit 0 to 99999999 When the synchronization deviation detected (bit 1 (SERx) of parameter No. 8162 is set to 1), this parameter specifies the limit of the difference between the positioning deviation of the slave axis and that of the master axis. Set this parameter to the slave axis.
Composite control axis of the other path in composite control for each axis

8183

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis [Valid data range] 101, 102, 103, . . . , (path number)*100+(intra-path relative axis number) (101, 102, 103, . . . , 201, 202, 203, . . . , 1001, 1002, 1003, . . .) This parameter sets with which axis each axis is to be placed under composite control. When zero is specified, control of the axis is not replaced under composite control. An identical number can be specified in two or more parameters, but composite control cannot be exercised for all of them at a time.
- 412 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE When the two-path interface is used (bit 1 (MIX) of parameter No. 8166 is set to 1), set this parameter for path 2.

8184

Coordinates of the reference point of an axis on the coordinate system of another axis under composite control

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter specifies the coordinates of the reference point of an axis on the coordinate system of another axis under composite control. This parameter is valid when bit 4 (MPMx) of parameter No. 8162 is set to 1, and workpiece coordinate systems (G54 to G59, including additional workpiece coordinate systems) are not used. [Example] Exercising composite control to replace the X1-axis with the X2-axis
X1m Z2m

Z1m Reference position of path 1 X1 X2m

Zero point of the workpiece coordinate system of path 2

Zero point of the workpiece coordinate system of path 1

Z1 X1m

Z2 Reference position of path 2

X2

Z1m

Z2m

X2m

(X1m, Z1m) are the coordinates of the reference point of path 2 on the workpiece coordinate system of path 1. (X2m, Z2m) are the coordinates of the reference point of path 1 on the workpiece coordinate system of path 2. X1m is specified for the parameter No. 8184x of path 1 and X2m for the parameter No. 8184x of path 2. If bit 4 (MPMx) of parameter No. 8162 is set to 1 when composite control is started, the workpiece coordinate system satisfying the following conditions is specified: X1 = (Value specified for the X-axis of path 1) (Machine coordinate of X2) Plus when bit 6 (MCDx) of parameter No. 8162 of path 1 is set to 0 Minus when bit 6 (MCDx) of parameter No. 8162 of path 1 is set to 1 X2 = (Value specified for the X-axis of path 2) (Machine coordinate of X1) Plus when bit 6 (MCDx) of parameter No. 8162 of path 2 is set to 0 Minus when bit 6 (MCDx) of parameter No. 8162 of path 2 is set to 1
- 413 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

If bit 5 (MPSx) of parameter No. 8162 is set to 1 when composite control is terminated, the workpiece coordinate system satisfying the following conditions is specified: X1 = (Parameter No. 1250 of path 1) + (Machine coordinate of X1) X2 = (Parameter No. 1250 of path 2) + (Machine coordinate of X2)
8185 Workpiece coordinates on each axis at the reference position

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the workpiece coordinates on each master axis, subject to synchronous control, when the master and slave axes are at the reference position. This parameter is enabled when bit 1 (SPMx) of parameter No. 8163 is set to 1. Set this parameter for the master axis.
Master axis under superimposed control

8186

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis [Valid data range] 101, 102, 103, . . . , (path number)*100+(intra-path relative axis number) (101, 102, 103, . . . , 201, 202, 203, . . . , 1001, 1002, 1003, . . .) This parameter sets the path number and intra-path relative axis number of a superimposed master axis for each axis when superimposed control is exercised. When zero is specified, the axis does not become a slave axis under superimposed control and the move pulse of another axis is not superimposed. An identical number can be specified in two or more parameters to exercise superimposed control simultaneously. This means that superimposed control with one master axis and multiple slave axes is possible. A slave axis may function as the master axis of another axis to allow three-generation superimposed control: parent (master axis) - child (slave axis/master axis) - grandchild (slave axis). In this case, a movement along the child is made by its travel distance plus the travel distance of the parent, and a movement along the grandchild is made by its travel distance plus the travel distance of the child plus the travel distance of the parent. Example of the relationship of parent (X1 of path 1) - child (X2 of path 2) - grandchild (X3 of path 3): The travel distance of X1 is superimposed on X2, and the travel distances of X1 and X2 are further superimposed on X3. Parameter No. 8186 (X axis) of path 2 = 101 Parameter No. 8186 (X axis) of path 3 = 201
8190 Rapid traverse rate of an axis under superimposed control

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0 to +999000.0)
- 414 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Set a rapid traverse rate for each of the axes when the rapid traverse override of the axes (master and slave axes) under superimposed control is 100%. The manual rapid traverse rate set in this parameter or the manual rapid traverse rate set in parameter No. 1424, whichever smaller, is used. If this parameter is set to 0, the normal rapid traverse rate (parameter No. 1420) is used.

8191

F0 velocity of rapid traverse override of an axis under superimposed control

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0 to +999000.0) Set the F0 velocity of rapid traverse override of an axis under superimposed control (each of the master and slave axes). If this parameter is set to 0, the F0 velocity of rapid traverse override in normal operation (parameter No. 1421) is used.
Linear acceleration/deceleration time constant in rapid traverse of an axis under superimposed control

8192

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis msec 0 to 4000 This parameter specifies the linear acceleration/deceleration time constant in rapid traverse for each of the axes (master and slave axes) under superimposed control.
Maximum cutting feedrate in superimposed control

8194

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0 to +999000.0) Set the maximum cutting feedrate that can be applied under superimposed control. If this parameter is set to 0, the maximum cutting feedrate in normal operation (parameter No. 1430) is used.

4.61
8200

PARAMETERS OF ANGULAR AXIS CONTROL


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 AZP #2 AZR #1 #0 AAC

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 AAC 0: Does not perform angular axis control.
- 415 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
1: #2 AZR 0: 1: Performs inclined axis control.

B-63950EN/04

The machine tool is moved along the Cartesian axis during manual reference position return along the slanted axis under angular axis control. The machine tool is not moved along the Cartesian axis during manual reference position return along the slanted axis under angular axis control.

#3

AZP When a movement is made along the Cartesian axis due to a movement along the slanted axis, reference position return end signals for the Cartesian axis ZP1 to ZP8 <F0094.0 to F0094.7> are: 0: Not cleared. 1: Cleared.
#7 #6 A53 #5 #4 #3 #2 AO3 #1 AO2 #0 AOT

8201

ADG

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 AOT Stored stroke limit 1 under angular axis control is handled as: 0: Value in the slanted coordinate system. 1: Value in the Cartesian coordinate system. AO2 Stored stroke limit 2 under angular axis control is handled as: 0: Value in the slanted coordinate system. 1: Value in the Cartesian coordinate system. AO3 Stored stroke limit 3 under angular axis control is handled as: 0: Value in the slanted coordinate system. 1: Value in the Cartesian coordinate system. A53 So far, if a slanted axis is singly specified by a machine coordinate command (G53) in angular axis control, this parameter set to 0 specifies that "compensation is applied to the Cartesian axis", and this parameter set to 1 specifies that "a movement is made along the slanted axis only". However, the specification has been changed so that "a movement is made along the slanted axis only", regardless of whether this parameter is set to 0 or 1. ADG The contents of diagnostic data Nos. 306 and 307 are: 0: Not swapped. The slanted axis and Cartesian axis are displayed in this order. 1: Swapped. The Cartesian axis and slanted axis are displayed in this order.
#7 8209 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 ARF

#1

#2

#6

#7

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

- 416 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE When this parameter bit is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.

#0

ARF In angular axis control, a movement from an intermediate point to the reference position in the G28/G30 command is: 0: Made in the angular coordinate system. 1: Made in the Cartesian coordinate system.
Slant angle of a slanted axis in angular axis control

8210

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path Degree Depend on the increment system of the applied axis -180.000 to 180.000. However, angular axis control is disabled in the ranges -95.000 to -85.000 and 85.000 to 95.000 (in the case of IS-B).
Axis number of a slanted axis subject to angular axis control Axis number of a Cartesian axis subject to slanted axis control

8211 8212

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 1 to number of controlled axes When angular axis control is to be applied to an arbitrary axis, these parameters set the axis numbers of a slanted axis and Cartesian axis. If 0 is set in either of the two parameters, the same number is set in the two parameters, or a number other than the controlled axis numbers is set in either of the two parameters, a slanted axis and Cartesian axis are selected as indicated in the following table:
Slanted axis M series T series Y-axis (axis with 2 set in parameter No. 1022) of the basic three axes X-axis (axis with 1 set in parameter No. 1022) of the basic three axes Cartesian axis Z-axis (axis with 3 set in parameter No. 1022) of the basic three axes Z-axis (axis with 3 set in parameter No. 1022) of the basic three axes

4.62
8301

PARAMETERS OF AXIS SYNCHRONOUS CONTROL


#7 #6 #5 #4 SYA #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #4 SYA In the servo-off state in axis synchronous control, the limit of the difference between the positioning deviation of the master axis and that of the slave axis is: 0: Checked. 1: Not checked.
- 417 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 8302 SMA #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1

B-63950EN/04

#0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#7 SMA When an absolute position detector is attached, and bit 4 (APZ) of parameter No. 1815 for an axis in synchronous operation is set to 0, APZ of the pairing axis in synchronous operation is: 0: Not set to OFF. 1: Set to OFF.
#7 8303 SOF #6 #5 #4 SYP #3 #2 SAF #1 ATS #0 ATE

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 ATE In axis synchronous control, automatic setting for grid positioning is: 0: Disabled 1: Enabled Set this parameter with a slave axis. ATS In axis synchronous control, automatic setting for grid positioning is: 0: Not started 1: Started Set this parameter with a slave axis.

#1

NOTE When starting automatic setting for grid positioning, set ATS to 1. Upon the completion of setting, ATS is automatically set to 0.
#2 SAF In axis synchronous control, a movement along a slave axis is: 0: Not added to actual feedrate display. 1: Added to actual feedrate display. Set this parameter with a slave axis. SYPx In axis synchronous control, some parameters must be set to the same value for the master and slave axes. When a value is set in such a parameter for the master axis: 0: The same value is not automatically set in the parameter for the slave axis. 1: The same value is automatically set in the parameter for the slave axis.

#4

- 418 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE 1 For the parameters that can be set automatically, refer to Subsection 1.6.8, "Automatic Setting of Parameters for Slave Axes", in Connection Manual (Function) (B-63943EN-1). 2 Set this parameter for both the master and slave axes.

#7

SOF In axis synchronous control, the synchronization establishment function based on machine coordinates is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. Set this parameter with a slave axis. When using synchronization error compensation, set this parameter to 0.
#7 #6 SMS #5 SCA #4 MVB #3 CLP #2 ADJ #1 SMC #0 SSA

8304

SYE

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 SSA When the one-direction synchronization establishment function under axis synchronous control is used: 0: The axis with a larger machine coordinate is used as the reference. 1: The axis with a smaller machine coordinate is used as the reference.

NOTE 1 When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued. 2 Set this parameter (SSA) to the same value for both the master and slave axes.
#1 SMC When a value for 3-dimensional machine position compensation is set for the master axis under axis synchronous control, the same value is: 0: Not output for the slave axis. 1: Output for the slave axis.

NOTE Set this parameter with a slave axis. When this parameter is set to 1 for a slave axis, the same 3-dimensional machine position compensation value as for the master axis is always output for the slave axis during synchronous operation. The value is not output during normal operation, however. (For the slave axis, compensation is also canceled when synchronous operation is released.)
#2 ADJ In axis synchronous control, this parameter specifies an axis along which a movement is made in the modification mode. 0: A movement is not made in the modification mode along the axis. 1: A movement is made in the modification mode along the axis. When this parameter is set to 1, the modification mode is set. Along an axis with this parameter set to 1, a movement is made by a move command for the master axis. Set this parameter for one of the master and slave axes.
- 419 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

When there are multiple slave axes for one master axis, set this parameter to 1 for an axis with which a synchronization error excessive alarm is issued for recovery. If an alarm is issued with multiple axes, modify this parameter after recovery of one axis to recover another axis. #3 CLP In axis feed synchronous control, synchronization error compensation is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. Set this parameter with a slave axis. MVB In the modification mode, a move command in a direction that increases a synchronization error is: 0: Ignored. 1: Valid. When there are multiple slave axes for one master axis, an attempt to reduce the synchronous error of a slave axis by a movement along the master axis can increase the synchronization error of another slave axis. If this parameter is set to 0 in such a case, a movement can be made in neither direction along the master axis. In this case, set bit 2 (ADJ) of parameter No. 8304 to make a movement along a slave axis to perform a corrective operation. SCA In axis synchronous control: 0: Synchronous operation is performed when the axis synchronous control manual feed selection signal SYNCJ <G0140> or the axis synchronous control selection signal SYNC <G0138> for slave axes is set to 1. 1: Synchronous operation is performed at all times. Set this parameter with a slave axis. SMS The synchronization error smooth suppress function is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. Set this parameter with a slave axis. SYE When external machine coordinate system shift is specified by external data input/output for the master axis in synchronous control, the slave axis is: 0: Not shifted. 1: Shifted by the same amount as specified for the master axis. Set this parameter for the slave axis. This function is disabled during normal operation.
#7 8305 #6 #5 #4 SLR #3 #2 SRF #1 SSE #0 SSO

#4

#5

#6

#7

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 SSO The uni-directional synchronization function in axis synchronous control is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. SSE After emergency stop, the uni-directional synchronization function in axis synchronous control is: 0: Enabled. 1: Disabled.
- 420 -

#1

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
SRF In axis synchronous control, G28, G30, and G53: 0: Make the same movement along the slave axis as a movement along the master axis. 1: Make movements along the slave axis and master axis independently to specified positions. SLR When G28 is specified for an axis under axis synchronous control for which the reference position is not established: 0: Alarm PS0213, ILLEGAL COMMAND IN SYNCHRO-MODE is issued. 1: Reference position return is performed at low speed.
Axis number of master axis in axis synchronous control

#2

#4

8311

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte axis [Valid data range] 0 to Number of controlled axes Select a master axis in axis synchronous control. In the parameter for the slave axis, set the axis number of the master axis. [Example 1] When one set of axis synchronous control is used: When the master axis is the first axis (X-axis), and the slave axis is the third axis (Z-axis), set parameter No. 8311 as follows: Parameter No. 8311 X (first axis) =0 Parameter No. 8311 Y (second axis) = 0 Parameter No. 8311 Z (third axis) =1 Parameter No. 8311 A (fourth axis) = 0 [Example 2] When three sets of axis synchronous control is used: When the master axes are the first axis, second axis, and third axis, and the slave axes are the sixth axis, fifth axis, and fourth axis, set parameter No. 8311 as follows: Parameter No. 8311 X (first axis) =0 Parameter No. 8311 Y (second axis) = 0 Parameter No. 8311 Z (third axis) =0 Parameter No. 8311 A (fourth axis) = 3 Parameter No. 8311 B (fifth axis) =2 Parameter No. 8311 C (sixth axis) =1
8312 Enabling/disabling mirror image in axis synchronous control

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis [Valid data range] -127 to 128 This parameter sets mirror image for the slave axis. When 100 or a more value is set with this parameter, the mirror image function is applied to synchronous control. Set this parameter to the slave axis. [Example] For reverse synchronization with the master axis being the third axis and the slave axis being the fourth axis, set parameter No. 8312 as follows: Parameter No. 8312 X (first axis) =0 Parameter No. 8312 Y (second axis) = 0 Parameter No. 8312 Z (third axis) =0 Parameter No. 8312 A (fourth axis) = 100

- 421 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE In synchronous operation with mirror image applied, synchronization error compensation, synchronization establishment, synchronization error checking, and modification mode cannot be used.
8314 Maximum allowable error in synchronization error check based on machine coordinates

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch, degree (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) This parameter sets a maximum allowable error in a synchronization error check based on machine coordinates. When the error between the master and slave axes in machine coordinates exceeds the value set in this parameter, the machine stops with the servo alarm SV0005, SYNC EXCESS ERROR (MCN). Set this parameter with a slave axis.

NOTE Set 0 in this parameter when a synchronization error check is not made.
8323 Limit in positional deviation check in axis synchronous control

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit 0 to 999999999 This parameter sets the maximum allowable difference between the master axis and slave axis position deviations. When the absolute value of a positional deviation difference exceeds the value set in this parameter in axis synchronous control, the alarm DS0001, SYNC EXCESS ERROR (POS DEV) is issued. Set this parameter with a slave axis. If 0 is specified in this parameter, no position deviation difference check is made.
Maximum compensation value in synchronization establishment based on machine coordinates

8325

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch, degree (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the maximum compensation value for synchronization. When a compensation value exceeding the value set in this parameter is detected, the servo alarm SV0001, SYNC ALIGNMENT ERROR is issued, and the synchronization establishment is not performed.

- 422 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Specify a slave axis for this parameter. To enable this parameter, set the bit 7 (SOF) of parameter No. 8303 to 1. When 0 is set in this parameter, synchronization establishment is not performed.

8326

Difference between master axis and slave axis reference counters

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit 0 to 999999999 The difference between the master axis reference counter and slave axis reference counter (master axis and slave axis grid shift) is automatically set when automatic setting for grid positioning is performed. Then, the difference is transferred together with an ordinary grid shift value to the servo system when the power is turned on. This parameter is set with a slave axis.
Torque difference alarm detection timer

8327

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis msec 0 to 4000 This parameter sets a time from the servo preparation completion signal, SA <F000.6>, being set to 1 until torque difference alarm detection is started in axis synchronous control. When 0 is set in this parameter, the specification of 512 msec is assumed. Set this parameter with a slave axis.
Multiplier for a maximum allowable synchronization error immediately after power-up

8330

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 1 to 100 Until synchronization establishment is completed immediately after power-up, synchronization error excessive alarm 2 is checked using the maximum allowable error (parameter No. 8332) multiplied by the value set in this parameter. If the result produced by multiplying the value of parameter No. 8332 by the value of this parameter exceeds 32767, the value is clamped to 32767.
8331 Maximum allowable synchronization error for synchronization error excessive alarm 1

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit 1 to 32767 This parameter sets a maximum allowable synchronization error for synchronization error excessive alarm 1. Set this parameter with a slave axis.

- 423 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
8332

B-63950EN/04

Maximum allowable synchronization error for synchronization error excessive alarm 2

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit 1 to 32767 This parameter sets a maximum allowable synchronization error for synchronization error excessive alarm 2. Set this parameter with a slave axis.
Synchronization error zero width for each axis

8333

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit 1 to 32767 When a synchronization error below the value set in this parameter is detected, synchronization error compensation is not performed. Set this parameter with a slave axis.
Synchronization error compensation gain for each axis

8334

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis [Valid data range] 1 to 1024 This parameter sets a synchronization error compensation gain. Compensation pulses found by the following expression are output for the slave axis: Compensation pulses = Synchronization error (Ci/1024) Ci: Compensation gain Set this parameter with a slave axis.
8335 Synchronization error zero width 2 for each axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit 0 to 32767 This parameter sets synchronization error zero width 2 for synchronization error smooth suppression. Set this parameter with a slave axis.

NOTE Set a value less than the value set in parameter No. 8333.
8336 Synchronization error compensation gain 2 for each axis

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis [Valid data range] 0 to 1024
- 424 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
This parameter sets synchronization error compensation gain 2 for synchronization error smooth suppression. Set this parameter with a slave axis.

NOTE Set a value less than the value set in parameter No. 8334.
8337 8338 M code for turning off synchronization in axis synchronous control M code for turning on synchronization in axis synchronous control

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 1 to 999999999 This parameter specifies an M code for switching between synchronous operation and normal operation. The M code set in this parameter is not buffered.

CAUTION To switch between synchronous operation and normal operation, specify the M code set in parameter No. 8337 or 8338.

4.63
8341

PARAMETERS OF SEQUENCE NUMBER COMPARISON AND STOP


Program number subject to comparison and stop

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 1 to 99999999 This parameter sets the program number, including a sequence number, subject to sequence number comparison and stop. Parameter No. 8342 is used to set a sequence number subject to check termination.
8342 Sequence number subject to comparison and stop

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to 99999999 This parameter sets the sequence number subject to sequence number comparison and stop. If the block containing the sequence number set with this parameter is executed while the program set with parameter No. 8341 is being executed, a single block stop occurs after the block is executed. At this time, the setting is automatically set to -1.

- 425 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE 1 When -1 is set in parameter No. 8342, comparison and stop is disabled. 2 Comparison and stop cannot be performed using a sequence number contained in a block (such as a macro statement, M98, and M99) that is processed only inside the CNC. 3 When a match is found with the sequence number of a block (such as an L specification of a canned cycle) that specifies the number of repeats, operation stops after executing as many times as the number of repeats. 4 If the sequence number set in parameter No. 8342 appears more than once in the program, operation stops at the block where the first match is found in the order of execution.

4.64
8360

PARAMETERS OF CHOPPING
#7 CHF #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 CVC #1 #0 ROV

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit path #0 ROV As rapid traverse override for a section from the chopping start point to point R: 0: Chopping override is used. 1: Rapid traverse override is used. CVC The feedrate along the chopping axis is changed: 0: At the upper or lower dead point immediately after the feedrate change command is issued. 1: At the upper dead point immediately after the feedrate change command is issued. CHF On the chopping screen, the chopping feedrate: 0: Can be set. 1: Cannot be set.
Chopping axis

#2

#7

8370

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to Number of controlled axes This parameter sets which servo axis the chopping axis corresponds to.
8371 Chopping reference point (point R)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch, deg (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) The data set in this parameter is absolute coordinates.

- 426 -

B-63950EN/04 8372

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Chopping upper dead point

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch, deg (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) The data set in this parameter is absolute coordinates.
Chopping lower dead point

8373

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch, deg (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) The data set in this parameter is absolute coordinates.
Chopping feedrate

8374

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm/min, inch/min, deg/min (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) This parameter sets the chopping feedrate.
Maximum chopping feedrate

8375

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, deg/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) The chopping feedrate is clamped at this parameter setting. The maximum feedrate must be set for the chopping axis. If this parameter is set to 0, no movement is made for chopping.
Chopping compensation factor

8376

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Byte path % 0 to 100 The value obtained by multiply the sum of the servo delay in an chopping operation and the acceleration/deceleration delay by the rate set in this parameter is used as chopping delay compensation. When this parameter is set to 0, chopping delay compensation is not applied.

- 427 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
8377 Chopping compensation start tolerance

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word path Detection unit 0 to 99999999 In a chopping operation, compensation is applied when the difference between an amount of shortage at the upper dead point and that at the lower dead point due to the servo position control delay is less than the value set in this parameter. When this parameter is set to 0, compensation is not applied.

4.65
8412

PARAMETERS OF AI CONTOUR CONTROL (1 OF 2)


#7 #6 #5 FDI #4 #3 #2 #1 HIK #0 EST

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 EST The simple NURBS interpolation start function is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. HIK The high-precision knot command of NURBS interpolation is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. FDI Parametric feedrate control of NURBS interpolation is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
#7 8451 NOF #6 #5 #4 ZAG #3 #2 #1 #0

#1

#5

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit path #4 ZAG The deceleration function based on cutting load in AI contour control (deceleration based on Z-axis fall angle) is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed. When this parameter is set to 1, be sure to set parameter Nos. 8456, 8457, and 8458. NOF In AI contour control, an F command is: 0: Not ignored. 1: Ignored. When this parameter is set to 1, the specification of the maximum allowable feedrate set in parameter No. 8465 is assumed.

#7

- 428 -

B-63950EN/04 8456

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Override for range 2 that is applied during deceleration according to the cutting load in AI contour control Override for range 3 that is applied during deceleration according to the cutting load in AI contour control Override for range 4 that is applied during deceleration according to the cutting load in AI contour control

8457

8458

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Word path % 1 to 100 For the function of decelerating according to the cutting load in AI contour control, the override set in a parameter can be applied according to the angle at which the tool moves downward along the Z-axis. The feedrate obtained according to other conditions is multiplied by the override for the range containing angle at which the tool moves downward. However, when bit 1 (ZG2) of parameter No. 19515 is set to 0, no parameter is available to range 1, and 100% is applied at all times. When bit 1 (ZG2) of parameter No. 19515 is set to 1, set an override value for range 1 in parameter No. 19516. Range 1 0<30 Range 2 30<45 Range 3 45<60 Range 4 6090
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 OVRB #2 #1 #0

8459

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #3 OVRB For deceleration based on a feedrate difference or acceleration rate in AI contour control, override is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. Usually, override is enabled for a specified feedrate, and AI contour control is applied to the specified feedrate. When this parameter is set to 1, override is applied to a feedrate placed under AI contour control.
Maximum allowable feedrate for AI contour control

8465

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real path mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) This parameter sets the maximum allowable feedrate for contour control. If a feedrate higher than the setting of this parameter is specified in the AI contour control mode, the feedrate is clamped to that set in this parameter. If this parameter is set to 0, no clamping is performed. When bit 7 (NOF) of parameter No. 8451 is set to 1, the tool moves, assuming that the feedrate set in this parameter is specified. If 0 is set in this parameter at this time, a movement is made at the specified feedrate.
- 429 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
8466

B-63950EN/04

Maximum allowable feedrate for AI contour control (when a rotation axis is singly specified)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real path mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) This parameter sets the maximum allowable feedrate for AI contour control when a rotation axis is singly specified. If a feedrate higher than the setting of this parameter is specified in the AI contour control mode, the feedrate is clamped to that set in this parameter. If this parameter is set to 0, the feedrate is clamped to that set in parameter No. 8465. When bit 7 (NOF) of parameter No. 8451 is set to 1 and a rotation axis is singly specified, the tool moves, assuming that the feedrate set in this parameter is specified. If 0 is set in this parameter at this time, the tool moves at the feedrate specified in parameter No. 8465.
Maximum travel distance of a block where smooth interpolation or Nano smoothing is applied

8486

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter specifies a block length used as a reference to decide whether to apply smooth interpolation or Nano smoothing. If the line specified in a block is longer than the value set in the parameter, smooth interpolation or Nano smoothing is not applied to that block.
Angle at which smooth interpolation or Nano smoothing is turned off

8487

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real path Degree Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 0 to 90 This parameter sets the angle used to determine whether to apply smooth interpolation or Nano smoothing. At a point having a difference in angle greater than this setting, smooth interpolation or Nano smoothing is turned off.
Minimum travel distance of a block where smooth interpolation or Nano smoothing is applied

8490

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets a block length used to determine whether to apply smooth interpolation or Nano smoothing. If the line specified in a block is shorter than the value set in this parameter, smooth interpolation or Nano smoothing is not applied to that block.
- 430 -

B-63950EN/04 8491

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Maximum tolerance for a block where smooth interpolation is applied

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets a tolerance for deciding whether to perform smooth interpolation. For a block that has a tolerance greater than the value set in this parameter, smooth interpolation is not performed. When 0 is set in this parameter, a tolerance-based decision is not made.
Minimum tolerance for a block where smooth interpolation is applied

8492

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets a tolerance for deciding whether to perform smooth interpolation. For a block that has a tolerance less than the value set in this parameter, smooth interpolation is not performed. Usually, set a value of about 1/10 of the maximum tolerance value (set in parameter No. 8491). When 0.0 is set, 1/10 of the maximum tolerance (set in parameter No. 8491) is used as a minimum tolerance. When a negative value is set, a minimum tolerance of 0.0 is assumed.

4.66
8500

PARAMETERS OF HIGH-SPEED POSITION SWITCH (1 OF 2)


#7 HPE #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #7 HPE The maximum number of high-speed position switches is: 0: 6. 1: 16.
#7 8501 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 HPD #1 HPS #0 HPF

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.

- 431 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#0 HPF The output signal of a high-speed position switch is output to: 0: Address Y. 1: Address F. HPS The current position used with the high-speed position switch: 0: Considers a servo error. 1: Does not consider a servo error.

B-63950EN/04

#1

#2

HPD When a high-speed position switch of direction decision type has reached (not passed) a set coordinate in a specified direction, the switch: 0: Does not operate. 1: Operates.
#7 #6 E07 #6 E15 #5 E06 #5 E14 #4 E05 #4 E13 #3 E04 #3 E12 #2 E03 #2 E11 #1 E02 #1 E10 #0 E01 #0 E09

8504

E08 #7

8505

E16

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path E01 to E16 These parameters specify whether to enable or disable each corresponding high-speed position switch. The following table shows the correspondence between the bits and switches. The settings of each bit have the following meaning: 0: The switch corresponding to the bit is enabled. 1: The switch corresponding to the bit is disabled (always outputs 0).
Parameter E01 E02 E03 : E16
#7 8508 D08 #7 8509 D16 #6 D07 #6 D15 #5 D06 #5 D14 #4 D05 #4 D13

Switch 1st high-speed position switch 2nd high-speed position switch 3rd high-speed position switch : 16th high-speed position switch
#3 D04 #3 D12 #2 D03 #2 D11 #1 D02 #1 D10 #0 D01 #0 D09

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
D01 to D16 These parameters set the output type of each corresponding high-speed position switch. The following table shows the correspondence between the bits and switches. The settings of each bit have the following meaning: 0: The output type of the switch corresponding to the bit is normal. 1: The output type of the switch corresponding to the bit is decision by direction.
Parameter D01 Switch 1st high-speed position switch

- 432 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Parameter D02 D03 : D16
#7 #6 A07 #6 A15 #5 A06 #5 A14 #4 A05 #4 A13

Switch 2nd high-speed position switch 3rd high-speed position switch : 16th high-speed position switch
#3 A04 #3 A12 #2 A03 #2 A11 #1 A02 #1 A10 #0 A01 #0 A09

8512

A08 #7

8513

A16

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path A01 to A16 These parameters set the passing direction in which each corresponding high-speed position switch is turned on. The following table shows the correspondence between the bits and switches. The settings of each bit have the following meaning: 0: The high-speed position switch is turned on when the tool passes through the coordinates for turning the switch on in the negative (-) direction. 1: The high-speed position switch is turned on when the tool passes through the coordinates for turning the switch on in the positive (+) direction.
Parameter A01 A02 A03 : A16
#7 8516 B08 #7 8517 B16 #6 B07 #6 B15 #5 B06 #5 B14 #4 B05 #4 B13

Switch 1st high-speed position switch 2nd high-speed position switch 3rd high-speed position switch : 16th high-speed position switch
#3 B04 #3 B12 #2 B03 #2 B11 #1 B02 #1 B10 #0 B01 #0 B09

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path B01 to B16 These parameters set the passing direction in which each corresponding high-speed position switch is turned off. The following table shows the correspondence between the bits and switches. The settings of each bit have the following meaning: 0: The high-speed position switch is turned off when the tool passes through the coordinates for turning the switch off in the negative (-) direction. 1: The high-speed position switch is turned off when the tool passes through the coordinates for turning the switch off in the positive (+) direction.
Parameter B01 B02 B03 : B16 Switch 1st high-speed position switch 2nd high-speed position switch 3rd high-speed position switch : 16th high-speed position switch

- 433 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
8565 Output address of the high-speed position switch signal

B-63950EN/04

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to 126 This parameter sets a Y signal address to which the high-speed position switch signal is output. The Y signal addresses consisting of the value set in this parameter and the set value plus 1 are used. If a nonexistent address is set, the high-speed position switch function is disabled. When bit 0 (HPF) of parameter No. 8501 is set to 1, however, this parameter has no effect.
8570 8571 to 8579 Controlled axis for which the tenth high-speed position switch function is performed Controlled axis for which the first high-speed position switch function is performed Controlled axis for which the second high-speed position switch function is performed

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to number of controlled axes Each of these parameters sets a controlled axis number for which each of the first to tenth high-speed position switch functions is performed. Set 0 for the number corresponding to a high-speed position switch which is not to be used.

NOTE For the 11th to 16th, see parameters Nos. 12201 to 12206.
8580 8581 to 8589 Maximum value of the operation range of the tenth high-speed position switch Maximum value of the operation range of the first high-speed position switch Maximum value of the operation range of the second high-speed position switch

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch, degree (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Each of these parameters sets the maximum value of the operation range of each of the first to tenth high-speed position switches. If such a setting that maximum value < minimum value is made, no operation range exists, so that the high-speed position switch does not operate.

NOTE For the 11th to 16th, see parameters Nos. 12221 to 12226.
8590 Minimum value of the operation range of the first high-speed position switch

- 434 -

B-63950EN/04 8591 to 8599

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Minimum value of the operation range of the second high-speed position switch Minimum value of the operation range of the tenth high-speed position switch

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch, degree (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Each of these parameters sets the minimum value of the operation range of each of the first to tenth high-speed position switches. If such a setting that maximum value < minimum value is made, no operation range exists, so that the high-speed position switch does not operate.

NOTE For the 11th to 16th, see parameter Nos. 12241 to 12246.

4.67
8650

OTHER PARAMETERS
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 EKY #1 CNA #0 RSK

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 RSK After the 0: 1: #1 key is pressed, the key code is:

Not passed to the application program. Passed to the application program.

CNA When a CNC alarm is issued while the user screen of C Language Executor is being displayed, automatic switching to the alarm screen is: 0: Determined by the setting of bit 7 (NPA) of parameter No. 3111. 1: Not performed, regardless of the setting of bit 7 (NPA) of parameter No. 3111. EKY The MDI key extension portion is: 0: Not read. 1: Read.

#2

#7 8654 WGS

#6

#5 DCC

#4 CRS

#3 CTM

#2 CGC

#1 CXW

#0 NVS

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit

- 435 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 NVS When an MDI unit with a 10.4-inch LCD unit is used, the vertical soft keys on the CNC screen: 0: Can be used. 1: Cannot be used. CXW If no display unit is used, C Language Executor is started: 0: Simultaneously when the CNC screen display function is started. 1: Simultaneously when the CNC is started. CGC When the crt_setmode function is called, the graphic plane is: 0: Cleared. 1: Not cleared. CTM The task execution status monitor screen is: 0: Not displayed. 1: Displayed. CRS When C Language Executor is used, communication is: 0: Performed at lower than the specified baud rate of RS-232C (conventional specification). 1: Performed at the specified baud rate of RS-232C. DCC With the rs_status function of C Language Executor, the transmission stop status and reception stop status are: 0: Posted. 1: Not posted. WGS When C Language Executor is used, the win_getstat function for acquiring the status of multiwindow display is based on: 0: Series 30i/31i/32i specification. 1: Series 16i/18i/21i specification. When the current status of window display is acquired using the win_getstat function with the Series 30i/31i/32i specification, the value of the window handle decremented by 1 is set in "winstack[ ]" for storing the stacking order of open windows, in "active" for storing the window handle of the currently active window, and in "selected" for storing the window handle of the currently selected window. With the Series 16i/18i/21i specification, the value of the window handle is set. With the Series 30i/31i/32i specification, the value of the window handle starts with 0 as 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, then 7. With the 16i/18i/21i specification, the value of the window handle starts with 1 as 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, then 8.
#7 8655 RCC #6 #5 HM2 #4 HM1 #3 CTS #2 #1 MT2 #0 MT1

#1

#2

#3

#4

#5

#7

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit

- 436 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.

#0 #1

MT1 MT2 Sets a Middle-Level task start interval when C Language Executor is used.
MT2 0 0 1 1 MT1 0 1 0 1 Start cycle Once per 2 High-Level tasks Once per 4 High-Level tasks Once per 8 High-Level tasks Once per 16 High-Level tasks

#3

CTS When the crt_cncscrn function is executed from the main task of C Language Executor, the main task is: 0: Not stopped at the end of the function (is stopped after processing is performed for a very short time). 1: Stopped at the end of the function. HM1 HM2 These parameters set the time allocation for high- and middle-level tasks.
Time allocation (ratio) between High-Level task and Middle-Level task High-level task Middle-level task 3 5 1 3 1 3 1 5

#4 #5

HM1 0 0 1 1

HM2 0 1 0 1

#7

RCC When the rs_close function is executed in RS-232C communication of C Language Executor with DC control exercised in the transmission/reception mode: 0: Communication is ended after checking the DC code of the communication destination device. 1: Communication is ended without checking the DC code of the communication destination device.
Size of variable area

8661

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input Word path KByte 0 to 59(251) When C Language Executor is used, this parameter sets the size of the static variable area sharable among tasks. Set a size in steps of 1K bytes. The maximum specifiable size is 59K bytes (or 251K bytes when the SRAM256KB option is selected). However, ensure that the sum of this size and the size of the SRAM disk does not exceed (usable SRAM size - 1)K bytes (namely, 63K bytes or 255K bytes). When the setting of this parameter is modified, the variable area and SRAM disk are initialized.
- 437 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
8662 Size of SRAM disk

B-63950EN/04

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input Word path KByte 4 to 63(255) When C Language Executor is used, this parameter sets the size of the SRAM disk. Set a size not smaller than 4K bytes in steps of 1K bytes. The maximum specifiable size is 63K bytes (or 255K bytes when the SRAM256KB option is selected). However, ensure that the sum of this size and the size of the variable area does not exceed (usable SRAM size 1)K bytes (namely, 63K bytes or 255K bytes). When the setting of this parameter is modified, the SRAM disk is initialized.
Setting of time zone

8663

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input 2-word path sec -123600 to 123600 This parameter sets the time difference from the Greenwich time in seconds. The time difference of Japan is -9 hours. So, set -32400 (= -93600) seconds.
Program number of data input/output (Power Mate CNC manager)

8760

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to 99999999 This parameter sets the program numbers of programs to be used for inputting and outputting slave data (parameters) when the Power Mate CNC manager function is used. For a slave specified with I/O LINK channel m and group n, the following program number is used: Setting + (m - 1) 100 + n 10
8781 Size of DRAM used with C Language Executor

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input Byte path 64KByte 12 to 96
- 438 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
This parameter sets the size of the DRAM used with C Language Executor. Set a value not smaller than 768K bytes in steps of 64K bytes. If a value not within the valid data range is set, the specification of 0 is assumed. When the specified value is 0, C Language Executor is not started.

NOTE The actually usable size is limited by the RAM capacity and selected option(s).
8783 Size of DRAM used with C Language Executor (for application program with "EXP_DRAMSIZE = ON" enabled in MAKEFILE setting)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word 64KByte 16 to 128 This parameter sets the size of the DRAM used with C Language Executor to operate a C Language Executor application program created with "EXP_DRAMSIZE = ON" enabled in MAKEFILE setting. Set a size not smaller than 1MB (a value not less than 16) in steps of 64K bytes. If a value not within the valid data range is set, the specification of 0 is assumed. When the specified value is 0, C Language Executor is not started. If an application program created with "EXP_DRAMSIZE = OFF" enabled is loaded to the CNC, the setting of this parameter is not used. Instead, the setting of parameter No. 8781 for specifying the DRAM size used with C Language Executor is used.
#7 #6 #6 #5 #5 #4 #4 #3 #3 #2 #2 #1 #1 #0 #0

8801 #7 8802

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path


8811 to 8813

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word


8814 to 8816

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path Parameters Nos. 8801 to 8802, 8811 to 8813, and 8814 to 8816 are designed specifically for use by the machine tool builder, and the usage of these parameters varies from machine to machine. For details, refer to the manual issued by the machine tool builder.

- 439 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

4.68
8900

PARAMETERS OF MAINTENANCE
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 PWE

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit #0 PWE The setting, from an external device and MDI panel, of those parameters that cannot be set by setting input is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
#7 8901 MEN #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 FAN

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit path #0 FAN A fan motor error is: 0: Detected. 1: Not detected.

NOTE Be sure to set this parameter to 0.


#7 MEN The periodic maintenance screen is: 0: Displayed. 1: Not displayed.
Percentage for life warning display on the periodic maintenance screen

8911

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Byte path % 0 to 99 On the periodic maintenance screen, if the remaining time of an item falls to a value less than the percentage of the life specified in this parameter, the item name and remaining time is displayed in red as a warning.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 MEM

8950

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 MEM The memory contents display screen is: 0: Not displayed. 1: Is displayed.

- 440 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

4.69
10000 to 10019

PARAMETERS OF THE INCORRECT OPERATION PREVENTION FUNCTION


Lower limit 1 of tool offsets No. 01 to Lower limit 1 of tool offsets No. 20

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the lower limits of the following offset values: T series, without tool geometry/wear offsets, X-axis offset T series, with tool geometry/wear offsets, X-axis and geometry offsets M series, tool offset memory A offset M series, tool offset memory B and geometry offsets M series, tool offset memory C, geometry, and length offsets
Upper limit 1 of tool offsets No. 01 to Upper limit 1 of tool offsets No. 20

10020 to 10039

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the upper limits of the following offset values: T series, without tool geometry/wear offsets, X-axis offset T series, with tool geometry/wear offsets, X-axis and geometry offsets M series, tool offset memory A offset M series, tool offset memory B and geometry offsets M series, tool offset memory C, geometry, and length offsets
Lower limit 2 of tool offsets No. 01 to Lower limit 2of tool offsets No. 20

10040 to 10059

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the lower limits of the following offset values: T series, without tool geometry/wear offsets, Z-axis offset T series, with tool geometry/wear offsets, Z-axis and geometry offsets M series, tool offset memory C, geometry, and radius offsets

- 441 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
10060 to 10079 Upper limit 2 of tool offsets No. 01 to Upper limit 2 of tool offsets No. 20

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the upper limits of the following offset values: T series, without tool geometry/wear offsets, Z-axis offset T series, with tool geometry/wear offsets, Z-axis and geometry offsets M series, tool offset memory C, geometry, and radius offsets
Lower limit 3 of tool offsets No. 01 to Lower limit 3 of tool offsets No. 20

10080 to 10099

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the lower limits of the following offset values: T series, without tool geometry/wear offsets, tool nose radius offset T series, with tool geometry/wear offsets, tool nose radius and geometry offsets
Upper limit 3 of tool offsets No. 01 to Upper limit 3 of tool offsets No. 20

10100 to 10119

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the upper limits of the following offset values: T series, without tool geometry/wear offsets, tool nose radius offset T series, with tool geometry/wear offsets, tool nose radius and geometry offsets
Lower limit 4 of tool offsets No. 01 to Lower limit 4 of tool offsets No. 20

10120 to 10139

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the lower limits of the following offset values:
- 442 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
T series, with tool geometry/wear offsets, X-axis and wear offsets M series, tool offset memory B and wear offsets M series, tool offset memory C, wear, and length offsets
Upper limit 4 of tool offsets No. 01 to Upper limit 4 of tool offsets No. 20

10140 to 10159

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the upper limits of the following offset values: T series, with tool geometry/wear offsets, X-axis and wear offsets M series, tool offset memory B and wear offsets M series, tool offset memory C, wear, and length offsets
Lower limit 5 of tool offsets No. 01 to Lower limit 5 of tool offsets No. 20

10160 to 10179

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the lower limits of the following offset values: T series, with tool geometry/wear offsets, Z-axis and wear offsets M series, tool offset memory C, wear, and radius offsets
Upper limit 5 of tool offsets No. 01 to Upper limit 5 of tool offsets No. 20

10180 to 10199

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the upper limits of the following offset values: T series, with tool geometry/wear offsets, Z-axis and wear offsets M series, tool offset memory C, wear, and radius offsets
Lower limit 6 of tool offsets No. 01 to Lower limit 6 of tool offsets No. 20

10200 to 10219

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Real path [Unit of data] mm, inch, degree (input unit)
- 443 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

[Min. unit of data] Depend on the increment system of the applied axis [Valid data range] 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the lower limits of the following offset values: T series, with tool geometry/wear offsets, tool noise radius and wear offsets
10220 to 10239 Upper limit 6 of tool offsets No. 01 to Upper limit 6 of tool offsets No. 20

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the upper limits of the following offset values: T series, with tool geometry/wear offsets, tool noise radius and wear offsets
Lower limit 1 of a tool offset number range No. 01 to Lower limit 1 of a tool offset number range No. 20

10240 to 10259

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to maximum number of offset sets Each of these parameters sets the lower limit of a tool offset number range. These parameters correspond to the tool offset lower/upper limits set in parameters Nos. 10000 to 10239.
10260 to 10279 Upper limit 1 of a tool offset number range No. 01 to Upper limit 1 of a tool offset number range No. 20

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to maximum number of offset sets Each of these parameters sets the upper limit of a tool offset number range. These parameters correspond to the tool offset lower/upper limits set in parameters Nos. 10000 to 10239.
10280 to 10283 Lower limit 7 of tool offsets No. 01 to Lower limit 7 of tool offsets No. 04

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the lower limits of the following offset values: T series, without tool geometry/wear offsets, Y-axis offset T series, with tool geometry/wear offsets, Y-axis and geometry offsets
- 444 -

B-63950EN/04 10284 to 10287

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Upper limit 7 of tool offsets No. 01 to Upper limit 7 of tool offsets No. 04

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the upper limits of the following offset values: T series, without tool geometry/wear offsets, Y-axis offset T series, with tool geometry/wear offsets, Y-axis and geometry offsets
Lower limit 8 of tool offsets No. 01 to Lower limit 8 of tool offsets No. 04

10288 to 10291

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the lower limits of the following offset values: T series, with tool geometry/wear offsets, Y-axis and wear offsets
Upper limit 8 of tool offsets No. 01 to Upper limit 8 of tool offsets No. 04

10292 to 10295

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the upper limits of the following offset values: T series, with tool geometry/wear offsets, Y-axis and wear offsets
Lower limit 2 of a tool offset number range No. 01 to Lower limit 2 of a tool offset number range No. 04

10296 to 10299

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to maximum number of offset sets Each of these parameters sets the lower limit of a tool offset number range. These parameters correspond to the tool offset lower/upper limits set in parameters Nos. 10280 to 10295.

- 445 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
10300 to 10303 Upper limit 2 of a tool offset number range No. 01 to Upper limit 2 of a tool offset number range No. 04

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to maximum number of offset sets Each of these parameters sets the upper limit of a tool offset number range. These parameters correspond to the tool offset lower/upper limits set in parameters Nos. 10280 to 10295.
10304 to 10309 Lower limit of workpiece zero point offsets No. 01 to Lower limit of workpiece zero point offsets No. 06

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Each of these parameters sets the lower limit of workpiece zero point offset values.
Upper limit of workpiece zero point offsets No. 01 to Upper limit of workpiece zero point offsets No. 06

10310 to 10315

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Each of these parameters sets the upper limit of workpiece zero point offset values.
Lower limit of a workpiece zero point offset range No. 01 to Lower limit of a workpiece zero point offset range No. 06

10316 to 10321

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to maximum number of offset sets Each of these parameters sets the lower limit of a workpiece zero point offset range. For an additional workpiece coordinate system, set a value after adding 1000. These parameters correspond to the workpiece zero point offset lower/upper limits set in parameters Nos. 10304 to 10315.
10322 to 10327 Upper limit of a workpiece zero point offset range No. 01 to Upper limit of a workpiece zero point offset range No. 06

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to maximum number of offset sets
- 446 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Each of these parameters sets the upper limit of a workpiece zero point offset range. For an additional workpiece coordinate system, set a value after adding 1000. These parameters correspond to the workpiece zero point offset lower/upper limits set in parameters Nos. 10304 to 10315.

10328

Lower limit of workpiece shifts

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets a workpiece shift lower limit.
Upper limit of workpiece shifts

10329

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets a workpiece shift upper limit.
#7 #6 ASD #5 EBC #4 MID #3 HSC #2 ADC #1 PDC #0 IIC

10330

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 IIC At the time of incremental input, a confirmation message is: 0: Displayed. 1: Not displayed. PDC At the time of program deletion, a confirmation message is: 0: Displayed. 1: Not displayed. ADC At the time of deletion of all data, a confirmation message is: 0: Displayed. 1: Not displayed. HSC When a cycle start is executed halfway in the program, a confirmation message is: 0: Displayed. 1: Not displayed. MID Updated modal information is: 0: Highlighted. 1: Not highlighted. EBC Program sum checking is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
- 447 -

#1

#2

#3

#4

#5

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#6 ASD Axis state display is: 0: Enabled. 1: Disabled.
Lower limit of external workpiece zero point offsets

B-63950EN/04

10331

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the lower limit of external workpiece zero point offsets.
Upper limit of external workpiece zero point offsets

10332

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the upper limit of external workpiece zero point offsets.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 MSC

10335

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 MSC A recheck on the intermediate block start of the incorrect operation prevention function is: 0: Enabled independently for each path. 1: Enabled for the local path and those paths for this parameter is set to 1.

4.70
10340

PARAMETERS OF AUTOMATIC DATA BACKUP


#7 EEB #6 EIB #5 #4 #3 #2 AAP #1 ABI #0 ABP

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 ABP Automatic data backup at power-on is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. ABI Overwrite-protected backup data is: 0: Regarded as invalid. 1: Regarded as valid. AAP Backup of NC programs and directory information in FROM is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
- 448 -

#1

#2

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
EIB When the CNC is turned on next, overwrite-protected backup data is: 0: Not updated. 1: Updated.

#6

NOTE This parameter is valid when 2 or a greater value is set in parameter No. 10342, and bit 1 (ABI) of parameter No. 10340 is set to 1.
#7 EEB When an emergency stop occurs, a backup operation is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed.

NOTE This parameter is valid when 1 or a greater value is set in parameter No. 10342.
10341 Interval at which automatic data backup is performed periodically

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word No unit 0 to 365 When automatic data backup is performed periodically, this parameter sets the interval as the number of days. When the power is turned on after a set number of days has passed from the date of the previous backup, a backup operation is performed. If 0 is set in this parameter, this function is disabled.
Number of backup data items

10342

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Byte No unit 0 to 3 This parameter sets the number of backup data items. If 0 is specified, backup is not performed.

4.71
10350

PARAMETERS OF AXIS CONTROL


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 PSI

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 PSI Pulse superimposed function is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.

- 449 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE Use the pulse superimposed mode switching signal PSIM <Gn578.7> to enable and disable the pulse superimposed function.
#7 10359 #6 #5 #4 #3 KVD #2 KVC #1 KVB #0 KVA

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 KVA The gear ratio override signal of flexible synchronization group A is: 0: Disabled (fixed at 100%). 1: Enabled. KVB The gear ratio override signal of flexible synchronization group B is: 0: Disabled (fixed at 100%). 1: Enabled. KVC The gear ratio override signal of flexible synchronization group C is: 0: Disabled (fixed at 100%). 1: Enabled. KVD The gear ratio override signal of flexible synchronization group D is: 0: Disabled (fixed at 100%). 1: Enabled.

#1

#2

#3

4.72
10360

PARAMETERS OF PARALLEL AXIS CONTROL


Bias value for the offset number of a tool offset for each axis

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Word axis [Valid data range] 0 to the number of tool offsets When parallel operation is performed, this parameter specifies a bias value for the offset number of a tool offset for each axis. The offset data to be used as a tool offset for an axis has a number obtained by adding a value set in this parameter for the axis to a specified offset number.
10361

Bias for the offset number of tool length compensation for each axis

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Word axis [Valid data range] 0 to the number of tool offsets When parallel operation is performed, this parameter specifies a bias value for the offset number of tool length compensation for each axis. The offset data to be used as the tool length compensation amount for an axis has a number obtained by adding a value set in this parameter for the axis to a specified offset number.

- 450 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

4.73
10370

PARAMETERS OF AXIS SWITCHING


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 RPC

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit path #0 RPC When a return from the reference position (G29) is made, axis switching is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
Axis switching number

10371

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 5 One of six types of axis switching can be selected by setting its axis switching number in this parameter. Programmed addresses X, Y, and Z correspond to machine axes x, y, and z as follows:
Axis switching No. 0 1 2 3 4 5 Programmed address Y y z x z x y

X x x y y z z

Z z y z x y x

Axis switching number 0 indicates that axis switching is not performed.

4.74
10410

PARAMETERS OF TOOL RETRACT AND RECOVER


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 NRT

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 NRT In tool retract and recover or manual intervention and return, the axis is: 0: Subject to tool retract and recover or manual intervention and return. 1: Not subject to tool retract and recover or manual intervention and return.

4.75
10421 10422 to 10435

PARAMETERS OF SCREEN DISPLAY COLORS (2 OF 2)


RGB value of color palette 1 for text for color set 2 RGB value of color palette 2 for text for color set 2 to RGB value of color palette 15 for text for color set 2

[Input type] Parameter input


- 451 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

[Data type] 2-word [Valid data range] 0 to 151515 Each of these parameters sets the RGB value of each color palette for text by specifying a 6-digit number as described below. rrggbb: 6-digit number (rr: red data, gg: green data, bb: blue data) The valid data range of each color is 0 to 15 (same as the tone levels on the color setting screen). When a number equal to or greater than 16 is specified, the specification of 15 is assumed. [Example] When the tone level of a color is: red:1 green:2, blue:3, set 10203 in the parameter.
10461 10462 to 10475 RGB value of color palette 1 for text for color set 3 RGB value of color palette 2 for text for color set 3 to RGB value of color palette 15 for text for color set 3

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word [Valid data range] 0 to 151515 Each of these parameters sets the RGB value of each color palette for text by specifying a 6-digit number as described below. rrggbb: 6-digit number (rr: red data, gg: green data, bb: blue data) The valid data range of each color is 0 to 15 (same as the tone levels on the color setting screen). When a number equal to or greater than 16 is specified, the specification of 15 is assumed. [Example] When the tone level of a color is: red:1 green:2, blue:3, set 10203 in the parameter.

4.76
10485

PARAMETERS OF SMOOTH TCP


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 STC

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit path #0 STC If, in a TCP start block (G43.4), address "L" is omitted, TCP is: 0: Started as normal TCP. 1: Started as smooth TCP.
First rotation axis compensation tolerance in smooth TCP mode

10486

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real path degree Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) If the first rotation axis is compensated in smooth TCP, the maximum change from the specified value before compensation is limited by this setting. The first rotation axis is the axis specified for parameter No. 19681. If 0 is set in this parameter, the first rotation axis is not compensated. If a value other than 0 is set in parameter No. 10490, this parameter is clamped with the value of parameter No. 10490 as the upper limit.
- 452 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Second rotation axis compensation tolerance in smooth TCP mode

10487

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real path degree Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) If the second rotation axis is compensated in smooth TCP, the maximum change from the specified value before compensation is limited by this setting. The second rotation axis is the axis specified for parameter No. 19686. If 0 is set in this parameter, the second rotation axis is not compensated. If a value other than 0 is set in parameter No. 10491, this parameter is clamped with the value of parameter No. 10491 as the upper limit.
Maximum first rotation axis compensation tolerance in smooth TCP mode

10490

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path degree Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) If a value other than 0 is set in this parameter and the setting of parameter No. 10486 is equal to or greater than the setting of this parameter, the setting of this parameter is regarded as the setting of parameter No. 10486. If 0 is set in this parameter, parameter No. 10486 is not limited.
Maximum second rotation axis compensation tolerance in smooth TCP mode

10491

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path degree Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) If a value other than 0 is set in this parameter and the setting of parameter No. 10487 is equal to or greater than the setting of this parameter, the setting of this parameter is regarded as the setting of parameter No. 10487. If 0 is set in this parameter, parameter No. 10487 is not limited.

4.77
10500 10501 to 10596

PARAMETERS OF DUAL CHECK SAFETY (1 OF 2)


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 STP #2 #1 APM #0 AVM

to

- 453 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
These parameters are related to Dual Check Safety. See Dual Check Safety CONNECTION MANUAL (B-64003EN) for details.

B-63950EN/04

4.78

PARAMETERS OF WAVEFORM DIAGNOSIS


Parameters Nos. 10600 to 10719 shown below hold initial values and values set through screen manipulations during waveform diagnosis. These parameters are set by the CNC. So, never input values from the parameter screen.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

10600

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit


10601 to 10719 to

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte / 2-word

4.79
10800 10801 10802

PARAMETERS OF 3-DIMENSIONAL ERROR COMPENSATION


First compensation axis for 3-dimensional error compensation Second compensation axis for 3-dimensional error compensation Third compensation axis for 3-dimensional error compensation

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to Number of controlled axes These parameters set three compensation axes for applying 3-dimensional error compensation.
10803 10804 10805 Number of compensation points for 3-dimensional error compensation (first compensation axis) Number of compensation points for 3-dimensional error compensation (second compensation axis) Number of compensation points for 3-dimensional error compensation (third compensation axis)

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path
- 454 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Valid data range] 2 to 25 These parameters set the number of compensation points for each axis for 3-dimensional error compensation.
10806 Compensation point number of the reference position for 3-dimensional error compensation (first compensation axis) Compensation point number of the reference position for 3-dimensional error compensation (second compensation axis) Compensation point number of the reference position for 3-dimensional error compensation (third compensation axis)

10807

10808

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to number of compensation points These parameters set the compensation point number of the reference position for each axis for 3-dimensional error compensation.
10809 10810 10811 Magnification for 3-dimensional error compensation (first compensation axis) Magnification for 3-dimensional error compensation (second compensation axis) Magnification for 3-dimensional error compensation (third compensation axis)

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to 100 These parameters set the magnification for each axis for 3-dimensional error compensation.
10812 10813 10814 Compensation interval for 3-dimensional error compensation (first compensation axis) Compensation interval for 3-dimensional error compensation (second compensation axis) Compensation interval for 3-dimensional error compensation (third compensation axis)

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input Real path mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999)
- 455 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

These parameters set the compensation interval for each axis for 3-dimensional error compensation.

4.80
10830

PARAMETERS OF 3-DIMENSIONAL MACHINE POSITION COMPENSATION


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 3MC

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 3MC 3-dimensional machine position compensation is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
Axis number of compensation axis 1 subject to 3-dimensional machine position compensation Axis number of compensation axis 2 subject to 3-dimensional machine position compensation Axis number of compensation axis 3 subject to 3-dimensional machine position compensation

10831 10832 10833

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to Number of controlled axes These parameters set the axis numbers of the compensation axes subject to 3-dimensiontal machine position compensation. For those axes for which 0 is set, compensation is not performed.
10834 to 10843 Machine coordinates of compensation point 1 for compensation axis 1 subject to 3-dimensional machine position compensation to Machine coordinates of compensation point 10 for compensation axis 1 subject to 3-dimensional machine position compensation Machine coordinates of compensation point 1 for compensation axis 2 subject to 3-dimensional machine position compensation to Machine coordinates of compensation point 10 for compensation axis 2 subject to 3-dimensional machine position compensation Machine coordinates of compensation point 1 for compensation axis 3 subject to 3-dimensional machine position compensation to Machine coordinates of compensation point 10 for compensation axis 3 subject to 3-dimensional machine position compensation

10844 to 10853

10854 to 10863

- 456 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (machine unit) -999999999 to 999999999 These parameters set the machine coordinates of the compensation points subject to 3-dimensional machine position compensation.

NOTE 1 Set the machine positions of compensation points 1 to 10 so that the following condition is met: Compensation point 1 < Compensation point 2 < ... < Compensation point 10 If a position that does not meet this condition is set, the corresponding compensation point and the subsequent ones will be invalid. At least two points must be set. 2 If 10 compensation points are not required, set the machine positions of as many compensation points as necessary, starting with compensation point 1. For those compensation points that are not necessary, they can be set to meet the condition described in NOTE 1 so that they can be excluded from compensation. 3 This function is effective to linear axes only. 4 Outside the compensation range specified with the machine coordinates that have been set, the compensation values of boundary compensation points are always maintained. If compensation is not to be performed outside the compensation range, set the compensation values of boundary compensation points to 0.
10864 to 10873 Compensation value 1 of compensation point 1 for compensation axis 1 subject to 3-dimensional machine position compensation to Compensation value 10 of compensation point 10 for compensation axis 1 subject to 3-dimensional machine position compensation Compensation value 1 of compensation point 1 for compensation axis 2 subject to 3-dimensional machine position compensation to Compensation value 10 of compensation point 10 for compensation axis 2 subject to 3-dimensional machine position compensation Compensation value 1 of compensation point 1 for compensation axis 3 subject to 3-dimensional machine position compensation to Compensation value 10 of compensation point 10 for compensation axis 3 subject to 3-dimensional machine position compensation

10874 to 10883

10884 to 10893

- 457 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE When these parameters are changed, re-calculated compensation amount is output at once.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input Word path Detection unit -32767 to 32767 These parameters set the compensation values for the respective compensation points.

4.81
10900

PARAMETERS OF ROTATION AREA INTERFERENCE CHECK (1 OF 2)


Axis number of the first axis of the plane on which group D is moved

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to the number of controlled axes or m100+n (m:1 to the path number, n:1 to the number of controlled axes) Setting value) 1 to 32 101 to 132 201 to 232 : 901 to 932 1001 to 1032

: controlled axes on own path : controlled axes on path1 : controlled axes on path2 : controlled axes on path9 : controlled axes on path10

This parameter sets the axis number of the first axis of the group-D movement plane. Set the axis number of the axis parallel to the first axis of the group-A movement plane. If there is no relevant movement axis, set 0.
10901 Axis number of the second axis of the plane on which group D is moved

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to the number of controlled axes or m100+n (m:1 to the path number, n:1 to the number of controlled axes) Setting value) 1 to 32 101 to 132 201 to 232 : 901 to 932 1001 to 1032

: controlled axes on own path : controlled axes on path1 : controlled axes on path2 : controlled axes on path9 : controlled axes on path10

This parameter sets the axis number of the second axis of the group-D movement plane. Set the axis number of the axis parallel to the second axis of the group-A movement plane. If there is no relevant movement axis, set 0.

- 458 -

B-63950EN/04 10902

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Axis number of the rotary axis on which group D is rotated

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to the number of controlled axes or m100+n (m:1 to the path number, n:1 to the number of controlled axes) Setting value) 1 to 32 101 to 132 201 to 232 : 901 to 932 1001 to 1032

: controlled axes on own path : controlled axes on path1 : controlled axes on path2 : controlled axes on path9 : controlled axes on path10

This parameter sets the axis number of a rotation axis used for rotating group-D. If there is no relevant rotary axis, set 0.

NOTE All the controlled axes which belong to group-A must be assigned to be the same path.
10903 10904 Maximum point of rectangle 1 of group D in the first axis Minimum point of rectangle 1 of group D in the first axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 1 of group D in the first axis. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. Set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points. Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
Maximum point of rectangle 1 of group D in the second axis Minimum point of rectangle 1 of group D in the second axis

10905 10906

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 1 of group D in the second axis. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. Set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points.
- 459 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
10907 10908 Maximum point of rectangle 2 of group D in the first axis Minimum point of rectangle 2 of group D in the first axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 2 of group D in the first axis. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. Set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points. Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
Maximum point of rectangle 2 of group D in the second axis Minimum point of rectangle 2 of group D in the second axis

10909 10910

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 2 of group D in the second axis. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. Set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points. Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
Maximum point of rectangle 3 of group D in the first axis Minimum point of rectangle 3 of group D in the first axis

10911 10912

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999)

- 460 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 3 of group D in the first axis. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. Set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points. Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.

10913 10914

Maximum point of rectangle 3 of group D in the second axis Minimum point of rectangle 3 of group D in the second axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 3 of group D in the second axis. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. Set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points. Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
Maximum point of rectangle 4 of group D in the first axis Minimum point of rectangle 4 of group D in the first axis

10915 10916

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 4 of group D in the first axis. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. Set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points. Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
Maximum point of rectangle 4 of group D in the second axis Minimum point of rectangle 4 of group D in the second axis

10917 10918

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999)

- 461 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 4 of group D in the second axis. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. Set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points. Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
10919 10920 Rotation center in the first axis when group-D is rotated Rotation center in the second axis when group-D is rotated

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the rotation center when group D is rotated. Set the distances from the machine zero point after reference position return has been performed for group-D movement axes. Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
Reference angular displacement of the rotation axis of group D

10921

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real degree (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the coordinate value (reference angular displacement) of the rotation axis when rectangle areas of group D are set for the interference check function. If there is no relevant rotation axis, set 0.

- 462 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

4.82
11000

PARAMETERS OF SPINDLE CONTROL WITH SERVO MOTOR


#7 SRV #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#7 SRV Spindle control with servo motor are: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed

NOTE When spindle control with servo motor are used for an axis, parameter No. 11010 must also be set for the axis.
#7 11001 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 DDM #1 TCR #0 SRB

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 SRB Acceleration/deceleration after interpolation in cutting feed during rigid tapping with servo motor is: 0: Linear acceleration/deceleration. 1: Bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration. TCR In SV speed control mode, time constant of acceleration/deceleration after interpolation for spindle control with servo motor or spindle control with Cs contour control is: 0: The parameter No. 1622. (Time constant of acceleration/deceleration in cutting feed for each axis) 1: The parameter No. 11016. (Time constant of acceleration/deceleration in SV speed control mode for each axis) Set this parameter for the axis to be placed under spindle control with servo motor or spindle control with Cs contour control. DDM The motor used for spindle control with servo motor is: 0: Not a DD motor. 1: A DD motor.
#7 11005 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 SIC

#1

#2

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit

- 463 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#0 SIC Spindle indexing is: 0: Performed based on absolute coordinates. 1: Performed based on machine coordinates.

B-63950EN/04

11010

Spindle number used by spindle control with servo motor or spindle control with Cs contour control

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte axis [Valid data range] 0 to maximum number of controlled spindles This parameter sets a spindle number for a servo axis for which spindle control with servo motor or spindle control with Cs contour control are performed.

NOTE Set a spindle number for the axes set in bits 6 and 7 of parameter No. 11000. For axes for which spindle control with servo motor or spindle control with Cs contour control are not performed, set 0.
11011 Movement of spindle control with servo motor axis per revolution

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input Real axis degree Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) This parameter sets a movement of axis per revolution for which spindle control with servo motor or spindle control with Cs contour control are performed.
Spindle indexing speed for each axis

11012

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis [Unit of data] min-1 If 0 is set, the spindle indexing speed is assumed to be the setting of parameter No. 11020 (speed (S0) for switching acceleration/ deceleration for each axis).
11013 Positioning deviation limit for each axis in movement

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit 0 to 99999999 This parameter sets the limit of positional deviation for each axis during movement in spindle control with servo motor or spindle control with Cs contour control.
- 464 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Positioning deviation limit for each axis in the stopped state

11014

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit 0 to 99999999 This parameter sets the limit of positional deviation at stop for each axis in spindle control with servo motor or spindle control with Cs contour control.
Maximum motor speed

11015

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis min-1 0 to 99999999 This parameter sets the maximum motor speed applicable when spindle control with servo motor or spindle control with Cs contour control are performed.
Time constant of acceleration/deceleration in SV speed control mode for each axis

11016

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis msec 0 to 4000 In spindle control with servo motor or spindle control with Cs contour control, set the time constant of acceleration/deceleration after interpolation in cutting feed for SV speed control mode. Set the time constant used for exponential acceleration/deceleration in cutting feed, bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration after interpolation or linear acceleration/deceleration after interpolation in cutting feed for each axis. Type of acceleration/deceleration is applied by bits 0 (CTLx) and 1 (CTBx) of parameter No. 1610.
FL rate of exponential acceleration/deceleration in SV speed control mode for each axis

11017

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) In spindle control with servo motor or spindle control with Cs contour control, this parameter sets the lowest feedrate (FL rate) in exponential acceleration/deceleration for velocity control. Set this parameter for the target axis for spindle control with servo motor or spindle control with Cs contour control.
Acceleration/deceleration switching speed (S0) for each axis

11020

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis min-1 0 to 99999999

- 465 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

In spindle control with servo motor or spindle control with Cs contour control, this parameter sets the speed at which acceleration/ deceleration is changed to perform rotation control. (First step)
11021 Acceleration/deceleration switching speed (S1) for each axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis min-1 0 to 99999999 In spindle control with servo motor or spindle control with Cs contour control, this parameter sets the speed at which acceleration/ deceleration is changed to perform rotation control. (Second step)
Individual acceleration / deceleration 1 (Leg 1)

11030

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis min-1/s 0 to 100000 In spindle control with servo motor or spindle control with Cs contour control, this parameter sets acceleration/deceleration to be applied to perform rotation control. When the speed ranges from 0 to acceleration switching speed 1, acceleration/deceleration 1 is applied. Acceleration switching speed 1 is the speed set in parameter No. 11020.
Individual acceleration / deceleration 2 (Leg 2)

11031

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis min-1/s 0 to 100000 In spindle control with servo motor or spindle control with Cs contour control, this parameter sets acceleration/deceleration to be applied to perform rotation control. When the speed ranges from acceleration switching speed 1 to acceleration switching speed 2, acceleration/ deceleration 2 is applied. Acceleration switching speed 1 and acceleration switching speed 2 are the speeds set in parameter Nos. 11020 and 11021, respectively.
Individual acceleration / deceleration 3 (Leg 3)

11032

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis min-1/s 0 to 100000 In spindle control with servo motor or spindle control with Cs contour control, this parameter sets acceleration/deceleration to be applied to perform rotation control. When the speed ranges from acceleration switching speed 2 to the maximum speed, acceleration/deceleration 3 is applied. Acceleration switching speed 2 is the speed set in parameter No. 11021. (When rotation command 8-step acceleration/deceleration in spindle control with Cs contour control is enabled)

- 466 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
In spindle control with servo motor or spindle control with Cs contour control, this parameter sets acceleration/deceleration to be applied to perform rotation control. When the speed ranges from acceleration switching speed 2 to acceleration switching speed 3, acceleration/deceleration 3 is applied. Acceleration switching speed 2 and acceleration switching speed 3 are the speeds set in parameter Nos. 11021 and 11022, respectively.

11050

Maximum allowable acceleration rate in acceleration/deceleration before interpolation for each axis in rigid tapping

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/sec2, inch/sec2, degree/sec2 (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (D) (When the machine system is metric system, 0.0 to +100000.0. When the machine system is inch system, 0.0 to +10000.0) Set a maximum allowable acceleration rate in acceleration/ deceleration before interpolation for each axis. If a value greater than 100000.0 is set, the value is clamped to 100000.0. If 0 is set, the specification of 100000.0 is assumed. If 0 is set for all axes, however, acceleration/deceleration before interpolation is not performed.
Acceleration change time of bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration before interpolation in rigid tapping

11051

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word path msec 0 to 200 Set an acceleration change time of bell-shaped acceleration/ deceleration before interpolation (time for changing from the state of constant federate (A) to the state of constant acceleration/deceleration (C) at the acceleration rate calculated from the acceleration rate set in parameter No. 11050: time of (B) in the figure below).
Speed in tangent direction Based on the setting of parameter No. 11050, an optimum inclination is calculated automatically.

(A)

(B)

(C)

(B)

(A)

(B)

(C)

(B)

(A)

Set time in parameter No. 11051.

11052

Time constant for acceleration/deceleration after cutting feed interpolation in the acceleration/deceleration before interpolation mode in rigid tapping

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis [Unit of data] msec
- 467 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

[Valid data range] 0 to 4000 In the acceleration/deceleration before interpolation mode as in AI contour control, not the ordinary time constant (parameter No. 1622) but the value of this parameter is used. Be sure to specify the same time constant value for all axes except for a special application. If different values are set, correct linear and circular figures cannot be obtained.
11060 11061 11062 11063 Time constant for acceleration/deceleration after cutting feed interpolation in rigid tapping (first gear) Time constant for acceleration/deceleration after cutting feed interpolation in rigid tapping (second gear) Time constant for acceleration/deceleration after cutting feed interpolation in rigid tapping (third gear) Time constant for acceleration/deceleration after cutting feed interpolation in rigid tapping (fourth gear)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis msec 0 to 4000 For the time constants in rigid tapping with servo motors, parameters Nos. 11060 to 11063 are used, not parameters Nos. 5261 to 5264. Set these parameters with a live tool axis in rigid tapping.
Time constant for acceleration/deceleration after cutting feed interpolation in rigid tapping extraction (first gear) Time constant for acceleration/deceleration after cutting feed interpolation in rigid tapping extraction (second gear) Time constant for acceleration/deceleration after cutting feed interpolation in rigid tapping extraction (third gear) Time constant for acceleration/deceleration after cutting feed interpolation in rigid tapping extraction (fourth gear)

11065

11066

11067

11068

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis msec 0 to 4000 If bit 2 (TDR) of parameter No. 5201 is set to 1, for the time constants in rigid tapping extraction with servo motors, parameters Nos. 11065 to 11068 are used, not parameters Nos. 5271 to 5274. Set these parameters with a live tool axis in rigid tapping.
Path number with which the rotation of each spindle is specified

11090

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte spindle [Valid data range] 0 to 10 When a path is specified for spindle commands, this parameter sets a path number with which the rotation of a spindle can be specified. 0: Spindle commands can be issued from all paths. 1 to 10: Spindle commands can be issued from a set path.

- 468 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE 1 This parameter is valid when SPSP<Gn536.7> is set to 1. 2 If the setting is illegal, an alarm PS5305, ILLEGAL SPINDLE NUMBER is issued when a spindle command is issued from any one of the paths. 3 This setting does not apply to spindle commands using the spindle select signals (SWS1 to SWS4<Gn027.0 to Gn027.2, Gn026.3>).

4.83
11200

PARAMETERS OF WORKPIECE SETTING ERROR COMPENSATION (1 OF 2)


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 WSK #2 #1 #0 RCM

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit path #0 RCM When workpiece setting error compensation is performed with a 5-axis machine, tool direction compensation (compensation for a rotation axis) is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed.

NOTE When this parameter is set to 0, machining cannot be performed precisely. For 5-axis machines, usually set this parameter to 1.
#3 WSK If, during workpiece setting error compensation, system variables #100151 to #100182 (skip coordinates) are read, 0: Values in the workpiece coordinate system can be read. 1: Values in the workpiece setting coordinate system can be read. This parameter is also applied to system variables #5061 to #5080 (skip coordinates).
The number of decimal places of rotation direction errors in workpiece setting error compensation

11201

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 8 This parameter sets the number of decimal places of rotation direction errors in workpiece setting error compensation.
Parameter No. 11201 1 2 3 0.001 999,999.999 7 0.0000001 99.9999999 4 0.0001 99,999.9999 8 0.00000001 9.99999999 Least input increment (deg) 0.1 0.01 Maximum settable value (deg) 99,999,999.9 9999,999.99 Parameter No. 11201 5 6 0.000001 999.999999

Least input increment (deg) 0.00001 Maximum settable value (deg) 9,999.99999

Note, however, that a value from 1 to 8 can be specified in this parameter. If a value not within the specifiable range is specified in this parameter, the least input increment of the reference axis is followed.

- 469 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Unit system of reference axis Least input increment (deg) Maximum settable value (deg)
11204

B-63950EN/04

IS-A 0.01

IS-B 0.001

IS-C 0.0001

IS-D 0.00001

IS-E 0.000001

999,999.99 999,999.999 99,999.9999 9,999.99999 999.999999

Angle to decide singular posture (for Workpiece setting error compensation)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path Degree Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) When Tool direction is compensated (bit 0 (RCM) of parameter No. 11200 is set to 1), in the case that Tool center point control is active during Workpiece setting error compensation, 3-dimension coordinates system conversion or Tilted working plane command, rotary axes are compensated. Then, compensation may be different when the tool is in singular posture. When the angle between the tool posture and the singular posture is less than this parameter, the compensation is done regarding tool posture as singular posture.

4.84
11208

PARAMETERS OF LINEAR INCLINATION COMPENSATION FUNCTION


Numerator for determining the trend of the approximation error line of linear inclination compensation a Denominator for determining the trend of the approximation error line of linear inclination compensation b

11209

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis None -999999999 to 999999999 These parameters sets the numerator and denominator for determining the trend of the approximation error line of linear inclination compensation.
Reference position of linear inclination compensation DST0

11210

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch, degree (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the machine position DST0 as the reference point for performing linear inclination compensation.
Linear inclination compensation value CMP0

11211

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis


- 470 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Unit of data] Detection unit [Valid data range] -32767 to 32767 This parameter sets the linear inclination compensation value, CMP0, not dependent on the machine position.

4.85
11220

PARAMETERS OF TILTED WORKING PLANE COMMAND


Minimum distance used for determining a plane when a tilted working plane command with three points is specified

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) When a tilted working plane command with three points is specified, if the distance (used for determining a place) between a straight line passing two points and the remaining one point is short, the plane is unstable. In this parameter, set the minimum distance used for determining a plane. If the distance is shorter than the value set in this parameter, an alarm PS5457, G68.2/G68.3 FORMAT ERROR is issued.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 TLC #2 3DW #1 D3R #0 MTW

11221

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 MTW Multiple tilted working plane commands are: 0: Not used. 1: Used. D3R In the 3-dimensional coordinate system conversion mode, tilted working plane command mode, or workpiece setting error compensation mode, rapid traverse in canned cycle for drilling is: 0: Performed in the cutting feed mode. 1: Performed in the rapid traverse mode. 3DW If, in the 3-dimensional coordinate system conversion mode, workpiece coordinate system selection using a G code is specified, the selection: 0: Operates in accordance with conventional specifications. (The workpiece coordinate system difference is reflected in the program coordinate system direction.) 1: Operates in accordance with the same specifications as those of workpiece coordinate system selection (bit 6 (3TW) of parameter No. 1205 = 1) during the tilted working plane command. (The workpiece coordinate system difference is reflected in the workpiece coordinate system direction.)

#1

#2

- 471 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

CAUTION If this parameter is set to 1, only G54 to G59 and G54.1 can be specified. If G52 and G92 are specified, alarm PS5462, "ILLEGAL COMMAND (G68.2/G69)" is issued. If G54 to G59 and G54.1 are specified, buffering is suppressed.
#3 TLC During tool length compensation, 3-dimensional coordinate conversion: 0: Cannot be used. 1: Can be used.

4.86
11222

PARAMETERS OF AXIS CONTROL/INCREMENT SYSTEM (2 OF 3)


#7 PDM #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 CIM #0 NIM

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 NIM Automatic conversion of a coordinate system by an inch/metric conversion command (G20 or G21) is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed. CIM When an inch/metric conversion command (G20 or G21) is specified, if the workpiece coordinate system is shifted by the shift amount as described below: 0: An alarm PS1298, ILLEGAL INCH/METRIC CONVERSION is issued. 1: Clearing is performed. If bit 0 (NIM) of parameter No. 11222 is set to 1, or if bit 2 (IRF) of parameter No. 14000 is set to 1, this parameter clears the following: Manual intervention made when the manual absolute signal is off Issuance of a move command with the machine locked Movement by handle interrupt Operation with a mirror image Shifting of a workpiece coordinate system when a local coordinate system or workpiece coordinate system is set up #7 PDM When switching between diameter and radius specification is made with the function for dynamic switching of diameter/radius specification, coordinates in the machine coordinate system select command (G53) are: 0: Switched between diameter and radius specification. 1: Set according to the setting of bit 3 (DIAx) of parameter No. 1006.

#1

4.87
11223

PARAMETERS OF DI/DO (2 OF 2)
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 OPS #1 TRS #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path


- 472 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
TRS In threading cycle retraction, when a block that specifies return to the start point of the threading cycle is executed, threading signal THRD <Fn002.3> is: 0: Set to 0. 1: Set to 1. OPS In the MEM mode, when a sequence number search operation ([N SEARCH]) is performed, automatic operation signal OP <Fn000.7> is: 0: Kept 0. 1: Set to 1.

#1

#2

4.88
11230 11231 11232

PARAMETERS OF FEEDRATE CONTROL AND ACCELERATION/DECELERATION CONTROL


Distance to the 4th step in positioning by optimum acceleration for each axis D4 Distance to the 5th step in positioning by optimum acceleration for each axis D5 Distance to the 6th step in positioning by optimum acceleration for each axis D6

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch, degree (machine unit) Refer to the standard parameter setting table (B) When using the function for switching the rapid traverse rate, time constant, and loop gain according to the positioning distance, this parameter sets the positioning distance for each axis.

NOTE 1 To use this parameter, set bit 0 (OADx) of parameter No. 6131 to 1. 2 If 0 is set in all of parameters Nos. 6136 to 6138 and 11230 to 11232, this function is disabled. 3 The settings must satisfy the following: D1<D2<D3<D4<D5<D6. 4 Switching in up to seven steps is possible. When up to four steps are used, for example, set parameters so that expression D1<D2<D3 is satisfied, and set a maximum value (such as +999999.999 mm) for D4, D5, and D6. 5 For axes with diameter specification, set a diameter value. If 10.000 mm is set for an axis with diameter specification, for example, switching is made when a movement takes place over a distance of 10.000 mm in diameter. 6 In parameters Nos. 6136 to 6138 and 11230 to 11232, set a distance for each axis. Block lengths must not be specified in these parameters.
#7 11240 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 FAE

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

- 473 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#0

B-63950EN/04

FAE During positioning when the AI contour control mode is canceled, the optimum torque acceleration/deceleration is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
Time constant of acceleration/deceleration after interpolation of acceleration/deceleration before rapid traverse interpolation

11242

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis msec 0 to 4000 This parameter is used for the time constant of acceleration/deceleration before rapid traverse interpolation. Be sure to specify the same time constant value for all axes except for a special application. If different time constants are set, a correct linear line cannot be obtained.

4.89
11250

PARAMETERS OF PROGRAM RESTART (2 OF 2)


#7 OAA #6 #5 #4 MTO #3 MCO #2 BOU #1 TOU #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #1 TOU When the program restart auxiliary function output function is applied in a lathe system, T codes are: 0: Not output to the MDI program. 1: Output to the MDI program.

NOTE In a machining center system, they are output regardless of the parameter setting.
BOU When the program restart auxiliary function output function is applied in a lathe system, B codes (second auxiliary function) are: 0: Not output to the MDI program. 1: Output to the MDI program.

#2

NOTE In a machining center system, they are output regardless of the parameter setting.
#3 MCO If, in the program restart auxiliary function output function, multiple MSTB codes are specified in the program to restart (or multiple M codes are specified), the output to the MDI program is as follows: 0: Each code is output to a single block. 1: All specified codes are output to a single block. In either case, the output is in MSTB order.

- 474 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
MTO In the program restart auxiliary function output function, modal T codes are: 0: Not output to the MDI program. 1: Output to the MDI program. OAA In the program restart output function, the approach to the program restart position for each arbitrary axis is: 0: Not used. 1: Used.

#4

#7

4.90
11260

PARAMETERS OF TOOL CENTER POINT CONTROL


#7 TRC #6 TFD #5 #4 #3 #2 AAI #1 #0 TCS

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 TCS If bit 6 (TOS) of parameter No. 5006 is set to 0, tool center point control is canceled (G49) by: 0: Axis movement. 1: Coordinate system shifting.
Tool center point control command Bit 6 (TOS) of parameter No. 5006 = 0 Bit 0 (TCS) of parameter No. 11260 = 0 Bit 6 (TOS) of parameter No. 5006 = 0 Bit 0 (TCS) of parameter No. 11260 = 1 Bit 6 (TOS) of parameter No. 5006 = 1 Bit 0 (TCS) of parameter No. 11260 = 0 Bit 6 (TOS) of parameter No. 5006 = 1 Bit 0 (TCS) of parameter No. 11260 = 1 Axis movement type Axis movement type Coordinate system shift type Cancellation of tool center point control Axis movement type Coordinate system shift type Coordinate system shift type

#2

AAI When tool center point control(G43.4/G43.5), or cutting point command (G43.8/G43.9) is commanded, AI contour control: 0: does not become active automatically. 1: becomes active automatically. TFD The actual cutting feedrate displayed during tool center point control is: 0: Control point feedrate. 1: Tool center point feedrate. TRC Rapid traverse during tool during tool center point control results in: 0: Tool path where tool center point control is enabled. 1: Tool path where tool center point control is disabled.

#6

#7

- 475 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE This parameter is regarded as being set to 0 in the following modes: 1) 3-dimensional coordinate system conversion 2) Tilted working plane command 3) Workpiece setting error compensation 4) Cutting point command If 1 is set in this parameter, manual intervention cannot be performed in rapid traverse during tool center point control. If manual intervention is performed, alarm PS5421," ILLEGAL COMMAND IN G43.4/G43.5" is issued at the cycle start after manual intervention.
11261 The amount of a retract operation in the tool axis direction during tool retract and return

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real axis mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the amount of a retract operation in the tool axis direction when G10.6 is specified alone during tool retraction and return (during tool center point control and workpiece setting error compensation). The retract operation is performed by using the value set in this parameter in an incremental manner. This data is valid only when bit 2 (RPS) of parameter No. 7040 is set to 1. If 0 is set in this parameter, a retract operation in the tool axis direction is not performed, but a retract operation is performed according to the setting of parameter No. 7041.
Angle decided to result in a special point posture (cutting point command)

11262

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path degree Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) If the angle formed by the tool posture and the vertical direction of the cutting plane is equal to or less than the value set in this parameter, the tool posture is regarded as a posture close to a special point. In the event of a posture close to a special point, the "vector pointing to the center point from the specified point" is fixed with the "vector pointing to the center point from the cutting point" immediately before the posture close to a special point.
Time constant of acceleration/deceleration after rapid traverse interpolation in tool center point control mode and in workpiece setting error compensation mode

11263

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis msec 0 to 4000 This parameter is used for the time constant of rapid traverse in tool center point control mode and in workpiece setting error compensation mode.
- 476 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Be sure to specify the same time constant value for all axes except for a special application. If different time constant values are set, a correct linear line cannot be obtained.

4.91
11275

PARAMETERS OF COORDINATE SYSTEM (2 OF 2)


The top number of M code used to turn on each axis workpiece coordinate system preset signal

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 1 to 999999999 Specify the top number of M code for turning 1 each axis workpiece coordinate system preset signal <Gn358.*> during automatic operation. When the specified M codes are within the range specified with this parameter and parameter No. 11276, each axis workpiece coordinate system preset signal is checked and preset workpiece coordinate system for axis that the signal is turned 1. The specified M codes prevent buffering.

NOTE When each axis workpiece coordinate system preset signals are turned 1 more than two signals by an M code, please turn 1 the signals of all axis at the same timing. If the timing is different, only the axis of the first signal turned 1 is preset. If you want to turn 1 the signals at the different timing, please specify M code separately.
11276 The number of M code used to turn on each axis workpiece coordinate system preset signal

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 1 to 999 Specify the number of M code for turning 1 each axis workpiece coordinate system preset signal <Gn358.*> during automatic operation. For example, when parameter No. 11275 = 100 and parameter No. 11276 = 10 are set, From M100 to M109 are used for turning 1 each axis workpiece coordinate system preset signal. When 0 is set, the number of M code is assumed to be 1.

NOTE Set only M code that is not used for another function. (M00 to 05, 30, 98, 99, M code used to call the subprogram, etc.)
#7 11277 #6 #5 PWR #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 WPA

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 WPA When an M code for turning on the workpiece coordinate system preset signal for an axis is specified, but the signal is not turned on, or an auxiliary function lock is provided: 0: An alarm PS1820, ILLEGAL DI SIGNAL STATE is issued. 1: An alarm is not issued.
- 477 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

When bit 6 (PGS) of parameter No. 3001 is set to 0 (M, S, T, and B codes are not output in the high speed program check mode), if an M code for turning on the workpiece coordinate system preset signal for an axis is specified, the system follows the setting of this parameter. #5 PWR When bit 3 (PPD) of parameter No. 3104 is set to 0, 0: The axis is preset with 0. 1: The axis is preset with machine coordinates.

NOTE This parameter is valid when bit 3 (PPD) of parameter No. 3104 is set to 0.

4.92
11284

PARAMETERS OF SYNCHRONOUS/COMPOSITE CONTROL AND SUPERIMPOSED CONTROL (2 OF 3)


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 SSH

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 SSH During superimposed control, manual handle interruption to the slave axis is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.

4.93
11290 11291 11292 11293 11294 11295 11296 11297 11298 11299

PARAMETERS OF PROGRAMS (2 OF 4)
M code preventing buffering M code preventing buffering M code preventing buffering M code preventing buffering M code preventing buffering M code preventing buffering M code preventing buffering M code preventing buffering M code preventing buffering M code preventing buffering 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to 99999999 Set M codes that prevent buffering the following blocks. If processing directed by an M code must be performed by the machine without buffering the following block, specify the M code.
- 478 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
M00, M01, M02, and M30 always prevent buffering even when they are not specified in these parameters.

4.94
11300

PARAMETERS OF DISPLAY AND EDIT (2 OF 5)


#7 MUC #6 ATH #5 MPH #4 FPI #3 ASH #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #3 ASH When the actual feedrate is read with FOCAS2 and the PMC window: 0: Data that has been updated at conventional intervals (approximately 32 ms) is read. 1: Data that has been updated at short intervals is read. If this parameter is set to 1, the machine coordinates of the machine unit with the delay in acceleration/deceleration and the servo delay considered are read for all axes, regardless of the setting of bit 7 (EMP) of parameter No. 11313.

NOTE When quick response is not required in particular for display operation and so on, normally set this parameter to 0 to reduce the load on the CNC.
#4 FPI In the number of registered programs, which is obtained by the cnc_rdproginfo() function: 0: The number of initial folders is included. 1: The number of initial folders is not included. MPH When the machine coordinates of the machine unit with the delay in acceleration/deceleration and the servo delay not considered are read with FOCAS2 and the PMC window: 0: Data that has been updated at conventional intervals (approximately 32 ms) is read. 1: Data that has been updated at short intervals is read.

#5

NOTE When quick response is not required in particular for display operation and so on, normally set this parameter to 0 to reduce the load on the CNC.
#6 ATH When the disturbance load torque data are read with FOCAS2 and the PMC window: 0: Data that has been updated at conventional intervals (approximately 32 ms) is read. 1: Data that has been updated at short intervals is read.

NOTE When quick response is not required in particular for display operation and so on, normally set this parameter to 0 to reduce the load on the CNC.
#7 MUC When the modal data are read with FOCAS2 and the PMC window: 0: Data that has been updated at conventional intervals (approximately 32 ms) is read. 1: Data that has been updated at short intervals is read.
- 479 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE When quick response is not required in particular for display operation and so on, normally set this parameter to 0 to reduce the load on the CNC.
#7 11302 CPG #6 FPF #5 PES #4 ADC #3 SMD #2 SDG #1 SPR #0 SPG

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 SPG Initially, the program screen is: 0: Displayed full-screen. 1: Displayed in a window. SPR Initially, the parameter screen is: 0: Displayed full-screen. 1: Displayed in a window. SDG Initially, the diagnosis screen is: 0: Displayed full-screen. 1: Displayed in a window. SMD The MDI program screen is: 0: Displayed according to the setting of bit 0 (SPG) of parameter No. 11302. 1: Displayed in a window. If this parameter is set to 0, the first display mode entered after the power is turned on is determined according to the setting of bit 0 (SPG) of parameter No. 11302. Depending on the display mode, the MDI program screen is displayed full-screen or in a window. Also, the screen display can be dynamically switched between the full-screen mode and the window mode by interacting with the program screen in another mode. If this parameter is set to 1, the MDI program screen is always displayed in a window, and it is impossible to switch between the full-screen mode and the window mode by operations. #4 ADC When all alarms have been eliminated, or the message key is pressed on the alarm screen: 0: The screen display does not change. 1: The screen display changes to the screen displayed before the alarm screen. PES After a program search operation is performed on the program list screen: 0: The cursor moves to a program on the list screen. 1: A specified program is selected as the main program, and the screen display changes to the edit screen. FPF Folders that can be used by program management are: 0: Not limited to other than the path folder corresponding to a selected path. 1: Limited to other than the path folder corresponding to a selected path. CPG PROG function screen selection is: 0: Not changed according to the CNC mode. 1: Changed according to the CNC mode.
- 480 -

#1

#2

#3

#5

#6

#7

B-63950EN/04 #7 11303 #6 #5 ISQ #4 DPM

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#3 BDP #2 DVP #1 SRC #0 LDP

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 LDP The servo load meter axis display: 0: Interacts with the axis display of coordinate values. 1: Does not interact with the axis display of coordinate values. SRC In program character editing, blocks not yet saved are: 0: Not saved at the time of reset. 1: Saved at the time of reset. DVP On the program list screen, path folders are displayed: 0: As many as the maximum number of paths that can be set in the system. 1: As many as the number of valid paths. BDP When a single-block stop occurs, on the program screen and program check screen: 0: The block next to the block that has been executed is displayed at the beginning. 1: The block that has been executed is displayed at the beginning.

#1

#2

#3

NOTE Only MEM operation is enabled.


#4 DPM During MDI program execution, blocks that call an execution macro are: 0: Not displayed. 1: Displayed. ISQ During MDI editing, automatic sequence number insertion is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
#7 11304 CFP #6 #5 #4 #3 ON8 #2 #1 GGD #0 PGR

#5

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 PGR When the path select signal is changed, the screen of the multi path simultaneous display group: 0: Is not switched. 1: Is switched to the display group including the selected path. GGD The G code guidance screen is: 0: Not displayed. 1: Displayed.

#1

- 481 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#3 ON8 Program numbers are: 0: Four digits long. 1: Eight digits long.

B-63950EN/04

NOTE If program numbers are changed from eight digits to four digits, all programs will be automatically deleted from program memory. If this parameter is changed from 1 to 0 and the power is turned off and back on, the following message appears on the IPL screen. For the Series 300is/310is/320is and for the CNC screen display function, the message appears on the IPL screen of NCBOOT32.exe. To delete them, enter 1. Otherwise, enter 0. PARAMETER NO.11304#3 IS CHANGED. ALL PROGRAM FILE MUST BE CLEARED. CLEAR FILE OK ? (NO=0, YES=1)
#7 CFP Folders that can be used by program management are: 0: Not limited to the path folder corresponding to a selected path. 1: Limited to the path folder corresponding to a selected path. Folders to be used are limited by bit 6 (FPF) of parameter No. 11302 and bit 7 (CFP) of parameter No. 11304 as follows:
Table 4.94 Folders that are made usable in a program list by parameter setting Bit 6 (FPF) of parameter No. 11302 0 1 Bit 7 (CFP) of 0 Unlimited Under path folder parameter No. 11304 1 Path folder only Path folder only
11305 Maximum number of simultaneously displayed axes

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 2 By setting this parameter, the maximum number of simultaneously displayed axes at the current position can be changed. A value set in this parameter corresponds to the maximum number of simultaneously displayed axis as follows:
Max. number of simultaneously displayed axes

5 0

10 1

20 2

Setting

A value other than 1 and 2 is assumed to be 0.


11307 Display sequence of the coordinates in current position display

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
- 482 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 5 This parameter sets the display sequence of the coordinates of a position displayed on the following screens: 10.4- and 15-inch display units Total position display screen Total position display on each screen 7.2- and 8.4-inch display units Total position display screen When the maximum number of simultaneously displayed axes is set to 20 (when 2 is set in parameter No. 11305), two sets of coordinates are displayed simultaneously as the current position display on each screen. When the first set is displayed, switching to the second set can be made by pressing then pressing the chapter selection soft key being selected. When the above operation is performed again, the displayed set changes to the first set. The display sequence of coordinates corresponds to the parameter setting as follows:
Display sequence of coordinates Setting 0 1 2 3 4 5
Relative coordinates Relative coordinates Relative coordinates Absolute coordinates Absolute coordinates Machine coordinates Absolute coordinates Machine coordinates Remaining travel distance Machine coordinates Remaining travel distance Remaining travel distance Machine coordinates Absolute coordinates Absolute coordinates Relative coordinates Relative coordinates Relative coordinates Remaining travel distance Remaining travel distance Machine coordinates Remaining travel distance Machine coordinates Absolute coordinates

If the setting is beyond the valid data range, 0 is assumed. When the multipath simultaneous display function is enabled (parameter No. 13131 is set to a nonzero value, and parameter No. 13132 is set to 1 or a greater value), this parameter becomes invalid.
#7 11308 DGH #6 ABH #5 SPH #4 PGS #3 FPD #2 EAS #1 COW #0 DOP

[Input type] parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 DOP If an alarm is issued in a path not being displayed: 0: The screen display does not change to the alarm screen. 1: The screen display changes to the alarm screen.

- 483 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#1

B-63950EN/04

COW When the file of specified name already exists on memory card, 0: It is not overwritten Alarm SR1973, FILE ALREADY EXIST is generated. 1: It is overwritten. Because the confirmation message is displayed before overwriting even if COW is 1, overwriting can be canceled.

NOTE When the overwritten file is read only attribute, it is not possible to overwrite even if bit 1 (COW) of parameter No. 11308 = 1.
#2 EAS When an extended axis name or extended spindle name is used in a path, subscripts for axis names or spindle names in that path: 0: Cannot be used. 1: Can be used. FPD On the program screen and program check screen, blocks already executed are: 0: Not displayed. 1: Displayed. PGS In program search operation: 0: A specified program name is searched for. 1: An O number program is searched for with "O" omitted. SPH When the spindle speed data are read with FOCAS2 or the PMC window: 0: Data that has been updated at conventional intervals (approximately 32 ms) is read. 1: Data that has been updated at short intervals is read.

#3

#4

#5

NOTE When quick response is not required in particular for display operation and so on, normally set this parameter to 0 to reduce the load on the CNC.
#6 ABH When the absolute coordinates data are read with FOCAS2 or the PMC window: 0: Data that has been updated at conventional intervals (approximately 32 ms) is read. 1: Data that has been updated at short intervals is read.

NOTE When quick response is not required in particular for display operation and so on, normally set this parameter to 0 to reduce the load on the CNC.
#7 DGH When the Remaining travel distance data are read with FOCAS2 or the PMC window: 0: Data that has been updated at conventional intervals (approximately 32 ms) is read. 1: Data that has been updated at short intervals is read.

NOTE When quick response is not required in particular for display operation and so on, normally set this parameter to 0 to reduce the load on the CNC.

- 484 -

B-63950EN/04 11310

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Selection of a PMC that performs read and write operations with an external touch panel

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte [Valid data range] 0 to 3 This parameter selects an PMC for read and write operations among three PMCs, which are the first PMC, second PMC, and third PMC. 0, 1 : First PMC 2 : Second PMC 3 : Third PMC

NOTE 1 It is impossible to perform read and write operations with more than one PMC at the same time. 2 When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued. 3 The second PMC and third PMC are optional.

4.95
11311

PARAMETERS OF EMBEDDED MACRO (1 OF 2)


Password for embedded macro

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word [Valid date range] 0 to 99999999 The password to set the attribute of the folder for the embedded macro (MTB1 folder) is set. When the values other than 0 are set to this parameter and the value is different from the parameter No. 11312 of the key word, the attribute of the MTB1 folder is locked. Thereafter, the attribute of the MTB1 folder is locked unless the same value as the password is set to the key word. Moreover, the value of the password cannot be changed. When the key is open, The attribute of the MTB1 folder can be changed. When it locks or the key is not set, The attribute of the MTB1 folder can not be changed.
11312 Key word for embedded macro

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word [Valid date range] 0 to 99999999 The key word in order to set the attribute of the folder for the embedded macro (MTB1 folder) is set.

NOTE The value is not displayed even if the parameter is set. Moreover, when the power is turned off, this parameter becomes 0.

- 485 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

4.96
11318

PARAMETERS OF DISPLAY AND EDIT (3 OF 5)


#7 #6 RTC #5 #4 #3 #2 DFM #1 MLD #0 POC

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 POC When the pattern data input function is used, on the custom macro screen a comment is: 0: Displayed in the lower part of the screen. 1: Displayed on the right side of the screen.

NOTE This parameter is not used when a 15-inch display unit is used.
#1 MLD On the program list screen, division of the screen display is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.

NOTE This parameter is valid when a 10.4- or 15-inch display unit is used.
#2 DFM On the program list screen, of the soft key character strings when devices are selected and selected device name character strings, the character strings related to the memory card are: 0: Not changed. 1: Changed. Soft key character strings when devices are selected (10.4-inch/15-inch display unit)
Mode EDIT Other than EDIT EDIT Other than EDIT MEMORY CARD DFM=0 Name MEMCARD DFM=1 Name M CARD EDIT M CARD OPER. M CARD I/O M CARD DNC

Soft key character strings when devices are selected (7.2-inch/8.4-inch display unit)
Mode EDIT Other than EDIT EDIT Other than EDIT DFM=0 Name MEMCARD M-CARD DFM=1 Name MC-EDT MC-OP. MC-I/O MC-DNC

Selected device name character strings


DFM=0 MEMCARD M_CARD DFM=1 MC-PROG MC-FILE

- 486 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
RTC On the program list screen, a file selected by a selection operation: 0: Can be copied repeatedly. 1: Cannot be copied repeatedly.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 IDC #0 DHN PGM

#6

11320

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 DHN On the program check screen, HD.T and NX.T, and a T number are: 0: Not displayed at the same time. 1: Displayed at the same time. If DHN is set to 1, HD.T, NX.T, and T are displayed regardless of the setting of bit 2 (PCT) of parameter No. 3108. IDC The soft key [UPDATA ALL ID], which updates ID information on the servo or spindle information screen as a batch, is: 0: Not displayed. 1: Displayed.

#1

NOTE IDC is effective only if bit 0 (IDW) of parameter No. 13112 is set to 1.
#7 PGM In the high speed program check mode, the machine position is displayed with: 0: Actual machine coordinates. (Machine position relative to the reference position) 1: Machine coordinates for the program check.
Spindle tool name (1st character) Spindle tool name (2nd character) Spindle tool name (3rd character) Spindle tool name (4th character)

11321 11322 11323 11324

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] See the character-code correspondence table. The name of the spindle tool (HD.T) displayed on the program check screen can be changed. Any character string consisting of numeric characters, alphabetical characters, katakana characters, and symbols with a maximum length of four characters can be displayed.

NOTE For characters and codes, see Appendix A, "CHARACTER-CODE CORRESPONDENCE TABLE". If the first character is 0 or an illegal character code, "HD.T" is displayed.
11325 11326 Next machining tool name (1st character) Next machining tool name (2nd character)

- 487 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
11327 11328 Next machining tool name (3rd character) Next machining tool name (4th character)

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] See the character-code correspondence table. The name of the next machining tool (NX.T) displayed on the program check screen can be changed. Any character string consisting of numeric characters, alphabetical characters, katakana characters, and symbols with a maximum length of four characters can be displayed.

NOTE For characters and codes, see Appendix A, "CHARACTER-CODE CORRESPONDENCE TABLE". If the first character is 0 or an illegal character code, "NX.T" is displayed.

4.97
11329

PARAMETERS OF GRAPHIC DISPLAY (2 OF 5)


#7 GST #6 #5 AER #4 GTF #3 BGM #2 GTL #1 DPC #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #1 DPC The coordinates displayed on each of the PATH GRAPHIC, ANIMATION GRAPHIC, and PATH GRAPHIC (TOOL POSITION) screens of the dynamic graphic display function are: 0: Absolute coordinates. 1: Machine coordinates. GTL When animated simulation is performed with the dynamic graphic display function, drawing at positions with tool length compensation considered is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed. BGM Coordinates used by the dynamic graphic display function are: 0: Absolute coordinates. 1: Machine coordinates. GTF When the tool path is drawn with the dynamic graphic display function, drawing at positions with tool compensation (tool length compensation and tool radius/tool nose radius compensation) considered is: 0: Performed. 1: Not performed. AER When the tool path is drawn with the dynamic graphic display function, automatic erasure at the start of drawing is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed.

#2

#3

#4

#5

- 488 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
GST When drawing cannot be performed for a command with the dynamic graphic display function: 0: The command is ignored, and drawing continues without stopping drawing. 1: Drawing stops.
Magnification of drawing in dynamic graphic display

#7

11330

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word path 0.01 1 to 10000 This parameter sets the magnification of the drawing range in the dynamic graphic display function.
Screen center coordinate value in the drawing range in dynamic graphic display

11331

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm,inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999 This parameter sets the coordinate value of the center of the drawing range in the dynamic graphic display function.

NOTE If bit 3 (BGM) of parameter No. 11329 is set to 1, set the coordinate value on each axis in the machine coordinate system.
11334 Rotation angle of the drawing coordinate system in dynamic graphic display (vertical direction)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word path degree -360 to 360 This parameter sets the rotation angle (vertical direction) of the drawing coordinate system in the dynamic graphic display function.
Rotation angle of the drawing coordinate system in dynamic graphic display (horizontal direction

11335

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word path degree -360 to 360 This parameter sets the rotation angle of the drawing coordinate system in the dynamic graphic display function (the angle of rotation about the vertical axis on the screen, that passes the center position of the blank).
Drawing color of the tool path in tool path drawing in dynamic graphic display

11336

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 7
- 489 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

This parameter sets the color in which the tool path is drawn with the dynamic graphic display function.
11337 Color of the cursor indicating the tool position on the PATH GRAPHIC (TOOL POSITION) screen of dynamic graphic display

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 7 This parameter sets the color of the cursor indicating the tool position on the PATH GRAPHIC (TOOL POSITION) screen of the dynamic graphic display function.
11341 Drawing color of a blank figure in dynamic graphic display

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 7 This parameter sets the color in which a blank figure is drawn with the dynamic graphic display function.
11342 Rotation angle of the drawing coordinate system of dynamic graphic display (screen center)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word path degree -360 to 360 This parameter sets the rotation angle of the drawing coordinate system in dynamic graphic display (the angle of rotation about the vertical axis on the screen plane, that passes the center position of the blank).
Blank figure in dynamic graphic display

11343

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 1 This parameter sets the type of a blank figure in dynamic graphic display.
Setting 0 1
11344

Figure Cylinder or hollow cylinder (parallel to the Z-axis) Rectangular parallelepiped


Blank reference position in dynamic graphic display

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm,inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999 This parameter sets the reference position of a blank in the dynamic graphic display function by using coordinate values in the workpiece coordinate system.

- 490 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE If bit 3 (BGM) of parameter No. 11329 is set to 1, set coordinate values in the machine coordinate system.

11345 11346 11347

Blank dimension I in dynamic graphic display Blank dimension J in dynamic graphic display Blank dimension K in dynamic graphic display

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm,inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.000 to +999999.999 These parameters set the dimensions of a blank in the dynamic graphic display function according to the blank figure as follows:
Blank type Cylinder Hollow cylinder Rectangular prism Dimension I Column diameter Diameter of outer circle of cylinder Length in X-axis direction Dimension 0 Diameter of inner circle of cylinder Length in Y-axis direction Dimension Column length Cylinder length Length in Z-axis direction

11348

Drawing color of a tool in animated simulation in dynamic graphic display

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 7 This parameter sets the color in which a tool is drawn during animated simulation in the dynamic graphic display function.
#7 11349 PDM #6 #5 #4 YGW #3 WNS #2 GSP #1 ABC #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #1 ABC In animated simulation in the dynamic graphic display function, when a fine boring cycle or back boring cycle, which is a hole machining canned cycle, is performed, the movement for a shift at the hole bottom is: 0: Not drawn. 1: Drawn. GSP In tool path drawing in the dynamic graphic display function, the drawing start position is: 0: The end position of a block that makes a movement for the first time. 1: The current position.

#2

- 491 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE When G92, G52, or G92.1 (for machining center systems) or G50, G52, or G50.3 (for lathe systems) is specified at the beginning of a program to be drawn, the position specified in this G code is assumed to be the drawing start position.
#3 WNS In the dynamic graphic display function, P-CODE workpiece number search is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.

NOTE A macro executor option, or a macro executor and C executor options are required.
#4 YGW If Y-axis offset geometry and wear compensation is enabled, switching between the tool geometry and wear compensation screens is performed with 0: Soft key [SWITCH]. 1: Soft key [WEAR]/[GEOMETRY]. PDM When the pattern data input function is enabled, variable name and comment are: 0: Displayed on the custom macro screen only if the menu is selecting. 1: Always displayed on the custom macro screen.

#7

4.98
11350

PARAMETERS OF DISPLAY AND EDIT (4 OF 5)


#7 #6 QLS #5 PAD #4 9DE #3 #2 PNE #1 APD #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#1 APD The display of the program under execution is: 0: A display containing look-ahead blocks. 1: A text display. PNE Path name expansion display function is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.

#2

NOTE This parameter is invalid if the number of paths is 1. It is effective to 10.4- and 15-inch display units.
#4 9DE On 7.2- and 8.4-inch display units, the maximum number of axes that can be displayed on a single screen is: 0: 4. 1: 5.
- 492 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
PAD On the pitch error compensation screen, axis names are: 0: Not displayed. 1: Displayed. QLS The machining quality level adjustment screen is: 0: Not displayed. 1: Displayed.
#7 #6 GTD #5 #4 3DD #3 #2 #1 #0

#5

#6

11351

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 3DD The setting screen for the 3-dimensional machine position compensation function is: 0: Not displayed. 1: Displayed. GTD On the parameter screen, group names are: 0: Not displayed. 1: Displayed.

#6

NOTE If this parameter is changed, the change will take effect when a screen other than the parameter screen is displayed and the parameter screen is displayed again.
#7 11352 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 PNI

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 PNI The display by the path name enlarged display function is: 0: A normal display. 1: A reverse display.

NOTE This parameter is effective to 10.4- and 15-inch display units.


#7 11353 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 SDE #0 SEK

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 SEK When the power is turned on, or when the clear state is present, sequence numbers are: 0: Not maintained. 1: Maintained.

- 493 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE During a subprogram call, the sequence number of the subprogram is maintained.
#1 SDE Sequence numbers on the screen are displayed with: 0: 5 digits. 1: 8 digits.
#7 11354 #6 #5 #4 DPC #3 SOH #2 SAH #1 CRS #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#1 CRS While data transmission is awaited using the DPRNT/BPRNT of the custom macro or macro executor, screen switching is: 0: Not possible. 1: Possible. SAH When the storage capacity for history data is exceeded due to non-alarm history, alarm history will be: 0: Erased. 1: Erased, except the most recent 50 items of history data. SOH When the storage capacity for history data is exceeded due to data other than external operator message history, external operator message history will be: 0: Erased. 1: Retained.

#2

#3

NOTE 1 The settings of bit 2 (SAH) of parameter No. 11354 and bit 3 (SOH) of parameter No. 11354 will be effective the next time the power is turned on. At this time, all history data (operation history, alarm history, and external operator message history) will be erased. 2 With the settings of bit 2 (SAH) of parameter No. 11354 and bit 3 (SOH) of parameter No. 11354, the number of history data items that can be retained varies. The number of history data items that can be recorded as follows: SAH=0, SOH=0 . . . Approx. 8000 items SAH=1, SOH=0 . . . Approx. 7400 items SAH=0, SOH=1 . . . Approx. 7500 items SAH=1, SOH=1 . . . Approx. 6900 items (*) The numbers of items above are those if only key operation history is recorded.
#4 DPC In the screen title, program comments corresponding to O-numbers are: 0: Displayed. 1: Not displayed.
- 494 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 #6 #5 #4 SCM #3 MTS #2 #1 CDA #0 DSN

11355

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 DSN The spindle names displayed on the spindle setting screen, the spindle adjustment screen, and the spindle monitor screen are: 0: Spindle numbers in the path plus the numbers indicating types such as MAIN and SUB. (Conventional specifications) 1: Names set in parameters. CDA When a 15-inch display unit is used, 0: A normal screen display is employed. 1: A screen display specifically for CNC display units for automotive is employed. MTS The function for switching between simultaneous multi-path display and single-path display is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. SCM In the initial state, the custom macro screen is: 0: A small screen display. 1: A full screen display.
#7 11356 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 TLD

#1

#3

#4

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 TLD When the protection signal is enabled, the deletion of the tool life management screen is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.

NOTE The 8-level data protection function cannot be disabled.


#7 11362 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 GSF

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 GSF In the lathe/machining center G code system switching function, the mode display is: 0: Shown in T-MODE (turning mode)/M-MODE (milling mode). 1: Not shown.
#7 11365 D40 #7 11366 D48 #6 D39 #6 D47 #5 D38 #5 D46 #4 D37 #4 D45 #3 D36 #3 D44 #2 D35 #2 D43 #1 D34 #1 D42 #0 D33 #0 D41

- 495 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 11367 D56 #6 D55 #5 D54 #4 D53 #3 D52 #2 D51 #1 D50

B-63950EN/04 #0 D49

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path D33 to D49 These bits set the G code groups to be displayed on the program check screen. The correspondence between the bits and G code groups is as given in the table below. The settings of each bit have the meanings below. 0: The G code group corresponding to the bit is displayed. 1: The G code group corresponding to the bit is not displayed.
Parameter D33 D34 D35 to D56 G code group 33 34 35 to 56

4.99
11400

PARAMETERS OF TOOL COMPENSATION (2 OF 3)


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 NO5 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #1 NO5 The fifth axis offset function is: 0: Not used. 1: Used.
Distance to the + contact ace of the touch sensor Distance to the - contact ace of the touch sensor

11401 11402

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm,inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) These parameters are for the function of direct input of offset value measured B. These parameters set the distances (with signs) to the respective contact faces of the sensor from the measurement reference position. For angular axis control, set the distances in the orthogonal coordinate system.

- 496 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Measurement reference position

Xp

Xm X-axis - contact face Z-axis - contact face Z-axis + contact face Zm X-axis + contact face Zp

+X

+Z
#7 11403 #6 WNM #5 #4 MMT #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #4 MMT If the tool offset for milling and turning function is used, the compensation values acquired with machining center system measurement functions are regarded as: 0: Tool length compensation values. 1: Tool position compensation values. If, in a machining center system measurement function, the X-axis direction of the tool is measured with MMT being set to 0, this results in the Z-axis/length (tool length compensation value). the X-axis direction of the tool is measured with MMT being set to 1, this results in the tool position compensation value in the X-axis direction. WNM In the tool length/workpiece zero point measurement function, the automatic reference position return operation after tool length compensation value measurement is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
Number of the workpiece coordinate system used as the reference for workpiece setting error amount No. 01 Number of the workpiece coordinate system used as the reference for workpiece setting error amount No. 02 Number of the workpiece coordinate system used as the reference for workpiece setting error amount No. 03 Number of the workpiece coordinate system used as the reference for workpiece setting error amount No. 04 Number of the workpiece coordinate system used as the reference for workpiece setting error amount No. 05 Number of the workpiece coordinate system used as the reference for workpiece setting error amount No. 06

#6

11411

11412

11413

11414

11415

11416

- 497 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
11417

B-63950EN/04

Number of the workpiece coordinate system used as the reference for workpiece setting error amount No. 07

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to 1300 These parameters set the numbers of the workpiece coordinate systems used as the reference for the respective workpiece setting errors. For G54 to G59, set 54 to 59. For G54.1P1 to G54.1P300, set 1001 to 1300. If 0 is set in one of these parameters, the workpiece setting error corresponding to that parameter cannot be used in multiple workpiece coordinate systems.

4.100
11420

PARAMETERS OF OPTIMUM TORQUE ACCELERATION/DECELERATION FOR RIGID TAPPING


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 RAU

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 RAU Optimum torque acceleration/deceleration function for rigid tapping is 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
Maximum acceleration of the optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 1) Maximum acceleration of the optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 2) Maximum acceleration of the optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 3) Maximum acceleration of the optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 4)

11421 11422 11423 11424

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word spindle rev/sec2 0 to 10000.0 These parameters set maximum accelerations.
Acceleration change time of bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 1) Acceleration change time of bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 2) Acceleration change time of bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 3) Acceleration change time of bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 4)

11425

11426

11427

11428

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word spindle msec 0 to 200

- 498 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
These parameters set the acceleration change time of bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (time taken for the change from the constant speed state (A) to the acceleration state (C) with the acceleration calculated from the optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping, i.e., the time indicated by (B) in the figure below).
Speed (min-1) Maximum acceleration that does not exceed the maximum permissible acceleration is automatically calculated.

(A)

(B)

(C)

(B)

(A)

(B)

(C)

(B)

(A)

Acceleration change time

11429 11430 11431 11432 11433 11434 11435 11436 11437 11438 11439 11440

Spindle speed at P1 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid taping (gear 1) Spindle speed at P2 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid taping (gear 1) Spindle speed at P3 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid taping (gear 1) Spindle speed at P1 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid taping (gear 2) Spindle speed at P2 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid taping (gear 2) Spindle speed at P3 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid taping (gear 2) Spindle speed at P1 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid taping (gear 3) Spindle speed at P2 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid taping (gear 3) Spindle speed at P3 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid taping (gear 3) Spindle speed at P1 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid taping (gear 4) Spindle speed at P2 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid taping (gear 4) Spindle speed at P3 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid taping (gear 4)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Byte spindle % 0 to 100 These parameters set the spindle speeds at P1 to P3 of acceleration points P0 to P4 as ratios to the maximum spindle speed (parameters Nos. 5241 to 5244). The spindle speed at P0 is 0, while the spindle speed at P4 is the maximum spindle speed. Any acceleration setting points where 0 is set will be skipped.

- 499 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
11441 11442 11443 11444 11445 11446 11447 11448 11449 11450 11451 11452 11453 11454 11455 11456 11457 11458 11459 11460

B-63950EN/04

Permissible acceleration at P0 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 1) Permissible acceleration at P1 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 1) Permissible acceleration at P2 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 1) Permissible acceleration at P3 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 1) Permissible acceleration at P4 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 1) Permissible acceleration at P0 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 2) Permissible acceleration at P1 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 2) Permissible acceleration at P2 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 2) Permissible acceleration at P3 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 2) Permissible acceleration at P4 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 2) Permissible acceleration at P0 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 3) Permissible acceleration at P1 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 3) Permissible acceleration at P2 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 3) Permissible acceleration at P3 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 3) Permissible acceleration at P4 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 3) Permissible acceleration at P0 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 4) Permissible acceleration at P1 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 4) Permissible acceleration at P2 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 4) Permissible acceleration at P3 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 4) Permissible acceleration at P4 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 4)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Byte spindle % 0 to 100 These parameters set the permissible accelerations at acceleration setting points P0 to P4 as ratios to the maximum acceleration (parameters Nos. 11421 to 11424). At any acceleration setting points where 0 is set, 100% is assumed.
Permissible deceleration at P0 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 1) Permissible deceleration at P1 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 1) Permissible deceleration at P2 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 1) Permissible deceleration at P3 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 1) Permissible deceleration at P4 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 1) Permissible deceleration at P0 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 2)

11461 11462 11463 11464 11465 11466

- 500 -

B-63950EN/04 11467 11468 11469 11470 11471 11472 11473 11474 11475 11476 11477 11478 11479 11480

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Permissible deceleration at P1 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 2) Permissible deceleration at P2 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 2) Permissible deceleration at P3 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 2) Permissible deceleration at P4 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 2) Permissible deceleration at P0 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 3) Permissible deceleration at P1 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 3) Permissible deceleration at P2 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 3) Permissible deceleration at P3 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 3) Permissible deceleration at P4 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 3) Permissible deceleration at P0 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 4) Permissible deceleration at P1 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 4) Permissible deceleration at P2 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 4) Permissible deceleration at P3 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 4) Permissible deceleration at P4 in optimum acceleration/deceleration for rigid tapping (gear 4)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Byte spindle % 0 to 100 These parameters set the permissible decelerations at acceleration setting points P0 to P4 as ratios to the maximum acceleration (parameters Nos. 11421 to 11424). At any acceleration setting points where 0 is set, 100% is assumed.

4.101
11502

PARAMETERS OF PROGRAMS (3 OF 4)
#7 IPW #6 CTC #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #6 CTC During axis moving, the time constant of rapid traverse linear acceleration/deceleration for each axis (parameter No. 1620) is: 0: Write-disabled. 1: Write-enabled. IPW The advanced preview feed-forward coefficient (parameter No. 2092) and bit 0 (SMR) of parameter No. 8162 for specifying whether to apply a mirror image during synchronization control are: 0: Write-disabled during axis moving. 1: Write-enabled if the corresponding axis is stopped.

#7

- 501 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 11600 #6 #5 AX1 #4 #3 #2 D3IT #1

B-63950EN/04 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #2 D3IT In the 3-dimensional coordinate system conversion mode, the valid interlock signals (interlock signal for each axis (*ITx) or interlock signal for each axis direction (MITx, PITx)) are: 0: The signals for all of the target axes for 3-dimensional coordinate system conversion. 1: The signals for axes along which a movement is made during 3-dimensional coordinate system conversion. AX1 If, in coordinate system rotation mode, a 1-axis command is issued in absolute mode, 0: First, the specified position is calculated in the coordinate system before rotation, and then the coordinate system is rotated. 1: First, the coordinate system is rotated, and then the tool moves to the specified position in the coordinate system. (FS16i/18i/21i compatible specification)

#5

[Example] G90 G0 X0 Y0 G01 X10. Y10. F6000 G68 X0 Y0 R45. ........................Coordinate system rotation command Y14.142 .....................................1-axis command (1) G69 When the bit 5 (AX1) of parameter No. 11600 is set to 0: In the coordinate system (XY) before rotation, the specified position is calculated, and then the coordinate system is rotated. Thus, for the command in (1), the position on the X-axis that is not specified is assumed to be X10, so that the specified position is (X10,Y14.142). Then, the tool moves to the movement position (X-2.929,Y17.071) resulting from 45-degree rotation.
Y Movement position : X-2.929,Y17.071

Specified position : X10,Y14.142 Tool path 45 degrees

Coordinates before the coordinate system rotation command : X10,Y10

When the bit 5 (AX1) of parameter No. 11600 is set to 1: The command in (1) converts the coordinates before the coordinate system rotation command, (X10,Y10), into the coordinates (X'14.142,Y'0) in the coordinate system rotated by 45 degrees (X'Y'). Then, the tool moves to the specified position (X'14.142,Y'14.142), i.e., the movement position (X0,Y20).
- 502 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Specified position : X'14.142,Y'14.142 Movement position : X0,Y20

Tool path Y'

X' Coordinates before the coordinate system rotation command Conversion : X10,Y10 Coordinates in the coordinate system after rotation : X'14.142,Y'0 X

45 degrees

#7 11630

#6

#5

#4

#3

#2 TFR

#1

#0 FRD

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 FRD The minimum command unit of the rotation angles of coordinate rotation and 3-dimensional coordinate system conversion is: 0: 0.001 degree. 1: 0.00001 degree. (1/100,000) TFR The minimum command unit of the rotation angles of the tilted working plane command is: 0: 0.001 degree. 1: 0.00001 degree.
M code 1 to protect M code 2 to protect M code 3 to protect M code 4 to protect M code 5 to protect M code 6 to protect M code 7 to protect M code 8 to protect M code 9 to protect M code 10 to protect

#2

11631 11632 11633 11634 11635 11636 11637 11638 11639 11640

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 3 to 99999999 (except 30, 98, and 99)
- 503 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

In connection with the M code protect function, these parameters set the M codes (auxiliary functions) to be permitted for execution from macro programs only.

NOTE Set 0 in any of the parameters that are not used.


11641 11643 11645 M code start number to protect (1st set) M code start number to protect (2nd set) M code start number to protect (3rd set)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 3 to 99999999 (except 30, 98, and 99)
11642 11644 11646 Number of M codes to protect (1st set) Number of M codes to protect (2nd set) Number of M codes to protect (3rd set)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 1 to 32767
In connection with the M code protect function, these parameters set the M codes (auxiliary functions) to be permitted for execution from macro programs only. Set an M code number and the number of consecutive M codes.

Up to three such sets can be set. Any sets in which either the M code number or the number of M codes is out of range are invalid. [Example of setting]
1st set M code Number of codes M codes to protect No. 1164150 No. 1164210 M50 to M59 2nd set No. 11643150 No. 116445 M150 to M154 3rd set No. 11645900 No. 1164630 M900 to M929

[Example of use] Parameter No. 11631 = 50: M50 is set as the M code to protect.
Main program O001 ; G90 G00 : : : M100 ; : : M50 ; : :
Macro program called by M100 with a macro call

(2)

O9020 ; G28 G90 Z10. : : : M50 ; (1) : : M99 ;

In this example, the following takes place: (1) The M50 command specified for protection is specified from within a program called with a macro call and is, therefore, executable.
- 504 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
(2) The M50 command specified for protection is specified from within the main program and is, therefore, not executable. (Alarm PS501 is issued.)

NOTE 1 Macro calls that can execute the M codes (auxiliary functions) specified for protection are as follows: - Macro call using a G/M code - Macro call using a macro interruption - Macro call using a T/S/second auxiliary function code (With this function, they are treated as macro calls.) 2 The calls below cannot execute the M codes specified for protection. - Macro call using a G65/G66/G66.1 - Subprogram call (except a T/S/second auxiliary function code.) 3 M code commands from execution macros are always executable. 4 It is possible to specify the target M codes (auxiliary functions) from a subprogram in a state in which a macro call is already executed. [Example] Main program Macro call Subprogram call (M code command) The target M code is specified from a subprogram called from a macro program and is, therefore, executable. 5 M code commands in MDI mode are also checked in the same way. 6 This function is invalid to the following M codes: - M00, M01, M02, M30, M98, M99

4.102
11681

PARAMETERS OF MACHINING QUALITY LEVEL ADJUSTMENT


Smoothing level currently selected when nano smoothing is used

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to 10 This parameter sets the smoothing level currently selected when nano smoothing or nano smoothing 2 is used.
11682 11683 Tolerance when nano smoothing is used (smoothing level 1) Tolerance when nano smoothing is used (smoothing level 10)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) Each of these parameters sets a tolerance value when nano smoothing is used.
- 505 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
It is necessary to set the value of both level1 and level10.
11684 11685

B-63950EN/04

Tolerance of rotary axes when nano smoothing 2 is used (smoothing level 1) Tolerance of rotary axes when nano smoothing 2 is used (smoothing level 10)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) Each of these parameters sets tolerances of rotary axes when nano smoothing 2 is used. It is necessary to set the value of both level1 and level10.
Standard value of smoothing level when nano smoothing is used

11686

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 10 Set standard value of smoothing level when nano smoothing or nano smoothing 2 is used. When the power is turned on or the system is reset, the smoothing level 0 : keeps its value. 1 to 10 : becomes the level set to this parameter.
11687 Standard value of precision level when AI contour control is used

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 10 Set standard value of precision level when AI contour control is used. When the power is turned on or the system is reset, the precision level 0 : keeps its value. 1 to 10 : becomes the level set to this parameter.

4.103
11750 11751 11752

PARAMETERS OF WORKPIECE SETTING ERROR COMPENSATION (2 OF 2)


Tolerance for assuming that the workpiece setting error a is 0 Tolerance for assuming that the workpiece setting error b is 0 Tolerance for assuming that the workpiece setting error c is 0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Unit of data] Least input increment of the error in the rotation direction in workpiece setting error compensation (see the explanation of parameter No. 11201) [Unit of data] 0 to 999999999 If the absolute value of the error in the rotation axis in workpiece setting error compensation is equal to or less than the setting of the corresponding one of these parameters, the error in the rotation direction is regarded as 0. If the setting is negative, its absolute value is used.
- 506 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
The least input increment of the error in the rotation direction depends on the setting of parameter No. 11201. For a machine with a table rotation axis, these parameters are effective to the errors a, b, and c in the rotation direction, respectively, when the table rotation axis position in the workpiece coordinate system is 0.

11753 11754 11755

Upper limit on the workpiece setting error a Upper limit on the workpiece setting error b Upper limit on the workpiece setting error c

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path Degree Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) If a value other than 0 is set in one of these parameters, and the corresponding error in the rotation axis in workpiece setting error compensation is equal to or greater than the setting of that parameter, alarm PS0517, "SETTING ERROR AMOUNT IS OUT OF RANGE" is issued when workpiece setting error compensation is started. The least input increment of these parameters adheres to the reference axis regardless of the setting of parameter No. 11201. For a machine with a table rotation axis, these parameters are effective to the errors a, b, and c in the rotation direction, respectively, when the table rotation axis position in the workpiece coordinate system is 0.
Lower limit on the workpiece setting error a Lower limit on the workpiece setting error b Lower limit on the workpiece setting error c

11756 11757 11758

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path Degree Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) If a value other than 0 is set in one of these parameters, and the corresponding error in the rotation axis in workpiece setting error compensation is equal to or less than the setting of that parameter, alarm PS0517, "SETTING ERROR AMOUNT IS OUT OF RANGE" is issued when workpiece setting error compensation is started. The least input increment of these parameters adheres to the reference axis regardless of the setting of parameter No. 11201. For a machine with a table rotation axis, these parameters are effective to the errors a, b, and c in the rotation direction, respectively, when the table rotation axis position in the workpiece coordinate system is 0.

- 507 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

4.104
11802

PARAMETERS OF SERVO (2 OF 2)
#7 #6 #5 #4 KSV #3 #2 SWF #1 #0 CPY

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 CPY When a change from a semi-closed loop to a closed loop is made by the SEMIx signal, and when the SEMIx signal indicates a closed loop at power-on, the absolute coordinate value in the semi-closed loop is: 0: Not replaced by the absolute coordinate value in the closed loop. 1: Replaced by the absolute coordinate value in the closed loop. SWF When switching between the semi-closed loop and closed loop is performed by the SEMIx signal, re-creation of coordinate values on the detector on the loop side set after switching is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed. KSV Servo axis is: 0: Enabled. 1: Disabled.

#2

#4

NOTE 1 This setting is effective regardless of the value of parameter No. 1023. 2 If this setting is made for the axis subject to Cs axis contour/spindle positioning, Cs axis contour/spindle positioning will be disabled.
#7 11803 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 CDP #0 STH

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 STH The dual position feedback turning mode is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.

NOTE Before the dual position feedback turning mode function can be used, a setting to enable dual position feedback is required in addition to the setting of this bit.
#1 CDP Dual position feedback compensation clamping is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed.
- 508 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE Before the dual position feedback compensation clamp function can be used, a setting to enable dual position feedback is required in addition to the setting of this bit.

4.105
11850

PARAMETERS OF AXIS CONTROL BY PMC (2 OF 3)


#7 IFH #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 CMI

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 CMI If, in PMC axis control, a rapid traverse rate is specified with the axis control block data signal, with bit 0 (RPD) of parameter No. 8002 being set to 1, the rapid traverse rate is: 0: Always treated as being in millimeters. 1: Dependent on the setting of bit 0 (INM) of parameter No. 1001. IFH When bit 2 (OVE) of parameter No. 8001 is set to 1 in PMC axis control, the 1% rapid traverse override signals *EROVs are: 0: On a path-by-path basis. (The first groups in the individual paths (first, fifth, ninth, ..., 33rd, and 37th groups) are used.) 1: On a group-by-group basis. Depending on this parameter and bit 1 (OVR) of parameter No. 8013, selected signals are as given in the table below. (The signal addresses are those in the first path, and the actual addresses differ depending on the group used.)
Bit 7 (IFH) of No. 11850 = 0 (*EROVs are on a path-by-path basis.) Bit 1 (OVR) of No. 8013 = 0 EROV1, EROV2 <G150.0, G150.1> Bit 7 (IFH) of No. 11850 = 1 (*EROVs are on a group-by-group basis.) EROV1, EROV2 <G150.0, G150.1> *EROVA<G151> *EROVB<G163> *EROVC<G175> *EROVD<G187>

#7

Bit 1 (OVR) of No. 8013 = 1

*EROV<G151>

NOTE Overrides are clamped at up to 100%.

4.106
11900 11901 11902

PARAMETERS OF PMC
PMC of execution order 1 in the multi-PMC function PMC of execution order 2 in the multi-PMC function PMC of execution order 3 in the multi-PMC function

- 509 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte [Valid data range] 0 to 3 Each of these parameters sets the execution order of each PMC when the multi-PMC function is used.
Setting value 0 1 2 3 PMC system Initial setting (see below) First PMC Second PMC Third PMC

When 0 is set in all of these parameters, the initially set execution order shown below is used.
First PMC Second Third PMC

Other processing such as trace Initial setting of multi-PMC execution order

CAUTION If any of these parameters is nonzero, a duplicate or missing number results in the PMC alarm "ER50 PMC EXECUTION ORDER ERROR", thus disabling all the PMCs from starting.
11905 11906 11907 Execution time percentage (%) of PMC of execution order 1 in the multi-PMC function Execution time percentage (%) of PMC of execution order 2 in the multi-PMC function Execution time percentage (%) of PMC of execution order 3 in the multi-PMC function

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input Byte % 0 to 100 Each of these parameters sets the execution time percentage (%) of each PMC when the multi-PMC function is used. When 0 is set in all of these parameters, the following initially set execution time percentage values are used:

- 510 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Initial setting of execution time percentages in the multi-PMC function PMC of PMC of PMC of Multi-PMC configuration execution order 1 execution order 2 execution order 3 First PMC only 100% First PMC + second PMC 85% 15% First PMC + third PMC 85% 15% First PMC + second PMC + third PMC 75% 15% 10%

NOTE 1 If a too small value is specified in these parameters, the first level may not be started for each scan. 2 Even if you input the same program in both second and third PMC, the scan time of both programs may not correspond because of changing of the waiting time by execution timing. 3 If the sum of these parameter settings exceeds 100, the PMC alarm "ER51 PMC EXECUTION PERCENTAGE ERROR" occurs, thus disabling all PMC from starting. 4 When the PMC memory sharing mode is used, the execution times of the shared PMC systems are totaled up, and sharing programs are executed successively in the total time.
11910 11911 11912 11913 I/O Link channel 1 input/output addresses I/O Link channel 2 input/output addresses I/O Link channel 3 input/output addresses I/O Link channel 4 input/output addresses

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0, 100 to 103, 200 to 203, 300 to 303, 900 Each of these parameters sets I/O Link input/output addresses.
Setting value 0 100 101 102 103 200 201 202 203 300 301 302 303 900 Input/output addresses of I/O Link channels Input/output address Initial setting (see below) X0 to 127/Y0 to 127 of the first PMC X200to327 / Y200to327 of the first PMC X400to527 / Y400to527 of the first PMC X600to727 / Y600to727 of the first PMC X0to127 / Y0to127 of the second PMC X200to327 / Y200to327 of the second PMC X400to527 / Y400to527 of the second PMC X600to727 / Y600to727 of the second PMC X0to127 / Y0to127 of the third PMC X200to327 / Y200to327 of the third PMC X400to527 / Y400to527 of the third PMC X600to727 / Y600to727 of the third PMC X0 to 127/Y0 to 127 of the dual check safety PMC

- 511 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

When all of these parameters are set to 0, all channels are assigned to the first PMC according to the initial setting as shown below.
First PMC X/Y 0 to 127 X/Y 200 to 327 X/Y 400 to 527 X/Y 600 to 727 Channel 1 Channel 2 Channel 3 Channel 4

Initial input/output address setting for each I/O Link channel

CAUTION 1 If a duplicate number is set when a value other than 0 is set in any of these parameters, PMC alarm ER52 I/O LINK CHANNEL ASSIGNMENT ERROR is issued, and none of the PMCs can be started. 2 If a parameter is not set, the assignment of PMC addresses to the channel is disabled.
11915 11916 11917 11918 Input/output addresses of the second block of I/O Link channel 1 Input/output addresses of the second block of I/O Link channel 2 Input/output addresses of the second block of I/O Link channel 3 Input/output addresses of the second block of I/O Link channel 4

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0, 100 to 103, 200 to 203, 300 to 303 Each of these parameters sets input/output addresses of two blocks of an I/O Link channel.
Input/output addresses of two blocks of each I/O Link channel Setting Input/output address 0 100 101 102 103 200 201 202 203 300 301 302 303 Does not perform assignment of two blocks of an I/O Link channel. X0 to 127/Y0 to 127 of the first PMC X200 to 327/Y200 to 327 of the first PMC X400 to 527/Y400 to 527 of the first PMC X600 to 727/Y600 to 727 of the first PMC X0 to 127/Y0 to 127 of the second PMC X200 to 327/Y200 to 327 of the second PMC X400 to 527/Y400 to 527 of the second PMC X600 to 727/Y600 to 727 of the second PMC X0 to 127/Y0 to 127 of the third PMC X200 to 327/Y200 to 327 of the third PMC X400 to 527/Y400 to 527 of the third PMC X600 to 727/Y600 to 727 of the third PMC

- 512 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
When these parameters are set to 0, assignment of two blocks of an I/O Link channel is not performed.

CAUTION 1 If a duplicate number is set in these parameters and parameter Nos. 11910 to 11913, PMC alarm "ER52 I/O LINK CHANNEL ASSIGNMENT ERROR" is issued, and none of the PMCs can be started. 2 The dual check safety PMC (DCSPMC) uses the first block of channel 3 or channel 4. In this case, never assign the second block of that channel to safety signals in the first, second, and third PMCs.
11920 11921 11922 11923 11924 11925 11926 11927 11928 11929 Input/output addresses of NC-PMC interface 1 Input/output addresses of NC-PMC interface 2 Input/output addresses of NC-PMC interface 3 Input/output addresses of NC-PMC interface 4 Input/output addresses of NC-PMC interface 5 Input/output addresses of NC-PMC interface 6 Input/output addresses of NC-PMC interface 7 Input/output addresses of NC-PMC interface 8 Input/output addresses of NC-PMC interface 9 Input/output addresses of NC-PMC interface 10

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0, 100 to 109, 200 to 209, 300 to 309 Each of these parameters assigns PMC F/G addresses to CNC F/G addresses.
CNC F/G addresses of CNC First PMC F/G addresses of 1st PMC

Second PMC F/G addresses of 2nd PMC

Third PMC F/G addresses of 3rd PMC

Concept of NC-PMC interface assignment

- 513 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Setting value 0 100 101 102 103 104 105 106 107 108 109 200 201 202 203 204 205 206 207 208 209 300 301 302 303 304 305 306 307 308 309 Input/output addresses of NC-PMC interfaces Input/output address Initial setting (see below) F0to767 / G0to767 of the first PMC F1000to1767 / G1000to1767 of the first PMC F2000to2767 / G2000to2767 of the first PMC F3000to3767 / G3000to3767 of the first PMC F4000to4767 / G4000to4767 of the first PMC F5000to5767 / G5000to5767 of the first PMC F6000to6767 / G6000to6767 of the first PMC F7000to7767 / G7000to7767 of the first PMC F8000to8767 / G8000to8767 of the first PMC F9000to9767 / G9000to9767 of the first PMC F0to767 / G0to767 of the second PMC F1000to1767 / G1000to1767 of the second PMC F2000to2767 / G2000to2767 of the second PMC F3000to3767 / G3000to3767 of the second PMC F4000to4767 / G4000to4767 of the second PMC F5000to5767 / G5000to5767 of the second PMC F6000to6767 / G6000to6767 of the second PMC F7000to7767 / G7000to7767 of the second PMC F8000to8767 / G8000to8767 of the second PMC F9000to9767 / G9000to9767 of the second PMC F0to767 / G0to767 of the third PMC F1000to1767 / G1000to1767 of the third PMC F2000to2767 / G2000to2767 of the third PMC F3000to3767 / G3000to3767 of the third PMC F4000to4767 / G4000to4767 of the third PMC F5000to5767 / G5000to5767 of the third PMC F6000to6767 / G6000to6767 of the third PMC F7000to7767 / G7000to7767 of the third PMC F8000to8767 / G8000to8767 of the third PMC F9000to9767 / G9000to9767 of the third PMC

B-63950EN/04

When 0 is set in all of these parameters, "F/G addresses of the CNC = F/G addresses of the first PMC" results according to the initial setting as shown below.
CNC F/G0 to 767 of CNC F/G1000 to 1767 of CNC F/G2000 to 2767 of CNC F/G3000 to 3767 of CNC F/G4000 to 4767 of CNC F/G5000 to 5767 of CNC F/G6000 to 6767 of CNC F/G7000 to 7767 of CNC F/G8000 to 8767 of CNC F/G9000to 9767 of CNC First PMC F/G0 to 767 of first PMC F/G1000 to 1767 of first PMC F/G2000 to 2767 of first PMC F/G3000 to 3767 of first PMC F/G4000 to 4767 of first PMC F/G5000 to 5767 of first PMC F/G6000 to 6767 of first PMC F/G7000 to 7767 of first PMC F/G8000 to 8767 of first PMC F/G9000 to 9767 of first PMC

Initial setting of NC-PMC interfaces

- 514 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS CAUTION 1 If any of these parameters is nonzero, a duplicate number results in the PMC alarm "ER54 NC-PMC I/F ASSIGNMENT ERROR", thus disabling all the PMCs from starting. 2 If a parameter is not set, the assignment of PMC addresses to the F/G addresses of the NC is disabled.

11930

Execution interval of ladder level 1

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte [Valid data range] 0, 4 ,8 This parameter sets the execution interval of ladder level 1.
Setting 4 0, 8 Executed at intervals of 4 msec. Executed at intervals of 8 msec. Description

CAUTION If this parameter is set to a value other than 0, 4, or 8, the PMC alarm ER55 LEVEL 1 EXECUTION INTERVAL ERROR is issued and all PMCs are not started.
#7 11931 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 M16 #0 PCC

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 PCC For a multipath PMC, ladder execution and stop are: 0: Controlled individually for each PMC path. 1: Controlled simultaneously for all PMC paths.

NOTE When the PMC memory sharing mode is used, ladder execution and stop are controlled simultaneously for all PMC paths, regardless of the setting of this parameter.
#1 M16 In the external data input and external messages, the maximum number of external alarm messages and external operator messages that can be displayed is: 0: 4. 1: 16.
- 515 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
11932 Interface between PMCs

B-63950EN/04

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte [Valid data range] 0, 1, 2, 3 This parameter sets the PMCs that use the PMC-to-PMC interface.
Setting 0 1 2 3 Meaning The PMC-to-PMC interface is not used. The PMC-to-PMC interface is used between the 1st PMC and the 2nd PMC. The PMC-to-PMC interface is used between the 1st PMC and the 3rd PMC. The PMC-to-PMC interface is used between the 2nd PMC and the 3rd PMC.

CAUTION If a value beyond the valid data range is set in this parameter, PMC alarm "ER57 PMC-TO-PMC INTERFACE ASSIGNMENT ERROR" is issued, and none of the PMCs can be started. Similarly, when a PMC specified in this parameter is not present, PMC alarm "ER57 PMC-TO-PMC INTERFACE ASSIGNMENT ERROR" is issued, and none of the PMCs can be started. NOTE This function cannot be used for PMCs for which the PMC memory sharing mode is set.
11940 11941 11942 PMC memory type of the first PMC PMC memory type of the second PMC PMC memory type of the third PMC

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Data type] Byte [Valid data range] -1, 0, 1, 2, 3 These parameters select the type of PMC memory. For the specifications of the PMC memory types, see Table 2.1.1 (b) in Subsection 2.1.1, "Basic Specifications".
Setting 0 1 2 3 -1 Meaning The PMC memory set as the standard setting is used. PMC memory A is used. PMC memory B is used. PMC memory C is used. The 2nd and 3rd PMCs share the PMC memory with the 1st PMC.

In the standard settings, the following PMC memory types are set for the PMCs:
- 516 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
PMC 1st PMC 2nd PMC 3rd PMC PMC memory type PMC memory B PMC memory A PMC memory A

CAUTION 1 If the value set in any of these parameters is beyond the valid data range, PMC alarm "ER58 PMC MEMORY TYPE SETTING ERROR" is issued, and none of the PMCs can be started. 2 When the PMC memory type has been changed, the PMC battery-powered memory must be initialized. For this reason, before changing the PMC memory type, back up PMC parameters. For how to initialize the PMC battery-powered memory, refer to Section 2.7, "BATTERY-BACKED-UP DATA", in "FANUC Series 30i/31i/32i-A PMC Programming Manual" (B-63983EN). NOTE 1 When PMC memory C is used for the first PMC, and the entire area of the data table is battery-powered, add the option for 10KB expansion of the PMC data table battery-powered area. If this option is not provided, the area from D10000 to D19999 in the data table is not battery-powered. 2 When PMC memory B is used for the second PMC, and the entire area of the data table is battery-powered, add the option for 7KB expansion of the PMC data table battery-powered area. If this option is not provided, the area from D3000 to D9999 in the data table is not battery-powered.
11950 to 11957 11960 to 11967 11970 to 11977 11980 to 11987 to to to to

These parameters are related to Dual Check Safety. See Dual Check Safety CONNECTION MANUAL (B-64003EN) for details.

- 517 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

4.107
12020 12023 12026 12029 12032 12035 12038 12041 12044 12047

PARAMETERS OF EMBEDDED MACRO (2 OF 2)


G code number for the embedded macro (first) G code number for the embedded macro (second) G code number for the embedded macro (third) G code number for the embedded macro (fourth) G code number for the embedded macro (fifth) G code number for the embedded macro (sixth) G code number for the embedded macro (seventh) G code number for the embedded macro (eighth) G code number for the embedded macro (ninth) G code number for the embedded macro (tenth)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid date range] 1 to 999
12021 12024 12027 12030 12033 12036 12039 12042 12045 12048 Macro program number for the embedded macro (first) Macro program number for the embedded macro (second) Macro program number for the embedded macro (third) Macro program number for the embedded macro (fourth) Macro program number for the embedded macro (fifth) Macro program number for the embedded macro (sixth) Macro program number for the embedded macro (seventh) Macro program number for the embedded macro (eighth) Macro program number for the embedded macro (ninth) Macro program number for the embedded macro (tenth)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid date range] 1 to 9999

- 518 -

B-63950EN/04 12022 12025 12028 12031 12034 12037 12040 12043 12046 12049

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Number of G code macro for embedded macro (first) Number of G code macro for embedded macro (second) Number of G code macro for embedded macro (third) Number of G code macro for embedded macro (fourth) Number of G code macro for embedded macro (fifth) Number of G code macro for embedded macro (sixth) Number of G code macro for embedded macro (seventh) Number of G code macro for embedded macro (eighth) Number of G code macro for embedded macro (ninth) Number of G code macro for embedded macro (tenth)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid date range] 1 to 255 The data of the macro call by G code added by the embedded macro is set. G code number and the macro program number for it are set, and the number of G codes is set. These sets can be set up to ten. If G code number duplicates, it gives priority from former set. The set that the G code number or the macro program number or numbers is 0 is invalid. [Example] In case that the range of macro program number is 7000 to 8999:
First group G code Program number Number No. 12020=100 No. 12021=8000 No. 12022=10 Second group No. 12023=150 No. 12024=7500 No. 12025=5 Third group No. 12026=900 No. 12027=8300 No. 12028=30

The following program is called by each G code.


G code G100 toG109 G150 to G154 G900 to G929 Called program O8000 to O8009 O7500 to O7504 O8300 to O8329

NOTE The parameter value is regarded as 0, when each parameter is set a out of range value.

- 519 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

4.108
12201 12202 12203 12204 12205 12206

PARAMETERS OF HIGH-SPEED POSITION SWITCH (2 OF 2)


Controlled axis for which the eleventh high-speed position switch function is performed Controlled axis for which the twelfth high-speed position switch function is performed Controlled axis for which the thirteenth high-speed position switch function is performed Controlled axis for which the fourteenth high-speed position switch function is performed Controlled axis for which the fifteenth high-speed position switch function is performed Controlled axis for which the sixteenth high-speed position switch function is performed

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to number of controlled axes Each of these parameters sets a controlled axis number for which each of the eleventh to sixteenth high-speed position switch functions is performed. Set 0 for the number corresponding to a high-speed position switch which is not to be used.
12221 12222 12223 12224 12225 12226 Maximum value of the operation range of the eleventh high-speed position switch Maximum value of the operation range of the twelfth high-speed position switch Maximum value of the operation range of the thirteenth high-speed position switch Maximum value of the operation range of the fourteenth high-speed position switch Maximum value of the operation range of the fifteenth high-speed position switch Maximum value of the operation range of the sixteenth high-speed position switch

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch, degree (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Each of these parameters sets the maximum value of the operation range of each of the eleventh to sixteenth high-speed position switches. If such a setting that maximum value < minimum value is made, no operation range exists, so that the high-speed position switch does not operate.
Minimum value of the operation range of the eleventh high-speed position switch Minimum value of the operation range of the twelfth high-speed position switch Minimum value of the operation range of the thirteenth high-speed position switch Minimum value of the operation range of the fourteenth high-speed position switch Minimum value of the operation range of the fifteenth high-speed position switch Minimum value of the operation range of the sixteenth high-speed position switch

12241 12242 12243 12244 12245 12246

[Input type] Parameter input


- 520 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Real path mm, inch, degree (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Each of these parameters sets the minimum value of the operation range of each of the eleventh to sixteenth high-speed position switches. If such a setting that maximum value < minimum value is made, no operation range exists, so that the high-speed position switch does not operate.

[Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

4.109
12255

PARAMETERS OF MALFUNCTION PROTECTION


Maximum servo motor speed

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) This parameter sets a maximum servo motor speed. When the value set in this parameter is exceeded, the servo motor stops with the alarm DS0004. When 0 is set in this parameter, the specification of a maximum allowable value (999000 for IS-B) is assumed.
Maximum servo motor acceleration rate

12256

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/sec/sec, inch/sec/sec, degree/sec/sec (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (D) (When the machine system is metric system, 0.0 to +100000.0. When the machine system is inch system, machine, 0.0 to +10000.0) This parameter sets a maximum servo motor acceleration rate. When the value set in this parameter is exceeded, the servo motor stops with the alarm DS0005. When 0 is set in this parameter, alarm check is not performed.

4.110
12300 12301 12302 12303 12304

PARAMETERS OF MANUAL HANDLE (2 OF 2)


X address of the 1st. manual pulse generator X address of the 2nd. manual pulse generator X address of the 3rd. manual pulse generator X address of the 4th. manual pulse generator X address of the 5th. manual pulse generator

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input
- 521 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
[Data type] Word [Valid data range] -1, 0 to 127, 200 to 327, 400 to 527, 600 to 727 To set X address of manual pulse generator connected with I/O Link in PMC. When the manual pulse generator is not connected, set -1 to this parameter.
PMC Path 1st. manual pulse generator 2nd. manual pulse generator 3rd. manual pulse generator 4th. manual pulse generator 5th. manual pulse generator No. 12340 No. 12341 No. 12342 No. 12343 No. 12344

B-63950EN/04

X Address No. 12300 No. 12301 No. 12302 No. 12303 No. 12304

Parameters No. 12340 to 12344 must be set as value showed in next table.
Value 0 1 2 3 PMC Path 1st. PMC 2nd. PMC 3rd. PMC

NOTE Set these parameters when bit 1 (HDX) of parameter No. 7105 is set to 1. When HDX = 0, these parameters are automatically set. If a manual handle is not connected when HDX = 0, -1 is set automatically.
12310 States of the manual handle feed axis selection signals when tool axis direction handle feed/interrupt and table-based vertical direction handle feed/interrupt are performed

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to 24 This parameter sets the states of the manual handle feed axis selection signal (HS1A to HS1E for the first manual handle) or the manual handle interrupt axis selection signal (HS1IA to HS1IE for the first manual handle) to perform tool axis direction handle feed/interrupt and table-based vertical direction handle feed/interrupt. The handle for which the signal states are set is determined by parameter No. 12323. <Table of correspondence with the manual handle feed axis selection signals> If parameter No. 12323 is set to 1, the states of the manual handle feed axis selection signals or manual handle interrupt axis selection signals for the first manual handle in the 3-dimensional manual feed (handle feed) mode and corresponding parameter settings are listed in the table below. When the first manual handle pulse generator is turned after setting the signals corresponding to the value set in the parameter, operation is performed in the specified mode.
HS1E (HS1IE) 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 HS1D (HS1ID) 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 HS1C (HS1IC) 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 HS1B (HS1IB) 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 HS1A (HS1IA) 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Parameter (No. 12310) 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

- 522 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
HS1E (HS1IE) 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 HS1D (HS1ID) 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 HS1C (HS1IC) 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 HS1B (HS1IB) 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 HS1A (HS1IA) 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 Parameter (No. 12310) 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24

If parameter No. 12323 is set to 2 to 5, replace 1 in HS1A to HS1E and HS1IA to HS1IE above with 2 to 5.
12311 States of the manual handle feed axis selection signals when a movement is made in the first axis direction in tool axis normal direction handle feed/interrupt and table-based horizontal direction handle feed/interrupt

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to 24 This parameter sets the states of the manual handle feed axis selection signals (HS1A to HS1E for the first manual handle) or the manual handle interrupt axis selection signal (HS1IA to HS1IE for the first manual handle) when a movement is made in the first axis direction. (For settings, see "Table of correspondence with the manual handle feed axis selection signals" in the description of parameter No. 12310.) The handle for which the signal states are set is determined by parameter No. 12323. The table below indicates the relationships of tool axis directions, first axis directions, and second axis directions.
Parameter No. 19697 1 2 3 Tool axis directions X Y Z First axis directions Y Z X Second axis directions Z X Y

Note, however, that the table above indicates the directions applicable when the angles of all rotation axes are set to 0. In tool axis direction/tool axis normal direction feed (not table-based), the directions indicated above assume that 0 is set in parameter No. 19698 and No. 19699. When a rotation axis has made a turn or a nonzero value is set in these parameters in tool axis direction/tool axis normal direction feed, the relevant directions are inclined accordingly.
12312 States of the manual handle feed axis selection signals when a movement is made in the second axis direction in tool axis normal direction handle feed/interrupt and table-based horizontal direction handle feed/interrupt

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to 24
- 523 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

This parameter sets the states of the manual handle feed axis selection signals (HS1A to HS1E for the first manual handle) or the manual handle interrupt axis selection signals (HS1IA to HS1IE for the first manual handle) when a movement is made in the second axis direction. (For settings, see "Table of correspondence with the manual handle feed axis selection signals" in the description of parameter No. 12310.) The handle for which the signal states are set is determined by parameter No. 12323.
12313 States of the manual handle feed axis selection signals when the first rotation axis is turned in tool tip center rotation handle feed/interrupt

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to 24 This parameter sets the states of the manual handle feed axis selection signals (HS1A to HS1E for the first manual handle) or the manual handle interrupt axis selection signals (HS1IA to HS1IE for the first manual handle) when the first rotation axis is turned in tool tip center rotation handle feed or interrupt. (For settings, see "Table of correspondence with the manual handle feed axis selection signals" in the description of parameter No. 12310.) The handle for which the signal states are set is determined by parameter No. 12323.
12314 States of the manual handle feed axis selection signals when the second rotation axis is turned in tool tip center rotation handle feed/interrupt

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to 24 This parameter sets the states of the manual handle feed axis selection signals (HS1A to HS1E for the first manual handle) or the manual handle interrupt axis selection signals (HS1IA to HS1IE for the first manual handle) when the second rotation axis is turned in tool tip center rotation handle feed or interrupt. (For settings, see "Table of correspondence with the manual handle feed axis selection signals" in the description of parameter No. 12310.) The handle for which the signal states are set is determined by parameter No. 12323.
12318 Tool length in 3-dimensional machining manual feed

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real path mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets a tool length when tool tip center rotation feed is performed with the 3-dimensional machining manual feed function and when the 3-dimensional machining manual feed screen is displayed.

NOTE Specify a radius value to set this parameter.


#7 12319 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 CAT #0 CAC

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path


- 524 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
CAC If a workpiece coordinate system offset is set for the rotation axis, the coordinate system of the rotation axis used to calculate the 3-dimensional manual feed is: 0: Machine coordinate system. For those parameters Nos. 19680 to 19714 used to configure the machine that depend on the coordinates of the rotation axis, set the values assumed when the machine coordinates of the rotation axis are 0. 1: Workpiece coordinate system. For those parameters Nos. 19680 to 19714 used to configure the machine that depend on the coordinates of the rotation axis, set the values assumed when the workpiece coordinates of the rotation axis are 0. CAT If a workpiece coordinate system offset is set for the rotation axis, the coordinate system of the rotation axis used to calculate the thermal growth compensation along tool vector is: 0: Machine coordinate system. For those parameters Nos. 19680 to 19714 used to configure the machine that depend on the coordinates of the rotation axis, set the values assumed when the machine coordinates of the rotation axis are 0. 1: Workpiece coordinate system. For those parameters Nos. 19680 to 19714 used to configure the machine that depend on the coordinates of the rotation axis, set the values assumed when the workpiece coordinates of the rotation axis are 0.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 JFR #1 FLL #0 TWD

#0

#1

12320

EM4

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit path #0 TWD The directions of 3-dimensional machining manual feed (other than tool tip center rotation feed) when the tilted working plane command is issued are: 0: Same as those not in the tilted working plane command. That is, the directions are: Tool axis normal direction 1 (table-based horizontal direction 1) Tool axis normal direction 2 (table-based horizontal direction 2) Tool axis direction (table-based vertical direction) 1: X, Y, and Z directions in the feature coordinate system. FLL The directions of tool axis normal direction feed or table-based horizontal direction feed in the 3-dimensional machining manual feed mode are: 0: Tool axis normal direction 1 (table-based horizontal direction 1) and tool axis normal direction 2 (table-based horizontal direction 2). 1: Longitude direction and latitude direction.
Bit 1 (FLL) of parameter No. 12320 0 0 1 Bit 0 (TWD) of parameter No. 12320 0 1 0

#1

Directions of 3-dimensional machining manual feed Conventional directions When the tilted working plane command is issued: X, Y, and Z directions in the feature coordinate system When the command is not issued: Conventional directions Longitude direction and latitude direction

- 525 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Bit 1 (FLL) of parameter No. 12320 Bit 0 (TWD) of parameter No. 12320

B-63950EN/04

Directions of 3-dimensional machining manual feed When the tilted working plane command is issued: X, Y, and Z directions in the feature coordinate system When the command is not issued: Longitude direction and latitude direction

#2

JFR As the feeedrate of 3-dimensional machining manual feed (jog feed or incremental feed) : 0: The dry run rate (parameter No. 1410) is used. 1: The jog feedrate (parameter No. 1423) is used. EM4 Manual handle feed amount selection signal MP4 is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
Normal axis direction

#7

12321

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 3 When a tilted working plane command (G68.3) is issued to perform 3-dimensional machining manual feed in the latitude direction, longitude direction, and tool axis direction, this parameter sets an axis parallel to the normal direction. 1 : Positive (+) X-axis direction 2 : Positive (+) Y-axis direction 3 : Positive (+) Z-axis direction 0 : Reference tool axis direction (parameter No. 19697)
12322 Angle used to determine whether to assume the tool axis direction to be parallel to the normal direction (parameter No. 12321)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path deg Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 0 to 90 When a tilted working plane command (G68.3) is issued to perform 3-dimensional machining manual feed in the latitude direction, longitude direction, and tool axis direction, if the angle between the tool axis direction and normal direction (parameter No. 12321) is too small, the tool axis direction is assumed to be parallel to the normal direction (parameter No. 12321). This parameter sets the maximum angle at which the tool axis direction is assumed to be parallel to the normal direction. When this parameter is set to 0 or a value outside the valid range, it is set to 1 degree.
Number of a manual handle used for 3-dimensional machining manual feed

12323

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 5 When 3-dimensional machining manual feed (handle feed) is performed, set the number of the manual handle to be used. When the second or third manual handle is used for 3-dimensional machining manual feed, the option for manual handle feed with 2/3 handles is required.
- 526 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
When the fourth or fifth manual handle is used for 3-dimensional machining manual feed, the option for manual handle feed with 4/5 handles is required. If 0 or the number of an unavailable handle is set, the first handle is assumed.
#7 #6 G16 #6 G1E #6 G26 #6 G2E #6 G36 #6 G3E #6 G46 #6 G4E #5 G15 #5 G1D #5 G25 #5 G2D #5 G35 #5 G3D #5 G45 #5 G4D #4 G14 #4 G1C #4 G24 #4 G2C #4 G34 #4 G3C #4 G44 #4 G4C #3 G13 #3 G1B #3 G23 #3 G2B #3 G33 #3 G3B #3 G43 #3 G4B #2 G12 #2 G1A #2 G22 #2 G2A #2 G32 #2 G3A #2 G42 #2 G4A #1 G11 #1 G19 #1 G21 #1 G29 #1 G31 #1 G39 #1 G41 #1 G49 #0 G10 #0 G18 #0 G20 #0 G28 #0 G30 #0 G38 #0 G40 #0 G48

12330 12331 12332 12333 12334 12335 12336 12337

G17 #7 G1F #7 G27 #7 G2F #7 G37 #7 G3F #7 G47 #7 G4F

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
G10 to G4F When the Power Mate or I/O Link is connected to the I/O Link, these bits set whether to transfer pulses from manual pulse generators connected to the I/O Link to the Power Mate or I/O Link . The setting of each bit has the following meaning: 0: Pulses are transferred. 1: Pulses are not transferred. The bits and the corresponding I/O Link channel numbers and group numbers are listed below:
Parameter G10 G11 G12 : G1F : G4F
12340 12341 12342 12343

Channel number 1 1 1 : 1 : 4

Group number 0 1 2 : 15 : 15

PMC path of the 1st. manual pulse generator connected with I/O Link PMC path of the 2nd. manual pulse generator connected with I/O Link PMC path of the 3rd. manual pulse generator connected with I/O Link PMC path of the 4th. manual pulse generator connected with I/O Link

- 527 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
12344 PMC path of the 5th. manual pulse generator connected with I/O Link

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte [Valid data range] 0 to 3 Referring to parameters Nos. 12300 to 12304.
12350 Manual handle feed magnification m in each axis

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis [Valid data range] 0 to 2000 For each axis, this parameter sets the magnification m when manual handle feed movement selection signals MP1 = 0, MP2 = 1.

NOTE When value is set to 0 for this parameter, the parameter No. 7113 is valid.
12351 Manual handle feed magnification n in each axis

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis [Valid data range] 0 to 2000 For each axis, this parameter sets the magnification when manual handle feed movement selection signals MP1 = 1, MP2 = 1.

NOTE When value is set to 0 for this parameter, the parameter No. 7114 is valid.

4.111
12600

PARAMETERS OF SYNCHRONOUS/COMPOSITE CONTROL AND SUPERIMPOSED CONTROL (3 OF 3)


Identification Number for synchronous, composite and superimposed control with program command

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis [Valid data range] 0,1 to 32767 Set identification numbers that can be specified with P,Q addresses. The axis whose identification number is 0 cannot become under synchronous /composite /superimposed control by CNC program. The same identification number cannot be set to two or more axes through all paths. When the same identification number is set, alarm PS5339 occurs at G50.4/G50.5/G50.6/G51.4/G51.5/G51.6 block.
12605 Minimum waiting synchronous start M code in superimposed control for high-speed cycle machining

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word [Valid data range] 0, 100 to 99999999

- 528 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
This parameter sets the waiting synchronous start M code to use if high-speed cycle machining or axis moving due to high-speed binary operation is to be started in synchronization with the superimposition command for an arbitrary operation path. For the waiting synchronous start M code, specify an M code that causes a synchronous start in the range of waiting M codes (parameters Nos. 8110 to 8111). Set in this parameter the minimum M code that causes a synchronous start.

NOTE Maximum M code that causes a synchronous start is set to parameter No. 8111.

4.112
12730

PARAMETERS OF AXIS CONTROL BY PMC (3 OF 3)


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 PTC

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 PTC Linear acceleration/deceleration time constant of continuous feed operation based on a speed command in PMC axis control is: 0: Normal. 1: Extended. This bit is available when speed command in PMC axis control is FS16 type (bit 2 (VCP) of parameter No. 8007 is 1).
Time constant 2 of linear acceleration/deceleration in velocity command continuous feed under PMC axis control

12731

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis msec/1000min-1 0 to 32767 If 0 is specified, the time constant at a given feedrate becomes invalid, and acceleration/deceleration is not performed. This parameter is valid only when the PMC axis control velocity command follows the FS16 specifications (when bit 2 (VCP) of parameter No. 8007 is set to 1), and the time constant of linear acceleration/deceleration in velocity command continuous feed under PMC axis control is expanded (when bit 0 (PTC) of parameter No. 12730 is set to 1).
Time constant 3 of linear acceleration/deceleration in velocity command continuous feed under PMC axis control

12732

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis msec/1000min-1 0 to 32767 If 0 is specified, the time constant at a given feedrate becomes invalid, and acceleration/deceleration is not performed. This parameter is valid only when the PMC axis control velocity command follows the FS16 specifications (when bit 2 (VCP) of parameter No. 8007 is set to 1), and the time constant of linear acceleration/deceleration in velocity command continuous feed under PMC axis control is expanded (when bit 0 (PTC) of parameter No. 12730 is set to 1).
- 529 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
12733

B-63950EN/04

4th time constant of linear acceleration/deceleration of continuous feed operation based on a speed command in PMC axis control

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis msec/1000min-1 0 to 32767 When this parameter is set 0, 4th time constant data is not available, and then acceleration / deceleration of speed command is not available in from 3rd feedrate to 4th feedrate. This parameter is available when speed command in PMC axis control is FS16 type (bit 2 (VCP) of parameter No. 8007 is 1) and linear acceleration/deceleration time constant of continuous feed operation based on a speed command in PMC axis control is extended (bit 0 (PTC) of parameter No. 12730 is 1).
5th time constant of linear acceleration/deceleration of continuous feed operation based on a speed command in PMC axis control

12734

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis msec/1000min-1 0 to 32767 When this parameter is set 0, 5th time constant data is not available, and then acceleration / deceleration of speed command is not available in from 4th feedrate to 5th feedrate. This parameter is available when speed command in PMC axis control is FS16 type (bit 2 (VCP) of parameter No. 8007 is 1) and linear acceleration/deceleration time constant of continuous feed operation based on a speed command in PMC axis control is extended (bit 0 (PTC) of parameter No. 12730 is 1).
1st feedrate for changing time constant of continuous feed operation based on a speed command in PMC axis control

12735

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis min-1 0 to 32767 Set feedrate parameters as following. No. 12735 < No. 12736 < No. 12737 < No. 12738. This parameter is available when speed command in PMC axis control is FS16 type (bit 2 (VCP) of parameter No. 8007) and linear acceleration/deceleration time constant of continuous feed operation based on a speed command in PMC axis control is extended (bit 0 (PTC) of parameter No. 12730 is 1).
2nd feedrate for changing time constant of continuous feed operation based on a speed command in PMC axis control

12736

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis min-1 0 to 32767 Set feedrate parameters as following. No. 12735 < No. 12736 < No. 12737 < No. 12738. This parameter is available when speed command in PMC axis control is FS16 type (bit 2 (VCP) of parameter No. 8007) and linear acceleration/deceleration time constant of continuous feed operation based on a speed command in PMC axis control is extended (bit 0 (PTC) of parameter No. 12730 is 1).
- 530 -

B-63950EN/04 12737

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
3rd feedrate for changing time constant of continuous feed operation based on a speed command in PMC axis control

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis min-1 0 to 32767 Set feedrate parameters as following. No. 12735 < No. 12736 < No. 12737 < No. 12738. This parameter is available when speed command in PMC axis control is FS16 type (bit 2 (VCP) of parameter No. 8007) and linear acceleration/deceleration time constant of continuous feed operation based on a speed command in PMC axis control is extended (bit 0 (PTC) of parameter No. 12730 is 1).
4th feedrate for changing time constant of continuous feed operation based on a speed command in PMC axis control

12738

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis min-1 0 to 32767 Set feedrate parameters as following. No. 12735 < No. 12736 < No. 12737 < No. 12738. This parameter is available when speed command in PMC axis control is FS16 type (bit 2 (VCP) of parameter No. 8007) and linear acceleration/deceleration time constant of continuous feed operation based on a speed command in PMC axis control is extended (bit 0 (PTC) of parameter No. 12730 is 1).

4.113
12750

PARAMETERS OF EXTERNAL DECELERATION POSITIONS EXPANSION


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 EX5 #0 EX4

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 EX4 External deceleration function setting 4 is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. EX5 External deceleration function setting 5 is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
External deceleration rate setting 4 in cutting feed

#1

12751

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0)
- 531 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

Set external deceleration rate 4 for cutting feed or positioning of linear interpolation type (G00).
12752 External deceleration rate setting 4 for each axis in rapid traverse

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) Set external deceleration rate 4 for each axis in rapid traverse.
Maximum manual handle feedrate setting 4 for each axis

12753

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) Set a maximum manual handle feedrate 4 for each axis.
External deceleration rate setting 5 in cutting feed

12754

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) Set external deceleration rate 5 for cutting feed or positioning of linear interpolation type (G00).
External deceleration rate setting 5 for each axis in rapid traverse

12755

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) Set external deceleration rate 5 for each axis in rapid traverse.
Maximum manual handle feedrate setting 5 for each axis

12756

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) Set a maximum manual handle feedrate 5 for each axis.

- 532 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

4.114
12801 to 12820

PARAMETERS OF DISPLAY AND EDIT (5 OF 5)


Operation history signal selection address type (No. 01) to Operation history signal selection address type (No. 20)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte [Valid data range] 0 to 4 These parameters set operation history signal selection address types Nos. 1 to 20. The correspondence between address types and settings is as given in the table below.
Address type Not selected. X G Y F Parameter value 0 1 2 3 4

Nos. 1 to 20 correspond to Nos. 1 to 20 on the operation history signal selection screen. These parameters are paired with other parameters as given below.
No. 01 02 03 20 PMC path number No. 24901 No. 24902 No. 24903 No. 24920 Address type No. 12801 No. 12802 No. 12803 No. 12820 Address number No. 12841 No. 12842 No. 12843 No. 12860 Bit number No. 12881 No. 12882 No. 12883 No. 12900

NOTE 1 Operation history signals that can be selected and deselected with parameters are for the first 20 of 60 sets. If an operation history signal is specified from the operation history signal selection screen, the PMC path number is fixed at the first PMC. 2 To deselect a signal, set 0. At this time, 0 is set as the initial value in the address number (Nos. 12841 to 12860) and the bit number (Nos. 12881 to 12900) corresponding to that signal. 3 When an address type is set, 1 is set as the initial value in the PMC path number (Nos. 24901 to 24920) corresponding to that signal, and 0 is set as the initial value in the address number (Nos. 12841 to 12860) and the bit number (Nos. 12881 to 12900). [Example] If parameter No. 12801 is set to 2, the parameters are initialized as follows: No. 24901=1 PMC path number No. 12841=0 Address number No. 12881=00000000 Bit number If, however, the PMC path number (Nos. 24901 to 24920) corresponding to that signal is set, the PMC path number (Nos. 24901 to 24920) will not be initialized. 4 If an attempt is made to set a value that cannot be set, a warning, "DATA IS OUT OF RANGE" appears; retry setting a value.

- 533 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
12841 to 12860 Operation history signal selection address number (No. 01) to Operation history signal selection address number (No. 20)

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] For an explanation of the address ranges of the G, F, X, and Y signals, refer to the PMC Programming Manual (B-63983). These parameters set operation history signal selection address numbers Nos. 1 to 20. Nos. 1 to 20 correspond to Nos. 1 to 20 on the operation history signal selection screen. These parameters are paired with other parameters as given below.
No. 01 02 03 20 PMC path number No. 24901 No. 24902 No. 24903 No. 24920 Address type No. 12801 No. 12802 No. 12803 No. 12820 Address number No. 12841 No. 12842 No. 12843 No. 12860 Bit number No. 12881 No. 12882 No. 12883 No. 12900

NOTE 1 Operation history signals that can be selected and deselected with parameters are for the first 20 of 60 sets. 2 When an address number is set, 0 is set as the initial value in the bit number (Nos. 12881 to 12900) corresponding to that signal. 3 If an attempt is made to set a value that cannot be set or if the address type (Nos. 12801 to 12820) corresponding to that signal is 0, a warning, "DATA IS OUT OF RANGE" appears; retry setting a value.
#7 12881 to 12900 RB7 RB6 RB5 RB4 RB7 #6 RB6 #5 RB5 #4 RB4 to RB3 RB2 RB1 RB0 #3 RB3 #2 RB2 #1 RB1 #0 RB0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit RB7 - RB0 History of the respective operation history signal selection bits Nos. 1 to 20 (RB7 to RB0) corresponding to the operation history signal selection addresses set in parameters Nos. 12801 to 12860 is: 0 : Not retained. (History of the bit is not recorded.) 1 : Retained. (History of the bit is recorded.) These parameters are paired with other parameters as given below.
No. 01 02 03 20 PMC path number No. 24901 No. 24902 No. 24903 No. 24920 Address type No. 12801 No. 12802 No. 12803 No. 12820 Address number No. 12841 No. 12842 No. 12843 No. 12860 Bit number No. 12881 No. 12882 No. 12883 No. 12900

- 534 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE 1 Operation history signals that can be selected and deselected with parameters are for the first 20 of 60 sets. 2 If the value of the address type (Nos. 12801 to 12820) corresponding to that signal is 0, a warning, "DATA IS OUT OF RANGE" appears; retry setting a value.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 TMD0

13000

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 TMD0 In the lathe/machining center G code system switching function, if an M code for switching to the turning mode or the milling mode is specified in a program command, the code and strobe signals are: 0: Output. 1: Not output.
M code number for switching to the turning mode (turning mode switching M code) M code number for switching to the milling mode (milling mode switching M code)

13020 13021

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 3 to 99999999 For the lathe/machining center G code system switching function, these parameters set the M codes for switching to the turning mode and the milling mode in a program command. M00, M01, M02, M30, M98, and M99 cannot be set. They will be invalid even if they are set. Do no use the M codes used in other functions. The same number cannot be set for the turning mode switching M code (parameter No. 13020) and the milling mode switching M code (parameter No. 13021). The mode switching M codes are not buffered.
#7 13101 #6 #5 CSC #4 #3 #2 15M #1 TPB #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#1 TPB Baud rate used with the external touch panel 0: 19200 bps is always used. 1: The baud rate with the baud rate number set in parameter No. 0123 for channel 2 is used. As mentioned in the description of bit 3 (TPA) of parameter No. 3119, when TPA is set to 0, the baud rate is always set to 19200 bps. To allow the baud rate to be changed, set bit 1 (TPB) of parameter No. 13101 to 1. This allows the baud rate number set in parameter No. 0123 for channel 2 to be used.
- 535 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE Baud rates that can be set may vary depending on the ETP used.
#2 15M On a 15-inch display unit, the simultaneous multi-path display program check screen: 0: Does not display modal information. 1: Displays modal information. CSC 0: On the monochrome LCD, the character color at the cursor position is white, and the background color is black. When the character edit screen is displayed on the monochrome LCD, the background of update blocks except the cursor is displayed in white. On the monochrome LCD, the character color at the cursor position is black, and the background color is gray. When the character edit screen is displayed on the monochrome LCD, the background of the update block except the cursor is displayed in gray.
#7 13102 EDT #6 BGI #5 BGD #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 TAD

#5

1:

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 TAD The current position display section of an axis not subject to current position display (bit 0 (NDPx) of parameter No. 3115 = 1) and that of an axis for which a display position is specified (No. 3130) are: 0: Displayed as blanks. 1: Replaced by the current position display section of the next axis subject to current position display. BGD When the background edit option is set, background editing on the CNC program edit screen is: 0: Enabled. 1: Disabled. When MANUAL GUIDE i is used, set this parameter to 1 to disable background editing on the CNC program edit screen. #6 BGI When the cursor is placed at a program, and the screen: 0: Background editing starts. 1: Background editing does not start. If this parameter is set to 0, pressing the key on the program list screen automatically changes the screen display to the background edit screen, allowing editing of a selected program. If the parameter is set to 1, the screen display does not change, and background editing does not start. key is pressed on the program list

#5

- 536 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
EDT During memory operation, program editing is: 0: Enabled. 1: Disabled.

#7

NOTE 1 When 0 is set, during memory operation, you can stop the program by a single block stop or feed hold, select the EDIT mode, and edit the program. When the main program is running: The same edit functions as used for ordinary editing can be used. When a subprogram is running: Only the word-unit edit function can be used. Any program called from DNC or MDI operation cannot be edited. Only the subprogram can be edited. 2 Before restarting memory operation, take extreme caution to return the cursor to the position before stopping the program. If you want to execute the program from other than the cursor position when stopped, be sure to reset the machine before executing the program.
#7 13112 NTD #6 NTA #5 #4 #3 #2 SPI #1 SVI #0 IDW

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 IDW Editing on the servo or spindle information screen is: 0: Prohibited. 1: Not prohibited. SVI The servo information screen is: 0: Displayed. 1: Not displayed. SPI The spindle information screen is: 0: Displayed. 1: Not displayed. NTA On the 3-dimensional machining manual feed screen, a table-based pulse amount is: 0: Displayed. 1: Not displayed. NTD On the 3-dimensional machining manual feed screen, a tool axis based pulse amount is: 0: Displayed. 1: Not displayed.
#7 13113 #6 #5 #4 #3 CFD #2 #1 #0 CLR

#1

#2

#6

#7

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path


- 537 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#0

B-63950EN/04

CLR Upon reset, the display of a travel distance by 3-dimensional machining manual feed is: 0: Not cleared. 1: Cleared. CFD As feedrate F, the 3-dimensional machining manual feed screen displays: 0: Composite feedrate at the linear axis/rotation axis control point. 1: Feedrate at the tool tip.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 P15

#3

13114

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 P15 When the screen is displayed using the CNC screen display function: 0: The 10.4 mode is used. 1: The 15 mode is used.

NOTE This parameter is valid when the CNC screen display function is used for the stand-alone type 300i/310i/320i.
#7 13115 P10 #6 KBC #5 SI2 #4 SI1 #3 IAU #2 ITB #1 IAT #0 ICT

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 ICT For MDI key input, the 0: Enabled. 1: Disabled. IAT For MDI key input, the 0: Enabled. 1: Disabled. ITB For MDI key input, the 0: 1: #3 Enabled. Disabled. key is: key is:

#1

key is:

#2

key is:

IAU For MDI key input, the 0: Enabled. 1: Disabled.

#4

SI1 Soft key input of the characters shown below is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. <>%$!~:"'

- 538 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
SI2 Soft key input of the characters shown below and switching between the uppercase and lowercase input modes by a soft key are: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. ()?*&@_ KBC With the standard ONGP-MDI unit, in the lowercase input mode, "[" and "]" are: 0: Not converted to "<" and ">", respectively. 1: Converted to "<" and ">", respectively. When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off then back on to make the setting of this parameter valid.

#5

#6

#7

P10 With the 300is/310is/320is with a 15-inch display unit, when the CNC screen display function is used, the mode for displaying the screen is: 0: The 15-inch mode. 1: The 10.4-inch mode.
#7 #6 SQB #5 PMP #4 INT #3 #2 #1 #0

13117

SQP

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #4 INT During a program restart, the interference check on cutter/tool nose radius compensation is: 0: Enabled. 1: Disabled. PMP To the MDI program that is output due to a program restart, the memory protection signals KEY1 and KEY3 are: 0: Not effective. 1: Effective.

#5

NOTE When 0 is set in bit 7 (KEY) of parameter No. 3290, KEY3 is used to protect the MDI program. When 1 is set in the parameter, KEY1 is used.
#6 SQB A program restart with a block number specification is: 0: Enabled. 1: Disabled. SQP A program restart with the P type is: 0: Enabled. 1: Disabled.
Group number for simultaneous display of multiple paths

#7

13131

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 10 This parameter sets a group for simultaneous display on one screen in a multi-path system.
- 539 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

The paths set to belong to the same group are displayed on one screen. If the values for all paths are set to 0, the simultaneous multi-path display function is disabled.

NOTE When specifying groups, specify group numbers not less than 1 successively. On 7.2-inch and 8.4-inch display units, simultaneous multi-path display cannot be specified. In this case, set 1 in this parameter for all paths. On 9.5-inch and 10.4-inch display units, up to three paths can be specified for simultaneous display. On a 15-inch display unit, up to four paths can be specified for simultaneous display.
13132 Simultaneous multi-path display order number

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to number of paths included in a simultaneous multi-path display group This parameter sets the display order of a path defined to belong to a simultaneous multi-path display group. Set the order, using numbers ranging from 1 to the number of paths included in the simultaneous multi-path display group. [Example] Setting of simultaneous display group numbers and simultaneous display order numbers
Number of paths of CNC One path Path
Display group number Intra-group display order number

Screen display
(Numbers represent displayed path numbers.) 1

Path 1 Path 1 Path 2 Path 3

1 1 1 1 1 2 3 1 1 2

1 1 2 3 1 1 1 2 1 1

1 2 3

Three path

Path 1 Path 2 Path 3 Path 1 Path 2 Path 3

NOTE Specify successive order numbers not less than 1 for the paths defined to belong to a group.
13140 13141 First character in spindle load meter display Second character in spindle load meter display

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Byte spindle


- 540 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Valid data range] These parameters set character codes to set the name of each spindle that appears in spindle load meter display. Any character string consisting of numeric characters, alphabetical characters, katakana characters, and symbols with a maximum length of two characters can be displayed as a spindle name. If 0 is set, the following is displayed: 1st spindle S1 2nd spindle S2 3rd spindle S3 4th spindle S4

4.115
13200

PARAMETERS OF TOOL MANAGEMENT FUNCTIONS (2 OF 2)


#7 NFD #6 NAM #5 T0O #4 TP2 #3 ETE #2 TRT #1 THN #0 TCF

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 TCF When a T code is specified with the tool management function: 0: A cartridge number and pot number found by the NC are output. 1: The specified T code is output without modification. THN When NX.T and HD.T are displayed with the tool management function: 0: The tool type numbers at the first spindle position and the first standby position are displayed. 1: The values specified from the PMC window are displayed. TRT As the remaining lifetime value for outputting the tool life arrival notice signal: 0: The remaining lifetime of the last tool is used. 1: The sum of the remaining lifetimes of the tools with the same type number is used.

#1

#2

NOTE This parameter is valid when bit 3 (ETE) of parameter No. 13200 is set to 0 (arrival notice for each type number).
#3 ETE The tool life arrival notice signal is output: 0: For each tool type. 1: For each tool. TP2 The punch-out format of cartridge management data is: 0: New registration format (G10L76P1 format). 1: Modification format (G10L76P2 format). T0O When T0 is specified: 0: A tool search is made assuming that the tool type number is 0. 1: The cartridge number and pot number are assumed to be 0. NAM When a T code is specified, but a valid tool with a remaining lifetime cannot be found: 0: The alarm PS5317, "LIVES OF ALL TOOLS EXPIRED" is issued. 1: The alarm is not issued. Instead, the tool with the maximum tool management number is selected from the tools of the specified tool type, and TMFNFD<F315.6> is set to 1.
- 541 -

#4

#5

#6

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7

B-63950EN/04

NFD When a T code is specified, but a valid tool with a remaining lifetime cannot be found in the cartridge: 0: The spindle position and standby position are also searched. 1: The spindle position and standby position are not searched.
#7 #6 TDS #5 #4 TFT #3 TME #2 TDB #1 TDN #0 TDC

13201

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 TDC The function of customizing the tool management data screen of the tool management function is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. TDN On the tool management function screen, the character string for indicating the tool life status can contain: 0: Up to 6 characters. 1: Up to 12 characters. TDB The tool management function displays tool information in the: 0: Conventional mode. 1: 1/0 mode. TME In the tool management function, multi-edge tools are: 0: Not supported. 1: Supported. TFT On the tool management data screen, data extraction for a specified item is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. TDS A tool data search using a tool type number is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed.
#7 13202 DOM #6 DOT #5 #4 DO2 #3 DOB #2 DOY #1 DCR #0

#1

#2

#3

#4

#6

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #1 DCR On the tool management function screen, tool nose radius compensation data is: 0: Displayed. 1: Not displayed.

- 542 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE This parameter is valid when the machine control type is the lathe system or compound system.

#2

DOY On the tool management function screen, Y-axis offset data is: 0: Displayed. 1: Not displayed.

NOTE This parameter is valid when the machine control type is the lathe system or compound system.
#3 DOB On the tool management function screen, B-axis offset data is: 0: Displayed. 1: Not displayed.

NOTE This parameter is valid when the machine control type is the lathe system or compound system.
#4 DO2 On the tool management function screen, the second geometry tool offset data is: 0: Displayed. 1: Not displayed.

NOTE This parameter is valid when the machine control type is the lathe system or compound system.
#6 DOT On the tool management function screen, the tool offset data (X, Z) of the T series is: 0: Displayed. 1: Not displayed.

NOTE This parameter is valid when the machine control type is the lathe system or compound system.
#7 DOM On the tool management function screen, the tool offset data of the M series is: 0: Displayed. 1: Not displayed.

NOTE This parameter is valid when the machine control type is the machining center system or compound system.
#7 13203 TCN #6 SWC #5 NTS #4 TSI #3 NM4 #2 NM3 #1 NM2 #0 NM1

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

- 543 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#0 NM1 The first cartridge is: 0: Searched. 1: Not searched. NM2 The second cartridge is: 0: Searched. 1: Not searched. NM3 The third cartridge is: 0: Searched. 1: Not searched. NM4 The fourth cartridge is: 0: Searched. 1: Not searched.

B-63950EN/04

#1

#2

#3

#4

TSI When multi-edge tools are supported by the tool management function, tools are searched as follows: 0: A tool is selected by remaining tool life. (Conventional search) 1: In selection, priority is given to a tool located at the spindle position or standby position. NTS When multi-edge tools are supported by the tool management function, if the life of an edge that belong to an edge group has expired, the edge group is: 0: Not excluded from the target tools to be searched during tool search operation. 1: Excluded from the target tools to be searched during tool search operation. SWC The tools with the same tool type number are searched for: 0: Tool with the shortest lifetime. 1: Tool with the small customization data number. In this case, a customization data number is to be set in parameter No. 13260. TCN Tool life count operation is triggered by: 0: M06/restart M code. (A T code alone does not start counting.) 1: T code. (Count operation is not started by M06.)
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 DTA #1 ATA #0 TDL

#5

#6

#7

13204

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 TDL The protection function for tool management data using a key is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. ATA The tool attachment signal, magazine number signal, and pot number signal are: 0: Used. (Auto attachment) 1: Not used. (Manual attachment) DTA The tool detachment signal, magazine number signal, and pot number signal are: 0: Used. (Auto detachment) 1: Not used. (Manual detachment)

#1

#2

- 544 -

B-63950EN/04 #7 13206 #6 #5 #4

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#3 #2 #1 SSM #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #1 SSM As a chapter selection soft key of the tool management function, a soft key for changing the screen display to the MANUAL GUIDE i screen is: 0: Not displayed. 1: Displayed.
#7 13210 FNS #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #7 FNS Acquisition of unused multi-edge group numbers and tool offset numbers and their display on the tool management screen are: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed.

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
13220 Number of valid tools in tool management data

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to 64 (Extended to 240 or 1000 by the addition of an option) This parameter sets the number of valid tools in tool management data.
13221 M code for tool life count restart

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to 65535 When 0 is set in this parameter, this parameter is ignored. When an M code for tool life count restart is specified, the counting of the life of the tool attached at the spindle position is started. When the type for counting the number of use times is selected, the target of life counting is switched to the tool attached at the spindle position, and the life count is incremented by 1. When the type for counting time is selected, the target of life counting is switched to the tool attached at the spindle position but no other operations are performed. If the tool attached at the spindle position is not a tool under tool life management, no operation is performed. The M code set in parameter No. 6811 waits for FIN. However, the M code set in this parameter does not wait for FIN.
- 545 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

The M code set in parameter No. 13221 must not be specified in a block where another auxiliary function is specified. The M code set in parameter No. 13221 does not wait for FIN. So, do not use the M code for other purposes.

NOTE The use of this parameter varies depending on whether it is used by the tool management function or tool life management function.
13222 Number of data items in the first cartridge

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 1 to 64 (Extended to 240 or 1000 by the addition of an option) This parameter sets the number of data items used with the first cartridge.
13223 Start pot number of the first cartridge

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 1 to 9999 This parameter sets the start pot number to be used with the first cartridge. Pot numbers starting with the value set in this parameter and sequentially incremented by 1 are assigned to all data items.
13227 Number of data items in the second cartridge

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 1 to 64(Extended to 240 or 1000 by the addition of an option) This parameter sets the number of data items used with the second cartridge.
13228 Start pot number of the second cartridge

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word
- 546 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Valid data range] 1 to 9999 This parameter sets the start pot number to be used with the second cartridge. Pot numbers starting with the value set in this parameter and sequentially incremented by 1 are assigned to all data items.
13232 Number of data items in the third cartridge

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 1 to 64(Extended to 240 or 1000 by the addition of an option) This parameter sets the number of data items used with the third cartridge.
13233 Start pot number of the third cartridge

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 1 to 9999 This parameter sets the start pot number to be used with the third cartridge. Pot numbers starting with the value set in this parameter and sequentially incremented by 1 are assigned to all data items.
13237 Number of data items in the fourth cartridge

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 1 to 64(Extended to 240 or 1000 by the addition of an option) This parameter sets the number of data items used with the fourth cartridge.
13238 Start pot number of the fourth cartridge

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 1 to 9999 This parameter sets the start pot number to be used with the fourth cartridge. Pot numbers starting with the value set in this parameter and sequentially incremented by 1 are assigned to all data items.
- 547 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 13240 #6 #5 #4 #3 MT4 #2 MT3 #1 MT2

B-63950EN/04 #0 MT1

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 MT1 The first cartridge is of the: 0: Chain type. 1: Matrix type. When this parameter is set to 1, parameter No. 13222 is invalid. MT2 The second cartridge is of the: 0: Chain type. 1: Matrix type. When this parameter is set to 1, parameter No. 13227 is invalid. MT3 The third cartridge is of the: 0: Chain type. 1: Matrix type. When this parameter is set to 1, parameter No. 13232 is invalid. MT4 The fourth cartridge is of the: 0: Chain type. 1: Matrix type. When this parameter is set to 1, parameter No. 13237 is invalid.
Number of rows of the first cartridge (when the cartridge is of the matrix type)

#1

#2

#3

13241

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to 1000 When the first cartridge is of the matrix type (bit 0 (MT1) of parameter No. 13240 is set to 1), set the number of rows in the pot in this parameter. The setting must satisfy the following condition, however: The sum total of the value obtained by (setting of parameter No. 13241) (setting of parameter No. 13242) and the number of pots of other cartridges should not exceed 64 (1000 at maximum). If this condition is not satisfied or this parameter is set to 0, the first cartridge is invalid.
13242 Number of columns of the first cartridge (when the cartridge is of the matrix type)

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
- 548 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to 1000 When the first cartridge is of the matrix type (bit 0 (MT1) of parameter No. 13240 is set to 1), set the number of columns in the pot in this parameter. The setting must satisfy the following condition, however: The sum total of the value obtained by (setting of parameter No. 13241) (setting of parameter No. 13242) and the number of pots of other cartridges should not exceed 64 (1000 at maximum). If this condition is not satisfied or this parameter is set to 0, the first cartridge is invalid.
13243 Number of rows of the second cartridge (when the cartridge is of the matrix type)

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to 1000 When the second cartridge is of the matrix type (bit 1 (MT2) of parameter No. 13240 is set to 1), set the number of rows in the pot in this parameter. The setting must satisfy the following condition, however: The sum total of the value obtained by (setting of parameter No. 13243) (setting of parameter No. 13244) and the number of pots of other cartridges should not exceed 64 (1000 at maximum). If this condition is not satisfied or this parameter is set to 0, the second cartridge is invalid.
13244 Number of columns of the second cartridge (when the cartridge is of the matrix type)

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to 1000 When the second cartridge is of the matrix type (bit 1 (MT2) of parameter No. 13240 is set to 1), set the number of columns in the pot in this parameter. The setting must satisfy the following condition, however: The sum total of the value obtained by (setting of parameter No. 13243) (setting of parameter No. 13244) and the number of pots of other cartridges should not exceed 64 (1000 at maximum). If this condition is not satisfied or this parameter is set to 0, the second cartridge is invalid.
13245 Number of rows of the third cartridge (when the cartridge is of the matrix type)

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word
- 549 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
[Valid data range] 0 to 1000

B-63950EN/04

When the third cartridge is of the matrix type (bit 2 (MT3) of parameter No. 13240 is set to 1), set the number of rows in the pot in this parameter. The setting must satisfy the following condition, however: The sum total of the value obtained by (setting of parameter No. 13245) (setting of parameter No. 13246) and the number of pots of other cartridges should not exceed 64 (1000 at maximum). If this condition is not satisfied or this parameter is set to 0, the third cartridge is invalid.
13246 Number of columns of the third cartridge (when the cartridge is of the matrix type)

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to 1000 When the third cartridge is of the matrix type (bit 2 (MT3) of parameter No. 13240 is set to 1), set the number of columns in the pot in this parameter. The setting must satisfy the following condition, however: The sum total of the value obtained by (setting of parameter No. 13245) (setting of parameter No. 13246) and the number of pots of other cartridges should not exceed 64 (1000 at maximum). If this condition is not satisfied or this parameter is set to 0, the third cartridge is invalid.
13247 Number of rows of the fourth cartridge (when the cartridge is of the matrix type)

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to 1000 When the fourth cartridge is of the matrix type (bit 3 (MT4) of parameter No. 13240 is set to 1), set the number of rows in the pot in this parameter. The setting must satisfy the following condition, however: The sum total of the value obtained by (setting of parameter No. 13247) (setting of parameter No. 13248) and the number of pots of other cartridges should not exceed 64 (1000 at maximum). If this condition is not satisfied or this parameter is set to 0, the fourth cartridge is invalid.
13248 Number of columns of the fourth cartridge (when the cartridge is of the matrix type)

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to 1000
- 550 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
When the fourth cartridge is of the matrix type (bit 3 (MT4) of parameter No. 13240 is set to 1), set the number of columns in the pot in this parameter. The setting must satisfy the following condition, however: The sum total of the value obtained by (setting of parameter No. 13247) (setting of parameter No. 13248) and the number of pots of other cartridges should not exceed 64 (1000 at maximum). If this condition is not satisfied or this parameter is set to 0, the fourth cartridge is invalid.

13250

Number of valid spindles

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 4 This parameter sets the number of spindle positions usable with the tool management function.
13251 Number of valid standby positions

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 4 This parameter sets the number of standby positions usable with the tool management function.
13252 M code for specifying a particular tool

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to 65535 This parameter sets not a tool type number but an M code for directly specifying the T code of a particular tool.
13260 Customization data number to be searched for

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 40 When bit 6 (SWC) of parameter No. 13203 is set to 1, this parameter sets a customization data number to be searched for. The valid data range is 1 to 4 when the option for customization data extension is not selected. When the option for customization data extension (5 to 20) is selected, the valid data range is 1 to 20. When the option for customization data extension (5 to 40) is selected, the valid data range is 1 to 40. When bit 6 (SWC) of parameter No. 13203 is set to 0, or a value not within the valid data range is set, the search function based on customization data is disabled, and the tool with the shortest lifetime is searched for.
- 551 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
13265 Number for selecting a spindle position offset number

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to 9999 This parameters sets an H/D code for selecting an offset number registered in the data of the tool attached at the spindle position. When 0 is set, an ordinary used code such as H99/D99 is used. When a value other than 0 is set, H99/D99 no longer has a particular meaning. So, when H99/D99 is specified in this case, the specification of offset number 99 is assumed. With the T series, address D only is used to specify a tool number and offset number, so that a restriction is imposed on the number of digits. So, the valid data range of this parameter varies according the number of digits of an offset number. When the number of digits of an offset number is 1: to 9 When the number of digits of an offset number is 2: to 99 When the number of digits of an offset number is 3: to 999

NOTE The use of this parameter varies depending on whether it is used by the tool management function or tool life management function.

4.116
13221

PARAMETERS OF TOOL LIFE MANAGEMENT (2 OF 2)


M code for tool life count restart

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to 255 (not including 01, 02, 30, 98, and 99) When 0 is set, this parameter is ignored. For the operation of an M code for tool life count restart, see the description of parameter No. 6811. This parameter is used when an M code for tool life count restart exceeds 127. Set parameter No. 6811 to 0, and set the value of an M code in this parameter.

NOTE The use of this parameter varies depending on whether it is used by the tool management function or tool life management function.
13265 H code for using the tool length offset in tool life management

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to 9999 Usually, when H99 is specified, tool length offset is enabled by the H code of the tool being used. By setting any H code in this parameter, the H code instead of H99 can be used. If 0 is specified, H99 is assumed. A value ranging from 0 to 9999 can be set.

NOTE The use of this parameter varies depending on whether it is used by the tool management function or tool life management function.
- 552 -

B-63950EN/04 13266

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
D code for enabling cutter compensation in tool life management

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to 9999 Usually in tool life management, specifying D99 allows the D code of the tool being used to enable cutter compensation. By setting any D code in this parameter, the D code instead of D99 can be used. If 0 is set, D99 is assumed.

4.117
13301 to 13304 13311 to 13314 13321 to 13324

PARAMETERS OF STRAIGHTNESS COMPENSATION (2 OF 2)


Straightness compensation: Straightness compensation: Straightness compensation: Straightness compensation: Straightness compensation: Straightness compensation: Compensation point number a of moving axis 4 to Compensation point number d of moving axis 4 Compensation point number a of moving axis 5 to Compensation point number b of moving axis 5 Compensation point number a of moving axis 6 to Compensation point number d of moving axis 6

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to 1535 These parameters set compensation point numbers in stored pitch error compensation. Set four compensation points for each moving axis.
13351 to 13354 13361 to 13364 13371 to 13374 Compensation value corresponding to compensation point number a of moving axis 4 to Compensation value corresponding to compensation point number d of moving axis 4 Compensation value corresponding to compensation point number a of moving axis 5 to Compensation value corresponding to compensation point number d of moving axis 5 Compensation value corresponding to compensation point number a of moving axis 6 to Compensation value corresponding to compensation point number d of moving axis 6

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Unit of data] Detection unit
- 553 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

[Valid data range] -32767 to 32767 These parameters set a compensation value for each moving axis compensation point.
13381 13382 13383 13384 13385 13386 Number of a straightness compensation point located at the most negative position of moving axis 1 Number of a straightness compensation point located at the most negative position of moving axis 2 Number of a straightness compensation point located at the most negative position of moving axis 3 Number of a straightness compensation point located at the most negative position of moving axis 4 Number of a straightness compensation point located at the most negative position of moving axis 5 Number of a straightness compensation point located at the most negative position of moving axis 6

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 6000 to 6767 These parameters set the number of a straightness compensation point located at the most negative position for each moving axis. If a parameter setting exceeds the valid data range, an alarm is issued, and compensation cannot be performed.
13391 13392 13393 13394 13395 13396 Compensation magnification for moving axis 1 in straightness compensation Compensation magnification for moving axis 2 in straightness compensation Compensation magnification for moving axis 3 in straightness compensation Compensation magnification for moving axis 4 in straightness compensation Compensation magnification for moving axis 5 in straightness compensation Compensation magnification for moving axis 6 in straightness compensation

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 100 These parameters set the straightness compensation magnification for each moving axis. When 1 is set as the straightness compensation magnification, the unit of compensation data equals the detection unit. When 0 is set, straightness compensation is not performed.

4.118
13420

PARAMETERS OF FLEXIBLE SYNCHRONOUS CONTROL (2 OF 2)


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 DID #2 DIC #1 DIB #0 DIA

- 554 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 DIA The movement direction of the automatic phase synchronization of group A is: 0: + direction. 1: - direction. DIB The movement direction of the automatic phase synchronization of group B is: 0: + direction. 1: - direction. DIC The movement direction of the automatic phase synchronization of group C is: 0: + direction. 1: - direction. DID The movement direction of the automatic phase synchronization of group D is: 0: + direction. 1: - direction.
#7 13421 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 FRF #1 FCN #0 FRS

#1

#2

#3

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

NOTE Set these parameters for the first path only. It will be effective to all paths.
#0 FRS In a program containing an M code for turning the flexible synchronous mode on/off, a program restart is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. FCN In the emergency stop/servo off state, Inter-Path flexible synchronous control is: 0: Canceled. 1: Not canceled. FRF If G27/G28/G29/G30/G30.1/G53 is specified during flexible synchronous control, alarm PS0010 is: 0: Issued. 1: Is not issued. Commands to the master axis are possible. Even if, however, parameter bit FRF is set to 1, and G28 is specified for the master axis in the state in which the reference position of the master axis subject to flexible synchronous control is not established, or if G27/G28/G29/G30/G30.1/G53 is specified for the slave axis, alarm PS5381 is issued.

#1

#2

NOTE If the option for inter-path flexible synchronous control is specified, even if 0 is set in the parameter bit FRF, the operation will be the same as that if 1 is set.

- 555 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
13425

B-63950EN/04

Acceleration/deceleration time constant of the slave axis when synchronization is started/canceled (group A) Acceleration/deceleration time constant of the slave axis when synchronization is started/canceled (group B) Acceleration/deceleration time constant of the slave axis when synchronization is started/canceled (group C) Acceleration/deceleration time constant of the slave axis when synchronization is started/canceled (group D)

13426

13427

13428

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word path msec 0 to 4000 These parameters set the acceleration/deceleration time constants of the slave axis subject to automatic phase synchronization for flexible synchronous control. The acceleration when synchronization is started/canceled will be as follows: Acceleration = parameter No. 1420 / parameters Nos. 13425 to 13428
Automatic phase synchronization rate for the slave axis (group A) Automatic phase synchronization rate for the slave axis (group B) Automatic phase synchronization rate for the slave axis (group C) Automatic phase synchronization rate for the slave axis (group D)

13429 13430 13431 13432

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm/min, inch/min, deg/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) These parameters set the automatic phase synchronization rates for the slave axis subject to automatic phase synchronization. These rates are superimposed on the rate synchronized to the master axis. If the setting of one of the parameters is 0, the automatic phase synchronization rate for the corresponding group will be 6 (mm/min).
Machine coordinates of the master axis used as the reference for phase synchronization (group A) Machine coordinates of the master axis used as the reference for phase synchronization (group B) Machine coordinates of the master axis used as the reference for phase synchronization (group C) Machine coordinates of the master axis used as the reference for phase synchronization (group D)

13433 13434 13435 13436

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch, deg (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the machine coordinates of the master axis used as the reference for phase synchronization. If the setting of this parameter is 0, the origin position (coordinates: 0) of the machine coordinate system of the master axis will be the reference position for automatic phase synchronization.
- 556 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

4.119
13450

PARAMETERS OF PROGRAMS (4 OF 4)
#7 #6 #5 #4 MFC #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #4 MFC When the cutting is executed without specifying a feedrate (F) after the modal G code of group 05 was changed by G93(inverse time feed) / G94(feed per minute) / G95(feed per revolution) command, 0: The feedrate (F) is inherited as a modal. 1: Alarm PS0011 is issued.

NOTE 1 In G93 mode, if the axis command and the feedrate (F) command are not in the same block, alarm PS1202, "NO F COMMAND AT G93" is issued regardless of the setting of this parameter. 2 If this parameter bit is set to 1, and if the G code of group 05 is cleared due to a reset, by setting bit 6 (CLR) of parameter No. 3402 to 1 and bit 5 (C05) of parameter No. 3406 to 0, so that the modal G code is switched, the feedrate (F) will be cleared even if bit 7 (CFH) of parameter No. 3409 is set to 1. 3 If this parameter bit is 1, and bit 7 (FC0) of parameter No. 1404 is set to 1, alarm PS0011 is not issued and the block is executed with a feedrate of 0 even if the feed selection command is used to switch the modal code of group 05 and the axis command is executed in cutting feed mode without specifying a feedrate (F). In G93 mode, alarm PS1202 is issued regardless of the setting of the parameter bit FC0. 4 If this parameter bit is 1, alarm PS0011 or PS1202 is not used even if the feed selection command is used to switch the modal code of group 05 and the axis command is executed in cutting feed mode without specifying a feedrate (F), provided that the travel distance is 0. 5 If this parameter bit is 1, alarms PS0011 and PS1202 are issued if the feed selection command is used to switch the modal code of group 05 and the axis command is executed in cutting feed mode without specifying a feedrate (F), even if cutting feedrate (parameter No. 1411) during automatic operation is set. (This is true of the M series.)
#7 13451 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 ATW #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

- 557 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#1

B-63950EN/04

ATW When I, J, and K are all set to 0 in a block that specifies a feature coordinate system setup command (G68.2), which is a tilted working plane command: 0: An alarm PS5457 is issued. 1: A feature coordinate system with a tilted plane angle of 0 degrees is assumed for operation.

4.120
13541

PARAMETERS OF MANUAL LINER/CIRCULAR INTERPOLATION


The head address of the R signal used by the input data in the manual linear/circular interpolation

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to 7999 The head address of the internal relay(R signal) of PMC used by the input data in the manual linear/circular interpolation is set. In input data, the data area in 20 bytes from the address which is set to this parameter is needed.

NOTE 1 When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued. 2 This parameter is valid when bit 3 (MRI) of parameter No.7106 is set to 1.
13542 Head address of the R signal used by the output data in the manual linear/circular interpolation

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 0 to 7999 The head address of the internal relay(R signal) of PMC used by the output data in the manual linear/circular interpolation is set. In output data, the data area in 10 bytes from the address which is set to this parameter is needed.

NOTE 1 When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued. 2 This parameter is valid when bit 4 (MRO) of parameter No.7106 is set to 1. 3 About setting parameters Nos. 13541 and 13542 (1) Set the value which becomes the multiple of four. (0, 4, 8, ) (2) The address of output data and input data must not be duplicated. (3) When the multi-path system is used, set the value which does not duplicate the data address used in other path systems. (4) The range in R address is different depending on PMC used and the memory. Confirm the specification of PMC, and set the value within the range which can be used. When the settings other than the above-mentioned ((1) to (4)) were done, the alarm PW5390, R-ADDRESS SETTING IS ILLEGAL is issued.
- 558 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

4.121
13543

PARAMETERS OF CANNED CYCLES FOR DRILLING M CODE OUTPUT IMPROVEMENT


M code for C-axis unclamping in canned cycles for drilling (1st set)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to 99999999 This parameter sets the M code for C-axis unclamping in canned cycles for drilling (first set).

NOTE This parameter is valid when bit 4 (CME) of parameter No. 5161 is set to 1.
13544 M code for C-axis clamping in canned cycles for drilling (2nd set)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to 99999999 This parameter sets the M code for C-axis clamping in canned cycles for drilling (second set).

NOTE This parameter is valid when bit 4 (CME) of parameter No. 5161 is set to 1.
13545 M code for C-axis unclamping in canned cycles for drilling (2nd set)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 0 to 99999999 This parameter sets the M code for C-axis unclamping in canned cycles for drilling (second set).

NOTE This parameter is valid when bit 4 (CME) of parameter No. 5161 is set to 1.

4.122
13600

PARAMETERS OF THE MACHINING CONDITION SELECTION FUNCTION


#7 MSA #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 MCR

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path


- 559 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#0

B-63950EN/04

MCR When an allowable acceleration rate adjustment is made with the machining condition selection function or machining quality level adjustment function (machining parameter adjustment screen, precision level selection screen), parameter No. 1735 for the deceleration function based on acceleration in circular interpolation is: 0: Modified. 1: Not modified. MSA When the machining condition selection function or machining quality level adjustment function is used, the acceleration rate change time (bell-shaped) (LV1, LV10) is: 0: Set using parameter Nos. 13612 and 13613. 1: Set using parameter Nos. 13662 and 13663.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 MPR

#7

13601

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
#0 MPR The machining parameter adjustment screen is: 0: Displayed. 1: Not displayed. Even if 1 is set in this parameter bit, the precision level selection screen for the machining condition selecting function and the precision level selection screens (machining quality level selection screen and the machining level selection screen) for the machining quality level adjustment function are displayed.
Acceleration rate for acceleration/deceleration before look-ahead interpolation in AI contour control (precision level 1) Acceleration rate for acceleration/deceleration before look-ahead interpolation in AI contour control (precision level 10)

13610

13611

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/sec/sec, inch/sec/sec, degree/sec/sec (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (D) (When the machine system is metric system, 0.0 to +100000.0. When the machine system is inch system, machine, 0.0 to +10000.0) Each of these parameters sets an acceleration rate for acceleration/ deceleration before interpolation in AI contour control. Set a value (precision level 1) with emphasis placed on speed, and a value (precision level 10) with emphasis on precision.
Acceleration rate change time (bell-shaped) when AI contour control is used (precision level 1) Acceleration rate change time (bell-shaped) when AI contour control is used (precision level 10)

13612 13613

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Unit of data] msec
- 560 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Valid data range] 0 to 127 Each of these parameters sets an acceleration rate change time (bell-shaped) in AI contour control. Set a value (precision level 1) with emphasis placed on speed, and a value (precision level 10) with emphasis on precision.
13614 Allowable acceleration rate change amount for each axis in speed control based on acceleration rate change under control on the rate of change of acceleration (precision level 1) Allowable acceleration rate change amount for each axis in speed control based on acceleration rate change under control on the rate of change of acceleration (precision level 10)

13615

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/sec/sec, inch/sec/sec, degree/sec/sec (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (D) (When the machine system is metric system, 0.0 to +100000.0. When the machine system is inch system, machine, 0.0 to +10000.0) Each of these parameters sets an allowable acceleration rate change amount per 1 ms for each axis in speed control based on acceleration rate change under control on the rate of change of acceleration during AI contour control. Set a value (precision level 1) with emphasis placed on speed, and a value (precision level 10) with emphasis on precision.
Allowable acceleration rate change amount for each axis in speed control based on acceleration rate change under control on the rate of change of acceleration in successive linear interpolation operations (precision level 1) Allowable acceleration rate change amount for each axis in speed control based on acceleration rate change under control on the rate of change of acceleration in successive linear interpolation operations (precision level 10)

13616

13617

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/sec/sec, inch/sec/sec, degree/sec/sec (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (D) (When the machine system is metric system, 0.0 to +100000.0. When the machine system is inch system, machine, 0.0 to +10000.0) Each of these parameters sets an allowable acceleration rate change amount per 1 ms for each axis in speed control based on acceleration rate change under control on the rate of change of acceleration in successive linear interpolation operations during AI contour control. Set a value (precision level 1) with emphasis placed on speed, and a value (precision level 10) with emphasis on precision.

- 561 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE 1 For an axis with 0 set in this parameter, parameter No. 13614 and No. 13615 (allowable acceleration rate change amount in speed control based on acceleration rate change under control on the rate of change of acceleration) are valid. 2 For an axis with 0 set in parameter No. 13614 and No. 13615 (allowable acceleration rate change amount in speed control based on acceleration rate change under control on the rate of change of acceleration), speed control based on acceleration rate change is disabled, so that the specification of this parameter has no effect.
13618 Rate of change time of the rate of change of acceleration in smooth bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration before interpolation when AI contour control is used (precision level 1) Rate of change time of the rate of change of acceleration in smooth bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration before interpolation when AI contour control is used (precision level 10)

13619

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Byte path % 0 to 50 Each of these parameters sets the rate (percentage) of the change time of the rate of change of acceleration to the change time of acceleration rate change in smooth bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration before look-ahead interpolation during AI contour control. Set a value (precision level 1) with emphasis placed on speed, and a value (precision level 10) with emphasis on precision.

NOTE When 0 or a value not within the valid data range is set in this parameter, smooth bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration before look-ahead interpolation is not performed.
13620 13621 Allowable acceleration rate when AI contour control is used (precision level 1) Allowable acceleration rate when AI contour control is used (precision level 10)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/sec/sec, inch/sec/sec, degree/sec/sec (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (D) (When the machine system is metric system, 0.0 to +100000.0. When the machine system is inch system, machine, 0.0 to +10000.0) Each of these parameters sets an allowable acceleration rate in AI contour control. Set a value (precision level 1) with emphasis placed on speed, and a value (precision level 10) with emphasis on precision.
Time constant for acceleration/deceleration after interpolation when AI contour control is used (precision level 1) Time constant for acceleration/deceleration after interpolation when AI contour control is used (precision level 10)

13622

13623

[Input type] Parameter input


- 562 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Data type] Word axis [Unit of data] msec [Valid data range] 1 to 512 Each of these parameters sets a time constant for acceleration/ deceleration after interpolation when AI contour control is used. Set a value (precision level 1) with emphasis placed on speed, and a value (precision level 10) with emphasis on precision.
13624 13625 Corner speed difference when AI contour control is used (precision level 1) Corner speed difference when AI contour control is used (precision level 10)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) Each of these parameters sets an allowable speed difference for speed determination based on corner speed difference in AI contour control. Set a value (precision level 1) with emphasis placed on speed, and a value (precision level 10) with emphasis on precision.
Maximum cutting speed when AI contour control is used (precision level 1) Maximum cutting speed when AI contour control is used (precision level 10)

13626 13627

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999000.0) Each of these parameters sets a maximum cutting speed in AI contour control. Set a value (precision level 1) with emphasis placed on speed, and a value (precision level 10) with emphasis on precision.
Parameter number corresponding to arbitrary item 1 when AI contour control is used Parameter number corresponding to arbitrary item 2 when AI contour control is used

13628 13629

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] 2-word path [Valid data range] 1 to 65535 These parameters set the parameter numbers corresponding to arbitrary items 1 and 2.

- 563 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE The parameter numbers corresponding to the following cannot be specified: Bit parameters Spindle parameters Nos. 4000 to 4799) Parameters of real number type Parameters that require power-off (for which the alarm PW0000 is issued) Nonexistent parameters
13630 Value with emphasis on speed (precision level 1) of the parameter corresponding to arbitrary item 1 when AI contour control is used Value with emphasis on speed (precision level 1) of the parameter corresponding to arbitrary item 2 when AI contour control is used Value with emphasis on speed (precision level 10) of the parameter corresponding to arbitrary item 1 when AI contour control is used Value with emphasis on speed (precision level 10) of the parameter corresponding to arbitrary item 2 when AI contour control is used

13631

13632

13633

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis Depend on the type of parameter for an arbitrary item Depend on the type of parameter for an arbitrary item Each of these parameters sets a value with emphasis placed on speed or precision for a parameter.
Precision level currently selected when AI contour control is used

13634

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to 10 This parameter sets the level currently selected.
13662 Acceleration rate change time (bell-shaped) when AI contour control is used (precision level 1), range extended Acceleration rate change time (bell-shaped) when AI contour control is used (precision level 10), range extended

13663

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word path msec 0 to 200 Each of these parameters sets an acceleration rate change time (bell-shaped) in AI contour control. Set a value (precision 1) with emphasis placed on speed, and a value (precision level 10) with emphasis on precision.

4.123
13730

PARAMETERS OF PARAMETER CHECK SUM FUNCTION


#7 CSR #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 CKS

[Input type] Parameter input


- 564 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Data type] Bit #0 CKS A power-on, a parameter check sum check is: 0: Not performed. 1: Performed. CSR Alarm No. 5340 (parameter check sum error) is cleared with: 0: 1:
13731 13732 13733 13734 13735 13736 13737 13738 13739 13740 13741 13742 13743 13744 13745 13746 13747 13748 13749 13750

#7

+ key.

keys.

Number to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 01 Number to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 02 Number to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 03 Number to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 04 Number to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 05 Number to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 06 Number to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 07 Number to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 08 Number to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 09 Number to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 10 Number to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 11 Number to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 12 Number to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 13 Number to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 14 Number to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 15 Number to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 16 Number to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 17 Number to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 18 Number to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 19 Number to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 20

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word path mm, inch, degree (machine unit) 0 to maximum parameter number These parameters set the numbers of the parameters to be excluded from the check sum in the parameter check sum function.

- 565 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
13751 13752 13753 13754 13755 13756 13757 13758 13759 13760 13761 13762 13763 13764 13765 13766 13767 13768 13769 13770

B-63950EN/04

Start number of the range to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 01 Start number of the range to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 02 Start number of the range to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 03 Start number of the range to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 04 Start number of the range to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 05 Start number of the range to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 06 Start number of the range to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 07 Start number of the range to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 08 Start number of the range to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 09 Start number of the range to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 10 Start number of the range to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 11 Start number of the range to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 12 Start number of the range to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 13 Start number of the range to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 14 Start number of the range to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 15 Start number of the range to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 16 Start number of the range to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 17 Start number of the range to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 18 Start number of the range to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 19 Start number of the range to be excluded from the NC parameter check sum, 20

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word path mm, inch, degree (machine unit) 0 to maximum parameter number These parameters specify the range of parameters to be excluded from the check sum in the parameter check sum function. The parameters ranging from the start number to the end number are excluded from the check sum.

NOTE 1 The parameters with the start and end numbers are also excluded. 2 In a combination of start and end numbers, if the start number is greater than the end number (start number > end number), the combination is invalid. 3 If the start and end numbers are the same (start number = end number), the single parameter with that number is excluded.

- 566 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

4.124
13810 13811 13821 to 13826 13829 13831 to 13838 13840 to 13843 13880 to 13911 13920 to 13951 13960 to 13991

PARAMETERS OF DUAL CHECK SAFETY (2 OF 2)

to

to

to

to

to

to

These parameters are related to Dual Check Safety. See Dual Check Safety CONNECTION MANUAL (B-64003EN) for details.

- 567 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

4.125
14000

PARAMETERS OF PARAMETERS OF AXIS CONTROL/INCREMENT SYSTEM (3 OF 3)


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 IRF #1 INA #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #1 INA If an inch-metric switch command is executed at a position other than the reference position, 0: It is executed as usual. 1: Alarm PS5362 is issued. IRF An inch-metric switch command (G20, G21) at the reference position is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. When this function is enabled for an axis, if an attempt to switch between the inch and metric unit is made although the tool is not at the reference position on that axis, an alarm PS5362 is issued, and switching between the inch and metric unit is canceled. Be sure to move the tool to the reference position by, for example, specifying G28 before switching between the inch and metric unit.

#2

4.126
14010

PARAMETERS OF LINEAR SCALE WITH ABSOLUTE ADDRESS REFERENCE POSITION


Maximum allowable travel distance when the reference position is established for a linear scale with an absolute address reference position

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word axis Detection unit 0 to 99999999 This parameter sets the maximum allowable travel distance at the FL rate when the reference position is established for a linear scale with an absolute address reference position. When the travel distance exceeds the setting of this parameter, the alarm DS0017, SERIAL DCL:REF-POS ESTABLISH ERR is issued. When this parameter is set to 0, the maximum allowable travel distance is not checked.

NOTE 1 To establish the reference position with axis synchronous control, set the parameter for both master and slave axes. 2 In angular axis control, the setting of this parameter is invalid to the orthogonal axis where the reference position on the angular axis is being established.

- 568 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

4.127
14250

PARAMETERS OF PIVOT AXIS CONTROL


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 RGE #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #3 RGE The division of the gain multiplier of the pivot axis is: 0: Performed at up to 10 points. For the pivot axis, set parameters Nos. 14270 to 14279 (angle) and parameters Nos. 14280 to 14289 (gain multiplier for the angle). 1: Expanded at up to (10 x number of controlled axes). The method of changing parameters Nos. 14270 to 14279 (angle) and parameters Nos. 14280 to 14289 (gain multiplier for the angle) is changed, and the number of division points varies with the number of controlled axes.

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.

When the bit 3 (RGE) of parameter No. 14250 is set to 0


14270 14271 14272 14273 14274 14275 14276 14277 14278 14279 Angle 1 ( - data for G diagrams) Angle 2 ( - data for G diagrams) Angle 3 ( - data for G diagrams) Angle 4 ( - data for G diagrams) Angle 5 ( - data for G diagrams) Angle 6 ( - data for G diagrams) Angle 7 ( - data for G diagrams) Angle 8 ( - data for G diagrams) Angle 9 ( - data for G diagrams) Angle 10 ( - data for G diagrams)

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input Real axis Degree Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +360. Set these parameters for the pivot axis.

- 569 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
14280 14281 14282 14283 14284 14285 14286 14287 14288 14289 Setting for the gain multiplier of angle 1 ( - gain for G diagrams) Setting for the gain multiplier of angle 2 ( - gain for G diagrams) Setting for the gain multiplier of angle 3 ( - gain for G diagrams) Setting for the gain multiplier of angle 4 ( - gain for G diagrams) Setting for the gain multiplier of angle 5 ( - gain for G diagrams) Setting for the gain multiplier of angle 6 ( - gain for G diagrams) Setting for the gain multiplier of angle 7 ( - gain for G diagrams) Setting for the gain multiplier of angle 8 ( - gain for G diagrams) Setting for the gain multiplier of angle 9 ( - gain for G diagrams) Setting for the gain multiplier of angle 10 ( - gain for G diagrams)

B-63950EN/04

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] Parameter input 2-word axis 1/512 -32768(-63) to 32767(64.9) Set these parameters for the pivot axis. The gain multiplier is calculated using the setting of a parameter, as follows:
Gain multiplier= Setting of parameter 512 +1

Thus, the gain multipliers for the settings below are as given below.
Setting Gain multiplier -32768 -63 -1536 -2 -1024 -1 512 2 1024 3 1536 4 32767 64.9

When the bit 3 (RGE) of parameter No. 14250 is set to 0


14270 to 14279 Angle ( - gain for G diagrams) to Angle ( - gain for G diagrams)

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input Real axis Degree Depend on the increment system of the applied axis -1, 0, or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -1.0, 0.0 to +360.) [Example] Set angles as follows: 1st axis: Angles 1.0 to 10.0 2nd axis: Angles 11.0 to 20.0
- 570 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
3rd axis: Angles 21.0 to 30.0 to 8th axis: Angles 71.0 to 75.0
Parameter 14270 14271 14272 14273 14274 14275 14276 14277 14278 14279 1st axis 2nd axis 3rd axis 4th axis 1.0 2.0 3.0 4.0 5.0 6.0 7.0 8.0 9.0 10.0 11.0 12.0 13.0 14.0 15.0 16.0 17.0 18.0 19.0 20.0 21.0 22.0 23.0 24.0 25.0 26.0 27.0 28.0 29.0 30.0 31.0 32.0 33.0 34.0 35.0 36.0 37.0 38.0 39.0 40.0 5th axis 41.0 42.0 43.0 44.0 45.0 46.0 47.0 48.0 49.0 50.0 6th axis 51.0 52.0 53.0 54.0 55.0 56.0 57.0 58.0 59.0 60.0 7th axis 61.0 62.0 63.0 64.0 65.0 66.0 67.0 68.0 69.0 70.0 8th axis 71.0 72.0 73.0 74.0 75.0 -1.0

Set -1.0 in the parameter for "maximum number of items used + 1", where items refer to angles. The table gives values if angles 1.0 to 75.0 are set in 1-degree steps. If there are multiple pivot axes, the settings are used universally to all the pivot axes.
14280 to 14289 Setting for the gain multiplier of angle ( - gain for G diagrams) to Setting for the gain multiplier of angle ( - gain for G diagrams)

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] Parameter input 2-word axis 1/512 -32768(-63) to 32767(64.9) The gain multiplier is calculated using the setting of a parameter, as follows:
Gain multiplier= Setting of parameter 512 +1

Thus, the gain multipliers for the settings below are as given below.
Setting Gain multiplier -32768 -63 -1536 -2 -1024 -1 512 2 1024 3 1536 4 32767 64.9

[Example] Set the settings for the gain multipliers for angles (parameters Nos. 14270 to 14279) as follows: 1st axis: Setting for the gain multiplier for angles 1.0 to 10.0 2nd axis: Setting for the gain multiplier for angles 11.0 to 20.0 3rd axis: Setting for the gain multiplier for angles 21.0 to 30.0 to 8th axis: Setting for the gain multiplier for angles 71.0 to 75.0
Parameter 14280 14281 14282 1st axis 614 691 768 2nd axis 1382 1428 1474 3rd axis 1843 1894 1920 4th axis 2150 2151 2152 5th axis 2150 2140 2130 6th axis 2048 2038 2027 7th axis 1945 1928 1912 8th axis 1782 1763 1743

- 571 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Parameter 14283 14284 14285 14286 14287 14288 14289 1st axis 845 922 999 1076 1153 1230 1307 2nd axis 1520 1566 1612 1659 1705 1751 1797 3rd axis 1945 1971 1997 2022 2048 2073 2099 4th axis 2153 2154 2155 2154 2153 2152 2151 5th axis 2119 2109 2099 2089 2078 2068 2058 6th axis 2017 2007 1996 1986 1976 1966 1955 7th axis 1896 1880 1864 1847 1831 1815 1798

B-63950EN/04

8th axis 1724 1704

In this example, the 12th angle is set for the second axis of parameter No. 14271, and the setting for the gain multiplier for the angle is set for the second axis of parameter No. 14281.

NOTE 1 When bit 3 (RGE) of parameter No. 14250 is set to 1, the number of angles and the number of settings for the gain multipliers for the angles vary depending on the number of controlled axes. [Example] For eight axes, up to 80 items can be set, and for four axes, up to 40 items can be set. 2 If there are multiple pivot axes, the settings are used universally to all the pivot axes.

4.128
14340 14341 to 14357

PARAMETERS OF FSSB
ATR value corresponding to slave 01 on FSSB line 1 ATR value corresponding to slave 02 on FSSB line 1 to ATR value corresponding to slave 18 on FSSB line 1

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte [Valid data range] 0 to 23, 64, -56, -96 Each of these parameters sets the value (ATR value) of the address translation table corresponding to each of slave 1 to slave 18 on FSSB line 1 (first optical connector). The slave is a generic term for servo amplifiers and separate detector interface units connected via an FSSB optical cable to the CNC. Numbers 1 to 18 are assigned to slaves, with younger numbers sequentially assigned to slaves closer to the CNC. A 2-axis amplifier consists of two slaves, and a 3-axis amplifier consists of three slaves. In each of these parameters, set a value as described below, depending on whether the slave is an amplifier, separate detector, or nonexistent. When the slave is an amplifier: Set a value obtained by subtracting 1 from the setting of parameter No. 1023 for the axis to which the amplifier is assigned. When the slave is a separate detector interface unit: Set 64 for the first separate detector interface unit (connected near the CNC), and set -56 for the second separate detector interface unit (connected far from the CNC).
- 572 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
When the slave is nonexistent: Set -96.

NOTE 1 When the electronic gear box (EGB) function is used Although an amplifier is not actually required for an EGB dummy axis, set this parameter with assuming that a dummy amplifier is connected. That is, as the address conversion table value for a nonexistent slave, set the value obtained by subtracting 1 from the setting of parameter No. 1023 for the EGB dummy axis, instead of -96. 2 When the FSSB is set to the automatic setting mode (when the bit 0 (FMD) of parameter No. 1902 is set to 0), parameter Nos. 14340 to 14357 are automatically set as data is input on the FSSB setting screen. When the manual setting 2 mode is set (when the bit 0 (FMD) of parameter No. 1902 is set to 1), be sure to directly set values in parameter Nos. 14340 to 14357.

- 573 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

Example of axis configuration and parameter settings


Example 1
CNC Slave number
Single-axis amplifier Two-axis amplifier Two-axis amplifier

Controlled Program axis Servo axis No.1023 name axis No.1020 number

ATR No.14340 to 14357 0 1 2 3 4 64 5 -56 -96

Axis

1 2 3 4 5 6

X Y Z A B C

1 3 4 2 5 6

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 to 18

X A Y Z B (M1) C (M2) (None)

M1
Single-axis amplifier

M2

CNC
Controlled Program axis Servo name axis axis No.1023 No.1020 number

Slave number
Single-axis amplifier Two-axis amplifier Two-axis amplifier

ATR No.14340 to 14357 0 2 3 1 4 64 5 -56 -96

Axis

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 to 18

X Y Z A B (M1) C (M2) (None)

1 2 3 4 5 6

X Y Z A B C

1 3 4 2 5 6

M1
Single-axis amplifier

M2

M1/M2: First/second separate detector interface units

- 574 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Example of axis configuration and parameter settings when the electronic gear box (EGB) function is used (EGB slave axis: A-axis, EGB dummy axis: B-axis)
CNC Slave number
Single-axis amplifier Two-axis amplifier Two-axis amplifier

Example 2

Controlled Program axis Servo axis No.1023 name axis No.1020 number

ATR No.14340 to 14357 0 1 2 4 5 64 -56 3 -96 -96

Axis

1 2 3 4 5 6

X Y Z A B C

1 2 5 3 4 6

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10

X Y A Z C (M1) (M2) B(Dummy) (None) (None)

M1 M2

M1/M2: First/second separate detector interface units

14358 14359 to 14375

ATR value corresponding to slave 01 on FSSB line 2 ATR value corresponding to slave 02 on FSSB line 2 to ATR value corresponding to slave 18 on FSSB line 2

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte [Valid data range] 0 to 23, 80, -40, -96 Each of these parameters sets the value (ATR value) of the address translation table corresponding to each of slave 1 to slave 18 on FSSB line 2 (second optical connector). When the slave is an amplifier: Set a value obtained by subtracting 1 from the setting of parameter No. 1023 for the axis to which the amplifier is assigned. When the slave is a separate detector interface unit: Set 80 for the third separate detector interface unit (connected near the CNC), and set -40 for the fourth separate detector interface unit (connected far from the CNC). When the slave is nonexistent: Set -96.

- 575 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE 1 Set these parameters only when a servo axis control card with two optical connectors (FSSB lines) is used. 2 When the FSSB is set to the automatic setting mode (when the bit 0 (FMD) of parameter No. 1902 is set to 0), parameters Nos. 14358 to 14375 are automatically set as data is input on the FSSB setting screen. When the manual setting 2 mode is set (when the bit 0 (FMD) of parameter No. 1902 is set to 1), be sure to directly set values in parameters Nos. 14358 to 14375.
14376 14377 to 14383 14384 to 14391 14392 to 14399 14400 to 14407 ATR value corresponding to connector 1 on the first separate detector interface unit ATR value corresponding to connector 2 on the first separate detector interface unit to ATR value corresponding to connector 8 on the first separate detector interface unit ATR value corresponding to connector 1 on the second separate detector interface unit to ATR value corresponding to connector 8 on the second separate detector interface unit ATR value corresponding to connector 1 on the third separate detector interface unit to ATR value corresponding to connector 8 on the third separate detector interface unit ATR value corresponding to connector 1 on the fourth separate detector interface unit to ATR value corresponding to connector 8 on the fourth separate detector interface unit

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte [Valid data range] 0 to 32 Each of these parameters sets the value (ATR value) of the address translation table corresponding to each connector on a separate detector interface unit. The first and second separate detector interface units are connected to FSSB line 1, and the third and fourth separate detector interface units are connected to FSSB line 2. In each of these parameters, set a value obtained by subtracting 1 from the setting of parameter No. 1023 for the axis connected to a connector on a separate detector interface unit. When there are axes for which settings are made to use a separate detector interface unit (bit 6 (PM1x) of parameter No. 1905 is set to 1, bit 7 (PM2x) of parameter No. 1905 is set to 1, bit 1 (PM3x) of parameter No. 1905 is set to 1, or bit 2 (PM4x) of parameter No. 1905 is set to 1), set 32 for connectors not used.

- 576 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE When the FSSB is set to the automatic setting mode (when the bit 0 (FMD) of parameter No. 1902 is set to 0), parameters Nos. 14376 to 14407 are automatically set as data is input on the FSSB setting screen. When the manual setting 2 mode is set (when the bit 0 (FMD) of parameter No. 1902 is set to 1), be sure to directly set values in parameters Nos. 14376 to 14407.

14408 14409 to 14425

ATR value corresponding to slave 01 on an additional axis board ATR value corresponding to slave 02 on an additional axis board to ATR value corresponding to slave 18 on an additional axis board

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte [Valid data range] 0 to 23, 64, -56, -96 Each of these parameters sets the value (ATR value) of the address translation table corresponding to each of slave 1 to slave 18 on an additional axis board. When the slave is an amplifier: If the servo software 90Ex series is used, set a value obtained by subtracting 25 from the setting of parameter No. 1023 for the axis to which an amplifier is to be allocated. If the servo software 90Dx for servo HRV4 control is used, set a value obtained by subtracting 13 from the setting of parameter No. 1023 for the axis to which an amplifier is to be allocated. When the slave is a separate detector interface unit: Set 64 for the first separate detector interface unit (connected near the CNC), and set -56 for the second separate detector interface unit (connected far from the CNC). When the slave is nonexistent: Set -96.

NOTE 1 Set these parameters when using an additional axis board. 2 When the FSSB is set to the automatic setting mode (when the bit 0 (FMD) of parameter No. 1902 is set to 0), parameters Nos. 14408 to 14425 are automatically set as data is input on the FSSB setting screen. When the manual setting 2 mode is set (when the bit 0 (FMD) of parameter No. 1902 is set to 1), be sure to directly set values in parameters Nos. 14408 to 14425.
14444 ATR value corresponding to connector 1 on the first separate detector interface unit connected to an additional axis board ATR value corresponding to connector 2 on the first separate detector interface unit connected to an additional axis board to ATR value corresponding to connector 8 on the first separate detector interface unit connected to an additional axis board

14445 to 14451

- 577 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
14452 to 14459

B-63950EN/04

ATR value corresponding to connector 1 on the second separate detector interface unit connected to an additional axis board to ATR value corresponding to connector 8 on the second separate detector interface unit connected to an additional axis board

NOTE When these parameters are set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte [Valid data range] 0 to 32 Each of these parameters sets the value (ATR value) of the address translation table corresponding to each connector on a separate detector interface unit connected to an additional axis board. To an additional axis board, the first and second separate detector interface units are connected. When the servo software 90Ex series is used, in each of these parameters, set a value obtained by subtracting 25 from the setting of parameter No. 1023 for the axis connected to a connector on a separate detector interface unit. If the servo software 90Dx for servo HRV4 control is used, set a value obtained by subtracting 13 from the setting of parameter No. 1023 for the axis connected to a connector on a separate detector interface unit. When there are axes for which settings are made to use a separate detector interface unit (bit 6 (PM1x) of parameter No. 1905 is set to 1, bit 7 (PM2x) of parameter No. 1905 is set to 1, bit 1 (PM3x) of parameter No. 1905 is set to 1, or bit 2 (PM4x) of parameter No. 1905 is set to 1), set 32 for connectors not used.

NOTE 1 Set these parameters when using an additional axis board. 2 When the FSSB is set to the automatic setting mode (when the bit 0 (FMD) of parameter No. 1902 is set to 0), parameters Nos. 14444 to 14459 are automatically set as data is input on the FSSB setting screen. When the manual setting 2 mode is set (when the bit 0 (FMD) of parameter No. 1902 is set to 1), be sure to directly set values in parameters Nos. 14444 to 14459.
#7 14476 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 2AX #0

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #1 2AX Servo software 90Dx series for servo HRV4 control is: 0: Not used. 1: Used.

- 578 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

4.129

PARAMETERS OF SERVO GUIDE Mate


Parameter Nos. 14500 to 14637 shown below hold initial values and values set by screen operations in SERVO GUIDE Mate. These parameters are set by the CNC. So, never input values from the parameter screen.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

14500

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit


14501 to 14637

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte / 2-word / Real

4.130
14706

PARAMETERS OF GRAPHIC DISPLAY (3 OF 5)


Directions of the axes of the machine

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 16 to 20 When the dynamic graphic display function is used, the directions of the axes of the machine (the orientations of the basic three axes of the workpiece coordinate system for the main spindle) are selected from the following and set in the parameter: Setting 16: Right-handed coordinate system Right = +Z, up = +X Setting 17: Right-handed coordinate system Right = -Z, up = + Setting 18: Right-handed coordinate system Right = -Z, up = - Setting 19: Right-handed coordinate system Right = +Z, up = - Setting 20: Right-handed coordinate system Right = +X, up = +Z
X X Z

Z Setting=16 Z

Z Setting=17 Z

X Setting=18

X Setting=19 Setting=20

14713

Unit of magnification by which enlargement and reduction is performed with the dynamic graphic display function

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word


- 579 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

[Valid data range] 0 to 255 This parameter sets the unit of magnification by which enlargement and reduction is performed with the dynamic graphic display function. Unit of magnification = 64 / setting If 0 is set, 64 is assumed.
14714 Unit of horizontal movement when a movement is made with the dynamic graphic display function

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to 255 This parameter sets the unit of horizontal movement (in dots) applied when a movement is made with the dynamic graphic display function. If 0 is set, 64 is assumed.
14715 Unit of vertical movement when a movement is made with the dynamic graphic display function

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to 255 This parameter sets the unit of vertical movement (in dots) applied when a movement is made with the dynamic graphic display function. If 0 is set, 35 is assumed.
14716 Unit of rotation angle when rotation is performed with the dynamic graphic display function

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to 255 This parameter sets the unit (in degrees) of a rotation angle by which the drawing coordinate system is rotated with the dynamic graphic display function. If 0 is set, 10 is assumed.
14717 Axis number of the rotation axis to be drawn with the dynamic graphic display function

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to Number of controlled axes This parameter sets the axis number of the rotation axis to be drawn with the dynamic graphic display function.

NOTE 1 This parameter regards as objects of drawing the rotation axes to operate when the following interpolation command is executed. - Polar coordinate interpolation 2 Do not change the setting of this parameter while drawing is in progress. 3 Rotation axes other than those rotation axes (such as the C-axis) whose center of rotation is on the Z-axis of the three basic axes cannot be objects of drawing.

- 580 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

4.131
14880

PARAMETERS OF EMBEDDED ETHERNET


#7 #6 DHC #5 DNS #4 UNM #3 D1E #2 #1 PCH #0 ETH

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit #0 ETH The embedded Ethernet function (a built-in port or PCMCIA LAN card) is: 0: Used. 1: Not used. PCH At the start of communication of the FTP file transfer function for built-in port, checking for the presence of the server using PING is: 0: Performed. 1: Not performed.

#1

NOTE Usually, set 0. If 1 is set not to check the presence of the server by using PING, it may take several tens of seconds to recognize an error when the server is not present in the network. For mainly security reasons, a personal computer may be set so that it does not respond to the PING command. To communicate with such a personal computer, set 1.
#3 D1E When the DHCP function on a built-in port is used: 0: Default parameters for the FOCAS2/Ethernet function are set. PORT NUMBER (TCP) : 8193 PORT NUMBER (UDP) : 0 TIME INTERVAL :0 1: Default parameters for CIMPLICITY iCELL communication are set. PORT NUMBER (TCP) : 8193 PORT NUMBER (UDP) : 8192 TIME INTERVAL : 50 UNM With a built-in port, the CNC Unsolicited Messaging function is: 0: Not used. 1: Used.

#4

NOTE To use the CNC Unsolicited Messaging function with a built-in port, the Enhanced Embedded Ethernet function (-R952) is required.
#5 DNS With a built-in port, the DNS client function is: 0: Not used. 1: Used. DHC With a built-in port, the DHCP client function is: 0: Not used. 1: Used.
- 581 -

#6

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 14882 #6 #5 #4 UNS #3 #2 #1

B-63950EN/04 #0

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit #4 UNS In the CNC Unsolicited Messaging function of a built-in port, when the end of the function is requested by other than the CNC Unsolicited Messaging server currently connected: 0: The request for the end of the function is rejected. 1: The request for the end of the function is accepted.

NOTE To use the CNC Unsolicited Messaging function with a built-in port, the Enhanced Embedded Ethernet function (-R952) is required.
14890 14891 14892 Selects the host computer 1 OS. Selects the host computer 2 OS. Selects the host computer 3 OS.

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to 2 0: Windows95/98/Me/2000/XP. 1: UNIX, VMS. 2: Linux.

NOTE Some FTP server software products do not depend on the OS. So, even when the above parameters are set, it is sometimes impossible to display a list of files properly.
14896 Selection of embedded Ethernet in stand-alone type 300is, 310is, and 320is

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to 3 When the stand-alone type 300is, 310is, or 320is is used, this parameter sets the embedded Ethernet that can be used.
No. 14896 0 1 2 3 Built-in port Port in the CNC Port in the CNC Port in the rear of the display unit Port in the rear of the display unit PCMCIA LAN card Memory card slot on a side of the display unit Memory card slot in the CNC Memory card slot on a side of the display unit Memory card slot in the CNC

- 582 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

4.132
14900

PARAMETERS OF ROTATION AREA INTERFERENCE CHECK (2 OF 2)


#7 IC4 #6 IC3 #5 IC2 #4 IC1 #3 IRB #2 IRA #1 IB2 #0 IB1

NOTE When at least one of these parameters is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 IB1 Movement direction of group B (the first axis) 0: The direction of movement along the first axis of the group-B movement plane is the same as the direction of movement along the first axis on the group-A movement plane. 1: The direction of movement along the first axis of the group-B movement plane is opposite to the direction of movement along the first axis on the group-A movement plane. IB2 Movement direction of group B (the second axis) 0: The direction of movement along the second axis of the group-B movement plane is the same as the direction of movement along the second axis on the group-A movement plane. 1: The direction of movement along the second axis of the group-B movement plane is opposite to the direction of movement along the second axis of the group-A movement plane. IRA Rotation direction of the rotation axis on which group A is rotated 0: The direction of a rotation from the positive side of the first axis of the plane to the positive side of the second axis is assumed to be the positive direction of the rotation axis on which group A is rotated. 1: The direction of a rotation from the positive side of the first axis of the plane to the positive side of the second axis is assumed to be the negative direction of the rotation axis on which group A is rotated. IRB Rotation direction of the rotation axis on which group B is rotated 0: The direction of a rotation from the positive side of the first axis of the plane to the positive side of the second axis is assumed to be the positive direction of the rotation axis on which group B is rotated. 1: The direction of a rotation from the positive side of the first axis of the plane to the positive side of the second axis is assumed to be the negative direction of the rotation axis on which group B is rotated.

#1

#2

#3

#4-7

IC1-IC4 Processing time required to make the interference check The processing time is a multiple of 8. If the calculated value of the processing time is smaller than 8, the processing time is assumed to be 8 msec.
Setting 16 4(8) 8 IC4 0 0 0 IC3 0 0 0 IC2 0 0 1 IC1 0 1 0

- 583 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Setting 16 24 32 40 48
#7 14901 NB4 #6 NB3

B-63950EN/04

IC4 0 0 1 1 1
#5 NB2 #4 NB1

IC3 1 1 0 0 1
#3 NA4

IC2 0 1 0 1 0
#2 NA3 #1 NA2

IC1 0 0 0 0 0
#0 NA1

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 #1 #2 #3 NA1 Rectangle 1 in the group A which rotates according to the movement of rotary axes specified. NA2 Rectangle 2 in the group A which rotates according to the movement of rotary axes specified. NA3 Rectangle 3 in the group A which rotates according to the movement of rotary axes specified. NA4 Rectangle 4 in the group A which rotates according to the movement of rotary axes specified. 0: Rectangle rotates according to the rotation on rotary axis of the group A. 1: Rectangle does not rotate according to the rotation on rotary axis of the group A. NB1 Rectangle 1 in the group B which rotates according to the movement of rotary axes specified. NB2 Rectangle 2 in the group B which rotates according to the movement of rotary axes specified. NB3 Rectangle 3 in the group B which rotates according to the movement of rotary axes specified. NB4 Rectangle 4 in the group B which rotates according to the movement of rotary axes specified. 0: Rectangle rotates according to the rotation on rotary axis of the group B. 1: Rectangle does not rotate according to the rotation on rotary axis of the group B
#7 14902 #6 #5 IRD #4 IRC #3 IDA2 #2 IDA1 #1 ICA2 #0 ICA1

is is is is

#4 #5 #6 #7

is is is is

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 ICA1 Movement direction of group C (the first axis) 0: The direction of movement along the first axis of the group-C movement plane is the same as the direction of movement along the first axis on the group-A movement plane. 1: The direction of movement along the first axis of the group-C movement plane is opposite to the direction of movement along the first axis on the group-A movement plane.

- 584 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
ICA2 Movement direction of group C (the second axis) 0: The direction of movement along the second axis of the group-C movement plane is the same as the direction of movement along the second axis on the group-A movement plane. 1: The direction of movement along the second axis of the group-C movement plane is opposite to the direction of movement along the second axis of the group-A movement plane. IDA1 Movement direction of group D (the first axis) 0: The direction of movement along the first axis of the group-D movement plane is the same as the direction of movement along the first axis on the group-A movement plane. 1: The direction of movement along the first axis of the group-D movement plane is opposite to the direction of movement along the first axis on the group-A movement plane. IDA2 Movement direction of group D (the second axis) 0: The direction of movement along the second axis of the group-D movement plane is the same as the direction of movement along the second axis on the group-A movement plane. 1: The direction of movement along the second axis of the group-D movement plane is opposite to the direction of movement along the second axis of the group-A movement plane. IRC Rotation direction of the rotation axis on which group C is rotated 0: The direction of a rotation from the positive side of the first axis of the plane to the positive side of the second axis is assumed to be the positive direction of the rotation axis on which group C is rotated. 1: The direction of a rotation from the positive side of the first axis of the plane to the positive side of the second axis is assumed to be the negative direction of the rotation axis on which group C is rotated. IRD Rotation direction of the rotation axis on which group D is rotated 0: The direction of a rotation from the positive side of the first axis of the plane to the positive side of the second axis is assumed to be the positive direction of the rotation axis on which group D is rotated. 1: The direction of a rotation from the positive side of the first axis of the plane to the positive side of the second axis is assumed to be the negative direction of the rotation axis on which group D is rotated.
#7 #6 ND3 #5 ND2 #4 ND1 #3 NC4 #2 NC3 #1 NC2 #0 NC1

#1

#2

#3

#4

#5

14903

ND4

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit

- 585 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#0 #1 #2 #3

B-63950EN/04

NC1 Rectangle 1 in the group C which rotates according to the movement of rotary axes specified. NC2 Rectangle 2 in the group C which rotates according to the movement of rotary axes specified. NC3 Rectangle 3 in the group C which rotates according to the movement of rotary axes specified. NC4 Rectangle 4 in the group C which rotates according to the movement of rotary axes specified. 0: Rectangle rotates according to the rotation on rotary axis of the group C. 1: Rectangle does not rotate according to the rotation on rotary axis of the group C. ND1 Rectangle 1 in the group D which rotates according to the movement of rotary axes specified. ND2 Rectangle 2 in the group D which rotates according to the movement of rotary axes specified. ND3 Rectangle 3 in the group D which rotates according to the movement of rotary axes specified. ND4 Rectangle 4 in the group D which rotates according to the movement of rotary axes specified. 0: Rectangle rotates according to the rotation on rotary axis of the group D. 1: Rectangle does not rotate according to the rotation on rotary axis of the group D
Axis number of the first axis of the plane on which group A is moved

is is is is

#4 #5 #6 #7

is is is is

14910

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to the number of controlled axes or m100+n (m:1 to the path number, n:1 to the number of controlled axes) Setting value 1 to 32 : controlled axes on own path 101 to 132 : controlled axes on path1 201 to 232 : controlled axes on path2 : 901 to 932 : controlled axes on path9 1001 to 1032 : controlled axes on path10 This parameter sets the axis number of the first axis of the group-A movement plane. Set the first axis of the basic plane This parameter should set the value. [Example] When an interference check is made on the Z-X plane, the first axis is the Z-axis.

NOTE This parameter is necessary for defining the rectangle other than A group, and this parameter is necessary also for defining a rectangular rotation center position other than A group. Therefore, please choose the number which can surely be set.
14911 Axis number of the second axis of the plane on which group A is moved

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to the number of controlled axes or m100+n (m:1 to the path number, n:1 to the number of controlled axes)
- 586 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Setting value 1 to 32 101 to 132 201 to 232 : 901 to 932 1001 to 1032 : controlled axes on own path : controlled axes on path1 : controlled axes on path2 : controlled axes on path9 : controlled axes on path10

This parameter sets the axis number of the second axis of the group-A movement plane. Set the second axis of the basic plane. This parameter should set the value. [Example] When an interference check is made on the Z-X plane, the second axis is the X-axis.

NOTE This parameter is necessary for defining the rectangle other than A group, and this parameter is necessary also for defining a rectangular rotation center position other than A group. Therefore, please choose the number which can surely be set.
14912 Axis number of the rotary axis on which group A is rotated

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to the number of controlled axes or m100+n (m:1 to the path number, n:1 to the number of controlled axes) Setting value 1 to 32 : controlled axes on own path 101 to 132 : controlled axes on path1 201 to 232 : controlled axes on path2 : 901 to 932 : controlled axes on path9 1001 to 1032 : controlled axes on path10 This parameter sets the axis number of a rotation axis used for rotating group-A. If there is no relevant rotary axis, set 0.

NOTE All the controlled axes which belong to group-A must be assigned to be the same path.
14913 Axis number of the first axis of the plane on which group B is moved

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to the number of controlled axes or m100+n (m:1 to the path number, n:1 to the number of controlled axes) Setting value 1 to 32 : controlled axes on own path 101 to 132 : controlled axes on path1 201 to 232 : controlled axes on path2 : 901 to 932 : controlled axes on path9 1001 to 1032 : controlled axes on path10
- 587 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

This parameter sets the axis number of the first axis of the group-B movement plane. Set the axis number of the axis parallel to the first axis of the group-A movement plane. If there is no relevant movement axis, set 0.
14914 Axis number of the second axis of the plane on which group B is moved

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to the number of controlled axes or m100+n (m:1 to the path number, n:1 to the number of controlled axes) Setting value 1 to 32 : controlled axes on own path 101 to 132 : controlled axes on path1 201 to 232 : controlled axes on path2 : 901 to 932 : controlled axes on path9 1001 to 1032 : controlled axes on path10 This parameter sets the axis number of the second axis of the group-B movement plane. Set the axis number of the axis parallel to the second axis of the group-A movement plane. If there is no relevant movement axis, set 0.
14915 Axis number of the rotary axis on which group B is rotated

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to the number of controlled axes or m100+n (m:1 to the path number, n:1 to the number of controlled axes) Setting value 1 to 32 : controlled axes on own path 101 to 132 : controlled axes on path1 201 to 232 : controlled axes on path2 : 901 to 932 : controlled axes on path9 1001 to 1032 : controlled axes on path10 This parameter sets the axis number of a rotation axis used for rotating group-B. If there is no relevant rotary axis, set 0.

NOTE All the controlled axes which belong to group-B must be assigned to be the same path.
14916 Axis number of the first axis of the plane on which group C is moved

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to the number of controlled axes or m100+n (m:1 to the path number, n:1 to the number of controlled axes) Setting value 1 to 32 : controlled axes on own path 101 to 132 : controlled axes on path1 201 to 232 : controlled axes on path2
- 588 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
: 901 to 932 : controlled axes on path9 1001 to 1032 : controlled axes on path10 This parameter sets the axis number of the first axis of the group-C movement plane. Set the axis number of the axis parallel to the first axis of the group-A movement plane. If there is no relevant movement axis, set 0.

14917

Axis number of the second axis of the plane on which group C is moved

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to the number of controlled axes or m100+n (m:1 to the path number, n:1 to the number of controlled axes) Setting value 1 to 32 : controlled axes on own path 101 to 132 : controlled axes on path1 201 to 232 : controlled axes on path2 : 901 to 932 : controlled axes on path9 1001 to 1032 : controlled axes on path10 This parameter sets the axis number of the second axis of the group-C movement plane. Set the axis number of the axis parallel to the second axis of the group-A movement plane. If there is no relevant movement axis, set 0.
14918 Axis number of the rotary axis on which group C is rotated

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word [Valid data range] 0 to the number of controlled axes or m100+n (m:1 to the path number, n:1 to the number of controlled axes) Setting value 1 to 32 : controlled axes on own path 101 to 132 : controlled axes on path1 201 to 232 : controlled axes on path2 : 901 to 932 : controlled axes on path9 1001 to 1032 : controlled axes on path10 This parameter sets the axis number of a rotation axis used for rotating group-C. If there is no relevant rotary axis, set 0.

NOTE All the controlled axes which belong to group-C must be assigned to be the same path.
14920 14921 Maximum point of rectangle 1 of group A in the first axis Minimum point of rectangle 1 of group A in the first axis

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Real [Unit of data] mm, inch(machine unit)
- 589 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

[Min. unit of data] Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path [Valid data range] 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 1 of group A in the first axis. When a rotation axis is present (parameter No. 14912), set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points after the reference position return has been performed for the group-A movement axes with the rotation axis set at the reference angular displacement (parameter No. 14938). Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
14922 14923 Maximum point of rectangle 1 of group A in the second axis Minimum point of rectangle 1 of group A in the second axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch(machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 1 of group A in the second axis. When a rotation axis is present (parameter No. 14912), set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points after the reference position return has been performed for the group-A movement axes with the rotation axis set at the reference angular displacement (parameter No. 14938). Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
Maximum point of rectangle 2 of group A in the first axis Minimum point of rectangle 2 of group A in the first axis

14924 14925

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch(machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 2 of group A in the first axis. When a rotation axis is present (parameter No. 14912), set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points after the reference position return has been performed for the group-A movement axes with the rotation axis set at the reference angular displacement (parameter No. 14938). Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
- 590 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Maximum point of rectangle 2 of group A in the second axis Minimum point of rectangle 2 of group A in the second axis

14926 14927

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch(machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 2 of group A in the second axis. When a rotation axis is present (parameter No. 14912), set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points after the reference position return has been performed for the group-A movement axes with the rotation axis set at the reference angular displacement (parameter No. 14938). Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
Maximum point of rectangle 3 of group A in the first axis Minimum point of rectangle 3 of group A in the first axis

14928 14929

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch(machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 3 of group A in the first axis. When a rotation axis is present (parameter No. 14912), set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points after the reference position return has been performed for the group-A movement axes with the rotation axis set at the reference angular displacement (parameter No. 14938). Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
Maximum point of rectangle 3 of group A in the second axis Minimum point of rectangle 3 of group A in the second axis

14930 14931

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch(machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999)

- 591 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 3 of group A in the second axis. When a rotation axis is present (parameter No. 14912), set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points after the reference position return has been performed for the group-A movement axes with the rotation axis set at the reference angular displacement (parameter No. 14938). Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
14932 14933 Maximum point of rectangle 4 of group A in the first axis Minimum point of rectangle 4 of group A in the first axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch(machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 4 of group A in the first axis. When a rotation axis is present (parameter No. 14912), set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points after the reference position return has been performed for the group-A movement axes with the rotation axis set at the reference angular displacement (parameter No. 14938). Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
Maximum point of rectangle 4 of group A in the second axis Minimum point of rectangle 4 of group A in the second axis

14934 14935

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch(machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 4 of group A in the second axis. When a rotation axis is present (parameter No. 14912), set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points after the reference position return has been performed for the group-A movement axes with the rotation axis set at the reference angular displacement (parameter No. 14938). Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.

- 592 -

B-63950EN/04 14936 14937

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Rotation center in the first axis when group-A is rotated Rotation center in the second axis when group-A is rotated

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch(machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the rotation center when group A is rotated. Set the distances from the machine zero point after reference position return has been performed for group-A movement axes. Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. If there is no rotation axis, set 0.
Reference angular displacement of the rotation axis of group A

14938

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real degree(machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the coordinate value (reference angular displacement) of the rotation axis when rectangle areas of group A are set for the interference check function. If there is no relevant rotation axis, set 0.
Maximum point of rectangle 1 of group B in the first axis Minimum point of rectangle 1 of group B in the first axis

14940 14941

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch(machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 1 of group B in the first axis. When a rotation axis is present (parameter No. 14915), set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points after the reference position return has been performed for the group-B movement axes with the rotation axis set at the reference angular displacement (parameter No. 14958). Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
Maximum point of rectangle 1 of group B in the second axis Minimum point of rectangle 1 of group B in the second axis

14942 14943

[Input type] Parameter input


- 593 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
[Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

B-63950EN/04

Real mm, inch(machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 1 of group B in the second axis. When a rotation axis is present (parameter No. 14915), set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points after the reference position return has been performed for the group-B movement axes with the rotation axis set at the reference angular displacement (parameter No. 14958). Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
Maximum point of rectangle 2 of group B in the first axis Minimum point of rectangle 2 of group B in the first axis

14944 14945

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch(machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 2 of group B in the first axis. When a rotation axis is present (parameter No. 14915), set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points after the reference position return has been performed for the group-B movement axes with the rotation axis set at the reference angular displacement (parameter No. 14958). Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
Maximum point of rectangle 2 of group B in the second axis Minimum point of rectangle 2 of group B in the second axis

14946 14947

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch(machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999)

- 594 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 2 of group B in the second axis. When a rotation axis is present (parameter No. 14915), set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points after the reference position return has been performed for the group-B movement axes with the rotation axis set at the reference angular displacement (parameter No. 14958). Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.

14948 14949

Maximum point of rectangle 3 of group B in the first axis Minimum point of rectangle 3 of group B in the first axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch(machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 3 of group B in the first axis. When a rotation axis is present (parameter No. 14915), set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points after the reference position return has been performed for the group-B movement axes with the rotation axis set at the reference angular displacement (parameter No. 14958). Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
Maximum point of rectangle 3 of group B in the second axis Minimum point of rectangle 3 of group B in the second axis

14950 14951

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch(machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 3 of group B in the second axis. When a rotation axis is present (parameter No. 14915), set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points after the reference position return has been performed for the group-B movement axes with the rotation axis set at the reference angular displacement (parameter No. 14958). Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.

- 595 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
14952 14953 Maximum point of rectangle 4 of group B in the first axis Minimum point of rectangle 4 of group B in the first axis

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch(machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 4 of group B in the first axis. When a rotation axis is present (parameter No. 14915), set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points after the reference position return has been performed for the group-B movement axes with the rotation axis set at the reference angular displacement (parameter No. 14958). Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
Maximum point of rectangle 4 of group B in the second axis Minimum point of rectangle 4 of group B in the second axis

14954 14955

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch(machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 4 of group B in the second axis. When a rotation axis is present (parameter No. 14915), set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points after the reference position return has been performed for the group-B movement axes with the rotation axis set at the reference angular displacement (parameter No. 14958). Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
Rotation center in the first axis when group-B is rotated Rotation center in the second axis when group-B is rotated

14956 14957

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch(machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999)

- 596 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
These parameters set the rotation center when group B is rotated. Set the distances from the machine zero point after reference position return has been performed for group-B movement axes. Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. If there is no rotation axis, set 0.

14958

Reference angular displacement of the rotation axis of group B

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real degree(machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the coordinate value (reference angular displacement) of the rotation axis when rectangle areas of group B are set for the interference check function. If there is no relevant rotation axis, set 0.
Maximum point of rectangle 1 of group C in the first axis Minimum point of rectangle 1 of group C in the first axis

14960 14961

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch(machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 1 of group C in the first axis. When a rotation axis is present (parameter No. 14918), set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points after the reference position return has been performed for the group-C movement axes with the rotation axis set at the reference angular displacement (parameter No. 14978). Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
Maximum point of rectangle 1 of group C in the second axis Minimum point of rectangle 1 of group C in the second axis

14962 14963

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch(machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 1 of group C in the second axis.

- 597 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

When a rotation axis is present (parameter No. 14918), set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points after the reference position return has been performed for the group-C movement axes with the rotation axis set at the reference angular displacement (parameter No. 14978). Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
14964 14965 Maximum point of rectangle 2 of group C in the first axis Minimum point of rectangle 2 of group C in the first axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch(machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 2 of group C in the first axis. When a rotation axis is present (parameter No. 14918), set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points after the reference position return has been performed for the group-C movement axes with the rotation axis set at the reference angular displacement (parameter No. 14978). Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
Maximum point of rectangle 2 of group C in the second axis Minimum point of rectangle 2 of group C in the second axis

14966 14967

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 2 of group C in the second axis. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. Set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points. Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
Maximum point of rectangle 3 of group C in the first axis Minimum point of rectangle 3 of group C in the first axis

14968 14969

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data]

Parameter input Real mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path
- 598 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

[Valid data range] 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 3 of group C in the first axis. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. Set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points. Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
14970 14971 Maximum point of rectangle 3 of group C in the second axis Minimum point of rectangle 3 of group C in the second axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 3 of group C in the second axis. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. Set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points. Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
Maximum point of rectangle 4 of group C in the first axis Minimum point of rectangle 4 of group C in the first axis

14972 14973

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 4 of group C in the first axis. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. Set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points. Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
Maximum point of rectangle 4 of group C in the second axis Minimum point of rectangle 4 of group C in the second axis

14974 14975

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999)
- 599 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

These parameters set the maximum point and minimum point of rectangle area 4 of group C in the second axis. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. Set the distances from the machine zero point to the maximum and minimum points. Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
14976 14977 Rotation center in the first axis when group-C is rotated Rotation center in the second axis when group-C is rotated

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the rotation center when group C is rotated. Set the distances from the machine zero point after reference position return has been performed for group-C movement axes. Be sure to set a radius value regardless of whether the axis command is a diameter- or radius-programmed command. The set plane is specified with group-A movement axes 1 and 2. If there is no relevant rectangle area, set 0.
Reference angular displacement of the rotation axis of group C

14978

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real degree(machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis in the first path 9 digit of minimum unit of data(refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the coordinate value (reference angular displacement) of the rotation axis when rectangle areas of group C are set for the interference check function. If there is no relevant rotation axis, set 0.

4.133
14985

PARAMETERS OF PERIODICAL SECONDARY PITCH COMPENSATION


Number of the periodical secondary pitch compensation position at the extremely negative position for each axis

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis [Valid data range] 0 to 1535 The compensation position set in this parameter is used as the reference point for periodical secondary pitch error compensation. This reference point is used as the compensation position at the reference position.
- 600 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
The compensation at the reference point must be 0.

14986

Number of the periodical secondary pitch compensation position at the extremely positive position for each axis

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word axis [Valid data range] 0 to 1535 This parameter sets the periodical secondary pitch compensation position at the extremely positive position for each axis.
14987 Interval between periodical secondary pitch compensation positions for each axis

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range] Parameter input Real axis mm, inch, deg (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 0 to interval between stored pitch error compensation positions (parameter No. 3624) This parameter sets the interval between periodical secondary pitch compensation positions for each axis.
Magnification for periodical secondary pitch error compensation for each axis

14988

NOTE When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off before operation is continued.
[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Integer axis [Valid data range] 0 to 100 This parameter sets the magnification for periodical secondary pitch error compensation for each axis. If the magnification is set to 1, the same unit as the detection unit is used for the compensation data.

4.134
18000

PARAMETERS OF MANUAL HANDLE RETRACE (2 OF 2)


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 RTW #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit

- 601 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#1

B-63950EN/04

RTW At the start of a re-forward movement operation of the manual handle retrace function in a multi-path system, 0: The re-forward movement operation is performed immediately on each path. 1: Those paths for which reverse movement is prohibited are synchronized at the stop position.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

18050

OPN

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #7 OPN If an axis move command is executed with PMC axis control during automatic operation, and the NC block under execution is stopped by a feed hold when the axis moving due to PMC axis control is completed, the amount of movement due to PMC axis control in that block is: 0: Not reflected in the NC coordinate system. 1: Reflected in the NC coordinate system.
M code that prohibits backward movement

18060

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 1 to 999 When an M code that prohibits backward movement is specified during backward movement, backward movement of blocks before the M code is prohibited. In this case, backward movement prohibition signal MRVSP<Fn091.2> is output. The M code that prohibits backward movement is not output to the PMC as an M code. As the M code that prohibits backward movement, set an M code that is not used by auxiliary functions and macros.
18065 18066 M code 1 that prohibits backward movement and is output as an M code M code 2 that prohibits backward movement and is output as an M code

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Word path [Valid data range] 1 to 999 When an M code that prohibits backward movement is specified during backward movement, backward movement of blocks before the M code is prohibited. In this case, backward movement prohibition signal MRVSP<Fn091.2> is output. Such M codes that prohibits backward movement are output to the PMC as M codes. As the M codes that prohibit backward movement, set M codes that are not used by auxiliary functions and macros.

- 602 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

4.135
19500

PARAMETERS OF AI CONTOUR CONTROL (2 OF 2)


#7 FCC #6 FNW #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #6 FNW When the feedrate is determined according to the feedrate difference and acceleration in AI contour control: 0: The maximum feedrate at which the allowable feedrate difference and acceleration for each axis are not exceeded is used. 1: A feedrate is determined to satisfy the condition that the allowable feedrate difference and allowable acceleration rate of each axis are not exceeded, and also to ensure that a constant deceleration rate is applied to the same figure regardless of the direction of movement. #7 FCC When there is an axis that requires one or more seconds for acceleration in acceleration/deceleration before look-ahead interpolation: 0: Emphasis is placed on precision, so that the specified feedrate may not be reached. 1: Emphasis is placed on speed, so that the specified feedrate is produced. When this parameter is set to 1, the precision of curved interpolation such as circular interpolation and NURBS interpolation may decrease.
#7 19501 #6 #5 FRP #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #5 FRP Linear rapid traverse is: 0: Acceleration/deceleration after interpolation 1: Acceleration/deceleration before interpolation Set a maximum allowable acceleration rate for each axis in parameter No. 1671. When using bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration before interpolation, set an acceleration rate change time in parameter No. 1672. When this parameter is set to 1, acceleration/deceleration before interpolation is also applied to rapid traverse if all conditions below are satisfied. At this time, acceleration/deceleration after interpolation is not applied. Bit 1 (LRP) of parameter No. 1401 is set to 1: Linear interpolation type positioning A value other than 0 is set in parameter No. 1671 for an axis. The AI contour control mode is set. If all of these conditions are not satisfied, acceleration/deceleration after interpolation is applied.
#7 19503 #6 #5 #4 ZOL #3 #2 #1 #0 HPF

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path

- 603 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#0

B-63950EN/04

HPF When a feedrate is determined based on acceleration in AI contour control, smooth feedrate control is: 0: Not used. 1: Used. ZOL The deceleration function based on cutting load in AI contour control (deceleration based on Z-axis fall angle) is: 0: Enabled for all commands. 1: Enabled for linear interpolation commands only.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 ZG2 #0 BEX

#4

19515

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 BEX When the tapping mode (G63) or a canned cycle is specified, the mode for acceleration/deceleration before look-ahead interpolation is: 0: Turned off. 1: Not turned off. ZG2 When the deceleration function based on cutting load in AI contour control (deceleration based on Z-axis fall angle) is used: 0: Stepwise override values are applied. 1: Inclined override values are applied. This parameter is valid only when bit 4 (ZAG) of parameter No. 8451 is set to 1. When this parameter is set to 1, be sure to set parameter Nos. 19516, 8456, 8457, and 8458.
Override for area 1 in deceleration based on cutting load in AI contour control

#1

19516

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word path % 1 to 100 This parameter sets an override value for area 1 when the deceleration function based on cutting load in AI contour control is used. This parameter is valid only when bit 1 (ZG2) of parameter No. 19515 is set to 1.

4.136
19530

PARAMETERS OF CYLINDRICAL INTERPOLATION


#7 #6 CYS #5 CYA #4 #3 #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #5 CYA Specifies whether to perform cylindrical interpolation cutting point compensation in the cylindrical interpolation command (G07.1). 0: Perform. 1: Do not perform.

- 604 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
CYS Specifies whether when the cylindrical interpolation cutting point compensation function is used, cutting point compensation is performed between blocks or together with a block movement if the cutting point compensation value is less than the setting of parameter No. 19534. 0: Performed between blocks. 1: Performed together with a block movement if the cutting point compensation value is less than the setting of parameter No. 19534.
Tool offset axis number for the XY plane Tool offset axis number for the ZX plane Tool offset axis number for the YZ plane

#6

19531 19532 19533

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to number of controlled axes Specify a tool offset axis that intersects the cylindrical rotation axis at right angles.
19534 Limit for changing cylindrical interpolation cutting point compensation in a single block

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 1 to 999999999 The following operation is performed, depending on the setting of parameter No. 19530: (1) Bit 6 (CYS) of parameter No. 19530) is set to 0 If the amount of cylindrical interpolation cutting point compensation is smaller than the value set in this parameter, cylindrical interpolation cutting point compensation is not performed. Instead, this ignored amount of cylindrical interpolation cutting point compensation is added to the next amount of cylindrical interpolation cutting point compensation to determine whether to perform cylindrical interpolation cutting point compensation. (2) Bit 6 (CYS) of parameter No. 19530) is set to 1 If the amount of cylindrical interpolation cutting point compensation is smaller than the value set in this parameter, cylindrical interpolation cutting point compensation is performed together with the movement of the specified block.

NOTE Set this parameter as follows: Setting < (setting for a rotation axis in parameter No. 1430) 4/3 where 4/3 is a constant for internal processing.
19535 Limit of travel distance moved with the cylindrical interpolation cutting point compensation in the previous block unchanged.

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 1 to 999999999 The following operation is performed, depending on the type of interpolation:
- 605 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

(1) For linear interpolation If the travel distance in a specified block is smaller than the value set in this parameter, machining is performed without changing the cylindrical interpolation cutting point compensation in the previous block. (2) For circular interpolation If the diameter of a specified arc is smaller than the value set in this parameter, machining is performed without changing the cylindrical interpolation cutting point compensation in the previous block. Cylindrical interpolation cutting point compensation is not performed according to a circular movement.

4.137
19540

PARAMETERS OF OPTIMAL TORQUE ACCELERATION/DECELERATION


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 FAP

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 FAP Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. When the linear positioning parameters, namely bit 1 (LRP) of parameter No. 1401 and bit 0 (FAP) of parameter No. 19540, are set to 1, and a value other than 0 is set in reference acceleration parameter No. 1671 for an axis, the acceleration/deceleration for rapid traverse becomes optimal torque acceleration/deceleration in the mode for acceleration/deceleration before look-ahead interpolation (or the AI contour control mode). Optimal torque acceleration/ deceleration is controlled according to parameter-set restricted acceleration curve data. Setting an acceleration pattern
A cceleration P1 P2 A cce leration pa ttern

Aa P0 Ab

P3 P4 P5

Sp eed Fa Fb

Set the speed at each of the acceleration setting points (P0 to P5) in a corresponding parameter, then in parameters for each axis, set acceleration rates applicable in the following four cases at these speeds: when a movement in the positive direction is accelerated, when a movement in the positive direction is decelerated, when a movement in the negative direction is accelerated, and when a movement in the negative direction is decelerated. The line connecting the acceleration setting points is the acceleration pattern. The acceleration rate for each axis is calculated. For example, between speeds Fa to Fb in the above figure, the acceleration rates corresponding to these speeds, Aa to Ab, are used for calculation.
- 606 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
The tangent acceleration is controlled so that it does not exceed the calculated acceleration rate for each axis.

CAUTION When an acceleration pattern is set, setting a high acceleration rate immediately after a speed of 0 can cause an impact on the machine, so it is not desirable. Therefore, be sure to apply a relatively low acceleration rate at a speed of 0 as shown in the above figure.
19541 19542 19543 19544 Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (speed at P1) Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (speed at P2) Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (speed at P3) Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (speed at P4)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis 0.01% 0 to 10000 The speeds at acceleration setting points P1 to P4 are to be set with speed parameters Nos. 19541 to 19544 as ratios to the rapid traverse speed (parameter No. 1420). The speed at P0 is 0, and the speed at P5 is the rapid traverse rate specified with parameter No. 1420. Any acceleration setting point for which the speed parameter (one of Nos. 19541 to 19544) is set to 0 will be skipped.
Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (acceleration at P0 during movement in + direction and acceleration) Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (acceleration at P1 during movement in + direction and acceleration) Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (acceleration at P2 during movement in + direction and acceleration) Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (acceleration at P3 during movement in + direction and acceleration) Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (acceleration at P4 during movement in + direction and acceleration) Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (acceleration at P5 during movement in + direction and acceleration) Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (acceleration at P0 during movement in - direction and acceleration) Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (acceleration at P1 during movement in - direction and acceleration) Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (acceleration at P2 during movement in - direction and acceleration) Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (acceleration at P3 during movement in - direction and acceleration) Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (acceleration at P4 during movement in - direction and acceleration)

19545

19546

19547

19548

19549

19550

19551

19552

19553

19554

19555

- 607 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
19556

B-63950EN/04

Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (acceleration at P5 during movement in - direction and acceleration) Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (acceleration at P0 during movement in + direction and deceleration) Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (acceleration at P1 during movement in + direction and deceleration) Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (acceleration at P2 during movement in + direction and deceleration) Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (acceleration at P3 during movement in + direction and deceleration) Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (acceleration at P4 during movement in + direction and deceleration) Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (acceleration at P5 during movement in + direction and deceleration) Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (acceleration at P0 during movement in - direction and deceleration) Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (acceleration at P1 during movement in - direction and deceleration) Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (acceleration at P2 during movement in - direction and deceleration) Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (acceleration at P3 during movement in - direction and deceleration) Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (acceleration at P4 during movement in - direction and deceleration) Optimal torque acceleration/deceleration (acceleration at P5 during movement in - direction and deceleration)

19557

19558

19559

19560

19561

19562

19563

19564

19565

19566

19567

19568

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Word axis 0.01% 0 to 32767 For each travel direction and each acceleration/deceleration operation, set the allowable acceleration rate at each of the acceleration setting points (P0 to P5). As an allowable acceleration rate, set a ratio to the value set in the reference acceleration parameter No. 1671. When 0 is set, the specification of 100% is assumed.

4.138
19581

PARAMETERS OF NANO SMOOTHING


Tolerance smoothing for nano smoothing

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real path mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) This parameter sets a tolerance value for a program created using miniature line segments in nano smoothing.
- 608 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
When 0 is set in this parameter, a minimum amount of travel in the increment system is regarded as a tolerance value.

19582

Minimum amount of travel of a block that makes a decision based on an angular difference between blocks for nano smoothing

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real path mm, inch, degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the minimum amount of travel of a block that makes a decision based on an angular difference between blocks for nano smoothing. A block that specifies an amount of travel less than the value set in this parameter makes no decision based on an angular difference. When 0 is set in this parameter, a decision based on an angular difference is made with all blocks. A value greater than the value set in parameter No. 8490 for making a decision based on the minimum travel distance of a block must be set.
Tolerance of rotary axes for nano smoothing 2

19587

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real axis degree (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 0 or positive 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to the standard parameter setting table (B)) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 - +999999.999) This parameter sets the tolerance of rotation axes in a program created using small line segments in nano smoothing 2. This parameter is valid only for the rotation axes specified in nano smoothing 2. When 0 is set in this parameter, a minimum amount of travel in the increment system is regarded as a tolerance value.

4.139
19604

PARAMETERS OF TOOL COMPENSATION (3 OF 3)


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 TPC

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Bit path #0 TPC In the case that there is no address P at the start of tool center point control (G43.4/G43.5), tool posture control 0: Does not work. 1: Works.
#7 19605 TIT #6 #5 NIC #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 NSC

[Input type] Parameter input


- 609 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
[Data type] Bit path #0

B-63950EN/04

NSC For the machine type that has no rotation axis for rotating the tool (when parameter No. 19680 is set to 12 to specify the table rotation type), control point shifting in the tilted working plane command is: 0: Enabled. Set bit 4 (SPR) and bit 5 (SVC) of parameter No. 19665. 1: Disabled. NIC When the compensation plane is changed in 3-dimensional cutter compensation, the interference check is: 0: Performed. 1: Not performed. TIT If, in a tool rotary type machine (parameter No. 19680 = 2), tool center point control and inverse time feed or feed per revolution are used together, 0: Inverse time feed or feed per revolution is applied during tool center point control. 1: It operates as tool length compensation in tool axis direction.

#5

#7

NOTE For the composite and table rotary types, inverse time feed or feed per revolution is applied during tool center point control regardless of this parameter.
#7 19607 NAG NAG #6 NAA NAA #5 CAV CAV WCD #4 #3 #2 CCC CCC #1 SPG SPG #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #1 SPG To apply 3-dimensional tool compensation to a machine having a table rotation axis, as the G code to be specified: 0: G41.2/G42.2 is used regardless of the machine type. 1: G41.4/G42.4 is used for a table rotation type machine; G41.5/G42.5 for a mixed type machine. CCC In the cutter compensation/tool nose radius compensation mode, the outer corner connection method is based on: 0: Linear connection type. 1: Circular connection type. WCD This parameter specify a direction of compensation vector by a sign of offset value in grinding-wheel wear compensation
Offset vale by D code Minus Bit 3 (WCD) of parameter No. 19607 0 1 Direction from compensation center to command end position. Direction from command end position to compensation center Plus Direction from command end position to compensation center Direction from compensation center to command end position.

#2

#3

- 610 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Z Compensation vector

Tool center path Compensation Center Programmed path

Y
Direction from compensation center to command end position

Compensation Vector

Compensation center

Tool center path

Programmed path

Y
Direction from command end position to compensation center

#5

CAV When an interference check finds that interference (overcutting) occurred: 0: Machining stops with the alarm PS0041. (Interference check alarm function) 1: Machining is continued by changing the tool path to prevent interference (overcutting) from occurring. (Interference check avoidance function) For the interference check method, see the descriptions of bit 1 (CNC) of parameter No. 5008 and bit 3 (CNV) of parameter No. 5008. NAA When the interference check avoidance function considers that an avoidance operation is dangerous or that a further interference to the interference avoidance vector occurs: 0: An alarm is issued. When an avoidance operation is considered to be dangerous, the alarm PS5447 is issued. When a further interference to the interference avoidance vector is considered to occur, the alarm PS5448 is issued. 1: No alarm is issued, and the avoidance operation is continued.

#6

CAUTION When this parameter is set to 1, the path may be shifted largely. Therefore, set this parameter to 0 unless special reasons are present.
#7 NAG If the gap vector length is 0 when the interference check avoidance function for cutter compensation/tool nose radius compensation is used: 0: Avoidance operation is performed. 1: Avoidance operation is not performed.
- 611 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 19608 HEL #6 MIR #5 PRI #4 #3 #2 DET #1 NI5

B-63950EN/04

#0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #1 NI5 The interference check in 3-dimensional cutter compensation is performed by: 0: Projecting a look-ahead command position onto a plane perpendicular to the tool axis direction of a block for which compensation is planned. 1: Projecting a look-ahead command position onto a plane that is always perpendicular to the tool axis direction. When a table rotation axis is present, checking is made in the table coordinate system.

NOTE When 3-dimensional cutter compensation is used, set this parameter to 1 unless special reasons are present.
#2 DET When the programming coordinate system is fastened to the table in tool center point control or 3-dimensional tool compensation, the relative position and absolute position of a specified path are: 0: Displayed in the programming coordinate system (fastened to the table). 1: Displayed in the workpiece coordinate system (not fastened to the table). PRI Among multiple end point candidates that exist when a movement is made on a rotation axis by a command such as I, J, and K when a slanted surface machining command is specified under tool center point control (type 2) or 3-dimensional tool compensation (type 2): 0: A combination in which the master (first rotation axis) makes a smaller angular movement is selected for a machine of tool rotation type or table rotation type. A combination in which the table (second rotation axis) makes a smaller angular movement is selected for a machine of composite type. 1: A combination in which the slave (second rotation axis) makes a smaller angular movement is selected for a machine of tool rotation type or table rotation type. A combination in which the tool (first rotation axis) makes a smaller angular movement is selected for a machine of composite type. MIR When programmable mirror image is applied to a linear axis in tool center point control (type 2) or 3-dimensional tool compensation (type 2), mirror image is: 0: Not applied to a specified I, J, or K command 1: Applied to a specified I, J, or K command. HEL When the tool is tilted toward the forward move direction by a Q command in tool center point control (type 2), a helical interpolation block: 0: Tilts the tool in the direction of the tangent to the arc (at the block end point). 1: Tilts the tool toward the forward move direction involving the helical axis (at the block end point).
#7 19609 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 CCT #0

#5

#6

#7

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path


- 612 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
CCT The cancellation of the G codes in group 08 is: 0: Specified by G49. 1: Able to be specified by G49.1 as well. If G49 is specified when cancellation using G49.1 is set, the G codes of group 08 are canceled.
Number of blocks to be read in the cutter compensation/tool nose radius compensation mode

#1

19625

[Input type] Setting input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 3 to 8 This parameter sets the number of blocks to be read in the cutter compensation/tool nose radius compensation mode. When a value less than 3 is set, the specification of 3 is assumed. When a value greater than 8 is set, the specification of 8 is assumed. As a greater number of blocks are read, an overcutting (interference) forecast can be made with a command farther ahead. However, the number of blocks read and analyzed increases, so that a longer block processing time becomes necessary. Even if the setting of this parameter is modified in the MDI mode by stopping in the cutter compensation/tool nose radius compensation mode, the setting does not become valid immediately. Before the new setting of this parameter can become valid, the cutter compensation/tool noise radius compensation mode must be canceled, then the mode must be entered again.
19630 Limit used to determine a block to make no movement during calculation of the intersection with the tool side face offset (G41.2, G42.2)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999 When the tool side face offset intersection is calculated, if the difference in coordinate value between two points in the compensation plane is smaller than the value set in this parameter, the block is regarded as making no movement. In this case, a look-ahead operation for one further block is performed before the intersection vector is calculated. Normally, set a value around 0.01 mm.
Variation for determining an angle when the leading-edge offset function is performed

19631

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis degree Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999 In the leading-edge offset function is performed, this parameter sets the range of variations applicable when the included angle of the tool direction vector (VT) and the advancing direction vector (VM) is determined to be 0, 180, or 90. For example, let the included angle between VT and VM be (0 180) and the angle set in this parameter be . is then determined as follows: If 0 = 0 (180-)180 = 180
- 613 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
(90-)(90+) Normally, set a value around 1.0.
19632

B-63950EN/04

= 90

Distance from a programmed point (pivot point) to tool center point position (cutting point)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch (input unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999 This parameter sets the distance from a programmed point to the actual cutting point to perform vector calculation for 3-dimensional cutter compensation at the tool center point. When this parameter is set to 0, the tool center point is not supported by the 3-dimensional cutter compensation function.

NOTE This parameter can be rewritten only before the 3-dimensional cutter compensation mode is entered.
19635 Angle used as a criterion for the interference check in 3-dimensional cutter compensation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Setting input Real axis degree Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999 In 3-dimensional cutter compensation, if the difference in angle between two tool direction vectors is equal to or greater than the setting of this parameter, the tool direction is determined to have been changed. When 0 is set, 45 degrees is assumed. Let two tool direction vectors be Va and Vb. Then, if the difference in angle is degrees or greater as shown in the figure below, the tool direction vector is determined to have changed.
Va
degrees

Vb

19636

Angle used to determine whether to execute the interference check/avoidance function of 3-dimensional tool compensation machining

[Input type] Setting input


- 614 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Real path deg Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) The interference check/avoidance function of 3-dimensional tool compensation machining is executed when the angle difference between the tool direction vectors for the target two points is less than the setting. This parameter is valid when bit 1 (NI5) of parameter No. 19608 is set to 1. When the setting is 0, the angle is assumed to be 10.0 degrees.

[Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

4.140
19650

PARAMETERS OF 5-AXIS MACHINING FUNCTION


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 RAP #0 RAM

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #0 RAM For a tool axis direction tool length compensation function, rotation axes are: 0: Not used. 1: Used. Select and set two rotation axes. RAP Rotation axes used for the tool axis direction tool length compensation function are: 0: Ordinary rotation axes. 1: Parameter axes. When 0 is set, absolute coordinates are used as the coordinates of rotation axes in tool axis direction tool length compensation. When 1 is set, the value set in parameter No. 19658 is used as the coordinates of the rotation axes. When there is no rotation axis or only one rotation axis in the controlled axes, set 1 in bits 0 (RAM) and 1 (RAP) of parameter No. 19650 for the linear axes to which non-existent rotation axes belong and set an angular displacement in parameter No. 19658.

#1

[Example 1] There are linear axes X, Y, and Z, and rotation axes A, B, and C which rotate about the X-, Y-, and Z-axes, respectively. The tool axis direction is controlled with the rotation axes A and C.
Bit 0 (RAM) of parameter No. 19650

X Y Z A B C

0 0 0 1 0 1

[Example 2] The controlled axes include only the linear axes X, Y, and Z. By using the tool attachment, the tool axis is tilted in the same tool axis direction as when the A- and C-axes are rotated.
Bit 0 (RAM) of parameter No. 19650 Bit 1 (RAP) of parameter No. 19650 Angular displacement of rotation axis (parameter No. 19658)

X Y Z

1 0 1

1 0 1

45.0 0.0 30.0

- 615 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
19655 Axis number of the linear axis to which a rotation axis belongs

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte axis [Valid data range] 0 to Number to controlled axes Set this parameter to use the tool axis direction tool length compensation function. When a rotation axis rotates about a linear axis, the linear axis is referred to as an axis to which the rotation axis belongs, and is set using this parameter. For a rotation axis that belongs to no linear axis or for a linear axis, set 0. [Example] Axis configuration: X, Y, Z, C, and A Linear axes: X, Y, and Z Rotation axes: A (rotating about the X-axis) and C (rotating about the Z-axis) In the above case, set the following:
Axis number Axis name Setting

1 2 3 4 5
19656

X Z Y C A
Tool axis direction

0 0 0 2 1

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 1 to 3 Enter the tool axis direction when the two rotation axes are set at 0 degrees.
Data Tool axis direction

1 2 3
19657 Master rotation axis number

X-axis Y-axis Z-axis

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to Number to controlled axes When a machine does not have the rotation axis that rotates about the tool axis, this parameter sets the axis number of a rotation axis used as the master axis. For a machine not using the master-axis configuration, set 0. When the tool axis direction is controlled by two rotation axes, neither of which rotates about the tool axis, one of the rotation axes is mounted on the other rotation axis as shown in the figure below. In this case, the rotation axis on which the other rotation axis is mounted is called the master axis.

- 616 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
A- and B-axes (The tool axis is the Z-axis and the B-axis is the master.) Center of rotation

Tool axis direction

Workpiece

A- and B-axes (The tool axis is the Z-axis and the A-axis is the master.) Center of rotation

Tool axis direction

Workpiece

Example of setting parameters that determine the machine configuration Tool axis direction: Z-axis Axis configuration: W, X, Y, Z, A, and B Rotation axes: A-axis (rotating about the X-axis) and B-axis (rotating about the Y-axis) Master axis: A-axis
Parameter number Data

No. 19655 No. 19656 No. 19657


19658

X 0

Y 0

Z 0 3 5

W 0

A 1

B 2

Angular displacement of a rotation axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis deg Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the coordinate of a rotation axis, among the rotation axes determining the tool axis direction, which is not controlled by the CNC for the tool axis direction tool length compensation function. Whether this parameter is valid or invalid is determined by the setting of bit 1 (RAP) of parameter No. 19650.
Offset value for the angular displacement of a rotation axis

19659

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data]

Parameter input Real axis deg Depend on the increment system of the applied axis
- 617 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

[Valid data range] 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) An offset can be applied to the angular displacement for the tool axis direction tool length compensation function to compensate for the move direction.
19660 Origin offset value of a rotation axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis deg Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets an angular displacement shifted from the origin for a rotation axis for the tool axis direction tool length compensation function.
Rotation center compensation vector in tool axis direction tool length compensation

19661

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the vector from the first rotation axis center to the second rotation axis center for the tool axis direction tool length compensation function.
Spindle center compensation vector in tool axis direction tool length compensation

19662

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the compensation vector for the spindle center for the tool axis direction tool length compensation function.
#7 #6 #5 SVC #4 SPR #3 #2 #1 #0

19665

ETH

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #4 SPR The controlled point is shifted by: 0: Automatic calculation. 1: Using parameter No. 19667.
Bit 5 (SVC) of parameter No. 19665 Bit 4 (SPR) of parameter No. 19665

Shift of controlled point

Shift is not performed as not done conventionally.

- 618 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Bit 5 (SVC) of parameter No. 19665 Bit 4 (SPR) of parameter No. 19665 Shift of controlled point

The controlled point is shifted according to the result of the following automatic calculation: - (Intersection offset vector between the tool axis and the first rotation axis of the tool + intersection offset vector between the second and first rotation axes of the tool + tool holder offset (parameter No. 19666)) (See the figure below.) The controlled point is shifted. As the shift vector, the vector set in parameter No. 19667 is used.

Shift of controlled point

First rotary axis of tool

Controlled point

E Second rotary axis of tool D

Controlled-point shift vector

Tool holder offset

Tool length offset

Tool center point

[Controlled-point shift vector when automatically calculated]

#5

SVC The controlled point is: 0: Not shifted. 1: Shifted. The method of shifting is specified by bit 4 (SPR) of parameter No. 19665.

NOTE When the machine has no rotation axis for rotating the tool (when parameter No. 19680 is set to 12 to specify the table rotation type), the controlled point is not shifted regardless of the setting of this parameter.
#7 ETH The tool holder offset function in tool length compensation is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
Tool holder offset value

19666

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999)
- 619 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

When the tool axis direction tool length compensation function, tool tip center rotation handle feed/interrupt, and the display of the tool center point position are performed, specify the offset for the machine-specific section from the rotation center of the rotation axis to the tool mounting position (the tool holder offset value) in tool length compensation during tool center point control and tilted working plane command mode (after G53.1). For the tool axis direction tool length compensation function, the tool holder offset function can be enabled or disabled by setting bit 7 (ETH) of parameter No. 19665.

NOTE Set a radius value.


19667 Controlled-point shift vector

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Set the shift vector for the controlled point. This value becomes valid when bit 5 (SVC) of parameter No. 19665 is set to 1, and bit 4 (SPR) of parameter No. 19665 is set to 1.

NOTE Set a radius value.


19680 Mechanical unit type

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 21 Specify the type of the mechanical unit.
Parameter No. 19680 Mechanical unit type Controlled rotation axis Master and slave

0 2 12 21 Tool rotation type Table rotation type Mixed type

Mechanism having no rotation axis Two rotation axes of the tool Two rotation axes of the table One rotation axis of the tool + one rotation axis of the table

The first rotation axis is the master, and the second rotation axis is the slave. The first rotation axis is the master, and the second rotation axis is the slave. The first rotation axis is the tool rotation axis, and the second rotation axis is the table rotation axis.

- 620 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
First rotary axis (master) Second rotary axis (slave) Tool rotary axes

Second rotary axis (slave) First rotary axis (master) Table rotary axes

NOTE A hypothetical axis is also counted as a controlled rotary axis. <Hypothetical axis> In some cases, it is convenient to use an imaginary rotary axis whose angle is fixed to a certain value. For example, suppose that a tool is mounted in a tilted manner through an attachment. In such a case, the rotary axis considered hypothetically is a hypothetical axis. Bits 0 (IA1) and 1 (IA2) of parameter No. 19696 determine whether each rotary axis is an ordinary rotary axis or a hypothetical axis.
19681 Controlled-axis number for the first rotation axis

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to Number of controlled axes Set the controlled-axis number for the first rotation axis. For a hypothetical axis (when bit 0 (IA1) of parameter No. 19696 is 1), set 0. [Example] Assuming that the axis configuration in path 1 is X,Y,Z,B,C and the axis configuration in path 2 is X,Z,C,Y,B, set the parameter to 5 in path 1 and to 3 in path 2 if C is the first rotation axis in each path.
19682 Axis direction of the first rotation axis

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 6 Specify the axis direction of the first rotation axis. 1: On X-axis 2: On Y-axis 3: On Z-axis 4: On an axis tilted a certain angle from the X-axis from the positive X-axis to positive Y-axis 5: On an axis tilted a certain angle from the Y-axis from the positive Y-axis to positive Z-axis 6: On an axis tilted a certain angle from the Z-axis from the positive Z-axis to positive X-axis (A value 4 to 6 is to be set when the inclined rotation axis control function is used.)

- 621 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Z

B-63950EN/04

2 Y

1 X

Parameter No.19682

19683

Inclination angle when the first rotation axis is an inclined axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path Degree The increment system of the reference axis is to be followed. Nine digits of the least input increment (see standard parameter setting table (A).) (-999999.999 to +999999.999 for IS-B) When a value 1 to 3 is set in parameter No. 19682, set 0 degrees. When a value 4 to 6 is set in parameter No. 19682, specify the inclination angle.
Z

Parameter No.19682

Parameter No.19683
X

19684

Rotation direction of the first rotation axis

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 1 Set the direction in which the first rotation axis rotates as a mechanical motion when a positive move command is issued.
- 622 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
0: Clockwise direction as viewed from the negative to positive direction of the axis specified in parameter No. 19682 (right-hand thread rotation) 1: Counterclockwise direction as viewed from the negative to positive direction of the axis specified in parameter No. 19682 (left-hand thread rotation) Normally, 0 is set for a tool rotation axis, and 1 is set for a table rotation axis.

19685

Rotation angle when the first rotation axis is a hypothetical axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path Degree Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) When the first rotation axis is a hypothetical axis (bit 0 (IA1) of parameter No. 19696 is 1), set the rotation angle.
Controlled-axis number for the second rotation axis

19686

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to Number of controlled axes Set the controlled-axis number for the second rotation axis. For a hypothetical axis (bit 1 (IA2) of parameter No. 19696 is 1), set 0. [Example] Assuming that the axis configuration in path 1 is X,Y,Z,B,C and the axis configuration in path 2 is X,Z,C,Y,B, set the parameter to 4 in path 1 and to 5 in path 2 if B is the second rotation axis in each path.
19687 Axis direction of the second rotation axis

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 6 Specify the axis direction of the second rotation axis. 1: On X-axis 2: On Y-axis 3: On Z-axis 4: On an axis tilted a certain angle from the X-axis from the positive X-axis to positive Y-axis 5: On an axis tilted a certain angle from the Y-axis from the positive Y-axis to positive Z-axis 6: On an axis tilted a certain angle from the Z-axis from the positive Z-axis to positive X-axis (A value 4 to 6 is to be set when the inclined rotation axis control function is used.) When the second rotation axis is the slave axis, the direction when the master axis is at 0 degrees must be set.
19688 Inclination angle when the second rotation axis is inclined

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path Degree Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999)
- 623 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
If parameter No. 19687 is set to a value 1 to 3, set 0 degrees. If parameter No. 19687 is set to a value 4 to 6, set the inclination angle.
19689 Rotation direction of the second rotation axis

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 1 Set the direction in which the second rotation axis rotates as a mechanical motion when a positive move command is issued. 0: Clockwise direction as viewed from the negative to positive direction of the axis specified in parameter No. 19687 (right-hand thread rotation) 1: Counterclockwise direction as viewed from the negative to positive direction of the axis specified in parameter No. 19687 (left-hand thread rotation) Normally, 0 is set for a tool rotation axis, and 1 is set for a table rotation axis.
19690 Rotation angle when the second rotation axis is a hypothetical axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path Degree Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) When the second rotation axis is a hypothetical axis (bit 1 (IA2) of parameter No. 19696 is 1), set the rotation angle.
#7 #6 RFC #5 WKP #4 #3 NPC #2 #1 IA2 #0 IA1

19696

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #0 IA1 0: The first rotation axis is an ordinary rotation axis. 1: The first rotation axis is a hypothetical axis. If IA1 is 1, set 0 as the controlled-axis number for the first rotation axis (parameter No. 19681). Also, set parameter Nos. 19682 to 19685 on the assumption that there is a rotation axis. IA2 0: The second rotation axis is an ordinary rotation axis. 1: The second rotation axis is a hypothetical axis. If IA2 is 1, set 0 as the controlled-axis number for the second rotation axis (parameter No. 19686). Also, set parameter Nos. 19687 to 19690 on the assumption that there is a rotation axis. NPC In tool posture control for tool center point control (type 2), when the change of tool posture at the block end is not done with the parameters Nos. 19738 and 19739, even if the tool posture passes the singular posture, 0: Program is executed without the change of tool posture. 1: The alarm PS5421 occurs. WKP For a 5-axis machine having a table rotation axis, as the programming coordinate system for tool center point control or 3-dimensional tool compensation machining: 0: The table coordinate system (coordinate system fixed on the rotary table) is used. 1: The workpiece coordinate system is used.
- 624 -

#1

#3

#5

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS NOTE For 3-dimensional tool compensation machining, the setting of this parameter is used only when bit 4 (TBP) of parameter No. 19746 is set to 1.

#6

RFC In tool center point control, when a command that does not move the tool center point with respect to the workpiece is issued, the feedrate of the rotation axis is: 0: The maximum cutting feedrate (parameter No. 1422). 1: A specified feedrate.
Reference tool axis direction

19697

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to 3 Set the tool axis direction in the machine coordinate system when the rotation axes for controlling the tool are all at 0 degrees. Also, set the tool axis direction in the machine coordinate system in a mechanism in which only the rotation axes for controlling the table are present (there is no rotation axis for controlling the tool). 1: Positive X-axis direction 2: Positive Y-axis direction 3: Positive Z-axis direction When the reference tool axis direction is neither the X-, Y-, nor Z-axis direction, set the reference direction in this parameter, then set appropriate angles as the reference angle RA and reference angle RB (parameter Nos. 19698 and 19699).
Reference tool axis direction Tool axis direction is positive Z-axis direction. Z

Tool axis direction is positive Y-axis direction.

X Tool axis direction is positive X-axis direction.

19698 19699

Angle when the reference tool axis direction is tilted (reference angle RA) Angle when the reference tool axis direction is tilted (reference angle RB)

[Input type] Parameter input


- 625 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
[Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

B-63950EN/04

Real path Degree Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) When the reference tool axis direction (parameter No. 19697) is set to 1, the tool axis is tilted the RA degrees on the Z-axis from the positive X-axis direction to positive Y-axis direction, then the tool axis is tilted the RB degrees on the X-axis from the positive Y-axis direction to positive Z-axis direction. When the reference tool axis direction (parameter No. 19697) is set to 2, the tool axis is tilted the RA degrees on the X-axis from the positive Y-axis direction to positive Z-axis direction, then the tool axis is tilted the RB degrees on the Y-axis from the positive Z-axis direction to positive X-axis direction. When the reference tool axis direction (parameter No. 19697) is set to 3, the tool axis is tilted the RA degrees on the Y-axis from the positive Z-axis direction to positive X-axis direction, then the tool axis is tilted the RB degrees on the Z-axis from the positive X-axis direction to positive Y-axis direction.
Tool axis direction when the reference tool axis direction is Z-axis Z X Z X Z X

RA

RB

Tool holder offset

Tool length offset

19700 19701 19702

Rotary table position (X-axis of the basic three axes) Rotary table position (Y-axis of the basic three axes) Rotary table position (Z-axis of the basic three axes)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Set these parameters when parameter No. 19680 is set to 12 or 21. The vector from the origin of the machine coordinate system to point A on the first rotation axis of the table is set as the rotary table position in the machine coordinate system.

- 626 -

B-63950EN/04
Rotary table position

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

A First rotary axis of table

Zm Ym Rotary table position Xm

NOTE As point A, set a position that is easy to measure on the first rotary axis of the table. Set a radius value. If the rotary table is moved along the X-, Y-, or Z-axis or all of these axes, set the position of the rotary table when the machine coordinates of the X-, Y-, and Z-axes are all set to 0.
19703 Intersection offset vector between the first and second rotation axes of the table (X-axis of the basic three axes) Intersection offset vector between the first and second rotation axes of the table (Y-axis of the basic three axes) Intersection offset vector between the first and second rotation axes of the table (Z-axis of the basic three axes)

19704

19705

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Set these parameters when the first rotation axis and second rotation axis of the table do not intersect. These parameters are valid when parameter No. 19680 is set to 12. When the rotation axes for controlling the table are all at 0 degrees, the vector from point A to point B on the second rotation axis of the table is set as the intersection offset vector in the machine coordinate system.
When table rotary axes do not intersect Second rotary axis of table

A First rotary axis of table Zm Ym Intersection offset vector between first and second rotary axes of table Xm Rotary table position

- 627 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE As point B, set a position that is easy to measure on the second rotary axis of the table. Set a radius value.
19709 19710 19711 Intersection offset vector between the tool axis and tool rotation axis (X-axis of the basic three axes) Intersection offset vector between the tool axis and tool rotation axis (Y-axis of the basic three axes) Intersection offset vector between the tool axis and tool rotation axis (Z-axis of the basic three axes)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Set these parameters when the tool axis and tool rotation axis do not intersect. These parameters are valid when parameter No. 19680 is set to 2 or 21. If parameter No. 19680 is 21, set the vector from point D on the tool axis to point E determined on the tool rotation axis as the intersection offset vector in the machine coordinate system when the rotation axes for controlling the tool are all at 0 degrees. If parameter No. 19680 is 2, set the vector from point D on the tool axis to point E determined on the second rotation axis of the tool as the intersection offset vector in the machine coordinate system when the rotation axes for controlling the tool are all at 0 degrees.
When tool axis and tool rotary axis do not intersect

Controlled point Intersection offset vector between tool axis and tool rotary axis Tool rotary axis E D Tool holder offset

Tool length offset

Tool center point

NOTE Point D is determined by adding the tool length offset and tool holder offset (parameter No. 19666) to the tool tip. As point E, set a position that is easy to measure. Set a radius value.
19712 Intersection offset vector between the second and first rotation axes of the tool (X-axis of the basic three axes) Intersection offset vector between the second and first rotation axes of the tool (Y-axis of the basic three axes) Intersection offset vector between the second and first rotation axes of the tool (Z-axis of the basic three axes)

19713

19714

- 628 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Parameter input Real path mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) Set these parameters when the rotation axes of the tool do not intersect. These parameters are valid when parameter No. 19680 is set to 2. Set the vector from point E on the second rotation axis of the tool to point F on the first rotation axis of the tool as the intersection offset vector in the machine coordinate system when the rotation axes for controlling the tool are all at 0 degrees.

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

When tool axis and tool rotary axis do not intersect

First rotary axis of tool

Controlled point Intersection offset vector between second and first rotary axes of tool

E Second rotary axis of tool D

Intersection offset vector between tool axis and second rotary axis of tool

Tool holder offset

Tool length offset

Tool center point

NOTE As point F, set a position that is easy to measure. Set a radius value.
19738 Angle to check if Tool posture is near Singular posture or not

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path degree Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) In the case of tool posture control for tool center point control (type 2), when the difference(angle) between a tool posture and the singular posture is less than this parameter, the tool posture is regarded as near the singular posture. Then, the tool posture at the block end is changed so that the tool posture passes the singular posture during the block. If this parameter is 0.0, the tool posture at the block end is not changed.
Angle to decide that the tool posture at block end is not changed

19739

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data]

Parameter input Real path degree Depend on the increment system of the reference axis
- 629 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

[Valid data range] 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table(A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) When an appropriate value is set in parameter No. 19738 in tool posture control for tool center point control (type 2), a tool posture near the singular point may occur during the execution of a block. If this happens, change the tool posture at the end point so that the singular posture is passed within the block. With respect to the angle of the rotation axis nearer to the workpiece before and after the tool posture is changed (the rotation axis is the master axis when the tool turns, the slave axis when the table turns, or the table rotation axis when the rotation is of the mixed type), however, the tool posture must not be changed if both the difference between the angle after the change and (angle before the change + 180 degrees) and the difference between the angle after the change and (angle before the change 180 degrees) are equal to or greater than the value set in the parameter.
19741 Upper limit of the movement range of the first rotation axis

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path Degree Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the upper limit of the movement range of the first rotation axis in tool center point control (type 2), 3-dimensional cutter compensation (type 2), or tool axis direction control of the tilted working plane command (G53.1). When the movement range of the first rotation axis is not specified, this parameter and parameter No. 19742 must both be set to 0.
Lower limit of the movement range of the first rotation axis

19742

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path Degree Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the lower limit of the movement range of the first rotation axis in tool center point control (type 2), 3-dimensional cutter compensation (type 2), or tool axis direction control of the tilted working plane command (G53.1). When the movement range of the first rotation axis is not specified, this parameter and parameter No. 19741 must both be set to 0.
Upper limit of the movement range of the second rotation axis

19743

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path Degree Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the upper limit of the movement range of the second rotation axis in tool center point control (type 2), 3-dimensional cutter compensation (type 2), or tool axis direction control of the tilted working plane command (G53.1). When the movement range of the second rotation axis is not specified, this parameter and parameter No. 19744 must both be set to 0.
- 630 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Lower limit of the movement range of the second rotation axis

19744

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path Degree Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the lower limit of the movement range of the second rotation axis in tool center point control (type 2), 3-dimensional cutter compensation (type 2), or tool axis direction control of the tilted working plane command (G53.1). When the movement range of the second rotation axis is not specified, this parameter and parameter No. 19743 must both be set to 0.
#7 #6 CRS #5 #4 TBP #3 LOZ #2 LOD #1 PTD #0

19746

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #1 PTD When 3-dimensional cutter compensation is performed for a table rotation type machine, the direction of the tool is: 0: Specified by parameter Nos. 19697, 19698, and 19699. 1: Specified as a direction perpendicular to the plane specified by G17, G18, or G19. LOD As the tool length for 3-dimensional machining manual feed: 0: The value of parameter No. 12318 is used. 1: The tool length currently used for tool length compensation is used. LOZ When bit 2 (LOD) of parameter No. 19746 is set to 1 and tool length compensation is not applied, as the tool length for 3-dimensional machining manual feed: 0: The value of parameter No. 12318 is used. 1: 0 is used. TBP For a 5-axis machine having a table rotation axis, as the programming coordinate system for 3-dimensional tool compensation machining: 0: The workpiece coordinate system is used. 1: The setting of bit 5 (WKP) of parameter No. 19696 is used. CRS In tool center point control, when the deviation from the path during movement at the specified cutting feedrate or rapid traverse rate is determined to exceed the limit: 0: The feedrate or rapid traverse rate is not decreased. 1: The feedrate or rapid traverse rate is controlled so that the limit of the deviation from the path set in the parameter for the cutting feed or rapid traverse is not exceeded. When this parameter is set to 1: In the rapid traverse mode, the rapid traverse rate is decreased so that the deviation from the path does not exceed the limit specified in parameter No. 19751. In the cutting feed mode, the cutting feedrate is decreased so that the deviation from the path does not exceed the limit specified in parameter No. 19752.
Limit of the deviation from the path (for rapid traverse)

#2

#3

#4

#6

19751

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Real path


- 631 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

[Unit of data] mm, inch (machine unit) [Min. unit of data] Depend on the increment system of the reference axis [Valid data range] 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the limit of the deviation from the path in the rapid traverse mode in tool center point control. If the tool moves at the specified rate, the deviation from the path may exceed the value specified in this parameter. In this case, the rate is decreased so that the tool moves along the path. This parameter is valid when bit 6 (CRS) of parameter No. 19746 is set to 1. When 0 is set, the least input increment is assumed to be the limit of the deviation from the path. If a negative value is set, the rapid traverse rate is not decreased.

NOTE The error generated after the rate is decreased may be smaller than the value set in this parameter depending on the calculation error.
19752 Limit of the deviation from the path (for cutting feed)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm, inch (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) This parameter sets the limit of the deviation from the path in the cutting feed mode in tool center point control. If the tool moves at the specified rate, the deviation from the path may exceed the value specified in this parameter. In this case, the rate is decreased so that the tool moves along the path. This parameter is valid when bit 6 (CRS) of parameter No. 19746 is set to 1. When 0 is set, the least input increment is assumed to be the limit of the deviation from the path. If a negative value is set, the cutting feedrate is not decreased.

NOTE The error generated after the rate is decreased may be smaller than the value set in this parameter depending on the calculation error.
#7 19754 SPM #6 #5 INZ #4 TCR #3 TAR #2 #1 #0

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit axis #3 TAR In the deceleration function using acceleration in AI contour control, permissible acceleration parameter No. 19762 and lower limit speed parameter No. 19760 for rapid traverse in tool center point control are: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled.
- 632 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
TCR In speed determination using the speed difference at a corner in AI contour control, permissible speed difference parameter No. 19761 for rapid traverse in tool center point control is: 0: Disabled. 1: Enabled. INZ If, in tool center point control and 3-dimensional cutter compensation, a table coordinate system command is issued, 0: In the state in which each function is started, the workpiece coordinate system is fixed to the rotary table, and becomes a table coordinate system. 1: Regardless of the table rotation axis position when each function is started, the workpiece table is fixed to the rotary table, with the table rotation axis position being 0, and becomes a table coordinate system. SPM The rotation axis position used as the reference when the parameters related to the functions below, parameters Nos. 19681 to 19714, are set is: 0: Absolute coordinates. 1: Machine coordinates This parameter is effective to the functions below. Tool center point control Smooth TCP Tool posture control 3-dimensional tool compensation Cutting point command Workpiece setting error compensation Tilted working plane command Tilted working plane command with guidance

#4

#5

#7

19760

Lower limit speed for the deceleration function using the acceleration in AI contour control (for rapid traverse in tool center point control)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the reference axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +240000.0) The deceleration function using the acceleration in AI contour control automatically calculates an optimum speed according to the geometry. Depending on the geometry, the calculated speed may be very low. In such cases, to prevent the feedrate from becoming too low, in rapid traverse in tool center point control, this parameter can be used to set the lower limit speed for deceleration. For this parameter to take effect, bit 3 (TAR) of parameter No. 19754 must be set to 1. If bit 3 (TAR) of parameter No. 19754 is set to 0, parameter No. 1738 becomes effective. Note that for linear interpolation, parameter No. 1738 becomes effective, while for circular interpolation, parameter No. 1732 becomes effective.
Permissible speed difference in speed determination using the speed difference at a corner (for rapid traverse in tool center point control)

19761

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Real axis [Unit of data] mm/min, inch/min, degree/min (machine unit)
- 633 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

[Min. unit of data] Depend on the increment system of the applied axis [Valid data range] Refer to the standard parameter setting table (C) (When the increment system is IS-B, 0.0 to +240000.0) If, in rapid traverse during tool center point control, speed determination using the speed difference at a corner is used, and the changes in the speed component on each axis exceeds the setting of this parameter at a block joint, a feedrate that does not exceed the setting is determined, and deceleration is performed using acceleration/deceleration before interpolation. This can reduce the shock to the machine at a corner, as well a machining errors. For this parameter to take effect, bit 4 (TCR) of parameter No. 19754 must be set to 1. If bit 4 (TCR) of parameter No. 19754 is set to 0, parameter No. 1783 becomes effective. When bit 4 (TCR) of parameter No. 19754 is set to 1, for any axes for which 0 is set for this parameter, speed determination using the speed difference at a corner is disabled in rapid traverse during tool center point control.
19762 Permissible acceleration for each axis in the deceleration function using the acceleration in AI contour control (for rapid traverse in tool center point control)

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real axis mm/sec/sec, inch/sec/sec, degree/sec/sec (machine unit) Depend on the increment system of the applied axis Refer to the standard parameter setting table (D) (For a millimeter machine, 0.0 to +100000.0, for an inch machine, 0.0 to +10000.0) This parameter sets the permissible value of the acceleration that will occur due to changes in the direction of movement along the linear axis in rapid traverse during tool center point control. For this parameter to take effect, bit 3 (TAR) of parameter No. 19754 must be set to 1. If bit 3 (TAR) of parameter No. 19754 is set to 0, parameter No. 1737 becomes effective. When bit 3 (TAR) of parameter No. 19754 is set to 1, for any axes for which 0 is set for this parameter, the deceleration function using the acceleration is disabled in rapid traverse during tool center point control. Note that for linear interpolation, parameter No. 1737 becomes effective, while for circular interpolation, parameter No. 1735 becomes effective.

4.141
24901 to 24920

PARAMETERS OF GRAPHIC DISPLAY (4 OF 5)


Operation history signal selection PMC path number (No. 01) to Operation history signal selection PMC path number (No. 20)

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte [Valid data range] 0 to 3 These parameters set operation history signal selection PMC path numbers Nos. 1 to 20. The correspondence between PMC path numbers and settings is as given in the table below.
PMC path number Not selected. 1st PMC 2nd PMC 3rd PMC Parameter value 0 1 2 3

Nos. 1 to 20 correspond to Nos. 1 to 20 on the operation history signal selection screen. These parameters are paired with other parameters as given below.
- 634 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
No. 01 02 03 20 PMC path number No. 24901 No. 24902 No. 24903 Address type No. 12801 No. 12802 No. 12803 No. 12820 Address number No. 12841 No. 12842 No. 12843 No. 12860 Bit number No. 12881 No. 12882 No. 12883 No. 12900

No. 24920

NOTE 1 Operation history signals that can be selected and deselected with parameters are for the first 20 of 60 sets. If an operation history signal is specified from the operation history signal selection screen, the PMC path number is fixed at the first PMC. 2 To deselect a signal, set 0. At this time, 0 is set as the initial value in the address type (Nos. 12801 to 12820), the address number (Nos. 12841 to 12860), and the bit number (Nos. 12881 to 12900) corresponding to that signal. 3 When a PMC path number is set, 1 is set as the initial value in the address type (Nos. 12801 to 12820) corresponding to that signal, and 0 is set as the initial value in the address number (Nos. 12841 to 12860) and the bit number (Nos. 12881 to 12900). [Example] If parameter No. 24901 is set to 1, the parameters are initialized as follows: No. 12801=1 Address type No. 12841=0 Address number No. 12881=00000000 Bit number If, however, the address type (Nos. 12801 to 12820) corresponding to that signal is set, the address type (Nos. 12801 to 12820), the address number (Nos. 12841 to 12860), and the bit number (Nos. 12881 to 12900) will not be initialized. 4 If an attempt is made to set a value that cannot be set, a warning, "DATA IS OUT OF RANGE" appears; retry setting a value.

4.142

PARAMETERS OF SPINDLE UNIT COMPENSATION AND NUTATING ROTARY HEAD TOOL LENGTH COMPENSATION
#7 #6 SU2 #5 #4 #3 NCV #2 SCV #1 #0 SU3

25860

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit path #2 SCV At power-on, a spindle unit compensation vector is: 0: Not calculated. 1: Calculated.

- 635 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

NOTE This parameter is effective in the case of either of the following settings: Bit 6 (CLR) of parameter No. 3402 = 0 Bit 6 (CLR) of parameter No. 3402 = 1 and bit 3 (C27) of parameter No. 3409 = 1
#3 NCV At power-on, an nutating rotary head tool length compensation vector is: 0: Not calculated. 1: Calculated.

NOTE This parameter is effective in the case of either of the following settings: Bit 6 (CLR) of parameter No. 3402 = 0 Bit 6 (CLR) of parameter No. 3402 = 1, bit 0 (C08) of parameter No. 3407 = 1, and bit 7 (CFH) of parameter No. 3409 = 1
#6 SU2 In absolute coordinate display and in relative position display, the spindle unit compensation vector is: 0: Included. 1: Not included. SU3 On the spindle unit compensation/nutating rotary head tool length compensation screens, parameter input is: 0: Prohibited. 1: Permitted.
Rotation axis for performing spindle unit compensation/tool length compensation (1st set) Linear axis 1 for performing spindle unit compensation/tool length compensation (1st set) Linear axis 2 for performing spindle unit compensation/tool length compensation (1st set) Linear axis 3 for performing spindle unit compensation/tool length compensation (1st set) Rotation axis for performing spindle unit compensation/tool length compensation (2nd set) Linear axis 1 for performing spindle unit compensation/tool length compensation (2nd set) Linear axis 2 for performing spindle unit compensation/tool length compensation (2nd set) Linear axis 3 for performing spindle unit compensation/tool length compensation (2nd set)

#7

25861 25862 25863 25864 25866 25867 25868 25869

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Byte path [Valid data range] 0 to Number of controlled axes These parameters set the rotation axes and linear axes for performing spindle unit compensation/nutating rotary head tool length compensation.
25865 Inclination of the rotation axis for performing spindle unit compensation/tool length compensation (1st set) Inclination of the rotation axis for performing spindle unit compensation/tool length compensation (2nd set)

25870

- 636 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Parameter input Real path Depend on the increment system of the reference axis -360.0 to 360.0 These parameters set the inclinations of the rotation axes for performing spindle unit compensation/nutating rotary head tool length compensation.
Component on linear axis 1 of the V2 vector for performing spindle unit compensation Component on linear axis 2 of the V2 vector for performing spindle unit compensation Component on linear axis 3 of the V2 vector for performing spindle unit compensation Component on linear axis 1 of the V1 vector for performing spindle unit compensation Component on linear axis 2 of the V1 vector for performing spindle unit compensation Component on linear axis 3 of the V1 vector for performing spindle unit compensation Component on linear axis 1 of the V0 vector for performing spindle unit compensation Component on linear axis 2 of the V0 vector for performing spindle unit compensation Component on linear axis 3 of the V0 vector for performing spindle unit compensation

[Input type] [Data type] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

25871 25872 25873 25874 25875 25876 25877 25878 25879

[Input type] [Data type] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path Depend on the increment system of the reference axis 9 digit of minimum unit of data (refer to standard parameter setting table (A)) (When the increment system is IS-B, -999999.999 to +999999.999) These parameters set the V2, V1, and V0 vectors for performing spindle unit compensation.
Reference angle of the rotation axis for performing spindle unit compensation (1st set) Reference angle of the rotation axis for performing spindle unit compensation (2nd set) Compensation amount of the rotation axis for performing spindle unit compensation (1st set) Compensation amount of the rotation axis for performing spindle unit compensation (2nd set)

25880 25881 25882 25883

[Input type] [Data type] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path Depend on the increment system of the reference axis -360.0 to 360.0 These parameters set the reference angles and compensation amount for performing spindle unit compensation.
Reference angle of the rotation axis for performing nutating rotary head tool length compensation (1st set) Reference angle of the rotation axis for performing nutating rotary head tool length compensation (2nd set)

25884

25885

[Input type] [Data type] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path Depend on the increment system of the reference axis -360.0 to 360.0
- 637 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

B-63950EN/04

These parameters set the reference angles for the rotation axes for performing nutating rotary head tool length compensation.
25886 25887 Reference angle (RA) of the tool axis on the plane of linear axes 2-3 Reference angle (RB) of the tool axis on the plane of linear axes 3-1

[Input type] [Data type] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path Depend on the increment system of the reference axis -360.0 to 360.0 These parameters set the direction of the rotation axis for performing nutating rotary head tool length compensation, using two angles RA and RB.
Compensation amount of the tilt angle of the rotation axis

25888

[Input type] [Data type] [Min. unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input Real path Depend on the increment system of the reference axis -360.0 to 360.0 This parameter sets the compensation amount of the tilt angle of the rotation axis when the spindle unit is of NUTATOR TYPE.

4.143
27350

PARAMETERS OF GRAPHIC DISPLAY (5 OF 5)


#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 GTP

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 GTP When a general-purpose tool is drawn in animated simulation, the tip is: 0: Positioned on the front. 1: Positioned on the rear.

Holder Tip Front Rear

Holder

27351

Cutting edge length applied when a general-purpose tool is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the cutting edge length applied when a general-purpose tool is drawn in animated simulation.
- 638 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

Holder Tip

Cutting edge length

When 0 is set, 12 mm for metric input or 0.4724 inch for inch input is assumed.
27352 Holder length applied when a general-purpose tool is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the holder length applied when a general-purpose tool is drawn in animated simulation.

Holder Holder length Tip

When 0 is set, 50 mm for metric input or 1.9685 inch for inch input is assumed.
27353 Holder width applied when a general-purpose tool is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the holder width applied when a general-purpose tool is drawn in animated simulation.

Holder Tip

Holder width

When 0 is set, 14 mm for metric input or 0.5512 inch for inch input is assumed.
- 639 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
27354

B-63950EN/04

Holder length 2 applied when a general-purpose tool is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the holder length 2 applied when a general-purpose tool is drawn in animated simulation.

Holder Tip

Holder length 2

27355

Holder width 2 applied when a general-purpose tool is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the holder width 2 applied when a general-purpose tool is drawn in animated simulation.

Holder Holder width 2

Tip Holder width

#7 27356

#6

#5

#4

#3

#2

#1

#0 TTP

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 TTP When a threading tool is drawn in animated simulation, the tip is: 0: Positioned on the front. 1: Positioned on the rear.

- 640 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

Holder Tip

Holder

Front

Rear

27357

Cutting edge width applied when a threading tool is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the cutting edge width applied when a threading tool is drawn in animated simulation.

Holder

Tip Cutting edge width

When 0 is set, 3 mm for metric input or 0.11811 inch for inch input is assumed.
27358 Holder length applied when a threading tool is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the holder length applied when a threading tool is drawn in animated simulation.

Holder Holder length

Tip

When 0 is set, 50 mm for metric input or 1.9685 inch for inch input is assumed.

- 641 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
27359 Holder width applied when a threading tool is drawn in animated simulation

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the holder width applied when a threading tool is drawn in animated simulation.

Holder

Tip Holder width

When 0 is set, 14 mm for metric input or 0.5512 inch for inch input is assumed.
#7 27360 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 GVP

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 GVP When a groove cutting tool is drawn in animated simulation, the tip is: 0: Positioned on the front. 1: Positioned on the rear.

Holder Tip

Holder

Front

Rear

27361

Holder length applied when a groove cutting tool is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the holder length applied when a groove cutting tool is drawn in animated simulation.

- 642 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

Holder Holder length

Tip

When 0 is set, 50 mm for metric input or 1.9685 inch for inch input is assumed.
27362 Holder width applied when a groove cutting tool is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the holder width applied when a groove cutting tool is drawn in animated simulation.

Holder

Tip Holder width

When 0 is set, 14 mm for metric input or 0.5512 inch for inch input is assumed.
#7 27363 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 BTP

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 BTP When a round-nose tool is drawn in animated simulation, the tip is: 0: Positioned on the front. 1: Positioned on the rear.

Holder Tip

Holder

Front

Rear

- 643 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
27364

B-63950EN/04

Holder length applied when a round-nose tool is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the holder length applied when a round-nose tool is drawn in animated simulation.

Holder Holder length

Tip

When 0 is set, 50 mm for metric input or 1.9685 inch for inch input is assumed.
27365 Holder width applied when a round-nose tool is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the holder width applied when a round-nose tool is drawn in animated simulation.

Holder

Tip Holder width

When 0 is set, 14 mm for metric input or 0.5512 inch for inch input is assumed.
#7 27366 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0 STP

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 STP When a point nose straight tool is drawn in animated simulation, the tip is: 0: Positioned on the front. 1: Positioned on the rear.

- 644 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

Holder Tip

Holder

Front

Rear

27367

Cutting edge length applied when a point nose straight tool is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the cutting edge length applied when a point nose straight tool is drawn in animated simulation.

Holder

Tip Cutting edge length

When 0 is set, 12 mm for metric input or 0.4724 inch for inch input is assumed.
27368 Holder length applied when a point nose straight tool is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the holder length applied when a point nose straight tool is drawn in animated simulation.

Holder Holder length

Tip

When 0 is set, 50 mm for metric input or 1.9685 inch for inch input is assumed.

- 645 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
27369

B-63950EN/04

Holder width applied when a point nose straight tool is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the holder width applied when a point nose straight tool is drawn in animated simulation.

Holder

Tip Holder width

When 0 is set, 14 mm for metric input or 0.5512 inch for inch input is assumed.
27370 Holder length 2 applied when a point nose straight tool is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the holder length 2 applied when a point nose straight tool is drawn in animated simulation.

Holder Tip Holder length 2

27371

Holder width 2 applied when a point nose straight tool is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the holder width 2 applied when a point nose straight tool is drawn in animated simulation.

- 646 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Holder Holder width 2

Tip Holder width


27372 Length of cut applied when a drill tool is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the length of cut applied when a drill tool is drawn in animated simulation.

Length of cut

When 0 is set, 50 mm for metric input or 1.9685 inch for inch input is assumed.
27373 Length of cut applied when a flat end milling cutter is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the length of cut applied when a flat end milling cutter is drawn in animated simulation.

Length of cut

When 0 is set, 50 mm for metric input or 1.9685 inch for inch input is assumed.

- 647 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
27374 Length of cut applied when a tapping tool is drawn in animated simulation

B-63950EN/04

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the length of cut applied when a tapping tool is drawn in animated simulation.

Length of cut

When 0 is set, 50 mm for metric input or 1.9685 inch for inch input is assumed.
27375 Included angle applied when a chamfering tool is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word degree 0 to 90 This parameter sets the included angle applied when a a chamfering tool is drawn in animated simulation.

Included angle

27376

Length of cut applied when a chamfering tool is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the length of cut applied when a chamfering tool is drawn in animated simulation.

- 648 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

Length of cut

When 0 is set, 26 mm for metric input or 1.0236 inch for inch input is assumed.
27377 Cutter length applied when a chamfering tool is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the cutter length applied when a chamfering tool is drawn in animated simulation.

Cutter length

When 0 is set, 50 mm for metric input or 1.9685 inch for inch input is assumed.
27378 Shank length applied when a chamfering tool is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the shank length applied when a chamfering tool is drawn in animated simulation.

Shank length

When 0 is set, 130 mm for metric input or 5.1181 inch for inch input is assumed.
- 649 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
27379

B-63950EN/04

Shank diameter applied when a chamfering tool is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the shank diameter applied when a chamfering tool is drawn in animated simulation.
Shank diameter

When 0 is set, 32 mm for metric input or 1.2598 inch for inch input is assumed.
27380 Length of cut applied when a ball end mill is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the length of cut applied when a ball end mill is drawn in animated simulation.

Length of cut

When 0 is set, 50 mm for metric input or 1.9685 inch for inch input is assumed.
27381 Length of cut applied when a reamer is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the length of cut applied when a reamer is drawn in animated simulation.

- 650 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

Length of cut

When 0 is set, 50 mm for metric input or 1.9685 inch for inch input is assumed.
27382 Length of cut applied when a boring tool is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the length of cut applied when a boring tool is drawn in animated simulation.

Length of cut

When 0 is set, 50 mm for metric input or 1.9685 inch for inch input is assumed.
27383 Length of cut applied when a face milling cutter is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the length of cut applied when a face milling cutter is drawn in animated simulation.

Length of cut

When 0 is set, 63 mm for metric input or 2.4803 inch for inch input is assumed.
- 651 -

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 27384 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1

B-63950EN/04 #0 VRP

[Input type] Parameter input [Data type] Bit #0 VRP When a multifunction tool is drawn in animated simulation, the tip is: 0: Positioned on the front. 1: Positioned on the rear.

Holder Tip

Holder

Front

Rear

27385

Holder length applied when a multifunction tool is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the holder length applied when a multifunction tool is drawn in animated simulation.

Holder Holder length

Tip

When 0 is set, 50 mm for metric input or 1.9685 inch for inch input is assumed.
27386 Holder width applied when a multifunction tool is drawn in animated simulation

[Input type] [Data type] [Unit of data] [Valid data range]

Parameter input 2-word 0.001mm (metric input), 0.0001inch (inch input) 0 or larger This parameter sets the holder width applied when a multifunction tool is drawn in animated simulation.

- 652 -

B-63950EN/04

4.DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS

Holder

Tip Holder width

When 0 is set, 14 mm for metric input or 0.5512 inch for inch input is assumed.

- 653 -

APPENDIX

B-63950EN/04

APPENDIX

A.CHARACTER CODE LIST

A
Character A B C D E F G H I J K L M N O P Q R S T U V W X Y Z 0 1 2 3 4 5

CHARACTER CODE LIST


Code 065 066 067 068 069 070 071 072 073 074 075 076 077 078 079 080 081 082 083 084 085 086 087 088 089 090 048 049 050 051 052 053 Comment Character 6 7 8 9 ! # $ % & ( ) * + , . / : ; < = > ? @ [ ] _ Code 054 055 056 057 032 033 034 035 036 037 038 039 040 041 042 043 044 045 046 047 058 059 060 061 062 063 064 091 094 092 093 095 Comment

Space Exclamation mark Quotation marks Sharp Dollar mark Percent Ampersand Apostrophe Left parenthesis Right parenthesis Asterisk Positive sign Comma Negative sign Period Slash Colon Semicolon Left angle bracket Equal sign Right angle bracket Question mark Commercial at mark Left square bracket Yen mark Right square bracket Underline

- 657 -

B-63950EN/04

INDEX

INDEX
<Number>
3-DIMENSIONAL ERROR COMPENSATION.........454 3-DIMENSIONAL MACHINE POSITION COMPENSATION.......................................................456 5-AXIS MACHINING FUNCTION ............................615 DEFINITION OF WARNING, CAUTION, AND NOTE ............................................................................s-1 DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS.............................15 DI/DO (1 OF 2) ............................................................126 DI/DO (2 OF 2) ............................................................472 DISPLAY AND EDIT (1 OF 5)...................................136 DISPLAY AND EDIT (2 OF 5)...................................479 DISPLAY AND EDIT (3 OF 5)...................................486 DISPLAY AND EDIT (4 OF 5)...................................492 DISPLAY AND EDIT (5 OF 5)...................................533 DISPLAYING PARAMETERS.......................................1 DUAL CHECK SAFETY (1 OF 2)..............................453 DUAL CHECK SAFETY (2 OF 2)..............................567

<A>
ACCELERATION/DECELERATION CONTROL ......75 AI CONTOUR CONTROL (1 OF 2) ...........................428 AI CONTOUR CONTROL (2 OF 2) ...........................603 ANGULAR AXIS CONTROL ....................................415 AUTOMATIC DATA BACKUP.................................448 AXIS CONTROL.........................................................449 AXIS CONTROL BY PMC (1 OF 3) ..........................387 AXIS CONTROL BY PMC (2 OF 3) ..........................509 AXIS CONTROL BY PMC (3 OF 3) ..........................529 AXIS CONTROL/INCREMENT SYSTEM (1 OF 3) ...33 AXIS CONTROL/INCREMENT SYSTEM (2 OF 3) .472 AXIS CONTROL/INCREMENT SYSTEM (3 OF 3) .568 AXIS SWITCHING .....................................................451 AXIS SYNCHRONOUS CONTROL ..........................417

<E>
EMBEDDED ETHERNET ..........................................581 EMBEDDED MACRO (1 OF 2)..................................485 EMBEDDED MACRO (2 OF 2)..................................518 ETHERNET/DATA SERVER FUNCTIONS................27 EXPONENTIAL INTERPOLATION..........................285 EXTERNAL DATA INPUT/OUTPUT .......................324 EXTERNAL DECELERATION POSITIONS EXPANSION ...............................................................531

<B>
Bit Axis Format................................................................8 Bit Format ........................................................................7 Bit Machine Group Format ..............................................7 Bit Path Format ................................................................8 Bit Spindle Format ...........................................................9 Byte/Word/Two-Word Axis Format ..............................10 Byte/Word/Two-Word Format.........................................9 Byte/Word/Two-Word Machine Group Format...............9 Byte/Word/Two-Word Path Format...............................10 Byte/Word/Two-Word Spindle Format..........................11

<F>
FEEDRATE ...................................................................61 FEEDRATE CONTROL AND ACCELERATION/DECELERATION CONTROL ....473 FINE TORQUE SENSING ..........................................327 FLEXIBLE SYNCHRONOUS CONTROL (1 OF 2) ..286 FLEXIBLE SYNCHRONOUS CONTROL (2 OF 2) ..554 FSSB ............................................................................572

<G>
GRAPHIC DISPLAY (1 OF 5) ....................................333 GRAPHIC DISPLAY (2 OF 5) ....................................488 GRAPHIC DISPLAY (3 OF 5) ....................................579 GRAPHIC DISPLAY (4 OF 5) ....................................634 GRAPHIC DISPLAY (5 OF 5) ....................................638

<C>
Canned Cycle for Drilling (1 of 2) ...............................245 Canned Cycle for Drilling (2 of 2) ...............................256 Canned Cycle for Grinding (for Grinding Machine)....261 CANNED CYCLES.....................................................245 CANNED CYCLES FOR DRILLING M CODE OUTPUT IMPROVEMENT ........................................559 Channel 1 (I/O CHANNEL=0) ......................................24 Channel 1 (I/O CHANNEL=1) ......................................25 Channel 2 (I/O CHANNEL=2) ......................................26 CHARACTER CODE LIST ........................................657 CHOPPING..................................................................426 CNC SCREEN DISPLAY FUNCTIONS ......................26 Common to All Channels...............................................21 COORDINATE SYSTEM (1 OF 2)...............................44 COORDINATE SYSTEM (2 OF 2).............................477 CUSTOM MACROS ...................................................294 CYLINDRICAL INTERPOLATION ..........................604

<H>
HIGH-SPEED CYCLE CUTTING ..............................362 HIGH-SPEED POSITION SWITCH (1 OF 2).............431 HIGH-SPEED POSITION SWITCH (2 OF 2).............520

<I>
I/O FORMATS.................................................................6 Inch/Metric Switching......................................................7 INCLINATION COMPENSATION ............................292 INDEX TABLE INDEXING .......................................282 INPUTTING AND OUTPUTTING PARAMETERS THROUGH THE READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE...4 INPUTTING PARAMETERS THROUGH THE READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE ...............................5 INTERFERENCE CHECK BETWEEN PATHS.........398 INVOLUTE INTERPOLATION .................................285

<D>
DATA TYPE..................................................................15

i-1

INDEX
<K>
Keywords .........................................................................6

B-63950EN/04

<R>
READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE .............................21 Real Number Axis Format .............................................13 Real Number Format ......................................................11 Real Number Machine Group Format ............................12 Real Number Path Format..............................................12 Real Number Spindle Format.........................................13 REFERENCE POSITION WITH MECHANICAL STOPPER.....................................................................357 REPRESENTATION OF PARAMETERS ....................16 RIGID TAPPING.........................................................264 ROTARY TABLE DYNAMIC FIXTURE OFFSET...370 ROTATION AREA INTERFERENCE CHECK (1 OF 2)........................................................................458 ROTATION AREA INTERFERENCE CHECK (2 OF 2)........................................................................583 RUN HOUR AND PARTS COUNT DISPLAY ..........336

<L>
LINEAR INCLINATION COMPENSATION FUNCTION .................................................................470 LINEAR SCALE WITH ABSOLUTE ADDRESS REFERENCE POSITION............................................568

<M>
MACHINING QUALITY LEVEL ADJUSTMENT....505 MAINTENANCE ........................................................440 MALFUNCTION PROTECTION ...............................521 MANUAL HANDLE (1 OF 2) ....................................352 MANUAL HANDLE (2 OF 2) ....................................521 MANUAL HANDLE RETRACE (1 OF 2) .................328 MANUAL HANDLE RETRACE (2 OF 2) .................601 MANUAL LINER/CIRCULAR INTERPOLATION ..558 MANUAL OPERATION AND AUTOMATIC OPERATION ...............................................................350 MULTI-PATH CONTROL..........................................395 Multiple Repetitive Canned Cycle ...............................252

<S>
SCALING/COORDINATE ROTATION.....................276 SCREEN DISPLAY COLORS (1 OF 2)......................335 SCREEN DISPLAY COLORS (2 OF 2)......................451 SEQUENCE NUMBER COMPARISON AND STOP 425 SERVO (1 OF 2) ............................................................90 SERVO (2 OF 2) ..........................................................508 SERVO GUIDE Mate ..................................................579 SETTING .......................................................................18 SETTING PARAMETERS FROM MDI .........................2 SINGLE DIRECTION POSITIONING .......................278 SKIP FUNCTION ........................................................314 SMOOTH TCP.............................................................452 SOFTWARE OPERATOR'S PANEL..........................358 SPINDLE CONTROL..................................................188 SPINDLE CONTROL WITH SERVO MOTOR .........463 SPINDLE UNIT COMPENSATION AND NUTATING ROTARY HEAD TOOL LENGTH COMPENSATION.......................................................635 STANDARD PARAMETER SETTING TABLES........17 Start and End of a Record ..............................................14 STORED STROKE CHECK .........................................51 STRAIGHTNESS COMPENSATION (1 OF 2)..........289 STRAIGHTNESS COMPENSATION (2 OF 2)..........553 SYNCHRONOUS/COMPOSITE CONTROL AND SUPERIMPOSED CONTROL (1 OF 3)......................402 SYNCHRONOUS/COMPOSITE CONTROL AND SUPERIMPOSED CONTROL (2 OF 3)......................478 SYNCHRONOUS/COMPOSITE CONTROL AND SUPERIMPOSED CONTROL (3 OF 3)......................528 SYSTEM CONFIGURATION.......................................30

<N>
NANO SMOOTHING .................................................608 NORMAL DIRECTION CONTROL ..........................280

<O>
OPTIMAL TORQUE ACCELERATION/DECELERATION ........................606 OPTIMUM TORQUE ACCELERATION/DECELERATION FOR RIGID TAPPING.....................................................................498 OTHER PARAMETERS .............................................435 OUTPUTTING PARAMETERS THROUGH THE READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE ...............................4

<P>
PARALLEL AXIS CONTROL ...................................450 PARAMETER CHECK SUM FUNCTION.................564 PATTERN DATA INPUT ...........................................311 PERIODICAL SECONDARY PITCH COMPENSATION.......................................................600 PITCH ERROR COMPENSATION ............................181 PIVOT AXIS CONTROL ............................................569 PMC .............................................................................509 POLAR COORDINATE INTERPOLATION..............279 POLYGON TURNING................................................371 POSITION SWITCH FUNCTIONS ............................348 POSITIONING BY OPTIMUM ACCELERATION ...312 POWER MATE CNC ....................................................30 PREFACE .................................................................... p-2 PROGRAM RESTART (1 OF 2).................................361 PROGRAM RESTART (2 OF 2).................................474 PROGRAMS (1 OF 4) .................................................166 PROGRAMS (2 OF 4) .................................................478 PROGRAMS (3 OF 4) .................................................501 PROGRAMS (4 OF 4) .................................................557

<T>
THE CHUCK AND TAIL STOCK BARRIER .............56 THE ELECTRONIC GEAR BOX (EGB)....................378 THE INCORRECT OPERATION PREVENTION FUNCTION..................................................................441 THE MACHINING CONDITION SELECTION FUNCTION..................................................................559 Thread Cutting Cycle ...................................................251

i-2

B-63950EN/04

INDEX

TILTED WORKING PLANE COMMAND................471 TOOL CENTER POINT CONTROL ..........................475 TOOL COMPENSATION (1 OF 3) ............................224 TOOL COMPENSATION (2 OF 3) ............................496 TOOL COMPENSATION (3 OF 3) ............................609 TOOL LIFE MANAGEMENT (1 OF 2) .....................339 TOOL LIFE MANAGEMENT (2 OF 2) .....................552 TOOL MANAGEMENT FUNCTIONS (1 OF 2)........339 TOOL MANAGEMENT FUNCTIONS (2 OF 2)........541 TOOL RETRACT AND RECOVER ...........................451

<W>
WAVEFORM DIAGNOSIS ........................................454 WORKPIECE SETTING ERROR COMPENSATION (1 OF 2)........................................................................469 WORKPIECE SETTING ERROR COMPENSATION (2 OF 2)........................................................................506

i-3

Revision Record

FANUC Series 30i-MODEL A, Series 31i-MODEL A, Series 32i-MODEL A PARAMETER MANUAL (B-63950EN)

04

Nov., 2009 Total revision

03

Aug., 2007 Total revision

02

May, 2004

Addition of functions Addition of following models - Series 31i /310i /310is-MODEL A5 - Series 31i /310i /310is-MODEL A - Series 32i /320i /320is-MODEL A

01

Apr., 2003

Edition

Date

Contents

Edition

Date

Contents

B-63950EN/04

* B - 6 3 9 5 0 E N /

0 4 *

You might also like